dwww Home | Manual pages | Find package

ZSHALL(1)                   General Commands Manual                  ZSHALL(1)

NAME
       zshall - the Z shell meta-man page

OVERVIEW
       Because  zsh contains many features, the zsh manual has been split into
       a number of sections.  This manual page includes all the separate  man-
       ual pages in the following order:

       zsh          Zsh overview
       zshroadmap   Informal introduction to the manual
       zshmisc      Anything not fitting into the other sections
       zshexpn      Zsh command and parameter expansion
       zshparam     Zsh parameters
       zshoptions   Zsh options
       zshbuiltins  Zsh built-in functions
       zshzle       Zsh command line editing
       zshcompwid   Zsh completion widgets
       zshcompsys   Zsh completion system
       zshcompctl   Zsh completion control
       zshmodules   Zsh loadable modules
       zshcalsys    Zsh built-in calendar functions
       zshtcpsys    Zsh built-in TCP functions
       zshzftpsys   Zsh built-in FTP client
       zshcontrib   Additional zsh functions and utilities

DESCRIPTION
       Zsh  is a UNIX command interpreter (shell) usable as an interactive lo-
       gin shell and as a shell script command  processor.   Of  the  standard
       shells,  zsh most closely resembles ksh but includes many enhancements.
       It does not provide compatibility with POSIX or other shells in its de-
       fault operating mode:  see the section `Compatibility' below.

       Zsh has command line editing, builtin spelling correction, programmable
       command completion, shell functions (with autoloading), a history mech-
       anism, and a host of other features.

AUTHOR
       Zsh  was  originally written by Paul Falstad.  Zsh is now maintained by
       the members of the zsh-workers mailing list <zsh-workers@zsh.org>.  The
       development is currently coordinated by Peter Stephenson <pws@zsh.org>.
       The coordinator can be contacted at <coordinator@zsh.org>, but  matters
       relating to the code should generally go to the mailing list.

AVAILABILITY
       Zsh is available from the following HTTP and anonymous FTP site.

       ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/
       https://www.zsh.org/pub/

       The  up-to-date source code is available via Git from Sourceforge.  See
       https://sourceforge.net/projects/zsh/ for details.  A  summary  of  in-
       structions for the archive can be found at https://zsh.sourceforge.io/.

MAILING LISTS
       Zsh has several mailing lists:

       <zsh-announce@zsh.org>
              Announcements about releases, major changes in the shell and the
              monthly posting of the Zsh FAQ.  (moderated)

       <zsh-users@zsh.org>
              User discussions.

       <zsh-workers@zsh.org>
              Hacking, development, bug reports and patches.

       <zsh-security@zsh.org>
              Private mailing list (the general public cannot subscribe to it)
              for discussing bug reports with security implications, i.e., po-
              tential vulnerabilities.

              If you find a security problem in zsh itself, please  mail  this
              address.

       To subscribe or unsubscribe, send mail to the associated administrative
       address for the mailing list.

       <zsh-announce-subscribe@zsh.org>
       <zsh-users-subscribe@zsh.org>
       <zsh-workers-subscribe@zsh.org>
       <zsh-announce-unsubscribe@zsh.org>
       <zsh-users-unsubscribe@zsh.org>
       <zsh-workers-unsubscribe@zsh.org>

       YOU ONLY NEED TO JOIN ONE OF THE MAILING LISTS AS THEY ARE NESTED.  All
       submissions  to  zsh-announce are automatically forwarded to zsh-users.
       All submissions to zsh-users are automatically forwarded  to  zsh-work-
       ers.

       If  you  have  problems subscribing/unsubscribing to any of the mailing
       lists, send mail to <listmaster@zsh.org>.

       The mailing lists are archived; the archives can be  accessed  via  the
       administrative  addresses  listed above.  There is also a hypertext ar-
       chive available at https://www.zsh.org/mla/.

THE ZSH FAQ
       Zsh has a list of Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ), maintained by Peter
       Stephenson  <pws@zsh.org>.   It  is  regularly  posted to the newsgroup
       comp.unix.shell and the zsh-announce mailing list.  The latest  version
       can    be    found   at   any   of   the   Zsh   FTP   sites,   or   at
       https://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.  The contact address for FAQ-related  matters
       is <faqmaster@zsh.org>.

THE ZSH WEB PAGE
       Zsh  has a web page which is located at https://www.zsh.org/.  The con-
       tact address for web-related matters is <webmaster@zsh.org>.

THE ZSH USERGUIDE
       A userguide is currently in preparation.  It is intended to  complement
       the  manual, with explanations and hints on issues where the manual can
       be cabbalistic, hierographic, or downright mystifying (for example, the
       word  `hierographic'  does not exist).  It can be viewed in its current
       state at https://zsh.sourceforge.io/Guide/.  At the  time  of  writing,
       chapters dealing with startup files and their contents and the new com-
       pletion system were essentially complete.

INVOCATION
       The following flags are interpreted by the shell when invoked to deter-
       mine where the shell will read commands from:

       -c     Take  the  first  argument  as a command to execute, rather than
              reading commands from a script or standard input.  If  any  fur-
              ther  arguments  are  given,  the  first  one is assigned to $0,
              rather than being used as a positional parameter.

       -i     Force shell to be interactive.  It is still possible to  specify
              a script to execute.

       -s     Force shell to read commands from the standard input.  If the -s
              flag is not present and an argument is given, the first argument
              is taken to be the pathname of a script to execute.

       If  there are any remaining arguments after option processing, and nei-
       ther of the options -c or -s was supplied, the first argument is  taken
       as  the file name of a script containing shell commands to be executed.
       If the option PATH_SCRIPT is set, and the file name does not contain  a
       directory  path  (i.e.  there is no `/' in the name), first the current
       directory and then the command path given  by  the  variable  PATH  are
       searched  for  the  script.   If the option is not set or the file name
       contains a `/' it is used directly.

       After the first one or two arguments  have  been  appropriated  as  de-
       scribed  above,  the remaining arguments are assigned to the positional
       parameters.

       For further options,  which  are  common  to  invocation  and  the  set
       builtin, see zshoptions(1).

       The  long option `--emulate' followed (in a separate word) by an emula-
       tion mode may be passed to the shell.  The emulation  modes  are  those
       described for the emulate builtin, see zshbuiltins(1).  The `--emulate'
       option must precede any other options (which might otherwise  be  over-
       ridden),  but  following options are honoured, so may be used to modify
       the requested emulation mode.  Note that certain extra steps are  taken
       to ensure a smooth emulation when this option is used compared with the
       emulate command within the shell: for example, variables that  conflict
       with POSIX usage such as path are not defined within the shell.

       Options  may  be specified by name using the -o option.  -o acts like a
       single-letter option, but takes a following string as the option  name.
       For example,

              zsh -x -o shwordsplit scr

       runs  the  script  scr,  setting the XTRACE option by the corresponding
       letter `-x' and the SH_WORD_SPLIT  option  by  name.   Options  may  be
       turned  off  by  name  by using +o instead of -o.  -o can be stacked up
       with preceding single-letter options, so for example `-xo  shwordsplit'
       or `-xoshwordsplit' is equivalent to `-x -o shwordsplit'.

       Options  may also be specified by name in GNU long option style, `--op-
       tion-name'.  When this is done, `-' characters in the option  name  are
       permitted: they are translated into `_', and thus ignored.  So, for ex-
       ample, `zsh --sh-word-split' invokes zsh with the SH_WORD_SPLIT  option
       turned  on.   Like  other option syntaxes, options can be turned off by
       replacing the initial `-' with a `+'; thus `+-sh-word-split' is equiva-
       lent  to `--no-sh-word-split'.  Unlike other option syntaxes, GNU-style
       long options cannot be stacked with any other options, so  for  example
       `-x-shwordsplit'  is  an  error,  rather  than  being  treated like `-x
       --shwordsplit'.

       The special GNU-style option `--version' is handled; it sends to  stan-
       dard  output  the shell's version information, then exits successfully.
       `--help' is also handled; it sends to standard output a list of options
       that can be used when invoking the shell, then exits successfully.

       Option  processing  may  be finished, allowing following arguments that
       start with `-' or `+' to be treated as normal arguments, in  two  ways.
       Firstly,  a lone `-' (or `+') as an argument by itself ends option pro-
       cessing.  Secondly, a special option `--' (or `+-'), which may be spec-
       ified  on its own (which is the standard POSIX usage) or may be stacked
       with preceding options (so `-x-' is equivalent to  `-x  --').   Options
       are not permitted to be stacked after `--' (so `-x-f' is an error), but
       note the GNU-style option form discussed above,  where  `--shwordsplit'
       is permitted and does not end option processing.

       Except  when  the sh/ksh emulation single-letter options are in effect,
       the option `-b' (or `+b') ends option processing.  `-b' is  like  `--',
       except that further single-letter options can be stacked after the `-b'
       and will take effect as normal.

COMPATIBILITY
       Zsh tries to emulate sh or ksh when it is invoked as sh or ksh  respec-
       tively;  more  precisely,  it  looks at the first letter of the name by
       which it was invoked, excluding any initial `r' (assumed to  stand  for
       `restricted'),  and  if  that  is `b', `s' or `k' it will emulate sh or
       ksh.  Furthermore, if invoked as su (which happens on  certain  systems
       when  the  shell  is executed by the su command), the shell will try to
       find an alternative name from the SHELL environment variable  and  per-
       form emulation based on that.

       In sh and ksh compatibility modes the following parameters are not spe-
       cial and not initialized by the shell:  ARGC,  argv,  cdpath,  fignore,
       fpath,  HISTCHARS,  mailpath,  MANPATH,  manpath, path, prompt, PROMPT,
       PROMPT2, PROMPT3, PROMPT4, psvar, status.

       The usual zsh startup/shutdown scripts are not executed.  Login  shells
       source /etc/profile followed by $HOME/.profile.  If the ENV environment
       variable is set on  invocation,  $ENV  is  sourced  after  the  profile
       scripts.  The value of ENV is subjected to parameter expansion, command
       substitution, and arithmetic expansion before being  interpreted  as  a
       pathname.   Note  that the PRIVILEGED option also affects the execution
       of startup files.

       The following options are set if the shell is invoked  as  sh  or  ksh:
       NO_BAD_PATTERN,    NO_BANG_HIST,    NO_BG_NICE,   NO_EQUALS,   NO_FUNC-
       TION_ARGZERO, GLOB_SUBST,  NO_GLOBAL_EXPORT,  NO_HUP,  INTERACTIVE_COM-
       MENTS,  KSH_ARRAYS,  NO_MULTIOS, NO_NOMATCH, NO_NOTIFY, POSIX_BUILTINS,
       NO_PROMPT_PERCENT, RM_STAR_SILENT, SH_FILE_EXPANSION,  SH_GLOB,  SH_OP-
       TION_LETTERS,   SH_WORD_SPLIT.    Additionally  the  BSD_ECHO  and  IG-
       NORE_BRACES options are set if zsh is invoked as sh.  Also, the KSH_OP-
       TION_PRINT,   LOCAL_OPTIONS,   PROMPT_BANG,   PROMPT_SUBST   and   SIN-
       GLE_LINE_ZLE options are set if zsh is invoked as ksh.

       Please note that, whilst reasonable efforts are taken to address incom-
       patibilities when they arise, zsh does not guarantee complete emulation
       of other shells, nor POSIX compliance. For more information on the dif-
       ferences between zsh and other shells, please refer to chapter 2 of the
       shell FAQ, https://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.

RESTRICTED SHELL
       When the basename of the command used to invoke  zsh  starts  with  the
       letter  `r'  or the `-r' command line option is supplied at invocation,
       the shell becomes  restricted.   Emulation  mode  is  determined  after
       stripping  the  letter `r' from the invocation name.  The following are
       disabled in restricted mode:

       •      changing directories with the cd builtin

       •      changing or unsetting the EGID, EUID, GID,  HISTFILE,  HISTSIZE,
              IFS,   LD_AOUT_LIBRARY_PATH,  LD_AOUT_PRELOAD,  LD_LIBRARY_PATH,
              LD_PRELOAD, MODULE_PATH, module_path, PATH, path, SHELL, UID and
              USERNAME parameters

       •      specifying command names containing /

       •      specifying command pathnames using hash

       •      redirecting output to files

       •      using the exec builtin command to replace the shell with another
              command

       •      using jobs -Z to overwrite the shell process' argument and envi-
              ronment space

       •      using  the ARGV0 parameter to override argv[0] for external com-
              mands

       •      turning off restricted mode with set +r or unsetopt RESTRICTED

       These restrictions are enforced after  processing  the  startup  files.
       The  startup  files  should set up PATH to point to a directory of com-
       mands which can be safely invoked in the restricted environment.   They
       may also add further restrictions by disabling selected builtins.

       Restricted  mode  can  also  be  activated  any time by setting the RE-
       STRICTED option.  This immediately enables  all  the  restrictions  de-
       scribed  above  even  if  the shell still has not processed all startup
       files.

       A shell Restricted Mode is an outdated way to restrict what  users  may
       do:   modern  systems have better, safer and more reliable ways to con-
       fine user actions, such as chroot jails, containers and zones.

       A restricted shell is very difficult to implement safely.  The  feature
       may be removed in a future version of zsh.

       It  is  important  to  realise  that the restrictions only apply to the
       shell, not to the commands it runs (except for  some  shell  builtins).
       While  a  restricted shell can only run the restricted list of commands
       accessible via the predefined `PATH'  variable,  it  does  not  prevent
       those commands from running any other command.

       As  an example, if `env' is among the list of allowed commands, then it
       allows the user to run any command as `env' is not a shell builtin com-
       mand and can run arbitrary executables.

       So when implementing a restricted shell framework it is important to be
       fully aware of what actions each of the allowed  commands  or  features
       (which may be regarded as modules) can perform.

       Many  commands  can  have their behaviour affected by environment vari-
       ables.  Except for the few listed above, zsh does not restrict the set-
       ting of environment variables.

       If  a  `perl',  `python',  `bash', or other general purpose interpreted
       script it treated as a restricted command, the user can work around the
       restriction  by  setting  specially  crafted  `PERL5LIB', `PYTHONPATH',
       `BASHENV' (etc.) environment variables. On GNU systems, any command can
       be  made to run arbitrary code when performing character set conversion
       (including zsh itself) by setting a `GCONV_PATH' environment  variable.
       Those are only a few examples.

       Bear  in  mind that, contrary to some other shells, `readonly' is not a
       security feature in zsh as it can be undone and so cannot  be  used  to
       mitigate the above.

       A restricted shell only works if the allowed commands are few and care-
       fully written so as not to grant more access to  users  than  intended.
       It  is  also important to restrict what zsh module the user may load as
       some of them, such as `zsh/system', `zsh/mapfile' and `zsh/files',  al-
       low bypassing most of the restrictions.

STARTUP/SHUTDOWN FILES
       Commands  are  first read from /etc/zsh/zshenv; this cannot be overrid-
       den.  Subsequent behaviour is modified by the RCS  and  GLOBAL_RCS  op-
       tions;  the former affects all startup files, while the second only af-
       fects global startup files (those shown here with an path starting with
       a  /).   If  one  of  the options is unset at any point, any subsequent
       startup file(s) of the corresponding type will not be read.  It is also
       possible  for  a file in $ZDOTDIR to re-enable GLOBAL_RCS. Both RCS and
       GLOBAL_RCS are set by default.

       Commands are then read from $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv.  If the shell is a  login
       shell,  commands  are  read  from  /etc/zsh/zprofile  and  then  $ZDOT-
       DIR/.zprofile.  Then, if the shell is interactive,  commands  are  read
       from /etc/zsh/zshrc and then $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc.  Finally, if the shell is
       a login shell, /etc/zsh/zlogin and $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin are read.

       When  a  login  shell  exits,  the  files  $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout  and  then
       /etc/zsh/zlogout  are  read.  This happens with either an explicit exit
       via the exit or  logout  commands,  or  an  implicit  exit  by  reading
       end-of-file from the terminal.  However, if the shell terminates due to
       exec'ing another process, the logout files are  not  read.   These  are
       also  affected  by  the RCS and GLOBAL_RCS options.  Note also that the
       RCS option affects the saving of history files, i.e. if  RCS  is  unset
       when the shell exits, no history file will be saved.

       If ZDOTDIR is unset, HOME is used instead.  Files listed above as being
       in /etc may be in another directory, depending on the installation.

       As /etc/zsh/zshenv is run for all instances of  zsh,  it  is  important
       that it be kept as small as possible.  In particular, it is a good idea
       to put code that does not need to be run for every single shell  behind
       a  test  of the form `if [[ -o rcs ]]; then ...' so that it will not be
       executed when zsh is invoked with the `-f' option.

       Any of these files may be pre-compiled with the zcompile  builtin  com-
       mand  (see  zshbuiltins(1)).   If a compiled file exists (named for the
       original file plus the .zwc extension) and it is newer than the  origi-
       nal file, the compiled file will be used instead.

ZSHROADMAP(1)               General Commands Manual              ZSHROADMAP(1)

NAME
       zshroadmap  -  informal  introduction to the zsh manual The Zsh Manual,
       like the shell itself, is large and often complicated.  This section of
       the manual provides some pointers to areas of the shell that are likely
       to be of particular interest to new users, and indicates where  in  the
       rest of the manual the documentation is to be found.

WHEN THE SHELL STARTS
       When it starts, the shell reads commands from various files.  These can
       be  created  or  edited  to  customize  the  shell.   See  the  section
       Startup/Shutdown Files in zsh(1).

       If no personal initialization files exist for the current user, a func-
       tion is run to help you change some of the most  common  settings.   It
       won't appear if your administrator has disabled the zsh/newuser module.
       The function is designed to be self-explanatory.  You  can  run  it  by
       hand  with  `autoload -Uz zsh-newuser-install; zsh-newuser-install -f'.
       See also the section `User Configuration Functions' in zshcontrib(1).

INTERACTIVE USE
       Interaction with the shell uses the builtin Zsh Line Editor, ZLE.  This
       is described in detail in zshzle(1).

       The  first  decision a user must make is whether to use the Emacs or Vi
       editing mode as the  keys  for  editing  are  substantially  different.
       Emacs  editing  mode  is probably more natural for beginners and can be
       selected explicitly with the command bindkey -e.

       A history mechanism for retrieving previously typed lines (most  simply
       with  the  Up or Down arrow keys) is available; note that, unlike other
       shells, zsh will not save these lines when the shell exits  unless  you
       set  appropriate variables, and the number of history lines retained by
       default is quite small (30 lines).  See the description  of  the  shell
       variables  (referred  to  in the documentation as parameters) HISTFILE,
       HISTSIZE and SAVEHIST in zshparam(1).  Note that  it's  currently  only
       possible  to  read and write files saving history when the shell is in-
       teractive, i.e. it does not work from scripts.

       The shell now supports the UTF-8 character set (and also others if sup-
       ported  by  the  operating system).  This is (mostly) handled transpar-
       ently by the shell, but the degree of support in terminal emulators  is
       variable.   There  is  some  discussion  of  this  in  the  shell  FAQ,
       https://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.  Note in particular that for combining  char-
       acters  to  be handled the option COMBINING_CHARS needs to be set.  Be-
       cause the shell is now more sensitive to the definition of the  charac-
       ter  set,  note  that if you are upgrading from an older version of the
       shell you should ensure that the appropriate variable, either LANG  (to
       affect  all  aspects  of  the shell's operation) or LC_CTYPE (to affect
       only the handling of character sets) is set to  an  appropriate  value.
       This  is true even if you are using a single-byte character set includ-
       ing extensions of ASCII such as ISO-8859-1 or ISO-8859-15.  See the de-
       scription of LC_CTYPE in zshparam(1).

   Completion
       Completion  is  a feature present in many shells. It allows the user to
       type only a part (usually the prefix) of a word and have the shell fill
       in  the rest.  The completion system in zsh is programmable.  For exam-
       ple, the shell can be set to complete email addresses in  arguments  to
       the  mail command from your ~/.abook/addressbook; usernames, hostnames,
       and even remote paths in arguments to scp, and so  on.   Anything  that
       can  be written in or glued together with zsh can be the source of what
       the line editor offers as possible completions.

       Zsh has two completion systems, an old, so  called  compctl  completion
       (named  after  the builtin command that serves as its complete and only
       user interface), and a new one, referred to as  compsys,  organized  as
       library  of builtin and user-defined functions.  The two systems differ
       in their interface for specifying the  completion  behavior.   The  new
       system  is  more customizable and is supplied with completions for many
       commonly used commands; it is therefore to be preferred.

       The completion system must be enabled explicitly when the shell starts.
       For more information see zshcompsys(1).

   Extending the line editor
       Apart from completion, the line editor is highly extensible by means of
       shell functions.  Some useful functions are provided  with  the  shell;
       they provide facilities such as:

       insert-composed-char
              composing characters not found on the keyboard

       match-words-by-style
              configuring what the line editor considers a word when moving or
              deleting by word

       history-beginning-search-backward-end, etc.
              alternative ways of searching the shell history

       replace-string, replace-pattern
              functions for replacing strings or patterns globally in the com-
              mand line

       edit-command-line
              edit the command line with an external editor.

       See  the  section  `ZLE Functions' in zshcontrib(1) for descriptions of
       these.

OPTIONS
       The shell has a large number of options  for  changing  its  behaviour.
       These  cover  all aspects of the shell; browsing the full documentation
       is the only good way to become acquainted with the many  possibilities.
       See zshoptions(1).

PATTERN MATCHING
       The  shell  has  a  rich  set  of patterns which are available for file
       matching (described in the documentation as `filename  generation'  and
       also  known for historical reasons as `globbing') and for use when pro-
       gramming.  These are described in the section `Filename Generation'  in
       zshexpn(1).

       Of particular interest are the following patterns that are not commonly
       supported by other systems of pattern matching:

       **     for matching over multiple directories

       |      for matching either of two alternatives

       ~, ^   the ability to exclude  patterns  from  matching  when  the  EX-
              TENDED_GLOB option is set

       (...)  glob  qualifiers, included in parentheses at the end of the pat-
              tern, which select files by type (such as directories) or attri-
              bute (such as size).

GENERAL COMMENTS ON SYNTAX
       Although  the  syntax  of zsh is in ways similar to the Korn shell, and
       therefore more remotely to the original UNIX shell, the  Bourne  shell,
       its  default  behaviour  does  not entirely correspond to those shells.
       General shell syntax is introduced in the section  `Shell  Grammar'  in
       zshmisc(1).

       One  commonly encountered difference is that variables substituted onto
       the command line are not split into words.  See the description of  the
       shell option SH_WORD_SPLIT in the section `Parameter Expansion' in zsh-
       expn(1).  In zsh, you can either explicitly request the splitting (e.g.
       ${=foo})  or  use  an  array when you want a variable to expand to more
       than one word.  See the section `Array Parameters' in zshparam(1).

PROGRAMMING
       The most convenient way of adding enhancements to the  shell  is  typi-
       cally  by  writing  a  shell  function  and  arranging for it to be au-
       toloaded.  Functions are described in the section `Functions'  in  zsh-
       misc(1).   Users changing from the C shell and its relatives should no-
       tice that aliases are less used in zsh as they don't  perform  argument
       substitution, only simple text replacement.

       A few general functions, other than those for the line editor described
       above, are provided with the shell and are described in  zshcontrib(1).
       Features include:

       promptinit
              a  prompt theme system for changing prompts easily, see the sec-
              tion `Prompt Themes'

       zsh-mime-setup
              a MIME-handling system which dispatches  commands  according  to
              the suffix of a file as done by graphical file managers

       zcalc  a calculator

       zargs  a version of xargs that makes the find command redundant

       zmv    a command for renaming files by means of shell patterns.

ZSHMISC(1)                  General Commands Manual                 ZSHMISC(1)

NAME
       zshmisc - everything and then some

SIMPLE COMMANDS & PIPELINES
       A  simple  command is a sequence of optional parameter assignments fol-
       lowed by  blank-separated  words,  with  optional  redirections  inter-
       spersed.   For  a  description of assignment, see the beginning of zsh-
       param(1).

       The first word is the command to be executed, and the remaining  words,
       if  any, are arguments to the command.  If a command name is given, the
       parameter assignments modify the environment of the command when it  is
       executed.   The  value  of  a simple command is its exit status, or 128
       plus the signal number if terminated by a signal.  For example,

              echo foo

       is a simple command with arguments.

       A pipeline is either a simple command, or a sequence  of  two  or  more
       simple commands where each command is separated from the next by `|' or
       `|&'.  Where commands are separated by `|', the standard output of  the
       first  command is connected to the standard input of the next.  `|&' is
       shorthand for `2>&1 |', which connects both the standard output and the
       standard  error  of the command to the standard input of the next.  The
       value of a pipeline is the value of the last command, unless the  pipe-
       line  is preceded by `!' in which case the value is the logical inverse
       of the value of the last command.  For example,

              echo foo | sed 's/foo/bar/'

       is a pipeline, where the output (`foo' plus a  newline)  of  the  first
       command will be passed to the input of the second.

       If a pipeline is preceded by `coproc', it is executed as a coprocess; a
       two-way pipe is established between it and the parent shell.  The shell
       can read from or write to the coprocess by means of the `>&p' and `<&p'
       redirection operators or with `print -p' and  `read  -p'.   A  pipeline
       cannot be preceded by both `coproc' and `!'.  If job control is active,
       the coprocess can be treated in other than input and output as an ordi-
       nary background job.

       A  sublist  is  either  a single pipeline, or a sequence of two or more
       pipelines separated by `&&' or `||'.  If two pipelines are separated by
       `&&',  the  second pipeline is executed only if the first succeeds (re-
       turns a zero status).  If two pipelines are separated by `||', the sec-
       ond  is  executed  only  if the first fails (returns a nonzero status).
       Both operators have equal precedence and  are  left  associative.   The
       value  of  the sublist is the value of the last pipeline executed.  For
       example,

              dmesg | grep panic && print yes

       is a sublist consisting of two pipelines, the second just a simple com-
       mand  which  will be executed if and only if the grep command returns a
       zero status.  If it does not, the value of the sublist is  that  return
       status,  else  it is the status returned by the print (almost certainly
       zero).

       A list is a sequence of zero or more sublists, in which each sublist is
       terminated  by `;', `&', `&|', `&!', or a newline.  This terminator may
       optionally be omitted from the last sublist in the list when  the  list
       appears as a complex command inside `(...)' or `{...}'.  When a sublist
       is terminated by `;' or newline, the shell waits for it to  finish  be-
       fore  executing the next sublist.  If a sublist is terminated by a `&',
       `&|', or `&!', the shell executes the last pipeline in it in the  back-
       ground,  and  does  not wait for it to finish (note the difference from
       other shells which execute the whole sublist  in  the  background).   A
       backgrounded pipeline returns a status of zero.

       More generally, a list can be seen as a set of any shell commands what-
       soever, including the complex commands below; this is implied  wherever
       the  word  `list' appears in later descriptions.  For example, the com-
       mands in a shell function form a special sort of list.

PRECOMMAND MODIFIERS
       A simple command may be preceded by a precommand modifier,  which  will
       alter  how  the  command  is  interpreted.   These  modifiers are shell
       builtin commands with the exception of nocorrect which  is  a  reserved
       word.

       -      The  command  is  executed  with  a `-' prepended to its argv[0]
              string.

       builtin
              The command word is taken to be the name of a  builtin  command,
              rather than a shell function or external command.

       command [ -pvV ]
              The command word is taken to be the name of an external command,
              rather than a shell function or builtin.   If the POSIX_BUILTINS
              option  is  set, builtins will also be executed but certain spe-
              cial properties of them are suppressed. The -p flag causes a de-
              fault  path to be searched instead of that in $path. With the -v
              flag, command is similar to whence and with -V, it is equivalent
              to whence -v.

       exec [ -cl ] [ -a argv0 ]
              The  following  command  together  with  any arguments is run in
              place of the current process, rather than as a sub-process.  The
              shell  does not fork and is replaced.  The shell does not invoke
              TRAPEXIT, nor does it source zlogout  files.   The  options  are
              provided for compatibility with other shells.

              The -c option clears the environment.

              The  -l  option  is  equivalent to the - precommand modifier, to
              treat the replacement command as a login shell; the  command  is
              executed  with  a  - prepended to its argv[0] string.  This flag
              has no effect if used together with the -a option.

              The -a option is used to specify explicitly the  argv[0]  string
              (the  name  of  the command as seen by the process itself) to be
              used by the replacement command and is  directly  equivalent  to
              setting a value for the ARGV0 environment variable.

       nocorrect
              Spelling  correction is not done on any of the words.  This must
              appear before any other precommand modifier,  as  it  is  inter-
              preted  immediately,  before any parsing is done.  It has no ef-
              fect in non-interactive shells.

       noglob Filename generation (globbing) is not performed on  any  of  the
              words.

COMPLEX COMMANDS
       A complex command in zsh is one of the following:

       if list then list [ elif list then list ] ... [ else list ] fi
              The  if  list is executed, and if it returns a zero exit status,
              the then list is executed.  Otherwise, the elif list is executed
              and  if  its status is zero, the then list is executed.  If each
              elif list returns nonzero status, the else list is executed.

       for name ... [ in word ... ] term do list done
              Expand the list of words, and set the parameter name to each  of
              them  in  turn,  executing  list each time.  If the `in word' is
              omitted, use the positional parameters instead of the words.

              The term consists of one or more newline or  ;  which  terminate
              the words, and are optional when the `in word' is omitted.

              More  than  one  parameter  name  can  appear before the list of
              words.  If N names are given, then on each execution of the loop
              the  next  N words are assigned to the corresponding parameters.
              If there are more names than remaining words, the remaining  pa-
              rameters  are  each  set  to the empty string.  Execution of the
              loop ends when there is no remaining word to assign to the first
              name.  It is only possible for in to appear as the first name in
              the list, else it will be treated as  marking  the  end  of  the
              list.

       for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) do list done
              The arithmetic expression expr1 is evaluated first (see the sec-
              tion `Arithmetic Evaluation').  The arithmetic expression  expr2
              is  repeatedly  evaluated  until  it  evaluates to zero and when
              non-zero, list is executed and the arithmetic  expression  expr3
              evaluated.   If any expression is omitted, then it behaves as if
              it evaluated to 1.

       while list do list done
              Execute the do list as long as the while  list  returns  a  zero
              exit status.

       until list do list done
              Execute the do list as long as until list returns a nonzero exit
              status.

       repeat word do list done
              word is expanded and treated as an arithmetic expression,  which
              must evaluate to a number n.  list is then executed n times.

              The  repeat  syntax is disabled by default when the shell starts
              in a mode emulating another shell.  It can be enabled  with  the
              command `enable -r repeat'

       case  word  in  [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&|;|) ] ...
       esac
              Execute the list associated with the first pattern that  matches
              word, if any.  The form of the patterns is the same as that used
              for filename generation.  See the section `Filename Generation'.

              Note further that, unless the SH_GLOB option is set,  the  whole
              pattern  with alternatives is treated by the shell as equivalent
              to a group of patterns within parentheses, although white  space
              may  appear  about the parentheses and the vertical bar and will
              be stripped from the pattern at those points.  White  space  may
              appear  elsewhere  in the pattern; this is not stripped.  If the
              SH_GLOB option is set, so that an opening parenthesis can be un-
              ambiguously  treated  as part of the case syntax, the expression
              is parsed into separate words and these are  treated  as  strict
              alternatives (as in other shells).

              If  the  list that is executed is terminated with ;& rather than
              ;;, the following list is also executed.  The rule for the  ter-
              minator of the following list ;;, ;& or ;| is applied unless the
              esac is reached.

              If the list that is executed is terminated  with  ;|  the  shell
              continues  to scan the patterns looking for the next match, exe-
              cuting the corresponding list, and applying  the  rule  for  the
              corresponding  terminator  ;;,  ;& or ;|.  Note that word is not
              re-expanded; all applicable patterns are tested  with  the  same
              word.

       select name [ in word ... term ] do list done
              where  term  is one or more newline or ; to terminate the words.
              Print the set of words, each preceded by a number.   If  the  in
              word  is  omitted,  use  the positional parameters.  The PROMPT3
              prompt is printed and a line is read from the line editor if the
              shell is interactive and that is active, or else standard input.
              If this line consists of the number of one of the listed  words,
              then the parameter name is set to the word corresponding to this
              number.  If this line is empty, the selection  list  is  printed
              again.   Otherwise,  the  value  of the parameter name is set to
              null.  The contents of the line  read  from  standard  input  is
              saved  in the parameter REPLY.  list is executed for each selec-
              tion until a break or end-of-file is encountered.

       ( list )
              Execute list in a subshell.  Traps set by the trap  builtin  are
              reset to their default values while executing list; an exception
              is that ignored signals will continue to be ignored if  the  op-
              tion POSIXTRAPS is set.

       { list }
              Execute list.

       { try-list } always { always-list }
              First  execute try-list.  Regardless of errors, or break or con-
              tinue commands encountered within try-list, execute always-list.
              Execution  then  continues  from  the result of the execution of
              try-list; in other words, any error, or break or  continue  com-
              mand  is  treated  in the normal way, as if always-list were not
              present.  The two chunks of code are referred  to  as  the  `try
              block' and the `always block'.

              Optional  newlines  or  semicolons  may appear after the always;
              note, however, that they may not appear  between  the  preceding
              closing brace and the always.

              An `error' in this context is a condition such as a syntax error
              which causes the shell to abort execution of the  current  func-
              tion,  script,  or  list.   Syntax  errors encountered while the
              shell is parsing the code do not cause the always-list to be ex-
              ecuted.   For  example,  an  erroneously constructed if block in
              try-list would cause the shell to abort during parsing, so  that
              always-list  would not be executed, while an erroneous substitu-
              tion such as ${*foo*} would cause a run-time error, after  which
              always-list would be executed.

              An  error condition can be tested and reset with the special in-
              teger variable  TRY_BLOCK_ERROR.   Outside  an  always-list  the
              value  is  irrelevant,  but it is initialised to -1.  Inside al-
              ways-list, the value is 1 if an error occurred in the  try-list,
              else  0.  If TRY_BLOCK_ERROR is set to 0 during the always-list,
              the error condition caused by the try-list is reset,  and  shell
              execution  continues normally after the end of always-list.  Al-
              tering the value during the try-list is not useful (unless  this
              forms part of an enclosing always block).

              Regardless  of TRY_BLOCK_ERROR, after the end of always-list the
              normal shell status $? is  the  value  returned  from  try-list.
              This   will   be  non-zero  if  there  was  an  error,  even  if
              TRY_BLOCK_ERROR was set to zero.

              The following executes the given code, ignoring  any  errors  it
              causes.   This is an alternative to the usual convention of pro-
              tecting code by executing it in a subshell.

                     {
                         # code which may cause an error
                       } always {
                         # This code is executed regardless of the error.
                         (( TRY_BLOCK_ERROR = 0 ))
                     }
                     # The error condition has been reset.

              When a try block occurs outside of any function, a return  or  a
              exit encountered in try-list does not cause the execution of al-
              ways-list.  Instead, the shell exits immediately after any  EXIT
              trap has been executed.  Otherwise, a return command encountered
              in try-list will cause the execution of always-list,  just  like
              break and continue.

       function [ -T ] word ... [ () ] [ term ] { list }
       word ... () [ term ] { list }
       word ... () [ term ] command
              where term is one or more newline or ;.  Define a function which
              is referenced by any one of word.  Normally, only  one  word  is
              provided;  multiple  words  are  usually only useful for setting
              traps.  The body of the function is the list between the  {  and
              }.  See the section `Functions'.

              The options of function have the following meanings:

              -T     Enable  tracing  for  this function, as though with func-
                     tions -T.  See the documentation of the -f option to  the
                     typeset builtin, in zshbuiltins(1).

              If  the  option  SH_GLOB  is  set  for  compatibility with other
              shells, then whitespace may appear between the  left  and  right
              parentheses  when there is a single word;  otherwise, the paren-
              theses will be treated as forming a  globbing  pattern  in  that
              case.

              In  any of the forms above, a redirection may appear outside the
              function body, for example

                     func() { ... } 2>&1

              The redirection is stored with the function and applied whenever
              the  function is executed.  Any variables in the redirection are
              expanded at the point the function is executed, but outside  the
              function scope.

       time [ pipeline ]
              The  pipeline is executed, and timing statistics are reported on
              the standard error in the form specified by the TIMEFMT  parame-
              ter.   If  pipeline is omitted, print statistics about the shell
              process and its children.

       [[ exp ]]
              Evaluates the conditional expression exp and return a zero  exit
              status if it is true.  See the section `Conditional Expressions'
              for a description of exp.

ALTERNATE FORMS FOR COMPLEX COMMANDS
       Many of  zsh's  complex  commands  have  alternate  forms.   These  are
       non-standard  and  are  likely not to be obvious even to seasoned shell
       programmers; they should not be used anywhere that portability of shell
       code is a concern.

       The short versions below only work if sublist is of the form `{ list }'
       or if the SHORT_LOOPS option is set.  For the if, while and until  com-
       mands, in both these cases the test part of the loop must also be suit-
       ably delimited, such as by `[[ ... ]]' or `(( ... ))', else the end  of
       the  test will not be recognized.  For the for, repeat, case and select
       commands no such special form for the arguments is necessary,  but  the
       other  condition (the special form of sublist or use of the SHORT_LOOPS
       option) still applies.  The SHORT_REPEAT option is available to  enable
       the short version only for the repeat command.

       if list { list } [ elif list { list } ] ... [ else { list } ]
              An alternate form of if.  The rules mean that

                     if [[ -o ignorebraces ]] {
                       print yes
                     }

              works, but

                     if true {  # Does not work!
                       print yes
                     }

              does not, since the test is not suitably delimited.

       if list sublist
              A  short  form of the alternate if.  The same limitations on the
              form of list apply as for the previous form.

       for name ... ( word ... ) sublist
              A short form of for.

       for name ... [ in word ... ] term sublist
              where term is at least one newline or ;.  Another short form  of
              for.

       for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) sublist
              A short form of the arithmetic for command.

       foreach name ... ( word ... ) list end
              Another form of for.

       while list { list }
              An  alternative form of while.  Note the limitations on the form
              of list mentioned above.

       until list { list }
              An alternative form of until.  Note the limitations on the  form
              of list mentioned above.

       repeat word sublist
              This is a short form of repeat.

       case word { [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&|;|) ] ... }
              An alternative form of case.

       select name [ in word ... term ] sublist
              where  term  is  at least one newline or ;.  A short form of se-
              lect.

       function word ... [ () ] [ term ] sublist
              This is a short form of function.

RESERVED WORDS
       The following words are recognized as reserved words when used  as  the
       first word of a command unless quoted or disabled using disable -r:

       do  done  esac then elif else fi for case if while function repeat time
       until select coproc nocorrect foreach end ! [[ { } declare export float
       integer local readonly typeset

       Additionally,  `}'  is  recognized  in  any position if neither the IG-
       NORE_BRACES option nor the IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES option is set.

ERRORS
       Certain errors are treated as fatal by the  shell:  in  an  interactive
       shell,  they  cause  control  to  return  to the command line, and in a
       non-interactive shell they cause the shell to  be  aborted.   In  older
       versions  of  zsh,  a  non-interactive shell running a script would not
       abort completely, but would resume execution at the next command to  be
       read  from the script, skipping the remainder of any functions or shell
       constructs such as loops or conditions; this somewhat illogical  behav-
       iour can be recovered by setting the option CONTINUE_ON_ERROR.

       Fatal errors found in non-interactive shells include:

       •      Failure to parse shell options passed when invoking the shell

       •      Failure to change options with the set builtin

       •      Parse errors of all sorts, including failures to parse mathemat-
              ical expressions

       •      Failures to set or modify variable behaviour with  typeset,  lo-
              cal, declare, export, integer, float

       •      Execution  of  incorrectly  positioned  loop  control structures
              (continue, break)

       •      Attempts to use regular expression with  no  regular  expression
              module available

       •      Disallowed operations when the RESTRICTED options is set

       •      Failure to create a pipe needed for a pipeline

       •      Failure to create a multio

       •      Failure to autoload a module needed for a declared shell feature

       •      Errors creating command or process substitutions

       •      Syntax errors in glob qualifiers

       •      File  generation  errors where not caught by the option BAD_PAT-
              TERN

       •      All bad patterns used for matching within case statements

       •      File generation failures where not caused by NO_MATCH or similar
              options

       •      All  file generation errors where the pattern was used to create
              a multio

       •      Memory errors where detected by the shell

       •      Invalid subscripts to shell variables

       •      Attempts to assign read-only variables

       •      Logical errors with variables such as assignment  to  the  wrong
              type

       •      Use of invalid variable names

       •      Errors in variable substitution syntax

       •      Failure to convert characters in $'...' expressions

       If  the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, more errors associated with shell
       builtin commands are treated as fatal, as specified by the POSIX  stan-
       dard.

COMMENTS
       In  non-interactive  shells, or in interactive shells with the INTERAC-
       TIVE_COMMENTS option set, a word beginning with the third character  of
       the  histchars  parameter (`#' by default) causes that word and all the
       following characters up to a newline to be ignored.

ALIASING
       Every eligible word in the shell input is checked to see if there is an
       alias  defined  for it.  If so, it is replaced by the text of the alias
       if it is in command position (if it could be the first word of a simple
       command), or if the alias is global.  If the replacement text ends with
       a space, the next word in the shell input is always eligible  for  pur-
       poses of alias expansion.

       It  is an error for the function name, word, in the sh-compatible func-
       tion definition syntax `word () ...' to be a word  that  resulted  from
       alias expansion, unless the ALIAS_FUNC_DEF option is set.

       An  alias is defined using the alias builtin; global aliases may be de-
       fined using the -g option to that builtin.

       A word is defined as:

       •      Any plain string or glob pattern

       •      Any quoted string, using  any  quoting  method  (note  that  the
              quotes  must be part of the alias definition for this to be eli-
              gible)

       •      Any parameter reference or command substitution

       •      Any series of the foregoing, concatenated without whitespace  or
              other tokens between them

       •      Any reserved word (case, do, else, etc.)

       •      With global aliasing, any command separator, any redirection op-
              erator, and `(' or `)' when not part of a glob pattern

       Alias expansion is done on the shell input before any  other  expansion
       except  history  expansion.   Therefore, if an alias is defined for the
       word foo, alias expansion may be avoided by quoting part of  the  word,
       e.g.  \foo.   Any  form  of quoting works, although there is nothing to
       prevent an alias being defined for the quoted  form  such  as  \foo  as
       well.

       In particular, note that quoting must be used when using unalias to re-
       move global aliases:

              % alias -g foo=bar
              % unalias foo
              unalias: no such hash table element: bar
              % unalias \foo
              %

       When POSIX_ALIASES is set, only plain unquoted strings are eligible for
       aliasing.   The  alias  builtin does not reject ineligible aliases, but
       they are not expanded.

       For use with completion, which would remove an initial  backslash  fol-
       lowed  by  a character that isn't special, it may be more convenient to
       quote the word by starting with a single quote, i.e.  'foo;  completion
       will automatically add the trailing single quote.

   Alias difficulties
       Although aliases can be used in ways that bend normal shell syntax, not
       every string of non-white-space characters can be used as an alias.

       Any set of characters not listed as a word above is not a  word,  hence
       no  attempt  is  made to expand it as an alias, no matter how it is de-
       fined (i.e. via the builtin or the special parameter aliases  described
       in the section THE ZSH/PARAMETER MODULE in zshmodules(1)).  However, as
       noted in the case of POSIX_ALIASES above, the shell does not attempt to
       deduce  whether  the string corresponds to a word at the time the alias
       is created.

       For example, an expression containing an = at the start  of  a  command
       line  is  an assignment and cannot be expanded as an alias; a lone = is
       not an assignment but can only be set as an alias using the  parameter,
       as otherwise the = is taken part of the syntax of the builtin command.

       It  is  not  presently possible to alias the `((' token that introduces
       arithmetic expressions, because until a full statement has been parsed,
       it  cannot be distinguished from two consecutive `(' tokens introducing
       nested subshells.  Also, if a separator such  as  &&  is  aliased,  \&&
       turns into the two tokens \& and &, each of which may have been aliased
       separately.  Similarly for \<<, \>|, etc.

       There is a commonly encountered problem with aliases illustrated by the
       following code:

              alias echobar='echo bar'; echobar

       This  prints  a  message  that  the command echobar could not be found.
       This happens because aliases are expanded when the code is read in; the
       entire  line  is read in one go, so that when echobar is executed it is
       too late to expand the newly defined alias.  This is often a problem in
       shell scripts, functions, and code executed with `source' or `.'.  Con-
       sequently, use of functions  rather  than  aliases  is  recommended  in
       non-interactive code.

QUOTING
       A  character  may be quoted (that is, made to stand for itself) by pre-
       ceding it with a `\'.  `\' followed by a newline is ignored.

       A string enclosed between `$'' and `'' is processed the same way as the
       string arguments of the print builtin, and the resulting string is con-
       sidered to be entirely quoted.  A literal `'' character can be included
       in the string by using the `\'' escape.

       All  characters  enclosed  between a pair of single quotes ('') that is
       not preceded by a `$' are quoted.  A single quote cannot appear  within
       single  quotes unless the option RC_QUOTES is set, in which case a pair
       of single quotes are turned into a single quote.  For example,

              print ''''

       outputs nothing apart from a newline if RC_QUOTES is not set,  but  one
       single quote if it is set.

       Inside  double  quotes  (""), parameter and command substitution occur,
       and `\' quotes the characters `\', ``', `"', `$', and the first charac-
       ter of $histchars (default `!').

REDIRECTION
       If  a  command is followed by & and job control is not active, then the
       default standard input for the command is  the  empty  file  /dev/null.
       Otherwise,  the environment for the execution of a command contains the
       file descriptors of the invoking  shell  as  modified  by  input/output
       specifications.

       The following may appear anywhere in a simple command or may precede or
       follow a complex command.  Expansion occurs before  word  or  digit  is
       used except as noted below.  If the result of substitution on word pro-
       duces more than one filename,  redirection  occurs  for  each  separate
       filename in turn.

       < word Open file word for reading as standard input.  It is an error to
              open a file in this fashion if it does not exist.

       <> word
              Open file word for reading and writing as  standard  input.   If
              the file does not exist then it is created.

       > word Open file word for writing as standard output.  If the file does
              not exist then it is created.  If the file exists, and the CLOB-
              BER  option  is  unset,  this  causes an error; otherwise, it is
              truncated to zero length.

       >| word
       >! word
              Same as >, except that the file is truncated to zero  length  if
              it exists, regardless of CLOBBER.

       >> word
              Open  file  word  for writing in append mode as standard output.
              If the file does not exist, and the  CLOBBER  and  APPEND_CREATE
              options  are  both  unset,  this causes an error; otherwise, the
              file is created.

       >>| word
       >>! word
              Same as >>, except that the file is created if it does  not  ex-
              ist, regardless of CLOBBER and APPEND_CREATE.

       <<[-] word
              The  shell  input is read up to a line that is the same as word,
              or to an end-of-file.  No parameter expansion, command substitu-
              tion or filename generation is performed on word.  The resulting
              document, called a here-document, becomes the standard input.

              If any character of word is quoted with single or double  quotes
              or a `\', no interpretation is placed upon the characters of the
              document.  Otherwise, parameter and command substitution occurs,
              `\'  followed  by  a newline is removed, and `\' must be used to
              quote the characters `\', `$', ``' and the  first  character  of
              word.

              Note  that  word itself does not undergo shell expansion.  Back-
              quotes in word do not have their usual effect; instead they  be-
              have  similarly  to  double  quotes,  except that the backquotes
              themselves are passed through unchanged.  (This  information  is
              given for completeness and it is not recommended that backquotes
              be used.)  Quotes in the form $'...' have their standard  effect
              of expanding backslashed references to special characters.

              If <<- is used, then all leading tabs are stripped from word and
              from the document.

       <<< word
              Perform shell expansion on word and pass the result to  standard
              input.  This is known as a here-string.  Compare the use of word
              in here-documents above, where word does not undergo  shell  ex-
              pansion.  The result will have a trailing newline after it.

       <& number
       >& number
              The  standard  input/output  is  duplicated from file descriptor
              number (see dup2(2)).

       <& -
       >& -   Close the standard input/output.

       <& p
       >& p   The input/output from/to the coprocess is moved to the  standard
              input/output.

       >& word
       &> word
              (Except  where `>& word' matches one of the above syntaxes; `&>'
              can always be used to avoid  this  ambiguity.)   Redirects  both
              standard  output  and  standard error (file descriptor 2) in the
              manner of `> word'.  Note that this does not have the  same  ef-
              fect  as  `> word 2>&1' in the presence of multios (see the sec-
              tion below).

       >&| word
       >&! word
       &>| word
       &>! word
              Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip-
              tor 2) in the manner of `>| word'.

       >>& word
       &>> word
              Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip-
              tor 2) in the manner of `>> word'.

       >>&| word
       >>&! word
       &>>| word
       &>>! word
              Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip-
              tor 2) in the manner of `>>| word'.

       If  one  of  the above is preceded by a digit, then the file descriptor
       referred to is that specified by the digit instead of the default 0  or
       1.   The order in which redirections are specified is significant.  The
       shell evaluates each redirection in  terms  of  the  (file  descriptor,
       file) association at the time of evaluation.  For example:

              ... 1>fname 2>&1

       first associates file descriptor 1 with file fname.  It then associates
       file descriptor 2 with the file associated with file descriptor 1 (that
       is,  fname).  If the order of redirections were reversed, file descrip-
       tor 2 would be associated with the terminal (assuming file descriptor 1
       had  been)  and  then  file  descriptor 1 would be associated with file
       fname.

       The `|&' command separator described in Simple Commands & Pipelines  in
       zshmisc(1) is a shorthand for `2>&1 |'.

       The various forms of process substitution, `<(list)', and `=(list)' for
       input and `>(list)' for output, are often used together with  redirect-
       ion.   For  example,  if  word  in an output redirection is of the form
       `>(list)' then the output is piped to the command represented by  list.
       See Process Substitution in zshexpn(1).

OPENING FILE DESCRIPTORS USING PARAMETERS
       When  the shell is parsing arguments to a command, and the shell option
       IGNORE_BRACES is not set, a different form of redirection  is  allowed:
       instead  of  a digit before the operator there is a valid shell identi-
       fier enclosed in braces.  The shell will open  a  new  file  descriptor
       that is guaranteed to be at least 10 and set the parameter named by the
       identifier to the file descriptor opened.  No whitespace is allowed be-
       tween the closing brace and the redirection character.  For example:

              ... {myfd}>&1

       This opens a new file descriptor that is a duplicate of file descriptor
       1 and sets the parameter myfd to the number  of  the  file  descriptor,
       which  will  be at least 10.  The new file descriptor can be written to
       using the syntax >&$myfd.  The file descriptor  remains  open  in  sub-
       shells and forked external executables.

       The  syntax  {varid}>&-,  for example {myfd}>&-, may be used to close a
       file descriptor opened in this fashion.  Note that the parameter  given
       by varid must previously be set to a file descriptor in this case.

       It  is an error to open or close a file descriptor in this fashion when
       the parameter is readonly.  However, it is not  an  error  to  read  or
       write  a  file  descriptor using <&$param or >&$param if param is read-
       only.

       If the option CLOBBER is unset, it is an error to open a file  descrip-
       tor  using  a  parameter that is already set to an open file descriptor
       previously allocated by this mechanism.  Unsetting the parameter before
       using it for allocating a file descriptor avoids the error.

       Note  that this mechanism merely allocates or closes a file descriptor;
       it does not perform any redirections from or to it.  It is usually con-
       venient  to  allocate  a file descriptor prior to use as an argument to
       exec.  The syntax does not in any case work when  used  around  complex
       commands  such  as  parenthesised subshells or loops, where the opening
       brace is interpreted as part of a command list to be  executed  in  the
       current shell.

       The  following shows a typical sequence of allocation, use, and closing
       of a file descriptor:

              integer myfd
              exec {myfd}>~/logs/mylogfile.txt
              print This is a log message. >&$myfd
              exec {myfd}>&-

       Note that the expansion of the variable in the expression  >&$myfd  oc-
       curs  at the point the redirection is opened.  This is after the expan-
       sion of command arguments and after any redirections to the left on the
       command line have been processed.

MULTIOS
       If the user tries to open a file descriptor for writing more than once,
       the shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that  copies
       its  input  to  all the specified outputs, similar to tee, provided the
       MULTIOS option is set, as it is by default.  Thus:

              date >foo >bar

       writes the date to two files, named `foo' and `bar'.  Note that a  pipe
       is an implicit redirection; thus

              date >foo | cat

       writes the date to the file `foo', and also pipes it to cat.

       Note  that  the  shell  opens  all  the  files to be used in the multio
       process immediately, not at the point they are about to be written.

       Note also that redirections are always expanded in order.  This happens
       regardless of the setting of the MULTIOS option, but with the option in
       effect there are additional consequences. For example, the  meaning  of
       the expression >&1 will change after a previous redirection:

              date >&1 >output

       In  the  case above, the >&1 refers to the standard output at the start
       of the line; the result is similar to the tee command.   However,  con-
       sider:

              date >output >&1

       As redirections are evaluated in order, when the >&1 is encountered the
       standard output is set to the file output and another copy of the  out-
       put is therefore sent to that file.  This is unlikely to be what is in-
       tended.

       If the MULTIOS option is set, the word after a redirection operator  is
       also subjected to filename generation (globbing).  Thus

              : > *

       will  truncate  all files in the current directory, assuming there's at
       least one.  (Without the MULTIOS option, it would create an empty  file
       called `*'.)  Similarly, you can do

              echo exit 0 >> *.sh

       If the user tries to open a file descriptor for reading more than once,
       the shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that  copies
       all the specified inputs to its output in the order specified, provided
       the MULTIOS option is set.  It should be noted that each file is opened
       immediately, not at the point where it is about to be read: this behav-
       iour differs from cat, so if strictly standard behaviour is needed, cat
       should be used instead.

       Thus

              sort <foo <fubar

       or even

              sort <f{oo,ubar}

       is equivalent to `cat foo fubar | sort'.

       Expansion of the redirection argument occurs at the point the redirect-
       ion is opened, at the point described above for the  expansion  of  the
       variable in >&$myfd.

       Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus

              cat bar | sort <foo

       is equivalent to `cat bar foo | sort' (note the order of the inputs).

       If  the MULTIOS option is unset, each redirection replaces the previous
       redirection for that file descriptor.  However, all files redirected to
       are actually opened, so

              echo Hello > bar > baz

       when  MULTIOS  is  unset  will  truncate  `bar', and write `Hello' into
       `baz'.

       There is a problem when an output multio is  attached  to  an  external
       program.  A simple example shows this:

              cat file >file1 >file2
              cat file1 file2

       Here,  it  is  possible that the second `cat' will not display the full
       contents of file1 and file2 (i.e. the original  contents  of  file  re-
       peated twice).

       The  reason  for  this  is  that  the multios are spawned after the cat
       process is forked from the parent shell, so the parent shell  does  not
       wait for the multios to finish writing data.  This means the command as
       shown can exit before file1 and file2 are  completely  written.   As  a
       workaround,  it  is possible to run the cat process as part of a job in
       the current shell:

              { cat file } >file >file2

       Here, the {...} job will pause to wait for both files to be written.

REDIRECTIONS WITH NO COMMAND
       When a simple command consists of one or more redirection operators and
       zero or more parameter assignments, but no command name, zsh can behave
       in several ways.

       If the parameter NULLCMD is not set or the option CSH_NULLCMD  is  set,
       an error is caused.  This is the csh behavior and CSH_NULLCMD is set by
       default when emulating csh.

       If the option SH_NULLCMD is set, the builtin `:' is inserted as a  com-
       mand  with  the given redirections.  This is the default when emulating
       sh or ksh.

       Otherwise, if the parameter NULLCMD is set, its value will be used as a
       command  with  the given redirections.  If both NULLCMD and READNULLCMD
       are set, then the value of the latter will be used instead of  that  of
       the  former  when the redirection is an input.  The default for NULLCMD
       is `cat' and for READNULLCMD is `more'. Thus

              < file

       shows the contents of file on standard output, with paging if that is a
       terminal.  NULLCMD and READNULLCMD may refer to shell functions.

COMMAND EXECUTION
       If a command name contains no slashes, the shell attempts to locate it.
       If there exists a shell function by that name, the function is  invoked
       as  described  in  the  section  `Functions'.   If there exists a shell
       builtin by that name, the builtin is invoked.

       Otherwise, the shell searches each element of  $path  for  a  directory
       containing an executable file by that name.

       If execution fails: an error message is printed, and one of the follow-
       ing values is returned.

       127    The search was unsuccessful.  The error message is `command  not
              found: cmd'.
       126    The executable file has insufficient permissions, is a directory
              or special file, or is not a script and is in a format  unrecog-
              nized  by  the operating system.  The exact conditions and error
              message are operating system-dependent; see execve(2).

       If execution fails because the file is not in  executable  format,  and
       the  file  is  not  a  directory,  it  is assumed to be a shell script.
       /bin/sh is spawned to execute it.  If the program is a  file  beginning
       with `#!', the remainder of the first line specifies an interpreter for
       the program.  The shell will execute the specified interpreter on oper-
       ating systems that do not handle this executable format in the kernel.

       If  no  external command is found but a function command_not_found_han-
       dler exists the shell executes this function with all command line  ar-
       guments.   The  return status of the function becomes the status of the
       command.  Note that the handler is executed in a subshell forked to ex-
       ecute  an external command, hence changes to directories, shell parame-
       ters, etc. have no effect on the main shell.

FUNCTIONS
       Shell functions are defined with the function reserved word or the spe-
       cial  syntax `funcname ()'.  Shell functions are read in and stored in-
       ternally.  Alias names are resolved when the function is  read.   Func-
       tions  are  executed  like  commands with the arguments passed as posi-
       tional parameters.  (See the section `Command Execution'.)

       Functions execute in the same process as the caller and share all files
       and  present working directory with the caller.  A trap on EXIT set in-
       side a function is executed after the function completes in  the  envi-
       ronment of the caller.

       The return builtin is used to return from function calls.

       Function  identifiers  can be listed with the functions builtin.  Func-
       tions can be undefined with the unfunction builtin.

AUTOLOADING FUNCTIONS
       A function can be marked as undefined using the  autoload  builtin  (or
       `functions  -u'  or `typeset -fu').  Such a function has no body.  When
       the function is first executed, the shell searches for  its  definition
       using the elements of the fpath variable.  Thus to define functions for
       autoloading, a typical sequence is:

              fpath=(~/myfuncs $fpath)
              autoload myfunc1 myfunc2 ...

       The usual alias expansion during reading will be suppressed if the  au-
       toload builtin or its equivalent is given the option -U. This is recom-
       mended for the use of functions supplied  with  the  zsh  distribution.
       Note  that  for functions precompiled with the zcompile builtin command
       the flag -U must be provided when the .zwc file is created, as the cor-
       responding information is compiled into the latter.

       For  each  element  in fpath, the shell looks for three possible files,
       the newest of which is used to load the definition for the function:

       element.zwc
              A file created with the zcompile builtin command, which  is  ex-
              pected  to  contain the definitions for all functions in the di-
              rectory named element.  The file is treated in the  same  manner
              as  a  directory  containing files for functions and is searched
              for the definition of the function.   If the definition  is  not
              found,  the  search for a definition proceeds with the other two
              possibilities described below.

              If element already includes a .zwc extension (i.e. the extension
              was  explicitly  given by the user), element is searched for the
              definition of the function without comparing its age to that  of
              other  files;  in  fact, there does not need to be any directory
              named element without the suffix.   Thus  including  an  element
              such as `/usr/local/funcs.zwc' in fpath will speed up the search
              for functions, with the  disadvantage  that  functions  included
              must  be  explicitly recompiled by hand before the shell notices
              any changes.

       element/function.zwc
              A file created with zcompile, which is expected to  contain  the
              definition  for function.  It may include other function defini-
              tions as well, but those are neither loaded nor executed; a file
              found  in  this way is searched only for the definition of func-
              tion.

       element/function
              A file of zsh command text, taken to be the definition for func-
              tion.

       In  summary, the order of searching is, first, in the parents of direc-
       tories in fpath for the newer of either a compiled directory or  a  di-
       rectory  in fpath; second, if more than one of these contains a defini-
       tion for the function that is sought, the leftmost in the fpath is cho-
       sen;  and  third,  within  a  directory, the newer of either a compiled
       function or an ordinary function definition is used.

       If the KSH_AUTOLOAD option is set, or the file contains only  a  simple
       definition of the function, the file's contents will be executed.  This
       will normally define the function in question,  but  may  also  perform
       initialization, which is executed in the context of the function execu-
       tion, and may therefore define local parameters.  It is an error if the
       function is not defined by loading the file.

       Otherwise,  the  function body (with no surrounding `funcname() {...}')
       is taken to be the complete contents of the file.  This form allows the
       file  to be used directly as an executable shell script.  If processing
       of the file results in the function being re-defined, the function  it-
       self  is not re-executed.  To force the shell to perform initialization
       and then call the function defined, the file should contain initializa-
       tion code (which will be executed then discarded) in addition to a com-
       plete function definition (which will be retained for subsequent  calls
       to the function), and a call to the shell function, including any argu-
       ments, at the end.

       For example, suppose the autoload file func contains

              func() { print This is func; }
              print func is initialized

       then `func; func' with KSH_AUTOLOAD set will produce both  messages  on
       the  first  call, but only the message `This is func' on the second and
       subsequent calls.  Without KSH_AUTOLOAD set, it will produce  the  ini-
       tialization  message  on  the  first call, and the other message on the
       second and subsequent calls.

       It is also possible to create a function that  is  not  marked  as  au-
       toloaded, but which loads its own definition by searching fpath, by us-
       ing `autoload -X' within a shell function.  For example, the  following
       are equivalent:

              myfunc() {
                autoload -X
              }
              myfunc args...

       and

              unfunction myfunc   # if myfunc was defined
              autoload myfunc
              myfunc args...

       In  fact,  the  functions  command outputs `builtin autoload -X' as the
       body of an autoloaded function.  This is done so that

              eval "$(functions)"

       produces a reasonable result.  A true autoloaded function can be  iden-
       tified  by  the  presence of the comment `# undefined' in the body, be-
       cause all comments are discarded from defined functions.

       To load the definition of an autoloaded function myfunc without execut-
       ing myfunc, use:

              autoload +X myfunc

ANONYMOUS FUNCTIONS
       If  no  name  is given for a function, it is `anonymous' and is handled
       specially.  Either form of function definition may be used: a `()' with
       no  preceding  name, or a `function' with an immediately following open
       brace.  The function is executed immediately at the point of definition
       and  is  not  stored  for  future  use.   The  function  name is set to
       `(anon)'.

       Arguments to the function may be specified as words following the clos-
       ing  brace  defining the function, hence if there are none no arguments
       (other than $0) are set.  This is a difference from the way other func-
       tions  are  parsed: normal function definitions may be followed by cer-
       tain keywords such as `else' or `fi', which will be  treated  as  argu-
       ments  to anonymous functions, so that a newline or semicolon is needed
       to force keyword interpretation.

       Note also that the argument list of any enclosing script or function is
       hidden  (as  would  be  the  case for any other function called at this
       point).

       Redirections may be applied to the anonymous function in the same  man-
       ner  as  to a current-shell structure enclosed in braces.  The main use
       of anonymous functions is to provide a scope for local variables.  This
       is  particularly  convenient  in start-up files as these do not provide
       their own local variable scope.

       For example,

              variable=outside
              function {
                local variable=inside
                print "I am $variable with arguments $*"
              } this and that
              print "I am $variable"

       outputs the following:

              I am inside with arguments this and that
              I am outside

       Note that function definitions with arguments that expand  to  nothing,
       for  example `name=; function $name { ... }', are not treated as anony-
       mous functions.  Instead, they are treated as normal  function  defini-
       tions where the definition is silently discarded.

SPECIAL FUNCTIONS
       Certain functions, if defined, have special meaning to the shell.

   Hook Functions
       For the functions below, it is possible to define an array that has the
       same name as the function with `_functions' appended.  Any  element  in
       such an array is taken as the name of a function to execute; it is exe-
       cuted in the same context and with the same arguments and same  initial
       value  of  $?  as the basic function.  For example, if $chpwd_functions
       is an array containing  the  values  `mychpwd',  `chpwd_save_dirstack',
       then the shell attempts to execute the functions `chpwd', `mychpwd' and
       `chpwd_save_dirstack', in that order.  Any function that does not exist
       is silently ignored.  A function found by this mechanism is referred to
       elsewhere as a hook function.  An error in any function  causes  subse-
       quent  functions not to be run.  Note further that an error in a precmd
       hook causes an immediately  following  periodic  function  not  to  run
       (though it may run at the next opportunity).

       chpwd  Executed whenever the current working directory is changed.

       periodic
              If  the parameter PERIOD is set, this function is executed every
              $PERIOD seconds, just before a prompt.  Note  that  if  multiple
              functions  are  defined  using the array periodic_functions only
              one period is applied to the complete set of functions, and  the
              scheduled time is not reset if the list of functions is altered.
              Hence the set of functions is always called together.

       precmd Executed before each prompt.  Note that precommand functions are
              not  re-executed  simply because the command line is redrawn, as
              happens, for example, when a notification about an  exiting  job
              is displayed.

       preexec
              Executed  just  after a command has been read and is about to be
              executed.  If the history mechanism  is  active  (regardless  of
              whether  the  line  was  discarded from the history buffer), the
              string that the user typed is passed as the first argument, oth-
              erwise  it  is an empty string.  The actual command that will be
              executed (including expanded aliases) is passed in two different
              forms:  the  second argument is a single-line, size-limited ver-
              sion of the command (with things like function  bodies  elided);
              the  third  argument  contains  the full text that is being exe-
              cuted.

       zshaddhistory
              Executed when a history line has been  read  interactively,  but
              before  it  is executed.  The sole argument is the complete his-
              tory line  (so  that  any  terminating  newline  will  still  be
              present).

              If  any  of the hook functions returns status 1 (or any non-zero
              value other than 2, though this is  not  guaranteed  for  future
              versions  of  the shell) the history line will not be saved, al-
              though it lingers in the history until the  next  line  is  exe-
              cuted, allowing you to reuse or edit it immediately.

              If  any  of the hook functions returns status 2 the history line
              will be saved on the internal history list, but not  written  to
              the  history  file.   In  case of a conflict, the first non-zero
              status value is taken.

              A hook function may call `fc -p ...' to switch the history  con-
              text  so that the history is saved in a different file from that
              in the global HISTFILE parameter.  This  is  handled  specially:
              the history context is automatically restored after the process-
              ing of the history line is finished.

              The following example function works with  one  of  the  options
              INC_APPEND_HISTORY  or SHARE_HISTORY set, in order that the line
              is written out immediately after the history entry is added.  It
              first  adds the history line to the normal history with the new-
              line stripped, which is usually the correct behaviour.  Then  it
              switches the history context so that the line will be written to
              a history file in the current directory.

                     zshaddhistory() {
                       print -sr -- ${1%%$'\n'}
                       fc -p .zsh_local_history
                     }

       zshexit
              Executed at the point where the main shell is about to exit nor-
              mally.   This  is  not called by exiting subshells, nor when the
              exec precommand modifier is used  before  an  external  command.
              Also, unlike TRAPEXIT, it is not called when functions exit.

   Trap Functions
       The functions below are treated specially but do not have corresponding
       hook arrays.

       TRAPNAL
              If defined and non-null, this function will be executed whenever
              the shell catches a signal SIGNAL, where NAL is a signal name as
              specified for the kill  builtin.   The  signal  number  will  be
              passed as the first parameter to the function.

              If  a  function  of this form is defined and null, the shell and
              processes spawned by it will ignore SIGNAL.

              The return status from the function is handled specially.  If it
              is  zero, the signal is assumed to have been handled, and execu-
              tion continues normally.  Otherwise, the shell  will  behave  as
              interrupted  except  that  the  return status of the trap is re-
              tained.

              Programs terminated by uncaught  signals  typically  return  the
              status  128  plus the signal number.  Hence the following causes
              the handler for SIGINT to print a message, then mimic the  usual
              effect of the signal.

                     TRAPINT() {
                       print "Caught SIGINT, aborting."
                       return $(( 128 + $1 ))
                     }

              The  functions  TRAPZERR,  TRAPDEBUG and TRAPEXIT are never exe-
              cuted inside other traps.

       TRAPDEBUG
              If the option DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set (as it is by default), ex-
              ecuted  before  each command; otherwise executed after each com-
              mand.  See the description of the trap builtin in zshbuiltins(1)
              for details of additional features provided in debug traps.

       TRAPEXIT
              Executed  when the shell exits, or when the current function ex-
              its if defined inside a function.  The value of $? at the  start
              of  execution is the exit status of the shell or the return sta-
              tus of the function exiting.

       TRAPZERR
              Executed whenever a command has a non-zero  exit  status.   How-
              ever,  the function is not executed if the command occurred in a
              sublist followed by `&&' or `||'; only the final  command  in  a
              sublist  of this type causes the trap to be executed.  The func-
              tion TRAPERR acts the same as TRAPZERR on systems where there is
              no SIGERR (this is the usual case).

       The  functions  beginning  `TRAP' may alternatively be defined with the
       trap builtin:  this may be preferable for some uses.   Setting  a  trap
       with  one  form removes any trap of the other form for the same signal;
       removing a trap in either form removes all traps for the  same  signal.
       The forms

              TRAPNAL() {
               # code
              }

       ('function traps') and

              trap '
               # code
              ' NAL

       ('list  traps')  are  equivalent in most ways, the exceptions being the
       following:

       •      Function traps have all the properties of normal functions,  ap-
              pearing in the list of functions and being called with their own
              function context rather than the  context  where  the  trap  was
              triggered.

       •      The  return status from function traps is special, whereas a re-
              turn from a list trap causes the surrounding context  to  return
              with the given status.

       •      Function  traps  are  not  reset within subshells, in accordance
              with zsh behaviour; list traps are  reset,  in  accordance  with
              POSIX behaviour.

JOBS
       If  the  MONITOR  option  is set, an interactive shell associates a job
       with each pipeline.  It keeps a table of current jobs, printed  by  the
       jobs  command,  and  assigns them small integer numbers.  When a job is
       started asynchronously with `&', the shell prints a  line  to  standard
       error which looks like:

              [1] 1234

       indicating that the job which was started asynchronously was job number
       1 and had one (top-level) process, whose process ID was 1234.

       If a job is started with `&|' or `&!', then  that  job  is  immediately
       disowned.   After  startup,  it does not have a place in the job table,
       and is not subject to the job control features described here.

       If you are running a job and wish to do something else you may hit  the
       key  ^Z (control-Z) which sends a TSTP signal to the current job:  this
       key may be redefined by the susp option of the external  stty  command.
       The  shell  will  then  normally  indicate  that the job has been `sus-
       pended', and print another prompt.  You can then manipulate  the  state
       of  this  job, putting it in the background with the bg command, or run
       some other commands and then eventually bring the  job  back  into  the
       foreground  with  the foreground command fg.  A ^Z takes effect immedi-
       ately and is like an interrupt in that pending output and unread  input
       are discarded when it is typed.

       A job being run in the background will suspend if it tries to read from
       the terminal.

       Note that if the job running in the foreground  is  a  shell  function,
       then  suspending  it will have the effect of causing the shell to fork.
       This is necessary to separate the function's state  from  that  of  the
       parent  shell performing the job control, so that the latter can return
       to the command line prompt.  As a result, even if fg is  used  to  con-
       tinue  the job the function will no longer be part of the parent shell,
       and any variables set by the function will not be visible in the parent
       shell.   Thus  the behaviour is different from the case where the func-
       tion was never suspended.  Zsh is different from many other  shells  in
       this regard.

       One  additional side effect is that use of disown with a job created by
       suspending shell code in this fashion is delayed: the job can  only  be
       disowned once any process started from the parent shell has terminated.
       At that point, the disowned job disappears silently from the job list.

       The same behaviour is found when the shell is  executing  code  as  the
       right  hand  side  of a pipeline or any complex shell construct such as
       if, for, etc., in order that the entire block of code can be managed as
       a  single job.  Background jobs are normally allowed to produce output,
       but this can be disabled by giving the command `stty tostop'.   If  you
       set this tty option, then background jobs will suspend when they try to
       produce output like they do when they try to read input.

       When a command is suspended and continued later with  the  fg  or  wait
       builtins,  zsh  restores tty modes that were in effect when it was sus-
       pended.  This (intentionally) does not apply if the command is  contin-
       ued via `kill -CONT', nor when it is continued with bg.

       There are several ways to refer to jobs in the shell.  A job can be re-
       ferred to by the process ID of any process of the job or by one of  the
       following:

       %number
              The job with the given number.
       %string
              The last job whose command line begins with string.
       %?string
              The last job whose command line contains string.
       %%     Current job.
       %+     Equivalent to `%%'.
       %-     Previous job.

       The shell learns immediately whenever a process changes state.  It nor-
       mally informs you whenever a job becomes blocked  so  that  no  further
       progress  is possible.  If the NOTIFY option is not set, it waits until
       just before it prints a prompt before it informs you.  All such notifi-
       cations  are  sent directly to the terminal, not to the standard output
       or standard error.

       When the monitor mode is on, each background job that  completes  trig-
       gers any trap set for CHLD.

       When  you  try  to leave the shell while jobs are running or suspended,
       you will be warned that `You have suspended (running) jobs'.   You  may
       use  the  jobs command to see what they are.  If you do this or immedi-
       ately try to exit again, the shell will not warn you a second time; the
       suspended  jobs will be terminated, and the running jobs will be sent a
       SIGHUP signal, if the HUP option is set.

       To avoid having the shell terminate the running jobs,  either  use  the
       nohup(1) command or the disown builtin.

SIGNALS
       The INT and QUIT signals for an invoked command are ignored if the com-
       mand is followed by `&' and the MONITOR  option  is  not  active.   The
       shell  itself  always ignores the QUIT signal.  Otherwise, signals have
       the values inherited by the shell from its parent (but see the  TRAPNAL
       special functions in the section `Functions').

       Certain  jobs  are run asynchronously by the shell other than those ex-
       plicitly put into the background; even in cases where the  shell  would
       usually wait for such jobs, an explicit exit command or exit due to the
       option ERR_EXIT will cause the shell to exit without waiting.  Examples
       of  such  asynchronous  jobs  are process substitution, see the section
       PROCESS SUBSTITUTION in the zshexpn(1) manual  page,  and  the  handler
       processes for multios, see the section MULTIOS in the zshmisc(1) manual
       page.

ARITHMETIC EVALUATION
       The shell can perform integer and floating point arithmetic, either us-
       ing  the  builtin let, or via a substitution of the form $((...)).  For
       integers, the shell is usually compiled to use 8-byte  precision  where
       this is available, otherwise precision is 4 bytes.  This can be tested,
       for example, by giving the command `print - $(( 12345678901 ))'; if the
       number  appears unchanged, the precision is at least 8 bytes.  Floating
       point arithmetic always uses the `double'  type  with  whatever  corre-
       sponding precision is provided by the compiler and the library.

       The let builtin command takes arithmetic expressions as arguments; each
       is evaluated separately.  Since many of the  arithmetic  operators,  as
       well  as  spaces, require quoting, an alternative form is provided: for
       any command which begins with a `((', all the characters until a match-
       ing  `))'  are treated as a double-quoted expression and arithmetic ex-
       pansion performed as for an argument of let.  More precisely, `((...))'
       is equivalent to `let "..."'.  The return status is 0 if the arithmetic
       value of the expression is non-zero, 1 if it is zero, and 2 if an error
       occurred.

       For example, the following statement

              (( val = 2 + 1 ))

       is equivalent to

              let "val = 2 + 1"

       both  assigning  the  value 3 to the shell variable val and returning a
       zero status.

       Integers can be in bases other than 10.  A leading `0x' or `0X' denotes
       hexadecimal and a leading `0b' or `0B' binary.  Integers may also be of
       the form `base#n', where base is  a  decimal  number  between  two  and
       thirty-six  representing  the arithmetic base and n is a number in that
       base (for example, `16#ff' is 255 in hexadecimal).  The base# may  also
       be omitted, in which case base 10 is used.  For backwards compatibility
       the form `[base]n' is also accepted.

       An integer expression or a base given in the form `base#n' may  contain
       underscores  (`_')  after  the leading digit for visual guidance; these
       are ignored in computation.   Examples  are  1_000_000  or  0xffff_ffff
       which are equivalent to 1000000 and 0xffffffff respectively.

       It is also possible to specify a base to be used for output in the form
       `[#base]', for example `[#16]'.  This is used  when  outputting  arith-
       metical  substitutions  or  when assigning to scalar parameters, but an
       explicitly defined integer or floating point parameter will not be  af-
       fected.   If an integer variable is implicitly defined by an arithmetic
       expression, any base specified in this way will be  set  as  the  vari-
       able's output arithmetic base as if the option `-i base' to the typeset
       builtin had been used.  The expression has no precedence and if it  oc-
       curs  more than once in a mathematical expression, the last encountered
       is used.  For clarity it is recommended that it appear at the beginning
       of an expression.  As an example:

              typeset -i 16 y
              print $(( [#8] x = 32, y = 32 ))
              print $x $y

       outputs first `8#40', the rightmost value in the given output base, and
       then `8#40 16#20', because y has been explicitly declared to have  out-
       put base 16, while x (assuming it does not already exist) is implicitly
       typed by the arithmetic evaluation, where it acquires the  output  base
       8.

       The base may be replaced or followed by an underscore, which may itself
       be followed by a positive integer (if it is  missing  the  value  3  is
       used).   This  indicates  that  underscores should be inserted into the
       output string, grouping the number for visual clarity.   The  following
       integer specifies the number of digits to group together.  For example:

              setopt cbases
              print $(( [#16_4] 65536 ** 2 ))

       outputs `0x1_0000_0000'.

       The  feature can be used with floating point numbers, in which case the
       base must be omitted; grouping is away from the decimal point.  For ex-
       ample,

              zmodload zsh/mathfunc
              print $(( [#_] sqrt(1e7) ))

       outputs  `3_162.277_660_168_379_5'  (the number of decimal places shown
       may vary).

       If the C_BASES option is set, hexadecimal numbers  are  output  in  the
       standard C format, for example `0xFF' instead of the usual `16#FF'.  If
       the option OCTAL_ZEROES is also set (it is not by default), octal  num-
       bers  will  be  treated  similarly and hence appear as `077' instead of
       `8#77'.  This option has no effect on the output of  bases  other  than
       hexadecimal  and  octal, and these formats are always understood on in-
       put.

       When an output base is specified using the `[#base]' syntax, an  appro-
       priate  base prefix will be output if necessary, so that the value out-
       put is valid syntax for input.   If  the  #  is  doubled,  for  example
       `[##16]', then no base prefix is output.

       Floating  point  constants  are recognized by the presence of a decimal
       point or an exponent.  The decimal point may be the first character  of
       the  constant, but the exponent character e or E may not, as it will be
       taken for a parameter name.  All numeric parts (before  and  after  the
       decimal  point  and  in the exponent) may contain underscores after the
       leading digit for visual guidance; these are ignored in computation.

       An arithmetic expression uses nearly the same syntax and  associativity
       of expressions as in C.

       In  the native mode of operation, the following operators are supported
       (listed in decreasing order of precedence):

       + - ! ~ ++ --
              unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}cre-
              ment
       << >>  bitwise shift left, right
       &      bitwise AND
       ^      bitwise XOR
       |      bitwise OR
       **     exponentiation
       * / %  multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
       + -    addition, subtraction
       < > <= >=
              comparison
       == !=  equality and inequality
       &&     logical AND
       || ^^  logical OR, XOR
       ? :    ternary operator
       = += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
              assignment
       ,      comma operator

       The  operators  `&&',  `||', `&&=', and `||=' are short-circuiting, and
       only one of the latter two expressions in a ternary operator is  evalu-
       ated.  Note the precedence of the bitwise AND, OR, and XOR operators.

       With the option C_PRECEDENCES the precedences (but no other properties)
       of the operators are altered to be the same as those in most other lan-
       guages that support the relevant operators:

       + - ! ~ ++ --
              unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}cre-
              ment
       **     exponentiation
       * / %  multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
       + -    addition, subtraction
       << >>  bitwise shift left, right
       < > <= >=
              comparison
       == !=  equality and inequality
       &      bitwise AND
       ^      bitwise XOR
       |      bitwise OR
       &&     logical AND
       ^^     logical XOR
       ||     logical OR
       ? :    ternary operator
       = += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
              assignment
       ,      comma operator

       Note the precedence of exponentiation in both cases is  below  that  of
       unary  operators, hence `-3**2' evaluates as `9', not `-9'.  Use paren-
       theses where necessary: `-(3**2)'.   This  is  for  compatibility  with
       other shells.

       Mathematical  functions  can  be  called  with the syntax `func(args)',
       where the function decides if the  args  is  used  as  a  string  or  a
       comma-separated list of arithmetic expressions. The shell currently de-
       fines no mathematical functions by default, but the module zsh/mathfunc
       may  be  loaded  with the zmodload builtin to provide standard floating
       point mathematical functions.

       An expression of the form `##x' where x is any character sequence  such
       as `a', `^A', or `\M-\C-x' gives the value of this character and an ex-
       pression of the form `#name' gives the value of the first character  of
       the  contents of the parameter name.  Character values are according to
       the character set used in the current locale; for  multibyte  character
       handling the option MULTIBYTE must be set.  Note that this form is dif-
       ferent from `$#name', a standard parameter substitution which gives the
       length  of  the  parameter name.  `#\' is accepted instead of `##', but
       its use is deprecated.

       Named parameters and subscripted  arrays  can  be  referenced  by  name
       within  an  arithmetic expression without using the parameter expansion
       syntax.  For example,

              ((val2 = val1 * 2))

       assigns twice the value of $val1 to the parameter named val2.

       An internal integer representation of a named parameter can  be  speci-
       fied  with  the integer builtin.  Arithmetic evaluation is performed on
       the value of each assignment to a named parameter declared  integer  in
       this  manner.   Assigning a floating point number to an integer results
       in rounding towards zero.

       Likewise, floating  point  numbers  can  be  declared  with  the  float
       builtin; there are two types, differing only in their output format, as
       described for the typeset builtin.  The output format can  be  bypassed
       by using arithmetic substitution instead of the parameter substitution,
       i.e. `${float}' uses  the  defined  format,  but  `$((float))'  uses  a
       generic floating point format.

       Promotion of integer to floating point values is performed where neces-
       sary.  In addition, if any operator which  requires  an  integer  (`&',
       `|',  `^', `<<', `>>' and their equivalents with assignment) is given a
       floating point argument, it will be silently rounded towards  zero  ex-
       cept for `~' which rounds down.

       Users  should  beware  that, in common with many other programming lan-
       guages but not software designed for calculation, the evaluation of  an
       expression  in  zsh is taken a term at a time and promotion of integers
       to floating point does not occur in terms only containing integers.   A
       typical  result of this is that a division such as 6/8 is truncated, in
       this being rounded towards 0.  The FORCE_FLOAT shell option can be used
       in  scripts  or  functions  where floating point evaluation is required
       throughout.

       Scalar variables can hold integer or floating point values at different
       times; there is no memory of the numeric type in this case.

       If a variable is first assigned in a numeric context without previously
       being declared, it will be implicitly typed as integer or float and re-
       tain that type either until the type is explicitly changed or until the
       end of the scope.  This can have unforeseen consequences.  For example,
       in the loop

              for (( f = 0; f < 1; f += 0.1 )); do
              # use $f
              done

       if  f has not already been declared, the first assignment will cause it
       to be created as an integer, and consequently the operation `f +=  0.1'
       will  always cause the result to be truncated to zero, so that the loop
       will fail.  A simple fix would be to turn the initialization into `f  =
       0.0'.   It is therefore best to declare numeric variables with explicit
       types.

CONDITIONAL EXPRESSIONS
       A conditional expression is used with the [[ compound command  to  test
       attributes  of  files  and  to compare strings.  Each expression can be
       constructed from one or more of the following unary or  binary  expres-
       sions:

       -a file
              true if file exists.

       -b file
              true if file exists and is a block special file.

       -c file
              true if file exists and is a character special file.

       -d file
              true if file exists and is a directory.

       -e file
              true if file exists.

       -f file
              true if file exists and is a regular file.

       -g file
              true if file exists and has its setgid bit set.

       -h file
              true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

       -k file
              true if file exists and has its sticky bit set.

       -n string
              true if length of string is non-zero.

       -o option
              true if option named option is on.  option may be a single char-
              acter, in which case it is a single letter  option  name.   (See
              the section `Specifying Options'.)

              When  no  option named option exists, and the POSIX_BUILTINS op-
              tion hasn't been set, return 3 with a warning.  If  that  option
              is set, return 1 with no warning.

       -p file
              true if file exists and is a FIFO special file (named pipe).

       -r file
              true if file exists and is readable by current process.

       -s file
              true if file exists and has size greater than zero.

       -t fd  true  if file descriptor number fd is open and associated with a
              terminal device.  (note: fd is not optional)

       -u file
              true if file exists and has its setuid bit set.

       -v varname
              true if shell variable varname is set.

       -w file
              true if file exists and is writable by current process.

       -x file
              true if file exists and is executable by  current  process.   If
              file  exists  and  is  a directory, then the current process has
              permission to search in the directory.

       -z string
              true if length of string is zero.

       -L file
              true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

       -O file
              true if file exists and is owned by the  effective  user  ID  of
              this process.

       -G file
              true if file exists and its group matches the effective group ID
              of this process.

       -S file
              true if file exists and is a socket.

       -N file
              true if file exists and its access time is not  newer  than  its
              modification time.

       file1 -nt file2
              true if file1 exists and is newer than file2.

       file1 -ot file2
              true if file1 exists and is older than file2.

       file1 -ef file2
              true if file1 and file2 exist and refer to the same file.

       string = pattern
       string == pattern
              true  if  string  matches  pattern.   The  two forms are exactly
              equivalent.  The `=' form is the traditional shell  syntax  (and
              hence the only one generally used with the test and [ builtins);
              the `==' form provides compatibility with other  sorts  of  com-
              puter language.

       string != pattern
              true if string does not match pattern.

       string =~ regexp
              true  if  string  matches the regular expression regexp.  If the
              option RE_MATCH_PCRE is set regexp is tested as a  PCRE  regular
              expression  using  the  zsh/pcre  module, else it is tested as a
              POSIX extended regular expression using  the  zsh/regex  module.
              Upon  successful match, some variables will be updated; no vari-
              ables are changed if the matching fails.

              If the option BASH_REMATCH is not set the scalar parameter MATCH
              is set to the substring that matched the pattern and the integer
              parameters MBEGIN and MEND to the index of the  start  and  end,
              respectively,  of  the  match  in string, such that if string is
              contained in variable var the expression `${var[$MBEGIN,$MEND]}'
              is  identical to `$MATCH'.  The setting of the option KSH_ARRAYS
              is respected.  Likewise, the array match  is  set  to  the  sub-
              strings that matched parenthesised subexpressions and the arrays
              mbegin and mend to the indices of the start and  end  positions,
              respectively,  of  the substrings within string.  The arrays are
              not set if there were no parenthesised subexpressions.  For  ex-
              ample,  if  the  string  `a short string' is matched against the
              regular expression `s(...)t', then (assuming the option  KSH_AR-
              RAYS  is  not  set) MATCH, MBEGIN and MEND are `short', 3 and 7,
              respectively, while match, mbegin and mend are single entry  ar-
              rays containing the strings `hor', `4' and `6', respectively.

              If  the option BASH_REMATCH is set the array BASH_REMATCH is set
              to the substring that matched the pattern followed by  the  sub-
              strings  that  matched  parenthesised  subexpressions within the
              pattern.

       string1 < string2
              true if string1 comes before string2 based  on  ASCII  value  of
              their characters.

       string1 > string2
              true  if  string1  comes  after  string2 based on ASCII value of
              their characters.

       exp1 -eq exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically equal to exp2.  Note that for purely
              numeric  comparisons use of the ((...)) builtin described in the
              section `ARITHMETIC EVALUATION' is more convenient  than  condi-
              tional expressions.

       exp1 -ne exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically not equal to exp2.

       exp1 -lt exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically less than exp2.

       exp1 -gt exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically greater than exp2.

       exp1 -le exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically less than or equal to exp2.

       exp1 -ge exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically greater than or equal to exp2.

       ( exp )
              true if exp is true.

       ! exp  true if exp is false.

       exp1 && exp2
              true if exp1 and exp2 are both true.

       exp1 || exp2
              true if either exp1 or exp2 is true.

       For  compatibility, if there is a single argument that is not syntacti-
       cally significant, typically a variable, the condition is treated as  a
       test for whether the expression expands as a string of non-zero length.
       In other words, [[ $var ]] is the same as [[ -n $var ]].  It is  recom-
       mended that the second, explicit, form be used where possible.

       Normal shell expansion is performed on the file, string and pattern ar-
       guments, but the result of each expansion is constrained to be a single
       word, similar to the effect of double quotes.

       Filename  generation is not performed on any form of argument to condi-
       tions.  However, it can be forced in any case where normal shell expan-
       sion  is  valid and when the option EXTENDED_GLOB is in effect by using
       an explicit glob qualifier of the form (#q) at the end of  the  string.
       A  normal  glob qualifier expression may appear between the `q' and the
       closing parenthesis; if none appears the expression has no  effect  be-
       yond  causing  filename generation.  The results of filename generation
       are joined together to form a single word, as with the results of other
       forms of expansion.

       This  special  use of filename generation is only available with the [[
       syntax.  If the condition occurs within the [ or test builtin  commands
       then  globbing  occurs instead as part of normal command line expansion
       before the condition is evaluated.  In this case it may generate multi-
       ple words which are likely to confuse the syntax of the test command.

       For example,

              [[ -n file*(#qN) ]]

       produces  status  zero if and only if there is at least one file in the
       current directory beginning with the string `file'.  The globbing qual-
       ifier  N  ensures  that the expression is empty if there is no matching
       file.

       Pattern metacharacters are active for the pattern arguments;  the  pat-
       terns  are  the  same  as  those used for filename generation, see zsh-
       expn(1), but there is no special behaviour of `/' nor initial dots, and
       no glob qualifiers are allowed.

       In  each  of the above expressions, if file is of the form `/dev/fd/n',
       where n is an integer, then the test applied to the open file whose de-
       scriptor  number  is  n, even if the underlying system does not support
       the /dev/fd directory.

       In the forms which do numeric comparison, the expressions  exp  undergo
       arithmetic expansion as if they were enclosed in $((...)).

       For example, the following:

              [[ ( -f foo || -f bar ) && $report = y* ]] && print File exists.

       tests if either file foo or file bar exists, and if so, if the value of
       the parameter report begins with `y';  if  the  complete  condition  is
       true, the message `File exists.' is printed.

EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES
       Prompt sequences undergo a special form of expansion.  This type of ex-
       pansion is also available using the -P option to the print builtin.

       If the PROMPT_SUBST option is set, the prompt string is first subjected
       to  parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion.
       See zshexpn(1).

       Certain escape sequences may be recognised in the prompt string.

       If the PROMPT_BANG option is set, a `!' in the prompt  is  replaced  by
       the  current  history  event  number.  A literal `!' may then be repre-
       sented as `!!'.

       If the PROMPT_PERCENT option is  set,  certain  escape  sequences  that
       start  with  `%'  are  expanded.  Many escapes are followed by a single
       character, although some of these take  an  optional  integer  argument
       that  should  appear  between the `%' and the next character of the se-
       quence.  More complicated escape sequences  are  available  to  provide
       conditional expansion.

SIMPLE PROMPT ESCAPES
   Special characters
       %%     A `%'.

       %)     A `)'.

   Login information
       %l     The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without `/dev/' prefix.
              If the name starts with `/dev/tty', that prefix is stripped.

       %M     The full machine hostname.

       %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.  An integer may follow the `%'
              to  specify  how  many  components  of the hostname are desired.
              With a negative integer, trailing components of the hostname are
              shown.

       %n     $USERNAME.

       %y     The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without `/dev/' prefix.
              This does not treat `/dev/tty' names specially.

   Shell state
       %#     A `#' if the shell is running with privileges,  a  `%'  if  not.
              Equivalent  to `%(!.#.%%)'.  The definition of `privileged', for
              these purposes, is that either the effective user  ID  is  zero,
              or,  if  POSIX.1e  capabilities are supported, that at least one
              capability is raised in either the Effective or Inheritable  ca-
              pability vectors.

       %?     The  return  status of the last command executed just before the
              prompt.

       %_     The status of the parser, i.e. the shell constructs  (like  `if'
              and  `for') that have been started on the command line. If given
              an integer number that many strings will  be  printed;  zero  or
              negative  or  no integer means print as many as there are.  This
              is most useful in prompts PS2 for continuation lines and PS4 for
              debugging  with  the  XTRACE  option; in the latter case it will
              also work non-interactively.

       %^     The status of the parser in reverse. This is the  same  as  `%_'
              other than the order of strings.  It is often used in RPS2.

       %d
       %/     Current  working  directory.   If an integer follows the `%', it
              specifies a number of trailing components of the current working
              directory  to show; zero means the whole path.  A negative inte-
              ger specifies leading components, i.e. %-1d specifies the  first
              component.

       %~     As  %d  and %/, but if the current working directory starts with
              $HOME, that part is replaced by a `~'. Furthermore, if it has  a
              named  directory  as  its prefix, that part is replaced by a `~'
              followed by the name of the directory, but only if the result is
              shorter  than the full path; see Dynamic and Static named direc-
              tories in zshexpn(1).

       %e     Evaluation depth of the current sourced file, shell function, or
              eval.   This  is incremented or decremented every time the value
              of %N is set or reverted  to  a  previous  value,  respectively.
              This is most useful for debugging as part of $PS4.

       %h
       %!     Current history event number.

       %i     The  line number currently being executed in the script, sourced
              file, or shell function given by %N.  This is  most  useful  for
              debugging as part of $PS4.

       %I     The  line  number currently being executed in the file %x.  This
              is similar to %i, but the line number is always a line number in
              the file where the code was defined, even if the code is a shell
              function.

       %j     The number of jobs.

       %L     The current value of $SHLVL.

       %N     The name of the script, sourced file, or shell function that zsh
              is currently executing, whichever was started most recently.  If
              there is none, this is equivalent to the parameter $0.  An inte-
              ger may follow the `%' to specify a number of trailing path com-
              ponents to show; zero means the full path.  A  negative  integer
              specifies leading components.

       %x     The  name of the file containing the source code currently being
              executed.  This behaves as %N except that function and eval com-
              mand  names  are not shown, instead the file where they were de-
              fined.

       %c
       %.
       %C     Trailing component of the current working directory.  An integer
              may  follow the `%' to get more than one component.  Unless `%C'
              is used, tilde contraction is performed first.  These are depre-
              cated  as %c and %C are equivalent to %1~ and %1/, respectively,
              while explicit positive integers have the same effect as for the
              latter two sequences.

   Date and time
       %D     The date in yy-mm-dd format.

       %T     Current time of day, in 24-hour format.

       %t
       %@     Current time of day, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

       %*     Current time of day in 24-hour format, with seconds.

       %w     The date in day-dd format.

       %W     The date in mm/dd/yy format.

       %D{string}
              string  is  formatted  using  the  strftime function.  See strf-
              time(3) for more details.  Various zsh extensions  provide  num-
              bers  with  no  leading  zero or space if the number is a single
              digit:

              %f     a day of the month
              %K     the hour of the day on the 24-hour clock
              %L     the hour of the day on the 12-hour clock

              In addition, if the system supports the POSIX gettimeofday  sys-
              tem  call,  %.  provides decimal fractions of a second since the
              epoch with leading zeroes.  By default three decimal places  are
              provided,  but a number of digits up to 9 may be given following
              the %; hence %6.  outputs microseconds, and %9. outputs nanosec-
              onds.   (The  latter  requires a nanosecond-precision clock_get-
              time; systems lacking this will return a value multiplied by the
              appropriate power of 10.)  A typical example of this is the for-
              mat `%D{%H:%M:%S.%.}'.

              The GNU extension %N is handled as a synonym for %9..

              Additionally, the GNU extension that a `-' between the % and the
              format  character  causes a leading zero or space to be stripped
              is handled directly by the shell for the format characters d, f,
              H, k, l, m, M, S and y; any other format characters are provided
              to the system's strftime(3) with any leading `-' present, so the
              handling is system dependent.  Further GNU (or other) extensions
              are also passed to strftime(3) and may work if the  system  sup-
              ports them.

   Visual effects
       %B (%b)
              Start (stop) boldface mode.

       %E     Clear to end of line.

       %U (%u)
              Start (stop) underline mode.

       %S (%s)
              Start (stop) standout mode.

       %F (%f)
              Start  (stop)  using a different foreground colour, if supported
              by the terminal.  The colour may be specified two  ways:  either
              as  a  numeric  argument,  as normal, or by a sequence in braces
              following the %F, for example %F{red}.  In the latter  case  the
              values  allowed are as described for the fg zle_highlight attri-
              bute; see Character Highlighting in zshzle(1).  This means  that
              numeric colours are allowed in the second format also.

       %K (%k)
              Start (stop) using a different bacKground colour.  The syntax is
              identical to that for %F and %f.

       %{...%}
              Include a string as  a  literal  escape  sequence.   The  string
              within  the braces should not change the cursor position.  Brace
              pairs can nest.

              A positive numeric argument between the % and the {  is  treated
              as described for %G below.

       %G     Within  a  %{...%} sequence, include a `glitch': that is, assume
              that a single character width will be output.   This  is  useful
              when  outputting  characters  that otherwise cannot be correctly
              handled by the shell, such as the  alternate  character  set  on
              some  terminals.   The  characters  in  question can be included
              within a %{...%} sequence together with the  appropriate  number
              of  %G  sequences to indicate the correct width.  An integer be-
              tween the `%' and `G' indicates a  character  width  other  than
              one.   Hence  %{seq%2G%} outputs seq and assumes it takes up the
              width of two standard characters.

              Multiple uses of %G accumulate in the obvious fashion; the posi-
              tion  of  the %G is unimportant.  Negative integers are not han-
              dled.

              Note that when prompt truncation is in use it  is  advisable  to
              divide  up  output  into  single  characters within each %{...%}
              group so that the correct truncation point can be found.

CONDITIONAL SUBSTRINGS IN PROMPTS
       %v     The value of the first element of  the  psvar  array  parameter.
              Following  the `%' with an integer gives that element of the ar-
              ray.  Negative integers count from the end of the array.

       %(x.true-text.false-text)
              Specifies a ternary expression.  The character following  the  x
              is  arbitrary;  the  same character is used to separate the text
              for the `true' result from that for the  `false'  result.   This
              separator  may  not appear in the true-text, except as part of a
              %-escape sequence.  A `)' may appear in the false-text as  `%)'.
              true-text and false-text may both contain arbitrarily-nested es-
              cape sequences, including further ternary expressions.

              The left parenthesis may be preceded or followed by  a  positive
              integer  n,  which defaults to zero.  A negative integer will be
              multiplied by -1, except as noted below for `l'.  The test char-
              acter x may be any of the following:

              !      True if the shell is running with privileges.
              #      True if the effective uid of the current process is n.
              ?      True if the exit status of the last command was n.
              _      True if at least n shell constructs were started.
              C
              /      True if the current absolute path has at least n elements
                     relative to the root directory, hence / is counted  as  0
                     elements.
              c
              .
              ~      True if the current path, with prefix replacement, has at
                     least n elements relative to the root directory, hence  /
                     is counted as 0 elements.
              D      True if the month is equal to n (January = 0).
              d      True if the day of the month is equal to n.
              e      True if the evaluation depth is at least n.
              g      True if the effective gid of the current process is n.
              j      True if the number of jobs is at least n.
              L      True if the SHLVL parameter is at least n.
              l      True  if  at least n characters have already been printed
                     on the current line.  When n  is  negative,  true  if  at
                     least abs(n) characters remain before the opposite margin
                     (thus the left margin for RPROMPT).
              S      True if the SECONDS parameter is at least n.
              T      True if the time in hours is equal to n.
              t      True if the time in minutes is equal to n.
              v      True if the array psvar has at least n elements.
              V      True  if  element  n  of  the  array  psvar  is  set  and
                     non-empty.
              w      True if the day of the week is equal to n (Sunday = 0).

       %<string<
       %>string>
       %[xstring]
              Specifies  truncation  behaviour for the remainder of the prompt
              string.   The  third,  deprecated,   form   is   equivalent   to
              `%xstringx',  i.e. x may be `<' or `>'.  The string will be dis-
              played in place of the truncated portion  of  any  string;  note
              this does not undergo prompt expansion.

              The numeric argument, which in the third form may appear immedi-
              ately after the `[', specifies the maximum permitted  length  of
              the various strings that can be displayed in the prompt.  In the
              first two forms, this numeric argument may be negative, in which
              case  the truncation length is determined by subtracting the ab-
              solute value of the numeric argument from the number of  charac-
              ter positions remaining on the current prompt line.  If this re-
              sults in a zero or negative length, a length of 1 is  used.   In
              other  words, a negative argument arranges that after truncation
              at least n characters remain before the right margin (left  mar-
              gin for RPROMPT).

              The  forms  with `<' truncate at the left of the string, and the
              forms with `>' truncate at the right of the string.   For  exam-
              ple,  if  the  current  directory  is  `/home/pike',  the prompt
              `%8<..<%/' will expand to `..e/pike'.  In this string, the  ter-
              minating  character (`<', `>' or `]'), or in fact any character,
              may be quoted by a preceding `\'; note when using print -P, how-
              ever, that this must be doubled as the string is also subject to
              standard print processing, in addition to  any  backslashes  re-
              moved  by  a  double quoted string:  the worst case is therefore
              `print -P "%<\\\\<<..."'.

              If the string is longer than the specified truncation length, it
              will appear in full, completely replacing the truncated string.

              The part of the prompt string to be truncated runs to the end of
              the string, or to the end of the next  enclosing  group  of  the
              `%('  construct,  or  to  the next truncation encountered at the
              same grouping level (i.e. truncations inside a  `%('  are  sepa-
              rate), which ever comes first.  In particular, a truncation with
              argument zero (e.g., `%<<') marks the end of the  range  of  the
              string  to  be truncated while turning off truncation from there
              on. For example, the prompt  `%10<...<%~%<<%#  '  will  print  a
              truncated representation of the current directory, followed by a
              `%' or `#', followed by a space.  Without the `%<<',  those  two
              characters  would  be  included  in  the string to be truncated.
              Note that `%-0<<' is not equivalent to `%<<' but specifies  that
              the prompt is truncated at the right margin.

              Truncation  applies  only  within  each  individual  line of the
              prompt, as delimited by embedded newlines (if any).  If the  to-
              tal length of any line of the prompt after truncation is greater
              than the terminal width, or if the part to be truncated contains
              embedded  newlines,  truncation  behavior  is  undefined and may
              change   in   a   future   version   of    the    shell.     Use
              `%-n(l.true-text.false-text)' to remove parts of the prompt when
              the available space is less than n.

ZSHEXPN(1)                  General Commands Manual                 ZSHEXPN(1)

NAME
       zshexpn - zsh expansion and substitution

DESCRIPTION
       The following types of expansions are performed in the indicated  order
       in five steps:

       History Expansion
              This is performed only in interactive shells.

       Alias Expansion
              Aliases  are  expanded  immediately  before  the command line is
              parsed as explained under Aliasing in zshmisc(1).

       Process Substitution
       Parameter Expansion
       Command Substitution
       Arithmetic Expansion
       Brace Expansion
              These five are performed in left-to-right fashion.  On each  ar-
              gument,  any of the five steps that are needed are performed one
              after the other.  Hence, for example, all the parts of parameter
              expansion  are completed before command substitution is started.
              After these expansions, all unquoted occurrences of the  charac-
              ters `\',`'' and `"' are removed.

       Filename Expansion
              If  the  SH_FILE_EXPANSION option is set, the order of expansion
              is modified for compatibility with sh and  ksh.   In  that  case
              filename  expansion  is performed immediately after alias expan-
              sion, preceding the set of five expansions mentioned above.

       Filename Generation
              This expansion, commonly referred to as globbing, is always done
              last.

       The following sections explain the types of expansion in detail.

HISTORY EXPANSION
       History  expansion  allows you to use words from previous command lines
       in the command line you are typing.  This simplifies  spelling  correc-
       tions and the repetition of complicated commands or arguments.

       Immediately  before  execution,  each  command  is saved in the history
       list, the size of which is controlled by the HISTSIZE  parameter.   The
       one  most  recent  command  is always retained in any case.  Each saved
       command in the history list is called a history event and is assigned a
       number,  beginning  with 1 (one) when the shell starts up.  The history
       number that you may see in your prompt (see  EXPANSION  OF  PROMPT  SE-
       QUENCES in zshmisc(1)) is the number that is to be assigned to the next
       command.

   Overview
       A history expansion begins with the first character  of  the  histchars
       parameter,  which is `!' by default, and may occur anywhere on the com-
       mand line, including inside double quotes (but not inside single quotes
       '...' or C-style quotes $'...' nor when escaped with a backslash).

       The  first  character  is followed by an optional event designator (see
       the section `Event Designators') and then an optional  word  designator
       (the  section  `Word  Designators'); if neither of these designators is
       present, no history expansion occurs.

       Input lines containing history expansions are echoed  after  being  ex-
       panded,  but before any other expansions take place and before the com-
       mand is executed.  It is this expanded form that  is  recorded  as  the
       history event for later references.

       History expansions do not nest.

       By  default, a history reference with no event designator refers to the
       same event as any preceding history reference on that command line;  if
       it  is the only history reference in a command, it refers to the previ-
       ous command.  However, if the option CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY  is  set,  then
       every  history  reference  with no event specification always refers to
       the previous command.

       For example, `!' is the event designator for the previous  command,  so
       `!!:1'  always  refers  to  the first word of the previous command, and
       `!!$' always refers to the last word of  the  previous  command.   With
       CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY set, then `!:1' and `!$' function in the same manner
       as `!!:1' and `!!$', respectively.  Conversely,  if  CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY
       is  unset,  then  `!:1' and `!$' refer to the first and last words, re-
       spectively, of the same event referenced by the nearest  other  history
       reference  preceding them on the current command line, or to the previ-
       ous command if there is no preceding reference.

       The character sequence `^foo^bar' (where `^'  is  actually  the  second
       character of the histchars parameter) repeats the last command, replac-
       ing the string foo with bar.  More precisely, the sequence  `^foo^bar^'
       is synonymous with `!!:s^foo^bar^', hence other modifiers (see the sec-
       tion  `Modifiers')  may  follow  the   final   `^'.    In   particular,
       `^foo^bar^:G' performs a global substitution.

       If  the  shell encounters the character sequence `!"' in the input, the
       history mechanism is temporarily disabled until the current  list  (see
       zshmisc(1))  is  fully parsed.  The `!"' is removed from the input, and
       any subsequent `!' characters have no special significance.

       A less convenient but more comprehensible form of command history  sup-
       port is provided by the fc builtin.

   Event Designators
       An  event designator is a reference to a command-line entry in the his-
       tory list.  In the list below, remember that the initial  `!'  in  each
       item  may  be changed to another character by setting the histchars pa-
       rameter.

       !      Start a history expansion, except when followed by a blank, new-
              line,  `=' or `('.  If followed immediately by a word designator
              (see the section `Word Designators'), this forms a history  ref-
              erence with no event designator (see the section `Overview').

       !!     Refer  to  the  previous command.  By itself, this expansion re-
              peats the previous command.

       !n     Refer to command-line n.

       !-n    Refer to the current command-line minus n.

       !str   Refer to the most recent command starting with str.

       !?str[?]
              Refer to the most recent command containing str.   The  trailing
              `?'  is necessary if this reference is to be followed by a modi-
              fier or followed by any text that is not to be  considered  part
              of str.

       !#     Refer  to the current command line typed in so far.  The line is
              treated as if it were complete up to and including the word  be-
              fore the one with the `!#' reference.

       !{...} Insulate a history reference from adjacent characters (if neces-
              sary).

   Word Designators
       A word designator indicates which word or words of a given command line
       are to be included in a history reference.  A `:' usually separates the
       event specification from the word designator.  It may be  omitted  only
       if  the  word designator begins with a `^', `$', `*', `-' or `%'.  Word
       designators include:

       0      The first input word (command).
       n      The nth argument.
       ^      The first argument.  That is, 1.
       $      The last argument.
       %      The word matched by (the most recent) ?str search.
       x-y    A range of words; x defaults to 0.
       *      All the arguments, or a null value if there are none.
       x*     Abbreviates `x-$'.
       x-     Like `x*' but omitting word $.

       Note that a `%' word designator works only when used in  one  of  `!%',
       `!:%'  or `!?str?:%', and only when used after a !? expansion (possibly
       in an earlier command).  Anything else results in  an  error,  although
       the error may not be the most obvious one.

   Modifiers
       After  the  optional  word designator, you can add a sequence of one or
       more of the following modifiers, each preceded by a `:'.   These  modi-
       fiers  also work on the result of filename generation and parameter ex-
       pansion, except where noted.

       a      Turn a file name into an absolute path:   prepends  the  current
              directory,  if  necessary;  remove `.' path segments; and remove
              `..' path segments and the  segments  that  immediately  precede
              them.

              This transformation is agnostic about what is in the filesystem,
              i.e. is on the logical, not the physical  directory.   It  takes
              place  in the same manner as when changing directories when nei-
              ther of the options CHASE_DOTS or CHASE_LINKS is set.  For exam-
              ple,  `/before/here/../after'  is  always  transformed  to `/be-
              fore/after', regardless of whether `/before/here' exists or what
              kind of object (dir, file, symlink, etc.) it is.

       A      Turn a file name into an absolute path as the `a' modifier does,
              and then pass the result through the realpath(3)  library  func-
              tion to resolve symbolic links.

              Note:  on  systems  that do not have a realpath(3) library func-
              tion, symbolic links are not resolved, so on those  systems  `a'
              and `A' are equivalent.

              Note: foo:A and realpath(foo) are different on some inputs.  For
              realpath(foo) semantics, see the `P` modifier.

       c      Resolve a command name into an absolute path  by  searching  the
              command path given by the PATH variable.  This does not work for
              commands containing directory parts.  Note also that  this  does
              not  usually  work as a glob qualifier unless a file of the same
              name is found in the current directory.

       e      Remove all but the part of the filename extension following  the
              `.';  see  the  definition  of the filename extension in the de-
              scription of the r modifier below.  Note that according to  that
              definition  the  result  will be empty if the string ends with a
              `.'.

       h [ digits ]
              Remove a trailing pathname component, shortening the path by one
              directory level: this is the `head' of the pathname.  This works
              like `dirname'.  If the h is followed immediately (with no  spa-
              ces or other separator) by any number of decimal digits, and the
              value of the resulting number is non-zero, that number of  lead-
              ing components is preserved instead of the final component being
              removed.  In an absolute path the leading `/' is the first  com-
              ponent,  so,  for  example,  if  var=/my/path/to/something, then
              ${var:h3} substitutes /my/path.  Consecutive  `/'s  are  treated
              the same as a single `/'.  In parameter substitution, digits may
              only be used if the expression is in braces, so for example  the
              short  form substitution $var:h2 is treated as ${var:h}2, not as
              ${var:h2}.  No restriction applies to the use of digits in  his-
              tory  substitution  or  globbing qualifiers.  If more components
              are requested than are present, the entire path  is  substituted
              (so  this  does not trigger a `failed modifier' error in history
              expansion).

       l      Convert the words to all lowercase.

       p      Print the new command but do not execute it.   Only  works  with
              history expansion.

       P      Turn  a  file name into an absolute path, like realpath(3).  The
              resulting path will be absolute, will refer to the  same  direc-
              tory  entry  as  the  input filename, and none of its components
              will be symbolic links or equal to `.' or `..'.

              Unlike realpath(3), non-existent trailing components are permit-
              ted and preserved.

       q      Quote  the  substituted  words,  escaping further substitutions.
              Works with history expansion and parameter expansion, though for
              parameters  it  is  only  useful  if the resulting text is to be
              re-evaluated such as by eval.

       Q      Remove one level of quotes from the substituted words.

       r      Remove a filename extension leaving the root name.  Strings with
              no  filename extension are not altered.  A filename extension is
              a `.' followed by any number of characters (including zero) that
              are  neither  `.'  nor  `/'  and that continue to the end of the
              string.  For example, the extension of `foo.orig.c' is `.c', and
              `dir.c/foo' has no extension.

       s/l/r[/]
              Substitute r for l as described below.  The substitution is done
              only for the first string that matches l.  For  arrays  and  for
              filename  generation,  this applies to each word of the expanded
              text.  See below for further notes on substitutions.

              The forms `gs/l/r' and `s/l/r/:G' perform  global  substitution,
              i.e. substitute every occurrence of r for l.  Note that the g or
              :G must appear in exactly the position shown.

              See further notes on this form of substitution below.

       &      Repeat the previous s substitution.  Like s, may be preceded im-
              mediately  by a g.  In parameter expansion the & must appear in-
              side braces, and in filename generation it must be quoted with a
              backslash.

       t [ digits ]
              Remove all leading pathname components, leaving the final compo-
              nent (tail).  This works like `basename'.  Any trailing  slashes
              are  first  removed.   Decimal  digits  are handled as described
              above for (h), but in this case that number of  trailing  compo-
              nents  is  preserved  instead of the default 1; 0 is treated the
              same as 1.

       u      Convert the words to all uppercase.

       x      Like q, but break into words at whitespace.  Does not work  with
              parameter expansion.

       The  s/l/r/  substitution  works  as follows.  By default the left-hand
       side of substitutions are not patterns,  but  character  strings.   Any
       character  can  be  used as the delimiter in place of `/'.  A backslash
       quotes  the  delimiter  character.    The   character   `&',   in   the
       right-hand-side  r,  is replaced by the text from the left-hand-side l.
       The `&' can be quoted with a backslash.  A null  l  uses  the  previous
       string  either from the previous l or from the contextual scan string s
       from `!?s'.  You can omit the rightmost delimiter if a newline  immedi-
       ately  follows  r; the rightmost `?' in a context scan can similarly be
       omitted.  Note the same record of the last l and r is maintained across
       all forms of expansion.

       Note that if a `&' is used within glob qualifiers an extra backslash is
       needed as a & is a special character in this case.

       Also note that the order of expansions affects the interpretation of  l
       and r.  When used in a history expansion, which occurs before any other
       expansions, l and r are treated as literal strings (except as explained
       for  HIST_SUBST_PATTERN  below).  When used in parameter expansion, the
       replacement of r into the parameter's value is done first, and then any
       additional process, parameter, command, arithmetic, or brace references
       are applied, which may evaluate those substitutions and expansions more
       than once if l appears more than once in the starting value.  When used
       in a glob qualifier, any substitutions or expansions are performed once
       at  the  time  the qualifier is parsed, even before the `:s' expression
       itself is divided into l and r sides.

       If the option HIST_SUBST_PATTERN is set, l is treated as a  pattern  of
       the  usual  form  described  in  the section FILENAME GENERATION below.
       This can be used in all the places where modifiers are available; note,
       however, that in globbing qualifiers parameter substitution has already
       taken place, so parameters in the replacement string should  be  quoted
       to  ensure  they are replaced at the correct time.  Note also that com-
       plicated patterns used in globbing qualifiers  may  need  the  extended
       glob  qualifier notation (#q:s/.../.../) in order for the shell to rec-
       ognize the expression as a glob qualifier.  Further, note that bad pat-
       terns  in the substitution are not subject to the NO_BAD_PATTERN option
       so will cause an error.

       When HIST_SUBST_PATTERN is set, l may start with a # to  indicate  that
       the  pattern  must  match at the start of the string to be substituted,
       and a % may appear at the start or after an # to indicate that the pat-
       tern must match at the end of the string to be substituted.  The % or #
       may be quoted with two backslashes.

       For example, the following piece of filename generation code  with  the
       EXTENDED_GLOB option:

              print -r -- *.c(#q:s/#%(#b)s(*).c/'S${match[1]}.C'/)

       takes  the  expansion  of  *.c  and  applies the glob qualifiers in the
       (#q...) expression, which consists of a substitution modifier  anchored
       to  the  start and end of each word (#%).  This turns on backreferences
       ((#b)), so that the parenthesised subexpression is available in the re-
       placement  string  as ${match[1]}.  The replacement string is quoted so
       that the parameter is not substituted before the start of filename gen-
       eration.

       The  following  f, F, w and W modifiers work only with parameter expan-
       sion and filename generation.  They are listed here to provide a single
       point of reference for all modifiers.

       f      Repeats the immediately (without a colon) following modifier un-
              til the resulting word doesn't change any more.

       F:expr:
              Like f, but repeats only n times if the expression  expr  evalu-
              ates  to  n.   Any  character can be used instead of the `:'; if
              `(', `[', or `{' is used as the opening delimiter,  the  closing
              delimiter should be ')', `]', or `}', respectively.

       w      Makes  the  immediately  following modifier work on each word in
              the string.

       W:sep: Like w but words are considered to be the parts  of  the  string
              that  are separated by sep. Any character can be used instead of
              the `:'; opening parentheses are handled specially, see above.

PROCESS SUBSTITUTION
       Each part  of  a  command  argument  that  takes  the  form  `<(list)',
       `>(list)' or `=(list)' is subject to process substitution.  The expres-
       sion may be preceded or followed by other strings except that, to  pre-
       vent  clashes  with  commonly  occurring strings and patterns, the last
       form must occur at the start of a command argument, and the  forms  are
       only  expanded  when  first  parsing  command  or assignment arguments.
       Process substitutions may be used following redirection  operators;  in
       this case, the substitution must appear with no trailing string.

       Note  that  `<<(list)'  is not a special syntax; it is equivalent to `<
       <(list)', redirecting standard input from the result of process substi-
       tution.   Hence  all  the  following documentation applies.  The second
       form (with the space) is recommended for clarity.

       In the case of the < or > forms, the shell runs the commands in list as
       a  subprocess of the job executing the shell command line.  If the sys-
       tem supports the /dev/fd mechanism, the command argument is the name of
       the  device  file corresponding to a file descriptor; otherwise, if the
       system supports named pipes (FIFOs), the command  argument  will  be  a
       named  pipe.   If the form with > is selected then writing on this spe-
       cial file will provide input for list.  If < is  used,  then  the  file
       passed  as  an  argument  will  be  connected to the output of the list
       process.  For example,

              paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) |
              tee >(process1) >(process2) >/dev/null

       cuts fields 1 and 3 from the files file1 and file2 respectively, pastes
       the  results  together,  and  sends  it  to  the processes process1 and
       process2.

       If =(...) is used instead of <(...), then the file passed as  an  argu-
       ment  will be the name of a temporary file containing the output of the
       list process.  This may be used instead of the <  form  for  a  program
       that expects to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the input file.

       There is an optimisation for substitutions of the form =(<<<arg), where
       arg is a single-word argument to the here-string redirection <<<.  This
       form produces a file name containing the value of arg after any substi-
       tutions have been performed.  This is handled entirely within the  cur-
       rent  shell.   This  is  effectively  the  reverse  of the special form
       $(<arg) which treats arg as a file name and replaces it with the file's
       contents.

       The = form is useful as both the /dev/fd and the named pipe implementa-
       tion of <(...) have drawbacks.  In the former case, some programmes may
       automatically  close  the  file descriptor in question before examining
       the file on the command line, particularly if this is necessary for se-
       curity  reasons  such  as when the programme is running setuid.  In the
       second case, if the programme does not actually open the file, the sub-
       shell  attempting  to read from or write to the pipe will (in a typical
       implementation, different operating systems may have  different  behav-
       iour)  block for ever and have to be killed explicitly.  In both cases,
       the shell actually supplies the information using a pipe, so that  pro-
       grammes that expect to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the file will not work.

       Also  note  that  the  previous example can be more compactly and effi-
       ciently written (provided the MULTIOS option is set) as:

              paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) > >(process1) > >(process2)

       The shell uses pipes instead of  FIFOs  to  implement  the  latter  two
       process substitutions in the above example.

       There  is  an additional problem with >(process); when this is attached
       to an external command, the parent shell does not wait for  process  to
       finish  and  hence  an immediately following command cannot rely on the
       results being complete.  The problem and solution are the same  as  de-
       scribed  in  the  section MULTIOS in zshmisc(1).  Hence in a simplified
       version of the example above:

              paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) > >(process)

       (note that no MULTIOS are involved), process will be run asynchronously
       as far as the parent shell is concerned.  The workaround is:

              { paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) } > >(process)

       The  extra  processes here are spawned from the parent shell which will
       wait for their completion.

       Another problem arises any time a job with a substitution that requires
       a  temporary  file  is  disowned by the shell, including the case where
       `&!' or `&|' appears at the end of a command containing a substitution.
       In  that case the temporary file will not be cleaned up as the shell no
       longer has any memory of the job.  A workaround is to use  a  subshell,
       for example,

              (mycmd =(myoutput)) &!

       as  the forked subshell will wait for the command to finish then remove
       the temporary file.

       A general workaround to ensure a process substitution  endures  for  an
       appropriate length of time is to pass it as a parameter to an anonymous
       shell function (a piece of shell code  that  is  run  immediately  with
       function scope).  For example, this code:

              () {
                 print File $1:
                 cat $1
              } =(print This be the verse)

       outputs something resembling the following

              File /tmp/zsh6nU0kS:
              This be the verse

       The  temporary file created by the process substitution will be deleted
       when the function exits.

PARAMETER EXPANSION
       The character `$' is used to introduce parameter expansions.  See  zsh-
       param(1) for a description of parameters, including arrays, associative
       arrays, and subscript notation to access individual array elements.

       Note in particular the fact that words of unquoted parameters  are  not
       automatically  split  on  whitespace unless the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is
       set; see references to this option below for more details.  This is  an
       important  difference  from other shells.  However, as in other shells,
       null words are elided from unquoted parameters' expansions.

       With default options, after the assignments:

              array=("first word" "" "third word")
              scalar="only word"

       then $array substitutes two words, `first word' and `third  word',  and
       $scalar  substitutes  a single word `only word'.  Note that second ele-
       ment of array was elided.  Scalar parameters can be elided too if their
       value  is  null  (empty).   To  avoid  elision, use quoting as follows:
       "$scalar" for scalars and "${array[@]}" or  "${(@)array}"  for  arrays.
       (The last two forms are equivalent.)

       Parameter  expansions  can  involve flags, as in `${(@kv)aliases}', and
       other operators, such as `${PREFIX:-"/usr/local"}'.   Parameter  expan-
       sions  can also be nested.  These topics will be introduced below.  The
       full rules are complicated and are noted at the end.

       In the expansions discussed below that require a pattern, the  form  of
       the  pattern  is the same as that used for filename generation; see the
       section `Filename Generation'.  Note that these  patterns,  along  with
       the  replacement  text  of any substitutions, are themselves subject to
       parameter expansion, command substitution,  and  arithmetic  expansion.
       In  addition to the following operations, the colon modifiers described
       in the section `Modifiers' in the section `History  Expansion'  can  be
       applied:   for example, ${i:s/foo/bar/} performs string substitution on
       the expansion of parameter $i.

       In the following descriptions, `word' refers to a single  word  substi-
       tuted on the command line, not necessarily a space delimited word.

       ${name}
              The  value,  if  any, of the parameter name is substituted.  The
              braces are required if the expansion is to be followed by a let-
              ter,  digit, or underscore that is not to be interpreted as part
              of name.  In addition, more complicated  forms  of  substitution
              usually require the braces to be present; exceptions, which only
              apply if the option KSH_ARRAYS is not set,  are  a  single  sub-
              script  or  any colon modifiers appearing after the name, or any
              of the characters `^', `=', `~', `#' or `+' appearing before the
              name, all of which work with or without braces.

              If  name is an array parameter, and the KSH_ARRAYS option is not
              set, then the value of each element of name is substituted,  one
              element  per word.  Otherwise, the expansion results in one word
              only; with KSH_ARRAYS, this is the first element  of  an  array.
              No   field   splitting   is   done  on  the  result  unless  the
              SH_WORD_SPLIT  option  is  set.   See  also  the  flags  =   and
              s:string:.

       ${+name}
              If  name is the name of a set parameter `1' is substituted, oth-
              erwise `0' is substituted.

       ${name-word}
       ${name:-word}
              If name is set, or in the second form is non-null, then  substi-
              tute  its  value; otherwise substitute word.  In the second form
              name may be omitted, in which case word is always substituted.

       ${name+word}
       ${name:+word}
              If name is set, or in the second form is non-null, then  substi-
              tute word; otherwise substitute nothing.

       ${name=word}
       ${name:=word}
       ${name::=word}
              In  the first form, if name is unset then set it to word; in the
              second form, if name is unset or null then set it to  word;  and
              in  the  third  form,  unconditionally set name to word.  In all
              forms, the value of the parameter is then substituted.

       ${name?word}
       ${name:?word}
              In the first form, if name is set, or in the second form if name
              is  both set and non-null, then substitute its value; otherwise,
              print word and exit from the shell.  Interactive shells  instead
              return  to the prompt.  If word is omitted, then a standard mes-
              sage is printed.

       In any of the above expressions that test a variable and substitute  an
       alternate  word,  note  that  you can use standard shell quoting in the
       word  value  to  selectively  override  the  splitting  done   by   the
       SH_WORD_SPLIT option and the = flag, but not splitting by the s:string:
       flag.

       In the following expressions, when name is an array and  the  substitu-
       tion is not quoted, or if the `(@)' flag or the name[@] syntax is used,
       matching and replacement is performed on each array element separately.

       ${name#pattern}
       ${name##pattern}
              If the pattern matches the beginning of the value of name,  then
              substitute  the  value of name with the matched portion deleted;
              otherwise, just substitute the value  of  name.   In  the  first
              form,  the smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the second
              form, the largest matching pattern is preferred.

       ${name%pattern}
       ${name%%pattern}
              If the pattern matches the end of the value of name,  then  sub-
              stitute the value of name with the matched portion deleted; oth-
              erwise, just substitute the value of name.  In the  first  form,
              the  smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the second form,
              the largest matching pattern is preferred.

       ${name:#pattern}
              If the pattern matches the value of name,  then  substitute  the
              empty  string; otherwise, just substitute the value of name.  If
              name is an array the matching array elements  are  removed  (use
              the `(M)' flag to remove the non-matched elements).

       ${name:|arrayname}
              If  arrayname is the name (N.B., not contents) of an array vari-
              able, then any elements contained in arrayname are removed  from
              the substitution of name.  If the substitution is scalar, either
              because name is a scalar variable or the expression  is  quoted,
              the  elements of arrayname are instead tested against the entire
              expression.

       ${name:*arrayname}
              Similar to the  preceding  substitution,  but  in  the  opposite
              sense, so that entries present in both the original substitution
              and as elements of arrayname are retained and others removed.

       ${name:^arrayname}
       ${name:^^arrayname}
              Zips two arrays, such that the output array is twice as long  as
              the shortest (longest for `:^^') of name and arrayname, with the
              elements alternatingly being picked from them. For `:^', if  one
              of the input arrays is longer, the output will stop when the end
              of the shorter array is reached.  Thus,

                     a=(1 2 3 4); b=(a b); print ${a:^b}

              will output `1 a 2 b'.  For `:^^', then the  input  is  repeated
              until  all  of  the  longer array has been used up and the above
              will output `1 a 2 b 3 a 4 b'.

              Either or both inputs may be a scalar, they will be  treated  as
              an array of length 1 with the scalar as the only element. If ei-
              ther array is empty, the other array is output with no extra el-
              ements inserted.

              Currently  the  following  code will output `a b' and `1' as two
              separate elements, which can be  unexpected.  The  second  print
              provides  a  workaround which should continue to work if this is
              changed.

                     a=(a b); b=(1 2); print -l "${a:^b}"; print -l "${${a:^b}}"

       ${name:offset}
       ${name:offset:length}
              This syntax gives effects similar to parameter  subscripting  in
              the  form $name[start,end], but is compatible with other shells;
              note that both offset and  length  are  interpreted  differently
              from the components of a subscript.

              If offset is non-negative, then if the variable name is a scalar
              substitute the contents  starting  offset  characters  from  the
              first  character  of the string, and if name is an array substi-
              tute elements starting offset elements from the  first  element.
              If length is given, substitute that many characters or elements,
              otherwise the entire rest of the scalar or array.

              A positive offset is always treated as the offset of a character
              or  element  in  name from the first character or element of the
              array (this is different from native  zsh  subscript  notation).
              Hence  0  refers to the first character or element regardless of
              the setting of the option KSH_ARRAYS.

              A negative offset counts backwards from the end of the scalar or
              array,  so that -1 corresponds to the last character or element,
              and so on.

              When positive, length counts from the offset position toward the
              end  of  the scalar or array.  When negative, length counts back
              from the end.  If this results in a position smaller  than  off-
              set, a diagnostic is printed and nothing is substituted.

              The option MULTIBYTE is obeyed, i.e. the offset and length count
              multibyte characters where appropriate.

              offset and length undergo the same set of shell substitutions as
              for  scalar  assignment;  in  addition, they are then subject to
              arithmetic evaluation.  Hence, for example

                     print ${foo:3}
                     print ${foo: 1 + 2}
                     print ${foo:$(( 1 + 2))}
                     print ${foo:$(echo 1 + 2)}

              all have the same effect, extracting the string starting at  the
              fourth character of $foo if the substitution would otherwise re-
              turn a scalar, or the array starting at the  fourth  element  if
              $foo  would  return an array.  Note that with the option KSH_AR-
              RAYS $foo always returns a scalar (regardless of the use of  the
              offset syntax) and a form such as ${foo[*]:3} is required to ex-
              tract elements of an array named foo.

              If offset is negative, the - may not  appear  immediately  after
              the  : as this indicates the ${name:-word} form of substitution.
              Instead, a space may be inserted  before  the  -.   Furthermore,
              neither offset nor length may begin with an alphabetic character
              or & as these are used to indicate history-style modifiers.   To
              substitute  a value from a variable, the recommended approach is
              to precede it with a $ as this signifies the intention  (parame-
              ter substitution can easily be rendered unreadable); however, as
              arithmetic substitution  is  performed,  the  expression  ${var:
              offs} does work, retrieving the offset from $offs.

              For  further  compatibility with other shells there is a special
              case for array offset 0.  This usually accesses the  first  ele-
              ment  of  the array.  However, if the substitution refers to the
              positional parameter array, e.g. $@ or $*, then offset 0 instead
              refers to $0, offset 1 refers to $1, and so on.  In other words,
              the  positional  parameter  array  is  effectively  extended  by
              prepending  $0.  Hence ${*:0:1} substitutes $0 and ${*:1:1} sub-
              stitutes $1.

       ${name/pattern/repl}
       ${name//pattern/repl}
       ${name:/pattern/repl}
              Replace the longest possible match of pattern in  the  expansion
              of  parameter name by string repl.  The first form replaces just
              the first occurrence, the second form all occurrences,  and  the
              third  form  replaces only if pattern matches the entire string.
              Both pattern and repl are subject to double-quoted substitution,
              so that expressions like ${name/$opat/$npat} will work, but obey
              the usual rule that pattern characters in $opat are not  treated
              specially  unless  either the option GLOB_SUBST is set, or $opat
              is instead substituted as ${~opat}.

              The pattern may begin with a `#', in which case the pattern must
              match  at the start of the string, or `%', in which case it must
              match at the end of the string, or `#%' in which case  the  pat-
              tern  must  match  the  entire string.  The repl may be an empty
              string, in which case the final `/' may  also  be  omitted.   To
              quote  the  final  `/' in other cases it should be preceded by a
              single backslash; this is not necessary if the `/' occurs inside
              a  substituted  parameter.   Note also that the `#', `%' and `#%
              are not active if they occur  inside  a  substituted  parameter,
              even at the start.

              If,  after quoting rules apply, ${name} expands to an array, the
              replacements act on each element individually.   Note  also  the
              effect  of the I and S parameter expansion flags below; however,
              the flags M, R, B, E and N are not useful.

              For example,

                     foo="twinkle twinkle little star" sub="t*e" rep="spy"
                     print ${foo//${~sub}/$rep}
                     print ${(S)foo//${~sub}/$rep}

              Here, the `~' ensures that the text of $sub is treated as a pat-
              tern rather than a plain string.  In the first case, the longest
              match for t*e is substituted and the result is `spy star', while
              in  the  second case, the shortest matches are taken and the re-
              sult is `spy spy lispy star'.

       ${#spec}
              If spec is one of the above substitutions, substitute the length
              in  characters  of  the result instead of the result itself.  If
              spec is an array expression, substitute the number  of  elements
              of the result.  This has the side-effect that joining is skipped
              even in quoted forms, which may affect other sub-expressions  in
              spec.   Note  that  `^', `=', and `~', below, must appear to the
              left of `#' when these forms are combined.

              If the option POSIX_IDENTIFIERS is not set, and spec is a simple
              name,  then  the braces are optional; this is true even for spe-
              cial parameters so e.g. $#- and  $#*  take  the  length  of  the
              string  $-  and the array $* respectively.  If POSIX_IDENTIFIERS
              is set, then braces are required for the # to be treated in this
              fashion.

       ${^spec}
       ${^^spec}
              Turn  on  the RC_EXPAND_PARAM option for the evaluation of spec;
              if the `^' is doubled, turn it off.  When this  option  is  set,
              array expansions of the form foo${xx}bar, where the parameter xx
              is set to  (a  b  c),  are  substituted  with  `fooabar  foobbar
              foocbar'  instead  of  the  default `fooa b cbar'.  Note that an
              empty array will therefore cause all arguments to be removed.

              Internally, each such expansion is converted into the equivalent
              list    for    brace    expansion.     E.g.,   ${^var}   becomes
              {$var[1],$var[2],...}, and is processed as described in the sec-
              tion  `Brace Expansion' below: note, however, the expansion hap-
              pens immediately, with any explicit  brace  expansion  happening
              later.   If  word  splitting  is  also in effect the $var[N] may
              themselves be split into different list elements.

       ${=spec}
       ${==spec}
              Perform word splitting using the rules for SH_WORD_SPLIT  during
              the  evaluation of spec, but regardless of whether the parameter
              appears in double quotes; if the `=' is doubled,  turn  it  off.
              This forces parameter expansions to be split into separate words
              before substitution, using IFS as a delimiter.  This is done  by
              default in most other shells.

              Note  that  splitting is applied to word in the assignment forms
              of spec before the assignment to name is  performed.   This  af-
              fects the result of array assignments with the A flag.

       ${~spec}
       ${~~spec}
              Turn on the GLOB_SUBST option for the evaluation of spec; if the
              `~' is doubled, turn it off.   When  this  option  is  set,  the
              string  resulting  from  the  expansion will be interpreted as a
              pattern anywhere that is possible, such as in filename expansion
              and  filename  generation and pattern-matching contexts like the
              right hand side of the `=' and `!=' operators in conditions.

              In nested substitutions, note that the effect of the  ~  applies
              to the result of the current level of substitution.  A surround-
              ing pattern operation on the result may cancel it.   Hence,  for
              example,  if  the  parameter foo is set to *, ${~foo//\*/*.c} is
              substituted by the pattern *.c, which may be expanded  by  file-
              name  generation,  but  ${${~foo}//\*/*.c}  substitutes  to  the
              string *.c, which will not be further expanded.

       If a ${...} type parameter expression or a $(...) type command  substi-
       tution is used in place of name above, it is expanded first and the re-
       sult is used as if it were the value of name.  Thus it is  possible  to
       perform  nested  operations:  ${${foo#head}%tail} substitutes the value
       of $foo with both `head' and `tail' deleted.  The form with  $(...)  is
       often  useful in combination with the flags described next; see the ex-
       amples below.  Each name or nested ${...} in a parameter expansion  may
       also be followed by a subscript expression as described in Array Param-
       eters in zshparam(1).

       Note that double quotes may appear around nested expressions, in  which
       case   only  the  part  inside  is  treated  as  quoted;  for  example,
       ${(f)"$(foo)"} quotes the result of $(foo), but the flag `(f)' (see be-
       low)  is applied using the rules for unquoted expansions.  Note further
       that quotes are themselves nested in  this  context;  for  example,  in
       "${(@f)"$(foo)"}",  there  are  two sets of quotes, one surrounding the
       whole expression, the other (redundant) surrounding the $(foo)  as  be-
       fore.

   Parameter Expansion Flags
       If  the  opening  brace is directly followed by an opening parenthesis,
       the string up to the matching closing parenthesis will be  taken  as  a
       list of flags.  In cases where repeating a flag is meaningful, the rep-
       etitions need not be consecutive; for example, `(q%q%q)' means the same
       thing  as  the  more  readable `(%%qqq)'.  The following flags are sup-
       ported:

       #      Evaluate the resulting words as numeric expressions  and  inter-
              pret these as character codes.  Output the corresponding charac-
              ters.  Note that this form is entirely distinct from use of  the
              # without parentheses.

              If  the  MULTIBYTE  option is set and the number is greater than
              127 (i.e. not an ASCII character) it is  treated  as  a  Unicode
              character.

       %      Expand  all  % escapes in the resulting words in the same way as
              in prompts (see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)). If
              this  flag  is given twice, full prompt expansion is done on the
              resulting words, depending on the setting of the PROMPT_PERCENT,
              PROMPT_SUBST and PROMPT_BANG options.

       @      In  double  quotes,  array elements are put into separate words.
              E.g.,  `"${(@)foo}"'  is   equivalent   to   `"${foo[@]}"'   and
              `"${(@)foo[1,2]}"'  is  the same as `"$foo[1]" "$foo[2]"'.  This
              is distinct from field splitting by the f, s or z  flags,  which
              still applies within each array element.

       A      Convert  the  substitution  into an array expression, even if it
              otherwise would be scalar.  This has lower precedence than  sub-
              scripting, so one level of nested expansion is required in order
              that subscripts apply to array elements.  Thus  ${${(A)name}[1]}
              yields the full value of name when name is scalar.

              This assigns an array parameter with `${...=...}', `${...:=...}'
              or `${...::=...}'.  If this flag is repeated (as in  `AA'),  as-
              signs an associative array parameter.  Assignment is made before
              sorting or padding; if field splitting is active, the word  part
              is  split before assignment.  The name part may be a subscripted
              range for ordinary arrays; when assigning an associative  array,
              the  word part must be converted to an array, for example by us-
              ing `${(AA)=name=...}' to activate field splitting.

              Surrounding context such as additional nesting  or  use  of  the
              value  in  a  scalar assignment may cause the array to be joined
              back into a single string again.

       a      Sort in array index order; when combined with `O'  sort  in  re-
              verse  array index order.  Note that `a' is therefore equivalent
              to the default but `Oa' is useful for obtaining an array's  ele-
              ments in reverse order.

       b      Quote  with backslashes only characters that are special to pat-
              tern matching. This is useful when the contents of the  variable
              are to be tested using GLOB_SUBST, including the ${~...} switch.

              Quoting  using  one  of  the q family of flags does not work for
              this purpose since quotes  are  not  stripped  from  non-pattern
              characters by GLOB_SUBST.  In other words,

                     pattern=${(q)str}
                     [[ $str = ${~pattern} ]]

              works if $str is `a*b' but not if it is `a b', whereas

                     pattern=${(b)str}
                     [[ $str = ${~pattern} ]]

              is always true for any possible value of $str.

       c      With ${#name}, count the total number of characters in an array,
              as if the elements were concatenated with spaces  between  them.
              This  is not a true join of the array, so other expressions used
              with this flag may have an effect on the elements of  the  array
              before it is counted.

       C      Capitalize  the resulting words.  `Words' in this case refers to
              sequences of alphanumeric characters separated  by  non-alphanu-
              merics, not to words that result from field splitting.

       D      Assume  the string or array elements contain directories and at-
              tempt to substitute the leading part of these by names.  The re-
              mainder of the path (the whole of it if the leading part was not
              substituted) is then quoted so that the whole string can be used
              as  a  shell argument.  This is the reverse of `~' substitution:
              see the section FILENAME EXPANSION below.

       e      Perform single word shell expansions,  namely  parameter  expan-
              sion,  command substitution and arithmetic expansion, on the re-
              sult. Such expansions can be nested but too deep  recursion  may
              have unpredictable effects.

       f      Split  the result of the expansion at newlines. This is a short-
              hand for `ps:\n:'.

       F      Join the words of arrays together using newline as a  separator.
              This is a shorthand for `pj:\n:'.

       g:opts:
              Process  escape  sequences like the echo builtin when no options
              are given (g::).  With the o option, octal escapes don't take  a
              leading  zero.   With the c option, sequences like `^X' are also
              processed.  With the e option, processes `\M-t' and similar  se-
              quences  like  the  print builtin.  With both of the o and e op-
              tions, behaves like the print builtin except  that  in  none  of
              these modes is `\c' interpreted.

       i      Sort case-insensitively.  May be combined with `n' or `O'.

       k      If name refers to an associative array, substitute the keys (el-
              ement names) rather than the values of the elements.  Used  with
              subscripts (including ordinary arrays), force indices or keys to
              be substituted even if the  subscript  form  refers  to  values.
              However,  this  flag  may not be combined with subscript ranges.
              With the KSH_ARRAYS option a subscript `[*]' or `[@]' is  needed
              to operate on the whole array, as usual.

       L      Convert all letters in the result to lower case.

       n      Sort  decimal integers numerically; if the first differing char-
              acters of two test strings are not digits, sorting  is  lexical.
              `+'  and  `-' are not treated specially; they are treated as any
              other non-digit.  Integers with more initial zeroes  are  sorted
              before  those  with fewer or none.  Hence the array `foo+24 foo1
              foo02 foo2 foo3 foo20 foo23' is sorted  into  the  order  shown.
              May be combined with `i' or `O'.

       -      As  n, but a leading minus sign indicates a negative decimal in-
              teger.  A leading minus sign not followed by an integer does not
              trigger  numeric  sorting.   Note that `+' signs are not handled
              specially (this may change in the future).

       o      Sort the resulting words in ascending order; if this appears  on
              its  own  the  sorting is lexical and case-sensitive (unless the
              locale renders it case-insensitive).  Sorting in ascending order
              is the default for other forms of sorting, so this is ignored if
              combined with `a', `i', `n' or `-'.

       O      Sort the resulting words in descending order; `O'  without  `a',
              `i', `n' or `-' sorts in reverse lexical order.  May be combined
              with `a', `i', `n' or `-' to reverse the order of sorting.

       P      This forces the value of the parameter name to be interpreted as
              a  further parameter name, whose value will be used where appro-
              priate.  Note that flags set with one of the typeset  family  of
              commands (in particular case transformations) are not applied to
              the value of name used in this fashion.

              If used with a nested parameter or command substitution, the re-
              sult  of that will be taken as a parameter name in the same way.
              For example, if you have `foo=bar' and  `bar=baz',  the  strings
              ${(P)foo},  ${(P)${foo}}, and ${(P)$(echo bar)} will be expanded
              to `baz'.

              Likewise, if the reference is itself nested, the expression with
              the  flag  is treated as if it were directly replaced by the pa-
              rameter name.  It is an error if this nested  substitution  pro-
              duces  an  array  with  more  than  one  word.   For example, if
              `name=assoc' where the parameter assoc is an associative  array,
              then  `${${(P)name}[elt]}' refers to the element of the associa-
              tive subscripted `elt'.

       q      Quote characters that are special to the shell in the  resulting
              words  with  backslashes;  unprintable or invalid characters are
              quoted using the $'\NNN' form, with  separate  quotes  for  each
              octet.

              If  this  flag is given twice, the resulting words are quoted in
              single quotes and if it is given  three  times,  the  words  are
              quoted  in  double quotes; in these forms no special handling of
              unprintable or invalid characters is attempted.  If the flag  is
              given four times, the words are quoted in single quotes preceded
              by a $.  Note that in all three of these forms quoting  is  done
              unconditionally,  even  if  this does not change the way the re-
              sulting string would be interpreted by the shell.

              If a q- is given (only a single q may appear), a minimal form of
              single  quoting is used that only quotes the string if needed to
              protect special characters.  Typically this form gives the  most
              readable output.

              If  a  q+  is given, an extended form of minimal quoting is used
              that causes unprintable characters to be rendered using  $'...'.
              This  quoting is similar to that used by the output of values by
              the typeset family of commands.

       Q      Remove one level of quotes from the resulting words.

       t      Use a string describing the type  of  the  parameter  where  the
              value  of  the  parameter would usually appear. This string con-
              sists of keywords separated by hyphens (`-'). The first  keyword
              in  the  string  describes  the  main  type,  it  can  be one of
              `scalar', `array',  `integer',  `float'  or  `association'.  The
              other keywords describe the type in more detail:

              local  for local parameters

              left   for left justified parameters

              right_blanks
                     for right justified parameters with leading blanks

              right_zeros
                     for right justified parameters with leading zeros

              lower  for parameters whose value is converted to all lower case
                     when it is expanded

              upper  for parameters whose value is converted to all upper case
                     when it is expanded

              readonly
                     for readonly parameters

              tag    for tagged parameters

              tied   for parameters tied to another parameter in the manner of
                     PATH (colon-separated list)  and  path  (array),  whether
                     these  are special parameters or user-defined with `type-
                     set -T'

              export for exported parameters

              unique for arrays which keep only the first occurrence of dupli-
                     cated values

              hide   for parameters with the `hide' flag

              hideval
                     for parameters with the `hideval' flag

              special
                     for special parameters defined by the shell

       u      Expand only the first occurrence of each unique word.

       U      Convert all letters in the result to upper case.

       v      Used  with k, substitute (as two consecutive words) both the key
              and the value of each associative array element.  Used with sub-
              scripts,  force  values  to be substituted even if the subscript
              form refers to indices or keys.

       V      Make any special characters in the resulting words visible.

       w      With ${#name}, count words in arrays or strings; the s flag  may
              be used to set a word delimiter.

       W      Similar  to  w  with the difference that empty words between re-
              peated delimiters are also counted.

       X      With this flag, parsing errors occurring with the  Q,  e  and  #
              flags  or  the  pattern matching forms such as `${name#pattern}'
              are reported.  Without the flag, errors are silently ignored.

       z      Split the result of the expansion into words using shell parsing
              to  find  the words, i.e. taking into account any quoting in the
              value.  Comments are  not  treated  specially  but  as  ordinary
              strings, similar to interactive shells with the INTERACTIVE_COM-
              MENTS option unset (however, see the Z flag  below  for  related
              options)

              Note  that  this  is  done  very late, even later than the `(s)'
              flag. So to access single words in the result use nested  expan-
              sions as in `${${(z)foo}[2]}'. Likewise, to remove the quotes in
              the resulting words use `${(Q)${(z)foo}}'.

       0      Split the result of the expansion on  null  bytes.   This  is  a
              shorthand for `ps:\0:'.

       The following flags (except p) are followed by one or more arguments as
       shown.  Any character, or the matching pairs `(...)', `{...}', `[...]',
       or  `<...>',  may  be  used in place of a colon as delimiters, but note
       that when a flag takes more than one argument, a matched pair of delim-
       iters must surround each argument.

       p      Recognize  the  same  escape  sequences  as the print builtin in
              string arguments to any of the flags described below that follow
              this argument.

              Alternatively,  with  this option string arguments may be in the
              form $var in which case the value of  the  variable  is  substi-
              tuted.   Note  this form is strict; the string argument does not
              undergo general parameter expansion.

              For example,

                     sep=:
                     val=a:b:c
                     print ${(ps.$sep.)val}

              splits the variable on a :.

       ~      Strings inserted into the expansion by any of  the  flags  below
              are to be treated as patterns.  This applies to the string argu-
              ments of flags that follow ~ within the same set of parentheses.
              Compare with ~ outside parentheses, which forces the entire sub-
              stituted string to be treated as a pattern.  Hence, for example,

                     [[ "?" = ${(~j.|.)array} ]]

              treats `|' as a pattern and succeeds if and only if $array  con-
              tains  the  string  `?' as an element.  The ~ may be repeated to
              toggle the behaviour; its effect only lasts to the  end  of  the
              parenthesised group.

       j:string:
              Join  the  words of arrays together using string as a separator.
              Note that this occurs before field splitting  by  the  s:string:
              flag or the SH_WORD_SPLIT option.

       l:expr::string1::string2:
              Pad  the  resulting  words on the left.  Each word will be trun-
              cated if required and placed in a field expr characters wide.

              The arguments :string1: and :string2: are optional; neither, the
              first, or both may be given.  Note that the same pairs of delim-
              iters must be used for each of the three arguments.   The  space
              to  the  left will be filled with string1 (concatenated as often
              as needed) or spaces if string1 is not given.  If  both  string1
              and  string2 are given, string2 is inserted once directly to the
              left of each word, truncated if  necessary,  before  string1  is
              used to produce any remaining padding.

              If either of string1 or string2 is present but empty, i.e. there
              are two delimiters together at that point, the  first  character
              of $IFS is used instead.

              If  the  MULTIBYTE  option  is in effect, the flag m may also be
              given, in which case widths will be used for the calculation  of
              padding;  otherwise  individual multibyte characters are treated
              as occupying one unit of width.

              If the MULTIBYTE option is not  in  effect,  each  byte  in  the
              string is treated as occupying one unit of width.

              Control  characters are always assumed to be one unit wide; this
              allows the mechanism to be used for  generating  repetitions  of
              control characters.

       m      Only  useful together with one of the flags l or r or with the #
              length operator when the MULTIBYTE option is in effect.  Use the
              character  width  reported by the system in calculating how much
              of the string it occupies or the overall length of  the  string.
              Most printable characters have a width of one unit, however cer-
              tain Asian character sets and certain special effects use  wider
              characters; combining characters have zero width.  Non-printable
              characters are arbitrarily counted as zero width; how they would
              actually be displayed will vary.

              If  the  m  is repeated, the character either counts zero (if it
              has zero width), else one.  For printable character strings this
              has  the  effect of counting the number of glyphs (visibly sepa-
              rate characters), except for the case where combining characters
              themselves have non-zero width (true in certain alphabets).

       r:expr::string1::string2:
              As  l, but pad the words on the right and insert string2 immedi-
              ately to the right of the string to be padded.

              Left and right padding may be used together.  In this  case  the
              strategy  is  to  apply  left padding to the first half width of
              each of the resulting words, and right  padding  to  the  second
              half.   If  the string to be padded has odd width the extra pad-
              ding is applied on the left.

       s:string:
              Force field splitting at the  separator  string.   Note  that  a
              string  of  two  or  more characters means that all of them must
              match in sequence; this differs from the  treatment  of  two  or
              more  characters  in the IFS parameter.  See also the = flag and
              the SH_WORD_SPLIT option.  An empty string may also be given  in
              which case every character will be a separate element.

              For historical reasons, the usual behaviour that empty array el-
              ements are retained inside double quotes is disabled for  arrays
              generated by splitting; hence the following:

                     line="one::three"
                     print -l "${(s.:.)line}"

              produces  two  lines  of output for one and three and elides the
              empty field.  To override this behaviour, supply the `(@)'  flag
              as well, i.e.  "${(@s.:.)line}".

       Z:opts:
              As z but takes a combination of option letters between a follow-
              ing pair of delimiter characters.  With no options the effect is
              identical to z.  The following options are available:

              (Z+c+) causes  comments  to  be parsed as a string and retained;
                     any field in the resulting array beginning  with  an  un-
                     quoted comment character is a comment.

              (Z+C+) causes  comments  to be parsed and removed.  The rule for
                     comments is standard: anything between  a  word  starting
                     with  the third character of $HISTCHARS, default #, up to
                     the next newline is a comment.

              (Z+n+) causes unquoted newlines to be treated as ordinary white-
                     space,  else  they  are treated as if they are shell code
                     delimiters and converted to semicolons.

              Options are combined within the same  set  of  delimiters,  e.g.
              (Z+Cn+).

       _:flags:
              The  underscore (_) flag is reserved for future use.  As of this
              revision of zsh, there are no valid flags; anything following an
              underscore,  other  than an empty pair of delimiters, is treated
              as an error, and the flag itself has no effect.

       The following flags are meaningful with the  ${...#...}  or  ${...%...}
       forms.   The  S,  I,  and  * flags may also be used with the ${.../...}
       forms.

       S      With # or ##, search for the match that starts  closest  to  the
              start  of  the string (a `substring match'). Of all matches at a
              particular position, # selects the shortest and ## the longest:

                     % str="aXbXc"
                     % echo ${(S)str#X*}
                     abXc
                     % echo ${(S)str##X*}
                     a
                     %

              With % or %%, search for the match that starts  closest  to  the
              end of the string:

                     % str="aXbXc"
                     % echo ${(S)str%X*}
                     aXbc
                     % echo ${(S)str%%X*}
                     aXb
                     %

              (Note that % and %% don't search for the match that ends closest
              to the end of the string, as one might expect.)

              With  substitution  via  ${.../...}  or  ${...//...},  specifies
              non-greedy matching, i.e. that the shortest instead of the long-
              est match should be replaced:

                     % str="abab"
                     % echo ${str/*b/_}
                     _
                     % echo ${(S)str/*b/_}
                     _ab
                     %

       I:expr:
              Search the exprth match (where  expr  evaluates  to  a  number).
              This only applies when searching for substrings, either with the
              S flag, or with ${.../...} (only the  exprth  match  is  substi-
              tuted)  or  ${...//...} (all matches from the exprth on are sub-
              stituted).  The default is to take the first match.

              The exprth match is counted such that there  is  either  one  or
              zero matches from each starting position in the string, although
              for global substitution matches  overlapping  previous  replace-
              ments  are  ignored.  With the ${...%...} and ${...%%...} forms,
              the starting position for the match moves backwards from the end
              as the index increases, while with the other forms it moves for-
              ward from the start.

              Hence with the string
                     which switch is the right switch for Ipswich?
              substitutions of the form ${(SI:N:)string#w*ch} as  N  increases
              from  1  will  match  and  remove  `which', `witch', `witch' and
              `wich'; the form using `##' will match and remove `which  switch
              is the right switch for Ipswich', `witch is the right switch for
              Ipswich', `witch for Ipswich' and `wich'.  The  form  using  `%'
              will  remove  the same matches as for `#', but in reverse order,
              and the form using `%%' will remove the same matches as for `##'
              in reverse order.

       *      Enable   EXTENDED_GLOB   for   substitution  via  ${.../...}  or
              ${...//...}.  Note that `**' does not disable extendedglob.

       B      Include the index of the beginning of the match in the result.

       E      Include the index one character past the end of the match in the
              result  (note  this is inconsistent with other uses of parameter
              index).

       M      Include the matched portion in the result.

       N      Include the length of the match in the result.

       R      Include the unmatched portion in the result (the Rest).

   Rules
       Here is a summary of the rules  for  substitution;  this  assumes  that
       braces are present around the substitution, i.e. ${...}.  Some particu-
       lar examples are given below.  Note that the Zsh Development Group  ac-
       cepts no responsibility for any brain damage which may occur during the
       reading of the following rules.

       1. Nested substitution
              If multiple nested ${...} forms  are  present,  substitution  is
              performed  from the inside outwards.  At each level, the substi-
              tution takes account of whether the current value is a scalar or
              an  array,  whether  the whole substitution is in double quotes,
              and what flags are supplied to the current  level  of  substitu-
              tion,  just  as  if  the nested substitution were the outermost.
              The flags are not propagated up to enclosing substitutions;  the
              nested  substitution  will return either a scalar or an array as
              determined by the flags, possibly adjusted for quoting.  All the
              following  steps  take  place  where applicable at all levels of
              substitution.

              Note that, unless the `(P)' flag is present, the flags  and  any
              subscripts  apply  directly to the value of the nested substitu-
              tion; for example, the expansion ${${foo}} behaves  exactly  the
              same as ${foo}.  When the `(P)' flag is present in a nested sub-
              stitution, the other substitution rules are applied to the value
              before  it  is interpreted as a name, so ${${(P)foo}} may differ
              from ${(P)foo}.

              At each nested level of substitution, the substituted words  un-
              dergo  all  forms of single-word substitution (i.e. not filename
              generation), including command substitution,  arithmetic  expan-
              sion  and  filename expansion (i.e. leading ~ and =).  Thus, for
              example, ${${:-=cat}:h} expands to the directory where  the  cat
              program resides.  (Explanation: the internal substitution has no
              parameter but a default value =cat, which is expanded  by  file-
              name  expansion  to a full path; the outer substitution then ap-
              plies the modifier :h and takes the directory part of the path.)

       2. Internal parameter flags
              Any parameter flags set by one of the  typeset  family  of  com-
              mands,  in particular the -L, -R, -Z, -u and -l options for pad-
              ding and capitalization, are applied directly to  the  parameter
              value.  Note these flags are options to the command, e.g. `type-
              set -Z'; they are not the same as the flags used within  parame-
              ter substitutions.

              At the outermost level of substitution, the `(P)' flag (rule 4.)
              ignores these transformations and uses the unmodified  value  of
              the  parameter  as the name to be replaced.  This is usually the
              desired behavior because padding may make  the  value  syntacti-
              cally illegal as a parameter name, but if capitalization changes
              are desired, use the ${${(P)foo}} form (rule 25.).

       3. Parameter subscripting
              If the value is a raw parameter reference with a subscript, such
              as  ${var[3]}, the effect of subscripting is applied directly to
              the parameter.  Subscripts are evaluated left to  right;  subse-
              quent  subscripts  apply to the scalar or array value yielded by
              the previous subscript.  Thus if var is an  array,  ${var[1][2]}
              is the second character of the first word, but ${var[2,4][2]} is
              the entire third word (the second word of the range of words two
              through  four  of the original array).  Any number of subscripts
              may appear.  Flags such as `(k)' and `(v)' which alter  the  re-
              sult of subscripting are applied.

       4. Parameter name replacement
              At  the  outermost  level of nesting only, the `(P)' flag is ap-
              plied.  This treats the value so far as a parameter name  (which
              may  include  a subscript expression) and replaces that with the
              corresponding value.  This replacement occurs later if the `(P)'
              flag appears in a nested substitution.

              If  the  value  so far names a parameter that has internal flags
              (rule 2.), those internal flags are applied to the new value af-
              ter replacement.

       5. Double-quoted joining
              If  the  value after this process is an array, and the substitu-
              tion appears in double quotes, and neither an `(@)' flag  nor  a
              `#'  length operator is present at the current level, then words
              of the value are joined with the first character of the  parame-
              ter $IFS, by default a space, between each word (single word ar-
              rays are not modified).  If the `(j)' flag is present,  that  is
              used for joining instead of $IFS.

       6. Nested subscripting
              Any  remaining  subscripts  (i.e.  of a nested substitution) are
              evaluated at this point, based on whether the value is an  array
              or  a scalar.  As with 3., multiple subscripts can appear.  Note
              that ${foo[2,4][2]} is thus equivalent to ${${foo[2,4]}[2]}  and
              also  to "${${(@)foo[2,4]}[2]}" (the nested substitution returns
              an array in both cases), but  not  to  "${${foo[2,4]}[2]}"  (the
              nested substitution returns a scalar because of the quotes).

       7. Modifiers
              Any  modifiers, as specified by a trailing `#', `%', `/' (possi-
              bly doubled) or by a set of modifiers of the  form  `:...'  (see
              the section `Modifiers' in the section `History Expansion'), are
              applied to the words of the value at this level.

       8. Character evaluation
              Any `(#)' flag is applied, evaluating the result so far  numeri-
              cally as a character.

       9. Length
              Any  initial  `#' modifier, i.e. in the form ${#var}, is used to
              evaluate the length of the expression so far.

       10. Forced joining
              If the `(j)' flag is present, or no `(j)' flag  is  present  but
              the  string is to be split as given by rule 11., and joining did
              not take place at rule 5., any words in the value are joined to-
              gether  using the given string or the first character of $IFS if
              none.  Note that the `(F)' flag implicitly supplies a string for
              joining in this manner.

       11. Simple word splitting
              If one of the `(s)' or `(f)' flags are present, or the `=' spec-
              ifier was present (e.g. ${=var}), the word is  split  on  occur-
              rences  of  the  specified string, or (for = with neither of the
              two flags present) any of the characters in $IFS.

              If no `(s)', `(f)' or `=' was given, but the word is not  quoted
              and the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is set, the word is split on occur-
              rences of any of the characters in $IFS.  Note this  step,  too,
              takes place at all levels of a nested substitution.

       12. Case modification
              Any  case  modification  from  one  of the flags `(L)', `(U)' or
              `(C)' is applied.

       13. Escape sequence replacement
              First any replacements from the `(g)' flag are  performed,  then
              any  prompt-style  formatting  from the `(%)' family of flags is
              applied.

       14. Quote application
              Any quoting or unquoting using `(q)' and `(Q)' and related flags
              is applied.

       15. Directory naming
              Any directory name substitution using `(D)' flag is applied.

       16. Visibility enhancement
              Any  modifications  to  make  characters visible using the `(V)'
              flag are applied.

       17. Lexical word splitting
              If the '(z)' flag or one of the  forms  of  the  '(Z)'  flag  is
              present,  the  word is split as if it were a shell command line,
              so that quotation marks and other metacharacters are used to de-
              cide  what  constitutes  a word.  Note this form of splitting is
              entirely distinct from that described by rule 11.: it  does  not
              use $IFS, and does not cause forced joining.

       18. Uniqueness
              If the result is an array and the `(u)' flag was present, dupli-
              cate elements are removed from the array.

       19. Ordering
              If the result is still an array and one of the  `(o)'  or  `(O)'
              flags was present, the array is reordered.

       20. RC_EXPAND_PARAM
              At  this  point the decision is made whether any resulting array
              elements are to be combined element by element with  surrounding
              text,  as  given by either the RC_EXPAND_PARAM option or the `^'
              flag.

       21. Re-evaluation
              Any `(e)' flag is applied to the value, forcing it to be  re-ex-
              amined for new parameter substitutions, but also for command and
              arithmetic substitutions.

       22. Padding
              Any padding of the value by the `(l.fill.)' or `(r.fill.)' flags
              is applied.

       23. Semantic joining
              In  contexts where expansion semantics requires a single word to
              result, all words are rejoined with the first character  of  IFS
              between.   So  in  `${(P)${(f)lines}}'  the value of ${lines} is
              split at newlines, but then must  be  joined  again  before  the
              `(P)' flag can be applied.

              If a single word is not required, this rule is skipped.

       24. Empty argument removal
              If  the  substitution  does not appear in double quotes, any re-
              sulting zero-length argument, whether from a scalar or  an  ele-
              ment  of an array, is elided from the list of arguments inserted
              into the command line.

              Strictly speaking, the removal happens later as the same happens
              with other forms of substitution; the point to note here is sim-
              ply that it occurs after any of the above parameter operations.

       25. Nested parameter name replacement
              If the `(P)' flag is present and rule 4. has  not  applied,  the
              value so far is treated as a parameter name (which may include a
              subscript expression) and replaced with the corresponding value,
              with internal flags (rule 2.) applied to the new value.

   Examples
       The  flag  f  is  useful  to split a double-quoted substitution line by
       line.  For example, ${(f)"$(<file)"} substitutes the contents  of  file
       divided  so  that each line is an element of the resulting array.  Com-
       pare this with the effect of $(<file) alone, which divides the file  up
       by words, or the same inside double quotes, which makes the entire con-
       tent of the file a single string.

       The following illustrates the rules for  nested  parameter  expansions.
       Suppose that $foo contains the array (bar baz):

       "${(@)${foo}[1]}"
              This  produces  the  result  b.   First,  the inner substitution
              "${foo}", which has no array (@) flag, produces  a  single  word
              result "bar baz".  The outer substitution "${(@)...[1]}" detects
              that this is a scalar, so that (despite the `(@)' flag) the sub-
              script picks the first character.

       "${${(@)foo}[1]}"
              This produces the result `bar'.  In this case, the inner substi-
              tution "${(@)foo}" produces the array `(bar  baz)'.   The  outer
              substitution "${...[1]}" detects that this is an array and picks
              the first word.  This is similar to the simple case "${foo[1]}".

       As an example of the rules for word splitting and joining, suppose $foo
       contains the array `(ax1 bx1)'.  Then

       ${(s/x/)foo}
              produces the words `a', `1 b' and `1'.

       ${(j/x/s/x/)foo}
              produces `a', `1', `b' and `1'.

       ${(s/x/)foo%%1*}
              produces  `a'  and ` b' (note the extra space).  As substitution
              occurs before either joining or splitting, the operation   first
              generates  the  modified  array (ax bx), which is joined to give
              "ax bx", and then split to give `a', ` b'  and  `'.   The  final
              empty string will then be elided, as it is not in double quotes.

COMMAND SUBSTITUTION
       A  command  enclosed  in  parentheses  preceded  by a dollar sign, like
       `$(...)', or quoted with grave accents, like ``...`', is replaced  with
       its  standard  output, with any trailing newlines deleted.  If the sub-
       stitution is not enclosed in double quotes, the output is  broken  into
       words using the IFS parameter.

       The  substitution `$(cat foo)' may be replaced by the faster `$(<foo)'.
       In this case foo undergoes single word shell expansions (parameter  ex-
       pansion,  command substitution and arithmetic expansion), but not file-
       name generation.

       If the option GLOB_SUBST is set, the result  of  any  unquoted  command
       substitution,  including  the  special form just mentioned, is eligible
       for filename generation.

ARITHMETIC EXPANSION
       A string of the form `$[exp]' or `$((exp))'  is  substituted  with  the
       value  of the arithmetic expression exp.  exp is subjected to parameter
       expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion before  it  is
       evaluated.  See the section `Arithmetic Evaluation'.

BRACE EXPANSION
       A  string  of the form `foo{xx,yy,zz}bar' is expanded to the individual
       words `fooxxbar', `fooyybar' and `foozzbar'.   Left-to-right  order  is
       preserved.   This construct may be nested.  Commas may be quoted in or-
       der to include them literally in a word.

       An expression of the form `{n1..n2}', where n1 and n2 are integers,  is
       expanded to every number between n1 and n2 inclusive.  If either number
       begins with a zero, all the resulting numbers will be padded with lead-
       ing  zeroes to that minimum width, but for negative numbers the - char-
       acter is also included in the width.  If the numbers are in  decreasing
       order the resulting sequence will also be in decreasing order.

       An  expression of the form `{n1..n2..n3}', where n1, n2, and n3 are in-
       tegers, is expanded as above, but only every n3th number starting  from
       n1  is output.  If n3 is negative the numbers are output in reverse or-
       der, this is slightly different from simply swapping n1 and n2  in  the
       case  that  the  step n3 doesn't evenly divide the range.  Zero padding
       can be specified in any of the three  numbers,  specifying  it  in  the
       third  can  be  useful to pad for example `{-99..100..01}' which is not
       possible to specify by putting a 0 on either of the first  two  numbers
       (i.e. pad to two characters).

       An  expression of the form `{c1..c2}', where c1 and c2 are single char-
       acters (which may be multibyte characters), is expanded to every  char-
       acter in the range from c1 to c2 in whatever character sequence is used
       internally.  For characters with code points below 128 this is US ASCII
       (this is the only case most users will need).  If any intervening char-
       acter is not printable, appropriate quotation  is  used  to  render  it
       printable.  If the character sequence is reversed, the output is in re-
       verse order, e.g. `{d..a}' is substituted as `d c b a'.

       If a brace expression matches none of the above forms, it is  left  un-
       changed,  unless the option BRACE_CCL (an abbreviation for `brace char-
       acter class') is set.  In that case, it is expanded to a  list  of  the
       individual  characters  between the braces sorted into the order of the
       characters in the ASCII character set  (multibyte  characters  are  not
       currently  handled).   The  syntax  is similar to a [...] expression in
       filename generation: `-' is treated specially  to  denote  a  range  of
       characters,  but `^' or `!' as the first character is treated normally.
       For example, `{abcdef0-9}' expands to 16 words 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 a  b
       c d e f.

       Note  that  brace  expansion  is not part of filename generation (glob-
       bing); an expression such as */{foo,bar} is  split  into  two  separate
       words  */foo and */bar before filename generation takes place.  In par-
       ticular, note that this is liable to produce a `no match' error if  ei-
       ther  of  the  two expressions does not match; this is to be contrasted
       with */(foo|bar), which is treated as a single  pattern  but  otherwise
       has similar effects.

       To  combine brace expansion with array expansion, see the ${^spec} form
       described in the section `Parameter Expansion' above.

FILENAME EXPANSION
       Each word is checked to see if it begins with an unquoted `~'.   If  it
       does,  then the word up to a `/', or the end of the word if there is no
       `/', is checked to see if it can be substituted in one of the ways  de-
       scribed here.  If so, then the `~' and the checked portion are replaced
       with the appropriate substitute value.

       A `~' by itself is replaced by the value of $HOME.  A `~' followed by a
       `+'  or a `-' is replaced by current or previous working directory, re-
       spectively.

       A `~' followed by a number is replaced by the directory at  that  posi-
       tion  in  the directory stack.  `~0' is equivalent to `~+', and `~1' is
       the top of the stack.  `~+' followed by a number is replaced by the di-
       rectory  at  that position in the directory stack.  `~+0' is equivalent
       to `~+', and `~+1' is the top of the stack.  `~-' followed by a  number
       is replaced by the directory that many positions from the bottom of the
       stack.  `~-0' is the bottom of the stack.  The PUSHD_MINUS  option  ex-
       changes  the effects of `~+' and `~-' where they are followed by a num-
       ber.

   Dynamic named directories
       If the  function  zsh_directory_name  exists,  or  the  shell  variable
       zsh_directory_name_functions  exists  and contains an array of function
       names, then the functions are used to implement dynamic directory  nam-
       ing.   The  functions are tried in order until one returns status zero,
       so it is important that functions test whether they can handle the case
       in question and return an appropriate status.

       A  `~'  followed  by  a  string  namstr  in unquoted square brackets is
       treated specially as a dynamic directory name.  Note that the first un-
       quoted  closing  square  bracket  always  terminates namstr.  The shell
       function is passed two arguments: the string n (for name)  and  namstr.
       It  should  either set the array reply to a single element which is the
       directory corresponding to the name and return status  zero  (executing
       an  assignment  as  the  last  statement  is usually sufficient), or it
       should return status non-zero.  In the former case the element of reply
       is used as the directory; in the latter case the substitution is deemed
       to have failed.  If all functions fail and the option NOMATCH  is  set,
       an error results.

       The  functions defined as above are also used to see if a directory can
       be turned into a name, for example when printing the directory stack or
       when expanding %~ in prompts.  In this case each function is passed two
       arguments: the string d (for directory) and the candidate  for  dynamic
       naming.   The function should either return non-zero status, if the di-
       rectory cannot be named by the function, or it should set the array re-
       ply  to  consist of two elements: the first is the dynamic name for the
       directory (as would appear within `~[...]'), and the second is the pre-
       fix  length of the directory to be replaced.  For example, if the trial
       directory is /home/myname/src/zsh and the dynamic  name  for  /home/my-
       name/src (which has 16 characters) is s, then the function sets

              reply=(s 16)

       The  directory  name so returned is compared with possible static names
       for parts of the directory path, as described below; it is used if  the
       prefix  length  matched (16 in the example) is longer than that matched
       by any static name.

       It is not a requirement that a function implements both n and d  calls;
       for  example,  it might be appropriate for certain dynamic forms of ex-
       pansion not to be contracted to names.  In that case any call with  the
       first argument d should cause a non-zero status to be returned.

       The  completion system calls `zsh_directory_name c' followed by equiva-
       lent calls to elements of the array zsh_directory_name_functions, if it
       exists,  in  order to complete dynamic names for directories.  The code
       for this should be as for any other completion function as described in
       zshcompsys(1).

       As a working example, here is a function that expands any dynamic names
       beginning with the string p: to directories  below  /home/pws/perforce.
       In  this  simple  case a static name for the directory would be just as
       effective.

              zsh_directory_name() {
                emulate -L zsh
                setopt extendedglob
                local -a match mbegin mend
                if [[ $1 = d ]]; then
                  # turn the directory into a name
                  if [[ $2 = (#b)(/home/pws/perforce/)([^/]##)* ]]; then
                    typeset -ga reply
                    reply=(p:$match[2] $(( ${#match[1]} + ${#match[2]} )) )
                  else
                    return 1
                  fi
                elif [[ $1 = n ]]; then
                  # turn the name into a directory
                  [[ $2 != (#b)p:(?*) ]] && return 1
                  typeset -ga reply
                  reply=(/home/pws/perforce/$match[1])
                elif [[ $1 = c ]]; then
                  # complete names
                  local expl
                  local -a dirs
                  dirs=(/home/pws/perforce/*(/:t))
                  dirs=(p:${^dirs})
                  _wanted dynamic-dirs expl 'dynamic directory' compadd -S\] -a dirs
                  return
                else
                  return 1
                fi
                return 0
              }

   Static named directories
       A `~' followed by anything not already covered consisting of any number
       of  alphanumeric  characters  or underscore (`_'), hyphen (`-'), or dot
       (`.') is looked up as a named directory, and replaced by the  value  of
       that  named  directory  if found.  Named directories are typically home
       directories for users on the system.  They may also be defined  if  the
       text  after the `~' is the name of a string shell parameter whose value
       begins with a `/'.  Note that trailing slashes will be removed from the
       path to the directory (though the original parameter is not modified).

       It  is  also  possible to define directory names using the -d option to
       the hash builtin.

       When the shell prints a path (e.g. when expanding %~ in prompts or when
       printing  the  directory stack), the path is checked to see if it has a
       named directory as its prefix.  If so, then the prefix portion  is  re-
       placed  with  a `~' followed by the name of the directory.  The shorter
       of the two ways of referring to the directory is used, i.e. either  the
       directory  name or the full path; the name is used if they are the same
       length.  The parameters $PWD and $OLDPWD are never abbreviated in  this
       fashion.

   `=' expansion
       If a word begins with an unquoted `=' and the EQUALS option is set, the
       remainder of the word is taken as the name of a command.  If a  command
       exists  by  that name, the word is replaced by the full pathname of the
       command.

   Notes
       Filename expansion is performed on the right hand side of  a  parameter
       assignment,  including  those  appearing  after commands of the typeset
       family.  In this case, the  right  hand  side  will  be  treated  as  a
       colon-separated list in the manner of the PATH parameter, so that a `~'
       or an `=' following a `:' is eligible for expansion.  All  such  behav-
       iour  can be disabled by quoting the `~', the `=', or the whole expres-
       sion (but not simply the colon); the EQUALS option is also respected.

       If the option MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST is set, any unquoted shell argument  in
       the form `identifier=expression' becomes eligible for file expansion as
       described in the previous paragraph.  Quoting the first  `='  also  in-
       hibits this.

FILENAME GENERATION
       If  a  word contains an unquoted instance of one of the characters `*',
       `(', `|', `<', `[', or `?', it is regarded as a  pattern  for  filename
       generation,  unless the GLOB option is unset.  If the EXTENDED_GLOB op-
       tion is set, the `^' and `#' characters also denote a  pattern;  other-
       wise they are not treated specially by the shell.

       The  word  is  replaced  with a list of sorted filenames that match the
       pattern.  If no matching pattern is found, the  shell  gives  an  error
       message,  unless the NULL_GLOB option is set, in which case the word is
       deleted; or unless the NOMATCH option is unset, in which case the  word
       is left unchanged.

       In  filename  generation, the character `/' must be matched explicitly;
       also, a `.' must be matched explicitly at the beginning of a pattern or
       after  a  `/', unless the GLOB_DOTS option is set.  No filename genera-
       tion pattern matches the files `.' or `..'.  In other instances of pat-
       tern matching, the `/' and `.' are not treated specially.

   Glob Operators
       *      Matches any string, including the null string.

       ?      Matches any character.

       [...]  Matches  any  of  the enclosed characters.  Ranges of characters
              can be specified by separating two characters by a `-'.   A  `-'
              or  `]' may be matched by including it as the first character in
              the list.  There are also several named classes  of  characters,
              in  the  form `[:name:]' with the following meanings.  The first
              set use the macros provided by the operating system to test  for
              the  given  character  combinations, including any modifications
              due to local language settings, see ctype(3):

              [:alnum:]
                     The character is alphanumeric

              [:alpha:]
                     The character is alphabetic

              [:ascii:]
                     The character is 7-bit, i.e. is a  single-byte  character
                     without the top bit set.

              [:blank:]
                     The character is a blank character

              [:cntrl:]
                     The character is a control character

              [:digit:]
                     The character is a decimal digit

              [:graph:]
                     The  character is a printable character other than white-
                     space

              [:lower:]
                     The character is a lowercase letter

              [:print:]
                     The character is printable

              [:punct:]
                     The character is printable but neither  alphanumeric  nor
                     whitespace

              [:space:]
                     The character is whitespace

              [:upper:]
                     The character is an uppercase letter

              [:xdigit:]
                     The character is a hexadecimal digit

              Another  set of named classes is handled internally by the shell
              and is not sensitive to the locale:

              [:IDENT:]
                     The character is allowed to form part of a shell  identi-
                     fier,  such  as  a parameter name; this test respects the
                     POSIX_IDENTIFIERS option

              [:IFS:]
                     The character is used as an input field  separator,  i.e.
                     is contained in the IFS parameter

              [:IFSSPACE:]
                     The  character  is  an IFS white space character; see the
                     documentation for IFS in the zshparam(1) manual page.

              [:INCOMPLETE:]
                     Matches a byte that starts an incomplete multibyte  char-
                     acter.   Note  that  there may be a sequence of more than
                     one bytes that taken together form the prefix of a multi-
                     byte  character.   To  test  for a potentially incomplete
                     byte sequence, use the pattern `[[:INCOMPLETE:]]*'.  This
                     will  never match a sequence starting with a valid multi-
                     byte character.

              [:INVALID:]
                     Matches a byte that does  not  start  a  valid  multibyte
                     character.   Note  this  may be a continuation byte of an
                     incomplete multibyte character as any part of a multibyte
                     string  consisting  of  invalid  and incomplete multibyte
                     characters is treated as single bytes.

              [:WORD:]
                     The character is treated as part of a word; this test  is
                     sensitive to the value of the WORDCHARS parameter

              Note  that the square brackets are additional to those enclosing
              the whole set of characters, so to test for  a  single  alphanu-
              meric  character  you  need `[[:alnum:]]'.  Named character sets
              can be used alongside other types, e.g. `[[:alpha:]0-9]'.

       [^...]
       [!...] Like [...], except that it matches any character which is not in
              the given set.

       <[x]-[y]>
              Matches  any  number  in the range x to y, inclusive.  Either of
              the numbers may be omitted to make the range  open-ended;  hence
              `<->' matches any number.  To match individual digits, the [...]
              form is more efficient.

              Be careful when using other wildcards adjacent  to  patterns  of
              this  form;  for  example, <0-9>* will actually match any number
              whatsoever at the start of the string, since  the  `<0-9>'  will
              match  the first digit, and the `*' will match any others.  This
              is a trap for the unwary, but is in fact  an  inevitable  conse-
              quence  of  the rule that the longest possible match always suc-
              ceeds.  Expressions such as `<0-9>[^[:digit:]]*' can be used in-
              stead.

       (...)  Matches  the  enclosed  pattern.  This is used for grouping.  If
              the KSH_GLOB option is set, then a `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!' im-
              mediately  preceding  the  `(' is treated specially, as detailed
              below. The option SH_GLOB prevents bare parentheses  from  being
              used in this way, though the KSH_GLOB option is still available.

              Note  that  grouping cannot extend over multiple directories: it
              is an error to have a `/' within a group (this only applies  for
              patterns  used in filename generation).  There is one exception:
              a group of the form (pat/)# appearing as a complete path segment
              can match a sequence of directories.  For example, foo/(a*/)#bar
              matches foo/bar, foo/any/bar, foo/any/anyother/bar, and so on.

       x|y    Matches either x or y.  This operator has lower precedence  than
              any  other.   The  `|'  character must be within parentheses, to
              avoid interpretation as a pipeline.  The alternatives are  tried
              in order from left to right.

       ^x     (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches anything except the
              pattern x.  This has a higher precedence than `/', so `^foo/bar'
              will  search  directories in `.' except `./foo' for a file named
              `bar'.

       x~y    (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Match anything that matches
              the  pattern  x but does not match y.  This has lower precedence
              than any operator except `|', so `*/*~foo/bar' will  search  for
              all  files in all directories in `.'  and then exclude `foo/bar'
              if there was such a match.  Multiple patterns can be excluded by
              `foo~bar~baz'.   In  the  exclusion pattern (y), `/' and `.' are
              not treated specially the way they usually are in globbing.

       x#     (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches zero or more occur-
              rences  of  the  pattern  x.  This operator has high precedence;
              `12#' is equivalent to `1(2#)', rather than `(12)#'.  It  is  an
              error  for  an  unquoted `#' to follow something which cannot be
              repeated; this includes an empty string, a pattern already  fol-
              lowed  by  `##',  or parentheses when part of a KSH_GLOB pattern
              (for example, `!(foo)#' is  invalid  and  must  be  replaced  by
              `*(!(foo))').

       x##    (Requires  EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches one or more occur-
              rences of the pattern x.  This  operator  has  high  precedence;
              `12##' is equivalent to `1(2##)', rather than `(12)##'.  No more
              than two active `#' characters may appear together.   (Note  the
              potential  clash with glob qualifiers in the form `1(2##)' which
              should therefore be avoided.)

   ksh-like Glob Operators
       If the KSH_GLOB option is set, the effects of parentheses can be  modi-
       fied by a preceding `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  This character need not
       be unquoted to have special effects, but the `(' must be.

       @(...) Match the pattern in the parentheses.  (Like `(...)'.)

       *(...) Match any number of occurrences.  (Like  `(...)#',  except  that
              recursive directory searching is not supported.)

       +(...) Match at least one occurrence.  (Like `(...)##', except that re-
              cursive directory searching is not supported.)

       ?(...) Match zero or one occurrence.  (Like `(|...)'.)

       !(...) Match  anything  but  the  expression  in  parentheses.    (Like
              `(^(...))'.)

   Precedence
       The precedence of the operators given above is (highest) `^', `/', `~',
       `|' (lowest); the remaining operators are simply treated from  left  to
       right  as  part of a string, with `#' and `##' applying to the shortest
       possible preceding unit (i.e. a character, `?', `[...]', `<...>', or  a
       parenthesised  expression).  As mentioned above, a `/' used as a direc-
       tory separator may not appear inside parentheses, while a `|'  must  do
       so;  in  patterns  used in other contexts than filename generation (for
       example, in case statements and tests within `[[...]]'), a `/'  is  not
       special;  and  `/'  is  also  not special after a `~' appearing outside
       parentheses in a filename pattern.

   Globbing Flags
       There are various flags which affect any text to their right up to  the
       end  of  the enclosing group or to the end of the pattern; they require
       the EXTENDED_GLOB option. All take the form (#X) where X may  have  one
       of the following forms:

       i      Case insensitive:  upper or lower case characters in the pattern
              match upper or lower case characters.

       l      Lower case characters in the pattern match upper or  lower  case
              characters;  upper  case  characters  in  the pattern still only
              match upper case characters.

       I      Case sensitive:  locally negates the effect of i or l from  that
              point on.

       b      Activate backreferences for parenthesised groups in the pattern;
              this does not work in filename generation.  When a pattern  with
              a  set  of active parentheses is matched, the strings matched by
              the groups are stored in the array $match, the  indices  of  the
              beginning  of  the matched parentheses in the array $mbegin, and
              the indices of the end in the array $mend, with the  first  ele-
              ment  of  each  array  corresponding  to the first parenthesised
              group, and so on.  These arrays are not otherwise special to the
              shell.   The  indices  use the same convention as does parameter
              substitution, so that elements of $mend and $mbegin may be  used
              in  subscripts;  the  KSH_ARRAYS  option  is respected.  Sets of
              globbing flags are not considered parenthesised groups; only the
              first nine active parentheses can be referenced.

              For example,

                     foo="a_string_with_a_message"
                     if [[ $foo = (a|an)_(#b)(*) ]]; then
                       print ${foo[$mbegin[1],$mend[1]]}
                     fi

              prints  `string_with_a_message'.   Note  that  the  first set of
              parentheses is before the (#b) and does not create a  backrefer-
              ence.

              Backreferences  work  with  all  forms of pattern matching other
              than filename generation, but note that when performing  matches
              on  an  entire array, such as ${array#pattern}, or a global sub-
              stitution, such as ${param//pat/repl}, only  the  data  for  the
              last  match  remains  available.  In the case of global replace-
              ments this may still be useful.  See the example for the m  flag
              below.

              The  numbering  of  backreferences strictly follows the order of
              the opening parentheses  from  left  to  right  in  the  pattern
              string,  although  sets of parentheses may be nested.  There are
              special rules for parentheses followed by `#' or `##'.  Only the
              last match of the parenthesis is remembered: for example, in `[[
              abab =  (#b)([ab])#  ]]',  only  the  final  `b'  is  stored  in
              match[1].   Thus extra parentheses may be necessary to match the
              complete segment: for example, use  `X((ab|cd)#)Y'  to  match  a
              whole  string  of either `ab' or `cd' between `X' and `Y', using
              the value of $match[1] rather than $match[2].

              If the match fails none of the parameters is altered, so in some
              cases  it  may  be  necessary to initialise them beforehand.  If
              some of the backreferences fail to match  --  which  happens  if
              they are in an alternate branch which fails to match, or if they
              are followed by # and matched zero times  --  then  the  matched
              string is set to the empty string, and the start and end indices
              are set to -1.

              Pattern matching with backreferences  is  slightly  slower  than
              without.

       B      Deactivate  backreferences,  negating  the  effect of the b flag
              from that point on.

       cN,M   The flag (#cN,M) can be used anywhere that the # or ## operators
              can  be  used  except in the expressions `(*/)#' and `(*/)##' in
              filename generation, where `/' has special meaning; it cannot be
              combined  with  other globbing flags and a bad pattern error oc-
              curs if it is misplaced.  It is equivalent to the form {N,M}  in
              regular  expressions.   The  previous  character or group is re-
              quired to match between N and  M  times,  inclusive.   The  form
              (#cN) requires exactly N matches; (#c,M) is equivalent to speci-
              fying N as 0; (#cN,) specifies that there is no maximum limit on
              the number of matches.

       m      Set  references to the match data for the entire string matched;
              this is similar to backreferencing and does not work in filename
              generation.   The  flag must be in effect at the end of the pat-
              tern, i.e. not local to a group. The parameters $MATCH,  $MBEGIN
              and  $MEND  will be set to the string matched and to the indices
              of the beginning and end of the string, respectively.   This  is
              most  useful in parameter substitutions, as otherwise the string
              matched is obvious.

              For example,

                     arr=(veldt jynx grimps waqf zho buck)
                     print ${arr//(#m)[aeiou]/${(U)MATCH}}

              forces all the matches (i.e. all vowels) into uppercase,  print-
              ing `vEldt jynx grImps wAqf zhO bUck'.

              Unlike backreferences, there is no speed penalty for using match
              references, other than the extra substitutions required for  the
              replacement strings in cases such as the example shown.

       M      Deactivate the m flag, hence no references to match data will be
              created.

       anum   Approximate matching: num  errors  are  allowed  in  the  string
              matched by the pattern.  The rules for this are described in the
              next subsection.

       s, e   Unlike the other flags, these have only a local effect, and each
              must  appear  on  its own:  `(#s)' and `(#e)' are the only valid
              forms.  The `(#s)' flag succeeds only at the start of  the  test
              string, and the `(#e)' flag succeeds only at the end of the test
              string; they correspond to `^' and `$' in standard  regular  ex-
              pressions.   They  are useful for matching path segments in pat-
              terns other than those in filename generation (where  path  seg-
              ments  are  in  any  case  treated  separately).   For  example,
              `*((#s)|/)test((#e)|/)*' matches a path segment `test' in any of
              the   following   strings:   test,  test/at/start,  at/end/test,
              in/test/middle.

              Another use is in parameter  substitution;  for  example  `${ar-
              ray/(#s)A*Z(#e)}'  will  remove  only elements of an array which
              match the complete pattern `A*Z'.  There are other ways of  per-
              forming many operations of this type, however the combination of
              the substitution operations `/' and `//'  with  the  `(#s)'  and
              `(#e)' flags provides a single simple and memorable method.

              Note that assertions of the form `(^(#s))' also work, i.e. match
              anywhere except at the start of the string, although this  actu-
              ally  means  `anything except a zero-length portion at the start
              of  the  string';  you  need  to  use  `(""~(#s))'  to  match  a
              zero-length portion of the string not at the start.

       q      A  `q' and everything up to the closing parenthesis of the glob-
              bing flags are ignored by the pattern matching  code.   This  is
              intended  to support the use of glob qualifiers, see below.  The
              result is that the pattern `(#b)(*).c(#q.)' can be used both for
              globbing and for matching against a string.  In the former case,
              the `(#q.)' will be treated as a glob qualifier and  the  `(#b)'
              will  not be useful, while in the latter case the `(#b)' is use-
              ful for backreferences and the `(#q.)' will  be  ignored.   Note
              that colon modifiers in the glob qualifiers are also not applied
              in ordinary pattern matching.

       u      Respect the current locale in determining the presence of multi-
              byte  characters  in  a pattern, provided the shell was compiled
              with MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT.  This overrides  the  MULTIBYTE  option;
              the  default  behaviour  is  taken  from the option.  Compare U.
              (Mnemonic: typically multibyte characters are  from  Unicode  in
              the UTF-8 encoding, although any extension of ASCII supported by
              the system library may be used.)

       U      All characters are considered to be a single byte long.  The op-
              posite of u.  This overrides the MULTIBYTE option.

       For  example,  the  test  string  fooxx  can  be matched by the pattern
       (#i)FOOXX, but not by (#l)FOOXX,  (#i)FOO(#I)XX  or  ((#i)FOOX)X.   The
       string  (#ia2)readme specifies case-insensitive matching of readme with
       up to two errors.

       When using the ksh syntax for grouping both KSH_GLOB and  EXTENDED_GLOB
       must  be  set  and  the left parenthesis should be preceded by @.  Note
       also that the flags do not affect letters inside [...] groups, in other
       words  (#i)[a-z]  still  matches only lowercase letters.  Finally, note
       that when examining whole paths case-insensitively every directory must
       be  searched  for  all files which match, so that a pattern of the form
       (#i)/foo/bar/... is potentially slow.

   Approximate Matching
       When matching approximately, the shell keeps  a  count  of  the  errors
       found,  which  cannot exceed the number specified in the (#anum) flags.
       Four types of error are recognised:

       1.     Different characters, as in fooxbar and fooybar.

       2.     Transposition of characters, as in banana and abnana.

       3.     A character missing in the target string, as  with  the  pattern
              road and target string rod.

       4.     An extra character appearing in the target string, as with stove
              and strove.

       Thus, the pattern (#a3)abcd matches dcba, with the errors occurring  by
       using  the first rule twice and the second once, grouping the string as
       [d][cb][a] and [a][bc][d].

       Non-literal parts of the pattern must match exactly, including  charac-
       ters  in  character  ranges:  hence (#a1)???  matches strings of length
       four, by applying rule 4 to an empty  part  of  the  pattern,  but  not
       strings  of  length  two, since all the ? must match.  Other characters
       which must match exactly are initial  dots  in  filenames  (unless  the
       GLOB_DOTS option is set), and all slashes in filenames, so that a/bc is
       two errors from ab/c (the slash cannot be transposed with another char-
       acter).   Similarly,  errors  are counted separately for non-contiguous
       strings in the pattern, so that (ab|cd)ef is two errors from aebf.

       When using exclusion  via  the  ~  operator,  approximate  matching  is
       treated entirely separately for the excluded part and must be activated
       separately.  Thus, (#a1)README~READ_ME matches READ.ME but not READ_ME,
       as  the  trailing  READ_ME  is matched without approximation.  However,
       (#a1)README~(#a1)READ_ME does not match any pattern of the form READ?ME
       as all such forms are now excluded.

       Apart  from exclusions, there is only one overall error count; however,
       the maximum errors allowed may be altered locally, and this can be  de-
       limited by grouping.  For example, (#a1)cat((#a0)dog)fox allows one er-
       ror in total, which may not occur in the dog section, and  the  pattern
       (#a1)cat(#a0)dog(#a1)fox  is  equivalent.  Note that the point at which
       an error is first found is the crucial one for establishing whether  to
       use   approximation;  for  example,  (#a1)abc(#a0)xyz  will  not  match
       abcdxyz, because the error occurs at the `x',  where  approximation  is
       turned off.

       Entire   path   segments   may   be   matched  approximately,  so  that
       `(#a1)/foo/d/is/available/at/the/bar' allows one error in any path seg-
       ment.   This  is  much  less efficient than without the (#a1), however,
       since every directory in the path must be scanned for  a  possible  ap-
       proximate match.  It is best to place the (#a1) after any path segments
       which are known to be correct.

   Recursive Globbing
       A pathname component of the form `(foo/)#' matches a path consisting of
       zero or more directories matching the pattern foo.

       As  a  shorthand, `**/' is equivalent to `(*/)#'; note that this there-
       fore matches files in the current directory as well as  subdirectories.
       Thus:

              ls -ld -- (*/)#bar

       or

              ls -ld -- **/bar

       does  a  recursive  directory search for files named `bar' (potentially
       including the file `bar' in the current directory).  This form does not
       follow  symbolic links; the alternative form `***/' does, but is other-
       wise identical.  Neither of these can be combined with other  forms  of
       globbing  within the same path segment; in that case, the `*' operators
       revert to their usual effect.

       Even shorter forms are available when  the  option  GLOB_STAR_SHORT  is
       set.   In  that  case  if no / immediately follows a ** or *** they are
       treated as if both a / plus a further * are present.  Hence:

              setopt GLOBSTARSHORT
              ls -ld -- **.c

       is equivalent to

              ls -ld -- **/*.c

   Glob Qualifiers
       Patterns used for filename generation may end in a list  of  qualifiers
       enclosed  in  parentheses.  The qualifiers specify which filenames that
       otherwise match the given pattern will  be  inserted  in  the  argument
       list.

       If the option BARE_GLOB_QUAL is set, then a trailing set of parentheses
       containing no `|' or `(' characters (or `~' if it is special) is  taken
       as  a set of glob qualifiers.  A glob subexpression that would normally
       be taken as glob qualifiers, for example `(^x)', can be  forced  to  be
       treated  as  part  of  the glob pattern by doubling the parentheses, in
       this case producing `((^x))'.

       If the option EXTENDED_GLOB is set, a different syntax for glob  quali-
       fiers  is  available,  namely  `(#qx)'  where x is any of the same glob
       qualifiers used in the other format.  The qualifiers must still  appear
       at  the  end  of  the pattern.  However, with this syntax multiple glob
       qualifiers may be chained together.  They are treated as a logical  AND
       of  the  individual sets of flags.  Also, as the syntax is unambiguous,
       the expression will be treated as glob  qualifiers  just  as  long  any
       parentheses contained within it are balanced; appearance of `|', `(' or
       `~' does not negate the effect.  Note that qualifiers  will  be  recog-
       nised  in  this form even if a bare glob qualifier exists at the end of
       the pattern, for example `*(#q*)(.)' will recognise executable  regular
       files if both options are set; however, mixed syntax should probably be
       avoided for the sake of clarity.  Note that within conditions using the
       `[[' form the presence of a parenthesised expression (#q...) at the end
       of a string indicates that globbing should be performed; the expression
       may include glob qualifiers, but it is also valid if it is simply (#q).
       This does not apply to the right hand side of pattern  match  operators
       as the syntax already has special significance.

       A qualifier may be any one of the following:

       /      directories

       F      `full'  (i.e.  non-empty)  directories.   Note that the opposite
              sense (^F) expands to empty directories and all non-directories.
              Use (/^F) for empty directories.

       .      plain files

       @      symbolic links

       =      sockets

       p      named pipes (FIFOs)

       *      executable plain files (0100 or 0010 or 0001)

       %      device files (character or block special)

       %b     block special files

       %c     character special files

       r      owner-readable files (0400)

       w      owner-writable files (0200)

       x      owner-executable files (0100)

       A      group-readable files (0040)

       I      group-writable files (0020)

       E      group-executable files (0010)

       R      world-readable files (0004)

       W      world-writable files (0002)

       X      world-executable files (0001)

       s      setuid files (04000)

       S      setgid files (02000)

       t      files with the sticky bit (01000)

       fspec  files with access rights matching spec. This spec may be a octal
              number optionally preceded by a `=', a `+', or a `-'. If none of
              these  characters is given, the behavior is the same as for `='.
              The octal number describes the mode bits to be expected, if com-
              bined  with a `=', the value given must match the file-modes ex-
              actly, with a `+', at least the bits in the given number must be
              set  in  the  file-modes, and with a `-', the bits in the number
              must not be set. Giving a `?' instead of a octal digit  anywhere
              in  the  number  ensures  that  the  corresponding  bits  in the
              file-modes are not checked, this is only useful  in  combination
              with `='.

              If the qualifier `f' is followed by any other character anything
              up to the next matching character (`[', `{', and `<' match  `]',
              `}',  and  `>' respectively, any other character matches itself)
              is taken as a list of comma-separated sub-specs.  Each  sub-spec
              may  be  either  an octal number as described above or a list of
              any of the characters `u', `g', `o', and `a', followed by a `=',
              a  `+',  or  a  `-', followed by a list of any of the characters
              `r', `w', `x', `s', and `t', or an octal digit. The  first  list
              of  characters specify which access rights are to be checked. If
              a `u' is given, those for the owner of the file are used,  if  a
              `g'  is  given,  those  of the group are checked, a `o' means to
              test those of other users, and the `a' says to  test  all  three
              groups. The `=', `+', and `-' again says how the modes are to be
              checked and have the same meaning as  described  for  the  first
              form above. The second list of characters finally says which ac-
              cess rights are to be expected: `r' for  read  access,  `w'  for
              write  access,  `x'  for  the  right  to execute the file (or to
              search a directory), `s' for the setuid and setgid bits, and `t'
              for the sticky bit.

              Thus,  `*(f70?)'  gives  the files for which the owner has read,
              write, and execute permission, and for which other group members
              have  no rights, independent of the permissions for other users.
              The pattern `*(f-100)' gives all files for which the owner  does
              not  have  execute  permission,  and `*(f:gu+w,o-rx:)' gives the
              files for which the owner and the other  members  of  the  group
              have  at least write permission, and for which other users don't
              have read or execute permission.

       estring
       +cmd   The string will be executed as shell code.  The filename will be
              included in the list if and only if the code returns a zero sta-
              tus (usually the status of the last command).

              In the first form, the first character after  the  `e'  will  be
              used as a separator and anything up to the next matching separa-
              tor will be taken  as the string; `[', `{', and `<'  match  `]',
              `}',  and  `>',  respectively, while any other character matches
              itself. Note that expansions must be quoted  in  the  string  to
              prevent  them  from  being  expanded  before  globbing  is done.
              string is then executed as shell code.  The string  globqual  is
              appended  to  the  array zsh_eval_context the duration of execu-
              tion.

              During the execution of  string  the  filename  currently  being
              tested is available in the parameter REPLY; the parameter may be
              altered to a string to be inserted into the list instead of  the
              original  filename.  In addition, the parameter reply may be set
              to an array or a string, which overrides the value of REPLY.  If
              set  to  an  array, the latter is inserted into the command line
              word by word.

              For  example,  suppose  a  directory  contains  a  single   file
              `lonely'.   Then  the expression `*(e:'reply=(${REPLY}{1,2})':)'
              will cause the words `lonely1' and `lonely2' to be inserted into
              the command line.  Note the quoting of string.

              The  form  +cmd  has  the  same effect, but no delimiters appear
              around cmd.  Instead, cmd is taken as the  longest  sequence  of
              characters  following the + that are alphanumeric or underscore.
              Typically cmd will be the name of a shell function that contains
              the appropriate test.  For example,

                     nt() { [[ $REPLY -nt $NTREF ]] }
                     NTREF=reffile
                     ls -ld -- *(+nt)

              lists  all  files  in the directory that have been modified more
              recently than reffile.

       ddev   files on the device dev

       l[-|+]ct
              files having a link count less than ct (-), greater than ct (+),
              or equal to ct

       U      files owned by the effective user ID

       G      files owned by the effective group ID

       uid    files  owned  by  user ID id if that is a number.  Otherwise, id
              specifies a user name: the character after the `u' will be taken
              as  a  separator and the string between it and the next matching
              separator will be taken as a user name.  The starting separators
              `[',  `{', and `<' match the final separators `]', `}', and `>',
              respectively; any other character matches itself.  The  selected
              files  are  those  owned by this user.  For example, `u:foo:' or
              `u[foo]' selects files owned by user `foo'.

       gid    like uid but with group IDs or names

       a[Mwhms][-|+]n
              files accessed exactly n days ago.  Files  accessed  within  the
              last  n  days  are  selected  using a negative value for n (-n).
              Files accessed more than n days ago are selected by a positive n
              value  (+n).  Optional unit specifiers `M', `w', `h', `m' or `s'
              (e.g. `ah5') cause the check to be performed with months (of  30
              days), weeks, hours, minutes or seconds instead of days, respec-
              tively.  An explicit `d' for days is also allowed.

              Any fractional part of the difference between  the  access  time
              and  the current part in the appropriate units is ignored in the
              comparison.  For instance, `echo *(ah-5)' would echo  files  ac-
              cessed  within  the  last five hours, while `echo *(ah+5)' would
              echo files accessed at least six hours ago,  as  times  strictly
              between five and six hours are treated as five hours.

       m[Mwhms][-|+]n
              like  the  file  access  qualifier, except that it uses the file
              modification time.

       c[Mwhms][-|+]n
              like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file in-
              ode change time.

       L[+|-]n
              files less than n bytes (-), more than n bytes (+), or exactly n
              bytes in length.

              If this flag is directly followed by a size specifier `k' (`K'),
              `m'  (`M'),  or  `p' (`P') (e.g. `Lk-50') the check is performed
              with kilobytes, megabytes, or blocks  (of  512  bytes)  instead.
              (On  some  systems additional specifiers are available for giga-
              bytes, `g' or `G', and terabytes, `t' or `T'.) If a size  speci-
              fier  is  used  a  file is regarded as "exactly" the size if the
              file size rounded up to the next unit is equal to the test size.
              Hence `*(Lm1)' matches files from 1 byte up to 1 Megabyte inclu-
              sive.  Note also that the set of files "less than" the test size
              only  includes  files  that  would  not match the equality test;
              hence `*(Lm-1)' only matches files of zero size.

       ^      negates all qualifiers following it

       -      toggles between making the qualifiers  work  on  symbolic  links
              (the  default) and the files they point to, if any; any symbolic
              link for whose target the `stat' system call fails (whatever the
              cause of the failure) is treated as a file in its own right

       M      sets the MARK_DIRS option for the current pattern

       T      appends a trailing qualifier mark to the filenames, analogous to
              the LIST_TYPES option, for the current pattern (overrides M)

       N      sets the NULL_GLOB option for the current pattern

       D      sets the GLOB_DOTS option for the current pattern

       n      sets the NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT option for the current pattern

       Yn     enables short-circuit mode: the pattern will expand to at most n
              filenames.   If  more  than  n  matches  exist, only the first n
              matches in directory traversal order will be considered.

              Implies oN when no oc qualifier is used.

       oc     specifies how the names of the files should be sorted. The  fol-
              lowing values of c sort in the following ways:

              n      By name.
              L      By the size (length) of the files.
              l      By number of links.
              a      By time of last access, youngest first.
              m      By time of last modification, youngest first.
              c      By time of last inode change, youngest first.
              d      By  directories:  files  in  subdirectories appear before
                     those in the current  directory  at  each  level  of  the
                     search  -- this is best combined with other criteria, for
                     example `odon' to sort on names for files within the same
                     directory.
              N      No sorting is performed.
              estring
              +cmd   Sort by shell code (see below).

              Note  that  the modifiers ^ and - are used, so `*(^-oL)' gives a
              list of all files sorted by file size in descending order,  fol-
              lowing  any  symbolic  links.  Unless oN is used, multiple order
              specifiers may occur to resolve ties.

              The default sorting is n (by name) unless the Y  glob  qualifier
              is used, in which case it is N (unsorted).

              oe  and  o+  are  special cases; they are each followed by shell
              code, delimited as for the e glob qualifier and the + glob qual-
              ifier  respectively  (see above).  The code is executed for each
              matched file with the parameter REPLY set to  the  name  of  the
              file  on  entry  and globsort appended to zsh_eval_context.  The
              code should modify the parameter REPLY in some fashion.  On  re-
              turn,  the  value  of  the parameter is used instead of the file
              name as the string on which to sort.  Unlike other  sort  opera-
              tors,  oe and o+ may be repeated, but note that the maximum num-
              ber of sort operators of any kind that may appear  in  any  glob
              expression is 12.

       Oc     like  `o',  but  sorts in descending order; i.e. `*(^oc)' is the
              same as `*(Oc)' and `*(^Oc)' is the same as `*(oc)';  `Od'  puts
              files in the current directory before those in subdirectories at
              each level of the search.

       [beg[,end]]
              specifies which of the matched filenames should be  included  in
              the  returned  list.  The  syntax  is the same as for array sub-
              scripts. beg and the optional end may  be  mathematical  expres-
              sions. As in parameter subscripting they may be negative to make
              them count from the last  match  backward.  E.g.:  `*(-OL[1,3])'
              gives a list of the names of the three largest files.

       Pstring
              The  string  will  be prepended to each glob match as a separate
              word.  string is delimited in the same way as arguments to the e
              glob  qualifier described above.  The qualifier can be repeated;
              the words are prepended separately so that the resulting command
              line contains the words in the same order they were given in the
              list of glob qualifiers.

              A typical use for this is to prepend an option before all occur-
              rences  of a file name; for example, the pattern `*(P:-f:)' pro-
              duces the command line arguments `-f file1 -f file2 ...'

              If the modifier ^ is active, then string will  be  appended  in-
              stead  of  prepended.  Prepending and appending is done indepen-
              dently so both can be used on the same glob expression; for  ex-
              ample  by  writing  `*(P:foo:^P:bar:^P:baz:)' which produces the
              command line arguments `foo baz file1 bar ...'

       More than one of these lists can be combined, separated by commas.  The
       whole  list  matches  if at least one of the sublists matches (they are
       `or'ed, the qualifiers in the sublists are `and'ed).  Some  qualifiers,
       however,  affect  all  matches generated, independent of the sublist in
       which they are given.  These are the qualifiers  `M',  `T',  `N',  `D',
       `n', `o', `O' and the subscripts given in brackets (`[...]').

       If  a  `:' appears in a qualifier list, the remainder of the expression
       in parenthesis is interpreted as a modifier  (see  the  section  `Modi-
       fiers'  in the section `History Expansion').  Each modifier must be in-
       troduced by a separate `:'.  Note also that the result after  modifica-
       tion  does  not  have to be an existing file.  The name of any existing
       file can be followed by a modifier of the form `(:...)' even if no  ac-
       tual  filename generation is performed, although note that the presence
       of the parentheses causes the entire expression to be subjected to  any
       global pattern matching options such as NULL_GLOB. Thus:

              ls -ld -- *(-/)

       lists all directories and symbolic links that point to directories, and

              ls -ld -- *(-@)

       lists all broken symbolic links, and

              ls -ld -- *(%W)

       lists all world-writable device files in the current directory, and

              ls -ld -- *(W,X)

       lists  all  files  in  the current directory that are world-writable or
       world-executable, and

              print -rC1 /tmp/foo*(u0^@:t)

       outputs the basename of all root-owned files beginning with the  string
       `foo' in /tmp, ignoring symlinks, and

              ls -ld -- *.*~(lex|parse).[ch](^D^l1)

       lists  all  files  having a link count of one whose names contain a dot
       (but not those starting with  a  dot,  since  GLOB_DOTS  is  explicitly
       switched off) except for lex.c, lex.h, parse.c and parse.h.

              print -rC1 b*.pro(#q:s/pro/shmo/)(#q.:s/builtin/shmiltin/)

       demonstrates  how  colon  modifiers and other qualifiers may be chained
       together.  The ordinary qualifier `.' is applied first, then the  colon
       modifiers  in order from left to right.  So if EXTENDED_GLOB is set and
       the base pattern matches the regular file builtin.pro, the  shell  will
       print `shmiltin.shmo'.

ZSHPARAM(1)                 General Commands Manual                ZSHPARAM(1)

NAME
       zshparam - zsh parameters

DESCRIPTION
       A  parameter  has  a name, a value, and a number of attributes.  A name
       may be any sequence of alphanumeric characters and underscores, or  the
       single  characters  `*',  `@', `#', `?', `-', `$', or `!'.  A parameter
       whose name begins with an alphanumeric or underscore is  also  referred
       to as a variable.

       The  attributes  of  a parameter determine the type of its value, often
       referred to as the parameter type or variable type,  and  also  control
       other  processing  that  may  be applied to the value when it is refer-
       enced.  The value type may be a scalar (a  string,  an  integer,  or  a
       floating  point number), an array (indexed numerically), or an associa-
       tive array (an unordered set of name-value pairs, indexed by name, also
       referred to as a hash).

       Named  scalar  parameters may have the exported, -x, attribute, to copy
       them into the process environment, which is then passed from the  shell
       to  any  new  processes that it starts.  Exported parameters are called
       environment variables. The shell also imports environment variables  at
       startup  time  and  automatically marks the corresponding parameters as
       exported.  Some environment variables are not imported for  reasons  of
       security  or because they would interfere with the correct operation of
       other shell features.

       Parameters may also be special, that  is,  they  have  a  predetermined
       meaning  to  the  shell.   Special  parameters  cannot  have their type
       changed or their readonly attribute turned off, and if a special param-
       eter is unset, then later recreated, the special properties will be re-
       tained.

       To declare the type of a parameter, or to assign a  string  or  numeric
       value to a scalar parameter, use the typeset builtin.

       The value of a scalar parameter may also be assigned by writing:

              name=value

       In  scalar  assignment,  value is expanded as a single string, in which
       the elements of arrays are joined together; filename expansion  is  not
       performed unless the option GLOB_ASSIGN is set.

       When  the  integer  attribute, -i, or a floating point attribute, -E or
       -F, is set for name, the value is  subject  to  arithmetic  evaluation.
       Furthermore, by replacing `=' with `+=', a parameter can be incremented
       or appended to.  See the  section  `Array  Parameters'  and  Arithmetic
       Evaluation (in zshmisc(1)) for additional forms of assignment.

       Note  that assignment may implicitly change the attributes of a parame-
       ter.  For example, assigning a number to a variable in arithmetic eval-
       uation  may  change  its type to integer or float, and with GLOB_ASSIGN
       assigning a pattern to a variable may change its type to an array.

       To reference the value of a parameter, write `$name' or `${name}'.  See
       Parameter  Expansion  in zshexpn(1) for complete details.  That section
       also explains the effect of the difference between scalar and array as-
       signment on parameter expansion.

ARRAY PARAMETERS
       To assign an array value, write one of:

              set -A name value ...
              name=(value ...)
              name=([key]=value ...)

       If  no  parameter  name exists, an ordinary array parameter is created.
       If the parameter name exists and is a scalar, it is replaced by  a  new
       array.

       In  the  third  form,  key  is  an expression that will be evaluated in
       arithmetic context (in its simplest form, an integer)  that  gives  the
       index  of the element to be assigned with value.  In this form any ele-
       ments not explicitly mentioned that come before the  largest  index  to
       which  a  value  is assigned are assigned an empty string.  The indices
       may be in any order.  Note that this syntax is strict: [  and  ]=  must
       not  be  quoted, and key may not consist of the unquoted string ]=, but
       is otherwise treated as a simple string.  The enhanced  forms  of  sub-
       script  expression  that may be used when directly subscripting a vari-
       able name, described in the section `Array Subscripts' below,  are  not
       available.

       The  syntaxes  with  and without the explicit key may be mixed.  An im-
       plicit key is deduced by incrementing the index from the previously as-
       signed  element.  Note that it is not treated as an error if latter as-
       signments in this form overwrite earlier assignments.

       For example, assuming the option KSH_ARRAYS is not set, the following:

              array=(one [3]=three four)

       causes the array variable array to contain four elements one, an  empty
       string, three and four, in that order.

       In the forms where only value is specified, full command line expansion
       is performed.

       In the [key]=value form, both key and value undergo all forms of expan-
       sion  allowed  for  single word shell expansions (this does not include
       filename generation); these are as performed by the parameter expansion
       flag  (e)  as described in zshexpn(1).  Nested parentheses may surround
       value and are included as part of the value, which  is  joined  into  a
       plain  string; this differs from ksh which allows the values themselves
       to be arrays.  A future version of zsh may support that.  To cause  the
       brackets  to  be  interpreted as a character class for filename genera-
       tion, and therefore to treat the resulting list of files as  a  set  of
       values, quote the equal sign using any form of quoting.  Example:

              name=([a-z]'='*)

       To  append to an array without changing the existing values, use one of
       the following:

              name+=(value ...)
              name+=([key]=value ...)

       In the second form key may specify an existing index as well as an  in-
       dex  off the end of the old array; any existing value is overwritten by
       value.  Also, it is possible to use [key]+=value to append to  the  ex-
       isting value at that index.

       Within the parentheses on the right hand side of either form of the as-
       signment, newlines and semicolons are treated the same as white  space,
       separating individual values.  Any consecutive sequence of such charac-
       ters has the same effect.

       Ordinary array parameters may also be explicitly declared with:

              typeset -a name

       Associative arrays must be declared before assignment, by using:

              typeset -A name

       When name refers to an associative array, the list in an assignment  is
       interpreted as alternating keys and values:

              set -A name key value ...
              name=(key value ...)
              name=([key]=value ...)

       Note  that  only one of the two syntaxes above may be used in any given
       assignment; the forms may not be mixed.  This is unlike the case of nu-
       merically indexed arrays.

       Every  key  must  have a value in this case.  Note that this assigns to
       the entire array, deleting any elements that do not appear in the list.
       The append syntax may also be used with an associative array:

              name+=(key value ...)
              name+=([key]=value ...)

       This  adds  a new key/value pair if the key is not already present, and
       replaces the value for the existing key if it is.  In the  second  form
       it is also possible to use [key]+=value to append to the existing value
       at that key.  Expansion is performed identically to  the  corresponding
       forms for normal arrays, as described above.

       To create an empty array (including associative arrays), use one of:

              set -A name
              name=()

   Array Subscripts
       Individual  elements  of an array may be selected using a subscript.  A
       subscript of the form `[exp]' selects the single element exp, where exp
       is  an arithmetic expression which will be subject to arithmetic expan-
       sion as if it were surrounded by `$((...))'.  The elements are numbered
       beginning  with  1,  unless  the KSH_ARRAYS option is set in which case
       they are numbered from zero.

       Subscripts may be used inside braces used to delimit a parameter  name,
       thus  `${foo[2]}' is equivalent to `$foo[2]'.  If the KSH_ARRAYS option
       is set, the braced form is the only one that works,  as  bracketed  ex-
       pressions otherwise are not treated as subscripts.

       If the KSH_ARRAYS option is not set, then by default accesses to an ar-
       ray element with a subscript that evaluates to  zero  return  an  empty
       string,  while an attempt to write such an element is treated as an er-
       ror.  For backward compatibility the KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT option  can  be
       set  to  cause  subscript  values 0 and 1 to be equivalent; see the de-
       scription of the option in zshoptions(1).

       The same subscripting syntax is used  for  associative  arrays,  except
       that  no  arithmetic expansion is applied to exp.  However, the parsing
       rules for arithmetic expressions still apply,  which  affects  the  way
       that  certain special characters must be protected from interpretation.
       See Subscript Parsing below for details.

       A subscript of the form `[*]' or `[@]' evaluates to all elements of  an
       array;  there  is no difference between the two except when they appear
       within double  quotes.   `"$foo[*]"'  evaluates  to  `"$foo[1]  $foo[2]
       ..."', whereas `"$foo[@]"' evaluates to `"$foo[1]" "$foo[2]" ...'.  For
       associative arrays, `[*]' or `[@]' evaluate to all the  values,  in  no
       particular order.  Note that this does not substitute the keys; see the
       documentation for the `k' flag under Parameter Expansion Flags in  zsh-
       expn(1) for complete details.  When an array parameter is referenced as
       `$name' (with no subscript) it  evaluates  to  `$name[*]',  unless  the
       KSH_ARRAYS  option  is  set  in which case it evaluates to `${name[0]}'
       (for an associative array, this means the value of the key  `0',  which
       may not exist even if there are values for other keys).

       A subscript of the form `[exp1,exp2]' selects all elements in the range
       exp1 to exp2, inclusive. (Associative arrays are unordered, and  so  do
       not  support  ranges.) If one of the subscripts evaluates to a negative
       number, say -n, then the nth element from the end of the array is used.
       Thus `$foo[-3]' is the third element from the end of the array foo, and
       `$foo[1,-1]' is the same as `$foo[*]'.

       Subscripting may also be performed on non-array values, in  which  case
       the  subscripts  specify  a substring to be extracted.  For example, if
       FOO is set to `foobar', then `echo $FOO[2,5]' prints `ooba'.  Note that
       some  forms  of  subscripting described below perform pattern matching,
       and in that case the substring extends from the start of the  match  of
       the  first  subscript  to the end of the match of the second subscript.
       For example,

              string="abcdefghijklm"
              print ${string[(r)d?,(r)h?]}

       prints `defghi'.  This is an obvious generalisation  of  the  rule  for
       single-character  matches.  For a single subscript, only a single char-
       acter is referenced (not the range of characters covered by the match).

       Note that in substring operations the second subscript is handled  dif-
       ferently  by the r and R subscript flags: the former takes the shortest
       match as the length and the latter the longest  match.   Hence  in  the
       former  case  a  *  at the end is redundant while in the latter case it
       matches the whole remainder of the string.  This does  not  affect  the
       result  of the single subscript case as here the length of the match is
       irrelevant.

   Array Element Assignment
       A subscript may be used on the left side of an assignment like so:

              name[exp]=value

       In this form of assignment the element or range specified by exp is re-
       placed by the expression on the right side.  An array (but not an asso-
       ciative array) may be created by assignment to a range or element.  Ar-
       rays do not nest, so assigning a parenthesized list of values to an el-
       ement or range changes the number of elements in  the  array,  shifting
       the  other  elements  to accommodate the new values.  (This is not sup-
       ported for associative arrays.)

       This syntax also works as an argument to the typeset command:

              typeset "name[exp]"=value

       The value may not be a parenthesized list in this case; only single-el-
       ement  assignments may be made with typeset.  Note that quotes are nec-
       essary in this case to prevent the brackets from being  interpreted  as
       filename generation operators.  The noglob precommand modifier could be
       used instead.

       To delete an element of an ordinary array, assign `()' to that element.
       To delete an element of an associative array, use the unset command:

              unset "name[exp]"

   Subscript Flags
       If  the  opening bracket, or the comma in a range, in any subscript ex-
       pression is directly followed by an opening parenthesis, the string  up
       to  the matching closing one is considered to be a list of flags, as in
       `name[(flags)exp]'.

       The flags s, n and b take an argument; the delimiter is shown below  as
       `:',  but  any  character,  or  the  matching  pairs  `(...)', `{...}',
       `[...]', or `<...>', may be used, but note that  `<...>'  can  only  be
       used if the subscript is inside a double quoted expression or a parame-
       ter substitution enclosed in braces as otherwise the expression is  in-
       terpreted as a redirection.

       The flags currently understood are:

       w      If  the  parameter  subscripted is a scalar then this flag makes
              subscripting work on words instead of characters.   The  default
              word  separator  is  whitespace.   When combined with the i or I
              flag, the effect is to produce the index of the first  character
              of  the  first/last  word  which matches the given pattern; note
              that a failed match in this case always yields 0.

       s:string:
              This gives the string that separates words (for use with  the  w
              flag).  The delimiter character : is arbitrary; see above.

       p      Recognize  the same escape sequences as the print builtin in the
              string argument of a subsequent `s' flag.

       f      If the parameter subscripted is a scalar then  this  flag  makes
              subscripting work on lines instead of characters, i.e. with ele-
              ments separated by newlines.  This is a shorthand for `pws:\n:'.

       r      Reverse subscripting: if this flag is given, the exp is taken as
              a  pattern  and  the result is the first matching array element,
              substring or word (if the parameter is an  array,  if  it  is  a
              scalar,  or if it is a scalar and the `w' flag is given, respec-
              tively).  The subscript used is the number of the matching  ele-
              ment,  so  that  pairs of subscripts such as `$foo[(r)??,3]' and
              `$foo[(r)??,(r)f*]' are possible if the parameter is not an  as-
              sociative array.  If the parameter is an associative array, only
              the value part of each pair is compared to the pattern, and  the
              result is that value.

              If  a  search  through an ordinary array failed, the search sets
              the subscript to one past the end of the array, and hence  ${ar-
              ray[(r)pattern]}  will  substitute  the  empty string.  Thus the
              success of a search can be tested by using the (i) flag, for ex-
              ample (assuming the option KSH_ARRAYS is not in effect):

                     [[ ${array[(i)pattern]} -le ${#array} ]]

              If KSH_ARRAYS is in effect, the -le should be replaced by -lt.

       R      Like  `r',  but  gives  the last match.  For associative arrays,
              gives all possible matches. May be used for assigning  to  ordi-
              nary  array  elements,  but not for assigning to associative ar-
              rays.  On failure, for normal arrays this has the effect of  re-
              turning  the element corresponding to subscript 0; this is empty
              unless one of the options KSH_ARRAYS or KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT is in
              effect.

              Note that in subscripts with both `r' and `R' pattern characters
              are active even if they were substituted for  a  parameter  (re-
              gardless  of  the setting of GLOB_SUBST which controls this fea-
              ture in normal pattern matching).  The flag `e' can be added  to
              inhibit  pattern  matching.  As this flag does not inhibit other
              forms of substitution, care is still required; using a parameter
              to hold the key has the desired effect:

                     key2='original key'
                     print ${array[(Re)$key2]}

       i      Like `r', but gives the index of the match instead; this may not
              be combined with a second argument.  On the left side of an  as-
              signment,  behaves  like  `r'.   For associative arrays, the key
              part of each pair is compared to  the  pattern,  and  the  first
              matching  key  found  is the result.  On failure substitutes the
              length of the array plus one, as discussed under the description
              of `r', or the empty string for an associative array.

              Note:  Although  `i'  may be applied to a scalar substitution to
              find the offset of a substring, the results  are  likely  to  be
              misleading  when  searching  within  substitutions that yield an
              empty string, or when searching for the empty substring.

       I      Like `i', but gives the index of the last match, or all possible
              matching  keys  in an associative array.  On failure substitutes
              0, or the empty string for an associative array.  This  flag  is
              best when testing for values or keys that do not exist.

              Note:  If  the  option  KSH_ARRAYS  is in effect and no match is
              found, the result is indistinguishable from the  case  when  the
              first element of the array matches.

       k      If used in a subscript on an associative array, this flag causes
              the keys to be interpreted as patterns, and  returns  the  value
              for  the  first key found where exp is matched by the key.  Note
              this could be any such key as no ordering of associative  arrays
              is  defined.  This flag does not work on the left side of an as-
              signment to an associative array element.  If  used  on  another
              type of parameter, this behaves like `r'.

       K      On  an associative array this is like `k' but returns all values
              where exp is matched by the keys.  On other types of  parameters
              this has the same effect as `R'.

       n:expr:
              If  combined  with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them give the nth
              or nth last match (if expr evaluates to n).  This  flag  is  ig-
              nored  when the array is associative.  The delimiter character :
              is arbitrary; see above.

       b:expr:
              If combined with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them begin  at  the
              nth  or  nth last element, word, or character (if expr evaluates
              to n).  This flag is ignored when the array is associative.  The
              delimiter character : is arbitrary; see above.

       e      This flag causes any pattern matching that would be performed on
              the subscript to  use  plain  string  matching  instead.   Hence
              `${array[(re)*]}'  matches only the array element whose value is
              *.  Note that other forms of substitution such as parameter sub-
              stitution are not inhibited.

              This  flag can also be used to force * or @ to be interpreted as
              a single key rather than as a reference to all values.   It  may
              be used for either purpose on the left side of an assignment.

       See  Parameter  Expansion Flags (zshexpn(1)) for additional ways to ma-
       nipulate the results of array subscripting.

   Subscript Parsing
       This discussion applies mainly to associative array key strings and  to
       patterns used for reverse subscripting (the `r', `R', `i', etc. flags),
       but it may also affect parameter substitutions that appear as  part  of
       an arithmetic expression in an ordinary subscript.

       To  avoid  subscript  parsing limitations in assignments to associative
       array elements, use the append syntax:

              aa+=('key with "*strange*" characters' 'value string')

       The basic rule to remember when writing a subscript expression is  that
       all  text between the opening `[' and the closing `]' is interpreted as
       if it were in double quotes (see zshmisc(1)).  However,  unlike  double
       quotes which normally cannot nest, subscript expressions may appear in-
       side double-quoted strings or inside other  subscript  expressions  (or
       both!), so the rules have two important differences.

       The first difference is that brackets (`[' and `]') must appear as bal-
       anced pairs in a subscript expression unless they  are  preceded  by  a
       backslash  (`\').  Therefore, within a subscript expression (and unlike
       true double-quoting) the sequence `\[' becomes `[', and similarly  `\]'
       becomes  `]'.  This applies even in cases where a backslash is not nor-
       mally required; for example, the pattern `[^[]' (to match any character
       other than an open bracket) should be written `[^\[]' in a reverse-sub-
       script pattern.  However, note that `\[^\[\]' and even `\[^[]' mean the
       same  thing,  because  backslashes are always stripped when they appear
       before brackets!

       The same rule applies to parentheses (`(' and `)') and braces (`{'  and
       `}'):  they must appear either in balanced pairs or preceded by a back-
       slash, and backslashes that protect parentheses or braces  are  removed
       during parsing.  This is because parameter expansions may be surrounded
       by balanced braces, and subscript  flags  are  introduced  by  balanced
       parentheses.

       The  second  difference is that a double-quote (`"') may appear as part
       of a subscript expression without being preceded by  a  backslash,  and
       therefore  that the two characters `\"' remain as two characters in the
       subscript (in true double-quoting, `\"' becomes `"').  However, because
       of the standard shell quoting rules, any double-quotes that appear must
       occur in balanced pairs unless preceded by a backslash.  This makes  it
       more  difficult  to  write  a subscript expression that contains an odd
       number of double-quote characters, but the reason for  this  difference
       is  so  that  when  a  subscript  expression  appears  inside true dou-
       ble-quotes, one can still write `\"' (rather than `\\\"') for `"'.

       To use an odd number of double quotes as a key in  an  assignment,  use
       the typeset builtin and an enclosing pair of double quotes; to refer to
       the value of that key, again use double quotes:

              typeset -A aa
              typeset "aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"=QQQ
              print "$aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"

       It is important to note that the quoting rules do not change when a pa-
       rameter  expansion  with a subscript is nested inside another subscript
       expression.  That is, it is not necessary to use additional backslashes
       within the inner subscript expression; they are removed only once, from
       the innermost subscript outwards.  Parameters are  also  expanded  from
       the innermost subscript first, as each expansion is encountered left to
       right in the outer expression.

       A further complication arises from a way in which subscript parsing  is
       not  different  from  double quote parsing.  As in true double-quoting,
       the sequences `\*', and `\@' remain as two characters when they  appear
       in  a subscript expression.  To use a literal `*' or `@' as an associa-
       tive array key, the `e' flag must be used:

              typeset -A aa
              aa[(e)*]=star
              print $aa[(e)*]

       A last detail must be considered  when  reverse  subscripting  is  per-
       formed.  Parameters appearing in the subscript expression are first ex-
       panded and then the complete expression is interpreted  as  a  pattern.
       This has two effects: first, parameters behave as if GLOB_SUBST were on
       (and it cannot be turned  off);  second,  backslashes  are  interpreted
       twice, once when parsing the array subscript and again when parsing the
       pattern.  In a reverse subscript, it's  necessary  to  use  four  back-
       slashes  to cause a single backslash to match literally in the pattern.
       For complex patterns, it is often easiest to assign the desired pattern
       to  a  parameter and then refer to that parameter in the subscript, be-
       cause then the backslashes, brackets, parentheses, etc., are seen  only
       when  the  complete expression is converted to a pattern.  To match the
       value of a parameter literally in a reverse subscript, rather than as a
       pattern, use `${(q)name}' (see zshexpn(1)) to quote the expanded value.

       Note  that  the `k' and `K' flags are reverse subscripting for an ordi-
       nary array, but are not reverse subscripting for an associative  array!
       (For an associative array, the keys in the array itself are interpreted
       as patterns by those flags; the subscript is a  plain  string  in  that
       case.)

       One final note, not directly related to subscripting: the numeric names
       of positional parameters (described below) are parsed specially, so for
       example  `$2foo'  is  equivalent  to `${2}foo'.  Therefore, to use sub-
       script syntax to extract a substring from a positional  parameter,  the
       expansion must be surrounded by braces; for example, `${2[3,5]}' evalu-
       ates to the third through fifth characters of the second positional pa-
       rameter, but `$2[3,5]' is the entire second parameter concatenated with
       the filename generation pattern `[3,5]'.

POSITIONAL PARAMETERS
       The positional parameters provide access to the command-line  arguments
       of a shell function, shell script, or the shell itself; see the section
       `Invocation', and also the section `Functions'.  The parameter n, where
       n  is a number, is the nth positional parameter.  The parameter `$0' is
       a special case, see the section `Parameters Set By The Shell'.

       The parameters *, @ and argv are arrays containing all  the  positional
       parameters;  thus `$argv[n]', etc., is equivalent to simply `$n'.  Note
       that the options KSH_ARRAYS or KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT apply to these arrays
       as  well,  so with either of those options set, `${argv[0]}' is equiva-
       lent to `$1' and so on.

       Positional parameters may be changed after the shell or function starts
       by  using the set builtin, by assigning to the argv array, or by direct
       assignment of the form `n=value' where n is the  number  of  the  posi-
       tional  parameter to be changed.  This also creates (with empty values)
       any of the positions from 1 to n that do not already have values.  Note
       that, because the positional parameters form an array, an array assign-
       ment of the form `n=(value ...)' is allowed,  and  has  the  effect  of
       shifting  all  the  values at positions greater than n by as many posi-
       tions as necessary to accommodate the new values.

LOCAL PARAMETERS
       Shell function executions delimit scopes for shell parameters.  (Param-
       eters  are  dynamically scoped.)  The typeset builtin, and its alterna-
       tive forms declare, integer, local and readonly (but not  export),  can
       be used to declare a parameter as being local to the innermost scope.

       When a parameter is read or assigned to, the innermost existing parame-
       ter of that name is used.  (That is,  the  local  parameter  hides  any
       less-local parameter.)  However, assigning to a non-existent parameter,
       or declaring a new parameter with export, causes it to  be  created  in
       the outermost scope.

       Local parameters disappear when their scope ends.  unset can be used to
       delete a parameter while it is still in scope; any outer  parameter  of
       the same name remains hidden.

       Special  parameters  may  also be made local; they retain their special
       attributes unless either the existing or  the  newly-created  parameter
       has  the  -h (hide) attribute.  This may have unexpected effects: there
       is no default value, so if there is no  assignment  at  the  point  the
       variable  is  made  local, it will be set to an empty value (or zero in
       the case of integers).  The following:

              typeset PATH=/new/directory:$PATH

       is valid for temporarily allowing the shell or programmes  called  from
       it to find the programs in /new/directory inside a function.

       Note  that  the restriction in older versions of zsh that local parame-
       ters were never exported has been removed.

PARAMETERS SET BY THE SHELL
       In the parameter lists that follow, the mark `<S>' indicates  that  the
       parameter  is special.  `<Z>' indicates that the parameter does not ex-
       ist when the shell initializes in sh or ksh emulation mode.

       The parameters `!', `#', `*', `-', `?', `@',  `$',  `ARGC',  `HISTCMD',
       `LINENO',     `PPID',    `status',    `TTYIDLE',    `zsh_eval_context',
       `ZSH_EVAL_CONTEXT', and `ZSH_SUBSHELL' are read-only and thus cannot be
       restored  by  the  user,  so they are not output by `typeset -p'.  This
       also applies to many read-only parameters loaded from modules.

       The following parameters are automatically set by the shell:

       ! <S>  The process ID of the last command  started  in  the  background
              with  &, put into the background with the bg builtin, or spawned
              with coproc.

       # <S>  The number of positional parameters in decimal.  Note that  some
              confusion  may  occur  with the syntax $#param which substitutes
              the length of param.  Use ${#} to resolve ambiguities.  In  par-
              ticular,  the  sequence  `$#-...' in an arithmetic expression is
              interpreted as the length of the parameter -, q.v.

       ARGC <S> <Z>
              Same as #.

       $ <S>  The process ID of this shell, set when  the  shell  initializes.
              Processes forked from the shell without executing a new program,
              such as command substitutions and commands grouped  with  (...),
              are subshells that duplicate the current shell, and thus substi-
              tute the same value for $$ as their parent shell.

       - <S>  Flags supplied to the shell on invocation or by the set  or  se-
              topt commands.

       * <S>  An array containing the positional parameters.

       argv <S> <Z>
              Same  as  *.  Assigning to argv changes the local positional pa-
              rameters, but argv is not itself a  local  parameter.   Deleting
              argv  with unset in any function deletes it everywhere, although
              only the innermost positional parameter array is deleted  (so  *
              and @ in other scopes are not affected).

       @ <S>  Same as argv[@], even when argv is not set.

       ? <S>  The exit status returned by the last command.

       0 <S>  The  name  used to invoke the current shell, or as set by the -c
              command line option upon invocation.   If  the  FUNCTION_ARGZERO
              option  is  set, $0 is set upon entry to a shell function to the
              name of the function, and upon entry to a sourced script to  the
              name  of  the  script,  and reset to its previous value when the
              function or script returns.

       status <S> <Z>
              Same as ?.

       pipestatus <S> <Z>
              An array containing the exit statuses returned by  all  commands
              in the last pipeline.

       _ <S>  The last argument of the previous command.  Also, this parameter
              is set in the environment of every command executed to the  full
              pathname of the command.

       CPUTYPE
              The machine type (microprocessor class or machine model), as de-
              termined at run time.

       EGID <S>
              The effective group ID of the shell process.  If you have suffi-
              cient  privileges,  you may change the effective group ID of the
              shell process by assigning to this  parameter.   Also  (assuming
              sufficient  privileges),  you  may start a single command with a
              different effective group ID by `(EGID=gid; command)'

              If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
              explicitly set locally.

       EUID <S>
              The  effective user ID of the shell process.  If you have suffi-
              cient privileges, you may change the effective user  ID  of  the
              shell  process  by  assigning to this parameter.  Also (assuming
              sufficient privileges), you may start a single  command  with  a
              different effective user ID by `(EUID=uid; command)'

              If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
              explicitly set locally.

       ERRNO <S>
              The value of errno (see errno(3)) as set by  the  most  recently
              failed  system  call.  This value is system dependent and is in-
              tended for debugging purposes.   It  is  also  useful  with  the
              zsh/system  module  which  allows the number to be turned into a
              name or message.

              To use this parameter, it must first be assigned a value  (typi-
              cally  0  (zero)).  It is initially unset for scripting compati-
              bility.

       FUNCNEST <S>
              Integer.  If greater than or equal to zero, the maximum  nesting
              depth  of  shell  functions.   When  it is exceeded, an error is
              raised at the point where a function  is  called.   The  default
              value  is  determined when the shell is configured, but is typi-
              cally 500.  Increasing the value increases the danger of a  run-
              away  function  recursion causing the shell to crash.  Setting a
              negative value turns off the check.

       GID <S>
              The real group ID of the shell process.  If you have  sufficient
              privileges,  you may change the group ID of the shell process by
              assigning to this parameter.  Also (assuming  sufficient  privi-
              leges),  you  may start a single command under a different group
              ID by `(GID=gid; command)'

              If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
              explicitly set locally.

       HISTCMD
              The  current  history  event  number in an interactive shell, in
              other words  the  event  number  for  the  command  that  caused
              $HISTCMD  to be read.  If the current history event modifies the
              history, HISTCMD changes to the new maximum history  event  num-
              ber.

       HOST   The current hostname.

       LINENO <S>
              The  line  number of the current line within the current script,
              sourced file, or shell function being  executed,  whichever  was
              started most recently.  Note that in the case of shell functions
              the line number refers to the function as  it  appeared  in  the
              original  definition,  not necessarily as displayed by the func-
              tions builtin.

       LOGNAME
              If the corresponding variable is not set in the  environment  of
              the  shell, it is initialized to the login name corresponding to
              the current login session. This parameter is exported by default
              but  this  can be disabled using the typeset builtin.  The value
              is set to the string returned by the getlogin(3) system call  if
              that is available.

       MACHTYPE
              The machine type (microprocessor class or machine model), as de-
              termined at compile time.

       OLDPWD The previous working directory.  This is set when the shell ini-
              tializes and whenever the directory changes.

       OPTARG <S>
              The  value  of the last option argument processed by the getopts
              command.

       OPTIND <S>
              The index of the last option argument processed by  the  getopts
              command.

       OSTYPE The operating system, as determined at compile time.

       PPID <S>
              The  process  ID  of the parent of the shell, set when the shell
              initializes.  As with $$, the value does not change in subshells
              created as a duplicate of the current shell.

       PWD    The  present working directory.  This is set when the shell ini-
              tializes and whenever the directory changes.

       RANDOM <S>
              A pseudo-random integer from 0 to 32767,  newly  generated  each
              time  this parameter is referenced.  The random number generator
              can be seeded by assigning a numeric value to RANDOM.

              The  values   of   RANDOM   form   an   intentionally-repeatable
              pseudo-random sequence; subshells that reference RANDOM will re-
              sult in identical pseudo-random values unless the value of  RAN-
              DOM  is referenced or seeded in the parent shell in between sub-
              shell invocations.

       SECONDS <S>
              The number of seconds since shell invocation.  If this parameter
              is assigned a value, then the value returned upon reference will
              be the value that was assigned plus the number of seconds  since
              the assignment.

              Unlike other special parameters, the type of the SECONDS parame-
              ter can be changed using the typeset command.  The type  may  be
              changed only to one of the floating point types or back to inte-
              ger.  For example, `typeset -F SECONDS' causes the value  to  be
              reported  as a floating point number.  The value is available to
              microsecond accuracy, although the shell may show more or  fewer
              digits  depending  on the use of typeset.  See the documentation
              for the builtin typeset in zshbuiltins(1) for more details.

       SHLVL <S>
              Incremented by one each time a new shell is started.

       signals
              An array containing the names of the signals.   Note  that  with
              the standard zsh numbering of array indices, where the first el-
              ement has index 1, the signals are offset by 1 from  the  signal
              number  used  by  the operating system.  For example, on typical
              Unix-like systems HUP is signal number 1, but is referred to  as
              $signals[2].   This  is because of EXIT at position 1 in the ar-
              ray, which is used internally by zsh but is not known to the op-
              erating system.

       TRY_BLOCK_ERROR <S>
              In an always block, indicates whether the preceding list of code
              caused an error.  The value is 1 to indicate an error, 0  other-
              wise.   It may be reset, clearing the error condition.  See Com-
              plex Commands in zshmisc(1)

       TRY_BLOCK_INTERRUPT <S>
              This variable works in a similar  way  to  TRY_BLOCK_ERROR,  but
              represents  the  status  of an interrupt from the signal SIGINT,
              which typically comes from the keyboard when the user types  ^C.
              If  set  to  0, any such interrupt will be reset; otherwise, the
              interrupt is propagated after the always block.

              Note that it is possible that an interrupt  arrives  during  the
              execution  of  the  always  block; this interrupt is also propa-
              gated.

       TTY    The name of the tty associated with the shell, if any.

       TTYIDLE <S>
              The idle time of the tty associated with the shell in seconds or
              -1 if there is no such tty.

       UID <S>
              The  real  user ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient
              privileges, you may change the user ID of the shell by assigning
              to  this  parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you
              may start  a  single  command  under  a  different  user  ID  by
              `(UID=uid; command)'

              If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
              explicitly set locally.

       USERNAME <S>
              The username corresponding to the real  user  ID  of  the  shell
              process.   If you have sufficient privileges, you may change the
              username (and also the user ID and group ID) of the shell by as-
              signing  to  this  parameter.   Also (assuming sufficient privi-
              leges), you may start a single command under a  different  user-
              name  (and  user  ID  and group ID) by `(USERNAME=username; com-
              mand)'

       VENDOR The vendor, as determined at compile time.

       zsh_eval_context <S> <Z> (ZSH_EVAL_CONTEXT <S>)
              An array (colon-separated list) indicating the context of  shell
              code that is being run.  Each time a piece of shell code that is
              stored within the shell is executed a string is temporarily  ap-
              pended  to  the  array to indicate the type of operation that is
              being performed.  Read in order the array gives an indication of
              the  stack of operations being performed with the most immediate
              context last.

              Note that the variable does not give  information  on  syntactic
              context  such  as  pipelines or subshells.  Use $ZSH_SUBSHELL to
              detect subshells.

              The context is one of the following:
              cmdarg Code specified by the -c option to the command line  that
                     invoked the shell.

              cmdsubst
                     Command substitution using the `...` or $(...) construct.

              equalsubst
                     File substitution using the =(...) construct.

              eval   Code executed by the eval builtin.

              evalautofunc
                     Code executed with the KSH_AUTOLOAD mechanism in order to
                     define an autoloaded function.

              fc     Code from the shell history executed by the -e option  to
                     the fc builtin.

              file   Lines  of code being read directly from a file, for exam-
                     ple by the source builtin.

              filecode
                     Lines of code being read from a .zwc file instead of  di-
                     rectly from the source file.

              globqual
                     Code executed by the e or + glob qualifier.

              globsort
                     Code executed to order files by the o glob qualifier.

              insubst
                     File substitution using the <(...) construct.

              loadautofunc
                     Code  read  directly  from a file to define an autoloaded
                     function.

              outsubst
                     File substitution using the >(...) construct.

              sched  Code executed by the sched builtin.

              shfunc A shell function.

              stty   Code passed to stty by  the  STTY  environment  variable.
                     Normally  this  is  passed  directly to the system's stty
                     command, so this value is unlikely to be  seen  in  prac-
                     tice.

              style  Code  executed as part of a style retrieved by the zstyle
                     builtin from the zsh/zutil module.

              toplevel
                     The highest execution level of a  script  or  interactive
                     shell.

              trap   Code  executed  as  a  trap  defined by the trap builtin.
                     Traps defined as functions have the context  shfunc.   As
                     traps  are asynchronous they may have a different hierar-
                     chy from other code.

              zpty   Code executed by the zpty builtin from the zsh/zpty  mod-
                     ule.

              zregexparse-guard
                     Code  executed as a guard by the zregexparse command from
                     the zsh/zutil module.

              zregexparse-action
                     Code executed as an action  by  the  zregexparse  command
                     from the zsh/zutil module.

       ZSH_ARGZERO
              If  zsh  was  invoked  to  run a script, this is the name of the
              script.  Otherwise, it is the name used to  invoke  the  current
              shell.    This  is  the  same  as  the  value  of  $0  when  the
              POSIX_ARGZERO option is set, but is always available.

       ZSH_EXECUTION_STRING
              If the shell was started with the option -c, this  contains  the
              argument passed to the option.  Otherwise it is not set.

       ZSH_NAME
              Expands  to  the basename of the command used to invoke this in-
              stance of zsh.

       ZSH_PATCHLEVEL
              The output of `git describe --tags --long' for the  zsh  reposi-
              tory  used  to build the shell.  This is most useful in order to
              keep track of versions of the shell during  development  between
              releases;  hence most users should not use it and should instead
              rely on $ZSH_VERSION.

       zsh_scheduled_events
              See the section `The zsh/sched Module' in zshmodules(1).

       ZSH_SCRIPT
              If zsh was invoked to run a script, this  is  the  name  of  the
              script, otherwise it is unset.

       ZSH_SUBSHELL
              Readonly  integer.   Initially  zero,  incremented each time the
              shell forks to create a  subshell  for  executing  code.   Hence
              `(print  $ZSH_SUBSHELL)' and `print $(print $ZSH_SUBSHELL)' out-
              put 1, while `( (print $ZSH_SUBSHELL) )' outputs 2.

       ZSH_VERSION
              The version number of the release of zsh.

PARAMETERS USED BY THE SHELL
       The following parameters are used by the shell.  Again, `<S>' indicates
       that  the  parameter  is special and `<Z>' indicates that the parameter
       does not exist when the shell initializes in sh or ksh emulation mode.

       In cases where there are two parameters with an  upper-  and  lowercase
       form  of the same name, such as path and PATH, the lowercase form is an
       array and the uppercase form is a scalar with the elements of the array
       joined  together  by colons.  These are similar to tied parameters cre-
       ated via `typeset -T'.  The normal use for the colon-separated form  is
       for exporting to the environment, while the array form is easier to ma-
       nipulate within the shell.  Note that unsetting either of the pair will
       unset  the  other; they retain their special properties when recreated,
       and recreating one of the pair will recreate the other.

       ARGV0  If exported, its value is used as the argv[0] of  external  com-
              mands.  Usually used in constructs like `ARGV0=emacs nethack'.

       BAUD   The  rate in bits per second at which data reaches the terminal.
              The line editor will use this value in order to compensate for a
              slow  terminal  by  delaying updates to the display until neces-
              sary.  If the parameter is unset or the value is zero  the  com-
              pensation  mechanism is turned off.  The parameter is not set by
              default.

              This parameter may be profitably set in some circumstances, e.g.
              for  slow  modems  dialing into a communications server, or on a
              slow wide area network.  It should be set to the  baud  rate  of
              the slowest part of the link for best performance.

       cdpath <S> <Z> (CDPATH <S>)
              An  array  (colon-separated  list) of directories specifying the
              search path for the cd command.

       COLUMNS <S>
              The number of columns  for  this  terminal  session.   Used  for
              printing select lists and for the line editor.

       CORRECT_IGNORE
              If set, is treated as a pattern during spelling correction.  Any
              potential correction that matches the pattern is  ignored.   For
              example,  if the value is `_*' then completion functions (which,
              by convention, have names beginning with `_') will never be  of-
              fered  as  spelling  corrections.  The pattern does not apply to
              the correction of file names, as applied by the CORRECT_ALL  op-
              tion (so with the example just given files beginning with `_' in
              the current directory would still be completed).

       CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE
              If set, is treated as a pattern during  spelling  correction  of
              file names.  Any file name that matches the pattern is never of-
              fered as a correction.  For example, if the value is  `.*'  then
              dot  file  names  will never be offered as spelling corrections.
              This is useful with the CORRECT_ALL option.

       DIRSTACKSIZE
              The maximum size of the directory stack, by default there is  no
              limit.  If the stack gets larger than this, it will be truncated
              automatically.  This is useful with the AUTO_PUSHD option.

       ENV    If the ENV environment variable is set when zsh is invoked as sh
              or ksh, $ENV is sourced after the profile scripts.  The value of
              ENV is subjected to parameter expansion,  command  substitution,
              and arithmetic expansion before being interpreted as a pathname.
              Note that ENV is not used unless the shell  is  interactive  and
              zsh is emulating sh or ksh.

       FCEDIT The  default  editor  for the fc builtin.  If FCEDIT is not set,
              the parameter EDITOR is used; if  that  is  not  set  either,  a
              builtin default, usually vi, is used.

       fignore <S> <Z> (FIGNORE <S>)
              An array (colon separated list) containing the suffixes of files
              to be ignored during filename completion.  However,  if  comple-
              tion only generates files with suffixes in this list, then these
              files are completed anyway.

       fpath <S> <Z> (FPATH <S>)
              An array (colon separated list) of  directories  specifying  the
              search  path  for  function  definitions.  This path is searched
              when a function with the -u attribute is referenced.  If an exe-
              cutable  file is found, then it is read and executed in the cur-
              rent environment.

       histchars <S>
              Three characters used by the shell's history and lexical  analy-
              sis  mechanism.  The first character signals the start of a his-
              tory expansion (default `!').  The second character signals  the
              start  of a quick history substitution (default `^').  The third
              character is the comment character (default `#').

              The characters must be in the ASCII character set;  any  attempt
              to  set  histchars to characters with a locale-dependent meaning
              will be rejected with an error message.

       HISTCHARS <S> <Z>
              Same as histchars.  (Deprecated.)

       HISTFILE
              The file to save the history in when an interactive shell exits.
              If unset, the history is not saved.

       HISTORY_IGNORE
              If  set,  is  treated as a pattern at the time history files are
              written.  Any potential history entry that matches  the  pattern
              is  skipped.   For example, if the value is `fc *' then commands
              that invoke the interactive history editor are never written  to
              the history file.

              Note  that  HISTORY_IGNORE  defines a single pattern: to specify
              alternatives use the `(first|second|...)' syntax.

              Compare the HIST_NO_STORE option or the zshaddhistory hook,  ei-
              ther  of  which  would prevent such commands from being added to
              the interactive history at all.  If you wish to use  HISTORY_IG-
              NORE to stop history being added in the first place, you can de-
              fine the following hook:

                     zshaddhistory() {
                       emulate -L zsh
                       ## uncomment if HISTORY_IGNORE
                       ## should use EXTENDED_GLOB syntax
                       # setopt extendedglob
                       [[ $1 != ${~HISTORY_IGNORE} ]]
                     }

       HISTSIZE <S>
              The maximum number of events  stored  in  the  internal  history
              list.   If  you  use  the HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST option, setting
              this value larger than the SAVEHIST size will give you the  dif-
              ference as a cushion for saving duplicated history events.

              If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
              explicitly set locally.

       HOME <S>
              The default argument for the cd command.  This is not set  auto-
              matically  by  the  shell in sh, ksh or csh emulation, but it is
              typically present in the environment anyway, and if  it  becomes
              set it has its usual special behaviour.

       IFS <S>
              Internal  field  separators  (by default space, tab, newline and
              NUL), that are used to separate words which result from  command
              or  parameter expansion and words read by the read builtin.  Any
              characters from the set space, tab and newline  that  appear  in
              the IFS are called IFS white space.  One or more IFS white space
              characters or one non-IFS white space  character  together  with
              any  adjacent  IFS white space character delimit a field.  If an
              IFS white space character appears  twice  consecutively  in  the
              IFS,  this  character  is treated as if it were not an IFS white
              space character.

              If the parameter is unset, the default is used.  Note this has a
              different effect from setting the parameter to an empty string.

       KEYBOARD_HACK
              This  variable defines a character to be removed from the end of
              the command line  before  interpreting  it  (interactive  shells
              only). It is intended to fix the problem with keys placed annoy-
              ingly close to return and replaces  the  SUNKEYBOARDHACK  option
              which did this for backquotes only.  Should the chosen character
              be one of singlequote, doublequote or backquote, there must also
              be an odd number of them on the command line for the last one to
              be removed.

              For backward compatibility, if the SUNKEYBOARDHACK option is ex-
              plicitly  set,  the value of KEYBOARD_HACK reverts to backquote.
              If the option is explicitly  unset,  this  variable  is  set  to
              empty.

       KEYTIMEOUT
              The  time the shell waits, in hundredths of seconds, for another
              key to be pressed when reading bound multi-character sequences.

       LANG <S>
              This variable determines the locale category  for  any  category
              not specifically selected via a variable starting with `LC_'.

       LC_ALL <S>
              This variable overrides the value of the `LANG' variable and the
              value of any of the other variables starting with `LC_'.

       LC_COLLATE <S>
              This variable determines the locale category for character  col-
              lation  information within ranges in glob brackets and for sort-
              ing.

       LC_CTYPE <S>
              This variable determines the locale category for character  han-
              dling  functions.   If  the  MULTIBYTE  option is in effect this
              variable or LANG should contain a value that reflects the  char-
              acter set in use, even if it is a single-byte character set, un-
              less only the 7-bit subset (ASCII) is used.  For example, if the
              character   set   is  ISO-8859-1,  a  suitable  value  might  be
              en_US.iso88591 (certain Linux distributions) or  en_US.ISO8859-1
              (MacOS).

       LC_MESSAGES <S>
              This  variable  determines the language in which messages should
              be written.  Note that zsh does not use message catalogs.

       LC_NUMERIC <S>
              This variable affects the decimal point character and  thousands
              separator character for the formatted input/output functions and
              string conversion functions.  Note that zsh ignores this setting
              when parsing floating point mathematical expressions.

       LC_TIME <S>
              This  variable  determines the locale category for date and time
              formatting in prompt escape sequences.

       LINES <S>
              The number of lines for this terminal session.  Used for  print-
              ing select lists and for the line editor.

       LISTMAX
              In the line editor, the number of matches to list without asking
              first. If the value is negative, the list will be  shown  if  it
              spans  at most as many lines as given by the absolute value.  If
              set to zero, the shell asks only if the top of the listing would
              scroll off the screen.

       MAIL   If  this  parameter  is  set  and mailpath is not set, the shell
              looks for mail in the specified file.

       MAILCHECK
              The interval in seconds between checks for new mail.

       mailpath <S> <Z> (MAILPATH <S>)
              An array (colon-separated list) of filenames to  check  for  new
              mail.  Each filename can be followed by a `?' and a message that
              will be printed.  The message will undergo parameter  expansion,
              command  substitution and arithmetic expansion with the variable
              $_ defined as the name of the file that has  changed.   The  de-
              fault message is `You have new mail'.  If an element is a direc-
              tory instead of a file the shell will  recursively  check  every
              file in every subdirectory of the element.

       manpath <S> <Z> (MANPATH <S> <Z>)
              An  array  (colon-separated list) whose value is not used by the
              shell.  The manpath array can be useful, however, since  setting
              it also sets MANPATH, and vice versa.

       match
       mbegin
       mend   Arrays set by the shell when the b globbing flag is used in pat-
              tern matches.  See the subsection Globbing flags in the documen-
              tation for Filename Generation in zshexpn(1).

       MATCH
       MBEGIN
       MEND   Set  by  the  shell  when the m globbing flag is used in pattern
              matches.  See the subsection Globbing flags in the documentation
              for Filename Generation in zshexpn(1).

       module_path <S> <Z> (MODULE_PATH <S>)
              An  array  (colon-separated  list)  of directories that zmodload
              searches for dynamically loadable modules.  This is  initialized
              to  a  standard  pathname, usually `/usr/local/lib/zsh/$ZSH_VER-
              SION'.  (The `/usr/local/lib' part varies from  installation  to
              installation.)  For security reasons, any value set in the envi-
              ronment when the shell is started will be ignored.

              These parameters only exist if the installation supports dynamic
              module loading.

       NULLCMD <S>
              The command name to assume if a redirection is specified with no
              command.  Defaults to cat.  For sh/ksh behavior, change this  to
              :.   For csh-like behavior, unset this parameter; the shell will
              print an error message if null commands are entered.

       path <S> <Z> (PATH <S>)
              An array (colon-separated list) of  directories  to  search  for
              commands.  When this parameter is set, each directory is scanned
              and all files found are put in a hash table.

       POSTEDIT <S>
              This string is output whenever the line editor exits.   It  usu-
              ally contains termcap strings to reset the terminal.

       PROMPT <S> <Z>
       PROMPT2 <S> <Z>
       PROMPT3 <S> <Z>
       PROMPT4 <S> <Z>
              Same as PS1, PS2, PS3 and PS4, respectively.

       prompt <S> <Z>
              Same as PS1.

       PROMPT_EOL_MARK
              When   the   PROMPT_CR   and  PROMPT_SP  options  are  set,  the
              PROMPT_EOL_MARK parameter can be used to customize how  the  end
              of partial lines are shown.  This parameter undergoes prompt ex-
              pansion, with the PROMPT_PERCENT option set.  If  not  set,  the
              default behavior is equivalent to the value `%B%S%#%s%b'.

       PS1 <S>
              The primary prompt string, printed before a command is read.  It
              undergoes a special form of expansion  before  being  displayed;
              see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).  The default is
              `%m%# '.

       PS2 <S>
              The secondary prompt, printed when the shell needs more informa-
              tion  to  complete a command.  It is expanded in the same way as
              PS1.  The default is `%_> ', which displays any shell constructs
              or quotation marks which are currently being processed.

       PS3 <S>
              Selection  prompt  used within a select loop.  It is expanded in
              the same way as PS1.  The default is `?# '.

       PS4 <S>
              The execution trace prompt.  Default is `+%N:%i> ',  which  dis-
              plays  the name of the current shell structure and the line num-
              ber within it.  In sh or ksh emulation, the default is `+ '.

       psvar <S> <Z> (PSVAR <S>)
              An array (colon-separated list) whose elements can  be  used  in
              PROMPT strings.  Setting psvar also sets PSVAR, and vice versa.

       READNULLCMD <S>
              The  command  name  to  assume  if a single input redirection is
              specified with no command.  Defaults to more.

       REPORTMEMORY
              If  nonnegative,  commands  whose  maximum  resident  set   size
              (roughly  speaking,  main  memory usage) in kilobytes is greater
              than this value have timing  statistics  reported.   The  format
              used to output statistics is the value of the TIMEFMT parameter,
              which is the same as for the REPORTTIME variable  and  the  time
              builtin; note that by default this does not output memory usage.
              Appending " max RSS %M" to the value of  TIMEFMT  causes  it  to
              output  the  value  that triggered the report.  If REPORTTIME is
              also in use, at most a single report is printed for  both  trig-
              gers.   This  feature requires the getrusage() system call, com-
              monly supported by modern Unix-like systems.

       REPORTTIME
              If nonnegative, commands whose combined user and  system  execu-
              tion  times  (measured  in  seconds) are greater than this value
              have timing statistics printed for them.  Output  is  suppressed
              for  commands executed within the line editor, including comple-
              tion; commands explicitly marked with  the  time  keyword  still
              cause the summary to be printed in this case.

       REPLY  This  parameter  is reserved by convention to pass string values
              between shell scripts and shell builtins in situations  where  a
              function call or redirection are impossible or undesirable.  The
              read builtin and the select complex command may set  REPLY,  and
              filename generation both sets and examines its value when evalu-
              ating certain expressions.  Some modules also employ  REPLY  for
              similar purposes.

       reply  As REPLY, but for array values rather than strings.

       RPROMPT <S>
       RPS1 <S>
              This  prompt  is  displayed on the right-hand side of the screen
              when the primary prompt is being displayed on  the  left.   This
              does  not  work if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE option is set.  It is ex-
              panded in the same way as PS1.

       RPROMPT2 <S>
       RPS2 <S>
              This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side  of  the  screen
              when  the secondary prompt is being displayed on the left.  This
              does not work if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE option is set.  It  is  ex-
              panded in the same way as PS2.

       SAVEHIST
              The  maximum  number  of  history  events to save in the history
              file.

              If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
              explicitly set locally.

       SPROMPT <S>
              The  prompt used for spelling correction.  The sequence `%R' ex-
              pands to the string which presumably needs spelling  correction,
              and  `%r'  expands to the proposed correction.  All other prompt
              escapes are also allowed.

              The actions available at the prompt are [nyae]:
              n (`no') (default)
                     Discard the correction and run the command.
              y (`yes')
                     Make the correction and run the command.
              a (`abort')
                     Discard the entire command line without running it.
              e (`edit')
                     Resume editing the command line.

       STTY   If this parameter is set in a command's environment,  the  shell
              runs  the stty command with the value of this parameter as argu-
              ments in order to set up the terminal before executing the  com-
              mand. The modes apply only to the command, and are reset when it
              finishes or is suspended. If the command is suspended  and  con-
              tinued  later with the fg or wait builtins it will see the modes
              specified by STTY, as if it were not  suspended.   This  (inten-
              tionally)  does  not apply if the command is continued via `kill
              -CONT'.  STTY is ignored if the command  is  run  in  the  back-
              ground,  or if it is in the environment of the shell but not ex-
              plicitly assigned to in the input line. This avoids running stty
              at  every  external  command  by accidentally exporting it. Also
              note that STTY should not be used  for  window  size  specifica-
              tions; these will not be local to the command.

              If  the parameter is set and empty, all of the above applies ex-
              cept that stty is not run. This can be useful as a way to freeze
              the  tty  around  a  single command, blocking its changes to tty
              settings, similar to the ttyctl builtin.

       TERM <S>
              The type of terminal in use.  This is used when looking up term-
              cap  sequences.  An assignment to TERM causes zsh to re-initial-
              ize the terminal, even if  the  value  does  not  change  (e.g.,
              `TERM=$TERM').   It is necessary to make such an assignment upon
              any change to the terminal definition database or terminal  type
              in order for the new settings to take effect.

       TERMINFO <S>
              A  reference  to  your terminfo database, used by the `terminfo'
              library when the system has it; see terminfo(5).  If  set,  this
              causes  the shell to reinitialise the terminal, making the work-
              around `TERM=$TERM' unnecessary.

       TERMINFO_DIRS <S>
              A colon-seprarated list of terminfo databases, used by the `ter-
              minfo'  library  when  the  system has it; see terminfo(5). This
              variable is only used by certain terminal libraries, in particu-
              lar  ncurses;  see  terminfo(5) to check support on your system.
              If set, this causes the shell to reinitialise the terminal, mak-
              ing  the  workaround `TERM=$TERM' unnecessary.  Note that unlike
              other colon-separated arrays this is not tied to a zsh array.

       TIMEFMT
              The format of process time reports with the time  keyword.   The
              default is `%J  %U user %S system %P cpu %*E total'.  Recognizes
              the following escape sequences, although not all may  be  avail-
              able on all systems, and some that are available may not be use-
              ful:

              %%     A `%'.
              %U     CPU seconds spent in user mode.
              %S     CPU seconds spent in kernel mode.
              %E     Elapsed time in seconds.
              %P     The CPU percentage, computed as 100*(%U+%S)/%E.
              %W     Number of times the process was swapped.
              %X     The average amount in (shared) text space used  in  kilo-
                     bytes.
              %D     The average amount in (unshared) data/stack space used in
                     kilobytes.
              %K     The total space used (%X+%D) in kilobytes.
              %M     The  maximum memory the process had in use at any time in
                     kilobytes.
              %F     The  number  of  major  page  faults  (page  needed to be
                     brought from disk).
              %R     The number of minor page faults.
              %I     The number of input operations.
              %O     The number of output operations.
              %r     The number of socket messages received.
              %s     The number of socket messages sent.
              %k     The number of signals received.
              %w     Number of voluntary context switches (waits).
              %c     Number of involuntary context switches.
              %J     The name of this job.

              A star may be inserted between the percent sign and flags print-
              ing  time  (e.g.,  `%*E'); this causes the time to be printed in
              `hh:mm:ss.ttt' format (hours and minutes  are  only  printed  if
              they  are  not  zero).   Alternatively,  `m'  or `u' may be used
              (e.g., `%mE') to produce time  output  in  milliseconds  or  mi-
              croseconds, respectively.

       TMOUT  If  this  parameter  is  nonzero, the shell will receive an ALRM
              signal if a command is not entered within the  specified  number
              of  seconds  after  issuing  a  prompt.  If  there  is a trap on
              SIGALRM, it will be executed and a new alarm is scheduled  using
              the  value  of the TMOUT parameter after executing the trap.  If
              no trap is set, and the idle time of the terminal  is  not  less
              than  the  value of the TMOUT parameter, zsh terminates.  Other-
              wise a new alarm is scheduled to TMOUT seconds  after  the  last
              keypress.

       TMPPREFIX
              A  pathname  prefix  which  the shell will use for all temporary
              files.  Note that this should include an initial  part  for  the
              file  name  as  well  as  any  directory  names.  The default is
              `/tmp/zsh'.

       TMPSUFFIX
              A filename suffix which the shell will use for  temporary  files
              created  by  process substitutions (e.g., `=(list)').  Note that
              the value should include a leading dot `.' if intended to be in-
              terpreted as a file extension.  The default is not to append any
              suffix, thus this parameter should be assigned only when  needed
              and then unset again.

       WORDCHARS <S>
              A  list of non-alphanumeric characters considered part of a word
              by the line editor.

       ZBEEP  If set, this gives a string of characters, which can use all the
              same  codes  as  the bindkey command as described in the zsh/zle
              module entry in zshmodules(1), that will be output to the termi-
              nal  instead  of beeping.  This may have a visible instead of an
              audible effect; for example,  the  string  `\e[?5h\e[?5l'  on  a
              vt100 or xterm will have the effect of flashing reverse video on
              and off (if you usually use reverse video, you  should  use  the
              string  `\e[?5l\e[?5h' instead).  This takes precedence over the
              NOBEEP option.

       ZDOTDIR
              The directory to search for shell startup files  (.zshrc,  etc),
              if not $HOME.

       zle_bracketed_paste
              Many  terminal emulators have a feature that allows applications
              to identify when text is pasted into the  terminal  rather  than
              being  typed  normally. For ZLE, this means that special charac-
              ters such as tabs and newlines can be inserted instead of invok-
              ing  editor  commands.   Furthermore, pasted text forms a single
              undo event and if the region is active, pasted text will replace
              the region.

              This  two-element  array  contains the terminal escape sequences
              for enabling and disabling the feature. These  escape  sequences
              are  used  to enable bracketed paste when ZLE is active and dis-
              able it at other times.  Unsetting the parameter has the  effect
              of ensuring that bracketed paste remains disabled.

       zle_highlight
              An  array  describing contexts in which ZLE should highlight the
              input text.  See Character Highlighting in zshzle(1).

       ZLE_LINE_ABORTED
              This parameter is set by the line editor when an  error  occurs.
              It  contains  the line that was being edited at the point of the
              error.  `print -zr -- $ZLE_LINE_ABORTED' can be used to  recover
              the line.  Only the most recent line of this kind is remembered.

       ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS
       ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS
              These  parameters  are used by the line editor.  In certain cir-
              cumstances suffixes (typically space or slash) added by the com-
              pletion system will be removed automatically, either because the
              next editing command was not an insertable character, or because
              the character was marked as requiring the suffix to be removed.

              These  variables  can  contain  the sets of characters that will
              cause the suffix to be removed.  If  ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS  is
              set,  those  characters  will cause the suffix to be removed; if
              ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set, those characters will  cause  the
              suffix to be removed and replaced by a space.

              If  ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is not set, the default behaviour is
              equivalent to:

                     ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$' \t\n;&|'

              If ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set but is  empty,  no  characters
              have  this  behaviour.  ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS takes precedence,
              so that the following:

                     ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$'&|'

              causes the characters `&' and `|' to remove the  suffix  but  to
              replace it with a space.

              To  illustrate  the difference, suppose that the option AUTO_RE-
              MOVE_SLASH is in effect and the directory DIR has just been com-
              pleted,  with an appended /, following which the user types `&'.
              The default result is `DIR&'.  With ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS  set
              but   without   including  `&'  the  result  is  `DIR/&'.   With
              ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS set to include `&' the result is `DIR &'.

              Note that certain completions may provide their own  suffix  re-
              moval  or  replacement  behaviour which overrides the values de-
              scribed here.  See the completion system documentation  in  zsh-
              compsys(1).

       ZLE_RPROMPT_INDENT <S>
              If set, used to give the indentation between the right hand side
              of the right prompt in the line  editor  as  given  by  RPS1  or
              RPROMPT  and the right hand side of the screen.  If not set, the
              value 1 is used.

              Typically this will be used to set the value to 0  so  that  the
              prompt  appears  flush  with  the right hand side of the screen.
              This is not the default as many terminals  do  not  handle  this
              correctly,  in particular when the prompt appears at the extreme
              bottom right of the screen.  Recent virtual terminals  are  more
              likely  to  handle this case correctly.  Some experimentation is
              necessary.

ZSHOPTIONS(1)               General Commands Manual              ZSHOPTIONS(1)

NAME
       zshoptions - zsh options

SPECIFYING OPTIONS
       Options are primarily referred to by name.  These names are case insen-
       sitive and underscores are ignored.  For example, `allexport' is equiv-
       alent to `A__lleXP_ort'.

       The sense of an option name may be inverted by preceding it with  `no',
       so  `setopt  No_Beep' is equivalent to `unsetopt beep'.  This inversion
       can only be done once, so `nonobeep' is not a synonym for `beep'.  Sim-
       ilarly,  `tify'  is not a synonym for `nonotify' (the inversion of `no-
       tify').

       Some options also have one or more single letter names.  There are  two
       sets of single letter options: one used by default, and another used to
       emulate sh/ksh (used when the SH_OPTION_LETTERS option  is  set).   The
       single  letter  options  can be used on the shell command line, or with
       the set, setopt and unsetopt builtins, as normal Unix options  preceded
       by `-'.

       The sense of the single letter options may be inverted by using `+' in-
       stead of `-'.  Some of the single letter option names refer to  an  op-
       tion  being off, in which case the inversion of that name refers to the
       option being on.  For example, `+n' is the short name  of  `exec',  and
       `-n' is the short name of its inversion, `noexec'.

       In  strings  of single letter options supplied to the shell at startup,
       trailing whitespace will be ignored; for example the  string  `-f     '
       will  be treated just as `-f', but the string `-f i' is an error.  This
       is because many systems which implement the `#!' mechanism for  calling
       scripts do not strip trailing whitespace.

       It  is possible for options to be set within a function scope.  See the
       description of the option LOCAL_OPTIONS below.

DESCRIPTION OF OPTIONS
       In the following list, options set by default  in  all  emulations  are
       marked  <D>;  those  set by default only in csh, ksh, sh, or zsh emula-
       tions are marked <C>, <K>, <S>, <Z> as appropriate.  When  listing  op-
       tions  (by `setopt', `unsetopt', `set -o' or `set +o'), those turned on
       by default appear in  the  list  prefixed  with  `no'.   Hence  (unless
       KSH_OPTION_PRINT is set), `setopt' shows all options whose settings are
       changed from the default.

   Changing Directories
       AUTO_CD (-J)
              If a command is issued that can't be executed as a  normal  com-
              mand, and the command is the name of a directory, perform the cd
              command to that directory.  This option is  only  applicable  if
              the  option  SHIN_STDIN  is set, i.e. if commands are being read
              from standard input.  The option  is  designed  for  interactive
              use;  it is recommended that cd be used explicitly in scripts to
              avoid ambiguity.

       AUTO_PUSHD (-N)
              Make cd push the old directory onto the directory stack.

       CDABLE_VARS (-T)
              If the argument to a cd command  (or  an  implied  cd  with  the
              AUTO_CD  option set) is not a directory, and does not begin with
              a slash, try to expand the expression as if it were preceded  by
              a `~' (see the section `Filename Expansion').

       CD_SILENT
              Never  print  the working directory after a cd (whether explicit
              or implied with the AUTO_CD option set). cd normally prints  the
              working  directory  when the argument given to it was -, a stack
              entry, or the name of a directory found under CDPATH. Note  that
              this is distinct from pushd's stack-printing behaviour, which is
              controlled by PUSHD_SILENT. This  option  overrides  the  print-
              ing-related effects of POSIX_CD.

       CHASE_DOTS
              When  changing  to  a  directory  containing a path segment `..'
              which would otherwise be treated as canceling the previous  seg-
              ment in the path (in other words, `foo/..' would be removed from
              the path, or if `..' is the first part of  the  path,  the  last
              part of the current working directory would be removed), instead
              resolve the path to the  physical  directory.   This  option  is
              overridden by CHASE_LINKS.

              For  example,  suppose  /foo/bar  is  a  link  to  the directory
              /alt/rod.  Without this option set, `cd /foo/bar/..' changes  to
              /foo;  with it set, it changes to /alt.  The same applies if the
              current directory is /foo/bar and `cd ..' is  used.   Note  that
              all other symbolic links in the path will also be resolved.

       CHASE_LINKS (-w)
              Resolve symbolic links to their true values when changing direc-
              tory.  This also has the effect of CHASE_DOTS, i.e. a `..'  path
              segment  will  be  treated  as referring to the physical parent,
              even if the preceding path segment is a symbolic link.

       POSIX_CD <K> <S>
              Modifies the behaviour of cd, chdir and pushd commands  to  make
              them more compatible with the POSIX standard. The behaviour with
              the option unset is described in the documentation  for  the  cd
              builtin in zshbuiltins(1).  If the option is set, the shell does
              not test for directories beneath the local directory (`.') until
              after all directories in cdpath have been tested, and the cd and
              chdir commands do not recognise arguments of the  form  `{+|-}n'
              as directory stack entries.

              Also, if the option is set, the conditions under which the shell
              prints the new directory after changing to it are modified.   It
              is no longer restricted to interactive shells (although printing
              of the directory stack with pushd is still limited  to  interac-
              tive  shells); and any use of a component of CDPATH, including a
              `.' but excluding an empty component that is  otherwise  treated
              as `.', causes the directory to be printed.

       PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS
              Don't push multiple copies of the same directory onto the direc-
              tory stack.

       PUSHD_MINUS
              Exchanges the meanings of `+' and `-' when used with a number to
              specify a directory in the stack.

       PUSHD_SILENT (-E)
              Do not print the directory stack after pushd or popd.

       PUSHD_TO_HOME (-D)
              Have pushd with no arguments act like `pushd $HOME'.

   Completion
       ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT <D>
              If  unset,  key functions that list completions try to return to
              the last prompt if given a numeric argument. If set these  func-
              tions try to return to the last prompt if given no numeric argu-
              ment.

       ALWAYS_TO_END
              If a completion is performed with the cursor within a word,  and
              a full completion is inserted, the cursor is moved to the end of
              the word.  That is, the cursor is moved to the end of  the  word
              if  either a single match is inserted or menu completion is per-
              formed.

       AUTO_LIST (-9) <D>
              Automatically list choices on an ambiguous completion.

       AUTO_MENU <D>
              Automatically use menu completion after the  second  consecutive
              request  for completion, for example by pressing the tab key re-
              peatedly. This option is overridden by MENU_COMPLETE.

       AUTO_NAME_DIRS
              Any parameter that is set to the absolute name  of  a  directory
              immediately becomes a name for that directory, that will be used
              by the `%~' and related prompt sequences, and will be  available
              when completion is performed on a word starting with `~'.  (Oth-
              erwise, the parameter must be used in the form `~param' first.)

       AUTO_PARAM_KEYS <D>
              If a parameter name was  completed  and  a  following  character
              (normally  a space) automatically inserted, and the next charac-
              ter typed is one of those that have to come directly  after  the
              name (like `}', `:', etc.), the automatically added character is
              deleted, so that the character typed comes immediately after the
              parameter  name.   Completion  in  a brace expansion is affected
              similarly: the added character is a `,', which will  be  removed
              if `}' is typed next.

       AUTO_PARAM_SLASH <D>
              If  a  parameter is completed whose content is the name of a di-
              rectory, then add a trailing slash instead of a space.

       AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH <D>
              When the last character resulting from a completion is  a  slash
              and  the next character typed is a word delimiter, a slash, or a
              character that ends a command (such as a semicolon or an  amper-
              sand), remove the slash.

       BASH_AUTO_LIST
              On  an ambiguous completion, automatically list choices when the
              completion function is called twice in succession.   This  takes
              precedence over AUTO_LIST.  The setting of LIST_AMBIGUOUS is re-
              spected.  If AUTO_MENU is set,  the  menu  behaviour  will  then
              start  with  the third press.  Note that this will not work with
              MENU_COMPLETE, since repeated completion calls immediately cycle
              through the list in that case.

       COMPLETE_ALIASES
              Prevents  aliases on the command line from being internally sub-
              stituted before completion is attempted.  The effect is to  make
              the alias a distinct command for completion purposes.

       COMPLETE_IN_WORD
              If unset, the cursor is set to the end of the word if completion
              is started. Otherwise it stays there and completion is done from
              both ends.

       GLOB_COMPLETE
              When  the current word has a glob pattern, do not insert all the
              words resulting from the expansion but generate matches  as  for
              completion  and  cycle  through  them  like  MENU_COMPLETE.  The
              matches are generated as if a `*' was added to the  end  of  the
              word,  or  inserted  at the cursor when COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set.
              This actually uses pattern matching, not globbing, so  it  works
              not only for files but for any completion, such as options, user
              names, etc.

              Note that when the pattern matcher  is  used,  matching  control
              (for  example,  case-insensitive or anchored matching) cannot be
              used.  This limitation only applies when the current  word  con-
              tains a pattern; simply turning on the GLOB_COMPLETE option does
              not have this effect.

       HASH_LIST_ALL <D>
              Whenever a command completion  or  spelling  correction  is  at-
              tempted,  make  sure  the  entire  command path is hashed first.
              This makes the first completion slower but avoids false  reports
              of spelling errors.

       LIST_AMBIGUOUS <D>
              This  option works when AUTO_LIST or BASH_AUTO_LIST is also set.
              If there is an unambiguous prefix to insert on the command line,
              that is done without a completion list being displayed; in other
              words, auto-listing behaviour  only  takes  place  when  nothing
              would  be  inserted.   In the case of BASH_AUTO_LIST, this means
              that the list will be delayed to the third call of the function.

       LIST_BEEP <D>
              Beep on an ambiguous completion.  More accurately,  this  forces
              the  completion  widgets to return status 1 on an ambiguous com-
              pletion, which causes the shell to beep if the  option  BEEP  is
              also  set;  this  may be modified if completion is called from a
              user-defined widget.

       LIST_PACKED
              Try to make the completion list smaller (occupying  less  lines)
              by printing the matches in columns with different widths.

       LIST_ROWS_FIRST
              Lay  out  the  matches  in completion lists sorted horizontally,
              that is, the second match is to the right of the first one,  not
              under it as usual.

       LIST_TYPES (-X) <D>
              When  listing files that are possible completions, show the type
              of each file with a trailing identifying mark.

       MENU_COMPLETE (-Y)
              On an ambiguous completion, instead of listing possibilities  or
              beeping,  insert the first match immediately.  Then when comple-
              tion is requested again, remove the first match and  insert  the
              second  match,  etc.  When there are no more matches, go back to
              the first one again.  reverse-menu-complete may be used to  loop
              through  the  list in the other direction. This option overrides
              AUTO_MENU.

       REC_EXACT (-S)
              If the string on the command line exactly  matches  one  of  the
              possible  completions,  it is accepted, even if there is another
              completion (i.e. that string with  something  else  added)  that
              also matches.

   Expansion and Globbing
       BAD_PATTERN (+2) <C> <Z>
              If  a  pattern for filename generation is badly formed, print an
              error message.  (If this option is unset, the  pattern  will  be
              left unchanged.)

       BARE_GLOB_QUAL <Z>
              In  a  glob  pattern,  treat  a trailing set of parentheses as a
              qualifier list, if it contains no `|', `(' or (if  special)  `~'
              characters.  See the section `Filename Generation'.

       BRACE_CCL
              Expand  expressions  in braces which would not otherwise undergo
              brace expansion to a lexically ordered list of all  the  charac-
              ters.  See the section `Brace Expansion'.

       CASE_GLOB <D>
              Make  globbing  (filename  generation)  sensitive to case.  Note
              that other uses of patterns are always sensitive  to  case.   If
              the option is unset, the presence of any character which is spe-
              cial to filename generation will cause  case-insensitive  match-
              ing.   For  example, cvs(/) can match the directory CVS owing to
              the  presence  of  the  globbing   flag   (unless   the   option
              BARE_GLOB_QUAL is unset).

       CASE_MATCH <D>
              Make  regular  expressions using the zsh/regex module (including
              matches with =~) sensitive to case.

       CASE_PATHS
              If CASE_PATHS is not set (the default),  CASE_GLOB  affects  the
              interpretation of every path component, whenever a special char-
              acter appears in any component.  When CASE_PATHS  is  set,  file
              path  components that do not contain special filename generation
              characters  are  always  sensitive  to  case,  thus  restricting
              NO_CASE_GLOB to components that contain globbing characters.

              Note  that  if  the  filesystem itself is not sensitive to case,
              then CASE_PATHS has no effect.

       CSH_NULL_GLOB <C>
              If a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete  the
              pattern  from  the  argument list; do not report an error unless
              all the patterns in a command have no  matches.   Overrides  NO-
              MATCH.

       EQUALS <Z>
              Perform = filename expansion.  (See the section `Filename Expan-
              sion'.)

       EXTENDED_GLOB
              Treat the `#', `~' and `^' characters as part  of  patterns  for
              filename  generation, etc.  (An initial unquoted `~' always pro-
              duces named directory expansion.)

       FORCE_FLOAT
              Constants in arithmetic evaluation will be treated  as  floating
              point even without the use of a decimal point; the values of in-
              teger variables will be converted to floating point when used in
              arithmetic expressions.  Integers in any base will be converted.

       GLOB (+F, ksh: +f) <D>
              Perform filename generation (globbing).  (See the section `File-
              name Generation'.)

       GLOB_ASSIGN <C>
              If this option is set, filename generation  (globbing)  is  per-
              formed on the right hand side of scalar parameter assignments of
              the form `name=pattern (e.g. `foo=*').  If the result  has  more
              than  one  word  the  parameter  will become an array with those
              words as arguments. This option is provided for  backwards  com-
              patibility  only: globbing is always performed on the right hand
              side of array  assignments  of  the  form  `name=(value)'  (e.g.
              `foo=(*)')  and  this form is recommended for clarity; with this
              option set, it is not possible to  predict  whether  the  result
              will be an array or a scalar.

       GLOB_DOTS (-4)
              Do not require a leading `.' in a filename to be matched explic-
              itly.

       GLOB_STAR_SHORT
              When this option is set and the default zsh-style globbing is in
              effect,  the  pattern  `**/*' can be abbreviated to `**' and the
              pattern `***/*' can be abbreviated to ***.  Hence `**.c' finds a
              file ending in .c in any subdirectory, and `***.c' does the same
              while also following symbolic links.  A / immediately after  the
              `**' or `***' forces the pattern to be treated as the unabbrevi-
              ated form.

       GLOB_SUBST <C> <K> <S>
              Treat any characters resulting from parameter expansion as being
              eligible for filename expansion and filename generation, and any
              characters resulting from command substitution as being eligible
              for  filename generation.  Braces (and commas in between) do not
              become eligible for expansion.

       HIST_SUBST_PATTERN
              Substitutions using the :s and :&  history  modifiers  are  per-
              formed  with  pattern matching instead of string matching.  This
              occurs wherever history  modifiers  are  valid,  including  glob
              qualifiers  and parameters.  See the section `Modifiers' in zsh-
              expn(1).

       IGNORE_BRACES (-I) <S>
              Do not perform brace expansion.   For  historical  reasons  this
              also includes the effect of the IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES option.

       IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES
              When  neither this option nor IGNORE_BRACES is set, a sole close
              brace character `}' is syntactically significant at any point on
              a  command  line.  This has the effect that no semicolon or new-
              line is necessary before the brace  terminating  a  function  or
              current  shell  construct.  When either option is set, a closing
              brace is syntactically significant  only  in  command  position.
              Unlike  IGNORE_BRACES, this option does not disable brace expan-
              sion.

              For example, with both options unset a function may  be  defined
              in the following fashion:

                     args() { echo $# }

              while  if either option is set, this does not work and something
              equivalent to the following is required:

                     args() { echo $#; }

       KSH_GLOB <K>
              In pattern matching, the interpretation of  parentheses  is  af-
              fected  by  a preceding `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  See the sec-
              tion `Filename Generation'.

       MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST
              All unquoted arguments of the form `anything=expression' appear-
              ing  after  the  command  name have filename expansion (that is,
              where expression has a leading `~' or `=') performed on  expres-
              sion  as if it were a parameter assignment.  The argument is not
              otherwise treated specially; it is passed to the  command  as  a
              single argument, and not used as an actual parameter assignment.
              For example, in echo  foo=~/bar:~/rod,  both  occurrences  of  ~
              would  be  replaced.  Note that this happens anyway with typeset
              and similar statements.

              This option respects the setting of the KSH_TYPESET option.   In
              other  words,  if  both options are in effect, arguments looking
              like assignments will not undergo word splitting.

       MARK_DIRS (-8, ksh: -X)
              Append a trailing `/' to  all  directory  names  resulting  from
              filename generation (globbing).

       MULTIBYTE <D>
              Respect  multibyte  characters when found in strings.  When this
              option is set, strings are examined using the system library  to
              determine how many bytes form a character, depending on the cur-
              rent locale.  This affects the way  characters  are  counted  in
              pattern matching, parameter values and various delimiters.

              The  option  is  on  by  default  if the shell was compiled with
              MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT; otherwise it is off by default and has no ef-
              fect if turned on.

              If the option is off a single byte is always treated as a single
              character.   This  setting  is  designed  purely  for  examining
              strings  known to contain raw bytes or other values that may not
              be characters in the current locale.  It is not necessary to un-
              set  the option merely because the character set for the current
              locale does not contain multibyte characters.

              The option does not affect the  shell's  editor,   which  always
              uses  the locale to determine multibyte characters.  This is be-
              cause the character set displayed by the  terminal  emulator  is
              independent of shell settings.

       NOMATCH (+3) <C> <Z>
              If  a  pattern  for filename generation has no matches, print an
              error, instead of leaving it unchanged  in  the  argument  list.
              This also applies to file expansion of an initial `~' or `='.

       NULL_GLOB (-G)
              If  a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete the
              pattern from the argument list instead of  reporting  an  error.
              Overrides NOMATCH.

       NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT
              If  numeric  filenames are matched by a filename generation pat-
              tern, sort the filenames numerically rather  than  lexicographi-
              cally.

       RC_EXPAND_PARAM (-P)
              Array  expansions of the form `foo${xx}bar', where the parameter
              xx is set to (a b c),  are  substituted  with  `fooabar  foobbar
              foocbar'  instead  of  the  default `fooa b cbar'.  Note that an
              empty array will therefore cause all arguments to be removed.

       REMATCH_PCRE
              If set, regular expression matching with the  =~  operator  will
              use  Perl-Compatible  Regular Expressions from the PCRE library.
              (The zsh/pcre module must be available.)  If  not  set,  regular
              expressions  will use the extended regexp syntax provided by the
              system libraries.

       SH_GLOB <K> <S>
              Disables the special meaning of `(', `|', `)' and '<' for  glob-
              bing  the  result of parameter and command substitutions, and in
              some other places where the shell accepts patterns.  If  SH_GLOB
              is  set but KSH_GLOB is not, the shell allows the interpretation
              of subshell expressions enclosed in parentheses  in  some  cases
              where  there  is  no  space before the opening parenthesis, e.g.
              !(true) is interpreted as if there were a  space  after  the  !.
              This option is set by default if zsh is invoked as sh or ksh.

       UNSET (+u, ksh: +u) <K> <S> <Z>
              Treat  unset parameters as if they were empty when substituting,
              and as if they were zero when reading their values in arithmetic
              expansion  and  arithmetic commands.  Otherwise they are treated
              as an error.

       WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL
              Print a warning message when a global parameter is created in  a
              function  by an assignment or in math context.  This often indi-
              cates that a parameter has  not  been  declared  local  when  it
              should  have  been.   Parameters explicitly declared global from
              within a function using typeset -g do not cause a warning.  Note
              that  there  is no warning when a local parameter is assigned to
              in a nested function, which may also indicate an error.

       WARN_NESTED_VAR
              Print a warning message when an existing parameter from  an  en-
              closing  function  scope,  or global, is set in a function by an
              assignment or in math context.  Assignment to shell special  pa-
              rameters  does  not  cause  a warning.  This is the companion to
              WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL as in this case the warning is  only  printed
              when a parameter is not created.  Where possible, use of typeset
              -g to set the parameter suppresses the error, but note that this
              needs  to  be used every time the parameter is set.  To restrict
              the effect of this option to a single function scope, use `func-
              tions -W'.

              For  example,  the following code produces a warning for the as-
              signment inside the function nested as that overrides the  value
              within toplevel

                     toplevel() {
                       local foo="in fn"
                       nested
                     }
                     nested() {
                          foo="in nested"
                     }
                     setopt warn_nested_var
                     toplevel

   History
       APPEND_HISTORY <D>
              If  this  is set, zsh sessions will append their history list to
              the history file, rather than replace it. Thus, multiple  paral-
              lel  zsh  sessions will all have the new entries from their his-
              tory lists added to the history file, in  the  order  that  they
              exit.  The file will still be periodically re-written to trim it
              when the number of lines grows 20% beyond the value specified by
              $SAVEHIST (see also the HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY option).

       BANG_HIST (+K) <C> <Z>
              Perform textual history expansion, csh-style, treating the char-
              acter `!' specially.

       EXTENDED_HISTORY <C>
              Save each command's beginning timestamp (in  seconds  since  the
              epoch)  and  the duration (in seconds) to the history file.  The
              format of this prefixed data is:

              `: <beginning time>:<elapsed seconds>;<command>'.

       HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER
              Add `|' to output redirections in the history.  This allows his-
              tory references to clobber files even when CLOBBER is unset.

       HIST_BEEP <D>
              Beep  in  ZLE  when  a widget attempts to access a history entry
              which isn't there.

       HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST
              If the internal history needs to be trimmed to add  the  current
              command  line, setting this option will cause the oldest history
              event that has a duplicate to be lost  before  losing  a  unique
              event  from  the  list.   You should be sure to set the value of
              HISTSIZE to a larger number than SAVEHIST in order to  give  you
              some  room for the duplicated events, otherwise this option will
              behave just like HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS once the history fills  up
              with unique events.

       HIST_FCNTL_LOCK
              When  writing  out  the history file, by default zsh uses ad-hoc
              file locking to avoid known problems with locking on some  oper-
              ating systems.  With this option locking is done by means of the
              system's fcntl call, where this method is available.  On  recent
              operating  systems  this may provide better performance, in par-
              ticular avoiding history corruption when  files  are  stored  on
              NFS.

       HIST_FIND_NO_DUPS
              When  searching  for  history entries in the line editor, do not
              display duplicates of a line previously found, even if  the  du-
              plicates are not contiguous.

       HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS
              If a new command line being added to the history list duplicates
              an older one, the older command is removed from the  list  (even
              if it is not the previous event).

       HIST_IGNORE_DUPS (-h)
              Do not enter command lines into the history list if they are du-
              plicates of the previous event.

       HIST_IGNORE_SPACE (-g)
              Remove command lines from the history list when the first  char-
              acter  on  the  line  is  a  space,  or when one of the expanded
              aliases contains a leading  space.   Only  normal  aliases  (not
              global  or  suffix  aliases) have this behaviour.  Note that the
              command lingers in the internal history until the  next  command
              is  entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse or
              edit the line.  If you want to make it vanish right away without
              entering another command, type a space and press return.

       HIST_LEX_WORDS
              By  default,  shell  history that is read in from files is split
              into words on all white space.  This means that  arguments  with
              quoted  whitespace  are  not  correctly handled, with the conse-
              quence that references to words in history lines that have  been
              read  from  a  file may be inaccurate.  When this option is set,
              words read in from a history file are divided up  in  a  similar
              fashion  to  normal  shell command line handling.  Although this
              produces more accurately delimited words, if  the  size  of  the
              history file is large this can be slow.  Trial and error is nec-
              essary to decide.

       HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS
              Remove function definitions from the history  list.   Note  that
              the function lingers in the internal history until the next com-
              mand is entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly  re-
              use or edit the definition.

       HIST_NO_STORE
              Remove  the  history  (fc -l) command from the history list when
              invoked.  Note that the command lingers in the internal  history
              until  the  next command is entered before it vanishes, allowing
              you to briefly reuse or edit the line.

       HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
              Remove superfluous blanks from each command line being added  to
              the history list.

       HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY <D>
              When  the  history  file  is re-written, we normally write out a
              copy of the file named $HISTFILE.new and then rename it over the
              old  one.  However, if this option is unset, we instead truncate
              the old history file and write out the new version in-place.  If
              one  of  the  history-appending  options is enabled, this option
              only has an effect when the enlarged history file  needs  to  be
              re-written  to  trim  it down to size.  Disable this only if you
              have special needs, as doing so makes it possible to  lose  his-
              tory entries if zsh gets interrupted during the save.

              When  writing  out a copy of the history file, zsh preserves the
              old file's permissions and group information, but will refuse to
              write  out  a  new  file  if  it would change the history file's
              owner.

       HIST_SAVE_NO_DUPS
              When writing out the history file, older commands that duplicate
              newer ones are omitted.

       HIST_VERIFY
              Whenever  the  user  enters a line with history expansion, don't
              execute the line directly; instead,  perform  history  expansion
              and reload the line into the editing buffer.

       INC_APPEND_HISTORY
              This  option  works  like APPEND_HISTORY except that new history
              lines are added to the $HISTFILE incrementally (as soon as  they
              are  entered),  rather  than waiting until the shell exits.  The
              file will still be periodically re-written to trim it  when  the
              number  of  lines grows 20% beyond the value specified by $SAVE-
              HIST (see also the HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY option).

       INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME
              This option is a variant of INC_APPEND_HISTORY in  which,  where
              possible, the history entry is written out to the file after the
              command is finished, so that the time taken by  the  command  is
              recorded  correctly in the history file in EXTENDED_HISTORY for-
              mat.  This means that the history entry will  not  be  available
              immediately from other instances of the shell that are using the
              same history file.

              This option is only useful if INC_APPEND_HISTORY and  SHARE_HIS-
              TORY are turned off.  The three options should be considered mu-
              tually exclusive.

       SHARE_HISTORY <K>

              This option both imports new commands from the history file, and
              also  causes  your  typed commands to be appended to the history
              file (the latter is like  specifying  INC_APPEND_HISTORY,  which
              should  be turned off if this option is in effect).  The history
              lines are  also  output  with  timestamps  ala  EXTENDED_HISTORY
              (which  makes it easier to find the spot where we left off read-
              ing the file after it gets re-written).

              By default, history movement commands visit the  imported  lines
              as  well  as the local lines, but you can toggle this on and off
              with the set-local-history zle binding.  It is also possible  to
              create a zle widget that will make some commands ignore imported
              commands, and some include them.

              If you find that you want more control over  when  commands  get
              imported,  you  may  wish  to  turn  SHARE_HISTORY  off, INC_AP-
              PEND_HISTORY or INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME (see above) on, and then
              manually import commands whenever you need them using `fc -RI'.

   Initialisation
       ALL_EXPORT (-a, ksh: -a)
              All parameters subsequently defined are automatically exported.

       GLOBAL_EXPORT <Z>
              If  this  option is set, passing the -x flag to the builtins de-
              clare, float, integer, readonly and typeset (but not local) will
              also set the -g flag;  hence parameters exported to the environ-
              ment will not be made local to the  enclosing  function,  unless
              they  were  already  or the flag +g is given explicitly.  If the
              option is unset, exported parameters will be made local in  just
              the same way as any other parameter.

              This  option is set by default for backward compatibility; it is
              not recommended that its behaviour be relied  upon.   Note  that
              the  builtin  export  always  sets both the -x and -g flags, and
              hence its effect extends beyond the scope of the enclosing func-
              tion; this is the most portable way to achieve this behaviour.

       GLOBAL_RCS (+d) <D>
              If  this  option  is unset, the startup files /etc/zsh/zprofile,
              /etc/zsh/zshrc, /etc/zsh/zlogin and /etc/zsh/zlogout will not be
              run.   It  can be disabled and re-enabled at any time, including
              inside local startup files (.zshrc, etc.).

       RCS (+f) <D>
              After /etc/zsh/zshenv is sourced on startup, source the .zshenv,
              /etc/zsh/zprofile,     .zprofile,     /etc/zsh/zshrc,    .zshrc,
              /etc/zsh/zlogin, .zlogin, and .zlogout files,  as  described  in
              the   section   `Files'.    If   this   option   is  unset,  the
              /etc/zsh/zshenv file is still sourced, but  any  of  the  others
              will  not be; it can be set at any time to prevent the remaining
              startup files after  the  currently  executing  one  from  being
              sourced.

   Input/Output
       ALIASES <D>
              Expand aliases.

       CLOBBER (+C, ksh: +C) <D>
              Allows  `>'  redirection  to truncate existing files.  Otherwise
              `>!' or `>|' must be used to truncate a file.

              If the option is not set, and the option APPEND_CREATE  is  also
              not  set,  `>>!' or `>>|' must be used to create a file.  If ei-
              ther option is set, `>>' may be used.

       CLOBBER_EMPTY
              This option is only used if the option CLOBBER is not set:  note
              that it is set by default.

              If  this option is set, then regular files of zero length may be
              ovewritten (`clobbered').  Note  that  it  is  possible  another
              process has written to the file between this test and use of the
              file by the current process.  This option should  therefore  not
              be  used  in cases where files to be clobbered may be written to
              asynchronously.

       CORRECT (-0)
              Try to correct the spelling of commands.  Note  that,  when  the
              HASH_LIST_ALL  option is not set or when some directories in the
              path are not readable, this may falsely report  spelling  errors
              the first time some commands are used.

              The  shell  variable  CORRECT_IGNORE  may be set to a pattern to
              match words that will never be offered as corrections.

       CORRECT_ALL (-O)
              Try to correct the spelling of all arguments in a line.

              The shell variable CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE may be set to  a  pattern
              to match file names that will never be offered as corrections.

       DVORAK Use  the Dvorak keyboard instead of the standard qwerty keyboard
              as a basis for examining spelling mistakes for the  CORRECT  and
              CORRECT_ALL options and the spell-word editor command.

       FLOW_CONTROL <D>
              If  this  option  is  unset,  output flow control via start/stop
              characters (usually  assigned  to  ^S/^Q)  is  disabled  in  the
              shell's editor.

       IGNORE_EOF (-7)
              Do  not  exit on end-of-file.  Require the use of exit or logout
              instead.  However, ten consecutive EOFs will cause the shell  to
              exit anyway, to avoid the shell hanging if its tty goes away.

              Also,  if  this  option  is set and the Zsh Line Editor is used,
              widgets implemented by shell functions can be bound to EOF (nor-
              mally  Control-D)  without  printing the normal warning message.
              This works only for normal widgets, not for completion widgets.

       INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS (-k) <K> <S>
              Allow comments even in interactive shells.

       HASH_CMDS <D>
              Note the location of each command the first time it is executed.
              Subsequent  invocations  of  the same command will use the saved
              location, avoiding a path search.  If this option is  unset,  no
              path hashing is done at all.  However, when CORRECT is set, com-
              mands whose names do not appear in the functions or aliases hash
              tables  are  hashed in order to avoid reporting them as spelling
              errors.

       HASH_DIRS <D>
              Whenever a command name is hashed, hash the directory containing
              it,  as  well as all directories that occur earlier in the path.
              Has no effect if neither HASH_CMDS nor CORRECT is set.

       HASH_EXECUTABLES_ONLY
              When hashing commands because of HASH_CMDS, check that the  file
              to be hashed is actually an executable.  This option is unset by
              default as if the path contains a large number of  commands,  or
              consists  of  many remote files, the additional tests can take a
              long time.  Trial and error is needed to show if this option  is
              beneficial.

       MAIL_WARNING (-U)
              Print  a  warning message if a mail file has been accessed since
              the shell last checked.

       PATH_DIRS (-Q)
              Perform a path search even on  command  names  with  slashes  in
              them.  Thus if `/usr/local/bin' is in the user's path, and he or
              she types `X11/xinit',  the  command  `/usr/local/bin/X11/xinit'
              will  be executed (assuming it exists).  Commands explicitly be-
              ginning with `/', `./' or `../' are  not  subject  to  the  path
              search.  This also applies to the `.' and source builtins.

              Note  that  subdirectories  of  the current directory are always
              searched for executables specified in  this  form.   This  takes
              place before any search indicated by this option, and regardless
              of whether `.' or the current directory appear  in  the  command
              search path.

       PATH_SCRIPT <K> <S>
              If  this option is not set, a script passed as the first non-op-
              tion argument to the shell must contain the name of the file  to
              open.   If this option is set, and the script does not specify a
              directory path, the script is looked for first  in  the  current
              directory, then in the command path.  See the section INVOCATION
              in zsh(1).

       PRINT_EIGHT_BIT
              Print eight bit characters literally in completion  lists,  etc.
              This  option  is  not necessary if your system correctly returns
              the printability of eight bit characters (see ctype(3)).

       PRINT_EXIT_VALUE (-1)
              Print the exit value of  programs  with  non-zero  exit  status.
              This  is  only  available  at  the  command  line in interactive
              shells.

       RC_QUOTES
              Allow the character sequence `'''  to  signify  a  single  quote
              within  singly  quoted  strings.   Note  this  does not apply in
              quoted strings using the format $'...', where a backslashed sin-
              gle quote can be used.

       RM_STAR_SILENT (-H) <K> <S>
              Do not query the user before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*'.

       RM_STAR_WAIT
              If  querying  the  user  before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*',
              first wait ten seconds and ignore anything typed in  that  time.
              This  avoids  the  problem of reflexively answering `yes' to the
              query when one didn't really mean it.  The wait  and  query  can
              always be avoided by expanding the `*' in ZLE (with tab).

       SHORT_LOOPS <C> <Z>
              Allow  the  short forms of for, repeat, select, if, and function
              constructs.

       SHORT_REPEAT
              Allow the short form repeat as SHORT_LOOPS but without  enabling
              it for the other constructs.

       SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK (-L)
              If  a line ends with a backquote, and there are an odd number of
              backquotes on the line, ignore the trailing backquote.  This  is
              useful  on some keyboards where the return key is too small, and
              the backquote key lies annoyingly close to it.  As  an  alterna-
              tive the variable KEYBOARD_HACK lets you choose the character to
              be removed.

   Job Control
       AUTO_CONTINUE
              With this option set, stopped jobs that are removed from the job
              table  with  the disown builtin command are automatically sent a
              CONT signal to make them running.

       AUTO_RESUME (-W)
              Treat single word simple commands without redirection as  candi-
              dates for resumption of an existing job.

       BG_NICE (-6) <C> <Z>
              Run all background jobs at a lower priority.  This option is set
              by default.

       CHECK_JOBS <Z>
              Report the status of background and suspended jobs before  exit-
              ing a shell with job control; a second attempt to exit the shell
              will succeed.  NO_CHECK_JOBS is best used  only  in  combination
              with NO_HUP, else such jobs will be killed automatically.

              The  check is omitted if the commands run from the previous com-
              mand line included a `jobs' command, since  it  is  assumed  the
              user  is  aware  that there are background or suspended jobs.  A
              `jobs' command run from one of the hook functions defined in the
              section  SPECIAL FUNCTIONS in zshmisc(1) is not counted for this
              purpose.

       CHECK_RUNNING_JOBS <Z>
              Check for both running and suspended jobs when CHECK_JOBS is en-
              abled.   When  this option is disabled, zsh checks only for sus-
              pended jobs, which matches the default behavior of bash.

              This option has no effect unless CHECK_JOBS is set.

       HUP <Z>
              Send the HUP signal to running jobs when the shell exits.

       LONG_LIST_JOBS (-R)
              Print job notifications in the long format by default.

       MONITOR (-m, ksh: -m)
              Allow job control.  Set by default in interactive shells.

       NOTIFY (-5, ksh: -b) <Z>
              Report the status of background jobs  immediately,  rather  than
              waiting until just before printing a prompt.

       POSIX_JOBS <K> <S>
              This  option  makes  job  control  more compliant with the POSIX
              standard.

              When the option is not set, the MONITOR option is unset on entry
              to subshells, so that job control is no longer active.  When the
              option is set, the MONITOR option and job control remain  active
              in  the  subshell,  but  note that the subshell has no access to
              jobs in the parent shell.

              When the option is not set, jobs put in the background or  fore-
              ground  with  bg  or  fg are displayed with the same information
              that would be reported by jobs.  When the option  is  set,  only
              the  text  is  printed.   The output from jobs itself is not af-
              fected by the option.

              When the option is not set,  job  information  from  the  parent
              shell is saved for output within a subshell (for example, within
              a pipeline).  When the option is set,  the  output  of  jobs  is
              empty until a job is started within the subshell.

              In  previous  versions  of the shell, it was necessary to enable
              POSIX_JOBS in order for the builtin command wait to  return  the
              status  of  background jobs that had already exited.  This is no
              longer the case.

   Prompting
       PROMPT_BANG <K>
              If set, `!' is treated specially in prompt expansion.   See  EX-
              PANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

       PROMPT_CR (+V) <D>
              Print  a  carriage  return  just before printing a prompt in the
              line editor.  This is on by default  as  multi-line  editing  is
              only  possible  if  the editor knows where the start of the line
              appears.

       PROMPT_SP <D>
              Attempt to preserve a partial line (i.e. a line that did not end
              with  a  newline) that would otherwise be covered up by the com-
              mand prompt due to the PROMPT_CR option.   This  works  by  out-
              putting  some  cursor-control  characters, including a series of
              spaces, that should make the terminal wrap to the next line when
              a  partial line is present (note that this is only successful if
              your terminal has automatic margins, which is typical).

              When a partial line is preserved, by default you will see an in-
              verse+bold  character at the end of the partial line:  a `%' for
              a normal user or a `#' for root.  If set,  the  shell  parameter
              PROMPT_EOL_MARK  can be used to customize how the end of partial
              lines are shown.

              NOTE: if the PROMPT_CR option is not set, enabling  this  option
              will have no effect.  This option is on by default.

       PROMPT_PERCENT <C> <Z>
              If  set,  `%' is treated specially in prompt expansion.  See EX-
              PANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

       PROMPT_SUBST <K> <S>
              If set, parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic
              expansion   are  performed  in  prompts.   Substitutions  within
              prompts do not affect the command status.

       TRANSIENT_RPROMPT
              Remove any right prompt from display when  accepting  a  command
              line.   This  may  be useful with terminals with other cut/paste
              methods.

   Scripts and Functions
       ALIAS_FUNC_DEF <S>
              By default, zsh does not allow the definition of functions using
              the  `name  ()'  syntax  if  name was expanded as an alias: this
              causes an error.  This is usually the desired behaviour, as oth-
              erwise  the  combination of an alias and a function based on the
              same definition can easily cause problems.

              When this option is set, aliases can be used for defining  func-
              tions.

              For  example,  consider  the following definitions as they might
              occur in a startup file.

                     alias foo=bar
                     foo() {
                       print This probably does not do what you expect.
                     }

              Here, foo is expanded as an alias to bar before the  ()  is  en-
              countered,  so  the function defined would be named bar.  By de-
              fault this is instead an error in native mode.  Note that  quot-
              ing  any  part  of the function name, or using the keyword func-
              tion, avoids the problem, so is recommended  when  the  function
              name can also be an alias.

       C_BASES
              Output hexadecimal numbers in the standard C format, for example
              `0xFF' instead of the usual `16#FF'.  If the option OCTAL_ZEROES
              is  also  set  (it  is  not  by  default), octal numbers will be
              treated similarly and hence appear as `077' instead  of  `8#77'.
              This  option has no effect on the choice of the output base, nor
              on the output of bases other than hexadecimal and  octal.   Note
              that  these  formats will be understood on input irrespective of
              the setting of C_BASES.

       C_PRECEDENCES
              This alters the precedence of arithmetic operators  to  be  more
              like  C  and other programming languages; the section ARITHMETIC
              EVALUATION in zshmisc(1) has an explicit list.

       DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD <D>
              Run the DEBUG trap before each command; otherwise it is run  af-
              ter  each  command.  Setting this option mimics the behaviour of
              ksh 93; with the option unset the behaviour is that of ksh 88.

       ERR_EXIT (-e, ksh: -e)
              If a command has a non-zero exit status, execute the ZERR  trap,
              if set, and exit.  This is disabled while running initialization
              scripts.

              The behaviour is also disabled inside DEBUG traps.  In this case
              the  option  is  handled  specially: it is unset on entry to the
              trap.  If the option DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set, as it  is  by  de-
              fault,  and  the  option  ERR_EXIT  is found to have been set on
              exit, then the command for which the DEBUG trap  is  being  exe-
              cuted is skipped.  The option is restored after the trap exits.

              Non-zero status in a command list containing && or || is ignored
              for commands not at the end of the list.  Hence

                     false && true

              does not trigger exit.

              Exiting due to ERR_EXIT has certain interactions with  asynchro-
              nous jobs noted in the section JOBS in zshmisc(1).

       ERR_RETURN
              If a command has a non-zero exit status, return immediately from
              the enclosing function.   The  logic  is  similar  to  that  for
              ERR_EXIT,  except  that an implicit return statement is executed
              instead of an exit.  This will trigger an exit at the  outermost
              level of a non-interactive script.

              Normally  this  option  inherits  the behaviour of ERR_EXIT that
              code followed by `&&' `||' does not trigger a return.  Hence  in
              the following:

                     summit || true

              no return is forced as the combined effect always has a zero re-
              turn status.

              Note. however, that if summit in the above example is  itself  a
              function,  code inside it is considered separately: it may force
              a return from summit (assuming the  option  remains  set  within
              summit),  but not from the enclosing context.  This behaviour is
              different from ERR_EXIT which is unaffected by function scope.

       EVAL_LINENO <Z>
              If set, line numbers of expressions evaluated using the  builtin
              eval  are tracked separately of the enclosing environment.  This
              applies both to the parameter LINENO and the line number  output
              by  the  prompt escape %i.  If the option is set, the prompt es-
              cape %N will output the string `(eval)' instead of the script or
              function  name  as  an indication.   (The two prompt escapes are
              typically used in the parameter PS4 to be output when the option
              XTRACE is set.)  If EVAL_LINENO is unset, the line number of the
              surrounding script or function is retained  during  the  evalua-
              tion.

       EXEC (+n, ksh: +n) <D>
              Do execute commands.  Without this option, commands are read and
              checked for syntax errors, but not executed.  This option cannot
              be  turned off in an interactive shell, except when `-n' is sup-
              plied to the shell at startup.

       FUNCTION_ARGZERO <C> <Z>
              When executing a shell function or sourcing  a  script,  set  $0
              temporarily  to the name of the function/script.  Note that tog-
              gling FUNCTION_ARGZERO from on to off (or off to  on)  does  not
              change  the  current  value of $0.  Only the state upon entry to
              the function or script has an effect.  Compare POSIX_ARGZERO.

       LOCAL_LOOPS
              When this option is not set, the effect of  break  and  continue
              commands  may  propagate outside function scope, affecting loops
              in calling functions.  When the option is set in a calling func-
              tion,  a  break or a continue that is not caught within a called
              function (regardless of the setting of the  option  within  that
              function) produces a warning and the effect is cancelled.

       LOCAL_OPTIONS <K>
              If  this option is set at the point of return from a shell func-
              tion, most options (including this one) which were in force upon
              entry  to  the  function  are restored; options that are not re-
              stored are PRIVILEGED and RESTRICTED.  Otherwise, only this  op-
              tion,  and  the LOCAL_LOOPS, XTRACE and PRINT_EXIT_VALUE options
              are restored.  Hence if this is  explicitly  unset  by  a  shell
              function  the other options in force at the point of return will
              remain so.  A shell function can also guarantee itself  a  known
              shell  configuration  with  a formulation like `emulate -L zsh';
              the -L activates LOCAL_OPTIONS.

       LOCAL_PATTERNS
              If this option is set at the point of return from a shell  func-
              tion,  the  state  of  pattern disables, as set with the builtin
              command `disable -p', is restored to what it was when the  func-
              tion  was  entered.   The behaviour of this option is similar to
              the effect of LOCAL_OPTIONS on options; hence  `emulate  -L  sh'
              (or indeed any other emulation with the -L option) activates LO-
              CAL_PATTERNS.

       LOCAL_TRAPS <K>
              If this option is set when a signal trap is set inside  a  func-
              tion,  then the previous status of the trap for that signal will
              be restored when the function exits.  Note that this option must
              be  set  prior to altering the trap behaviour in a function; un-
              like LOCAL_OPTIONS, the value on exit from the function  is  ir-
              relevant.  However, it does not need to be set before any global
              trap for that to be correctly restored by a function.  For exam-
              ple,

                     unsetopt localtraps
                     trap - INT
                     fn() { setopt localtraps; trap '' INT; sleep 3; }

              will restore normal handling of SIGINT after the function exits.

       MULTI_FUNC_DEF <Z>
              Allow definitions of multiple functions at once in the form `fn1
              fn2...()'; if the option is not set, this causes a parse  error.
              Definition  of  multiple  functions with the function keyword is
              always allowed.  Multiple function  definitions  are  not  often
              used and can cause obscure errors.

       MULTIOS <Z>
              Perform implicit tees or cats when multiple redirections are at-
              tempted (see the section `Redirection').

       OCTAL_ZEROES <S>
              Interpret any integer constant beginning with a 0 as octal,  per
              IEEE  Std 1003.2-1992 (ISO 9945-2:1993).  This is not enabled by
              default as it causes problems with parsing of, for example, date
              and time strings with leading zeroes.

              Sequences  of  digits indicating a numeric base such as the `08'
              component in `08#77' are always interpreted as decimal,  regard-
              less of leading zeroes.

       PIPE_FAIL
              By  default,  when  a pipeline exits the exit status recorded by
              the shell and returned by the shell variable $? reflects that of
              the rightmost element of a pipeline.  If this option is set, the
              exit status instead reflects the status of the rightmost element
              of  the  pipeline that was non-zero, or zero if all elements ex-
              ited with zero status.

       SOURCE_TRACE
              If set, zsh will print an informational message  announcing  the
              name of each file it loads.  The format of the output is similar
              to that for the XTRACE option, with the  message  <sourcetrace>.
              A  file  may be loaded by the shell itself when it starts up and
              shuts down  (Startup/Shutdown  Files)  or  by  the  use  of  the
              `source' and `dot' builtin commands.

       TYPESET_SILENT
              If  this is unset, executing any of the `typeset' family of com-
              mands with no options and a list of parameters that have no val-
              ues  to  be assigned but already exist will display the value of
              the parameter.  If the option is set, they will  only  be  shown
              when  parameters  are selected with the `-m' option.  The option
              `-p' is available whether or not the option is set.

       TYPESET_TO_UNSET <K> <S>
              When declaring a new parameter with any of the `typeset'  family
              of  related commands, the parameter remains unset unless and un-
              til a value is explicitly assigned to it, either in  the  `type-
              set' command itself or as a later assignment statement.

       VERBOSE (-v, ksh: -v)
              Print shell input lines as they are read.

       XTRACE (-x, ksh: -x)
              Print  commands  and  their arguments as they are executed.  The
              output is preceded by the value of $PS4, formatted as  described
              in the section EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

   Shell Emulation
       APPEND_CREATE <K> <S>
              This option only applies when NO_CLOBBER (-C) is in effect.

              If this option is not set, the shell will report an error when a
              append redirection (>>) is used on a file that does not  already
              exists  (the  traditional  zsh behaviour of NO_CLOBBER).  If the
              option is set, no error is reported (POSIX behaviour).

       BASH_REMATCH
              When set, matches performed with the =~ operator  will  set  the
              BASH_REMATCH  array  variable,  instead of the default MATCH and
              match variables.  The first element of  the  BASH_REMATCH  array
              will  contain  the  entire  matched text and subsequent elements
              will contain extracted substrings.  This option makes more sense
              when  KSH_ARRAYS is also set, so that the entire matched portion
              is stored at index 0 and the first  substring  is  at  index  1.
              Without  this  option,  the  MATCH  variable contains the entire
              matched text and the match array variable contains substrings.

       BSD_ECHO <S>
              Make the echo builtin compatible with the BSD  echo(1)  command.
              This  disables  backslashed escape sequences in echo strings un-
              less the -e option is specified.

       CONTINUE_ON_ERROR
              If a fatal error is encountered (see the section ERRORS in  zsh-
              misc(1)),  and  the  code is running in a script, the shell will
              resume execution at the next statement in the script at the  top
              level,  in other words outside all functions or shell constructs
              such as loops and conditions.  This mimics the behaviour of  in-
              teractive  shells, where the shell returns to the line editor to
              read a new command; it was the normal behaviour in  versions  of
              zsh before 5.0.1.

       CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY <C>
              A history reference without an event specifier will always refer
              to the previous command.  Without this option,  such  a  history
              reference  refers to the same event as the previous history ref-
              erence on the current command line, defaulting to  the  previous
              command.

       CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS <C>
              Allow  loop  bodies  to take the form `list; end' instead of `do
              list; done'.

       CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES <C>
              Changes the rules for single- and double-quoted  text  to  match
              that  of  csh.  These require that embedded newlines be preceded
              by a backslash; unescaped newlines will cause an error  message.
              In  double-quoted  strings, it is made impossible to escape `$',
              ``' or `"' (and `\' itself no longer needs  escaping).   Command
              substitutions are only expanded once, and cannot be nested.

       CSH_NULLCMD <C>
              Do  not  use  the values of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when running
              redirections with no command.  This make such redirections  fail
              (see the section `Redirection').

       KSH_ARRAYS <K> <S>
              Emulate  ksh array handling as closely as possible.  If this op-
              tion is set, array elements are numbered from zero, an array pa-
              rameter without subscript refers to the first element instead of
              the whole array, and braces are required to delimit a  subscript
              (`${path[2]}' rather than just `$path[2]') or to apply modifiers
              to any parameter (`${PWD:h}' rather than `$PWD:h').

       KSH_AUTOLOAD <K> <S>
              Emulate ksh function autoloading.  This means that when a  func-
              tion  is  autoloaded, the corresponding file is merely executed,
              and must define the function itself.  (By default, the  function
              is  defined to the contents of the file.  However, the most com-
              mon ksh-style case - of the file containing only a simple  defi-
              nition of the function - is always handled in the ksh-compatible
              manner.)

       KSH_OPTION_PRINT <K>
              Alters the way options settings are printed: instead of separate
              lists  of  set  and unset options, all options are shown, marked
              `on' if they are in the non-default state, `off' otherwise.

       KSH_TYPESET
              This option is now obsolete: a better appropximation to the  be-
              haviour  of  other shells is obtained with the reserved word in-
              terface to declare, export, float, integer, local, readonly  and
              typeset.  Note that the option is only applied when the reserved
              word interface is not in use.

              Alters the way arguments to the typeset family of commands,  in-
              cluding declare, export, float, integer, local and readonly, are
              processed.  Without this option, zsh will  perform  normal  word
              splitting  after command and parameter expansion in arguments of
              an assignment; with it, word splitting does not  take  place  in
              those cases.

       KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT
              Treat  use  of  a subscript of value zero in array or string ex-
              pressions as a reference to the first element, i.e. the  element
              that usually has the subscript 1.  Ignored if KSH_ARRAYS is also
              set.

              If neither this option nor KSH_ARRAYS is set, accesses to an el-
              ement  of an array or string with subscript zero return an empty
              element or string, while attempts to set element zero of an  ar-
              ray or string are treated as an error.  However, attempts to set
              an otherwise valid subscript range that includes zero will  suc-
              ceed.  For example, if KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT is not set,

                     array[0]=(element)

              is an error, while

                     array[0,1]=(element)

              is not and will replace the first element of the array.

              This  option  is  for  compatibility  with older versions of the
              shell and is not recommended in new code.

       POSIX_ALIASES <K> <S>
              When this option is set, reserved words are not  candidates  for
              alias expansion:  it is still possible to declare any of them as
              an alias, but the alias will never be expanded.  Reserved  words
              are described in the section RESERVED WORDS in zshmisc(1).

              Alias expansion takes place while text is being read; hence when
              this option is set it does not take effect until the end of  any
              function  or other piece of shell code parsed as one unit.  Note
              this may cause differences from other shells even when  the  op-
              tion  is  in  effect.   For example, when running a command with
              `zsh -c', or even `zsh -o posixaliases -c', the  entire  command
              argument  is  parsed  as one unit, so aliases defined within the
              argument are not available even in later lines.   If  in  doubt,
              avoid use of aliases in non-interactive code.

       POSIX_ARGZERO
              This  option may be used to temporarily disable FUNCTION_ARGZERO
              and thereby restore the value of $0 to the name used  to  invoke
              the  shell  (or as set by the -c command line option).  For com-
              patibility with previous versions of the shell,  emulations  use
              NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO  instead  of POSIX_ARGZERO, which may result
              in unexpected scoping of $0 if the emulation mode is changed in-
              side  a  function  or  script.  To avoid this, explicitly enable
              POSIX_ARGZERO in the emulate command:

                     emulate sh -o POSIX_ARGZERO

              Note that NO_POSIX_ARGZERO has no effect unless FUNCTION_ARGZERO
              was already enabled upon entry to the function or script.

       POSIX_BUILTINS <K> <S>
              When  this option is set the command builtin can be used to exe-
              cute shell builtin commands.   Parameter  assignments  specified
              before  shell  functions and special builtins are kept after the
              command completes unless the special builtin  is  prefixed  with
              the  command  builtin.   Special  builtins are ., :, break, con-
              tinue, declare, eval, exit, export,  integer,  local,  readonly,
              return, set, shift, source, times, trap and unset.

              In  addition, various error conditions associated with the above
              builtins or exec cause a non-interactive shell to  exit  and  an
              interactive shell to return to its top-level processing.

              Furthermore, functions and shell builtins are not executed after
              an exec prefix; the command to be executed must be  an  external
              command found in the path.

              Furthermore,  the  getopts builtin behaves in a POSIX-compatible
              fashion in that the associated variable OPTIND is not made local
              to  functions,  and its value is calculated differently to match
              other shells.

              Moreover, the warning and special exit code from [[ -o non_exis-
              tent_option ]] are suppressed.

       POSIX_IDENTIFIERS <K> <S>
              When  this option is set, only the ASCII characters a to z, A to
              Z, 0 to 9 and _ may be used in identifiers (names of  shell  pa-
              rameters and modules).

              In  addition, setting this option limits the effect of parameter
              substitution with no  braces,  so  that  the  expression  $#  is
              treated  as the parameter $# even if followed by a valid parame-
              ter name.  When it is unset, zsh allows expressions of the  form
              $#name  to  refer to the length of $name, even for special vari-
              ables, for example in expressions such as $#- and $#*.

              Another difference is that with the option set assignment to  an
              unset  variable  in arithmetic context causes the variable to be
              created as a scalar rather than a numeric type.  So after `unset
              t;  ((  t  =  3 ))'. without POSIX_IDENTIFIERS set t has integer
              type, while with it set it has scalar type.

              When the option is unset and multibyte character support is  en-
              abled  (i.e. it is compiled in and the option MULTIBYTE is set),
              then additionally any alphanumeric characters in the local char-
              acter  set  may  be  used in identifiers.  Note that scripts and
              functions written with this feature are not portable,  and  also
              that  both  options must be set before the script or function is
              parsed; setting them during execution is not sufficient  as  the
              syntax  variable=value  has  already  been  parsed  as a command
              rather than an assignment.

              If multibyte character support is not compiled  into  the  shell
              this  option  is ignored; all octets with the top bit set may be
              used in identifiers.  This is non-standard  but  is  the  tradi-
              tional zsh behaviour.

       POSIX_STRINGS <K> <S>
              This  option affects processing of quoted strings.  Currently it
              only affects the behaviour of null characters, i.e. character  0
              in the portable character set corresponding to US ASCII.

              When  this  option  is  not set, null characters embedded within
              strings of the form $'...' are treated as  ordinary  characters.
              The  entire  string is maintained within the shell and output to
              files where necessary, although owing to restrictions of the li-
              brary interface the string is truncated at the null character in
              file names, environment variables, or in arguments  to  external
              programs.

              When  this  option is set, the $'...' expression is truncated at
              the null character.  Note  that  remaining  parts  of  the  same
              string beyond the termination of the quotes are not truncated.

              For example, the command line argument a$'b\0c'd is treated with
              the option off as the characters a, b, null, c, d, and with  the
              option on as the characters a, b, d.

       POSIX_TRAPS <K> <S>
              When  this  option  is set, the usual zsh behaviour of executing
              traps for EXIT on exit from shell functions is  suppressed.   In
              that case, manipulating EXIT traps always alters the global trap
              for exiting the shell; the LOCAL_TRAPS option is ignored for the
              EXIT trap.

              Also,  a  return  statement  executed in a trap with no argument
              passes back from the function the  value  from  the  surrounding
              context, not from code executed within the trap.

              Furthermore, if a trap is set to be ignored, this state persists
              when a subshell is entered.  Without the option, the trap  would
              be reset to its default state at this point.

       SH_FILE_EXPANSION <K> <S>
              Perform  filename expansion (e.g., ~ expansion) before parameter
              expansion, command substitution, arithmetic expansion and  brace
              expansion.  If this option is unset, it is performed after brace
              expansion, so things like `~$USERNAME' and `~{pfalstad,rc}' will
              work.

       SH_NULLCMD <K> <S>
              Do  not  use  the  values  of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when doing
              redirections, use `:' instead (see the section `Redirection').

       SH_OPTION_LETTERS <K> <S>
              If this option is set the shell tries to interpret single letter
              options  (which  are  used  with  set and setopt) like ksh does.
              This also affects the value of the - special parameter.

       SH_WORD_SPLIT (-y) <K> <S>
              Causes field splitting to be performed on unquoted parameter ex-
              pansions.   Note  that  this  option has nothing to do with word
              splitting.  (See zshexpn(1).)

       TRAPS_ASYNC
              While waiting for a program to  exit,  handle  signals  and  run
              traps  immediately.   Otherwise  the  trap  is run after a child
              process has exited.  Note this does  not  affect  the  point  at
              which  traps  are  run for any case other than when the shell is
              waiting for a child process.

   Shell State
       INTERACTIVE (-i, ksh: -i)
              This is an interactive shell.  This option is set upon initiali-
              sation  if  the  standard  input is a tty and commands are being
              read from standard input.  (See the discussion  of  SHIN_STDIN.)
              This  heuristic may be overridden by specifying a state for this
              option on the command line.  The value of this option  can  only
              be  changed  via  flags supplied at invocation of the shell.  It
              cannot be changed once zsh is running.

       LOGIN (-l, ksh: -l)
              This is a login shell.  If this option is  not  explicitly  set,
              the  shell  becomes  a login shell if the first character of the
              argv[0] passed to the shell is a `-'.

       PRIVILEGED (-p, ksh: -p)
              Turn on privileged mode. Typically this is used when  script  is
              to  be run with elevated privileges. This should be done as fol-
              lows directly with the -p option to zsh so that it takes  effect
              during startup.

                     #!/bin/zsh -p

              The  option is enabled automatically on startup if the effective
              user (group) ID is not equal to the real  user  (group)  ID.  In
              this  case, turning the option off causes the effective user and
              group IDs to be set to the real user and  group  IDs.  Be  aware
              that  if  that fails the shell may be running with different IDs
              than was intended so a script should check for failure  and  act
              accordingly, for example:

                     unsetopt privileged || exit

              The  PRIVILEGED option disables sourcing user startup files.  If
              zsh  is  invoked  as  `sh'  or  `ksh'  with  this  option   set,
              /etc/suid_profile  is sourced (after /etc/profile on interactive
              shells). Sourcing ~/.profile is disabled and the contents of the
              ENV variable is ignored. This option cannot be changed using the
              -m option of setopt and unsetopt, and changing it inside a func-
              tion  always changes it globally regardless of the LOCAL_OPTIONS
              option.

       RESTRICTED (-r)
              Enables restricted mode.  This option cannot  be  changed  using
              unsetopt,  and  setting  it  inside a function always changes it
              globally regardless of the LOCAL_OPTIONS option.  See  the  sec-
              tion `Restricted Shell'.

       SHIN_STDIN (-s, ksh: -s)
              Commands  are  being read from the standard input.  Commands are
              read from standard input if no command is specified with -c  and
              no  file of commands is specified.  If SHIN_STDIN is set explic-
              itly on the command line, any argument that would otherwise have
              been  taken as a file to run will instead be treated as a normal
              positional parameter.  Note that setting or unsetting  this  op-
              tion  on  the command line does not necessarily affect the state
              the option will have while the shell is running - that is purely
              an  indicator of whether or not commands are actually being read
              from standard input.  The value  of  this  option  can  only  be
              changed  via flags supplied at invocation of the shell.  It can-
              not be changed once zsh is running.

       SINGLE_COMMAND (-t, ksh: -t)
              If the shell is reading from standard input, it  exits  after  a
              single  command  has  been  executed.  This also makes the shell
              non-interactive, unless the INTERACTIVE option is explicitly set
              on  the  command  line.   The  value  of this option can only be
              changed via flags supplied at invocation of the shell.  It  can-
              not be changed once zsh is running.

   Zle
       BEEP (+B) <D>
              Beep on error in ZLE.

       COMBINING_CHARS
              Assume  that  the  terminal  displays  combining characters cor-
              rectly.  Specifically, if a base alphanumeric character is  fol-
              lowed  by  one or more zero-width punctuation characters, assume
              that the zero-width characters will be  displayed  as  modifica-
              tions to the base character within the same width.  Not all ter-
              minals handle this.  If this option is not set, zero-width char-
              acters are displayed separately with special mark-up.

              If  this  option  is  set, the pattern test [[:WORD:]] matches a
              zero-width punctuation character on the assumption that it  will
              be  used as part of a word in combination with a word character.
              Otherwise the base shell does not  handle  combining  characters
              specially.

       EMACS  If  ZLE is loaded, turning on this option has the equivalent ef-
              fect of `bindkey -e'.  In addition,  the  VI  option  is  unset.
              Turning it off has no effect.  The option setting is not guaran-
              teed to reflect the current keymap.  This option is provided for
              compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.

       OVERSTRIKE
              Start up the line editor in overstrike mode.

       SINGLE_LINE_ZLE (-M) <K>
              Use single-line command line editing instead of multi-line.

              Note  that  although  this  is on by default in ksh emulation it
              only provides superficial compatibility with the ksh line editor
              and reduces the effectiveness of the zsh line editor.  As it has
              no effect on shell syntax, many users may wish to  disable  this
              option when using ksh emulation interactively.

       VI     If  ZLE is loaded, turning on this option has the equivalent ef-
              fect of `bindkey -v'.  In addition, the EMACS option  is  unset.
              Turning it off has no effect.  The option setting is not guaran-
              teed to reflect the current keymap.  This option is provided for
              compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.

       ZLE (-Z)
              Use  the  zsh line editor.  Set by default in interactive shells
              connected to a terminal.

OPTION ALIASES
       Some options have alternative names.  These aliases are never used  for
       output,  but  can be used just like normal option names when specifying
       options to the shell.

       BRACE_EXPAND
              NO_IGNORE_BRACES (ksh and bash compatibility)

       DOT_GLOB
              GLOB_DOTS (bash compatibility)

       HASH_ALL
              HASH_CMDS (bash compatibility)

       HIST_APPEND
              APPEND_HISTORY (bash compatibility)

       HIST_EXPAND
              BANG_HIST (bash compatibility)

       LOG    NO_HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS (ksh compatibility)

       MAIL_WARN
              MAIL_WARNING (bash compatibility)

       ONE_CMD
              SINGLE_COMMAND (bash compatibility)

       PHYSICAL
              CHASE_LINKS (ksh and bash compatibility)

       PROMPT_VARS
              PROMPT_SUBST (bash compatibility)

       STDIN  SHIN_STDIN (ksh compatibility)

       TRACK_ALL
              HASH_CMDS (ksh compatibility)

SINGLE LETTER OPTIONS
   Default set
       -0     CORRECT
       -1     PRINT_EXIT_VALUE
       -2     NO_BAD_PATTERN
       -3     NO_NOMATCH
       -4     GLOB_DOTS
       -5     NOTIFY
       -6     BG_NICE
       -7     IGNORE_EOF
       -8     MARK_DIRS
       -9     AUTO_LIST
       -B     NO_BEEP
       -C     NO_CLOBBER
       -D     PUSHD_TO_HOME
       -E     PUSHD_SILENT
       -F     NO_GLOB
       -G     NULL_GLOB
       -H     RM_STAR_SILENT
       -I     IGNORE_BRACES
       -J     AUTO_CD
       -K     NO_BANG_HIST
       -L     SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK
       -M     SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
       -N     AUTO_PUSHD
       -O     CORRECT_ALL
       -P     RC_EXPAND_PARAM
       -Q     PATH_DIRS
       -R     LONG_LIST_JOBS
       -S     REC_EXACT
       -T     CDABLE_VARS
       -U     MAIL_WARNING
       -V     NO_PROMPT_CR
       -W     AUTO_RESUME
       -X     LIST_TYPES
       -Y     MENU_COMPLETE
       -Z     ZLE
       -a     ALL_EXPORT
       -e     ERR_EXIT
       -f     NO_RCS
       -g     HIST_IGNORE_SPACE
       -h     HIST_IGNORE_DUPS
       -i     INTERACTIVE
       -k     INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
       -l     LOGIN
       -m     MONITOR
       -n     NO_EXEC
       -p     PRIVILEGED
       -r     RESTRICTED
       -s     SHIN_STDIN
       -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
       -u     NO_UNSET
       -v     VERBOSE
       -w     CHASE_LINKS
       -x     XTRACE
       -y     SH_WORD_SPLIT

   sh/ksh emulation set
       -C     NO_CLOBBER
       -T     TRAPS_ASYNC
       -X     MARK_DIRS
       -a     ALL_EXPORT
       -b     NOTIFY
       -e     ERR_EXIT
       -f     NO_GLOB
       -i     INTERACTIVE
       -l     LOGIN
       -m     MONITOR
       -n     NO_EXEC
       -p     PRIVILEGED
       -r     RESTRICTED
       -s     SHIN_STDIN
       -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
       -u     NO_UNSET
       -v     VERBOSE
       -x     XTRACE

   Also note
       -A     Used by set for setting arrays
       -b     Used on the command line to specify end of option processing
       -c     Used on the command line to specify a single command
       -m     Used by setopt for pattern-matching option setting
       -o     Used in all places to allow use of long option names
       -s     Used by set to sort positional parameters

ZSHBUILTINS(1)              General Commands Manual             ZSHBUILTINS(1)

NAME
       zshbuiltins - zsh built-in commands

SHELL BUILTIN COMMANDS
       Some shell builtin commands take options as described in individual en-
       tries;  these  are  often  referred  to in the list below as `flags' to
       avoid confusion with shell options, which may also have  an  effect  on
       the  behaviour of builtin commands.  In this introductory section, `op-
       tion' always has the meaning of an option to a command that  should  be
       familiar to most command line users.

       Typically,  options  are  single letters preceded by a hyphen (-).  Op-
       tions that take an argument accept it either immediately following  the
       option  letter  or after white space, for example `print -C3 {1..9}' or
       `print -C 3 {1..9}' are equivalent.  Arguments to options are  not  the
       same  as arguments to the command; the documentation indicates which is
       which.  Options that do not take an argument may be combined in a  sin-
       gle  word,  for example `print -rca -- *' and `print -r -c -a -- *' are
       equivalent.

       Some shell builtin commands also take options that begin with  `+'  in-
       stead of `-'.  The list below makes clear which commands these are.

       Options  (together with their individual arguments, if any) must appear
       in a group before any non-option arguments; once the  first  non-option
       argument has been found, option processing is terminated.

       All  builtin  commands other than `echo' and precommand modifiers, even
       those that have no options, can be given the argument `--' to terminate
       option processing.  This indicates that the following words are non-op-
       tion arguments, but is otherwise ignored.   This  is  useful  in  cases
       where arguments to the command may begin with `-'.  For historical rea-
       sons, most builtin commands (including `echo') also recognize a  single
       `-'  in  a separate word for this purpose; note that this is less stan-
       dard and use of `--' is recommended.

       - simple command
              See the section `Precommand Modifiers' in zshmisc(1).

       . file [ arg ... ]
              Read commands from file and execute them in  the  current  shell
              environment.

              If  file  does  not contain a slash, or if PATH_DIRS is set, the
              shell looks in the components of $path  to  find  the  directory
              containing  file.   Files  in the current directory are not read
              unless  `.'  appears  somewhere  in  $path.   If  a  file  named
              `file.zwc'  is  found,  is  newer than file, and is the compiled
              form (created with the zcompile builtin) of file, then  commands
              are read from that file instead of file.

              If  any  arguments arg are given, they become the positional pa-
              rameters; the old positional parameters are  restored  when  the
              file is done executing.  However, if no arguments are given, the
              positional parameters remain those of the calling  context,  and
              no restoring is done.

              If  file  was  not  found  the return status is 127; if file was
              found but contained a syntax error the  return  status  is  126;
              else  the  return  status is the exit status of the last command
              executed.

       : [ arg ... ]
              This command does nothing, although normal  argument  expansions
              is performed which may have effects on shell parameters.  A zero
              exit status is returned.

       alias [ {+|-}gmrsL ] [ name[=value] ... ]
              For each name with a corresponding value, define an  alias  with
              that  value.   A trailing space in value causes the next word to
              be checked for alias expansion.  If the -g flag is present,  de-
              fine a global alias; global aliases are expanded even if they do
              not occur in command position:

                     % perldoc --help 2>&1 | grep 'built-in functions'
                         -f   Search Perl built-in functions
                     % alias -g HG='--help 2>&1 | grep'
                     % perldoc HG 'built-in functions'
                         -f   Search Perl built-in functions

              If the -s flag is present, define a suffix alias: if the command
              word on a command line is in the form `text.name', where text is
              any  non-empty  string,  it  is  replaced  by  the  text  `value
              text.name'.   Note that name is treated as a literal string, not
              a pattern.  A trailing space in value is  not  special  in  this
              case.  For example,

                     alias -s ps='gv --'

              will  cause  the  command `*.ps' to be expanded to `gv -- *.ps'.
              As alias expansion is carried out  earlier  than  globbing,  the
              `*.ps'  will then be expanded.  Suffix aliases constitute a dif-
              ferent name space from other aliases (so in the above example it
              is still possible to create an alias for the command ps) and the
              two sets are never listed together.

              For each name with no value, print the value of  name,  if  any.
              With  no  arguments,  print  all currently defined aliases other
              than suffix aliases.  If the -m flag is given the arguments  are
              taken  as  patterns (they should be quoted to preserve them from
              being interpreted as glob patterns), and  the  aliases  matching
              these  patterns  are  printed.  When printing aliases and one of
              the -g, -r or -s flags is  present,  restrict  the  printing  to
              global, regular or suffix aliases, respectively; a regular alias
              is one which is neither a global nor a suffix alias.   Using `+'
              instead  of  `-',  or  ending the option list with a single `+',
              prevents the values of the aliases from being printed.

              If the -L flag is present, then print each  alias  in  a  manner
              suitable  for  putting  in a startup script.  The exit status is
              nonzero if a name (with no value) is given for  which  no  alias
              has been defined.

              For  more  on  aliases, include common problems, see the section
              ALIASING in zshmisc(1).

       autoload [ {+|-}RTUXdkmrtWz ] [ -w ] [ name ... ]
              See the section `Autoloading Functions' in zshmisc(1)  for  full
              details.  The fpath parameter will be searched to find the func-
              tion definition when the function is first referenced.

              If name consists of an absolute path, the function is defined to
              load  from  the file given (searching as usual for dump files in
              the given location).  The name of the function is  the  basename
              (non-directory  part)  of  the file.  It is normally an error if
              the function is not found in the given location; however, if the
              option  -d  is  given,  searching  for  the function defaults to
              $fpath.  If a function is loaded by absolute path, any functions
              loaded  from it that are marked for autoload without an absolute
              path have the load  path  of  the  parent  function  temporarily
              prepended to $fpath.

              If  the  option  -r or -R is given, the function is searched for
              immediately and the location is recorded internally for use when
              the  function is executed; a relative path is expanded using the
              value of $PWD.  This protects against a change to  $fpath  after
              the call to autoload.  With -r, if the function is not found, it
              is silently left unresolved until execution; with -R,  an  error
              message  is  printed  and command processing aborted immediately
              the search fails, i.e. at the autoload command  rather  than  at
              function execution..

              The flag -X may be used only inside a shell function.  It causes
              the calling function to be marked for autoloading and then imme-
              diately  loaded  and  executed,  with the current array of posi-
              tional parameters as arguments.  This replaces the previous def-
              inition of the function.  If no function definition is found, an
              error is printed and the function remains undefined  and  marked
              for  autoloading.   If an argument is given, it is used as a di-
              rectory (i.e. it does not include the name of the  function)  in
              which the function is to be found; this may be combined with the
              -d option to allow the function search to default to  $fpath  if
              it is not in the given location.

              The  flag  +X  attempts to load each name as an autoloaded func-
              tion, but does not execute it.  The exit status  is  zero  (suc-
              cess)  if  the function was not previously defined and a defini-
              tion for it was found.  This does not replace any existing defi-
              nition of the function.  The exit status is nonzero (failure) if
              the function was already  defined  or  when  no  definition  was
              found.   In  the  latter case the function remains undefined and
              marked for autoloading.  If ksh-style  autoloading  is  enabled,
              the  function created will contain the contents of the file plus
              a call to the function itself appended to it, thus giving normal
              ksh autoloading behaviour on the first call to the function.  If
              the -m flag is also given each name is treated as a pattern  and
              all functions already marked for autoload that match the pattern
              are loaded.

              With the -t flag, turn on execution tracing; with  -T,  turn  on
              execution  tracing only for the current function, turning it off
              on entry to any called functions that do not also  have  tracing
              enabled.

              With  the  -U flag, alias expansion is suppressed when the func-
              tion is loaded.

              With the -w flag, the names are taken as names of files compiled
              with the zcompile builtin, and all functions defined in them are
              marked for autoloading.

              The flags -z and -k mark the function to be autoloaded using the
              zsh  or  ksh  style, as if the option KSH_AUTOLOAD were unset or
              were set, respectively.  The flags override the setting  of  the
              option at the time the function is loaded.

              Note  that  the  autoload command makes no attempt to ensure the
              shell options set during the loading or execution  of  the  file
              have any particular value.  For this, the emulate command can be
              used:

                     emulate zsh -c 'autoload -Uz func'

              arranges that when func is loaded the shell is in native zsh em-
              ulation, and this emulation is also applied when func is run.

              Some of the functions of autoload are also provided by functions
              -u or functions -U, but autoload is a more comprehensive  inter-
              face.

       bg [ job ... ]
       job ... &
              Put  each specified job in the background, or the current job if
              none is specified.

       bindkey
              See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       break [ n ]
              Exit from an enclosing for, while, until, select or repeat loop.
              If  an arithmetic expression n is specified, then break n levels
              instead of just one.

       builtin name [ args ... ]
              Executes the builtin name, with the given args.

       bye    Same as exit.

       cap    See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       cd [ -qsLP ] [ arg ]
       cd [ -qsLP ] old new
       cd [ -qsLP ] {+|-}n
              Change the current directory.  In the  first  form,  change  the
              current directory to arg, or to the value of $HOME if arg is not
              specified.  If arg is `-', change to the previous directory.

              Otherwise, if arg begins with a slash, attempt to change to  the
              directory given by arg.

              If  arg  does  not  begin with a slash, the behaviour depends on
              whether the current directory `.' occurs in the list of directo-
              ries  contained  in the shell parameter cdpath.  If it does not,
              first attempt to change to the directory arg under  the  current
              directory,  and  if that fails but cdpath is set and contains at
              least one element attempt to change to the directory  arg  under
              each  component  of cdpath in turn until successful.  If `.' oc-
              curs in cdpath, then cdpath is searched  strictly  in  order  so
              that `.' is only tried at the appropriate point.

              The  order  of testing cdpath is modified if the option POSIX_CD
              is set, as described in the documentation for the option.

              If no directory is found, the option CDABLE_VARS is set,  and  a
              parameter  named  arg  exists  whose  value begins with a slash,
              treat its value as the directory.  In that case,  the  parameter
              is added to the named directory hash table.

              The  second form of cd substitutes the string new for the string
              old in the name of the current directory, and tries to change to
              this new directory.

              The third form of cd extracts an entry from the directory stack,
              and changes to that directory.  An argument  of  the  form  `+n'
              identifies  a  stack entry by counting from the left of the list
              shown by the dirs command, starting with zero.  An  argument  of
              the  form `-n' counts from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option
              is set, the meanings of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.
              If the POSIX_CD option is set, this form of cd is not recognised
              and will be interpreted as the first form.

              If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook  function  chpwd
              and  the  functions in the array chpwd_functions are not called.
              This is useful for calls to cd that do not change  the  environ-
              ment seen by an interactive user.

              If  the -s option is specified, cd refuses to change the current
              directory if the given pathname contains symlinks.   If  the  -P
              option is given or the CHASE_LINKS option is set, symbolic links
              are resolved to their true values.  If the -L  option  is  given
              symbolic  links are retained in the directory (and not resolved)
              regardless of the state of the CHASE_LINKS option.

       chdir  Same as cd.

       clone  See the section `The zsh/clone Module' in zshmodules(1).

       command [ -pvV ] simple command
              The simple command argument is taken as an external command  in-
              stead  of  a  function  or  builtin  and  is  executed.  If  the
              POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, builtins will also be executed but
              certain  special  properties of them are suppressed. The -p flag
              causes a default path to be searched instead of that  in  $path.
              With  the  -v flag, command is similar to whence and with -V, it
              is equivalent to whence -v.

              See also the section `Precommand Modifiers' in zshmisc(1).

       comparguments
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compcall
              See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compctl
              See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compdescribe
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compfiles
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compgroups
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compquote
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       comptags
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       comptry
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compvalues
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       continue [ n ]
              Resume the next iteration of the enclosing  for,  while,  until,
              select  or  repeat loop. If an arithmetic expression n is speci-
              fied, break out of n-1 loops and resume  at  the  nth  enclosing
              loop.

       declare
              Same as typeset.

       dirs [ -c ] [ arg ... ]
       dirs [ -lpv ]
              With  no  arguments,  print the contents of the directory stack.
              Directories are added to this stack with the pushd command,  and
              removed  with  the cd or popd commands.  If arguments are speci-
              fied, load them onto the  directory  stack,  replacing  anything
              that was there, and push the current directory onto the stack.

              -c     clear the directory stack.

              -l     print directory names in full instead of using of using ~
                     expressions (see Dynamic and Static named directories  in
                     zshexpn(1)).

              -p     print directory entries one per line.

              -v     number the directories in the stack when printing.

       disable [ -afmprs ] name ...
              Temporarily  disable  the named hash table elements or patterns.
              The default is to disable builtin commands.  This allows you  to
              use an external command with the same name as a builtin command.
              The -a option  causes  disable  to  act  on  regular  or  global
              aliases.  The -s option causes disable to act on suffix aliases.
              The -f option causes disable to act on shell functions.  The  -r
              options  causes disable to act on reserved words.  Without argu-
              ments all disabled hash table elements  from  the  corresponding
              hash  table  are  printed.   With  the -m flag the arguments are
              taken as patterns (which should be quoted to prevent  them  from
              undergoing filename expansion), and all hash table elements from
              the corresponding hash table matching these  patterns  are  dis-
              abled.  Disabled objects can be enabled with the enable command.

              With  the  option  -p, name ... refer to elements of the shell's
              pattern syntax as described in  the  section  `Filename  Genera-
              tion'.   Certain  elements  can be disabled separately, as given
              below.

              Note that patterns not allowed by the current settings  for  the
              options  EXTENDED_GLOB,  KSH_GLOB and SH_GLOB are never enabled,
              regardless of the setting here.  For example,  if  EXTENDED_GLOB
              is  not active, the pattern ^ is ineffective even if `disable -p
              "^"' has not been issued.  The list below indicates  any  option
              settings  that  restrict  the  use of the pattern.  It should be
              noted that setting SH_GLOB has a wider effect than  merely  dis-
              abling  patterns as certain expressions, in particular those in-
              volving parentheses, are parsed differently.

              The following patterns may be disabled;  all  the  strings  need
              quoting  on  the  command line to prevent them from being inter-
              preted immediately as patterns and the patterns are shown  below
              in single quotes as a reminder.

              '?'    The  pattern  character  ?  wherever it occurs, including
                     when preceding a parenthesis with KSH_GLOB.

              '*'    The pattern character * wherever it occurs, including re-
                     cursive  globbing  and  when preceding a parenthesis with
                     KSH_GLOB.

              '['    Character classes.

              '<' (NO_SH_GLOB)
                     Numeric ranges.

              '|' (NO_SH_GLOB)
                     Alternation in  grouped  patterns,  case  statements,  or
                     KSH_GLOB parenthesised expressions.

              '(' (NO_SH_GLOB)
                     Grouping  using  single parentheses.  Disabling this does
                     not disable the use of  parentheses  for  KSH_GLOB  where
                     they  are introduced by a special character, nor for glob
                     qualifiers (use  `setopt  NO_BARE_GLOB_QUAL'  to  disable
                     glob qualifiers that use parentheses only).

              '~' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
                     Exclusion in the form A~B.

              '^' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
                     Exclusion in the form A^B.

              '#' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
                     The pattern character # wherever it occurs, both for rep-
                     etition of a previous pattern and for indicating globbing
                     flags.

              '?(' (KSH_GLOB)
                     The  grouping form ?(...).  Note this is also disabled if
                     '?' is disabled.

              '*(' (KSH_GLOB)
                     The grouping form *(...).  Note this is also disabled  if
                     '*' is disabled.

              '+(' (KSH_GLOB)
                     The grouping form +(...).

              '!(' (KSH_GLOB)
                     The grouping form !(...).

              '@(' (KSH_GLOB)
                     The grouping form @(...).

       disown [ job ... ]
       job ... &|
       job ... &!
              Remove  the specified jobs from the job table; the shell will no
              longer report their status, and will not complain if you try  to
              exit  an  interactive shell with them running or stopped.  If no
              job is specified, disown the current job.

              If the jobs are currently stopped and the  AUTO_CONTINUE  option
              is  not  set,  a warning is printed containing information about
              how to make them running after they have been disowned.  If  one
              of  the latter two forms is used, the jobs will automatically be
              made running, independent of the setting  of  the  AUTO_CONTINUE
              option.

       echo [ -neE ] [ arg ... ]
              Write  each  arg on the standard output, with a space separating
              each one.  If the -n flag is not present, print a newline at the
              end.  echo recognizes the following escape sequences:

              \a     bell character
              \b     backspace
              \c     suppress subsequent characters and final newline
              \e     escape
              \f     form feed
              \n     linefeed (newline)
              \r     carriage return
              \t     horizontal tab
              \v     vertical tab
              \\     backslash
              \0NNN  character code in octal
              \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
              \uNNNN unicode character code in hexadecimal
              \UNNNNNNNN
                     unicode character code in hexadecimal

              The  -E  flag,  or  the  BSD_ECHO option, can be used to disable
              these escape sequences.  In the latter case, -e flag can be used
              to enable them.

              Note that for standards compliance a double dash does not termi-
              nate option processing; instead, it is printed  directly.   How-
              ever,  a  single  dash  does terminate option processing, so the
              first dash, possibly following options, is not printed, but  ev-
              erything  following  it  is  printed as an argument.  The single
              dash behaviour is different from other shells.  For a more  por-
              table  way of printing text, see printf, and for a more control-
              lable way of printing text within zsh, see print.

       echotc See the section `The zsh/termcap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       echoti See the section `The zsh/terminfo Module' in zshmodules(1).

       emulate [ -lLR ] [ {zsh|sh|ksh|csh} [ flags ... ] ]
              Without any argument print current emulation mode.

              With single argument set up zsh options to emulate the specified
              shell  as  much  as possible.  csh will never be fully emulated.
              If the argument is not one of the shells listed above, zsh  will
              be used as a default; more precisely, the tests performed on the
              argument are the same as those used to determine  the  emulation
              at  startup based on the shell name, see the section COMPATIBIL-
              ITY in zsh(1) .  In addition to setting shell options, the  com-
              mand  also restores the pristine state of pattern enables, as if
              all patterns had been enabled using enable -p.

              If the emulate command occurs inside a function  that  has  been
              marked  for  execution tracing with functions -t then the xtrace
              option will be turned on regardless of emulation mode  or  other
              options.   Note that code executed inside the function by the .,
              source, or eval commands is not considered  to  be  running  di-
              rectly from the function, hence does not provoke this behaviour.

              If  the  -R  switch  is given, all settable options are reset to
              their default value corresponding  to  the  specified  emulation
              mode,  except for certain options describing the interactive en-
              vironment; otherwise, only those options likely to cause  porta-
              bility problems in scripts and functions are altered.  If the -L
              switch is given, the options LOCAL_OPTIONS,  LOCAL_PATTERNS  and
              LOCAL_TRAPS will be set as well, causing the effects of the emu-
              late command and any setopt, disable -p or enable -p,  and  trap
              commands  to be local to the immediately surrounding shell func-
              tion, if any; normally these options are turned off in all  emu-
              lation  modes  except  ksh.  The -L switch is mutually exclusive
              with the use of -c in flags.

              If there is a single argument and the -l switch  is  given,  the
              options  that  would  be set or unset (the latter indicated with
              the prefix `no') are listed.  -l can be combined with -L  or  -R
              and  the list will be modified in the appropriate way.  Note the
              list does not depend on the current setting of options, i.e.  it
              includes  all  options  that  may  in principle change, not just
              those that would actually change.

              The flags may be any of the invocation-time flags  described  in
              the section INVOCATION in zsh(1), except that `-o EMACS' and `-o
              VI' may not be used.  Flags such as `+r'/`+o RESTRICTED' may  be
              prohibited in some circumstances.

              If -c arg appears in flags, arg is evaluated while the requested
              emulation is temporarily in effect.  In this case the  emulation
              mode  and  all options are restored to their previous values be-
              fore emulate returns.  The -R switch may precede the name of the
              shell  to emulate; note this has a meaning distinct from includ-
              ing -R in flags.

              Use of -c enables `sticky' emulation mode for functions  defined
              within  the evaluated expression:  the emulation mode is associ-
              ated thereafter with the function so that whenever the  function
              is executed the emulation (respecting the -R switch, if present)
              and all options are set (and pattern  disables  cleared)  before
              entry to the function, and the state is restored after exit.  If
              the function is called when the sticky emulation is  already  in
              effect, either within an `emulate shell -c' expression or within
              another function with the same sticky emulation, entry and  exit
              from the function do not cause options to be altered (except due
              to standard processing such as the LOCAL_OPTIONS option).   This
              also  applies to functions marked for autoload within the sticky
              emulation; the appropriate set of options will be applied at the
              point the function is loaded as well as when it is run.

              For example:

                     emulate sh -c 'fni() { setopt cshnullglob; }
                     fno() { fni; }'
                     fno

              The  two functions fni and fno are defined with sticky sh emula-
              tion.  fno is then executed, causing options associated with em-
              ulations  to  be set to their values in sh.  fno then calls fni;
              because fni is also marked for sticky sh  emulation,  no  option
              changes  take  place on entry to or exit from it.  Hence the op-
              tion cshnullglob, turned off by sh emulation, will be turned  on
              within  fni  and remain on return to fno.  On exit from fno, the
              emulation mode and all options will be  restored  to  the  state
              they were in before entry to the temporary emulation.

              The documentation above is typically sufficient for the intended
              purpose of executing code designed for other shells in  a  suit-
              able environment.  More detailed rules follow.
              1.     The  sticky  emulation  environment  provided by `emulate
                     shell -c' is identical to that provided  by  entry  to  a
                     function  marked for sticky emulation as a consequence of
                     being defined in such an environment.  Hence,  for  exam-
                     ple,  the  sticky  emulation is inherited by subfunctions
                     defined within functions with sticky emulation.
              2.     No change of options takes place on entry to or exit from
                     functions that are not marked for sticky emulation, other
                     than those that would normally take place, even if  those
                     functions are called within sticky emulation.
              3.     No  special handling is provided for functions marked for
                     autoload nor for functions present in wordcode created by
                     the zcompile command.
              4.     The  presence or absence of the -R switch to emulate cor-
                     responds to different sticky emulation modes, so for  ex-
                     ample  `emulate  sh  -c', `emulate -R sh -c' and `emulate
                     csh -c' are treated as three distinct sticky emulations.
              5.     Difference in shell options supplied in addition  to  the
                     basic  emulation also mean the sticky emulations are dif-
                     ferent, so for example `emulate zsh -c' and `emulate  zsh
                     -o cbases -c' are treated as distinct sticky emulations.

       enable [ -afmprs ] name ...
              Enable  the  named hash table elements, presumably disabled ear-
              lier with disable.  The default is to enable  builtin  commands.
              The -a option causes enable to act on regular or global aliases.
              The -s option causes enable to act on suffix  aliases.   The  -f
              option  causes  enable to act on shell functions.  The -r option
              causes enable to act on reserved words.  Without  arguments  all
              enabled  hash  table  elements from the corresponding hash table
              are printed.  With the -m flag the arguments are taken  as  pat-
              terns  (should  be  quoted) and all hash table elements from the
              corresponding hash table matching these  patterns  are  enabled.
              Enabled  objects  can  be disabled with the disable builtin com-
              mand.

              enable -p reenables patterns disabled  with  disable  -p.   Note
              that it does not override globbing options; for example, `enable
              -p "~"' does not cause the pattern character ~ to be active  un-
              less the EXTENDED_GLOB option is also set.  To enable all possi-
              ble patterns (so that they may  be  individually  disabled  with
              disable -p), use `setopt EXTENDED_GLOB KSH_GLOB NO_SH_GLOB'.

       eval [ arg ... ]
              Read the arguments as input to the shell and execute the result-
              ing command(s) in the current shell process.  The return  status
              is the same as if the commands had been executed directly by the
              shell; if there are no args or they contain  no  commands  (i.e.
              are an empty string or whitespace) the return status is zero.

       exec [ -cl ] [ -a argv0 ] [ command [ arg ... ] ]
              Replace  the current shell with command rather than forking.  If
              command is a shell builtin command  or  a  shell  function,  the
              shell executes it, and exits when the command is complete.

              With  -c clear the environment; with -l prepend - to the argv[0]
              string of the command executed (to simulate a login shell); with
              -a  argv0  set  the argv[0] string of the command executed.  See
              the section `Precommand Modifiers' in zshmisc(1).

              If the option POSIX_BUILTINS is set,  command  is  never  inter-
              preted as a shell builtin command or shell function.  This means
              further precommand modifiers such as builtin and noglob are also
              not interpreted within the shell.  Hence command is always found
              by searching the command path.

              If command is omitted but any redirections are  specified,  then
              the redirections will take effect in the current shell.

       exit [ n ]
              Exit  the  shell with the exit status specified by an arithmetic
              expression n; if none is specified, use the exit status from the
              last  command  executed.   An  EOF condition will also cause the
              shell to exit, unless the IGNORE_EOF option is set.

              See notes at the end of the section JOBS in zshmisc(1) for  some
              possibly unexpected interactions of the exit command with jobs.

       export [ name[=value] ... ]
              The specified names are marked for automatic export to the envi-
              ronment of subsequently executed commands.  Equivalent to  type-
              set -gx.  If a parameter specified does not already exist, it is
              created in the global scope.

       false [ arg ... ]
              Do nothing and return an exit status of 1.

       fc [ -e ename ] [ -s ] [ -LI ] [ -m match ] [ old=new ... ] [  first  [
       last ] ]
       fc -l [ -LI ] [ -nrdfEiD ] [ -t timefmt ] [ -m match ]
             [ old=new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]
       fc -p [ -a ] [ filename [ histsize [ savehistsize ] ] ]
       fc -P
       fc -ARWI [ filename ]
              The fc command controls the interactive history mechanism.  Note
              that reading and writing of history options is only performed if
              the  shell  is  interactive.  Usually this is detected automati-
              cally, but it can be forced by setting  the  interactive  option
              when starting the shell.

              The  first  two  forms  of this command select a range of events
              from first to last from the history list.  The  arguments  first
              and  last  may be specified as a number or as a string.  A nega-
              tive number is used as an offset to the  current  history  event
              number.  A string specifies the most recent event beginning with
              the given string.  All substitutions old=new, if any,  are  then
              performed on the text of the events.

              The  range of events selected by numbers can be narrowed further
              by the following flags.
              -I     restricts to only internal events (not from $HISTFILE)
              -L     restricts to only local events (not  from  other  shells,
                     see SHARE_HISTORY in zshoptions(1) -- note that $HISTFILE
                     is considered local when read at startup)
              -m     takes the first argument as a pattern  (which  should  be
                     quoted) and only the history events matching this pattern
                     are considered

              If first is not specified, it will be set to -1 (the most recent
              event), or to -16 if the -l flag is given.  If last is not spec-
              ified, it will be set to first, or to  -1  if  the  -l  flag  is
              given.   However,  if the current event has added entries to the
              history with `print -s' or `fc -R', then the default last for -l
              includes all new history entries since the current event began.

              When  the  -l  flag is given, the resulting events are listed on
              standard output.  Otherwise the editor program specified  by  -e
              ename  is invoked on a file containing these history events.  If
              -e is not given, the value of the parameter FCEDIT is  used;  if
              that  is  not  set the value of the parameter EDITOR is used; if
              that is not set a builtin default, usually  `vi'  is  used.   If
              ename  is  `-', no editor is invoked.  When editing is complete,
              the edited command is executed.

              The flag `-s' is equivalent to `-e -'.  The flag -r reverses the
              order  of  the  events  and the flag -n suppresses event numbers
              when listing.

              Also when listing,
              -d     prints timestamps for each event
              -f     prints full time-date stamps in the US  `MM/DD/YY  hh:mm'
                     format
              -E     prints  full time-date stamps in the European `dd.mm.yyyy
                     hh:mm' format
              -i     prints  full  time-date  stamps  in  ISO8601  `yyyy-mm-dd
                     hh:mm' format
              -t fmt prints  time  and date stamps in the given format; fmt is
                     formatted with the strftime function with the zsh  exten-
                     sions  described  for the %D{string} prompt format in the
                     section EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).  The
                     resulting formatted string must be no more than 256 char-
                     acters or will not be printed
              -D     prints elapsed times; may be combined with one of the op-
                     tions above

              `fc  -p'  pushes  the  current  history  list  onto  a stack and
              switches to a new history list.  If the -a option is also speci-
              fied,  this  history  list will be automatically popped when the
              current function scope is exited, which is a much  better  solu-
              tion than creating a trap function to call `fc -P' manually.  If
              no arguments are specified, the  history  list  is  left  empty,
              $HISTFILE  is  unset, and $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are set to their
              default values.  If one argument is given, $HISTFILE is  set  to
              that filename, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are left unchanged, and the
              history file is read in (if it exists)  to  initialize  the  new
              list.   If a second argument is specified, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST
              are instead set to the single specified numeric value.  Finally,
              if a third argument is specified, $SAVEHIST is set to a separate
              value from $HISTSIZE.  You are free to change these  environment
              values  for  the new history list however you desire in order to
              manipulate the new history list.

              `fc -P' pops the history list back to an older list saved by `fc
              -p'.   The  current  list is saved to its $HISTFILE before it is
              destroyed (assuming that $HISTFILE and $SAVEHIST are set  appro-
              priately,  of  course).  The values of $HISTFILE, $HISTSIZE, and
              $SAVEHIST are restored to the values they had when `fc  -p'  was
              called.   Note  that  this  restoration can conflict with making
              these variables "local", so your best bet is to avoid local dec-
              larations  for  these  variables  in functions that use `fc -p'.
              The one other guaranteed-safe  combination  is  declaring  these
              variables  to be local at the top of your function and using the
              automatic option (-a) with `fc -p'.  Finally, note  that  it  is
              legal to manually pop a push marked for automatic popping if you
              need to do so before the function exits.

              `fc -R' reads the history from the given file,  `fc  -W'  writes
              the  history out to the given file, and `fc -A' appends the his-
              tory out to the given file.  If no filename  is  specified,  the
              $HISTFILE  is  assumed.   If  the -I option is added to -R, only
              those events that are not already contained within the  internal
              history  list are added.  If the -I option is added to -A or -W,
              only those events  that  are  new  since  last  incremental  ap-
              pend/write  to  the  history  file are appended/written.  In any
              case, the created file will have no more than $SAVEHIST entries.

       fg [ job ... ]
       job ...
              Bring each specified job in turn to the foreground.  If  no  job
              is specified, resume the current job.

       float [ {+|-}Hghlprtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZ [ n ] ] [ name[=value] ... ]
              Equivalent  to  typeset  -E,  except  that options irrelevant to
              floating point numbers are not permitted.

       functions [ {+|-}UkmtTuWz ] [ -x num ] [ name ... ]
       functions -c oldfn newfn
       functions -M [-s] mathfn [ min [ max [ shellfn ] ] ]
       functions -M [ -m pattern ... ]
       functions +M [ -m ] mathfn ...
              Equivalent to typeset -f, with the exception of the -c,  -x,  -M
              and  -W  options.   For  functions  -u and functions -U, see au-
              toload, which provides additional options.  For functions -t and
              functions -T, see typeset -f.

              The -x option indicates that any functions output will have each
              leading tab for indentation, added by the shell to show  syntac-
              tic  structure, expanded to the given number num of spaces.  num
              can also be 0 to suppress all indentation.

              The -W option turns on the option WARN_NESTED_VAR for the  named
              function  or  functions  only.   The option is turned off at the
              start of nested functions (apart from anonoymous functions)  un-
              less the called function also has the -W attribute.

              The  -c  option causes oldfn to be copied to newfn.  The copy is
              efficiently handled internally by reference counting.  If  oldfn
              was marked for autoload it is first loaded and if this fails the
              copy fails.  Either function may subsequently be redefined with-
              out  affecting  the other.  A typical idiom is that oldfn is the
              name of a library shell function which is then redefined to call
              newfn, thereby installing a modified version of the function.

              The -M and +M flags

              Use of the -M option may not be combined with any of the options
              handled by typeset -f.

              functions -M mathfn defines mathfn as the name of a mathematical
              function  recognised  in  all forms of arithmetical expressions;
              see the section `Arithmetic Evaluation' in zshmisc(1).   By  de-
              fault  mathfn  may take any number of comma-separated arguments.
              If min is given, it must have exactly min args; if min  and  max
              are  both given, it must have at least min and at most max args.
              max may be -1 to indicate that there is no upper limit.

              By default the function is implemented by a  shell  function  of
              the  same name; if shellfn is specified it gives the name of the
              corresponding shell function while mathfn remains the name  used
              in  arithmetical expressions.  The name of the function in $0 is
              mathfn (not shellfn as would usually be the case), provided  the
              option FUNCTION_ARGZERO is in effect.  The positional parameters
              in the shell function correspond to the arguments of the  mathe-
              matical function call.

              The  result of the last arithmetical expression evaluated inside
              the shell function gives the result of  the  mathematical  func-
              tion.   This  is  not limited to arithmetic substitutions of the
              form $((...)), but also includes arithmetical expressions evalu-
              ated  in any other way, including by the let builtin, by ((...))
              statements, and even by the return builtin  and  by  array  sub-
              scripts.   Therefore,  care must be taken not to use syntactical
              constructs that perform arithmetic evaluation  after  evaluating
              what is to be the result of the function.  For example:

                     # WRONG
                     zmath_cube() {
                       (( $1 * $1 * $1 ))
                       return 0
                     }
                     functions -M cube 1 1 zmath_cube
                     print $(( cube(3) ))

              This will print `0' because of the return.

              Commenting the return out would lead to a different problem: the
              ((...)) statement would become the last statement in  the  func-
              tion,  so  the  return  status  ($?)  of  the  function would be
              non-zero (indicating failure) whenever the arithmetic result  of
              the function would happen to be zero (numerically):

                     # WRONG
                     zmath_cube() {
                       (( $1 * $1 * $1 ))
                     }
                     functions -M cube 1 1 zmath_cube
                     print $(( cube(0) ))

              Instead, the true builtin can be used:

                     # RIGHT
                     zmath_cube() {
                       (( $1 * $1 * $1 ))
                       true
                     }
                     functions -M cube 1 1 zmath_cube
                     print $(( cube(3) ))

              If  the additional option -s is given to functions -M, the argu-
              ment to the function is a single string:  anything  between  the
              opening  and matching closing parenthesis is passed to the func-
              tion as a single argument, even if it includes commas  or  white
              space.   The minimum and maximum argument specifiers must there-
              fore be 1 if given.  An empty  argument  list  is  passed  as  a
              zero-length string.  Thus, the following string function takes a
              single argument, including the commas, and prints 11:

                     stringfn() { (( $#1 )); true }
                     functions -Ms stringfn
                     print $(( stringfn(foo,bar,rod) ))

              functions -M with no arguments lists all such user-defined func-
              tions in the same form as a definition.  With the additional op-
              tion -m and a list of  arguments,  all  functions  whose  mathfn
              matches one of the pattern arguments are listed.

              function +M removes the list of mathematical functions; with the
              additional option -m the arguments are treated as  patterns  and
              all  functions  whose  mathfn  matches  the pattern are removed.
              Note that the shell function implementing the behaviour  is  not
              removed (regardless of whether its name coincides with mathfn).

       getcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       getln [ -AclneE ] name ...
              Read the top value from the buffer stack and put it in the shell
              parameter name.  Equivalent to read -zr.

       getopts optstring name [ arg ... ]
              Checks the args for legal options.  If the args are omitted, use
              the  positional parameters.  A valid option argument begins with
              a `+' or a `-'.  An argument not beginning with a `+' or a  `-',
              or  the argument `--', ends the options.  Note that a single `-'
              is not considered a valid option argument.   optstring  contains
              the letters that getopts recognizes.  If a letter is followed by
              a `:', that option requires an argument.   The  options  can  be
              separated from the argument by blanks.

              Each  time  it  is  invoked, getopts places the option letter it
              finds in the shell parameter name, prepended with a `+' when arg
              begins  with  a  `+'.   The  index  of the next arg is stored in
              OPTIND.  The option argument, if any, is stored in OPTARG.

              The first option to be examined may be changed by explicitly as-
              signing  to  OPTIND.   OPTIND  has an initial value of 1, and is
              normally set to 1 upon entry to a shell  function  and  restored
              upon  exit.   (The POSIX_BUILTINS option disables this, and also
              changes the way the value is calculated to match other  shells.)
              OPTARG  is  not reset and retains its value from the most recent
              call to getopts.  If either of OPTIND or  OPTARG  is  explicitly
              unset, it remains unset, and the index or option argument is not
              stored.  The option itself is still stored in name in this case.

              A leading `:' in optstring causes getopts to store the letter of
              any  invalid option in OPTARG, and to set name to `?' for an un-
              known option and to `:' when a  required  argument  is  missing.
              Otherwise,  getopts sets name to `?' and prints an error message
              when an option is invalid.  The  exit  status  is  nonzero  when
              there are no more options.

       hash [ -Ldfmrv ] [ name[=value] ] ...
              hash  can be used to directly modify the contents of the command
              hash table, and the named directory hash  table.   Normally  one
              would  modify these tables by modifying one's PATH (for the com-
              mand hash table) or by  creating  appropriate  shell  parameters
              (for  the named directory hash table).  The choice of hash table
              to work on is determined by the -d option;  without  the  option
              the  command  hash  table is used, and with the option the named
              directory hash table is used.

              A command name starting with a / is never hashed, whether by ex-
              plicit  use of the hash command or otherwise.  Such a command is
              always found by direct look up in the file system.

              Given no arguments, and neither the -r or -f  options,  the  se-
              lected hash table will be listed in full.

              The  -r option causes the selected hash table to be emptied.  It
              will be subsequently rebuilt in the normal fashion.  The -f  op-
              tion  causes the selected hash table to be fully rebuilt immedi-
              ately.  For the command hash table this hashes all the  absolute
              directories  in the PATH, and for the named directory hash table
              this adds all users' home directories.  These two options cannot
              be used with any arguments.

              The  -m  option  causes  the  arguments  to be taken as patterns
              (which should be quoted) and the  elements  of  the  hash  table
              matching  those  patterns  are printed.  This is the only way to
              display a limited selection of hash table elements.

              For each name with a corresponding value, put `name' in the  se-
              lected hash table, associating it with the pathname `value'.  In
              the command hash table, this means that whenever `name' is  used
              as  a  command  argument, the shell will try to execute the file
              given by `value'.  In the named directory hash table, this means
              that `value' may be referred to as `~name'.

              For  each  name with no corresponding value, attempt to add name
              to the hash table, checking what the appropriate value is in the
              normal  manner  for  that  hash  table.  If an appropriate value
              can't be found, then the hash table will be unchanged.

              The -v option causes hash table entries to be listed as they are
              added  by explicit specification.  If has no effect if used with
              -f.

              If the -L flag is present, then each hash table entry is printed
              in the form of a call to hash.

       history
              Same as fc -l.

       integer [ {+|-}Hghlprtux ] [ {+|-}LRZi [ n ] ] [ name[=value] ... ]
              Equivalent  to typeset -i, except that options irrelevant to in-
              tegers are not permitted.

       jobs [ -dlprs ] [ job ... ]
       jobs -Z string
              Lists information about each given job, or all jobs  if  job  is
              omitted.   The  -l flag lists process IDs, and the -p flag lists
              process groups.  If the -r flag is specified only  running  jobs
              will be listed and if the -s flag is given only stopped jobs are
              shown.  If the -d flag is given, the directory  from  which  the
              job  was  started (which may not be the current directory of the
              job) will also be shown.

              The -Z option replaces  the  shell's  argument  and  environment
              space  with  the  given  string,  truncated if necessary to fit.
              This will normally be visible in ps (ps(1)) listings.  This fea-
              ture is typically used by daemons, to indicate their state.

              Full  job control is only available in the top-level interactive
              shell, not in commands run in the left hand side of pipelines or
              within  the  (...)  construct.   However,  a snapshot of the job
              state at that point is taken, so it is still possible to use the
              jobs  builtin, or any parameter providing job information.  This
              gives information about the state of jobs at the point the  sub-
              shell  was  created.  If background processes are created within
              the subshell, then instead information about those processes  is
              provided.

              For example,

                     sleep 10 &    # Job in background
                     (             # Shell forks
                     jobs          # Shows information about "sleep 10 &"
                     sleep 5 &     # Process in background (no job control)
                     jobs          # Shows information about "sleep 5 &"
                     )

       kill [ -s signal_name | -n signal_number | -sig ] job ...
       kill -l [ sig ... ]
              Sends  either  SIGTERM or the specified signal to the given jobs
              or processes.  Signals are given by number or by names, with  or
              without  the  `SIG'  prefix.   If  the  signal being sent is not
              `KILL' or `CONT', then the job will be sent a `CONT'  signal  if
              it  is stopped.  The argument job can be the process ID of a job
              not in the job list.  In the second form, kill -l, if sig is not
              specified  the signal names are listed.  Otherwise, for each sig
              that is a name, the corresponding signal number is listed.   For
              each  sig  that  is a signal number or a number representing the
              exit status of a process which was terminated or  stopped  by  a
              signal the name of the signal is printed.

              On  some systems, alternative signal names are allowed for a few
              signals.  Typical examples are SIGCHLD and SIGCLD or SIGPOLL and
              SIGIO, assuming they correspond to the same signal number.  kill
              -l will only list the preferred form, however kill -l  alt  will
              show  if  the  alternative  form corresponds to a signal number.
              For example, under Linux kill -l IO and kill -l POLL both output
              29, hence kill -IO and kill -POLL have the same effect.

              Many  systems  will  allow  process IDs to be negative to kill a
              process group or zero to kill the current process group.

       let arg ...
              Evaluate each arg as an arithmetic expression.  See the  section
              `Arithmetic  Evaluation'  in  zshmisc(1)  for  a  description of
              arithmetic expressions.  The exit status is 0 if  the  value  of
              the last expression is nonzero, 1 if it is zero, and 2 if an er-
              ror occurred.

       limit [ -hs ] [ resource [ limit ] ] ...
              Set or display resource limits.  Unless the -s  flag  is  given,
              the  limit  applies  only  the  children of the shell.  If -s is
              given without other arguments, the resource limits of  the  cur-
              rent  shell  is set to the previously set resource limits of the
              children.

              If limit is not specified, print the current limit placed on re-
              source,  otherwise set the limit to the specified value.  If the
              -h flag is given, use hard limits instead of soft limits.  If no
              resource is given, print all limits.

              When looping over multiple resources, the shell will abort imme-
              diately if it detects a badly formed argument.  However,  if  it
              fails to set a limit for some other reason it will continue try-
              ing to set the remaining limits.

              resource can be one of:

              addressspace
                     Maximum amount of address space used.
              aiomemorylocked
                     Maximum amount of memory locked in  RAM  for  AIO  opera-
                     tions.
              aiooperations
                     Maximum number of AIO operations.
              cachedthreads
                     Maximum number of cached threads.
              coredumpsize
                     Maximum size of a core dump.
              cputime
                     Maximum CPU seconds per process.
              datasize
                     Maximum data size (including stack) for each process.
              descriptors
                     Maximum value for a file descriptor.
              filesize
                     Largest single file allowed.
              kqueues
                     Maximum number of kqueues allocated.
              maxproc
                     Maximum number of processes.
              maxpthreads
                     Maximum number of threads per process.
              memorylocked
                     Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM.
              memoryuse
                     Maximum resident set size.
              msgqueue
                     Maximum number of bytes in POSIX message queues.
              posixlocks
                     Maximum number of POSIX locks per user.
              pseudoterminals
                     Maximum number of pseudo-terminals.
              resident
                     Maximum resident set size.
              sigpending
                     Maximum number of pending signals.
              sockbufsize
                     Maximum size of all socket buffers.
              stacksize
                     Maximum stack size for each process.
              swapsize
                     Maximum amount of swap used.
              vmemorysize
                     Maximum amount of virtual memory.

              Which of these resource limits are available depends on the sys-
              tem.  resource can be abbreviated to any unambiguous prefix.  It
              can also be an integer, which corresponds to the integer defined
              for the resource by the operating system.

              If argument corresponds to a number which is out of the range of
              the  resources  configured into the shell, the shell will try to
              read or write the limit anyway, and will report an error if this
              fails.   As  the shell does not store such resources internally,
              an attempt to set the limit will fail unless the  -s  option  is
              present.

              limit is a number, with an optional scaling factor, as follows:

              nh     hours
              nk     kilobytes (default)
              nm     megabytes or minutes
              ng     gigabytes
              [mm:]ss
                     minutes and seconds

              The  limit  command  is  not  made available by default when the
              shell starts in a mode emulating another shell.  It can be  made
              available with the command `zmodload -F zsh/rlimits b:limit'.

       local [ {+|-}AHUahlprtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZi [ n ] ] [ name[=value] ... ]
              Same as typeset, except that the options -g, and -f are not per-
              mitted.  In this case the -x option does not force  the  use  of
              -g, i.e. exported variables will be local to functions.

       logout [ n ]
              Same as exit, except that it only works in a login shell.

       noglob simple command
              See the section `Precommand Modifiers' in zshmisc(1).

       popd [ -q ] [ {+|-}n ]
              Remove  an  entry  from the directory stack, and perform a cd to
              the new top directory.  With no argument, the current top  entry
              is removed.  An argument of the form `+n' identifies a stack en-
              try by counting from the left of the list shown by the dirs com-
              mand,  starting  with  zero.   An argument of the form -n counts
              from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the  meanings
              of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

              If  the  -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd
              and the functions in the array $chpwd_functions are not  called,
              and  the new directory stack is not printed.  This is useful for
              calls to popd that do not change the environment seen by an  in-
              teractive user.

       print [ -abcDilmnNoOpPrsSz ] [ -u n ] [ -f format ] [ -C cols ]
             [ -v name ] [ -xX tabstop ] [ -R [ -en ]] [ arg ... ]
              With  the  `-f' option the arguments are printed as described by
              printf.  With no flags or with the flag `-', the  arguments  are
              printed  on  the  standard output as described by echo, with the
              following differences: the escape  sequence  `\M-x'  (or  `\Mx')
              metafies  the  character  x  (sets  the highest bit), `\C-x' (or
              `\Cx') produces a control character (`\C-@' and `\C-?' give  the
              characters NULL and delete), a character code in octal is repre-
              sented by `\NNN' (instead of `\0NNN'), and `\E' is a synonym for
              `\e'.   Finally,  if  not in an escape sequence, `\' escapes the
              following character and is not printed.

              -a     Print arguments with the column incrementing first.  Only
                     useful with the -c and -C options.

              -b     Recognize  all the escape sequences defined for the bind-
                     key command, see the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

              -c     Print the arguments in columns.  Unless -a is also given,
                     arguments are printed with the row incrementing first.

              -C cols
                     Print  the  arguments in cols columns.  Unless -a is also
                     given, arguments are printed with  the  row  incrementing
                     first.

              -D     Treat  the  arguments  as paths, replacing directory pre-
                     fixes  with  ~  expressions  corresponding  to  directory
                     names, as appropriate.

              -i     If  given  together  with  -o or -O, sorting is performed
                     case-independently.

              -l     Print the arguments separated by newlines instead of spa-
                     ces.   Note:  if the list of arguments is empty, print -l
                     will still output one  empty  line.  To  print  a  possi-
                     bly-empty  list of arguments one per line, use print -C1,
                     as in `print -rC1 -- "$list[@]"'.

              -m     Take the first argument as a pattern (should be  quoted),
                     and remove it from the argument list together with subse-
                     quent arguments that do not match this pattern.

              -n     Do not add a newline to the output.

              -N     Print the arguments separated and  terminated  by  nulls.
                     Again,  print  -rNC1  -- "$list[@]" is a canonical way to
                     print an arbitrary list as null-delimited records.

              -o     Print the arguments sorted in ascending order.

              -O     Print the arguments sorted in descending order.

              -p     Print the arguments to the input of the coprocess.

              -P     Perform prompt expansion (see  EXPANSION  OF  PROMPT  SE-
                     QUENCES in zshmisc(1)).  In combination with `-f', prompt
                     escape sequences are parsed only within interpolated  ar-
                     guments, not within the format string.

              -r     Ignore the escape conventions of echo.

              -R     Emulate  the BSD echo command, which does not process es-
                     cape sequences unless the -e flag is given.  The -n  flag
                     suppresses  the  trailing  newline.   Only  the -e and -n
                     flags are recognized after -R; all  other  arguments  and
                     options are printed.

              -s     Place  the  results in the history list instead of on the
                     standard output.  Each argument to the print  command  is
                     treated  as  a  single word in the history, regardless of
                     its content.

              -S     Place the results in the history list instead of  on  the
                     standard  output.  In this case only a single argument is
                     allowed; it will be split into words as if it were a full
                     shell command line.  The effect is similar to reading the
                     line from a history file with the  HIST_LEX_WORDS  option
                     active.

              -u n   Print the arguments to file descriptor n.

              -v name
                     Store the printed arguments as the value of the parameter
                     name.

              -x tab-stop
                     Expand leading tabs on each line of output in the printed
                     string  assuming  a  tab  stop every tab-stop characters.
                     This is appropriate for formatting code that may  be  in-
                     dented with tabs.  Note that leading tabs of any argument
                     to print, not just the first, are expanded, even if print
                     is  using  spaces to separate arguments (the column count
                     is maintained across arguments but may  be  incorrect  on
                     output owing to previous unexpanded tabs).

                     The  start of the output of each print command is assumed
                     to be aligned with a tab stop.  Widths of multibyte char-
                     acters  are handled if the option MULTIBYTE is in effect.
                     This option is ignored if other formatting options are in
                     effect,  namely  column  alignment or printf style, or if
                     output is to a special location such as shell history  or
                     the command line editor.

              -X tab-stop
                     This  is  similar  to  -x,  except  that  all tabs in the
                     printed string are expanded.  This is appropriate if tabs
                     in  the  arguments are being used to produce a table for-
                     mat.

              -z     Push the arguments onto the editing buffer  stack,  sepa-
                     rated by spaces.

              If  any  of `-m', `-o' or `-O' are used in combination with `-f'
              and there are no arguments (after the  removal  process  in  the
              case of `-m') then nothing is printed.

       printf [ -v name ] format [ arg ... ]
              Print  the arguments according to the format specification. For-
              matting rules are the same as used in C.  The  same  escape  se-
              quences  as for echo are recognised in the format. All C conver-
              sion specifications ending in one of csdiouxXeEfgGn are handled.
              In  addition  to this, `%b' can be used instead of `%s' to cause
              escape sequences in the argument to be recognised and  `%q'  can
              be used to quote the argument in such a way that allows it to be
              reused as shell input. With the numeric  format  specifiers,  if
              the  corresponding  argument  starts with a quote character, the
              numeric value of the following character is used as  the  number
              to  print;  otherwise the argument is evaluated as an arithmetic
              expression. See the  section  `Arithmetic  Evaluation'  in  zsh-
              misc(1)  for a description of arithmetic expressions. With `%n',
              the corresponding argument is taken as an  identifier  which  is
              created as an integer parameter.

              Normally, conversion specifications are applied to each argument
              in order but they can explicitly specify the nth argument is  to
              be  used by replacing `%' by `%n$' and `*' by `*n$'.  It is rec-
              ommended that you do not mix references of this  explicit  style
              with  the normal style and the handling of such mixed styles may
              be subject to future change.

              If arguments remain unused after formatting, the  format  string
              is reused until all arguments have been consumed. With the print
              builtin, this can be suppressed by using the -r option. If  more
              arguments  are  required by the format than have been specified,
              the behaviour is as if zero or an empty string had  been  speci-
              fied as the argument.

              The -v option causes the output to be stored as the value of the
              parameter name, instead of printed. If name is an array and  the
              format  string is reused when consuming arguments then one array
              element will be used for each use of the format string.

       pushd [ -qsLP ] [ arg ]
       pushd [ -qsLP ] old new
       pushd [ -qsLP ] {+|-}n
              Change the current directory, and push the old current directory
              onto the directory stack.  In the first form, change the current
              directory to arg.  If arg is not specified, change to the second
              directory  on the stack (that is, exchange the top two entries),
              or change to $HOME if the PUSHD_TO_HOME  option  is  set  or  if
              there  is only one entry on the stack.  Otherwise, arg is inter-
              preted as it would be by cd.  The meaning of old and new in  the
              second form is also the same as for cd.

              The third form of pushd changes directory by rotating the direc-
              tory list.  An argument of the form `+n' identifies a stack  en-
              try by counting from the left of the list shown by the dirs com-
              mand, starting with zero.  An argument of the form  `-n'  counts
              from  the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the meanings
              of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

              If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook  function  chpwd
              and  the functions in the array $chpwd_functions are not called,
              and the new directory stack is not printed.  This is useful  for
              calls to pushd that do not change the environment seen by an in-
              teractive user.

              If  the  option  -q  is  not  specified  and  the  shell  option
              PUSHD_SILENT is not set, the directory stack will be printed af-
              ter a pushd is performed.

              The options -s, -L and -P have the same meanings as for  the  cd
              builtin.

       pushln [ arg ... ]
              Equivalent to print -nz.

       pwd [ -rLP ]
              Print  the  absolute  pathname of the current working directory.
              If the -r or the -P flag is specified, or the CHASE_LINKS option
              is  set  and the -L flag is not given, the printed path will not
              contain symbolic links.

       r      Same as fc -e -.

       read [ -rszpqAclneE ] [ -t [ num ] ] [ -k [ num ] ] [ -d delim ]
            [ -u n ] [ [name][?prompt] ] [ name ...  ]
              Read one line and break it into fields using the  characters  in
              $IFS  as  separators, except as noted below.  The first field is
              assigned to the first name, the second field to the second name,
              etc.,  with  leftover fields assigned to the last name.  If name
              is omitted then REPLY is used for scalars and reply for arrays.

              -r     Raw mode: a `\' at the end of a  line  does  not  signify
                     line continuation and backslashes in the line don't quote
                     the following character and are not removed.

              -s     Don't echo back characters if reading from the terminal.

              -q     Read only one character from the terminal and set name to
                     `y'  if  this  character was `y' or `Y' and to `n' other-
                     wise.  With this flag set the return status is zero  only
                     if the character was `y' or `Y'.  This option may be used
                     with a timeout (see -t); if the read times  out,  or  en-
                     counters  end  of  file,  status 2 is returned.  Input is
                     read from the terminal unless one of -u or -p is present.
                     This option may also be used within zle widgets.

              -k [ num ]
                     Read  only  one (or num) characters.  All are assigned to
                     the first name, without word splitting.  This flag is ig-
                     nored  when -q is present.  Input is read from the termi-
                     nal unless one of -u or -p is present.  This  option  may
                     also be used within zle widgets.

                     Note  that  despite  the  mnemonic `key' this option does
                     read full characters, which may consist of multiple bytes
                     if the option MULTIBYTE is set.

              -z     Read one entry from the editor buffer stack and assign it
                     to the first  name,  without  word  splitting.   Text  is
                     pushed  onto  the stack with `print -z' or with push-line
                     from the line editor (see zshzle(1)).  This flag  is  ig-
                     nored when the -k or -q flags are present.

              -e
              -E     The  input  read is printed (echoed) to the standard out-
                     put.  If the -e flag is used, no input is assigned to the
                     parameters.

              -A     The  first  name is taken as the name of an array and all
                     words are assigned to it.

              -c
              -l     These flags are allowed only if called inside a  function
                     used  for  completion (specified with the -K flag to com-
                     pctl).  If the -c flag is given, the words of the current
                     command are read. If the -l flag is given, the whole line
                     is assigned as a scalar.  If both flags are  present,  -l
                     is used and -c is ignored.

              -n     Together with -c, the number of the word the cursor is on
                     is read.  With -l, the index of the character the  cursor
                     is on is read.  Note that the command name is word number
                     1, not word 0, and that when the cursor is at the end  of
                     the  line,  its character index is the length of the line
                     plus one.

              -u n   Input is read from file descriptor n.

              -p     Input is read from the coprocess.

              -d delim
                     Input is terminated by the first character of  delim  in-
                     stead of by newline.

              -t [ num ]
                     Test if input is available before attempting to read.  If
                     num is present, it must begin with a digit  and  will  be
                     evaluated  to  give  a  number of seconds, which may be a
                     floating point number; in this case the read times out if
                     input  is  not available within this time.  If num is not
                     present, it is taken to be zero, so that read returns im-
                     mediately  if  no  input  is  available.   If no input is
                     available, return status 1 and do not set any variables.

                     This option is not available when reading from the editor
                     buffer  with  -z, when called from within completion with
                     -c or -l, with -q which clears  the  input  queue  before
                     reading,  or  within zle where other mechanisms should be
                     used to test for input.

                     Note that read does not attempt to alter the  input  pro-
                     cessing  mode.   The  default mode is canonical input, in
                     which an entire line is read at a time, so usually  `read
                     -t'  will not read anything until an entire line has been
                     typed.  However, when reading from the terminal  with  -k
                     input  is processed one key at a time; in this case, only
                     availability of the first character is  tested,  so  that
                     e.g. `read -t -k 2' can still block on the second charac-
                     ter.  Use two instances of `read -t -k' if  this  is  not
                     what is wanted.

              If the first argument contains a `?', the remainder of this word
              is used as a prompt on standard error when the shell is interac-
              tive.

              The  value (exit status) of read is 1 when an end-of-file is en-
              countered, or when -c or -l is present and the  command  is  not
              called  from a compctl function, or as described for -q.  Other-
              wise the value is 0.

              The behavior of some combinations of the -k, -p, -q, -u  and  -z
              flags  is  undefined.   Presently  -q cancels all the others, -p
              cancels -u, -k cancels -z, and otherwise -z cancels both -p  and
              -u.

              The -c or -l flags cancel any and all of -kpquz.

       readonly
              Same as typeset -r.  With the POSIX_BUILTINS option set, same as
              typeset -gr.

       rehash Same as hash -r.

       return [ n ]
              Causes a shell function or `.' script to return to the  invoking
              script with the return status specified by an arithmetic expres-
              sion n.  For example, the following prints `42':

                     () { integer foo=40; return "foo + 2" }
                     echo $?

              If n is omitted, the return status is that of the  last  command
              executed.

              If  return  was  executed from a trap in a TRAPNAL function, the
              effect is different for zero and non-zero return  status.   With
              zero  status  (or  after  an  implicit  return at the end of the
              trap), the shell will return to whatever it was previously  pro-
              cessing; with a non-zero status, the shell will behave as inter-
              rupted except that the return status of the  trap  is  retained.
              Note  that the numeric value of the signal which caused the trap
              is passed as  the  first  argument,  so  the  statement  `return
              "128+$1"'  will  return the same status as if the signal had not
              been trapped.

       sched  See the section `The zsh/sched Module' in zshmodules(1).

       set [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o [ option_name ] ] ... [ {+|-}A [ name ] ]
           [ arg ... ]
              Set the options for the shell and/or set the positional  parame-
              ters,  or  declare and set an array.  If the -s option is given,
              it causes the specified arguments to be sorted before  assigning
              them to the positional parameters (or to the array name if -A is
              used).  With +s sort arguments in  descending  order.   For  the
              meaning  of  the  other  flags, see zshoptions(1).  Flags may be
              specified by name using the -o option. If no option name is sup-
              plied  with  -o, the current option states are printed:  see the
              description of setopt below for more information on the  format.
              With  +o they are printed in a form that can be used as input to
              the shell.

              If the -A flag is specified, name is set to an array  containing
              the  given args; if no name is specified, all arrays are printed
              together with their values.

              If +A is used and name is an array, the given arguments will re-
              place  the  initial elements of that array; if no name is speci-
              fied, all arrays are printed without their values.

              The behaviour of arguments after -A name or +A name  depends  on
              whether the option KSH_ARRAYS is set.  If it is not set, all ar-
              guments following name are treated as values for the array,  re-
              gardless  of  their  form.   If the option is set, normal option
              processing continues at that point; only regular  arguments  are
              treated as values for the array.  This means that

                     set -A array -x -- foo

              sets array to `-x -- foo' if KSH_ARRAYS is not set, but sets the
              array to foo and turns on the option `-x' if it is set.

              If the -A flag is not present, but there  are  arguments  beyond
              the  options,  the positional parameters are set.  If the option
              list (if any) is terminated by `--', and there  are  no  further
              arguments, the positional parameters will be unset.

              If no arguments and no `--' are given, then the names and values
              of all parameters are printed on the standard  output.   If  the
              only argument is `+', the names of all parameters are printed.

              For historical reasons, `set -' is treated as `set +xv' and `set
              - args' as `set +xv -- args' when in any  other  emulation  mode
              than zsh's native mode.

       setcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       setopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ -m ] [ name ... ]
              Set  the  options  for  the shell.  All options specified either
              with flags or by name are set.

              If no arguments are supplied, the names of all options currently
              set  are printed.  The form is chosen so as to minimize the dif-
              ferences from the default options for the current emulation (the
              default  emulation  being  native  zsh,  shown  as <Z> in zshop-
              tions(1)).  Options that are on by default for the emulation are
              shown  with  the prefix no only if they are off, while other op-
              tions are shown without the prefix no and only if they  are  on.
              In  addition  to  options  changed from the default state by the
              user, any options activated automatically by the shell (for  ex-
              ample,  SHIN_STDIN  or  INTERACTIVE)  will be shown in the list.
              The format is further modified by the  option  KSH_OPTION_PRINT,
              however  the  rationale for choosing options with or without the
              no prefix remains the same in this case.

              If the -m flag is given the  arguments  are  taken  as  patterns
              (which  should  be  quoted  to protect them from filename expan-
              sion), and all options with names matching  these  patterns  are
              set.

              Note  that  a bad option name does not cause execution of subse-
              quent shell code to be aborted; this is behaviour  is  different
              from  that  of  `set  -o'.  This is because set is regarded as a
              special builtin by the POSIX standard, but setopt is not.

       shift [ -p ] [ n ] [ name ... ]
              The positional parameters ${n+1} ...  are  renamed  to  $1  ...,
              where  n is an arithmetic expression that defaults to 1.  If any
              names are given then the arrays with these names are shifted in-
              stead of the positional parameters.

              If the option -p is given arguments are instead removed (popped)
              from the end rather than the start of the array.

       source file [ arg ... ]
              Same as  `.',  except  that  the  current  directory  is  always
              searched  and  is  always  searched first, before directories in
              $path.

       stat   See the section `The zsh/stat Module' in zshmodules(1).

       suspend [ -f ]
              Suspend the execution of the shell (send it a SIGTSTP) until  it
              receives  a  SIGCONT.   Unless the -f option is given, this will
              refuse to suspend a login shell.

       test [ arg ... ]
       [ [ arg ... ] ]
              Like the system version of test.  Added for  compatibility;  use
              conditional  expressions  instead  (see the section `Conditional
              Expressions').  The main differences between the conditional ex-
              pression syntax and the test and [ builtins are:  these commands
              are not handled syntactically, so for example an empty  variable
              expansion  may  cause  an  argument to be omitted; syntax errors
              cause status 2 to be returned instead  of  a  shell  error;  and
              arithmetic operators expect integer arguments rather than arith-
              metic expressions.

              The command attempts to implement POSIX and its extensions where
              these are specified.  Unfortunately there are intrinsic ambigui-
              ties in the syntax; in particular there is  no  distinction  be-
              tween  test operators and strings that resemble them.  The stan-
              dard attempts to resolve these for small  numbers  of  arguments
              (up to four); for five or more arguments compatibility cannot be
              relied on.  Users are urged wherever possible to  use  the  `[['
              test syntax which does not have these ambiguities.

       times  Print  the  accumulated  user and system times for the shell and
              for processes run from the shell.

       trap [ arg ] [ sig ... ]
              arg is a series of commands (usually quoted to protect  it  from
              immediate  evaluation by the shell) to be read and executed when
              the shell receives any of the signals specified by one  or  more
              sig  args.  Each sig can be given as a number, or as the name of
              a signal either with or without the string SIG in front (e.g. 1,
              HUP, and SIGHUP are all the same signal).

              If arg is `-', then the specified signals are reset to their de-
              faults, or, if no sig args are present, all traps are reset.

              If arg is an empty string, then the specified  signals  are  ig-
              nored by the shell (and by the commands it invokes).

              If  arg  is  omitted but one or more sig args are provided (i.e.
              the first argument is a valid signal number or name), the effect
              is the same as if arg had been specified as `-'.

              The trap command with no arguments prints a list of commands as-
              sociated with each signal.

              If sig is ZERR then arg will be executed after each command with
              a nonzero exit status.  ERR is an alias for ZERR on systems that
              have no SIGERR signal (this is the usual case).

              If sig is DEBUG then arg will be executed before each command if
              the  option  DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set (as it is by default), else
              after each command.  Here, a `command' is what is described as a
              `sublist'  in the shell grammar, see the section SIMPLE COMMANDS
              & PIPELINES in zshmisc(1).  If DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is  set  various
              additional  features  are  available.   First, it is possible to
              skip the next command by setting the option  ERR_EXIT;  see  the
              description  of the ERR_EXIT option in zshoptions(1).  Also, the
              shell parameter ZSH_DEBUG_CMD is set to the string corresponding
              to  the  command  to  be executed following the trap.  Note that
              this string is reconstructed from the internal  format  and  may
              not be formatted the same way as the original text.  The parame-
              ter is unset after the trap is executed.

              If sig is 0 or EXIT and the trap statement  is  executed  inside
              the  body  of a function, then the command arg is executed after
              the function completes.  The value of $? at the start of  execu-
              tion is the exit status of the shell or the return status of the
              function exiting.  If sig is 0 or EXIT and the trap statement is
              not executed inside the body of a function, then the command arg
              is executed when the shell terminates; the trap runs before  any
              zshexit hook functions.

              ZERR, DEBUG, and EXIT traps are not executed inside other traps.
              ZERR and DEBUG traps are  kept  within  subshells,  while  other
              traps are reset.

              Note  that traps defined with the trap builtin are slightly dif-
              ferent from those defined as `TRAPNAL () { ... }', as the latter
              have  their  own function environment (line numbers, local vari-
              ables, etc.) while the former use the environment of the command
              in which they were called.  For example,

                     trap 'print $LINENO' DEBUG

              will  print  the  line number of a command executed after it has
              run, while

                     TRAPDEBUG() { print $LINENO; }

              will always print the number zero.

              Alternative signal names are allowed  as  described  under  kill
              above.   Defining a trap under either name causes any trap under
              an alternative name to be removed.  However, it  is  recommended
              that  for consistency users stick exclusively to one name or an-
              other.

       true [ arg ... ]
              Do nothing and return an exit status of 0.

       ttyctl [ -fu ]
              The -f option freezes the tty (i.e. terminal or terminal  emula-
              tor),  and  -u unfreezes it.  When the tty is frozen, no changes
              made to the tty settings by external programs will be honored by
              the  shell,  except  for  changes in the size of the screen; the
              shell will simply reset the settings to their previous values as
              soon as each command exits or is suspended.  Thus, stty and sim-
              ilar programs have no effect when the tty is  frozen.   Freezing
              the  tty  does not cause the current state to be remembered: in-
              stead, it causes future changes to the state to be blocked.

              Without options it reports whether the  terminal  is  frozen  or
              not.

              Note  that,  regardless of whether the tty is frozen or not, the
              shell needs to change the settings when the line editor  starts,
              so  unfreezing  the  tty does not guarantee settings made on the
              command line are preserved.  Strings  of  commands  run  between
              editing  the  command line will see a consistent tty state.  See
              also the shell variable STTY for a means of initialising the tty
              before  running external commands and/or freezing the tty around
              a single command.

       type [ -wfpamsS ] name ...
              Equivalent to whence -v.

       typeset [ {+|-}AHUaghlmrtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZip [ n ] ]
               [ + ] [ name[=value] ... ]
       typeset -T [ {+|-}Uglrux ] [ {+|-}LRZp [ n ] ]
               [ + | SCALAR[=value] array[=(value ...)] [ sep ] ]
       typeset -f [ {+|-}TUkmtuz ] [ + ] [ name ... ]
              Set or display attributes and values for shell parameters.

              Except as noted below for control flags that change  the  behav-
              ior,  a parameter is created for each name that does not already
              refer to one.  When inside a function, a new parameter  is  cre-
              ated  for every name (even those that already exist), and is un-
              set again when the function completes.  See  `Local  Parameters'
              in  zshparam(1).   The same rules apply to special shell parame-
              ters, which retain their special attributes when made local.

              For each name=value assignment, the parameter  name  is  set  to
              value.   If the assignment is omitted and name does not refer to
              an existing parameter, a new parameter is initialized  to  empty
              string,  zero, or empty array (as appropriate), unless the shell
              option TYPESET_TO_UNSET is set.  When that option  is  set,  the
              parameter  attributes are recorded but the parameter remains un-
              set.

              If the shell option TYPESET_SILENT is not set, for each  remain-
              ing  name  that  refers  to a parameter that is already set, the
              name and value of the parameter are printed in the  form  of  an
              assignment.  Nothing is printed for newly-created parameters, or
              when any attribute flags listed below are given along  with  the
              name.   Using  `+'  instead  of  minus to introduce an attribute
              turns it off.

              If no name is present, the names and values  of  all  parameters
              are printed.  In this case the attribute flags restrict the dis-
              play to only  those  parameters  that  have  the  specified  at-
              tributes,  and  using  `+' rather than `-' to introduce the flag
              suppresses printing of the values of parameters when there is no
              parameter name.

              All  forms  of  the command handle scalar assignment.  Array as-
              signment is possible if any of the reserved words  declare,  ex-
              port, float, integer, local, readonly or typeset is matched when
              the line is parsed (N.B. not when it is executed).  In this case
              the  arguments  are  parsed as assignments, except that the `+='
              syntax and the GLOB_ASSIGN option are not supported, and  scalar
              values  after  =  are  not split further into words, even if ex-
              panded (regardless of the setting  of  the  KSH_TYPESET  option;
              this option is obsolete).

              Examples  of  the  differences between command and reserved word
              parsing:

                     # Reserved word parsing
                     typeset svar=$(echo one word) avar=(several words)

              The above creates a scalar parameter svar and an array parameter
              avar as if the assignments had been

                     svar="one word"
                     avar=(several words)

              On the other hand:

                     # Normal builtin interface
                     builtin typeset svar=$(echo two words)

              The builtin keyword causes the above to use the standard builtin
              interface to typeset in which argument parsing is  performed  in
              the  same  way  as  for  other commands.  This example creates a
              scalar svar containing the value two and another scalar  parame-
              ter  words with no value.  An array value in this case would ei-
              ther cause an error or be treated as  an  obscure  set  of  glob
              qualifiers.

              Arbitrary arguments are allowed if they take the form of assign-
              ments after command line expansion; however, these only  perform
              scalar assignment:

                     var='svar=val'
                     typeset $var

              The  above  sets  the  scalar  parameter  svar to the value val.
              Parentheses around the value within var would  not  cause  array
              assignment  as  they will be treated as ordinary characters when
              $var is substituted.  Any non-trivial expansion in the name part
              of  the  assignment  causes  the  argument to be treated in this
              fashion:

                     typeset {var1,var2,var3}=name

              The above syntax is valid, and has the expected effect  of  set-
              ting  the  three  parameters  to the same value, but the command
              line is parsed as a set of three normal command  line  arguments
              to  typeset after expansion.  Hence it is not possible to assign
              to multiple arrays by this means.

              Note that each interface to any of the commands may be  disabled
              separately.   For example, `disable -r typeset' disables the re-
              served word interface to typeset, exposing  the  builtin  inter-
              face,  while  `disable typeset' disables the builtin.  Note that
              disabling the reserved word  interface  for  typeset  may  cause
              problems  with the output of `typeset -p', which assumes the re-
              served word interface is available in order to restore array and
              associative array values.

              Unlike parameter assignment statements, typeset's exit status on
              an assignment that involves a command substitution does not  re-
              flect  the  exit status of the command substitution.  Therefore,
              to test for an error in a  command  substitution,  separate  the
              declaration of the parameter from its initialization:

                     # WRONG
                     typeset var1=$(exit 1) || echo "Trouble with var1"

                     # RIGHT
                     typeset var1 && var1=$(exit 1) || echo "Trouble with var1"

              To  initialize a parameter param to a command output and mark it
              readonly, use typeset -r param or readonly param after  the  pa-
              rameter assignment statement.

              If  no  attribute  flags are given, and either no name arguments
              are present or the flag +m is used,  then  each  parameter  name
              printed  is preceded by a list of the attributes of that parame-
              ter (array, association, exported, float, integer, readonly,  or
              undefined  for  autoloaded parameters not yet loaded).  If +m is
              used with attribute flags, and all those  flags  are  introduced
              with  +, the matching parameter names are printed but their val-
              ues are not.

              The following control flags change the behavior of typeset:

              +      If `+' appears by itself in a separate word as  the  last
                     option,  then the names of all parameters (functions with
                     -f) are printed, but the  values  (function  bodies)  are
                     not.   No  name  arguments may appear, and it is an error
                     for any other options to follow `+'.  The effect  of  `+'
                     is  as if all attribute flags which precede it were given
                     with a `+' prefix.  For example, `typeset -U +' is equiv-
                     alent  to  `typeset +U' and displays the names of all ar-
                     rays having the uniqueness attribute, whereas `typeset -f
                     -U  +'  displays the names of all autoloadable functions.
                     If + is the only option, then  type  information  (array,
                     readonly,  etc.)  is  also printed for each parameter, in
                     the same manner as `typeset +m "*"'.

              -g     The -g (global) means that any resulting  parameter  will
                     not  be  restricted  to local scope.  Note that this does
                     not necessarily mean that the parameter will  be  global,
                     as the flag will apply to any existing parameter (even if
                     unset) from an enclosing function.  This  flag  does  not
                     affect  the parameter after creation, hence it has no ef-
                     fect when listing existing parameters, nor does the  flag
                     +g have any effect except in combination with -m (see be-
                     low).

              -m     If the -m flag is given the name arguments are  taken  as
                     patterns  (use quoting to prevent these from being inter-
                     preted as file patterns).  With no attribute  flags,  all
                     parameters  (or functions with the -f flag) with matching
                     names are printed (the shell option TYPESET_SILENT is not
                     used in this case).

                     If the +g flag is combined with -m, a new local parameter
                     is created for every matching parameter that is  not  al-
                     ready local.  Otherwise -m applies all other flags or as-
                     signments to the existing parameters.

                     Except when assignments are made with  name=value,  using
                     +m forces the matching parameters and their attributes to
                     be printed, even inside a function.  Note that -m is  ig-
                     nored  if no patterns are given, so `typeset -m' displays
                     attributes but `typeset -a +m' does not.

              -p [ n ]
                     If the -p option is  given,  parameters  and  values  are
                     printed  in the form of a typeset command with an assign-
                     ment, regardless of other flags and options.   Note  that
                     the  -H flag on parameters is respected; no value will be
                     shown for these parameters.

                     -p may be followed by an optional integer argument.  Cur-
                     rently  only  the value 1 is supported.  In this case ar-
                     rays and associative arrays are printed with newlines be-
                     tween indented elements for readability.

              -T [ scalar[=value] array[=(value ...)] [ sep ] ]
                     This  flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see
                     below.  Otherwise the -T option requires  zero,  two,  or
                     three  arguments  to  be present.  With no arguments, the
                     list of parameters created  in  this  fashion  is  shown.
                     With  two  or three arguments, the first two are the name
                     of a scalar and of an array  parameter  (in  that  order)
                     that  will  be  tied  together in the manner of $PATH and
                     $path.  The optional third argument is a single-character
                     separator  which will be used to join the elements of the
                     array to form the scalar; if absent, a colon is used,  as
                     with $PATH.  Only the first character of the separator is
                     significant;  any  remaining  characters   are   ignored.
                     Multibyte characters are not yet supported.

                     Only  one  of  the scalar and array parameters may be as-
                     signed an initial value (the restrictions  on  assignment
                     forms described above also apply).

                     Both  the scalar and the array may be manipulated as nor-
                     mal.  If one is unset, the other  will  automatically  be
                     unset  too.   There  is  no  way of untying the variables
                     without unsetting them, nor of converting the type of one
                     of  them  with another typeset command; +T does not work,
                     assigning an array to scalar is an error, and assigning a
                     scalar to array sets it to be a single-element array.

                     Note  that  both  `typeset  -xT ...'  and `export -T ...'
                     work, but only the scalar  will  be  marked  for  export.
                     Setting the value using the scalar version causes a split
                     on all separators (which cannot be quoted).  It is possi-
                     ble to apply -T to two previously tied variables but with
                     a different separator character, in which case the  vari-
                     ables  remain  joined  as  before  but  the  separator is
                     changed.

                     When an existing scalar is tied to a new array, the value
                     of  the  scalar  is preserved but no attribute other than
                     export will be preserved.

              Attribute flags that transform the final value (-L, -R, -Z,  -l,
              -u) are only applied to the expanded value at the point of a pa-
              rameter expansion expression using `$'.  They  are  not  applied
              when  a  parameter  is retrieved internally by the shell for any
              purpose.

              The following attribute flags may be specified:

              -A     The names refer to associative array parameters; see `Ar-
                     ray Parameters' in zshparam(1).

              -L [ n ]
                     Left  justify  and  remove  leading blanks from the value
                     when the parameter is expanded.  If n is nonzero, it  de-
                     fines the width of the field.  If n is zero, the width is
                     determined by the width of the value of the first assign-
                     ment.   In  the case of numeric parameters, the length of
                     the complete value assigned to the parameter is  used  to
                     determine the width, not the value that would be output.

                     The width is the count of characters, which may be multi-
                     byte characters if the MULTIBYTE  option  is  in  effect.
                     Note  that the screen width of the character is not taken
                     into account; if this is required, use padding  with  pa-
                     rameter  expansion  flags  ${(ml...)...}  as described in
                     `Parameter Expansion Flags' in zshexpn(1).

                     When the parameter is expanded, it is filled on the right
                     with  blanks  or truncated if necessary to fit the field.
                     Note truncation can lead to unexpected results  with  nu-
                     meric  parameters.   Leading  zeros are removed if the -Z
                     flag is also set.

              -R [ n ]
                     Similar to -L, except that right justification  is  used;
                     when  the parameter is expanded, the field is left filled
                     with blanks or truncated from the end.  May not  be  com-
                     bined with the -Z flag.

              -U     For  arrays  (but  not for associative arrays), keep only
                     the first occurrence of each duplicated value.  This  may
                     also  be  set for tied parameters (see -T) or colon-sepa-
                     rated special parameters like PATH or FIGNORE, etc.  Note
                     the  flag takes effect on assignment, and the type of the
                     variable being assigned to is  determinative;  for  vari-
                     ables  with  shared values it is therefore recommended to
                     set the flag for all interfaces, e.g.  `typeset  -U  PATH
                     path'.

                     This  flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see
                     below.

              -Z [ n ]
                     Specially handled if set along with the -L flag.   Other-
                     wise,  similar  to -R, except that leading zeros are used
                     for padding instead of  blanks  if  the  first  non-blank
                     character  is  a digit.  Numeric parameters are specially
                     handled: they are always eligible for  padding  with  ze-
                     roes, and the zeroes are inserted at an appropriate place
                     in the output.

              -a     The names refer to array parameters.  An array  parameter
                     may be created this way, but it may be assigned to in the
                     typeset statement only if the reserved word form of type-
                     set  is  enabled (as it is by default).  When displaying,
                     both normal and associative arrays are shown.

              -f     The names refer to functions rather than parameters.   No
                     assignments  can  be made, and the only other valid flags
                     are -t, -T, -k, -u, -U and -z.  The flag -t turns on exe-
                     cution  tracing  for  this function; the flag -T does the
                     same, but turns off tracing for any named (not anonymous)
                     function  called  from the present one, unless that func-
                     tion also has the -t or -T flag.  The  -u  and  -U  flags
                     cause  the function to be marked for autoloading; -U also
                     causes alias expansion to be suppressed when the function
                     is loaded.  See the description of the `autoload' builtin
                     for details.

                     Note that the builtin functions provides the  same  basic
                     capabilities  as typeset -f but gives access to a few ex-
                     tra options; autoload gives  further  additional  options
                     for the case typeset -fu and typeset -fU.

              -h     Hide:  only  useful  for special parameters (those marked
                     `<S>' in the table in zshparam(1)), and for local parame-
                     ters  with  the  same name as a special parameter, though
                     harmless for others.  A special parameter with  this  at-
                     tribute  will not retain its special effect when made lo-
                     cal.  Thus after `typeset -h PATH', a function containing
                     `typeset  PATH'  will  create an ordinary local parameter
                     without the usual behaviour of PATH.  Alternatively,  the
                     local parameter may itself be given this attribute; hence
                     inside a function `typeset -h PATH' creates  an  ordinary
                     local parameter and the special PATH parameter is not al-
                     tered in any way.  It is also possible to create a  local
                     parameter  using  `typeset  +h  special', where the local
                     copy of special will retain its  special  properties  re-
                     gardless  of having the -h attribute.  Global special pa-
                     rameters loaded from shell modules  (currently  those  in
                     zsh/mapfile  and  zsh/parameter)  are automatically given
                     the -h attribute to avoid name clashes.

              -H     Hide value: specifies that typeset will not  display  the
                     value  of the parameter when listing parameters; the dis-
                     play for such parameters is always as if the `+' flag had
                     been  given.   Use  of the parameter is in other respects
                     normal, and the option does not apply if the parameter is
                     specified  by  name,  or  by  pattern with the -m option.
                     This is on by default for the parameters in  the  zsh/pa-
                     rameter and zsh/mapfile modules.  Note, however, that un-
                     like the -h flag this is also useful for non-special  pa-
                     rameters.

              -i [ n ]
                     Use  an internal integer representation.  If n is nonzero
                     it defines the output arithmetic base,  otherwise  it  is
                     determined  by  the first assignment.  Bases from 2 to 36
                     inclusive are allowed.

              -E [ n ]
                     Use an internal double-precision floating point represen-
                     tation.  On output the variable will be converted to sci-
                     entific notation.  If n is nonzero it defines the  number
                     of significant figures to display; the default is ten.

              -F [ n ]
                     Use an internal double-precision floating point represen-
                     tation.  On output the  variable  will  be  converted  to
                     fixed-point decimal notation.  If n is nonzero it defines
                     the number of digits to display after the decimal  point;
                     the default is ten.

              -l     Convert  the  result to lower case whenever the parameter
                     is expanded.  The value is not converted when assigned.

              -r     The given names are marked readonly.  Note that  if  name
                     is  a  special  parameter,  the readonly attribute can be
                     turned on, but cannot then be turned off.

                     If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, the readonly  attri-
                     bute  is  more restrictive: unset variables can be marked
                     readonly and cannot then be set; furthermore,  the  read-
                     only attribute cannot be removed from any variable.

                     It  is  still  possible to change other attributes of the
                     variable though, some of which like -U or -Z would affect
                     the  value. More generally, the readonly attribute should
                     not be relied on as a security mechanism.

                     Note that in zsh (like in pdksh  but  unlike  most  other
                     shells)  it  is still possible to create a local variable
                     of the same name as this is considered a different  vari-
                     able (though this variable, too, can be marked readonly).
                     Special variables that have  been  made  readonly  retain
                     their value and readonly attribute when made local.

              -t     Tags  the named parameters.  Tags have no special meaning
                     to the shell.  This flag has  a  different  meaning  when
                     used with -f; see above.

              -u     Convert  the  result to upper case whenever the parameter
                     is expanded.  The value is not converted  when  assigned.
                     This  flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see
                     above.

              -x     Mark for automatic export to the  environment  of  subse-
                     quently  executed  commands.  If the option GLOBAL_EXPORT
                     is set, this implies the option -g, unless +g is also ex-
                     plicitly  given; in other words the parameter is not made
                     local to the enclosing function.  This is for compatibil-
                     ity with previous versions of zsh.

       ulimit [ -HSa ] [ { -bcdfiklmnpqrsTtvwx | -N resource } [ limit ] ... ]
              Set  or  display  resource limits of the shell and the processes
              started by the shell.  The value of limit can be a number in the
              unit specified below or one of the values `unlimited', which re-
              moves the limit on the resource, or `hard', which uses the  cur-
              rent value of the hard limit on the resource.

              By  default, only soft limits are manipulated. If the -H flag is
              given use hard limits instead of soft limits.  If the -S flag is
              given together with the -H flag set both hard and soft limits.

              If no options are used, the file size limit (-f) is assumed.

              If limit is omitted the current value of the specified resources
              are printed.  When more than one resource value is printed,  the
              limit name and unit is printed before each value.

              When looping over multiple resources, the shell will abort imme-
              diately if it detects a badly formed argument.  However,  if  it
              fails to set a limit for some other reason it will continue try-
              ing to set the remaining limits.

              Not all the following resources are supported  on  all  systems.
              Running ulimit -a will show which are supported.

              -a     Lists all of the current resource limits.
              -b     Socket buffer size in bytes (N.B. not kilobytes)
              -c     512-byte blocks on the size of core dumps.
              -d     Kilobytes on the size of the data segment.
              -f     512-byte blocks on the size of files written.
              -i     The number of pending signals.
              -k     The number of kqueues allocated.
              -l     Kilobytes on the size of locked-in memory.
              -m     Kilobytes on the size of physical memory.
              -n     open file descriptors.
              -p     The number of pseudo-terminals.
              -q     Bytes in POSIX message queues.
              -r     Maximum  real  time priority.  On some systems where this
                     is not available, such as NetBSD, this has the  same  ef-
                     fect as -T for compatibility with sh.
              -s     Kilobytes on the size of the stack.
              -T     The number of simultaneous threads available to the user.
              -t     CPU seconds to be used.
              -u     The number of processes available to the user.
              -v     Kilobytes on the size of virtual memory.  On some systems
                     this refers to the limit called `address space'.
              -w     Kilobytes on the size of swapped out memory.
              -x     The number of locks on files.

              A resource may also be specified by integer in the form `-N  re-
              source',  where  resource corresponds to the integer defined for
              the resource by the operating system.  This may be used  to  set
              the  limits for resources known to the shell which do not corre-
              spond to option letters.  Such limits will be shown by number in
              the output of `ulimit -a'.

              The  number may alternatively be out of the range of limits com-
              piled into the shell.  The shell will try to read or  write  the
              limit anyway, and will report an error if this fails.

       umask [ -S ] [ mask ]
              The umask is set to mask.  mask can be either an octal number or
              a symbolic value as described in the chmod(1) man page.  If mask
              is  omitted, the current value is printed.  The -S option causes
              the mask to be printed as a symbolic value.  Otherwise, the mask
              is  printed  as an octal number.  Note that in the symbolic form
              the permissions you specify are those which are  to  be  allowed
              (not denied) to the users specified.

       unalias [ -ams ] name ...
              Removes  aliases.  This command works the same as unhash -a, ex-
              cept that the -a option removes all regular or  global  aliases,
              or  with  -s  all suffix aliases: in this case no name arguments
              may appear.  The options -m (remove by pattern) and  -s  without
              -a (remove listed suffix aliases) behave as for unhash -a.  Note
              that the meaning of -a is different between unalias and unhash.

       unfunction
              Same as unhash -f.

       unhash [ -adfms ] name ...
              Remove the element named name from an internal hash table.   The
              default  is remove elements from the command hash table.  The -a
              option causes unhash to remove regular or global  aliases;  note
              when  removing a global aliases that the argument must be quoted
              to prevent it from being expanded before  being  passed  to  the
              command.   The -s option causes unhash to remove suffix aliases.
              The -f option causes unhash to remove shell functions.   The  -d
              options  causes  unhash  to remove named directories.  If the -m
              flag is given the arguments are taken  as  patterns  (should  be
              quoted)  and  all  elements of the corresponding hash table with
              matching names will be removed.

       unlimit [ -hs ] resource ...
              The resource limit for each resource is set to the  hard  limit.
              If  the  -h  flag  is given and the shell has appropriate privi-
              leges, the hard resource limit for  each  resource  is  removed.
              The  resources  of  the shell process are only changed if the -s
              flag is given.

              The unlimit command is not made available by  default  when  the
              shell  starts in a mode emulating another shell.  It can be made
              available with the command `zmodload -F zsh/rlimits b:unlimit'.

       unset [ -fmv ] name ...
              Each named parameter is unset.  Local  parameters  remain  local
              even  if unset; they appear unset within scope, but the previous
              value will still reappear when the scope ends.

              Individual elements of associative array parameters may be unset
              by  using  subscript  syntax on name, which should be quoted (or
              the entire command prefixed with noglob)  to  protect  the  sub-
              script from filename generation.

              If  the -m flag is specified the arguments are taken as patterns
              (should be quoted) and all parameters with  matching  names  are
              unset.  Note that this cannot be used when unsetting associative
              array elements, as the subscript will be treated as part of  the
              pattern.

              The  -v  flag  specifies that name refers to parameters. This is
              the default behaviour.

              unset -f is equivalent to unfunction.

       unsetopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]
              Unset the options for the shell.  All options  specified  either
              with  flags or by name are unset.  If no arguments are supplied,
              the names of all options currently unset are printed.  If the -m
              flag  is given the arguments are taken as patterns (which should
              be quoted to preserve them from being interpreted as  glob  pat-
              terns),  and  all options with names matching these patterns are
              unset.

       vared  See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       wait [ job ... ]
              Wait for the specified jobs or processes.  If job is  not  given
              then  all currently active child processes are waited for.  Each
              job can be either a job specification or the process ID of a job
              in  the job table.  The exit status from this command is that of
              the job waited for.  If job represents an unknown job or process
              ID,  a  warning  is printed (unless the POSIX_BUILTINS option is
              set) and the exit status is 127.

              It is possible  to  wait  for  recent  processes  (specified  by
              process ID, not by job) that were running in the background even
              if the process has exited.  Typically the  process  ID  will  be
              recorded  by  capturing the value of the variable $! immediately
              after the process has been started.  There is  a  limit  on  the
              number  of process IDs remembered by the shell; this is given by
              the value of the system configuration parameter CHILD_MAX.  When
              this  limit  is  reached, older process IDs are discarded, least
              recently started processes first.

              Note there is no protection against  the  process  ID  wrapping,
              i.e.  if  the wait is not executed soon enough there is a chance
              the process waited for is the wrong  one.   A  conflict  implies
              both process IDs have been generated by the shell, as other pro-
              cesses are not recorded, and that the user is potentially inter-
              ested in both, so this problem is intrinsic to process IDs.

       whence [ -vcwfpamsS ] [ -x num ] name ...
              For each name, indicate how it would be interpreted if used as a
              command name.

              If name is not an alias,  built-in  command,  external  command,
              shell  function,  hashed  command,  or a reserved word, the exit
              status shall be non-zero, and -- if -v, -c, or -w was passed  --
              a  message will be written to standard output.  (This is differ-
              ent from other shells that write that message  to  standard  er-
              ror.)

              whence  is most useful when name is only the last path component
              of a command, i.e. does not include a `/'; in  particular,  pat-
              tern  matching only succeeds if just the non-directory component
              of the command is passed.

              -v     Produce a more verbose report.

              -c     Print the results  in  a  csh-like  format.   This  takes
                     precedence over -v.

              -w     For  each  name,  print `name: word' where word is one of
                     alias, builtin, command, function,  hashed,  reserved  or
                     none,  according  as  name  corresponds  to  an  alias, a
                     built-in command, an external command, a shell  function,
                     a command defined with the hash builtin, a reserved word,
                     or is not recognised.  This takes precedence over -v  and
                     -c.

              -f     Causes  the contents of a shell function to be displayed,
                     which would otherwise not happen unless the -c flag  were
                     used.

              -p     Do  a  path  search  for name even if it is an alias, re-
                     served word, shell function or builtin.

              -a     Do a search for all occurrences of  name  throughout  the
                     command  path.   Normally  only  the  first occurrence is
                     printed.

              -m     The arguments are taken as patterns  (pattern  characters
                     should  be  quoted), and the information is displayed for
                     each command matching one of these patterns.

              -s     If a pathname contains symlinks, print  the  symlink-free
                     pathname as well.

              -S     As  -s, but if the pathname had to be resolved by follow-
                     ing  multiple  symlinks,  the  intermediate   steps   are
                     printed, too.  The symlink resolved at each step might be
                     anywhere in the path.

              -x num Expand tabs when outputting shell functions using the  -c
                     option.  This has the same effect as the -x option to the
                     functions builtin.

       where [ -wpmsS ] [ -x num ] name ...
              Equivalent to whence -ca.

       which [ -wpamsS ] [ -x num ] name ...
              Equivalent to whence -c.

       zcompile [ -U ] [ -z | -k ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
       zcompile -ca [ -m ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
       zcompile -t file [ name ... ]
              This builtin  command  can  be  used  to  compile  functions  or
              scripts,  storing  the  compiled  form in a file, and to examine
              files containing the compiled  form.   This  allows  faster  au-
              toloading of functions and sourcing of scripts by avoiding pars-
              ing of the text when the files are read.

              The first form (without the -c, -a or -t options) creates a com-
              piled file.  If only the file argument is given, the output file
              has the name `file.zwc' and will be placed in the same directory
              as  the  file.  The shell will load the compiled file instead of
              the normal function file when the function  is  autoloaded;  see
              the section `Autoloading Functions' in zshmisc(1) for a descrip-
              tion of how autoloaded functions are  searched.   The  extension
              .zwc stands for `zsh word code'.

              If  there is at least one name argument, all the named files are
              compiled into the output file given as the first  argument.   If
              file  does  not end in .zwc, this extension is automatically ap-
              pended.  Files containing multiple compiled functions are called
              `digest'  files,  and are intended to be used as elements of the
              FPATH/fpath special array.

              The second form, with the -c or -a options, writes the  compiled
              definitions  for all the named functions into file.  For -c, the
              names must be functions currently  defined  in  the  shell,  not
              those  marked  for  autoloading.   Undefined  functions that are
              marked for autoloading may be written by using the -a option, in
              which case the fpath is searched and the contents of the defini-
              tion files for those functions,  if  found,  are  compiled  into
              file.   If both -c and -a are given, names of both defined func-
              tions and functions marked for autoloading may be given.  In ei-
              ther  case, the functions in files written with the -c or -a op-
              tion will be autoloaded as if the KSH_AUTOLOAD option  were  un-
              set.

              The reason for handling loaded and not-yet-loaded functions with
              different options is that some definition files for  autoloading
              define  multiple functions, including the function with the same
              name as the file, and, at the end, call that function.  In  such
              cases  the  output  of  `zcompile -c' does not include the addi-
              tional functions defined in the file, and any other  initializa-
              tion code in the file is lost.  Using `zcompile -a' captures all
              this extra information.

              If the -m option is combined with -c or -a, the names  are  used
              as  patterns  and  all  functions whose names match one of these
              patterns will be written. If no name is given,  the  definitions
              of  all functions currently defined or marked as autoloaded will
              be written.

              Note the second form cannot be used for compiling functions that
              include  redirections  as  part  of  the  definition rather than
              within the body of the function; for example

                     fn1() { { ... } >~/logfile }

              can be compiled but

                     fn1() { ... } >~/logfile

              cannot.  It is possible to use the first  form  of  zcompile  to
              compile  autoloadable  functions  that include the full function
              definition instead of just the body of the function.

              The third form, with the -t option, examines  an  existing  com-
              piled  file.  Without further arguments, the names of the origi-
              nal files compiled into it are listed.  The first line of output
              shows  the  version of the shell which compiled the file and how
              the file will be used (i.e. by reading it directly or by mapping
              it  into memory).  With arguments, nothing is output and the re-
              turn status is set to zero if definitions  for  all  names  were
              found  in  the compiled file, and non-zero if the definition for
              at least one name was not found.

              Other options:

              -U     Aliases are not expanded when compiling the named files.

              -R     When the compiled file is read, its contents  are  copied
                     into  the  shell's memory, rather than memory-mapped (see
                     -M).  This happens automatically on systems that  do  not
                     support memory mapping.

                     When compiling scripts instead of autoloadable functions,
                     it is often desirable to use this option;  otherwise  the
                     whole  file, including the code to define functions which
                     have already been defined,  will  remain  mapped,  conse-
                     quently wasting memory.

              -M     The  compiled file is mapped into the shell's memory when
                     read. This is done in such a way that multiple  instances
                     of  the  shell  running  on the same host will share this
                     mapped file.  If neither -R nor -M is given, the zcompile
                     builtin  decides what to do based on the size of the com-
                     piled file.

              -k
              -z     These options are used when the  compiled  file  contains
                     functions which are to be autoloaded. If -z is given, the
                     function will be autoloaded as if the KSH_AUTOLOAD option
                     is  not  set,  even if it is set at the time the compiled
                     file is read, while if the -k is given, the function will
                     be  loaded as if KSH_AUTOLOAD is set.  These options also
                     take precedence over any -k or -z  options  specified  to
                     the  autoload  builtin.  If  neither  of these options is
                     given, the function will be loaded as determined  by  the
                     setting  of  the KSH_AUTOLOAD option at the time the com-
                     piled file is read.

                     These options may also appear as many times as  necessary
                     between  the listed names to specify the loading style of
                     all following functions, up to the next -k or -z.

                     The created file always contains two versions of the com-
                     piled  format,  one  for  big-endian machines and one for
                     small-endian machines.  The upshot of this  is  that  the
                     compiled file is machine independent and if it is read or
                     mapped, only one half of the file is actually  used  (and
                     mapped).

       zformat
              See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zftp   See the section `The zsh/zftp Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zle    See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       zmodload [ -dL ] [ -s ] [ ... ]
       zmodload -F [ -alLme -P param ] module [ [+-]feature ... ]
       zmodload -e [ -A ] [ ... ]
       zmodload [ -a [ -bcpf [ -I ] ] ] [ -iL ] ...
       zmodload -u [ -abcdpf [ -I ] ] [ -iL ] ...
       zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
       zmodload -R modalias ...
              Performs operations relating to zsh's loadable modules.  Loading
              of modules while the shell is running (`dynamical  loading')  is
              not  available on all operating systems, or on all installations
              on a particular operating system, although the zmodload  command
              itself is always available and can be used to manipulate modules
              built into versions of the shell  executable  without  dynamical
              loading.

              Without  arguments the names of all currently loaded binary mod-
              ules are printed.  The -L option causes this list to be  in  the
              form  of  a  series  of zmodload commands.  Forms with arguments
              are:

              zmodload [ -is ] name ...
              zmodload -u [ -i ] name ...
                     In the simplest case, zmodload  loads  a  binary  module.
                     The  module  must  be in a file with a name consisting of
                     the specified name followed by a standard suffix, usually
                     `.so' (`.sl' on HPUX).  If the module to be loaded is al-
                     ready loaded the duplicate module is ignored.   If  zmod-
                     load  detects an inconsistency, such as an invalid module
                     name or circular dependency list, the current code  block
                     is  aborted.  If it is available, the module is loaded if
                     necessary, while if it is not available, non-zero  status
                     is silently returned.  The option -i is accepted for com-
                     patibility but has no effect.

                     The named module is searched for in the same way  a  com-
                     mand  is,  using $module_path instead of $path.  However,
                     the path search is performed even when  the  module  name
                     contains  a  `/', which it usually does.  There is no way
                     to prevent the path search.

                     If the module supports  features  (see  below),  zmodload
                     tries  to  enable all features when loading a module.  If
                     the module was successfully loaded but not  all  features
                     could be enabled, zmodload returns status 2.

                     If  the  option  -s  is given, no error is printed if the
                     module was not available (though other errors  indicating
                     a  problem with the module are printed).  The return sta-
                     tus indicates if the module was loaded.  This  is  appro-
                     priate if the caller considers the module optional.

                     With -u, zmodload unloads modules.  The same name must be
                     given that was given when the module was loaded,  but  it
                     is not necessary for the module to exist in the file sys-
                     tem.  The -i option suppresses the error if the module is
                     already unloaded (or was never loaded).

                     Each  module has a boot and a cleanup function.  The mod-
                     ule will not be loaded if its boot function fails.  Simi-
                     larly  a module can only be unloaded if its cleanup func-
                     tion runs successfully.

              zmodload -F [ -almLe -P param ] module [ [+-]feature ... ]
                     zmodload -F allows more selective control over  the  fea-
                     tures  provided  by  modules.  With no options apart from
                     -F, the module named module is loaded, if it was not  al-
                     ready  loaded, and the list of features is set to the re-
                     quired state.  If no features are specified,  the  module
                     is loaded, if it was not already loaded, but the state of
                     features is unchanged.  Each feature may be preceded by a
                     +  to  turn the feature on, or - to turn it off; the + is
                     assumed if neither character is present.  Any feature not
                     explicitly mentioned is left in its current state; if the
                     module was not previously loaded this means any such fea-
                     tures will remain disabled.  The return status is zero if
                     all features were set, 1 if the module  failed  to  load,
                     and  2  if some features could not be set (for example, a
                     parameter couldn't be added because there was a different
                     parameter of the same name) but the module was loaded.

                     The  standard  features are builtins, conditions, parame-
                     ters and math functions; these are indicated by the  pre-
                     fix  `b:',  `c:'  (`C:' for an infix condition), `p:' and
                     `f:', respectively, followed by the name that the  corre-
                     sponding  feature  would have in the shell.  For example,
                     `b:strftime'  indicates  a  builtin  named  strftime  and
                     p:EPOCHSECONDS  indicates a parameter named EPOCHSECONDS.
                     The module may provide other (`abstract') features of its
                     own as indicated by its documentation; these have no pre-
                     fix.

                     With -l or  -L,  features  provided  by  the  module  are
                     listed.   With -l alone, a list of features together with
                     their states is shown, one feature  per  line.   With  -L
                     alone,  a  zmodload  -F  command that would cause enabled
                     features of the module to be turned on  is  shown.   With
                     -lL,  a zmodload -F command that would cause all the fea-
                     tures to be set to their current state is shown.  If  one
                     of  these  combinations is given with the option -P param
                     then the parameter param is set to an array of  features,
                     either features together with their state or (if -L alone
                     is given) enabled features.

                     With the option -L the module name may be omitted; then a
                     list  of  all  enabled features for all modules providing
                     features is printed in the form of zmodload -F  commands.
                     If  -l  is also given, the state of both enabled and dis-
                     abled features is output in that form.

                     A set of features may be provided together with -l or  -L
                     and  a  module name; in that case only the state of those
                     features is considered.  Each feature may be preceded  by
                     +  or  -  but  the character has no effect.  If no set of
                     features is provided, all features are considered.

                     With -e, the command  first  tests  that  the  module  is
                     loaded;  if it is not, status 1 is returned.  If the mod-
                     ule is loaded, the list of features given as an  argument
                     is  examined.  Any feature given with no prefix is simply
                     tested to see if the  module  provides  it;  any  feature
                     given  with  a  prefix + or - is tested to see if is pro-
                     vided and in the given state.  If the tests on  all  fea-
                     tures  in  the  list  succeed, status 0 is returned, else
                     status 1.

                     With -m, each entry in the  given  list  of  features  is
                     taken as a pattern to be matched against the list of fea-
                     tures provided by the module.  An initial + or - must  be
                     given  explicitly.   This may not be combined with the -a
                     option as autoloads must be specified explicitly.

                     With -a, the given list of features  is  marked  for  au-
                     toload  from  the  specified module, which may not yet be
                     loaded.  An optional +  may  appear  before  the  feature
                     name.   If  the  feature is prefixed with -, any existing
                     autoload is removed.  The options -l and -L may  be  used
                     to list autoloads.  Autoloading is specific to individual
                     features; when the module is loaded  only  the  requested
                     feature  is  enabled.  Autoload requests are preserved if
                     the module is subsequently  unloaded  until  an  explicit
                     `zmodload  -Fa  module -feature' is issued.  It is not an
                     error to request an autoload for a feature  of  a  module
                     that is already loaded.

                     When  the  module  is  loaded  each  autoload  is checked
                     against the features actually provided by the module;  if
                     the  feature  is  not  provided  the  autoload request is
                     deleted.  A warning message is output; if the  module  is
                     being loaded to provide a different feature, and that au-
                     toload is successful, there is no effect on the status of
                     the  current command.  If the module is already loaded at
                     the time when zmodload -Fa is run, an  error  message  is
                     printed and status 1 returned.

                     zmodload  -Fa  can be used with the -l, -L, -e and -P op-
                     tions for listing and testing the existence of  autoload-
                     able features.  In this case -l is ignored if -L is spec-
                     ified.  zmodload -FaL with no module name lists autoloads
                     for all modules.

                     Note  that  only standard features as described above can
                     be autoloaded; other features require the  module  to  be
                     loaded before enabling.

              zmodload -d [ -L ] [ name ]
              zmodload -d name dep ...
              zmodload -ud name [ dep ... ]
                     The -d option can be used to specify module dependencies.
                     The modules named in the second and subsequent  arguments
                     will be loaded before the module named in the first argu-
                     ment.

                     With -d and one argument, all dependencies for that  mod-
                     ule are listed.  With -d and no arguments, all module de-
                     pendencies are listed.  This listing is by default  in  a
                     Makefile-like  format.  The -L option changes this format
                     to a list of zmodload -d commands.

                     If -d and -u are both used, dependencies are removed.  If
                     only  one  argument  is  given, all dependencies for that
                     module are removed.

              zmodload -ab [ -L ]
              zmodload -ab [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
              zmodload -ub [ -i ] builtin ...
                     The -ab option defines autoloaded builtins.   It  defines
                     the  specified  builtins.   When any of those builtins is
                     called, the module specified in  the  first  argument  is
                     loaded  and  all  its features are enabled (for selective
                     control of features use `zmodload  -F  -a'  as  described
                     above).   If  only  the name is given, one builtin is de-
                     fined, with the same name as the module.   -i  suppresses
                     the  error  if  the  builtin  is  already  defined or au-
                     toloaded, but not if another builtin of the same name  is
                     already defined.

                     With  -ab  and  no arguments, all autoloaded builtins are
                     listed, with the module  name  (if  different)  shown  in
                     parentheses  after  the  builtin  name.   The  -L  option
                     changes this format to a list of zmodload -a commands.

                     If -b is used together with the  -u  option,  it  removes
                     builtins  previously defined with -ab.  This is only pos-
                     sible if the builtin is not yet  loaded.   -i  suppresses
                     the error if the builtin is already removed (or never ex-
                     isted).

                     Autoload requests are retained if the  module  is  subse-
                     quently unloaded until an explicit `zmodload -ub builtin'
                     is issued.

              zmodload -ac [ -IL ]
              zmodload -ac [ -iI ] name [ cond ... ]
              zmodload -uc [ -iI ] cond ...
                     The -ac option is used  to  define  autoloaded  condition
                     codes.  The cond strings give the names of the conditions
                     defined by the module. The optional -I option is used  to
                     define  infix condition names. Without this option prefix
                     condition names are defined.

                     If given no condition names, all defined names are listed
                     (as  a  series  of  zmodload commands if the -L option is
                     given).

                     The -uc option removes definitions for autoloaded  condi-
                     tions.

              zmodload -ap [ -L ]
              zmodload -ap [ -i ] name [ parameter ... ]
              zmodload -up [ -i ] parameter ...
                     The  -p  option  is like the -b and -c options, but makes
                     zmodload work on autoloaded parameters instead.

              zmodload -af [ -L ]
              zmodload -af [ -i ] name [ function ... ]
              zmodload -uf [ -i ] function ...
                     The -f option is like the -b, -p,  and  -c  options,  but
                     makes zmodload work on autoloaded math functions instead.

              zmodload -a [ -L ]
              zmodload -a [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
              zmodload -ua [ -i ] builtin ...
                     Equivalent to -ab and -ub.

              zmodload -e [ -A ] [ string ... ]
                     The -e option without arguments lists all loaded modules;
                     if the -A option is also  given,  module  aliases  corre-
                     sponding  to loaded modules are also shown.  If arguments
                     are provided, nothing is printed; the  return  status  is
                     set  to  zero if all strings given as arguments are names
                     of loaded modules and to one if at least on string is not
                     the  name  of  a loaded module.  This can be used to test
                     for the availability of things  implemented  by  modules.
                     In  this case, any aliases are automatically resolved and
                     the -A flag is not used.

              zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
                     For each argument, if both modalias and module are given,
                     define modalias to be an alias for the module module.  If
                     the module modalias is ever subsequently  requested,  ei-
                     ther via a call to zmodload or implicitly, the shell will
                     attempt to load module instead.  If module is not  given,
                     show  the  definition  of  modalias.  If no arguments are
                     given, list all defined module aliases.  When listing, if
                     the  -L  flag  was  also  given, list the definition as a
                     zmodload command to recreate the alias.

                     The existence of aliases for modules is completely  inde-
                     pendent  of  whether the name resolved is actually loaded
                     as a module: while the alias exists, loading and  unload-
                     ing  the  module under any alias has exactly the same ef-
                     fect as using the resolved name, and does not affect  the
                     connection  between the alias and the resolved name which
                     can be removed either by zmodload -R or by redefining the
                     alias.   Chains of aliases (i.e. where the first resolved
                     name is itself an alias) are valid so long as  these  are
                     not  circular.   As  the  aliases take the same format as
                     module names, they may include path separators:  in  this
                     case,  there  is  no requirement for any part of the path
                     named to exist as the alias will be resolved first.   For
                     example, `any/old/alias' is always a valid alias.

                     Dependencies  added to aliased modules are actually added
                     to the resolved module; these remain if the alias is  re-
                     moved.   It is valid to create an alias whose name is one
                     of the standard shell modules and  which  resolves  to  a
                     different module.  However, if a module has dependencies,
                     it will not be possible to use  the  module  name  as  an
                     alias  as the module will already be marked as a loadable
                     module in its own right.

                     Apart from the above, aliases can be used in the zmodload
                     command  anywhere  module  names  are required.  However,
                     aliases will not be shown in lists of loaded modules with
                     a bare `zmodload'.

              zmodload -R modalias ...
                     For each modalias argument that was previously defined as
                     a module alias via zmodload -A, delete the alias.  If any
                     was  not defined, an error is caused and the remainder of
                     the line is ignored.

              Note that zsh makes no distinction  between  modules  that  were
              linked  into  the shell and modules that are loaded dynamically.
              In both cases this builtin command has to be used to make avail-
              able  the  builtins  and other things defined by modules (unless
              the module is autoloaded on these  definitions).  This  is  true
              even for systems that don't support dynamic loading of modules.

       zparseopts
              See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zprof  See the section `The zsh/zprof Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zpty   See the section `The zsh/zpty Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zregexparse
              See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zsocket
              See the section `The zsh/net/socket Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zstyle See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       ztcp   See the section `The zsh/net/tcp Module' in zshmodules(1).

ZSHZLE(1)                   General Commands Manual                  ZSHZLE(1)

NAME
       zshzle - zsh command line editor

DESCRIPTION
       If the ZLE option is set (which it is by default in interactive shells)
       and the shell input is attached to the terminal, the user  is  able  to
       edit command lines.

       There  are  two  display  modes.  The first, multiline mode, is the de-
       fault.  It only works if the TERM parameter is set to a valid  terminal
       type  that  can  move  the cursor up.  The second, single line mode, is
       used if TERM is invalid or incapable of moving the cursor up, or if the
       SINGLE_LINE_ZLE  option  is set.  This mode is similar to ksh, and uses
       no termcap sequences.  If TERM is "emacs", the ZLE option will be unset
       by default.

       The  parameters BAUD, COLUMNS, and LINES are also used by the line edi-
       tor. See Parameters Used By The Shell in zshparam(1).

       The parameter zle_highlight is also used by the line editor; see  Char-
       acter  Highlighting  below.  Highlighting of special characters and the
       region between the cursor and the mark (as set with set-mark-command in
       Emacs  mode,  or by visual-mode in Vi mode) is enabled by default; con-
       sult this reference for more information.  Irascible conservatives will
       wish  to  know  that  all highlighting may be disabled by the following
       setting:

              zle_highlight=(none)

       In many places, references are made to the numeric argument.  This  can
       by default be entered in emacs mode by holding the alt key and typing a
       number, or pressing escape before each digit, and in vi command mode by
       typing the number before entering a command.  Generally the numeric ar-
       gument causes the next command entered to  be  repeated  the  specified
       number  of  times, unless otherwise noted below; this is implemented by
       the digit-argument widget. See also the  Arguments  subsection  of  the
       Widgets  section  for some other ways the numeric argument can be modi-
       fied.

KEYMAPS
       A keymap in ZLE contains a set of bindings between  key  sequences  and
       ZLE commands.  The empty key sequence cannot be bound.

       There can be any number of keymaps at any time, and each keymap has one
       or more names.  If all of a keymap's names are deleted, it  disappears.
       bindkey can be used to manipulate keymap names.

       Initially, there are eight keymaps:

       emacs  EMACS emulation
       viins  vi emulation - insert mode
       vicmd  vi emulation - command mode
       viopp  vi emulation - operator pending
       visual vi emulation - selection active
       isearch
              incremental search mode
       command
              read a command name
       .safe  fallback keymap

       The  `.safe'  keymap is special.  It can never be altered, and the name
       can never be removed.  However, it can be linked to other names,  which
       can  be  removed.   In  the  future other special keymaps may be added;
       users should avoid  using  names  beginning  with  `.'  for  their  own
       keymaps.

       In addition to these names, either `emacs' or `viins' is also linked to
       the name `main'.  If one of the VISUAL or EDITOR environment  variables
       contain  the  string `vi' when the shell starts up then it will be `vi-
       ins', otherwise it will be `emacs'.  bindkey's -e and -v  options  pro-
       vide a convenient way to override this default choice.

       When  the  editor starts up, it will select the `main' keymap.  If that
       keymap doesn't exist, it will use `.safe' instead.

       In the `.safe' keymap, each single key is bound to self-insert,  except
       for  ^J  (line  feed)  and  ^M (return) which are bound to accept-line.
       This is deliberately not pleasant to use; if you are using it, it means
       you deleted the main keymap, and you should put it back.

   Reading Commands
       When ZLE is reading a command from the terminal, it may read a sequence
       that is bound to some command and is also a prefix of  a  longer  bound
       string.  In this case ZLE will wait a certain time to see if more char-
       acters are typed, and if not (or they don't match any longer string) it
       will  execute  the  binding.  This timeout is defined by the KEYTIMEOUT
       parameter; its default is 0.4 sec.  There is no timeout if  the  prefix
       string is not itself bound to a command.

       The  key  timeout  is also applied when ZLE is reading the bytes from a
       multibyte character string when it is in the appropriate  mode.   (This
       requires that the shell was compiled with multibyte mode enabled; typi-
       cally also the locale has characters with the UTF-8 encoding,  although
       any multibyte encoding known to the operating system is supported.)  If
       the second or a subsequent byte is not read within the timeout  period,
       the shell acts as if ? were typed and resets the input state.

       As  well  as ZLE commands, key sequences can be bound to other strings,
       by using `bindkey -s'.  When such a sequence is read,  the  replacement
       string  is pushed back as input, and the command reading process starts
       again using these fake keystrokes.  This input can itself  invoke  fur-
       ther replacement strings, but in order to detect loops the process will
       be stopped if there are twenty such replacements without a real command
       being read.

       A  key sequence typed by the user can be turned into a command name for
       use in user-defined widgets with the read-command widget, described  in
       the subsection `Miscellaneous' of the section `Standard Widgets' below.

   Local Keymaps
       While  for  normal editing a single keymap is used exclusively, in many
       modes a local keymap allows for some keys to be customised.  For  exam-
       ple,  in  an  incremental  search mode, a binding in the isearch keymap
       will override a binding in the main keymap but all keys  that  are  not
       overridden can still be used.

       If  a key sequence is defined in a local keymap, it will hide a key se-
       quence in the global keymap that is a prefix of that sequence. An exam-
       ple  of  this  occurs with the binding of iw in viopp as this hides the
       binding of i in vicmd. However, a longer sequence in the global  keymap
       that  shares the same prefix can still apply so for example the binding
       of ^Xa in the global keymap will be unaffected by the binding of ^Xb in
       the local keymap.

ZLE BUILTINS
       The  ZLE  module  contains  three related builtin commands. The bindkey
       command manipulates keymaps and key bindings; the vared command invokes
       ZLE  on the value of a shell parameter; and the zle command manipulates
       editing widgets and allows command line access  to  ZLE  commands  from
       within shell functions.

       bindkey [ options ] -l [ -L ] [ keymap ... ]
       bindkey [ options ] -d
       bindkey [ options ] -D keymap ...
       bindkey [ options ] -A old-keymap new-keymap
       bindkey [ options ] -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
       bindkey [ options ] -m
       bindkey [ options ] -r in-string ...
       bindkey [ options ] -s in-string out-string ...
       bindkey [ options ] in-string command ...
       bindkey [ options ] [ in-string ]
              bindkey's  options  can be divided into three categories: keymap
              selection for the current command, operation selection, and oth-
              ers.  The keymap selection options are:

              -e     Selects  keymap `emacs' for any operations by the current
                     command, and also links `emacs' to `main' so that  it  is
                     selected by default the next time the editor starts.

              -v     Selects  keymap `viins' for any operations by the current
                     command, and also links `viins' to `main' so that  it  is
                     selected by default the next time the editor starts.

              -a     Selects  keymap `vicmd' for any operations by the current
                     command.

              -M keymap
                     The keymap specifies a keymap name that is  selected  for
                     any operations by the current command.

              If  a keymap selection is required and none of the options above
              are used, the `main' keymap is used.   Some  operations  do  not
              permit a keymap to be selected, namely:

              -l     List  all  existing  keymap  names;  if any arguments are
                     given, list just those keymaps.

                     If the -L option is also used, list in the form of  bind-
                     key commands to create or link the keymaps.  `bindkey -lL
                     main' shows which keymap is linked to `main', if any, and
                     hence if the standard emacs or vi emulation is in effect.
                     This option does not show the  .safe  keymap  because  it
                     cannot  be  created  in that fashion; however, neither is
                     `bindkey -lL .safe' reported as an error, it simply  out-
                     puts nothing.

              -d     Delete  all  existing  keymaps  and  reset to the default
                     state.

              -D keymap ...
                     Delete the named keymaps.

              -A old-keymap new-keymap
                     Make the new-keymap name an alias for old-keymap, so that
                     both  names  refer  to  the  same keymap.  The names have
                     equal standing; if either is deleted, the other  remains.
                     If there is already a keymap with the new-keymap name, it
                     is deleted.

              -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
                     Create a new keymap, named new-keymap.  If a  keymap  al-
                     ready  has  that  name,  it is deleted.  If an old-keymap
                     name is given, the new keymap is initialized to be a  du-
                     plicate of it, otherwise the new keymap will be empty.

              To  use  a  newly  created  keymap, it should be linked to main.
              Hence the sequence of commands to create and use  a  new  keymap
              `mymap'  initialized  from  the  emacs keymap (which remains un-
              changed) is:

                     bindkey -N mymap emacs
                     bindkey -A mymap main

              Note that while `bindkey -A newmap main' will work  when  newmap
              is emacs or viins, it will not work for vicmd, as switching from
              vi insert to command mode becomes impossible.

              The following operations act on the `main' keymap if  no  keymap
              selection option was given:

              -m     Add the built-in set of meta-key bindings to the selected
                     keymap.  Only keys that are unbound or bound to  self-in-
                     sert are affected.

              -r in-string ...
                     Unbind  the  specified in-strings in the selected keymap.
                     This is exactly equivalent to binding the strings to  un-
                     defined-key.

                     When -R is also used, interpret the in-strings as ranges.

                     When  -p  is  also used, the in-strings specify prefixes.
                     Any binding that has the given in-string as a prefix, not
                     including  the  binding for the in-string itself, if any,
                     will be removed.  For example,

                            bindkey -rpM viins '^['

                     will remove all bindings in the vi-insert  keymap  begin-
                     ning with an escape character (probably cursor keys), but
                     leave the binding for the escape character itself (proba-
                     bly  vi-cmd-mode).   This is incompatible with the option
                     -R.

              -s in-string out-string ...
                     Bind each in-string to each out-string.   When  in-string
                     is  typed,  out-string will be pushed back and treated as
                     input to the line editor.  When -R is also  used,  inter-
                     pret the in-strings as ranges.

                     Note  that  both  in-string and out-string are subject to
                     the same form of interpretation, as described below.

              in-string command ...
                     Bind each in-string to each command.  When  -R  is  used,
                     interpret the in-strings as ranges.

              [ in-string ]
                     List  key  bindings.   If  an in-string is specified, the
                     binding of that string in the  selected  keymap  is  dis-
                     played.   Otherwise,  all  key  bindings  in the selected
                     keymap are displayed.  (As a special case, if the  -e  or
                     -v  option  is  used alone, the keymap is not displayed -
                     the implicit linking of keymaps is the  only  thing  that
                     happens.)

                     When  the  option  -p  is  used,  the  in-string  must be
                     present.  The listing shows all bindings which  have  the
                     given  key  sequence as a prefix, not including any bind-
                     ings for the key sequence itself.

                     When the -L option is used, the list is in  the  form  of
                     bindkey commands to create the key bindings.

              When  the  -R  option is used as noted above, a valid range con-
              sists of two characters, with an optional `-' between them.  All
              characters  between  the  two specified, inclusive, are bound as
              specified.

              For either in-string or out-string,  the  following  escape  se-
              quences are recognised:

              \a     bell character
              \b     backspace
              \e, \E escape
              \f     form feed
              \n     linefeed (newline)
              \r     carriage return
              \t     horizontal tab
              \v     vertical tab
              \NNN   character code in octal
              \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
              \uNNNN unicode character code in hexadecimal
              \UNNNNNNNN
                     unicode character code in hexadecimal
              \M[-]X character with meta bit set
              \C[-]X control character
              ^X     control character

              In all other cases, `\' escapes the following character.  Delete
              is written as `^?'.  Note that `\M^?' and  `^\M?'  are  not  the
              same, and that (unlike emacs), the bindings `\M-X' and `\eX' are
              entirely distinct, although they are  initialized  to  the  same
              bindings by `bindkey -m'.

       vared [ -Aacghe ] [ -p prompt ] [ -r rprompt ]
             [ -M main-keymap ] [ -m vicmd-keymap ]
             [ -i init-widget ] [ -f finish-widget ]
             [ -t tty ] name
              The  value of the parameter name is loaded into the edit buffer,
              and the line editor is invoked.  When the editor exits, name  is
              set  to  the  string  value returned by the editor.  When the -c
              flag is given, the parameter is created if  it  doesn't  already
              exist.   The -a flag may be given with -c to create an array pa-
              rameter, or the -A flag to create an associative array.  If  the
              type of an existing parameter does not match the type to be cre-
              ated, the parameter is unset and recreated.  The -g flag may  be
              given  to  suppress  warnings  from  the  WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL and
              WARN_NESTED_VAR options.

              If an array or array slice is being edited, separator characters
              as  defined  in  $IFS  will be shown quoted with a backslash, as
              will backslashes themselves.  Conversely, when the  edited  text
              is  split  into an array, a backslash quotes an immediately fol-
              lowing separator character or backslash; no other  special  han-
              dling of backslashes, or any handling of quotes, is performed.

              Individual  elements  of existing array or associative array pa-
              rameters may be edited by using subscript syntax on  name.   New
              elements are created automatically, even without -c.

              If  the  -p flag is given, the following string will be taken as
              the prompt to display at the left.  If the -r flag is given, the
              following  string  gives the prompt to display at the right.  If
              the -h flag is specified, the history can be accessed from  ZLE.
              If  the -e flag is given, typing ^D (Control-D) on an empty line
              causes vared to exit immediately with a non-zero return value.

              The -M option gives a keymap to link to the main  keymap  during
              editing,  and  the -m option gives a keymap to link to the vicmd
              keymap during editing.  For vi-style editing, this allows a pair
              of  keymaps  to override viins and vicmd.  For emacs-style edit-
              ing, only -M is normally needed but the -m option may  still  be
              used.  On exit, the previous keymaps will be restored.

              Vared  calls  the  usual  `zle-line-init'  and `zle-line-finish'
              hooks before and after it takes control. Using the -i and -f op-
              tions,  it  is  possible to replace these with other custom wid-
              gets.

              If `-t tty' is given, tty is the name of a terminal device to be
              used  instead of the default /dev/tty.  If tty does not refer to
              a terminal an error is reported.

       zle
       zle -l [ -L | -a ] [ string ... ]
       zle -D widget ...
       zle -A old-widget new-widget
       zle -N widget [ function ]
       zle -f flag [ flag... ]
       zle -C widget completion-widget function
       zle -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
       zle -M string
       zle -U string
       zle -K keymap
       zle -F [ -L | -w ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
       zle -I
       zle -T [ tc function | -r tc | -L ]
       zle widget [ -n num ] [ -f flag ] [ -Nw ] [ -K keymap ] args ...
              The zle builtin performs a number of different actions  concern-
              ing ZLE.

              With no options and no arguments, only the return status will be
              set.  It is zero if ZLE is currently active and widgets could be
              invoked using this builtin command and non-zero otherwise.  Note
              that even if non-zero status is returned, zle may still  be  ac-
              tive  as  part of the completion system; this does not allow di-
              rect calls to ZLE widgets.

              Otherwise, which operation it performs depends on its options:

              -l [ -L | -a ] [ string ]
                     List all existing user-defined widgets.  If the -L option
                     is  used,  list in the form of zle commands to create the
                     widgets.

                     When combined with the -a option, all  widget  names  are
                     listed,  including  the builtin ones. In this case the -L
                     option is ignored.

                     If at least one string is given, and -a is present or  -L
                     is  not used, nothing will be printed.  The return status
                     will be zero if all strings are names of existing widgets
                     and  non-zero  if  at least one string is not a name of a
                     defined widget.  If -a is also present, all widget  names
                     are  used  for  the comparison including builtin widgets,
                     else only user-defined widgets are used.

                     If at least one string is present and the  -L  option  is
                     used, user-defined widgets matching any string are listed
                     in the form of zle commands to create the widgets.

              -D widget ...
                     Delete the named widgets.

              -A old-widget new-widget
                     Make the new-widget name an alias for old-widget, so that
                     both  names  refer  to  the  same widget.  The names have
                     equal standing; if either is deleted, the other  remains.
                     If there is already a widget with the new-widget name, it
                     is deleted.

              -N widget [ function ]
                     Create a user-defined widget.  If there is already a wid-
                     get with the specified name, it is overwritten.  When the
                     new widget is invoked from within the editor, the  speci-
                     fied  shell  function  is called.  If no function name is
                     specified, it defaults to the same name  as  the  widget.
                     For further information, see the section `Widgets' below.

              -f flag [ flag... ]
                     Set various flags on the running widget.  Possible values
                     for flag are:

                     yank for indicating that the widget has yanked text  into
                     the buffer.  If the widget is wrapping an existing inter-
                     nal widget, no further action is necessary, but if it has
                     inserted the text manually, then it should also take care
                     to set YANK_START  and  YANK_END  correctly.   yankbefore
                     does  the  same  but is used when the yanked text appears
                     after the cursor.

                     kill for indicating that text has been  killed  into  the
                     cutbuffer.   When repeatedly invoking a kill widget, text
                     is appended to the cutbuffer instead of replacing it, but
                     when  wrapping such widgets, it is necessary to call `zle
                     -f kill' to retain this effect.

                     vichange for indicating that the widget represents  a  vi
                     change  that  can  be  repeated  as  a whole with `vi-re-
                     peat-change'. The flag should be set early in  the  func-
                     tion  before  inspecting the value of NUMERIC or invoking
                     other widgets. This has no effect for  a  widget  invoked
                     from  insert mode. If insert mode is active when the wid-
                     get finishes, the change extends until next returning  to
                     command mode.

              -C widget completion-widget function
                     Create a user-defined completion widget named widget. The
                     completion widget will behave like the  built-in  comple-
                     tion-widget  whose name is given as completion-widget. To
                     generate the completions,  the  shell  function  function
                     will  be  called.   For further information, see zshcomp-
                     wid(1).

              -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
                     Redisplay the command line.  If a display-string is given
                     and  not empty, this is shown in the status line (immedi-
                     ately below the line being edited).

                     If the optional strings are given they are  listed  below
                     the  prompt  in  the  same  way  as  completion lists are
                     printed. If no strings are given but  the  -c  option  is
                     used such a list is cleared.

                     Note  that  immediately after returning from running wid-
                     gets, the  command  line  will  be  redisplayed  and  the
                     strings displayed will be erased.  Therefore, this option
                     is only useful for widgets that do not  exit  immediately
                     after using it.

                     This  command  can  safely be called outside user defined
                     widgets; if zle is active, the display will be refreshed,
                     while  if  zle  is not active, the command has no effect.
                     In this case there will usually be no other arguments.

                     The status is zero if zle was active, else one.

              -M string
                     As with the -R option, the string will be displayed below
                     the  command  line; unlike the -R option, the string will
                     not be put into the  status  line  but  will  instead  be
                     printed  normally  below the prompt.  This means that the
                     string will still be displayed after the  widget  returns
                     (until it is overwritten by subsequent commands).

              -U string
                     This  pushes  the characters in the string onto the input
                     stack of ZLE.  After the widget currently  executed  fin-
                     ishes  ZLE will behave as if the characters in the string
                     were typed by the user.

                     As ZLE uses a stack, if this option  is  used  repeatedly
                     the  last  string pushed onto the stack will be processed
                     first.  However, the characters in each  string  will  be
                     processed  in  the  order  in  which  they  appear in the
                     string.

              -K keymap
                     Selects the keymap named keymap.  An error  message  will
                     be displayed if there is no such keymap.

                     This  keymap selection affects the interpretation of fol-
                     lowing keystrokes within this  invocation  of  ZLE.   Any
                     following  invocation  (e.g., the next command line) will
                     start as usual with the `main' keymap selected.

              -F [ -L | -w ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
                     Only available if your system supports one of the  `poll'
                     or `select' system calls; most modern systems do.

                     Installs handler (the name of a shell function) to handle
                     input from file descriptor fd.  Installing a handler  for
                     an  fd  which is already handled causes the existing han-
                     dler to be replaced.  Any number of handlers for any num-
                     ber  of readable file descriptors may be installed.  Note
                     that zle makes no attempt to check whether this fd is ac-
                     tually  readable  when  installing the handler.  The user
                     must make their own arrangements for  handling  the  file
                     descriptor when zle is not active.

                     When zle is attempting to read data, it will examine both
                     the terminal and the list of handled fd's.  If  data  be-
                     comes  available  on a handled fd, zle calls handler with
                     the fd which is ready for reading as the first  argument.
                     Under normal circumstances this is the only argument, but
                     if an error was detected, a second argument provides  de-
                     tails:  `hup'  for  a  disconnect, `nval' for a closed or
                     otherwise invalid descriptor, or `err' for any other con-
                     dition.   Systems  that  support only the `select' system
                     call always use `err'.

                     If the option -w is also given, the handler is instead  a
                     line  editor widget, typically a shell function made into
                     a widget using `zle -N'.  In that case  handler  can  use
                     all  the  facilities of zle to update the current editing
                     line.  Note, however, that as handling fd takes place  at
                     a low level changes to the display will not automatically
                     appear; the widget should call `zle -R' to  force  redis-
                     play.  As of this writing, widget handlers only support a
                     single argument and thus are never passed  a  string  for
                     error  state, so widgets must be prepared to test the de-
                     scriptor themselves.

                     If either type of handler produces output to  the  termi-
                     nal, it should call `zle -I' before doing so (see below).
                     Handlers should not attempt to read from the terminal.

                     If no handler is given, but an fd is present, any handler
                     for  that fd is removed.  If there is none, an error mes-
                     sage is printed and status 1 is returned.

                     If no arguments are given, or the -L option is  supplied,
                     a  list  of  handlers  is  printed in a form which can be
                     stored for later execution.

                     An fd (but not a handler) may optionally  be  given  with
                     the  -L  option; in this case, the function will list the
                     handler if any, else silently return status 1.

                     Note that this feature should be used with care.   Activ-
                     ity  on one of the fd's which is not properly handled can
                     cause the terminal to become unusable.   Removing  an  fd
                     handler from within a signal trap may cause unpredictable
                     behavior.

                     Here is a simple example of using this feature.   A  con-
                     nection  to  a  remote TCP port is created using the ztcp
                     command; see the description of the zsh/net/tcp module in
                     zshmodules(1).   Then a handler is installed which simply
                     prints out any data which  arrives  on  this  connection.
                     Note that `select' will indicate that the file descriptor
                     needs handling if the remote side has closed the  connec-
                     tion; we handle that by testing for a failed read.

                            if ztcp pwspc 2811; then
                              tcpfd=$REPLY
                              handler() {
                                zle -I
                                local line
                                if ! read -r line <&$1; then
                                  # select marks this fd if we reach EOF,
                                  # so handle this specially.
                                  print "[Read on fd $1 failed, removing.]" >&2
                                  zle -F $1
                                  return 1
                                fi
                                print -r - $line
                              }
                              zle -F $tcpfd handler
                            fi

              -I     Unusually,  this  option  is most useful outside ordinary
                     widget functions, though it may be used within if  normal
                     output  to  the terminal is required.  It invalidates the
                     current zle display in preparation for output;  typically
                     this  will  be from a trap function.  It has no effect if
                     zle is not active.  When a trap exits, the  shell  checks
                     to  see if the display needs restoring, hence the follow-
                     ing will print output in such a way as not to disturb the
                     line being edited:

                            TRAPUSR1() {
                              # Invalidate zle display
                              [[ -o zle ]] && zle -I
                              # Show output
                              print Hello
                            }

                     In  general,  the  trap function may need to test whether
                     zle is active before using this method (as shown  in  the
                     example),  since  the  zsh/zle  module  may  not  even be
                     loaded; if it is not, the command can be skipped.

                     It is possible to call `zle -I' several times before con-
                     trol  is returned to the editor; the display will only be
                     invalidated the first time to minimise disruption.

                     Note that there are normally better ways of  manipulating
                     the  display  from  within zle widgets; see, for example,
                     `zle -R' above.

                     The returned status is zero if zle was invalidated,  even
                     though  this may have been by a previous call to `zle -I'
                     or by a system notification.  To test if a zle widget may
                     be  called  at  this point, execute zle with no arguments
                     and examine the return status.

              -T     This is used to add, list or remove internal  transforma-
                     tions on the processing performed by the line editor.  It
                     is typically used only for debugging or  testing  and  is
                     therefore of little interest to the general user.

                     `zle  -T  transformation  func'  specifies that the given
                     transformation (see below) is effected by shell  function
                     func.

                     `zle -Tr transformation' removes the given transformation
                     if it was present (it is not an error if none was).

                     `zle -TL' can be used to list  all  transformations  cur-
                     rently in operation.

                     Currently  the  only  transformation is tc.  This is used
                     instead of outputting  termcap  codes  to  the  terminal.
                     When  the  transformation is in operation the shell func-
                     tion is passed the termcap code that would be  output  as
                     its  first  argument; if the operation required a numeric
                     argument, that is passed as a second argument.  The func-
                     tion  should  set  the shell variable REPLY to the trans-
                     formed termcap code.  Typically this is used  to  produce
                     some  simply  formatted  version of the code and optional
                     argument for debugging or testing.  Note that this trans-
                     formation is not applied to other non-printing characters
                     such as carriage returns and newlines.

              widget [ -n num ] [ -f flag ] [ -Nw ] [ -K keymap ] args ...
                     Invoke the specified widget.  This can only be done  when
                     ZLE  is  active;  normally this will be within a user-de-
                     fined widget.

                     With the options -n and -N, the current numeric  argument
                     will be saved and then restored after the call to widget;
                     `-n num' sets the numeric argument  temporarily  to  num,
                     while  `-N' sets it to the default, i.e. as if there were
                     none.

                     With the option -K, keymap will be used  as  the  current
                     keymap  during the execution of the widget.  The previous
                     keymap will be restored when the widget exits.

                     Normally, calling a widget in this way does not  set  the
                     special  parameter WIDGET and related parameters, so that
                     the environment appears as if the top-level widget called
                     by  the user were still active.  With the option -w, WID-
                     GET and related parameters are set to reflect the  widget
                     being executed by the zle call.

                     Normally, when widget returns the special parameter LAST-
                     WIDGET will point to it.  This can be inhibited by  pass-
                     ing the option -f nolast.

                     Any  further arguments will be passed to the widget; note
                     that as standard argument handling is performed, any gen-
                     eral  argument list should be preceded by --.  If it is a
                     shell function, these are passed down as  positional  pa-
                     rameters;  for  builtin widgets it is up to the widget in
                     question what it does with them.  Currently arguments are
                     only handled by the incremental-search commands, the his-
                     tory-search-forward and -backward and  the  corresponding
                     functions prefixed by vi-, and by universal-argument.  No
                     error is flagged if the command does not  use  the  argu-
                     ments, or only uses some of them.

                     The  return status reflects the success or failure of the
                     operation carried out by  the  widget,  or  if  it  is  a
                     user-defined  widget the return status of the shell func-
                     tion.

                     A non-zero return status causes the shell  to  beep  when
                     the  widget  exits,  unless the BEEP options was unset or
                     the widget was called via the zle  command.   Thus  if  a
                     user defined widget requires an immediate beep, it should
                     call the beep widget directly.

ZLE WIDGETS
       All actions in the editor are performed by `widgets'.  A  widget's  job
       is  simply to perform some small action.  The ZLE commands that key se-
       quences in keymaps are bound to are in fact widgets.   Widgets  can  be
       user-defined or built in.

       The standard widgets built into ZLE are listed in the section `Standard
       Widgets' below.  Other built-in widgets can be defined by other modules
       (see  zshmodules(1)).   Each  built-in widget has two names: its normal
       canonical name, and the same name preceded by a `.'.  The `.'  name  is
       special:  it  can't  be  rebound to a different widget.  This makes the
       widget available even when its usual name has been redefined.

       User-defined widgets are defined using `zle  -N',  and  implemented  as
       shell  functions.  When the widget is executed, the corresponding shell
       function is executed, and can perform editing (or other)  actions.   It
       is recommended that user-defined widgets should not have names starting
       with `.'.

USER-DEFINED WIDGETS
       User-defined widgets, being implemented as shell functions, can execute
       any  normal  shell  command.   They can also run other widgets (whether
       built-in or user-defined) using the zle builtin command.  The  standard
       input  of the function is redirected from /dev/null to prevent external
       commands from unintentionally blocking ZLE by reading from  the  termi-
       nal,  but  read -k or read -q can be used to read characters.  Finally,
       they can examine and edit the ZLE buffer being edited  by  reading  and
       setting the special parameters described below.

       These  special parameters are always available in widget functions, but
       are not in any way special outside ZLE.  If they have some normal value
       outside  ZLE,  that  value is temporarily inaccessible, but will return
       when the widget function exits.  These special parameters in fact  have
       local scope, like parameters created in a function using local.

       Inside  completion  widgets and traps called while ZLE is active, these
       parameters are available read-only.

       Note that the parameters appear as local to any  ZLE  widget  in  which
       they  appear.  Hence if it is desired to override them this needs to be
       done within a nested function:

              widget-function() {
                # $WIDGET here refers to the special variable
                # that is local inside widget-function
                () {
                   # This anonymous nested function allows WIDGET
                   # to be used as a local variable.  The -h
                   # removes the special status of the variable.
                   local -h WIDGET
                }
              }

       BUFFER (scalar)
              The entire contents of the edit buffer.  If it  is  written  to,
              the  cursor remains at the same offset, unless that would put it
              outside the buffer.

       BUFFERLINES (integer)
              The number of screen lines needed for the edit buffer  currently
              displayed  on  screen (i.e. without any changes to the preceding
              parameters done after the last redisplay); read-only.

       CONTEXT (scalar)
              The context in which zle was called to read a  line;  read-only.
              One of the values:

              start  The start of a command line (at prompt PS1).

              cont   A continuation to a command line (at prompt PS2).

              select In a select loop (at prompt PS3).

              vared  Editing a variable in vared.

       CURSOR (integer)
              The  offset  of  the cursor, within the edit buffer.  This is in
              the  range  0  to  $#BUFFER,  and  is  by  definition  equal  to
              $#LBUFFER.   Attempts to move the cursor outside the buffer will
              result in the cursor being moved to the appropriate end  of  the
              buffer.

       CUTBUFFER (scalar)
              The  last item cut using one of the `kill-' commands; the string
              which the next yank would insert in the line.  Later entries  in
              the  kill ring are in the array killring.  Note that the command
              `zle copy-region-as-kill string' can be used to set the text  of
              the  cut buffer from a shell function and cycle the kill ring in
              the same way as interactively killing text.

       HISTNO (integer)
              The current history number.  Setting this has the same effect as
              moving  up  or  down in the history to the corresponding history
              line.  An attempt to set it is ignored if the line is not stored
              in  the  history.   Note  this  is not the same as the parameter
              HISTCMD, which always gives the number of the history line being
              added  to  the  main shell's history.  HISTNO refers to the line
              being retrieved within zle.

       ISEARCHMATCH_ACTIVE (integer)
       ISEARCHMATCH_START (integer)
       ISEARCHMATCH_END (integer)
              ISEARCHMATCH_ACTIVE indicates whether a part of  the  BUFFER  is
              currently  matched  by  an  incremental search pattern. ISEARCH-
              MATCH_START  and  ISEARCHMATCH_END  give  the  location  of  the
              matched  part and are in the same units as CURSOR. They are only
              valid for reading when ISEARCHMATCH_ACTIVE is non-zero.

              All parameters are read-only.

       KEYMAP (scalar)
              The name of the currently selected keymap; read-only.

       KEYS (scalar)
              The keys typed to invoke  this  widget,  as  a  literal  string;
              read-only.

       KEYS_QUEUED_COUNT (integer)
              The number of bytes pushed back to the input queue and therefore
              available for  reading  immediately  before  any  I/O  is  done;
              read-only.  See also PENDING; the two values are distinct.

       killring (array)
              The  array  of  previously  killed items, with the most recently
              killed first.  This gives the items that would be retrieved by a
              yank-pop  in  the  same order.  Note, however, that the most re-
              cently killed item is in $CUTBUFFER; $killring shows  the  array
              of previous entries.

              The  default size for the kill ring is eight, however the length
              may be changed by normal array operations.  Any empty string  in
              the kill ring is ignored by the yank-pop command, hence the size
              of the array effectively sets the maximum  length  of  the  kill
              ring,  while  the  number  of non-zero strings gives the current
              length, both as seen by the user at the command line.

       LASTABORTEDSEARCH (scalar)
              The last search string used by an interactive  search  that  was
              aborted by the user (status 3 returned by the search widget).

       LASTSEARCH (scalar)
              The last search string used by an interactive search; read-only.
              This is set even if the search failed (status 0, 1 or 2 returned
              by the search widget), but not if it was aborted by the user.

       LASTWIDGET (scalar)
              The name of the last widget that was executed; read-only.

       LBUFFER (scalar)
              The part of the buffer that lies to the left of the cursor posi-
              tion.  If it is assigned to, only that part of the buffer is re-
              placed,  and the cursor remains between the new $LBUFFER and the
              old $RBUFFER.

       MARK (integer)
              Like CURSOR, but for the mark. With vi-mode operators that  wait
              for  a movement command to select a region of text, setting MARK
              allows the selection to extend in both directions from the  ini-
              tial cursor position.

       NUMERIC (integer)
              The numeric argument. If no numeric argument was given, this pa-
              rameter is unset. When this is set  inside  a  widget  function,
              builtin widgets called with the zle builtin command will use the
              value assigned. If it is unset inside a widget function, builtin
              widgets called behave as if no numeric argument was given.

       PENDING (integer)
              The  number of bytes pending for input, i.e. the number of bytes
              which have already been typed and can immediately  be  read.  On
              systems  where  the  shell  is not able to get this information,
              this parameter will always have a  value  of  zero.   Read-only.
              See also KEYS_QUEUED_COUNT; the two values are distinct.

       PREBUFFER (scalar)
              In  a  multi-line  input at the secondary prompt, this read-only
              parameter contains the contents of the lines before the one  the
              cursor is currently in.

       PREDISPLAY (scalar)
              Text  to be displayed before the start of the editable text buf-
              fer.  This does not have to be a complete  line;  to  display  a
              complete  line, a newline must be appended explicitly.  The text
              is reset on each new invocation (but not  recursive  invocation)
              of zle.

       POSTDISPLAY (scalar)
              Text  to be displayed after the end of the editable text buffer.
              This does not have to be a complete line; to display a  complete
              line, a newline must be prepended explicitly.  The text is reset
              on each new invocation (but not recursive invocation) of zle.

       RBUFFER (scalar)
              The part of the buffer that lies to the right of the cursor  po-
              sition.   If  it is assigned to, only that part of the buffer is
              replaced, and the cursor remains between the  old  $LBUFFER  and
              the new $RBUFFER.

       REGION_ACTIVE (integer)
              Indicates if the region is currently active.  It can be assigned
              0 or 1 to deactivate and activate  the  region  respectively.  A
              value of 2 activates the region in line-wise mode with the high-
              lighted text extending for whole lines only; see Character High-
              lighting below.

       region_highlight (array)
              Each element of this array may be set to a string that describes
              highlighting for an arbitrary region of the  command  line  that
              will  take effect the next time the command line is redisplayed.
              Highlighting of the non-editable parts of the  command  line  in
              PREDISPLAY  and  POSTDISPLAY  are  possible, but note that the P
              flag is needed for character indexing to include PREDISPLAY.

              Each  string  consists  of  the  following  whitespace-separated
              parts:

              •      Optionally,  a `P' to signify that the start and end off-
                     set that follow include any string set by the  PREDISPLAY
                     special  parameter;  this  is  needed  if  the predisplay
                     string itself is to be highlighted.   Whitespace  between
                     the `P' and the start offset is optional.

              •      A start offset in the same units as CURSOR.

              •      An end offset in the same units as CURSOR.

              •      A  highlight specification in the same format as used for
                     contexts in the parameter zle_highlight, see the  section
                     `Character  Highlighting' below; for example, standout or
                     fg=red,bold.

              •      Optionally, a string of the form `memo=token'.  The token
                     consists  of  everything  between  the  `='  and the next
                     whitespace, comma, NUL, or the end of  the  string.   The
                     token is preserved verbatim but not parsed in any way.

                     Plugins may use this to identify array elements they have
                     added: for example, a plugin might set token to its  (the
                     plugin's)  name  and  then  use `region_highlight=( ${re-
                     gion_highlight:#*memo=token} )' in order to remove  array
                     elements it have added.

                     (This  example uses the `${name:#pattern}' array-grepping
                     syntax described in the section `Parameter Expansion'  in
                     zshexpn(1).)

              For example,

                     region_highlight=("P0 20 bold memo=foobar")

              specifies that the first twenty characters of the text including
              any predisplay string should be highlighted in bold.

              Note that the effect of region_highlight is not saved and disap-
              pears as soon as the line is accepted.

              Note  that  zsh  5.8  and  older do not support the `memo=token'
              field and may misparse the third (highlight specification) field
              when a memo is given.

              The  final  highlighting on the command line depends on both re-
              gion_highlight and  zle_highlight;  see  the  section  CHARACTER
              HIGHLIGHTING below for details.

       registers (associative array)
              The contents of each of the vi register buffers. These are typi-
              cally set using vi-set-buffer followed by a  delete,  change  or
              yank command.

       SUFFIX_ACTIVE (integer)
       SUFFIX_START (integer)
       SUFFIX_END (integer)
              SUFFIX_ACTIVE  indicates  whether  an  auto-removable completion
              suffix is currently active. SUFFIX_START and SUFFIX_END give the
              location of the suffix and are in the same units as CURSOR. They
              are only valid for reading when SUFFIX_ACTIVE is non-zero.

              All parameters are read-only.

       UNDO_CHANGE_NO (integer)
              A number representing the state of the undo history.   The  only
              use  of this is passing as an argument to the undo widget in or-
              der to undo back to the recorded point.  Read-only.

       UNDO_LIMIT_NO (integer)
              A number corresponding to an existing change in  the  undo  his-
              tory; compare UNDO_CHANGE_NO.  If this is set to a value greater
              than zero, the undo command will not allow the line to be undone
              beyond  the  given  change  number.  It is still possible to use
              `zle undo change' in a widget to undo beyond that point; in that
              case, it will not be possible to undo at all until UNDO_LIMIT_NO
              is reduced.  Set to 0 to disable the limit.

              A typical use of this variable in a widget function is  as  fol-
              lows (note the additional function scope is required):

                     () {
                       local UNDO_LIMIT_NO=$UNDO_CHANGE_NO
                       # Perform some form of recursive edit.
                     }

       WIDGET (scalar)
              The name of the widget currently being executed; read-only.

       WIDGETFUNC (scalar)
              The  name of the shell function that implements a widget defined
              with either zle -N or zle -C.  In the former case, this  is  the
              second  argument  to the zle -N command that defined the widget,
              or the first argument if there was no second argument.   In  the
              latter  case  this  is  the third argument to the zle -C command
              that defined the widget.  Read-only.

       WIDGETSTYLE (scalar)
              Describes the implementation behind the completion  widget  cur-
              rently  being executed; the second argument that followed zle -C
              when the widget was defined.  This is the name of a builtin com-
              pletion  widget.  For widgets defined with zle -N this is set to
              the empty string.  Read-only.

       YANK_ACTIVE (integer)
       YANK_START (integer)
       YANK_END (integer)
              YANK_ACTIVE indicates whether text has just been yanked (pasted)
              into  the  buffer.  YANK_START and YANK_END give the location of
              the pasted text and are in the same units as CURSOR.   They  are
              only  valid  for reading when YANK_ACTIVE is non-zero.  They can
              also be assigned by widgets that  insert  text  in  a  yank-like
              fashion,  for example wrappers of bracketed-paste.  See also zle
              -f.

              YANK_ACTIVE is read-only.

       ZLE_RECURSIVE (integer)
              Usually zero, but incremented  inside  any  instance  of  recur-
              sive-edit.  Hence indicates the current recursion level.

              ZLE_RECURSIVE is read-only.

       ZLE_STATE (scalar)
              Contains  a  set of space-separated words that describe the cur-
              rent zle state.

              Currently, the states shown are the insert mode as  set  by  the
              overwrite-mode  or  vi-replace  widgets and whether history com-
              mands will visit imported entries as controlled by  the  set-lo-
              cal-history  widget.  The string contains `insert' if characters
              to be inserted on the command line move existing  characters  to
              the  right or `overwrite' if characters to be inserted overwrite
              existing characters. It contains `localhistory'  if  only  local
              history  commands will be visited or `globalhistory' if imported
              history commands will also be visited.

              The substrings are sorted in alphabetical order so that  if  you
              want  to test for two specific substrings in a future-proof way,
              you can do match by doing:

                     if [[ $ZLE_STATE == *globalhistory*insert* ]]; then ...; fi

   Special Widgets
       There are a few user-defined widgets which are special  to  the  shell.
       If they do not exist, no special action is taken.  The environment pro-
       vided is identical to that for any other editing widget.

       zle-isearch-exit
              Executed at the end of incremental search at the point where the
              isearch prompt is removed from the display.  See zle-isearch-up-
              date for an example.

       zle-isearch-update
              Executed within incremental search when the display is about  to
              be  redrawn.   Additional  output  below  the incremental search
              prompt can be generated by using `zle  -M'  within  the  widget.
              For example,

                     zle-isearch-update() { zle -M "Line $HISTNO"; }
                     zle -N zle-isearch-update

              Note the line output by `zle -M' is not deleted on exit from in-
              cremental search.  This can be done from a zle-isearch-exit wid-
              get:

                     zle-isearch-exit() { zle -M ""; }
                     zle -N zle-isearch-exit

       zle-line-pre-redraw
              Executed whenever the input line is about to be redrawn, provid-
              ing an opportunity to update the region_highlight array.

       zle-line-init
              Executed every time the line editor is started  to  read  a  new
              line  of input.  The following example puts the line editor into
              vi command mode when it starts up.

                     zle-line-init() { zle -K vicmd; }
                     zle -N zle-line-init

              (The command inside the function sets the keymap directly; it is
              equivalent to zle vi-cmd-mode.)

       zle-line-finish
              This  is similar to zle-line-init but is executed every time the
              line editor has finished reading a line of input.

       zle-history-line-set
              Executed when the history line changes.

       zle-keymap-select
              Executed every time the keymap changes, i.e. the special parame-
              ter KEYMAP is set to a different value, while the line editor is
              active.  Initialising the keymap when  the  line  editor  starts
              does not cause the widget to be called.

              The  value  $KEYMAP within the function reflects the new keymap.
              The old keymap is passed as the sole argument.

              This can be used for detecting switches between the  vi  command
              (vicmd) and insert (usually main) keymaps.

STANDARD WIDGETS
       The  following is a list of all the standard widgets, and their default
       bindings in emacs mode,  vi  command  mode  and  vi  insert  mode  (the
       `emacs', `vicmd' and `viins' keymaps, respectively).

       Note  that cursor keys are bound to movement keys in all three keymaps;
       the shell assumes that the cursor keys send the key sequences  reported
       by  the  terminal-handling  library (termcap or terminfo).  The key se-
       quences shown in the list are those based on the VT100, common on  many
       modern  terminals, but in fact these are not necessarily bound.  In the
       case of the viins keymap, the initial escape character of the sequences
       serves  also to return to the vicmd keymap: whether this happens is de-
       termined by the KEYTIMEOUT parameter, see zshparam(1).

   Movement
       vi-backward-blank-word (unbound) (B) (unbound)
              Move backward one word, where a word is defined as a  series  of
              non-blank characters.

       vi-backward-blank-word-end (unbound) (gE) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the previous word, where a word is defined as
              a series of non-blank characters.

       backward-char (^B ESC-[D) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move backward one character.

       vi-backward-char (unbound) (^H h ^?) (ESC-[D)
              Move backward one character, without changing lines.

       backward-word (ESC-B ESC-b) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move to the beginning of the previous word.

       emacs-backward-word
              Move to the beginning of the previous word.

       vi-backward-word (unbound) (b) (unbound)
              Move to the beginning of the previous word, vi-style.

       vi-backward-word-end (unbound) (ge) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the previous word, vi-style.

       beginning-of-line (^A) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move to the beginning of the line.  If already at the  beginning
              of the line, move to the beginning of the previous line, if any.

       vi-beginning-of-line
              Move to the beginning of the line, without changing lines.

       down-line (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move down a line in the buffer.

       end-of-line (^E) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the line,
              move to the end of the next line, if any.

       vi-end-of-line (unbound) ($) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the line.  If an argument is  given  to  this
              command,  the cursor will be moved to the end of the line (argu-
              ment - 1) lines down.

       vi-forward-blank-word (unbound) (W) (unbound)
              Move forward one word, where a word is defined as  a  series  of
              non-blank characters.

       vi-forward-blank-word-end (unbound) (E) (unbound)
              Move  to  the  end of the current word, or, if at the end of the
              current word, to the end of the next word, where a word  is  de-
              fined as a series of non-blank characters.

       forward-char (^F ESC-[C) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move forward one character.

       vi-forward-char (unbound) (space l) (ESC-[C)
              Move forward one character.

       vi-find-next-char (^X^F) (f) (unbound)
              Read  a character from the keyboard, and move to the next occur-
              rence of it in the line.

       vi-find-next-char-skip (unbound) (t) (unbound)
              Read a character from the keyboard, and  move  to  the  position
              just before the next occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-find-prev-char (unbound) (F) (unbound)
              Read a character from the keyboard, and move to the previous oc-
              currence of it in the line.

       vi-find-prev-char-skip (unbound) (T) (unbound)
              Read a character from the keyboard, and  move  to  the  position
              just after the previous occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-first-non-blank (unbound) (^) (unbound)
              Move to the first non-blank character in the line.

       vi-forward-word (unbound) (w) (unbound)
              Move forward one word, vi-style.

       forward-word (ESC-F ESC-f) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move  to the beginning of the next word.  The editor's idea of a
              word is specified with the WORDCHARS parameter.

       emacs-forward-word
              Move to the end of the next word.

       vi-forward-word-end (unbound) (e) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the next word.

       vi-goto-column (ESC-|) (|) (unbound)
              Move to the column specified by the numeric argument.

       vi-goto-mark (unbound) (`) (unbound)
              Move to the specified mark.

       vi-goto-mark-line (unbound) (') (unbound)
              Move to beginning of the line containing the specified mark.

       vi-repeat-find (unbound) (;) (unbound)
              Repeat the last vi-find command.

       vi-rev-repeat-find (unbound) (,) (unbound)
              Repeat the last vi-find command in the opposite direction.

       up-line (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move up a line in the buffer.

   History Control
       beginning-of-buffer-or-history (ESC-<) (gg) (unbound)
              Move to the beginning of the buffer, or if already  there,  move
              to the first event in the history list.

       beginning-of-line-hist
              Move  to the beginning of the line.  If already at the beginning
              of the buffer, move to the previous history line.

       beginning-of-history
              Move to the first event in the history list.

       down-line-or-history (^N ESC-[B) (j) (ESC-[B)
              Move down a line in the buffer, or  if  already  at  the  bottom
              line, move to the next event in the history list.

       vi-down-line-or-history (unbound) (+) (unbound)
              Move  down  a  line  in  the buffer, or if already at the bottom
              line, move to the next event in the history list.  Then move  to
              the first non-blank character on the line.

       down-line-or-search
              Move  down  a  line  in  the buffer, or if already at the bottom
              line, search forward in the history for a  line  beginning  with
              the first word in the buffer.

              If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
              first argument is taken as  the  string  for  which  to  search,
              rather than the first word in the buffer.

       down-history (unbound) (^N) (unbound)
              Move to the next event in the history list.

       history-beginning-search-backward
              Search  backward  in  the  history for a line beginning with the
              current line up to the cursor.  This leaves the  cursor  in  its
              original position.

       end-of-buffer-or-history (ESC->) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move  to the end of the buffer, or if already there, move to the
              last event in the history list.

       end-of-line-hist
              Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the  buf-
              fer, move to the next history line.

       end-of-history
              Move to the last event in the history list.

       vi-fetch-history (unbound) (G) (unbound)
              Fetch  the history line specified by the numeric argument.  This
              defaults to the current history line (i.e. the  one  that  isn't
              history yet).

       history-incremental-search-backward (^R ^Xr) (unbound) (unbound)
              Search  backward  incrementally  for  a  specified  string.  The
              search is case-insensitive if the search string  does  not  have
              uppercase letters and no numeric argument was given.  The string
              may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of  the
              line.  When called from a user-defined function returns the fol-
              lowing statuses: 0, if the search succeeded; 1,  if  the  search
              failed;  2,  if  the  search  term  was a bad pattern; 3, if the
              search was aborted by the send-break command.

              A restricted set  of  editing  functions  is  available  in  the
              mini-buffer.   Keys are looked up in the special isearch keymap,
              and if not found there in the main keymap (note that by  default
              the  isearch  keymap is empty).  An interrupt signal, as defined
              by the stty setting, will stop the search and  go  back  to  the
              original  line.   An  undefined  key  will have the same effect.
              Note that the following always perform the same task within  in-
              cremental  searches  and cannot be replaced by user defined wid-
              gets, nor can the set of functions be extended.   The  supported
              functions are:

              accept-and-hold
              accept-and-infer-next-history
              accept-line
              accept-line-and-down-history
                     Perform  the  usual  function  after  exiting incremental
                     search.  The command line displayed is executed.

              backward-delete-char
              vi-backward-delete-char
                     Back up one place in the search history.  If  the  search
                     has been repeated this does not immediately erase a char-
                     acter in the minibuffer.

              accept-search
                     Exit incremental search, retaining the command  line  but
                     performing no further action.  Note that this function is
                     not bound by default and has no effect outside  incremen-
                     tal search.

              backward-delete-word
              backward-kill-word
              vi-backward-kill-word
                     Back  up  one  character  in  the minibuffer; if multiple
                     searches have been performed since the character was  in-
                     serted  the  search  history is rewound to the point just
                     before the character was entered.  Hence this has the ef-
                     fect of repeating backward-delete-char.

              clear-screen
                     Clear the screen, remaining in incremental search mode.

              history-incremental-search-backward
                     Find the next occurrence of the contents of the mini-buf-
                     fer. If the mini-buffer is empty, the most recent  previ-
                     ously used search string is reinstated.

              history-incremental-search-forward
                     Invert the sense of the search.

              magic-space
                     Inserts a non-magical space.

              quoted-insert
              vi-quoted-insert
                     Quote the character to insert into the minibuffer.

              redisplay
                     Redisplay  the  command  line,  remaining  in incremental
                     search mode.

              vi-cmd-mode
                     Select the `vicmd'  keymap;  the  `main'  keymap  (insert
                     mode) will be selected initially.

                     In addition, the modifications that were made while in vi
                     insert mode are merged to form a single undo event.

              vi-repeat-search
              vi-rev-repeat-search
                     Repeat the search.  The direction of the search is  indi-
                     cated in the mini-buffer.

              Any  character  that is not bound to one of the above functions,
              or self-insert or self-insert-unmeta, will cause the mode to  be
              exited.   The  character  is  then looked up and executed in the
              keymap in effect at that point.

              When called from a widget function by the zle command,  the  in-
              cremental search commands can take a string argument.  This will
              be treated as a string of keys, as for arguments to the  bindkey
              command, and used as initial input for the command.  Any charac-
              ters in the string which are unused by  the  incremental  search
              will be silently ignored.  For example,

                     zle history-incremental-search-backward forceps

              will  search  backwards for forceps, leaving the minibuffer con-
              taining the string `forceps'.

       history-incremental-search-forward (^S ^Xs) (unbound) (unbound)
              Search forward incrementally for a specified string.  The search
              is case-insensitive if the search string does not have uppercase
              letters and no numeric argument was given.  The string may begin
              with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.  The
              functions available in the mini-buffer are the same as for  his-
              tory-incremental-search-backward.

       history-incremental-pattern-search-backward
       history-incremental-pattern-search-forward
              These widgets behave similarly to the corresponding widgets with
              no -pattern, but the search string typed by the user is  treated
              as a pattern, respecting the current settings of the various op-
              tions affecting pattern matching.  See  FILENAME  GENERATION  in
              zshexpn(1)  for  a description of patterns.  If no numeric argu-
              ment was given lowercase letters in the search string may  match
              uppercase letters in the history.  The string may begin with `^'
              to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.

              The prompt changes to indicate an invalid pattern; this may sim-
              ply indicate the pattern is not yet complete.

              Note  that  only non-overlapping matches are reported, so an ex-
              pression with wildcards may return fewer matches on a line  than
              are visible by inspection.

       history-search-backward (ESC-P ESC-p) (unbound) (unbound)
              Search  backward  in  the  history for a line beginning with the
              first word in the buffer.

              If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
              first  argument  is  taken  as  the  string for which to search,
              rather than the first word in the buffer.

       vi-history-search-backward (unbound) (/) (unbound)
              Search backward in the history  for  a  specified  string.   The
              string  may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning
              of the line.

              A restricted set  of  editing  functions  is  available  in  the
              mini-buffer.   An  interrupt signal, as defined by the stty set-
              ting,  will stop the search.  The  functions  available  in  the
              mini-buffer  are:  accept-line,  backward-delete-char,  vi-back-
              ward-delete-char,   backward-kill-word,   vi-backward-kill-word,
              clear-screen, redisplay, quoted-insert and vi-quoted-insert.

              vi-cmd-mode  is treated the same as accept-line, and magic-space
              is treated as a space.  Any other character that is not bound to
              self-insert  or  self-insert-unmeta will beep and be ignored. If
              the function is called from vi command mode, the bindings of the
              current insert mode will be used.

              If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
              first argument is taken as  the  string  for  which  to  search,
              rather than the first word in the buffer.

       history-search-forward (ESC-N ESC-n) (unbound) (unbound)
              Search  forward  in  the  history  for a line beginning with the
              first word in the buffer.

              If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
              first  argument  is  taken  as  the  string for which to search,
              rather than the first word in the buffer.

       vi-history-search-forward (unbound) (?) (unbound)
              Search forward in the  history  for  a  specified  string.   The
              string  may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning
              of the line. The functions available in the mini-buffer are  the
              same  as  for  vi-history-search-backward.  Argument handling is
              also the same as for that command.

       infer-next-history (^X^N) (unbound) (unbound)
              Search in the history list for a line matching the  current  one
              and fetch the event following it.

       insert-last-word (ESC-_ ESC-.) (unbound) (unbound)
              Insert the last word from the previous history event at the cur-
              sor position.  If a positive numeric argument is  given,  insert
              that  word  from  the end of the previous history event.  If the
              argument is zero or negative insert  that  word  from  the  left
              (zero  inserts  the previous command word).  Repeating this com-
              mand replaces the word just inserted with the last word from the
              history  event prior to the one just used; numeric arguments can
              be used in the same way to pick a word from that event.

              When called from a shell function invoked  from  a  user-defined
              widget,  the command can take one to three arguments.  The first
              argument specifies a history offset which applies to  successive
              calls  to  this  widget:  if  it is -1, the default behaviour is
              used, while if it is 1,  successive  calls  will  move  forwards
              through  the  history.  The value 0 can be used to indicate that
              the history line examined by the previous execution of the  com-
              mand  will  be reexamined.  Note that negative numbers should be
              preceded by a `--' argument to avoid  confusing  them  with  op-
              tions.

              If two arguments are given, the second specifies the word on the
              command line in normal array index notation (as a  more  natural
              alternative  to  the  numeric  argument).   Hence 1 is the first
              word, and -1 (the default) is the last word.

              If a third argument is given, its value is ignored,  but  it  is
              used  to signify that the history offset is relative to the cur-
              rent history line, rather than the one remembered after the pre-
              vious invocations of insert-last-word.

              For example, the default behaviour of the command corresponds to

                     zle insert-last-word -- -1 -1

              while the command

                     zle insert-last-word -- -1 1 -

              always  copies the first word of the line in the history immedi-
              ately before the line being edited.  This has  the  side  effect
              that  later  invocations  of the widget will be relative to that
              line.

       vi-repeat-search (unbound) (n) (unbound)
              Repeat the last vi history search.

       vi-rev-repeat-search (unbound) (N) (unbound)
              Repeat the last vi history search, but in reverse.

       up-line-or-history (^P ESC-[A) (k) (ESC-[A)
              Move up a line in the buffer, or if already  at  the  top  line,
              move to the previous event in the history list.

       vi-up-line-or-history (unbound) (-) (unbound)
              Move  up  a  line  in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
              move to the previous event in the history list.   Then  move  to
              the first non-blank character on the line.

       up-line-or-search
              Move  up  a  line  in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
              search backward in the history for a  line  beginning  with  the
              first word in the buffer.

              If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
              first argument is taken as  the  string  for  which  to  search,
              rather than the first word in the buffer.

       up-history (unbound) (^P) (unbound)
              Move to the previous event in the history list.

       history-beginning-search-forward
              Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the cur-
              rent line up to the cursor.  This leaves the cursor in its orig-
              inal position.

       set-local-history
              By  default,  history movement commands visit the imported lines
              as well as the local lines. This widget lets you toggle this  on
              and  off, or set it with the numeric argument. Zero for both lo-
              cal and imported lines and nonzero for only local lines.

   Modifying Text
       vi-add-eol (unbound) (A) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-add-next (unbound) (a) (unbound)
              Enter insert mode after the  current  cursor  position,  without
              changing lines.

       backward-delete-char (^H ^?) (unbound) (unbound)
              Delete the character behind the cursor.

       vi-backward-delete-char (unbound) (X) (^H)
              Delete  the character behind the cursor, without changing lines.
              If in insert mode, this won't delete past the point where insert
              mode was last entered.

       backward-delete-word
              Delete the word behind the cursor.

       backward-kill-line
              Kill from the beginning of the line to the cursor position.

       backward-kill-word (^W ESC-^H ESC-^?) (unbound) (unbound)
              Kill the word behind the cursor.

       vi-backward-kill-word (unbound) (unbound) (^W)
              Kill  the  word  behind the cursor, without going past the point
              where insert mode was last entered.

       capitalize-word (ESC-C ESC-c) (unbound) (unbound)
              Capitalize the current word and move past it.

       vi-change (unbound) (c) (unbound)
              Read a movement command from the keyboard,  and  kill  from  the
              cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.  Then enter in-
              sert mode.  If the command  is  vi-change,  change  the  current
              line.

              For  compatibility with vi, if the command is vi-forward-word or
              vi-forward-blank-word, the whitespace after the word is not  in-
              cluded.  If  you  prefer  the more consistent behaviour with the
              whitespace included use the following key binding:

                     bindkey -a -s cw dwi

       vi-change-eol (unbound) (C) (unbound)
              Kill to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-change-whole-line (unbound) (S) (unbound)
              Kill the current line and enter insert mode.

       copy-region-as-kill (ESC-W ESC-w) (unbound) (unbound)
              Copy the area from the cursor to the mark to the kill buffer.

              If called from a ZLE widget function in the form  `zle  copy-re-
              gion-as-kill  string'  then  string will be taken as the text to
              copy to the kill buffer.  The cursor, the mark and the  text  on
              the command line are not used in this case.

       copy-prev-word (ESC-^_) (unbound) (unbound)
              Duplicate the word to the left of the cursor.

       copy-prev-shell-word
              Like  copy-prev-word, but the word is found by using shell pars-
              ing, whereas copy-prev-word looks for blanks. This makes a  dif-
              ference when the word is quoted and contains spaces.

       vi-delete (unbound) (d) (unbound)
              Read  a  movement  command  from the keyboard, and kill from the
              cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.  If the command
              is vi-delete, kill the current line.

       delete-char
              Delete the character under the cursor.

       vi-delete-char (unbound) (x) (unbound)
              Delete  the  character  under the cursor, without going past the
              end of the line.

       delete-word
              Delete the current word.

       down-case-word (ESC-L ESC-l) (unbound) (unbound)
              Convert the current word to all lowercase and move past it.

       vi-down-case (unbound) (gu) (unbound)
              Read a movement command from the keyboard, and convert all char-
              acters  from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement
              to lowercase.  If the movement command is vi-down-case, swap the
              case of all characters on the current line.

       kill-word (ESC-D ESC-d) (unbound) (unbound)
              Kill the current word.

       gosmacs-transpose-chars
              Exchange the two characters behind the cursor.

       vi-indent (unbound) (>) (unbound)
              Indent a number of lines.

       vi-insert (unbound) (i) (unbound)
              Enter insert mode.

       vi-insert-bol (unbound) (I) (unbound)
              Move  to the first non-blank character on the line and enter in-
              sert mode.

       vi-join (^X^J) (J) (unbound)
              Join the current line with the next one.

       kill-line (^K) (unbound) (unbound)
              Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.  If already on  the
              end of the line, kill the newline character.

       vi-kill-line (unbound) (unbound) (^U)
              Kill  from  the cursor back to wherever insert mode was last en-
              tered.

       vi-kill-eol (unbound) (D) (unbound)
              Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.

       kill-region
              Kill from the cursor to the mark.

       kill-buffer (^X^K) (unbound) (unbound)
              Kill the entire buffer.

       kill-whole-line (^U) (unbound) (unbound)
              Kill the current line.

       vi-match-bracket (^X^B) (%) (unbound)
              Move to the bracket character (one of {}, () or []) that matches
              the  one  under  the  cursor.  If the cursor is not on a bracket
              character, move forward without going past the end of  the  line
              to find one, and then go to the matching bracket.

       vi-open-line-above (unbound) (O) (unbound)
              Open a line above the cursor and enter insert mode.

       vi-open-line-below (unbound) (o) (unbound)
              Open a line below the cursor and enter insert mode.

       vi-oper-swap-case (unbound) (g~) (unbound)
              Read  a movement command from the keyboard, and swap the case of
              all characters from the cursor position to the endpoint  of  the
              movement.   If  the  movement command is vi-oper-swap-case, swap
              the case of all characters on the current line.

       overwrite-mode (^X^O) (unbound) (unbound)
              Toggle between overwrite mode and insert mode.

       vi-put-before (unbound) (P) (unbound)
              Insert the contents of the kill buffer before  the  cursor.   If
              the  kill  buffer  contains  a  sequence of lines (as opposed to
              characters), paste it above the current line.

       vi-put-after (unbound) (p) (unbound)
              Insert the contents of the kill buffer after the cursor.  If the
              kill  buffer contains a sequence of lines (as opposed to charac-
              ters), paste it below the current line.

       put-replace-selection (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
              Replace the contents of the current region or selection with the
              contents  of  the kill buffer. If the kill buffer contains a se-
              quence of lines (as opposed to  characters),  the  current  line
              will be split by the pasted lines.

       quoted-insert (^V) (unbound) (unbound)
              Insert  the  next character typed into the buffer literally.  An
              interrupt character will not be inserted.

       vi-quoted-insert (unbound) (unbound) (^Q ^V)
              Display a `^' at the cursor position, and insert the next  char-
              acter  typed  into the buffer literally.  An interrupt character
              will not be inserted.

       quote-line (ESC-') (unbound) (unbound)
              Quote the current line; that is, put a `'' character at the  be-
              ginning and the end, and convert all `'' characters to `'\'''.

       quote-region (ESC-") (unbound) (unbound)
              Quote the region from the cursor to the mark.

       vi-replace (unbound) (R) (unbound)
              Enter overwrite mode.

       vi-repeat-change (unbound) (.) (unbound)
              Repeat  the last vi mode text modification.  If a count was used
              with the modification, it is remembered.  If a count is given to
              this  command,  it overrides the remembered count, and is remem-
              bered for future uses of this command.  The cut buffer  specifi-
              cation is similarly remembered.

       vi-replace-chars (unbound) (r) (unbound)
              Replace  the  character  under  the cursor with a character read
              from the keyboard.

       self-insert (printable characters) (unbound) (printable characters  and
       some control characters)
              Insert a character into the buffer at the cursor position.

       self-insert-unmeta (ESC-^I ESC-^J ESC-^M) (unbound) (unbound)
              Insert  a character into the buffer after stripping the meta bit
              and converting ^M to ^J.

       vi-substitute (unbound) (s) (unbound)
              Substitute the next character(s).

       vi-swap-case (unbound) (~) (unbound)
              Swap the case of the character under the cursor  and  move  past
              it.

       transpose-chars (^T) (unbound) (unbound)
              Exchange  the two characters to the left of the cursor if at end
              of line, else exchange the character under the cursor  with  the
              character to the left.

       transpose-words (ESC-T ESC-t) (unbound) (unbound)
              Exchange the current word with the one before it.

              With  a positive numeric argument N, the word around the cursor,
              or following it if the cursor is between  words,  is  transposed
              with the preceding N words.  The cursor is put at the end of the
              resulting group of words.

              With a negative numeric argument -N, the effect is the  same  as
              using  a positive argument N except that the original cursor po-
              sition is retained, regardless of how the words are rearranged.

       vi-unindent (unbound) (<) (unbound)
              Unindent a number of lines.

       vi-up-case (unbound) (gU) (unbound)
              Read a movement command from the keyboard, and convert all char-
              acters  from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement
              to lowercase.  If the movement command is vi-up-case,  swap  the
              case of all characters on the current line.

       up-case-word (ESC-U ESC-u) (unbound) (unbound)
              Convert the current word to all caps and move past it.

       yank (^Y) (unbound) (unbound)
              Insert the contents of the kill buffer at the cursor position.

       yank-pop (ESC-y) (unbound) (unbound)
              Remove  the  text just yanked, rotate the kill-ring (the history
              of previously killed text) and yank the  new  top.   Only  works
              following yank, vi-put-before, vi-put-after or yank-pop.

       vi-yank (unbound) (y) (unbound)
              Read  a  movement command from the keyboard, and copy the region
              from the cursor position to the endpoint of  the  movement  into
              the  kill  buffer.   If the command is vi-yank, copy the current
              line.

       vi-yank-whole-line (unbound) (Y) (unbound)
              Copy the current line into the kill buffer.

       vi-yank-eol
              Copy the region from the cursor position to the end of the  line
              into the kill buffer.  Arguably, this is what Y should do in vi,
              but it isn't what it actually does.

   Arguments
       digit-argument (ESC-0..ESC-9) (1-9) (unbound)
              Start a new numeric argument, or add to the  current  one.   See
              also vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line.  This only works if bound to
              a key sequence ending in a decimal digit.

              Inside a widget function, a call to  this  function  treats  the
              last  key  of  the  key  sequence which called the widget as the
              digit.

       neg-argument (ESC--) (unbound) (unbound)
              Changes the sign of the following argument.

       universal-argument
              Multiply the argument of the next command by 4.   Alternatively,
              if  this  command  is  followed by an integer (positive or nega-
              tive), use that as the argument for the next command.  Thus dig-
              its cannot be repeated using this command.  For example, if this
              command occurs twice, followed immediately by forward-char, move
              forward  sixteen  spaces;  if instead it is followed by -2, then
              forward-char, move backward two spaces.

              Inside a widget function, if passed an argument, i.e. `zle  uni-
              versal-argument  num',  the numeric argument will be set to num;
              this is equivalent to `NUMERIC=num'.

       argument-base
              Use the existing numeric argument as a numeric base, which  must
              be  in the range 2 to 36 inclusive.  Subsequent use of digit-ar-
              gument and universal-argument will input a new numeric  argument
              in  the  given  base.  The usual hexadecimal convention is used:
              the letter a or A corresponds to 10, and so  on.   Arguments  in
              bases requiring digits from 10 upwards are more conveniently in-
              put with universal-argument, since ESC-a etc.  are  not  usually
              bound to digit-argument.

              The  function  can  be  used  with  a  command argument inside a
              user-defined widget.  The following code sets the base to 16 and
              lets  the  user  input a hexadecimal argument until a key out of
              the digit range is typed:

                     zle argument-base 16
                     zle universal-argument

   Completion
       accept-and-menu-complete
              In a menu completion, insert the  current  completion  into  the
              buffer, and advance to the next possible completion.

       complete-word
              Attempt completion on the current word.

       delete-char-or-list (^D) (unbound) (unbound)
              Delete  the character under the cursor.  If the cursor is at the
              end of the line, list possible completions for the current word.

       expand-cmd-path
              Expand the current command to its full pathname.

       expand-or-complete (TAB) (unbound) (TAB)
              Attempt shell expansion on the current word.  If that fails, at-
              tempt completion.

       expand-or-complete-prefix
              Attempt shell expansion on the current word up to cursor.

       expand-history (ESC-space ESC-!) (unbound) (unbound)
              Perform history expansion on the edit buffer.

       expand-word (^X*) (unbound) (unbound)
              Attempt shell expansion on the current word.

       list-choices (ESC-^D) (^D =) (^D)
              List possible completions for the current word.

       list-expand (^Xg ^XG) (^G) (^G)
              List the expansion of the current word.

       magic-space
              Perform  history  expansion  and insert a space into the buffer.
              This is intended to be bound to space.

       menu-complete
              Like complete-word, except that menu completion  is  used.   See
              the MENU_COMPLETE option.

       menu-expand-or-complete
              Like expand-or-complete, except that menu completion is used.

       reverse-menu-complete
              Perform  menu  completion,  like menu-complete, except that if a
              menu completion is already in progress,  move  to  the  previous
              completion rather than the next.

       end-of-list
              When  a  previous  completion displayed a list below the prompt,
              this widget can be used to move the prompt below the list.

   Miscellaneous
       accept-and-hold (ESC-A ESC-a) (unbound) (unbound)
              Push the contents of the buffer on the buffer stack and  execute
              it.

       accept-and-infer-next-history
              Execute  the  contents  of  the buffer.  Then search the history
              list for a line matching the current one and push the event fol-
              lowing onto the buffer stack.

       accept-line (^J ^M) (^J ^M) (^J ^M)
              Finish  editing  the buffer.  Normally this causes the buffer to
              be executed as a shell command.

       accept-line-and-down-history (^O) (unbound) (unbound)
              Execute the current line, and push the next history event on the
              buffer stack.

       auto-suffix-remove
              If  the  previous  action added a suffix (space, slash, etc.) to
              the word on the command line, remove it.  Otherwise do  nothing.
              Removing  the suffix ends any active menu completion or menu se-
              lection.

              This widget is intended to be called from  user-defined  widgets
              to enforce a desired suffix-removal behavior.

       auto-suffix-retain
              If  the  previous  action added a suffix (space, slash, etc.) to
              the word on the command line, force it to be preserved.   Other-
              wise do nothing.  Retaining the suffix ends any active menu com-
              pletion or menu selection.

              This widget is intended to be called from  user-defined  widgets
              to enforce a desired suffix-preservation behavior.

       beep   Beep, unless the BEEP option is unset.

       bracketed-paste (^[[200~) (^[[200~) (^[[200~)
              This  widget is invoked when text is pasted to the terminal emu-
              lator. It is not intended to be bound to actual keys but instead
              to  the special sequence generated by the terminal emulator when
              text is pasted.

              When invoked interactively, the pasted text is inserted  to  the
              buffer  and  placed  in the cutbuffer.  If a numeric argument is
              given, shell quoting will be applied to the pasted  text  before
              it is inserted.

              When  a  named  buffer is specified with vi-set-buffer ("x), the
              pasted text is stored in that named buffer but not inserted.

              When called from a widget function  as  `bracketed-paste  name`,
              the  pasted  text  is assigned to the variable name and no other
              processing is done.

              See also the zle_bracketed_paste parameter.

       vi-cmd-mode (^X^V) (unbound) (^[)
              Enter command mode; that is, select the  `vicmd'  keymap.   Yes,
              this is bound by default in emacs mode.

       vi-caps-lock-panic
              Hang  until  any lowercase key is pressed.  This is for vi users
              without the mental capacity to keep track of their caps lock key
              (like the author).

       clear-screen (^L ESC-^L) (^L) (^L)
              Clear the screen and redraw the prompt.

       deactivate-region
              Make the current region inactive. This disables vim-style visual
              selection mode if it is active.

       describe-key-briefly
              Reads a key sequence, then prints the function bound to that se-
              quence.

       exchange-point-and-mark (^X^X) (unbound) (unbound)
              Exchange  the  cursor  position (point) with the position of the
              mark.  Unless a negative numeric argument is given,  the  region
              between  point  and  mark  is  activated so that it can be high-
              lighted.  If a zero numeric argument is given, the region is ac-
              tivated but point and mark are not swapped.

       execute-named-cmd (ESC-x) (:) (unbound)
              Read  the  name  of  an editor command and execute it.  Aliasing
              this widget with `zle -A' or replacing it with `zle -N'  has  no
              effect   when   interpreting   key   bindings,   but  `zle  exe-
              cute-named-cmd' will invoke such an alias or replacement.

              A restricted set  of  editing  functions  is  available  in  the
              mini-buffer.   Keys are looked up in the special command keymap,
              and if not found there in the main keymap.  An interrupt signal,
              as  defined  by the stty setting, will abort the function.  Note
              that the following always perform the same task within the  exe-
              cuted-named-cmd  environment  and cannot be replaced by user de-
              fined widgets, nor can the set of functions  be  extended.   The
              allowed    functions    are:    backward-delete-char,   vi-back-
              ward-delete-char,   clear-screen,   redisplay,    quoted-insert,
              vi-quoted-insert,   backward-kill-word,   vi-backward-kill-word,
              kill-whole-line, vi-kill-line, backward-kill-line, list-choices,
              delete-char-or-list,  complete-word, accept-line, expand-or-com-
              plete and expand-or-complete-prefix.

              kill-region kills the last word, and vi-cmd-mode is treated  the
              same as accept-line.  The space and tab characters, if not bound
              to one of these functions, will complete the name and then  list
              the  possibilities  if  the  AUTO_LIST option is set.  Any other
              character that is not bound to self-insert or self-insert-unmeta
              will  beep  and  be ignored.  The bindings of the current insert
              mode will be used.

              Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.

       execute-last-named-cmd (ESC-z) (unbound) (unbound)
              Redo the last function executed with execute-named-cmd.

              Like execute-named-cmd, this command may not be  redefined,  but
              it may be called by name.

       get-line (ESC-G ESC-g) (unbound) (unbound)
              Pop  the top line off the buffer stack and insert it at the cur-
              sor position.

       pound-insert (unbound) (#) (unbound)
              If there is no # character at the beginning of the  buffer,  add
              one  to the beginning of each line.  If there is one, remove a #
              from each line that has one.  In either case, accept the current
              line.   The  INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option must be set for this to
              have any usefulness.

       vi-pound-insert
              If there is no # character at the beginning of the current line,
              add  one.  If there is one, remove it.  The INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
              option must be set for this to have any usefulness.

       push-input
              Push the entire current  multiline  construct  onto  the  buffer
              stack  and return to the top-level (PS1) prompt.  If the current
              parser construct is only a single line,  this  is  exactly  like
              push-line.   Next  time  the  editor starts up or is popped with
              get-line, the construct will be popped off the top of the buffer
              stack and loaded into the editing buffer.

       push-line (^Q ESC-Q ESC-q) (unbound) (unbound)
              Push the current buffer onto the buffer stack and clear the buf-
              fer.  Next time the editor starts up, the buffer will be  popped
              off the top of the buffer stack and loaded into the editing buf-
              fer.

       push-line-or-edit
              At the top-level (PS1) prompt, equivalent to  push-line.   At  a
              secondary  (PS2)  prompt, move the entire current multiline con-
              struct into the editor buffer.   The  latter  is  equivalent  to
              push-input followed by get-line.

       read-command
              Only  useful  from  a  user-defined widget.  A keystroke is read
              just as in normal operation, but instead of  the  command  being
              executed  the  name  of  the  command  that would be executed is
              stored in the shell parameter REPLY.  This can be  used  as  the
              argument  of  a  future zle command.  If the key sequence is not
              bound, status 1 is returned; typically, however, REPLY is set to
              undefined-key to indicate a useless key sequence.

       recursive-edit
              Only  useful  from  a user-defined widget.  At this point in the
              function, the editor regains control until one of  the  standard
              widgets which would normally cause zle to exit (typically an ac-
              cept-line caused by hitting the return key)  is  executed.   In-
              stead,  control  returns to the user-defined widget.  The status
              returned is non-zero if the return was caused by an  error,  but
              the  function  still  continues executing and hence may tidy up.
              This makes it safe for the user-defined widget to alter the com-
              mand line or key bindings temporarily.

              The following widget, caps-lock, serves as an example.

                     self-insert-ucase() {
                       LBUFFER+=${(U)KEYS[-1]}
                     }

                     integer stat

                     zle -N self-insert self-insert-ucase
                     zle -A caps-lock save-caps-lock
                     zle -A accept-line caps-lock

                     zle recursive-edit
                     stat=$?

                     zle -A .self-insert self-insert
                     zle -A save-caps-lock caps-lock
                     zle -D save-caps-lock

                     (( stat )) && zle send-break

                     return $stat

              This  causes  typed letters to be inserted capitalised until ei-
              ther accept-line (i.e. typically the return key) is typed or the
              caps-lock  widget is invoked again; the later is handled by sav-
              ing the old definition of caps-lock as save-caps-lock  and  then
              rebinding it to invoke accept-line.  Note that an error from the
              recursive edit is detected as a non-zero return status and prop-
              agated by using the send-break widget.

       redisplay (unbound) (^R) (^R)
              Redisplays the edit buffer.

       reset-prompt (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
              Force the prompts on both the left and right of the screen to be
              re-expanded, then redisplay  the  edit  buffer.   This  reflects
              changes  both  to the prompt variables themselves and changes in
              the expansion of the values (for example, changes in time or di-
              rectory, or changes to the value of variables referred to by the
              prompt).

              Otherwise, the prompt is only expanded each time zle starts, and
              when  the  display  has  been interrupted by output from another
              part of the shell (such as a job notification) which causes  the
              command line to be reprinted.

              reset-prompt doesn't alter the special parameter LASTWIDGET.

       send-break (^G ESC-^G) (unbound) (unbound)
              Abort  the  current editor function, e.g. execute-named-command,
              or the editor itself, e.g. if you are in vared. Otherwise  abort
              the  parsing  of the current line; in this case the aborted line
              is available in the shell variable ZLE_LINE_ABORTED.  If the ed-
              itor    is    aborted    from   within   vared,   the   variable
              ZLE_VARED_ABORTED is set.

       run-help (ESC-H ESC-h) (unbound) (unbound)
              Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute  the  command
              `run-help  cmd',  where cmd is the current command.  run-help is
              normally aliased to man.

       vi-set-buffer (unbound) (") (unbound)
              Specify a buffer to be used in the following command.  There are
              37  buffers  that can be specified: the 26 `named' buffers "a to
              "z, the `yank' buffer "0, the nine `queued' buffers "1 to "9 and
              the `black hole' buffer "_.  The named buffers can also be spec-
              ified as "A to "Z.

              When a buffer is specified for a cut, change  or  yank  command,
              the  text concerned replaces the previous contents of the speci-
              fied buffer. If a named buffer is specified using a capital, the
              newly  cut text is appended to the buffer instead of overwriting
              it. When using the "_ buffer, nothing happens. This can be  use-
              ful for deleting text without affecting any buffers.

              If  no  buffer  is  specified for a cut or change command, "1 is
              used, and the contents of "1 to "8 are each  shifted  along  one
              buffer;  the  contents  of "9 is lost. If no buffer is specified
              for a yank command, "0 is used. Finally, a paste command without
              a specified buffer will paste the text from the most recent com-
              mand regardless of any buffer that might  have  been  used  with
              that command.

              When  called from a widget function by the zle command, the buf-
              fer can optionally be specified with an argument. For example,

                     zle vi-set-buffer A

       vi-set-mark (unbound) (m) (unbound)
              Set the specified mark at the cursor position.

       set-mark-command (^@) (unbound) (unbound)
              Set the mark at the cursor position.  If called with a  negative
              numeric  argument, do not set the mark but deactivate the region
              so that it is no longer highlighted  (it  is  still  usable  for
              other purposes).  Otherwise the region is marked as active.

       spell-word (ESC-$ ESC-S ESC-s) (unbound) (unbound)
              Attempt spelling correction on the current word.

       split-undo
              Breaks  the undo sequence at the current change.  This is useful
              in vi mode as changes made in insert mode are coalesced  on  en-
              tering  command  mode.   Similarly, undo will normally revert as
              one all the changes made by a user-defined widget.

       undefined-key
              This command is executed when a key sequence that is  not  bound
              to any command is typed.  By default it beeps.

       undo (^_ ^Xu ^X^U) (u) (unbound)
              Incrementally undo the last text modification.  When called from
              a user-defined widget, takes an optional argument  indicating  a
              previous   state   of  the  undo  history  as  returned  by  the
              UNDO_CHANGE_NO variable; modifications  are  undone  until  that
              state   is   reached,  subject  to  any  limit  imposed  by  the
              UNDO_LIMIT_NO variable.

              Note that when invoked from vi  command  mode,  the  full  prior
              change  made in insert mode is reverted, the changes having been
              merged when command mode was selected.

       redo (unbound) (^R) (unbound)
              Incrementally redo undone text modifications.

       vi-undo-change (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
              Undo the last text modification.  If repeated, redo the  modifi-
              cation.

       visual-mode (unbound) (v) (unbound)
              Toggle vim-style visual selection mode. If line-wise visual mode
              is currently enabled then it is changed to being character-wise.
              If used following an operator, it forces the subsequent movement
              command to be treated as a character-wise movement.

       visual-line-mode (unbound) (V) (unbound)
              Toggle vim-style line-wise visual  selection  mode.  If  charac-
              ter-wise  visual mode is currently enabled then it is changed to
              being line-wise. If used following an operator,  it  forces  the
              subsequent  movement  command to be treated as a line-wise move-
              ment.

       what-cursor-position (^X=) (ga) (unbound)
              Print the character under the cursor, its code as an octal, dec-
              imal  and hexadecimal number, the current cursor position within
              the buffer and the column of the cursor in the current line.

       where-is
              Read the name of an editor command and print the listing of  key
              sequences  that  invoke the specified command.  A restricted set
              of editing functions is available in the mini-buffer.  Keys  are
              looked  up in the special command keymap, and if not found there
              in the main keymap.

       which-command (ESC-?) (unbound) (unbound)
              Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute  the  command
              `which-command   cmd'.   where   cmd  is  the  current  command.
              which-command is normally aliased to whence.

       vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line (unbound) (0) (unbound)
              If the last command executed was a digit as part of an argument,
              continue the argument.  Otherwise, execute vi-beginning-of-line.

   Text Objects
       Text  objects  are  commands that can be used to select a block of text
       according to some criteria. They are a feature of the vim  text  editor
       and  so are primarily intended for use with vi operators or from visual
       selection mode. However, they can also be used from vi-insert or  emacs
       mode. Key bindings listed below apply to the viopp and visual keymaps.

       select-a-blank-word (aW)
              Select a word including adjacent blanks, where a word is defined
              as a series of non-blank characters. With  a  numeric  argument,
              multiple words will be selected.

       select-a-shell-word (aa)
              Select  the  current  command argument applying the normal rules
              for quoting.

       select-a-word (aw)
              Select a  word  including  adjacent  blanks,  using  the  normal
              vi-style  word  definition.  With  a  numeric argument, multiple
              words will be selected.

       select-in-blank-word (iW)
              Select a word, where a word is defined as a series of  non-blank
              characters.  With a numeric argument, multiple words will be se-
              lected.

       select-in-shell-word (ia)
              Select the current command argument applying  the  normal  rules
              for quoting. If the argument begins and ends with matching quote
              characters, these are not included in the selection.

       select-in-word (iw)
              Select a word, using the normal vi-style word definition. With a
              numeric argument, multiple words will be selected.

CHARACTER HIGHLIGHTING
       The  line  editor has the ability to highlight characters or regions of
       the line that have a particular significance.  This  is  controlled  by
       the array parameter zle_highlight, if it has been set by the user.

       If  the  parameter  contains  the single entry none all highlighting is
       turned off.  Note the parameter is still expected to be an array.

       Otherwise each entry of the array should consist of a word indicating a
       context  for highlighting, then a colon, then a comma-separated list of
       the types of highlighting to apply in that context.

       The contexts available for highlighting are the following:

       default
              Any text within the command line not affected by any other high-
              lighting.  Text outside the editable area of the command line is
              not affected.

       isearch
              When one of the incremental history search  widgets  is  active,
              the  area  of  the  command line matched by the search string or
              pattern.

       region The currently selected text. In emacs terminology, this  is  re-
              ferred to as the region and is bounded by the cursor (point) and
              the mark. The region is only highlighted if it is active,  which
              is  the case after the mark is modified with set-mark-command or
              exchange-point-and-mark.  Note that whether or not the region is
              active  has  no effect on its use within emacs style widgets, it
              simply determines whether it is highlighted. In vi mode, the re-
              gion corresponds to selected text in visual mode.

       special
              Individual  characters that have no direct printable representa-
              tion but are shown in a  special  manner  by  the  line  editor.
              These characters are described below.

       suffix This  context  is  used  in  completion  for characters that are
              marked as suffixes that will be removed if the  completion  ends
              at  that point, the most obvious example being a slash (/) after
              a directory name.  Note that suffix removal is configurable; the
              circumstances  under which the suffix will be removed may differ
              for different completions.

       paste  Following a command to paste text, the characters that were  in-
              serted.

       When  region_highlight  is  set, the contexts that describe a region --
       isearch, region, suffix, and paste  --  are  applied  first,  then  re-
       gion_highlight  is  applied,  then the remaining zle_highlight contexts
       are applied.  If a particular character is affected by multiple  speci-
       fications, the last specification wins.

       zle_highlight  may contain additional fields for controlling how termi-
       nal sequences to change colours are output.  Each of the  following  is
       followed  by a colon and a string in the same form as for key bindings.
       This will not be necessary for the vast majority of  terminals  as  the
       defaults shown in parentheses are widely used.

       fg_start_code (\e[3)
              The  start  of  the  escape  sequence for the foreground colour.
              This is followed by one to three ASCII digits  representing  the
              colour.   Only  used  for palette colors, i.e. not 24-bit colors
              specified via a color triplet.

       fg_default_code (9)
              The number to use instead of the colour  to  reset  the  default
              foreground colour.

       fg_end_code (m)
              The end of the escape sequence for the foreground colour.

       bg_start_code (\e[4)
              The start of the escape sequence for the background colour.  See
              fg_start_code above.

       bg_default_code (9)
              The number to use instead of the colour  to  reset  the  default
              background colour.

       bg_end_code (m)
              The end of the escape sequence for the background colour.

       The  available  types of highlighting are the following.  Note that not
       all types of highlighting are available on all terminals:

       none   No highlighting is applied to the given context.  It is not use-
              ful  for  this to appear with other types of highlighting; it is
              used to override a default.

       fg=colour
              The foreground colour should be set to colour, a  decimal  inte-
              ger,  the name of one of the eight most widely-supported colours
              or as a `#' followed by an RGB triplet in hexadecimal format.

              Not all terminals support this and, of those that  do,  not  all
              provide  facilities  to  test the support, hence the user should
              decide based on the terminal type.  Most terminals  support  the
              colours  black,  red,  green,  yellow,  blue,  magenta, cyan and
              white, which can be set by name.  In addition.  default  may  be
              used to set the terminal's default foreground colour.  Abbrevia-
              tions are allowed; b or bl selects black.   Some  terminals  may
              generate  additional  colours  if  the  bold  attribute  is also
              present.

              On recent terminals and on systems with an  up-to-date  terminal
              database  the  number  of colours supported may be tested by the
              command `echotc Co'; if this succeeds, it indicates a  limit  on
              the number of colours which will be enforced by the line editor.
              The number of colours is in any case limited to  256  (i.e.  the
              range 0 to 255).

              Some  modern  terminal  emulators  have  support for 24-bit true
              colour (16 million colours). In this case, the hex triplet  for-
              mat  can  be  used.  This consists of a `#' followed by either a
              three or six digit hexadecimal number describing the red,  green
              and blue components of the colour. Hex triplets can also be used
              with 88 and 256 colour terminals via  the  zsh/nearcolor  module
              (see zshmodules(1)).

              Colour is also known as color.

       bg=colour
              The background colour should be set to colour.  This works simi-
              larly to the foreground colour, except  the  background  is  not
              usually affected by the bold attribute.

       bold   The  characters  in  the given context are shown in a bold font.
              Not all terminals distinguish bold fonts.

       standout
              The characters in the given context are shown in the  terminal's
              standout  mode.   The actual effect is specific to the terminal;
              on many terminals it is inverse video.  On some such  terminals,
              where  the  cursor  does not blink it appears with standout mode
              negated, making it less than clear where the cursor actually is.
              On such terminals one of the other effects may be preferable for
              highlighting the region and matched search string.

       underline
              The characters in the given context are shown underlined.   Some
              terminals  show the foreground in a different colour instead; in
              this case whitespace will not be highlighted.

       The characters described above as `special' are as follows.   The  for-
       matting  described  here is used irrespective of whether the characters
       are highlighted:

       ASCII control characters
              Control characters in the ASCII range are shown as `^'  followed
              by the base character.

       Unprintable multibyte characters
              This  item applies to control characters not in the ASCII range,
              plus other characters as follows.  If the MULTIBYTE option is in
              effect, multibyte characters not in the ASCII character set that
              are reported as having zero width are treated as combining char-
              acters  when the option COMBINING_CHARS is on.  If the option is
              off, or if a character appears where a  combining  character  is
              not valid, the character is treated as unprintable.

              Unprintable multibyte characters are shown as a hexadecimal num-
              ber between angle brackets.  The number is the code point of the
              character in the wide character set; this may or may not be Uni-
              code, depending on the operating system.

       Invalid multibyte characters
              If the MULTIBYTE option is in effect, any  sequence  of  one  or
              more  bytes  that does not form a valid character in the current
              character set is treated as a series of bytes each  shown  as  a
              special  character.   This  case can be distinguished from other
              unprintable characters as the bytes are represented as two hexa-
              decimal digits between angle brackets, as distinct from the four
              or eight digits that are used for  unprintable  characters  that
              are nonetheless valid in the current character set.

              Not  all systems support this: for it to work, the system's rep-
              resentation of wide characters must be code values from the Uni-
              versal  Character  Set,  as  defined by IS0 10646 (also known as
              Unicode).

       Wrapped double-width characters
              When a double-width character appears in the final column  of  a
              line, it is instead shown on the next line. The empty space left
              in the original position is highlighted as a special character.

       If zle_highlight is not set or no value applies to  a  particular  con-
       text, the defaults applied are equivalent to

              zle_highlight=(region:standout special:standout
              suffix:bold isearch:underline paste:standout)

       i.e. both the region and special characters are shown in standout mode.

       Within  widgets,  arbitrary  regions  may be highlighted by setting the
       special array parameter region_highlight; see above.

ZSHCOMPWID(1)               General Commands Manual              ZSHCOMPWID(1)

NAME
       zshcompwid - zsh completion widgets

DESCRIPTION
       The shell's programmable completion mechanism can be manipulated in two
       ways;  here the low-level features supporting the newer, function-based
       mechanism are defined.  A complete set  of  shell  functions  based  on
       these  features is described in zshcompsys(1), and users with no inter-
       est in adding to that system (or, potentially, writing their own -- see
       dictionary  entry  for  `hubris') should skip the current section.  The
       older system based on the compctl builtin command is described in  zsh-
       compctl(1).

       Completion widgets are defined by the -C option to the zle builtin com-
       mand provided by the zsh/zle module (see zshzle(1)). For example,

              zle -C complete expand-or-complete completer

       defines a widget named `complete'.  The second argument is the name  of
       any  of the builtin widgets that handle completions: complete-word, ex-
       pand-or-complete,  expand-or-complete-prefix,  menu-complete,  menu-ex-
       pand-or-complete,      reverse-menu-complete,      list-choices,     or
       delete-char-or-list.  Note that this will still work even if the widget
       in question has been re-bound.

       When  this  newly  defined  widget  is bound to a key using the bindkey
       builtin command defined in the zsh/zle module (see  zshzle(1)),  typing
       that key will call the shell function `completer'. This function is re-
       sponsible for generating completion  matches  using  the  builtins  de-
       scribed  below.  As with other ZLE widgets, the function is called with
       its standard input closed.

       Once the function returns, the completion code takes over control again
       and treats the matches in the same manner as the specified builtin wid-
       get, in this case expand-or-complete.

COMPLETION SPECIAL PARAMETERS
       The parameters ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS and  ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS  are
       used  by  the completion mechanism, but are not special. See Parameters
       Used By The Shell in zshparam(1).

       Inside completion widgets, and any functions called from them, some pa-
       rameters  have  special  meaning;  outside these functions they are not
       special to the shell in any way.  These parameters are used to pass in-
       formation  between  the completion code and the completion widget. Some
       of the builtin commands and the condition codes use or change the  cur-
       rent  values  of  these parameters.  Any existing values will be hidden
       during execution of completion widgets; except for compstate,  the  pa-
       rameters  are  reset  on  each function exit (including nested function
       calls from within the completion widget) to the values  they  had  when
       the function was entered.

       CURRENT
              This is the number of the current word, i.e. the word the cursor
              is currently on in the words array.  Note  that  this  value  is
              only correct if the ksharrays option is not set.

       IPREFIX
              Initially  this will be set to the empty string.  This parameter
              functions like PREFIX; it contains a string which  precedes  the
              one in PREFIX and is not considered part of the list of matches.
              Typically, a string is transferred from the beginning of  PREFIX
              to the end of IPREFIX, for example:

                     IPREFIX=${PREFIX%%\=*}=
                     PREFIX=${PREFIX#*=}

              causes  the  part  of  the  prefix up to and including the first
              equal sign not to be treated as part of a matched string.   This
              can be done automatically by the compset builtin, see below.

       ISUFFIX
              As  IPREFIX, but for a suffix that should not be considered part
              of the matches; note that the ISUFFIX string follows the  SUFFIX
              string.

       PREFIX Initially  this will be set to the part of the current word from
              the beginning of the word up to the position of the  cursor;  it
              may be altered to give a common prefix for all matches.

       QIPREFIX
              This parameter is read-only and contains the quoted string up to
              the word being completed. E.g. when completing `"foo', this  pa-
              rameter  contains  the double quote. If the -q option of compset
              is used (see below), and the original string was `"foo bar' with
              the cursor on the `bar', this parameter contains `"foo '.

       QISUFFIX
              Like QIPREFIX, but containing the suffix.

       SUFFIX Initially  this will be set to the part of the current word from
              the cursor position to the end; it may be altered to give a com-
              mon  suffix  for all matches.  It is most useful when the option
              COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set, as otherwise the whole word on the com-
              mand line is treated as a prefix.

       compstate
              This  is  an associative array with various keys and values that
              the completion code uses to exchange information with  the  com-
              pletion widget.  The keys are:

              all_quotes
                     The  -q option of the compset builtin command (see below)
                     allows a quoted string to be broken into separate  words;
                     if the cursor is on one of those words, that word will be
                     completed, possibly invoking  `compset  -q'  recursively.
                     With  this key it is possible to test the types of quoted
                     strings which are currently broken  into  parts  in  this
                     fashion.  Its value contains one character for each quot-
                     ing level.  The characters are a single quote or a double
                     quote for strings quoted with these characters, a dollars
                     sign for strings quoted with $'...' and a  backslash  for
                     strings  not  starting with a quote character.  The first
                     character in the value always corresponds to  the  inner-
                     most quoting level.

              context
                     This  will  be  set by the completion code to the overall
                     context in which completion is attempted. Possible values
                     are:

                     array_value
                            when  completing  inside the value of an array pa-
                            rameter assignment; in this case the  words  array
                            contains the words inside the parentheses.

                     brace_parameter
                            when  completing  the name of a parameter in a pa-
                            rameter expansion beginning with ${.  This context
                            will  also  be set when completing parameter flags
                            following ${(; the full command line  argument  is
                            presented  and  the handler must test the value to
                            be completed to ascertain that this is the case.

                     assign_parameter
                            when completing the name of a parameter in  a  pa-
                            rameter assignment.

                     command
                            when  completing  for  a normal command (either in
                            command position or for an argument  of  the  com-
                            mand).

                     condition
                            when completing inside a `[[...]]' conditional ex-
                            pression; in this case the  words  array  contains
                            only the words inside the conditional expression.

                     math   when completing in a mathematical environment such
                            as a `((...))' construct.

                     parameter
                            when completing the name of a parameter in  a  pa-
                            rameter expansion beginning with $ but not ${.

                     redirect
                            when completing after a redirection operator.

                     subscript
                            when completing inside a parameter subscript.

                     value  when  completing  the value of a parameter assign-
                            ment.

              exact  Controls the behaviour when the REC_EXACT option is  set.
                     It  will  be set to accept if an exact match would be ac-
                     cepted, and will be unset otherwise.

                     If it was set when at least one match equal to the string
                     on the line was generated, the match is accepted.

              exact_string
                     The  string of an exact match if one was found, otherwise
                     unset.

              ignored
                     The number of completions that were ignored because  they
                     matched  one  of the patterns given with the -F option to
                     the compadd builtin command.

              insert This controls the manner in which  a  match  is  inserted
                     into  the command line.  On entry to the widget function,
                     if it is unset the command line is not to be changed;  if
                     set  to  unambiguous, any prefix common to all matches is
                     to be inserted; if set to automenu-unambiguous, the  com-
                     mon  prefix  is to be inserted and the next invocation of
                     the completion code may start menu completion (due to the
                     AUTO_MENU  option  being set); if set to menu or automenu
                     menu completion will be started for the matches currently
                     generated  (in  the  latter case this will happen because
                     the AUTO_MENU is set). The value  may  also  contain  the
                     string  `tab' when the completion code would normally not
                     really do completion, but only insert the TAB character.

                     On exit it may be set to any of the values  above  (where
                     setting  it  to the empty string is the same as unsetting
                     it), or to a number, in which case the match whose number
                     is  given  will be inserted into the command line.  Nega-
                     tive numbers count backward from  the  last  match  (with
                     `-1'  selecting  the  last match) and out-of-range values
                     are wrapped around, so that a value of zero  selects  the
                     last  match and a value one more than the maximum selects
                     the first. Unless the value of this key ends in a  space,
                     the match is inserted as in a menu completion, i.e. with-
                     out automatically appending a space.

                     Both menu and automenu may also specify the number of the
                     match  to  insert,  given  after  a  colon.  For example,
                     `menu:2' says to start menu  completion,  beginning  with
                     the second match.

                     Note  that  a  value containing the substring `tab' makes
                     the matches generated be ignored and only the TAB be  in-
                     serted.

                     Finally,  it  may  also  be  set  to all, which makes all
                     matches generated be inserted into the line.

              insert_positions
                     When the completion system inserts an unambiguous  string
                     into the line, there may be multiple places where charac-
                     ters are missing or where the character inserted  differs
                     from  at least one match.  The value of this key contains
                     a colon separated list of all these positions, as indexes
                     into the command line.

              last_prompt
                     If  this  is  set  to  a non-empty string for every match
                     added, the completion code will move the cursor  back  to
                     the  previous  prompt  after  the list of completions has
                     been displayed.  Initially this is set or unset according
                     to the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option.

              list   This  controls whether or how the list of matches will be
                     displayed.  If it is unset or empty they  will  never  be
                     listed;  if  its value begins with list, they will always
                     be listed; if it begins with autolist or ambiguous,  they
                     will  be  listed when the AUTO_LIST or LIST_AMBIGUOUS op-
                     tions respectively would normally cause them to be.

                     If the substring force appears in the value,  this  makes
                     the  list  be shown even if there is only one match. Nor-
                     mally, the list would be shown only if there are at least
                     two matches.

                     The   value   contains   the   substring  packed  if  the
                     LIST_PACKED option is set. If this substring is given for
                     all  matches  added  to a group, this group will show the
                     LIST_PACKED  behavior.  The  same   is   done   for   the
                     LIST_ROWS_FIRST option with the substring rows.

                     Finally,  if  the value contains the string explanations,
                     only the explanation strings, if any, will be listed  and
                     if  it  contains  messages, only the messages (added with
                     the -x option of compadd) will be listed.  If it contains
                     both  explanations and messages both kinds of explanation
                     strings will be listed.  It will be set appropriately  on
                     entry to a completion widget and may be changed there.

              list_lines
                     This gives the number of lines that are needed to display
                     the full list of completions.  Note that to calculate the
                     total number of lines to display you need to add the num-
                     ber of lines needed for the command line to  this  value,
                     this is available as the value of the BUFFERLINES special
                     parameter.

              list_max
                     Initially this is set to the value of the LISTMAX parame-
                     ter.   It  may be set to any other value; when the widget
                     exits this value will be used in  the  same  way  as  the
                     value of LISTMAX.

              nmatches
                     The  number  of  matches  added by the completion code so
                     far.

              old_insert
                     On entry to the widget this will be set to the number  of
                     the match of an old list of completions that is currently
                     inserted into the command line. If no match has been  in-
                     serted, this is unset.

                     As with old_list, the value of this key will only be used
                     if it is the string keep. If it was set to this value  by
                     the  widget  and there was an old match inserted into the
                     command line, this match will be kept and if the value of
                     the insert key specifies that another match should be in-
                     serted, this will be inserted after the old one.

              old_list
                     This is set to yes if there is still a valid list of com-
                     pletions  from a previous completion at the time the wid-
                     get is invoked.  This will usually be  the  case  if  and
                     only  if  the previous editing operation was a completion
                     widget or one of the builtin  completion  functions.   If
                     there  is  a valid list and it is also currently shown on
                     the screen, the value of this key is shown.

                     After the widget has exited the value of this key is only
                     used  if it was set to keep.  In this case the completion
                     code will continue to use this old list.  If  the  widget
                     generated new matches, they will not be used.

              parameter
                     The  name of the parameter when completing in a subscript
                     or in the value of a parameter assignment.

              pattern_insert
                     Normally this is set to menu, which specifies  that  menu
                     completion  will  be  used  whenever a set of matches was
                     generated using pattern_match (see below).  If it is  set
                     to  any  other non-empty string by the user and menu com-
                     pletion is not selected by  other  option  settings,  the
                     code will instead insert any common prefix for the gener-
                     ated matches as with normal completion.

              pattern_match
                     Locally controls the behaviour given by the GLOB_COMPLETE
                     option.   Initially  it  is set to `*' if and only if the
                     option is set.  The completion widget may set it to  this
                     value,  to  an empty string (which has the same effect as
                     unsetting it), or to any other non-empty string.   If  it
                     is non-empty, unquoted metacharacters on the command line
                     will be treated as patterns; if it is `*', then addition-
                     ally a wildcard `*' is assumed at the cursor position; if
                     it is empty or unset, metacharacters will be treated lit-
                     erally.

                     Note  that  the match specifications given to the compadd
                     builtin command  are  not  used  if  this  is  set  to  a
                     non-empty string.

              quote  When  completing  inside quotes, this contains the quota-
                     tion character (i.e. either  a  single  quote,  a  double
                     quote, or a backtick).  Otherwise it is unset.

              quoting
                     When  completing inside single quotes, this is set to the
                     string single; inside double quotes, the  string  double;
                     inside  backticks,  the string backtick.  Otherwise it is
                     unset.

              redirect
                     The redirection operator when completing in a redirection
                     position, i.e. one of <, >, etc.

              restore
                     This  is  set to auto before a function is entered, which
                     forces the special  parameters  mentioned  above  (words,
                     CURRENT,  PREFIX, IPREFIX, SUFFIX, and ISUFFIX) to be re-
                     stored to their previous values when the function  exits.
                     If  a  function unsets it or sets it to any other string,
                     they will not be restored.

              to_end Specifies the occasions on which the cursor is  moved  to
                     the  end  of a string when a match is inserted.  On entry
                     to a widget function, it may be single if this will  hap-
                     pen when a single unambiguous match was inserted or match
                     if it will happen any time a match is inserted (for exam-
                     ple,  by menu completion; this is likely to be the effect
                     of the ALWAYS_TO_END option).

                     On exit, it may be set to single as above.  It  may  also
                     be  set  to  always,  or to the empty string or unset; in
                     those cases the cursor will be moved to the  end  of  the
                     string always or never respectively.  Any other string is
                     treated as match.

              unambiguous
                     This key is read-only and will always be set to the  com-
                     mon  (unambiguous)  prefix the completion code has gener-
                     ated for all matches added so far.

              unambiguous_cursor
                     This gives the position the cursor would be placed at  if
                     the  common  prefix in the unambiguous key were inserted,
                     relative to the value of that key. The  cursor  would  be
                     placed  before the character whose index is given by this
                     key.

              unambiguous_positions
                     This contains all positions where characters in the unam-
                     biguous  string  are  missing  or where the character in-
                     serted differs from at least one of the matches.  The po-
                     sitions are given as indexes into the string given by the
                     value of the unambiguous key.

              vared  If completion is called while editing a  line  using  the
                     vared  builtin,  the value of this key is set to the name
                     of the parameter given as an argument to vared.  This key
                     is only set while a vared command is active.

       words  This  array  contains the words present on the command line cur-
              rently being edited.

COMPLETION BUILTIN COMMANDS
       compadd [ -akqQfenUl12C ] [ -F array ]
               [-P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
               [-p hidden-prefix ] [ -s hidden-suffix ]
               [-i ignored-prefix ] [ -I ignored-suffix ]
               [-W file-prefix ] [ -d array ]
               [-J group-name ] [ -X explanation ] [ -x message ]
               [-V group-name ] [ -o [ order ] ]
               [-r remove-chars ] [ -R remove-func ]
               [-D array ] [ -O array ] [ -A array ]
               [-E number ]
               [-M match-spec ] [ -- ] [ completions ... ]

              This builtin command can be used to  add  matches  directly  and
              control all the information the completion code stores with each
              possible completion. The return status is zero if at  least  one
              match was added and non-zero if no matches were added.

              The  completion  code breaks each match into seven fields in the
              order:

                     <ipre><apre><hpre><body><hsuf><asuf><isuf>

              The first field is an ignored  prefix  taken  from  the  command
              line,  the  contents  of  the  IPREFIX parameter plus the string
              given with the -i option. With the -U option,  only  the  string
              from the -i option is used. The field <apre> is an optional pre-
              fix string given with the -P option.   The  <hpre>  field  is  a
              string  that is considered part of the match but that should not
              be shown when listing completions, given with the -p option; for
              example,  functions  that do filename generation might specify a
              common path prefix this way.  <body> is the part  of  the  match
              that  should  appear  in  the list of matches shown to the user.
              The suffixes <hsuf>, <asuf> and <isuf> correspond  to  the  pre-
              fixes <hpre>, <apre> and <ipre> and are given by the options -s,
              -S and -I, respectively.

              The supported flags are:

              -P prefix
                     This gives a string to be  inserted  before  each  match.
                     The  string  given is not considered as part of the match
                     and any shell metacharacters in it  will  not  be  quoted
                     when the string is inserted.

              -S suffix
                     Like  -P,  but  gives  a string to be inserted after each
                     match.

              -p hidden-prefix
                     This gives a string that should be inserted  before  each
                     match  but that should not appear in the list of matches.
                     Unless the -U  option  is  given,  this  string  must  be
                     matched as part of the string on the command line.

              -s hidden-suffix
                     Like `-p', but gives a string to insert after each match.

              -i ignored-prefix
                     This  gives  a  string  to  insert just before any string
                     given with the `-P' option.  Without `-P' the  string  is
                     inserted  before  the  string given with `-p' or directly
                     before each match.

              -I ignored-suffix
                     Like -i, but gives an ignored suffix.

              -a     With this flag the completions are taken as names of  ar-
                     rays  and  the  actual  completions are their values.  If
                     only some elements of the arrays are needed, the  comple-
                     tions may also contain subscripts, as in `foo[2,-1]'.

              -k     With  this flag the completions are taken as names of as-
                     sociative arrays and the  actual  completions  are  their
                     keys.   As for -a, the words may also contain subscripts,
                     as in `foo[(R)*bar*]'.

              -d array
                     This  adds  per-completion  display  strings.  The  array
                     should contain one element per completion given. The com-
                     pletion code will then display the first element  instead
                     of  the  first  completion,  and  so on. The array may be
                     given as the name of an array parameter or directly as  a
                     space-separated list of words in parentheses.

                     If  there are fewer display strings than completions, the
                     leftover completions will be displayed unchanged  and  if
                     there  are  more  display  strings  than completions, the
                     leftover display strings will be silently ignored.

              -l     This option only has an effect if used together with  the
                     -d option. If it is given, the display strings are listed
                     one per line, not arrayed in columns.

              -o [ order ]
                     This controls the order in which matches are sorted.  or-
                     der  is  a  comma-separated list comprising the following
                     possible values.  These  values  can  be  abbreviated  to
                     their initial two or three characters.  Note that the or-
                     der forms part of the group name space  so  matches  with
                     different orderings will not be in the same group.

                     match  If given, the order of the output is determined by
                            the match strings; otherwise it is  determined  by
                            the display strings (i.e. the strings given by the
                            -d option). This is the default if `-o' is  speci-
                            fied but the order argument is omitted.

                     nosort This specifies that the completions are pre-sorted
                            and their order should be preserved.   This  value
                            only makes sense alone and cannot be combined with
                            any others.

                     numeric
                            If the matches include numbers, sort them  numeri-
                            cally rather than lexicographically.

                     reverse
                            Arrange  the  matches  backwards  by reversing the
                            sort ordering.

              -J group-name
                     Gives the name of the group that the  matches  should  be
                     stored in.

              -V group-name
                     Like  -J  but  naming  an  unsorted group. This option is
                     identical to the combination of -J and -o nosort.

              -1     If given together with the -V option, makes only consecu-
                     tive duplicates in the group be removed. If combined with
                     the -J option, this has  no  visible  effect.  Note  that
                     groups  with  and without this flag are in different name
                     spaces.

              -2     If given together with the -J or -V option, makes all du-
                     plicates  be  kept.  Again,  groups with and without this
                     flag are in different name spaces.

              -X explanation
                     The explanation string will be printed with the  list  of
                     matches, above the group currently selected.

                     Within  the  explanation,  the following sequences may be
                     used to specify output attributes  as  described  in  the
                     section  EXPANSION  OF  PROMPT  SEQUENCES  in zshmisc(1):
                     `%B', `%S', `%U', `%F', `%K' and their lower  case  coun-
                     terparts, as well as `%{...%}'.  `%F', `%K' and `%{...%}'
                     take arguments in the  same  form  as  prompt  expansion.
                     (Note  that  the sequence `%G' is not available; an argu-
                     ment to `%{' should be used instead.)  The sequence  `%%'
                     produces a literal `%'.

                     These  sequences  are  most  often employed by users when
                     customising the format  style  (see  zshcompsys(1)),  but
                     they must also be taken into account when writing comple-
                     tion functions, as passing  descriptions  with  unescaped
                     `%'  characters  to  utility functions such as _arguments
                     and _message may produce unexpected results. If arbitrary
                     text  is to be passed in a description, it can be escaped
                     using e.g. ${my_str//\%/%%}.

              -x message
                     Like -X, but the message will be printed  even  if  there
                     are no matches in the group.

              -q     The suffix given with -S will be automatically removed if
                     the next character typed is a blank or  does  not  insert
                     anything, or if the suffix consists of only one character
                     and the next character typed is the same character.

              -r remove-chars
                     This is a more versatile form of the -q option.  The suf-
                     fix  given with -S or the slash automatically added after
                     completing directories will be automatically  removed  if
                     the  next  character  typed inserts one of the characters
                     given in the remove-chars.  This string is  parsed  as  a
                     characters  class and understands the backslash sequences
                     used by the print command.  For example, `-r "a-z\t"' re-
                     moves  the  suffix  if the next character typed inserts a
                     lower case character or a TAB, and  `-r  "^0-9"'  removes
                     the  suffix  if the next character typed inserts anything
                     but a digit. One extra backslash sequence  is  understood
                     in  this  string: `\-' stands for all characters that in-
                     sert nothing. Thus `-S "=" -q' is the same as `-S "="  -r
                     "= \t\n\-"'.

                     This  option may also be used without the -S option; then
                     any automatically added space will be removed when one of
                     the characters in the list is typed.

              -R remove-func
                     This  is  another form of the -r option. When a match has
                     been accepted and a suffix has been inserted,  the  func-
                     tion  remove-func will be called after the next character
                     typed.  It is passed the length of the suffix as an argu-
                     ment  and can use the special parameters available in or-
                     dinary (non-completion) zle widgets  (see  zshzle(1))  to
                     analyse and modify the command line.

              -f     If  this flag is given, all of the matches built from the
                     completions are marked as being the names of files.  They
                     are not required to be actual filenames, but if they are,
                     and the option LIST_TYPES is set, the characters describ-
                     ing  the  types of the files in the completion lists will
                     be shown. This also forces a slash to be added  when  the
                     name of a directory is completed.

              -e     This  flag  can  be used to tell the completion code that
                     the matches added are parameter names for a parameter ex-
                     pansion.   This   will   make  the  AUTO_PARAM_SLASH  and
                     AUTO_PARAM_KEYS options be used for the matches.

              -W file-prefix
                     This string is a pathname that will be prepended to  each
                     match together with any prefix specified by the -p option
                     to form a complete filename for  testing.   Hence  it  is
                     only  useful  if  combined with the -f flag, as the tests
                     will not otherwise be performed.

              -F array
                     Specifies an array containing patterns.  completions that
                     match  one  of  these  patterns are ignored, that is, not
                     considered to be matches.

                     The array may be the name of an array parameter or a list
                     of  literal  patterns enclosed in parentheses and quoted,
                     as in `-F "(*?.o *?.h)"'. If the  name  of  an  array  is
                     given,  the  elements  of the array are taken as the pat-
                     terns.

              -Q     This flag instructs the completion code not to quote  any
                     metacharacters  in  the  matches when inserting them into
                     the command line.

              -M match-spec
                     This gives local match specifications as described  below
                     in the section `Completion Matching Control'. This option
                     may  be  given  more  than  once.   In  this   case   all
                     match-specs  given  are  concatenated with spaces between
                     them to form the specification string to use.  Note  that
                     they will only be used if the -U option is not given.

              -n     Specifies  that  matching  completions are to be added to
                     the set of matches, but are not to be listed to the user.

              -U     If this flag is given, all completions are added  to  the
                     set  of  matches and no matching will be done by the com-
                     pletion code. Normally this is used in functions that  do
                     the matching themselves.

              -O array
                     If this option is given, the completions are not added to
                     the set of matches.  Instead, matching is done  as  usual
                     and  all  of the completions that match will be stored in
                     the array parameter whose name is given as array.

              -A array
                     As the -O option, except that instead  of  those  of  the
                     completions  which  match  being  stored  in  array,  the
                     strings generated internally by the completion  code  are
                     stored.   For  example, with a match specification of `-M
                     "L:|no="', a current word of  `nof'  and  completions  of
                     `foo',  this  option stores the string `nofoo' in the ar-
                     ray, whereas the -O option stores  the  `foo'  originally
                     given.

              -D array
                     As  with  -O, the completions are not added to the set of
                     matches.  Instead, whenever the nth completion  does  not
                     match, the nth element of the array is removed.  Elements
                     for which the corresponding completion  matches  are  re-
                     tained.  This option can be used more than once to remove
                     elements from multiple arrays.

              -C     This option adds a special match  which  expands  to  all
                     other  matches  when  inserted  into the line, even those
                     that are added after this option is used.  Together  with
                     the  -d  option  it  is possible to specify a string that
                     should be displayed in the list for this  special  match.
                     If  no string is given, it will be shown as a string con-
                     taining the strings that would be inserted for the  other
                     matches, truncated to the width of the screen.

              -E number
                     This option adds number empty matches after matching com-
                     pletions have been added.  An empty match takes up  space
                     in  completion listings but will never be inserted in the
                     line and can't be selected with menu completion  or  menu
                     selection.   This makes empty matches only useful to for-
                     mat completion lists and to make  explanatory  string  be
                     shown  in  completion  lists  (since empty matches can be
                     given display strings with the -d option).   And  because
                     all but one empty string would otherwise be removed, this
                     option implies the -V and -2 options (even if an explicit
                     -J option is given).  This can be important to note as it
                     affects the name space into which matches are added.

              -
              --     This flag ends the list of flags and options.  All  argu-
                     ments  after  it will be taken as the completions even if
                     they begin with hyphens.

              Except for the -M flag, if any of these flags is given more than
              once, the first one (and its argument) will be used.

       compset -p number
       compset -P [ number ] pattern
       compset -s number
       compset -S [ number ] pattern
       compset -n begin [ end ]
       compset -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
       compset -q
              This  command simplifies modification of the special parameters,
              while its return status allows tests on them to be carried out.

              The options are:

              -p number
                     If the value of the PREFIX parameter is at  least  number
                     characters  long, the first number characters are removed
                     from it and appended to the contents of the  IPREFIX  pa-
                     rameter.

              -P [ number ] pattern
                     If the value of the PREFIX parameter begins with anything
                     that matches the pattern, the matched portion is  removed
                     from PREFIX and appended to IPREFIX.

                     Without  the optional number, the longest match is taken,
                     but if number is given, anything up to the numberth match
                     is  moved.  If the number is negative, the numberth long-
                     est match is moved. For example, if PREFIX  contains  the
                     string  `a=b=c',  then  compset  -P  '*\='  will move the
                     string `a=b=' into the IPREFIX parameter, but compset  -P
                     1 '*\=' will move only the string `a='.

              -s number
                     As  -p,  but transfer the last number characters from the
                     value of SUFFIX to the front of the value of ISUFFIX.

              -S [ number ] pattern
                     As -P, but match the last portion of SUFFIX and  transfer
                     the matched portion to the front of the value of ISUFFIX.

              -n begin [ end ]
                     If  the current word position as specified by the parame-
                     ter CURRENT is greater than or equal to  begin,  anything
                     up  to  the  beginth word is removed from the words array
                     and the value of the parameter CURRENT is decremented  by
                     begin.

                     If  the  optional  end is given, the modification is done
                     only if the current word position is also  less  than  or
                     equal  to  end. In this case, the words from position end
                     onwards are also removed from the words array.

                     Both begin and end may be  negative  to  count  backwards
                     from the last element of the words array.

              -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
                     If  one of the elements of the words array before the one
                     at the index given by the value of the parameter  CURRENT
                     matches  the  pattern beg-pat, all elements up to and in-
                     cluding the matching one are removed from the words array
                     and  the value of CURRENT is changed to point to the same
                     word in the changed array.

                     If the optional pattern end-pat is also given, and  there
                     is  an  element in the words array matching this pattern,
                     the parameters are modified only if  the  index  of  this
                     word  is higher than the one given by the CURRENT parame-
                     ter (so that the matching word has to be after  the  cur-
                     sor).  In  this  case,  the  words  starting with the one
                     matching end-pat are also removed from the  words  array.
                     If  words  contains no word matching end-pat, the testing
                     and modification is performed as if it were not given.

              -q     The word currently being completed  is  split  on  spaces
                     into  separate  words, respecting the usual shell quoting
                     conventions.  The resulting words are stored in the words
                     array,  and CURRENT, PREFIX, SUFFIX, QIPREFIX, and QISUF-
                     FIX are modified to reflect the word part  that  is  com-
                     pleted.

              In  all  the  above  cases the return status is zero if the test
              succeeded and the parameters were modified and  non-zero  other-
              wise. This allows one to use this builtin in tests such as:

                     if compset -P '*\='; then ...

              This  forces anything up to and including the last equal sign to
              be ignored by the completion code.

       compcall [ -TD ]
              This allows the use of  completions  defined  with  the  compctl
              builtin  from  within  completion  widgets.  The list of matches
              will be generated as if one of the non-widget  completion  func-
              tions  (complete-word,  etc.)  had been called, except that only
              compctls given for specific commands are used. To force the code
              to  try completions defined with the -T option of compctl and/or
              the default completion (whether defined by  compctl  -D  or  the
              builtin  default)  in  the  appropriate places, the -T and/or -D
              flags can be passed to compcall.

              The return status can be used to test if a matching compctl def-
              inition  was  found.  It  is non-zero if a compctl was found and
              zero otherwise.

              Note that this builtin is defined by the zsh/compctl module.

COMPLETION CONDITION CODES
       The following additional condition codes for use within the [[  ...  ]]
       construct  are available in completion widgets.  These work on the spe-
       cial parameters.  All of these tests  can  also  be  performed  by  the
       compset builtin, but in the case of the condition codes the contents of
       the special parameters are not modified.

       -prefix [ number ] pattern
              true if the test for the -P option of compset would succeed.

       -suffix [ number ] pattern
              true if the test for the -S option of compset would succeed.

       -after beg-pat
              true if the test of the -N option with only  the  beg-pat  given
              would succeed.

       -between beg-pat end-pat
              true if the test for the -N option with both patterns would suc-
              ceed.

COMPLETION MATCHING CONTROL
       When the user invokes completion, the current word on the command  line
       (that  is,  the  word the cursor is currently on) is used to generate a
       match pattern.  Only those completions that match the pattern  are  of-
       fered to the user as matches.

       The default match pattern is generated from the current word by either

       •      appending  a `*' (matching any number of characters in a comple-
              tion) or,

       •      if the shell option COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set, inserting a `*'  at
              the cursor position.

       This  narrow  pattern  can  be broadened selectively by passing a match
       specification to the compadd builtin command through its -M option (see
       `Completion  Builtin  Commands' above).  A match specification consists
       of one or more matchers separated by whitespace.  Matchers in  a  match
       specification  are applied one at a time, from left to right.  Once all
       matchers have been applied, completions are compared to the final match
       pattern and non-matching ones are discarded.

       •      Note  that the -M option is ignored if the current word contains
              a glob pattern and the shell option GLOB_COMPLETE is set  or  if
              the pattern_match key of the special associative array compstate
              is set to a non-empty value (see `Completion Special Parameters'
              above).

       •      Users  of the completion system (see zshcompsys(1))  should gen-
              erally not use the  -M  option  directly,  but  rather  use  the
              matcher-list  and  matcher  styles  (see the subsection Standard
              Styles in the documentation for COMPLETION SYSTEM  CONFIGURATION
              in zshcompsys(1)).

       Each matcher consists of

       •      a case-sensitive letter

       •      a `:',

       •      one or more patterns separated by pipes (`|'),

       •      an equals sign (`='), and

       •      another pattern.

       The patterns before the `=' are used to match substrings of the current
       word.  For each matched substring, the corresponding part of the  match
       pattern is broadened with the pattern after the `=', by means of a log-
       ical OR.

       Each pattern in a matcher cosists of either

       •      the empty string or

       •      a sequence of

              •      literal characters (which may be quoted with a `\'),

              •      question marks (`?'),

              •      bracket expressions (`[...]'; see the subsection Glob Op-
                     erators  in  the documentation for GLOB OPERATORS in zsh-
                     expn(1)), and/or

              •      brace expressions (see below).

       Other shell patterns are not allowed.

       A brace expression, like a bracket expression, consists of a list of

       •      literal characters,

       •      ranges (`0-9'), and/or

       •      character classes (`[:name:]').

       However, they differ from each other as follows:

       •      A brace expression is delimited by a pair of braces (`{...}').

       •      Brace expressions do not support negations.  That is, an initial
              `!'  or  `^' has no special meaning and will be interpreted as a
              literal character.

       •      When a character in the current word matches the nth pattern  in
              a  brace expression, the corresponding part of the match pattern
              is broadened only with the nth pattern of the  brace  expression
              on  the  other  side of the `=', if there is one; if there is no
              brace expression on the other side, then  this  pattern  is  the
              empty string.  However, if either brace expression has more ele-
              ments than the other, then the excess  entries  are  simply  ig-
              nored.   When comparing indexes, each literal character or char-
              acter class counts as one element, but each range is instead ex-
              panded  to  the  full  list of literal characters it represents.
              Additionally, if on both sides of the `=', the  nth  pattern  is
              `[:upper:]'  or  `[:lower:]', then these are expanded as ranges,
              too.

       Note that, although the matching system does not yet  handle  multibyte
       characters,  this  is  likely  to  be a future extension.  Hence, using
       `[:upper:]' and `[:lower:]' is recommended over `A-Z' and `a-z'.

       Below are the different forms of matchers  supported.   Each  uppercase
       form  behaves exactly like its lowercase counterpart, but adds an addi-
       tional step after the match pattern has filtered out non-matching  com-
       pletions:   Each  of a match's substrings that was matched by a subpat-
       tern from an uppercase matcher is replaced with the corresponding  sub-
       string  of the current word.  However, patterns from lowercase matchers
       have higher weight:  If a substring of the current word was matched  by
       patterns  from both a lowercase and an uppercase matcher, then the low-
       ercase matcher's pattern wins and the corresponding part of  the  match
       is not modified.

       Unless   indicated   otherwise,   each   example  listed  assumes  COM-
       PLETE_IN_WORD to be unset (as it is by default).

       m:word-pat=match-pat
       M:word-pat=match-pat

              For each substring of the current word  that  matches  word-pat,
              broaden the corresponding part of the match pattern to addition-
              ally match match-pat.

              Examples:

                     m:{[:lower:]}={[:upper:]} lets any lower  case  character
                     in  the current word be completed to itself or its upper-
                     case counterpart.  So, the completions `foo',  `FOO'  and
                     `Foo' will are be considered matches for the word `fo'.

                     M:_=  inserts every underscore from the current word into
                     each match, in the same relative position, determined  by
                     matching  the  substrings around it.  So, given a comple-
                     tion `foo', the word `f_o' will be completed to the match
                     `f_oo',  even though the latter was not present as a com-
                     pletion.

       b:word-pat=match-pat
       B:word-pat=match-pat
       e:word-pat=match-pat
       E:word-pat=match-pat

              For each consecutive substring at the b:eginning or e:nd of  the
              current  word  that  matches word-pat, broaden the corresponding
              part of the match pattern to additionally match match-pat.

              Examples:

                     `b:-=+' lets any number of minuses at the  start  of  the
                     current word be completed to a minus or a plus.

                     `B:0='  adds  all  zeroes at the beginning of the current
                     word to the beginning of each match.

       l:|word-pat=match-pat
       L:|word-pat=match-pat
       R:word-pat|=match-pat
       r:word-pat|=match-pat

              If there is a substring at the l:eft or r:ight edge of the  cur-
              rent  word that matches word-pat, then broaden the corresponding
              part of the match pattern to additionally match match-pat.

              For each l:, L:, r: and R: matcher (including the  ones  below),
              the  pattern match-pat may also be a `*'.  This matches any num-
              ber of characters in a completion.

              Examples:

                     `r:|=*' appends a `*' to the  match  pattern,  even  when
                     COMPLETE_IN_WORD  is set and the cursor is not at the end
                     of the current word.

                     If the current word starts with  a  minus,  then  `L:|-='
                     will prepend it to each match.

       l:anchor|word-pat=match-pat
       L:anchor|word-pat=match-pat
       r:word-pat|anchor=match-pat
       R:word-pat|anchor=match-pat

              For each substring of the current word that matches word-pat and
              has on its l:eft or r:ight another  substring  matching  anchor,
              broaden the corresponding part of the match pattern to addition-
              ally match match-pat.

              Note that these matchers (and the ones below) modify  only  what
              is matched by word-pat; they do not change the matching behavior
              of what is matched by anchor (or coanchor; see the matchers  be-
              low).   Thus, unless its corresponding part of the match pattern
              has been modified, the anchor in the current word has  to  match
              literally  in  each completion, just like any other substring of
              the current word.

              If a matcher includes at least one anchor  (which  includes  the
              matchers  with  two  anchors, below), then match-pat may also be
              `*' or `**'.  `*' can match any part of a completion  that  does
              not  contain  any substrings matching anchor, whereas a `**' can
              match any part of a completion, period.  (Note that this is dif-
              ferent  from the behavior of `*' in the anchorless forms of `l:'
              and `r:' and and also different from `*' and `**'  in  glob  ex-
              pressions.)

              Examples:

                     `r:|.=*' makes the completion `comp.sources.unix' a match
                     for the word `..u' -- but not for the word `.u'.

                     Given a completion `--foo', the matcher `L:--|no-='  will
                     complete the word `--no-' to the match `--no-foo'.

       l:anchor||coanchor=match-pat
       L:anchor||coanchor=match-pat
       r:coanchor||anchor=match-pat
       R:coanchor||anchor=match-pat

              For  any  two  consecutive  substrings  of the current word that
              match anchor and coanchor, in the order given, insert  the  pat-
              tern  match-pat  between  their corresponding parts in the match
              pattern.

              Note that, unlike anchor, the pattern coanchor does  not  change
              what `*' can match.

              Examples:

                     `r:?||[[:upper:]]=*'  will complete the current word `fB'
                     to `fooBar', but it will not complete it  to  `fooHooBar'
                     (because  `*'  here cannot match anything that includes a
                     match for `[[:upper:]]), nor  will  it  complete  `B'  to
                     `fooBar'  (because  there  is no character in the current
                     word to match coanchor).

                     Given  the  current  word  `pass.n'  and   a   completion
                     `pass.byname',  the  matcher  `L:.||[[:alpha:]]=by'  will
                     produce the match `pass.name'.

       x:

              Ignore this matcher and all matchers to its right.

              This matcher is used to mark the end of a  match  specification.
              In  a  single  standalone list of matchers, this has no use, but
              where match specifications are concatenated,  as  is  often  the
              case  when  using  the completion system (see zshcompsys(1)), it
              can allow one match specification to override another.

COMPLETION WIDGET EXAMPLE
       The first step is to define the widget:

              zle -C complete complete-word complete-files

       Then the widget can be bound to a key using the  bindkey  builtin  com-
       mand:

              bindkey '^X\t' complete

       After that the shell function complete-files will be invoked after typ-
       ing control-X and TAB. The function should then generate  the  matches,
       e.g.:

              complete-files () { compadd - * }

       This function will complete files in the current directory matching the
       current word.

ZSHCOMPSYS(1)               General Commands Manual              ZSHCOMPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshcompsys - zsh completion system

DESCRIPTION
       This describes the shell code for the `new' completion system, referred
       to  as compsys.  It is written in shell functions based on the features
       described in zshcompwid(1).

       The features are contextual, sensitive to the point at which completion
       is started.  Many completions are already provided.  For this reason, a
       user can perform a great many tasks without knowing any details  beyond
       how  to  initialize the system, which is described below in INITIALIZA-
       TION.

       The context that decides what completion is to be performed may be
       •      an argument or option position: these describe the  position  on
              the  command line at which completion is requested.  For example
              `first argument to rmdir, the word being completed names  a  di-
              rectory';

       •      a  special  context,  denoting an element in the shell's syntax.
              For example `a word in  command  position'  or  `an  array  sub-
              script'.

       A  full  context specification contains other elements, as we shall de-
       scribe.

       Besides commands names and contexts, the system employs two  more  con-
       cepts,  styles  and tags.  These provide ways for the user to configure
       the system's behaviour.

       Tags play a dual role.  They serve as a classification system  for  the
       matches,  typically indicating a class of object that the user may need
       to distinguish.  For example, when completing arguments of the ls  com-
       mand  the  user  may prefer to try files before directories, so both of
       these are tags.  They also appear as the rightmost element in a context
       specification.

       Styles modify various operations of the completion system, such as out-
       put formatting, but also what kinds of completers are used (and in what
       order),  or  which  tags are examined.  Styles may accept arguments and
       are manipulated using the zstyle command described in zshmodules(1).

       In summary, tags describe what the completion objects  are,  and  style
       how they are to be completed.  At various points of execution, the com-
       pletion system checks what styles and/or tags are defined for the  cur-
       rent  context, and uses that to modify its behavior.  The full descrip-
       tion of context handling, which determines how tags and other  elements
       of the context influence the behaviour of styles, is described below in
       COMPLETION SYSTEM CONFIGURATION.

       When a completion is requested, a dispatcher function  is  called;  see
       the  description of _main_complete in the list of control functions be-
       low. This dispatcher decides which function should be called to produce
       the completions, and calls it. The result is passed to one or more com-
       pleters, functions that  implement  individual  completion  strategies:
       simple  completion, error correction, completion with error correction,
       menu selection, etc.

       More generally, the shell functions contained in the completion  system
       are of two types:
       •      those beginning `comp' are to be called directly; there are only
              a few of these;

       •      those beginning `_' are called  by  the  completion  code.   The
              shell  functions  of this set, which implement completion behav-
              iour and may be bound to keystrokes, are referred  to  as  `wid-
              gets'.  These proliferate as new completions are required.

INITIALIZATION
       If the system was installed completely, it should be enough to call the
       shell function compinit from your initialization  file;  see  the  next
       section.   However,  the  function  compinstall can be run by a user to
       configure various aspects of the completion system.

       Usually, compinstall will insert code into .zshrc, although if that  is
       not  writable  it will save it in another file and tell you that file's
       location.  Note that it is up to you to make sure that the lines  added
       to  .zshrc are actually run; you may, for example, need to move them to
       an earlier place in the file if .zshrc usually returns early.  So  long
       as you keep them all together (including the comment lines at the start
       and finish), you can rerun compinstall and it will correctly locate and
       modify  these lines.  Note, however, that any code you add to this sec-
       tion by hand is likely to be lost if you  rerun  compinstall,  although
       lines using the command `zstyle' should be gracefully handled.

       The  new  code  will  take effect next time you start the shell, or run
       .zshrc by hand; there is also an option to make them take effect  imme-
       diately.   However,  if  compinstall  has removed definitions, you will
       need to restart the shell to see the changes.

       To run compinstall you will need to make sure it is in a directory men-
       tioned in your fpath parameter, which should already be the case if zsh
       was properly configured as long as your startup files do not remove the
       appropriate  directories  from fpath.  Then it must be autoloaded (`au-
       toload -U compinstall' is recommended).  You can abort the installation
       any  time  you are being prompted for information, and your .zshrc will
       not be altered at all; changes only take place right at the end,  where
       you are specifically asked for confirmation.

   Use of compinit
       This section describes the use of compinit to initialize completion for
       the current session when called directly; if you have  run  compinstall
       it will be called automatically from your .zshrc.

       To  initialize  the system, the function compinit should be in a direc-
       tory mentioned in the fpath parameter, and should be  autoloaded  (`au-
       toload -U compinit' is recommended), and then run simply as `compinit'.
       This will define a few utility functions, arrange for all the necessary
       shell  functions  to be autoloaded, and will then re-define all widgets
       that do completion to use the new system.  If you use  the  menu-select
       widget,  which is part of the zsh/complist module, you should make sure
       that that module is loaded before the call to  compinit  so  that  that
       widget is also re-defined.  If completion styles (see below) are set up
       to perform expansion as well as completion by default, and the TAB  key
       is  bound  to  expand-or-complete,  compinit  will  rebind  it  to com-
       plete-word; this is necessary to use the correct form of expansion.

       Should you need to use the original completion commands, you can  still
       bind  keys  to  the old widgets by putting a `.' in front of the widget
       name, e.g. `.expand-or-complete'.

       To speed up the running of compinit, it can be made to produce a dumped
       configuration  that  will be read in on future invocations; this is the
       default, but can be turned off by calling compinit with the option  -D.
       The  dumped  file  is  .zcompdump  in the same directory as the startup
       files (i.e. $ZDOTDIR or $HOME); alternatively, an  explicit  file  name
       can  be  given  by  `compinit  -d  dumpfile'.   The  next invocation of
       compinit will read the dumped file instead of performing  a  full  ini-
       tialization.

       If the number of completion files changes, compinit will recognise this
       and produce a new dump file.  However, if the name of a function or the
       arguments in the first line of a #compdef function (as described below)
       change, it is easiest to delete the dump file by hand so that  compinit
       will  re-create it the next time it is run.  The check performed to see
       if there are new functions can be omitted by giving the option -C.   In
       this  case  the  dump  file will only be created if there isn't one al-
       ready.

       The dumping is actually done by another  function,  compdump,  but  you
       will  only  need  to  run this yourself if you change the configuration
       (e.g. using compdef) and then want to dump the new one.   The  name  of
       the old dumped file will be remembered for this purpose.

       If the parameter _compdir is set, compinit uses it as a directory where
       completion functions can be found; this is only necessary if  they  are
       not already in the function search path.

       For  security  reasons  compinit  also  checks if the completion system
       would use files not owned by root or by the current user, or  files  in
       directories  that are world- or group-writable or that are not owned by
       root or by the current user.  If such files or directories  are  found,
       compinit  will  ask if the completion system should really be used.  To
       avoid these tests and make all files found be used without asking,  use
       the  option -u, and to make compinit silently ignore all insecure files
       and directories use the option -i.  This security check is skipped  en-
       tirely when the -C option is given, provided the dumpfile exists.

       The  security  check can be retried at any time by running the function
       compaudit.  This is the same check used by compinit, but when it is ex-
       ecuted  directly any changes to fpath are made local to the function so
       they do not persist.  The directories to be checked may  be  passed  as
       arguments; if none are given, compaudit uses fpath and _compdir to find
       completion system directories, adding missing ones to fpath  as  neces-
       sary.   To  force a check of exactly the directories currently named in
       fpath, set _compdir to an empty  string  before  calling  compaudit  or
       compinit.

       The  function  bashcompinit provides compatibility with bash's program-
       mable completion system.  When run it will define the functions,  comp-
       gen  and  complete  which correspond to the bash builtins with the same
       names.  It will then be possible to use completion  specifications  and
       functions written for bash.

   Autoloaded files
       The convention for autoloaded functions used in completion is that they
       start with an underscore; as already mentioned, the fpath/FPATH parame-
       ter  must  contain  the directory in which they are stored.  If zsh was
       properly installed on your system, then fpath/FPATH automatically  con-
       tains the required directories for the standard functions.

       For  incomplete  installations,  if compinit does not find enough files
       beginning with an underscore (fewer than twenty) in the search path, it
       will  try  to  find more by adding the directory _compdir to the search
       path.  If that directory has a subdirectory named Base, all subdirecto-
       ries  will be added to the path.  Furthermore, if the subdirectory Base
       has a subdirectory named Core, compinit will add all subdirectories  of
       the  subdirectories to the path: this allows the functions to be in the
       same format as in the zsh source distribution.

       When compinit is  run,  it  searches  all  such  files  accessible  via
       fpath/FPATH and reads the first line of each of them.  This line should
       contain one of the tags described below.  Files whose first  line  does
       not  start  with one of these tags are not considered to be part of the
       completion system and will not be treated specially.

       The tags are:

       #compdef name ... [ -{p|P} pattern ... [ -N name ... ] ]
              The file will be made autoloadable and the function  defined  in
              it will be called when completing names, each of which is either
              the name of a command whose arguments are to be completed or one
              of  a number of special contexts in the form -context- described
              below.

              Each name may also be of the form `cmd=service'.  When  complet-
              ing  the  command  cmd, the function typically behaves as if the
              command (or special context) service  was  being  completed  in-
              stead.   This  provides a way of altering the behaviour of func-
              tions that can perform many different completions.  It is imple-
              mented  by setting the parameter $service when calling the func-
              tion; the function may choose to interpret this how  it  wishes,
              and simpler functions will probably ignore it.

              If  the  #compdef line contains one of the options -p or -P, the
              words following are taken to be patterns.  The function will  be
              called  when  completion  is  attempted for a command or context
              that matches one of the patterns.  The options  -p  and  -P  are
              used  to specify patterns to be tried before or after other com-
              pletions respectively.  Hence -P may be used to specify  default
              actions.

              The option -N is used after a list following -p or -P; it speci-
              fies that remaining words no longer define patterns.  It is pos-
              sible  to toggle between the three options as many times as nec-
              essary.

       #compdef -k style key-sequence ...
              This option creates a widget behaving like  the  builtin  widget
              style  and  binds  it  to  the given key-sequences, if any.  The
              style must be one of the builtin widgets  that  perform  comple-
              tion,  namely complete-word, delete-char-or-list, expand-or-com-
              plete, expand-or-complete-prefix,  list-choices,  menu-complete,
              menu-expand-or-complete,   or   reverse-menu-complete.   If  the
              zsh/complist module is loaded  (see  zshmodules(1))  the  widget
              menu-select is also available.

              When one of the key-sequences is typed, the function in the file
              will be invoked to generate the matches.  Note that a  key  will
              not  be  re-bound if it already was (that is, was bound to some-
              thing other than undefined-key).  The  widget  created  has  the
              same  name  as the file and can be bound to any other keys using
              bindkey as usual.

       #compdef -K widget-name style key-sequence [ name style seq ... ]
              This is similar to -k except that only one key-sequence argument
              may  be given for each widget-name style pair.  However, the en-
              tire set of three arguments may be repeated with a different set
              of  arguments.   Note in particular that the widget-name must be
              distinct in each set.  If it does not begin with `_'  this  will
              be added.  The widget-name should not clash with the name of any
              existing widget: names based on the name  of  the  function  are
              most useful.  For example,

                     #compdef -K _foo_complete complete-word "^X^C" \
                       _foo_list list-choices "^X^D"

              (all on one line) defines a widget _foo_complete for completion,
              bound to `^X^C', and a widget _foo_list for  listing,  bound  to
              `^X^D'.

       #autoload [ options ]
              Functions  with the #autoload tag are marked for autoloading but
              are not otherwise treated specially.  Typically they are  to  be
              called from within one of the completion functions.  Any options
              supplied will be passed to the autoload builtin; a  typical  use
              is +X to force the function to be loaded immediately.  Note that
              the -U and -z flags are always added implicitly.

       The # is part of the tag name and no white space is allowed  after  it.
       The  #compdef  tags  use the compdef function described below; the main
       difference is that the name of the function is supplied implicitly.

       The special contexts for which completion functions can be defined are:

       -array-value-
              The right hand side of an array-assignment (`name=(...)')

       -assign-parameter-
              The name of a parameter in an assignment, i.e. on the left  hand
              side of an `='

       -brace-parameter-
              The name of a parameter expansion within braces (`${...}')

       -command-
              A word in command position

       -condition-
              A word inside a condition (`[[...]]')

       -default-
              Any word for which no other completion is defined

       -equal-
              A word beginning with an equals sign

       -first-
              This  is  tried before any other completion function.  The func-
              tion called may set the _compskip parameter to  one  of  various
              values:  all:  no further completion is attempted; a string con-
              taining the substring patterns: no pattern completion  functions
              will  be  called;  a string containing default: the function for
              the `-default-' context will not be called,  but  functions  de-
              fined for commands will be.

       -math- Inside mathematical contexts, such as `((...))'

       -parameter-
              The name of a parameter expansion (`$...')

       -redirect-
              The word after a redirection operator.

       -subscript-
              The contents of a parameter subscript.

       -tilde-
              After  an initial tilde (`~'), but before the first slash in the
              word.

       -value-
              On the right hand side of an assignment.

       Default implementations are supplied for each of  these  contexts.   In
       most  cases  the  context  -context-  is implemented by a corresponding
       function _context, for example the context `-tilde-' and  the  function
       `_tilde').

       The contexts -redirect- and -value- allow extra context-specific infor-
       mation.  (Internally, this is handled by the functions for each context
       calling  the function _dispatch.)  The extra information is added sepa-
       rated by commas.

       For the -redirect- context, the extra information is in the form  `-re-
       direct-,op,command',  where  op is the redirection operator and command
       is the name of the command on the line.  If there is no command on  the
       line yet, the command field will be empty.

       For the -value- context, the form is `-value-,name,command', where name
       is the name of the parameter on the left hand side of  the  assignment.
       In  the  case  of  elements  of  an associative array, for example `as-
       soc=(key <TAB>', name is expanded to `name-key'.   In  certain  special
       contexts,  such  as  completing  after `make CFLAGS=', the command part
       gives the name of the command, here make; otherwise it is empty.

       It is not necessary to define fully specific completions as  the  func-
       tions  provided  will  try to generate completions by progressively re-
       placing the elements with `-default-'.  For  example,  when  completing
       after  `foo=<TAB>',  _value will try the names `-value-,foo,' (note the
       empty command part), `-value-,foo,-default-' and`-value-,-default-,-de-
       fault-',  in  that  order, until it finds a function to handle the con-
       text.

       As an example:

              compdef '_files -g "*.log"' '-redirect-,2>,-default-'

       completes files matching `*.log' after `2> <TAB>' for any command  with
       no more specific handler defined.

       Also:

              compdef _foo -value-,-default-,-default-

       specifies  that  _foo provides completions for the values of parameters
       for which no special function has been defined.  This is  usually  han-
       dled by the function _value itself.

       The same lookup rules are used when looking up styles (as described be-
       low); for example

              zstyle ':completion:*:*:-redirect-,2>,*:*' file-patterns '*.log'

       is another way to make  completion  after  `2>  <TAB>'  complete  files
       matching `*.log'.

   Functions
       The  following  function  is  defined by compinit and may be called di-
       rectly.

       compdef [ -ane ] function name ... [ -{p|P} pattern ... [ -N name ...]]
       compdef -d name ...
       compdef -k [ -an ] function style key-sequence [ key-sequence ... ]
       compdef -K [ -an ] function name style key-seq [ name style seq ... ]
              The first form defines the function to call  for  completion  in
              the given contexts as described for the #compdef tag above.

              Alternatively,  all  the  arguments  may have the form `cmd=ser-
              vice'.   Here  service  should  already  have  been  defined  by
              `cmd1=service' lines in #compdef files, as described above.  The
              argument for cmd will be completed in the same way as service.

              The function argument may alternatively be a  string  containing
              almost  any  shell  code.  If the string contains an equal sign,
              the above will take precedence.  The option -e may  be  used  to
              specify the first argument is to be evaluated as shell code even
              if it contains an equal sign.  The string will be executed using
              the eval builtin command to generate completions.  This provides
              a way of avoiding having to define a  new  completion  function.
              For  example,  to  complete files ending in `.h' as arguments to
              the command foo:

                     compdef '_files -g "*.h"' foo

              The option -n prevents any completions already defined  for  the
              command or context from being overwritten.

              The  option -d deletes any completion defined for the command or
              contexts listed.

              The names may also contain -p, -P and -N  options  as  described
              for  the #compdef tag.  The effect on the argument list is iden-
              tical, switching between  definitions  of  patterns  tried  ini-
              tially,  patterns  tried  finally,  and normal commands and con-
              texts.

              The parameter $_compskip may be set by any function defined  for
              a  pattern context.  If it is set to a value containing the sub-
              string `patterns' none of the pattern-functions will be  called;
              if it is set to a value containing the substring `all', no other
              function will be called.  Setting $_compskip in this  manner  is
              of particular utility when using the -p option, as otherwise the
              dispatcher will move on to additional functions (likely the  de-
              fault one) after calling the pattern-context one, which can man-
              gle the display of completion possibilities if not handled prop-
              erly.

              The  form  with  -k  defines  a widget with the same name as the
              function that will be called for each of the key-sequences; this
              is  like  the #compdef -k tag.  The function should generate the
              completions needed and will otherwise behave  like  the  builtin
              widget  whose  name is given as the style argument.  The widgets
              usable for this  are:  complete-word,  delete-char-or-list,  ex-
              pand-or-complete,    expand-or-complete-prefix,    list-choices,
              menu-complete,  menu-expand-or-complete,  and  reverse-menu-com-
              plete,  as  well  as  menu-select  if the zsh/complist module is
              loaded.  The option -n prevents the key being bound if it is al-
              ready to bound to something other than undefined-key.

              The  form  with -K is similar and defines multiple widgets based
              on the same function, each of which requires the  set  of  three
              arguments name, style and key-sequence, where the latter two are
              as for -k and the first must be a unique widget  name  beginning
              with an underscore.

              Wherever  applicable, the -a option makes the function autoload-
              able, equivalent to autoload -U function.

       The function compdef can be used to associate existing completion func-
       tions with new commands.  For example,

              compdef _pids foo

       uses the function _pids to complete process IDs for the command foo.

       Note  also the _gnu_generic function described below, which can be used
       to complete options for commands that understand the `--help' option.

COMPLETION SYSTEM CONFIGURATION
       This section gives a short overview of how the completion system works,
       and  then  more  detail on how users can configure how and when matches
       are generated.

   Overview
       When completion is attempted somewhere on the command line the  comple-
       tion system begins building the context.  The context represents every-
       thing that the shell knows about the meaning of the  command  line  and
       the  significance of the cursor position.  This takes account of a num-
       ber of things including the command word (such as `grep' or `zsh')  and
       options  to which the current word may be an argument (such as the `-o'
       option to zsh which takes a shell option as an argument).

       The context starts out very generic ("we are beginning  a  completion")
       and becomes more specific as more is learned ("the current word is in a
       position that is usually a command name" or "the current word might  be
       a  variable  name"  and so on).  Therefore the context will vary during
       the same call to the completion system.

       This context information is condensed into a string consisting of  mul-
       tiple  fields  separated by colons, referred to simply as `the context'
       in the remainder of the documentation.  Note that a user of the comple-
       tion  system rarely needs to compose a context string, unless for exam-
       ple a new function is being written to perform  completion  for  a  new
       command.   What a user may need to do is compose a style pattern, which
       is matched against a context when needed to look  up  context-sensitive
       options that configure the completion system.

       The  next  few  paragraphs explain how a context is composed within the
       completion function suite.  Following that is discussion of how  styles
       are  defined.  Styles determine such things as how the matches are gen-
       erated, similarly to shell options but with much  more  control.   They
       are defined with the zstyle builtin command (see zshmodules(1)).

       The  context string always consists of a fixed set of fields, separated
       by colons and with a leading colon before the first.  Fields which  are
       not yet known are left empty, but the surrounding colons appear anyway.
       The fields are always in the order  :completion:function:completer:com-
       mand:argument:tag.  These have the following meaning:

       •      The literal string completion, saying that this style is used by
              the completion system.   This  distinguishes  the  context  from
              those used by, for example, zle widgets and ZFTP functions.

       •      The function, if completion is called from a named widget rather
              than through the normal completion system.   Typically  this  is
              blank,  but  it is set by special widgets such as predict-on and
              the various functions in the Widget directory of  the  distribu-
              tion to the name of that function, often in an abbreviated form.

       •      The completer currently active, the name of the function without
              the leading underscore and with other underscores  converted  to
              hyphens.   A `completer' is in overall control of how completion
              is to be performed; `complete' is the simplest, but  other  com-
              pleters exist to perform related tasks such as correction, or to
              modify the behaviour of a  later  completer.   See  the  section
              `Control Functions' below for more information.

       •      The command or a special -context-, just at it appears following
              the #compdef tag or the compdef function.  Completion  functions
              for commands that have sub-commands usually modify this field to
              contain the name of the command followed by a minus sign and the
              sub-command.   For  example, the completion function for the cvs
              command sets this field to cvs-add when completing arguments  to
              the add subcommand.

       •      The  argument; this indicates which command line or option argu-
              ment we are completing.  For command  arguments  this  generally
              takes  the  form  argument-n, where n is the number of the argu-
              ment, and for arguments to options the form option-opt-n where n
              is  the  number of the argument to option opt.  However, this is
              only the case if  the  command  line  is  parsed  with  standard
              UNIX-style options and arguments, so many completions do not set
              this.

       •      The tag.  As described previously, tags are used to discriminate
              between  the types of matches a completion function can generate
              in a certain context.  Any completion function may use  any  tag
              name  it  likes, but a list of the more common ones is given be-
              low.

       The context is gradually put together as the  functions  are  executed,
       starting  with  the  main  entry point, which adds :completion: and the
       function element if necessary.  The completer then adds  the  completer
       element.   The  contextual completion adds the command and argument op-
       tions.  Finally, the tag is added when  the  types  of  completion  are
       known.  For example, the context name

              :completion::complete:dvips:option-o-1:files

       says  that normal completion was attempted as the first argument to the
       option -o of the command dvips:

              dvips -o ...

       and the completion function will generate filenames.

       Usually completion will be tried for all  possible  tags  in  an  order
       given  by the completion function.  However, this can be altered by us-
       ing the tag-order style.  Completion is then restricted to the list  of
       given tags in the given order.

       The  _complete_help  bindable  command  shows all the contexts and tags
       available for completion at a particular point.  This provides an  easy
       way  of  finding information for tag-order and other styles.  It is de-
       scribed in the section `Bindable Commands' below.

       When looking up styles the completion system uses full  context  names,
       including  the tag.  Looking up the value of a style therefore consists
       of two things: the context, which is matched to the most specific (best
       fitting)  pattern,  and  the  name  of  the style itself, which must be
       matched exactly.  The following examples demonstrate that patterns  may
       be loosely defined for styles that apply broadly, or as tightly defined
       as desired for styles that apply in narrower circumstances.

       For example, many completion functions can generate matches in a simple
       and  a  verbose  form  and  use  the verbose style to decide which form
       should be used.  To make all such functions use the verbose form, put

              zstyle ':completion:*' verbose yes

       in a startup file (probably .zshrc).  This gives the verbose style  the
       value  yes  in  every context inside the completion system, unless that
       context has a more specific definition.  It is best to avoid giving the
       pattern  as  `*' in case the style has some meaning outside the comple-
       tion system.

       Many such general purpose styles can be configured simply by using  the
       compinstall function.

       A  more specific example of the use of the verbose style is by the com-
       pletion for the kill builtin.  If the style is set, the  builtin  lists
       full  job  texts and process command lines; otherwise it shows the bare
       job numbers and PIDs.  To turn the style off for this use only:

              zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:*' verbose no

       For even more control, the style can use one  of  the  tags  `jobs'  or
       `processes'.  To turn off verbose display only for jobs:

              zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:jobs' verbose no

       The  -e option to zstyle even allows completion function code to appear
       as the argument to a style; this requires some understanding of the in-
       ternals of completion functions (see see zshcompwid(1))).  For example,

              zstyle -e ':completion:*' hosts 'reply=($myhosts)'

       This  forces  the value of the hosts style to be read from the variable
       myhosts each time a host name is needed; this is useful if the value of
       myhosts  can  change  dynamically.  For another useful example, see the
       example in the description of the file-list style below.  This form can
       be slow and should be avoided for commonly examined styles such as menu
       and list-rows-first.

       Note that the order in which styles are defined does  not  matter;  the
       style  mechanism uses the most specific possible match for a particular
       style to determine the set of values.  Strings are preferred over  pat-
       terns (for example, `:completion::complete:::foo' is more specific than
       `:completion::complete:::*'), and longer patterns  are  preferred  over
       the pattern `*'. See zmodules(1) for details.

       Context  patterns that use something other than a wildcard (*) to match
       the middle parts of the context -- the completer, command, and argument
       in  :completion:function:completer:command:argument:tag  --  should in-
       clude all six colons (:) explicitly. Without this, a  pattern  such  as
       :completion:*:foo:*  could match foo against a component other than the
       intended one (for example, against completer when a match against  com-
       mand was intended).

       Style  names like those of tags are arbitrary and depend on the comple-
       tion function.  However, the following two sections list  some  of  the
       most common tags and styles.

   Standard Tags
       Some  of  the following are only used when looking up particular styles
       and do not refer to a type of match.

       accounts
              used to look up the users-hosts style

       all-expansions
              used by the _expand completer when adding the single string con-
              taining all possible expansions

       all-files
              for  the  names of all files (as distinct from a particular sub-
              set, see the globbed-files tag).

       arguments
              for arguments to a command

       arrays for names of array parameters

       association-keys
              for keys of associative arrays; used when  completing  inside  a
              subscript to a parameter of this type

       bookmarks
              when  completing  bookmarks (e.g. for URLs and the zftp function
              suite)

       builtins
              for names of builtin commands

       characters
              for single characters in arguments of  commands  such  as  stty.
              Also  used  when  completing  character classes after an opening
              bracket

       colormapids
              for X colormap ids

       colors for color names

       commands
              for names of external commands.  Also used by  complex  commands
              such as cvs when completing names subcommands.

       contexts
              for contexts in arguments to the zstyle builtin command

       corrections
              used  by  the  _approximate and _correct completers for possible
              corrections

       cursors
              for cursor names used by X programs

       default
              used in some contexts to provide a way of  supplying  a  default
              when  more  specific tags are also valid.  Note that this tag is
              used when only the function field of the context name is set

       descriptions
              used when looking up the value of the format style  to  generate
              descriptions for types of matches

       devices
              for names of device special files

       directories
              for  names  of  directories -- local-directories is used instead
              when completing arguments of cd  and  related  builtin  commands
              when the cdpath array is set

       directory-stack
              for entries in the directory stack

       displays
              for X display names

       domains
              for network domains

       email-plugin
              for   email   addresses  from  the  `_email-plugin'  backend  of
              _email_addresses

       expansions
              used by the _expand completer for individual words  (as  opposed
              to  the complete set of expansions) resulting from the expansion
              of a word on the command line

       extensions
              for X server extensions

       file-descriptors
              for numbers of open file descriptors

       files  the generic file-matching tag used by functions completing file-
              names

       fonts  for X font names

       fstypes
              for file system types (e.g. for the mount command)

       functions
              names of functions -- normally shell functions, although certain
              commands may understand other kinds of function

       globbed-files
              for filenames when the name has been generated by pattern match-
              ing

       groups for names of user groups

       history-words
              for words from the history

       hosts  for hostnames

       indexes
              for array indexes

       interfaces
              for network interfaces

       jobs   for jobs (as listed by the `jobs' builtin)

       keymaps
              for names of zsh keymaps

       keysyms
              for names of X keysyms

       libraries
              for names of system libraries

       limits for system limits

       local-directories
              for  names of directories that are subdirectories of the current
              working directory when completing arguments of  cd  and  related
              builtin  commands  (compare path-directories) -- when the cdpath
              array is unset, directories is used instead

       mailboxes
              for e-mail folders

       manuals
              for names of manual pages

       maps   for map names (e.g. NIS maps)

       messages
              used to look up the format style for messages

       modifiers
              for names of X modifiers

       modules
              for modules (e.g. zsh modules)

       my-accounts
              used to look up the users-hosts style

       named-directories
              for named directories (you wouldn't  have  guessed  that,  would
              you?)

       names  for all kinds of names

       newsgroups
              for USENET groups

       nicknames
              for nicknames of NIS maps

       options
              for command options

       original
              used  by  the _approximate, _correct and _expand completers when
              offering the original string as a match

       other-accounts
              used to look up the users-hosts style

       packages
              for packages (e.g. rpm or installed Debian packages)

       parameters
              for names of parameters

       path-directories
              for names of directories found by  searching  the  cdpath  array
              when  completing  arguments  of  cd and related builtin commands
              (compare local-directories)

       paths  used to look up the values of the  expand,  ambiguous  and  spe-
              cial-dirs styles

       pods   for perl pods (documentation files)

       ports  for communication ports

       prefixes
              for prefixes (like those of a URL)

       printers
              for print queue names

       processes
              for process identifiers

       processes-names
              used  to  look up the command style when generating the names of
              processes for killall

       sequences
              for sequences (e.g. mh sequences)

       sessions
              for sessions in the zftp function suite

       signals
              for signal names

       strings
              for strings (e.g. the replacement strings  for  the  cd  builtin
              command)

       styles for styles used by the zstyle builtin command

       suffixes
              for filename extensions

       tags   for tags (e.g. rpm tags)

       targets
              for makefile targets

       time-zones
              for time zones (e.g. when setting the TZ parameter)

       types  for types of whatever (e.g. address types for the xhost command)

       urls   used to look up the urls and local styles when completing URLs

       users  for usernames

       values for one of a set of values in certain lists

       variant
              used  by _pick_variant to look up the command to run when deter-
              mining what program is installed for a particular command name.

       visuals
              for X visuals

       warnings
              used to look up the format style for warnings

       widgets
              for zsh widget names

       windows
              for IDs of X windows

       zsh-options
              for shell options

   Standard Styles
       Note that the values of several of these styles represent boolean  val-
       ues.   Any  of the strings `true', `on', `yes', and `1' can be used for
       the value `true' and any of the strings `false', `off', `no',  and  `0'
       for  the  value `false'.  The behavior for any other value is undefined
       except where explicitly mentioned.  The default  value  may  be  either
       `true' or `false' if the style is not set.

       Some  of  these  styles  are tested first for every possible tag corre-
       sponding to a type of match, and if no style was found, for the default
       tag.   The  most  notable styles of this type are menu, list-colors and
       styles  controlling  completion  listing  such   as   list-packed   and
       last-prompt.   When tested for the default tag, only the function field
       of the context will be set so that a style using the default  tag  will
       normally be defined along the lines of:

              zstyle ':completion:*:default' menu ...

       accept-exact
              This is tested for the default tag in addition to the tags valid
              for the current context.  If it is set to `true' and any of  the
              trial  matches  is  the  same as the string on the command line,
              this match will immediately be accepted (even if it would other-
              wise be considered ambiguous).

              When  completing  pathnames (where the tag used is `paths') this
              style accepts any number of patterns as the value in addition to
              the  boolean  values.   Pathnames matching one of these patterns
              will be accepted immediately even if the command  line  contains
              some more partially typed pathname components and these match no
              file under the directory accepted.

              This style is also used by the _expand completer  to  decide  if
              words  beginning  with  a tilde or parameter expansion should be
              expanded.  For example, if there are parameters foo and  foobar,
              the  string  `$foo' will only be expanded if accept-exact is set
              to `true'; otherwise the completion system will  be  allowed  to
              complete  $foo  to  $foobar.  If the style is set to `continue',
              _expand will add the expansion as a  match  and  the  completion
              system will also be allowed to continue.

       accept-exact-dirs
              This  is used by filename completion.  Unlike accept-exact it is
              a boolean.  By default, filename completion examines all  compo-
              nents  of  a path to see if there are completions of that compo-
              nent, even if the component matches an existing directory.   For
              example,  when completion after /usr/bin/, the function examines
              possible completions to /usr.

              When this style is `true', any prefix of a path that matches  an
              existing  directory  is accepted without any attempt to complete
              it further.  Hence, in the given example, the path /usr/bin/  is
              accepted immediately and completion tried in that directory.

              This style is also useful when completing after directories that
              magically appear when referenced, such as ZFS  .zfs  directories
              or  NetApp  .snapshot  directories.   When  the style is set the
              shell does not check for the existence of the  directory  within
              the parent directory.

              If  you  wish  to  inhibit  this  behaviour  entirely,  set  the
              path-completion style (see below) to `false'.

       add-space
              This style is used by the _expand completer.  If  it  is  `true'
              (the  default), a space will be inserted after all words result-
              ing from the expansion, or a slash  in  the  case  of  directory
              names.   If  the  value is `file', the completer will only add a
              space to names of existing files.  Either a  boolean  `true'  or
              the value `file' may be combined with `subst', in which case the
              completer will not add a space to words generated from  the  ex-
              pansion of a substitution of the form `$(...)' or `${...}'.

              The  _prefix completer uses this style as a simple boolean value
              to decide if a space should be inserted before the suffix.

       ambiguous
              This applies when completing non-final  components  of  filename
              paths,  in  other  words  those with a trailing slash.  If it is
              set, the cursor is left after  the  first  ambiguous  component,
              even  if  menu completion is in use.  The style is always tested
              with the paths tag.

       assign-list
              When completing after an equals sign that is being treated as an
              assignment,  the  completion  system normally completes only one
              filename.  In some cases the value  may be a list  of  filenames
              separated  by colons, as with PATH and similar parameters.  This
              style can be set to a list of patterns  matching  the  names  of
              such parameters.

              The  default  is to complete lists when the word on the line al-
              ready contains a colon.

       auto-description
              If set, this style's value will be used as the  description  for
              options  that are not described by the completion functions, but
              that have exactly one argument.  The sequence `%d' in the  value
              will  be replaced by the description for this argument.  Depend-
              ing on personal preferences, it may be useful to set this  style
              to  something  like  `specify: %d'.  Note that this may not work
              for some commands.

       avoid-completer
              This is used by the _all_matches  completer  to  decide  if  the
              string  consisting  of  all  matches should be added to the list
              currently being generated.  Its value is a list of names of com-
              pleters.  If any of these is the name of the completer that gen-
              erated the matches in this completion, the string  will  not  be
              added.

              The  default value for this style is `_expand _old_list _correct
              _approximate', i.e. it  contains  the  completers  for  which  a
              string with all matches will almost never be wanted.

       cache-path
              This  style  defines  the  path where any cache files containing
              dumped completion data  are  stored.   It  defaults  to  `$ZDOT-
              DIR/.zcompcache',  or `$HOME/.zcompcache' if $ZDOTDIR is not de-
              fined.  The  completion  cache  will  not  be  used  unless  the
              use-cache style is set.

       cache-policy
              This  style  defines the function that will be used to determine
              whether a cache  needs  rebuilding.   See  the  section  on  the
              _cache_invalid function below.

       call-command
              This style is used in the function for commands such as make and
              ant where calling the command directly to generate matches  suf-
              fers  problems such as being slow or, as in the case of make can
              potentially cause actions in the makefile to be executed. If  it
              is  set to `true' the command is called to generate matches. The
              default value of this style is `false'.

       command
              In many places, completion functions need to call external  com-
              mands  to  generate  the list of completions.  This style can be
              used to override the command that is called in some such  cases.
              The  elements of the value are joined with spaces to form a com-
              mand line to execute.  The value can also start with  a  hyphen,
              in  which  case the usual command will be added to the end; this
              is most useful for putting `builtin' or `command'  in  front  to
              make  sure  the  appropriate version of a command is called, for
              example to avoid calling a shell function with the same name  as
              an external command.

              As an example, the completion function for process IDs uses this
              style with the processes tag to generate the IDs to complete and
              the  list  of  processes  to  display  (if  the verbose style is
              `true').  The list produced by the command should look like  the
              output  of the ps command.  The first line is not displayed, but
              is searched for the string `PID' (or `pid') to find the position
              of the process IDs in the following lines.  If the line does not
              contain `PID', the first numbers in each of the other lines  are
              taken as the process IDs to complete.

              Note  that  the  completion  function  generally has to call the
              specified command for each attempt to  generate  the  completion
              list.   Hence care should be taken to specify only commands that
              take a short time to run, and in particular to  avoid  any  that
              may never terminate.

       command-path
              This  is  a  list  of directories to search for commands to com-
              plete.  The default for this style is the value of  the  special
              parameter path.

       commands
              This  is  used  by  the function completing sub-commands for the
              system initialisation scripts (residing in /etc/init.d or  some-
              where  not too far away from that).  Its values give the default
              commands to complete for those commands for which the completion
              function isn't able to find them out automatically.  The default
              for this style are the two strings `start' and `stop'.

       complete
              This is used by the _expand_alias function  when  invoked  as  a
              bindable  command.  If set to `true' and the word on the command
              line is not the name of an alias, matching alias names  will  be
              completed.

       complete-options
              This  is  used  by  the  completer for cd, chdir and pushd.  For
              these commands a - is used to introduce a directory stack  entry
              and  completion  of these is far more common than completing op-
              tions.  Hence unless the value of this style is  `true'  options
              will  not  be  completed,  even  after  an  initial -.  If it is
              `true', options will be completed  after  an  initial  -  unless
              there is a preceding -- on the command line.

       completer
              The  strings  given as the value of this style provide the names
              of the completer functions to use. The available completer func-
              tions are described in the section `Control Functions' below.

              Each  string may be either the name of a completer function or a
              string of the form `function:name'.  In the first case the  com-
              pleter  field  of  the context will contain the name of the com-
              pleter without the leading underscore and with all other  under-
              scores  replaced by hyphens.  In the second case the function is
              the name of the completer to call, but the context will  contain
              the user-defined name in the completer field of the context.  If
              the name starts with a hyphen, the string for the  context  will
              be build from the name of the completer function as in the first
              case with the name appended to it.  For example:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _complete:-foo

              Here, completion will call the _complete completer  twice,  once
              using  `complete' and once using `complete-foo' in the completer
              field of the context.  Normally, using the same  completer  more
              than  once  only makes sense when used with the `functions:name'
              form, because otherwise the context name will be the same in all
              calls to the completer; possible exceptions to this rule are the
              _ignored and _prefix completers.

              The default value for this style is `_complete  _ignored':  only
              completion  will be done, first using the ignored-patterns style
              and the $fignore array and then without ignoring matches.

       condition
              This style is used by the _list completer function to decide  if
              insertion  of matches should be delayed unconditionally. The de-
              fault is `true'.

       delimiters
              This style is used when adding a delimiter for use with  history
              modifiers  or glob qualifiers that have delimited arguments.  It
              is an array of preferred delimiters to add.  Non-special charac-
              ters are preferred as the completion system may otherwise become
              confused.  The default list is :, +, /, -, %.  The list  may  be
              empty to force a delimiter to be typed.

       disabled
              If  this is set to `true', the _expand_alias completer and bind-
              able command will try to expand disabled aliases, too.  The  de-
              fault is `false'.

       domains
              A  list  of names of network domains for completion.  If this is
              not set, domain names will  be  taken  from  the  file  /etc/re-
              solv.conf.

       environ
              The environ style is used when completing for `sudo'.  It is set
              to an array of `VAR=value' assignments to be exported  into  the
              local  environment  before the completion for the target command
              is invoked.
              zstyle ':completion:*:sudo::' environ \
                PATH="/sbin:/usr/sbin:$PATH" HOME="/root"

       expand This style is used when completing strings consisting of  multi-
              ple parts, such as path names.

              If one of its values is the string `prefix', the partially typed
              word from the line will be expanded as far as possible  even  if
              trailing parts cannot be completed.

              If  one of its values is the string `suffix', matching names for
              components after the first ambiguous one  will  also  be  added.
              This  means that the resulting string is the longest unambiguous
              string possible.  However, menu completion can be used to  cycle
              through all matches.

       extra-verbose
              If  set, the completion listing is more verbose at the cost of a
              probable decrease in completion speed.   Completion  performance
              will suffer if this style is set to `true'.

       fake   This  style may be set for any completion context.  It specifies
              additional strings that will always be completed  in  that  con-
              text.  The form of each string is `value:description'; the colon
              and description may be omitted, but any literal colons in  value
              must  be  quoted  with a backslash.  Any description provided is
              shown alongside the value in completion listings.

              It is important to use a sufficiently restrictive  context  when
              specifying  fake  strings.   Note that the styles fake-files and
              fake-parameters  provide  additional  features  when  completing
              files or parameters.

       fake-always
              This  works  identically  to  the fake style except that the ig-
              nored-patterns style is not applied to it.  This makes it possi-
              ble  to  override a set of matches completely by setting the ig-
              nored patterns to `*'.

              The following shows a way of supplementing any  tag  with  arbi-
              trary  data,  but  having  it behave for display purposes like a
              separate tag.  In this  example  we  use  the  features  of  the
              tag-order  style  to  divide  the named-directories tag into two
              when performing completion with the standard completer  complete
              for  arguments  of cd.  The tag named-directories-normal behaves
              as normal, but the tag named-directories-mine contains  a  fixed
              set  of  directories.   This  has the effect of adding the match
              group `extra directories' with the given completions.

                     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*' tag-order \
                       'named-directories:-mine:extra\ directories
                       named-directories:-normal:named\ directories *'
                     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
                       fake-always mydir1 mydir2
                     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
                       ignored-patterns '*'

       fake-files
              This style is used when completing files and looked up without a
              tag.   Its values are of the form `dir:names...'.  This will add
              the names (strings separated by spaces) as possible matches when
              completing  in  the  directory dir, even if no such files really
              exist.  The dir may be a pattern; pattern characters  or  colons
              in  dir  should  be quoted with a backslash to be treated liter-
              ally.

              This can be useful on systems that support special file  systems
              whose  top-level  pathnames  can not be listed or generated with
              glob patterns (but see accept-exact-dirs for a more general  way
              of dealing with this problem).  It can also be used for directo-
              ries for which one does not have read permission.

              The pattern form can be used to add a certain `magic'  entry  to
              all directories on a particular file system.

       fake-parameters
              This  is  used  by  the completion function for parameter names.
              Its values are names of parameters that might not yet be set but
              should be completed nonetheless.  Each name may also be followed
              by a colon and a string specifying the  type  of  the  parameter
              (like  `scalar',  `array'  or `integer').  If the type is given,
              the name will only be completed if parameters of that  type  are
              required  in the particular context.  Names for which no type is
              specified will always be completed.

       file-list
              This style controls whether files completed using  the  standard
              builtin  mechanism  are to be listed with a long list similar to
              ls -l.  Note that this feature uses the  shell  module  zsh/stat
              for file information; this loads the builtin stat which will re-
              place any external stat executable.  To avoid this the following
              code can be included in an initialization file:

                     zmodload -i zsh/stat
                     disable stat

              The style may either be set to a `true' value (or `all'), or one
              of the values `insert' or `list', indicating that files  are  to
              be  listed in long format in all circumstances, or when attempt-
              ing to insert a file name, or when listing  file  names  without
              attempting to insert one.

              More  generally,  the  value may be an array of any of the above
              values, optionally followed by =num.  If num is present it gives
              the  maximum number of matches for which long listing style will
              be used.  For example,

                     zstyle ':completion:*' file-list list=20 insert=10

              specifies that long format will be used when listing  up  to  20
              files  or  inserting  a  file  with up to 10 matches (assuming a
              listing is to be shown at all, for example on an ambiguous  com-
              pletion), else short format will be used.

                     zstyle -e ':completion:*' file-list \
                            '(( ${+NUMERIC} )) && reply=(true)'

              specifies that long format will be used any time a numeric argu-
              ment is supplied, else short format.

       file-patterns
              This is used by the standard function for completing  filenames,
              _files.   If  the  style  is unset up to three tags are offered,
              `globbed-files',`directories' and `all-files', depending on  the
              types of files  expected by the caller of _files.  The first two
              (`globbed-files' and `directories')  are  normally  offered  to-
              gether to make it easier to complete files in sub-directories.

              The  file-patterns  style  provides  alternatives to the default
              tags, which are not used.  Its value consists of elements of the
              form  `pattern:tag';  each string may contain any number of such
              specifications separated by spaces.

              The pattern is a pattern that is to be used  to  generate  file-
              names.   Any  occurrence of the sequence `%p' is replaced by any
              pattern(s) passed by the function calling _files.  Colons in the
              pattern  must  be  preceded  by a backslash to make them distin-
              guishable from the colon before the tag.  If more than one  pat-
              tern  is  needed, the patterns can be given inside braces, sepa-
              rated by commas.

              The tags of all strings in the value will be offered  by  _files
              and  used  when  looking  up other styles.  Any tags in the same
              word will be offered at the same time and  before  later  words.
              If no `:tag' is given the `files' tag will be used.

              The  tag  may also be followed by an optional second colon and a
              description, which will be used for the `%d' in the value of the
              format style (if that is set) instead of the default description
              supplied by the completion function.  The  inclusion  of  a  de-
              scription  also  gives  precedence to associated options such as
              for completion grouping so it can be used where files should  be
              separated.

              For example, to make the rm command first complete only names of
              object files and then the names of all  files  if  there  is  no
              matching object file:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:rm:*:*' file-patterns \
                         '*.o:object-files' '%p:all-files'

              To alter the default behaviour of file completion -- offer files
              matching a pattern and directories on the  first  attempt,  then
              all  files -- to offer only matching files on the first attempt,
              then directories, and finally all files:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' file-patterns \
                         '%p:globbed-files' '*(-/):directories' '*:all-files'

              This works even  where  there  is  no  special  pattern:  _files
              matches  all  files  using the pattern `*' at the first step and
              stops when it sees this pattern.  Note also it will never try  a
              pattern more than once for a single completion attempt.

              To separate directories into a separate group from the files but
              still complete them at the first attempt, a description needs to
              be  given.  Note that directories need to be explicitly excluded
              from the globbed-files because `*' will match  directories.  For
              grouping, it is also necessary to set the group-name style.

                     zstyle ':completion:*' file-patterns \
                         '%p(^-/):globbed-files *(-/):directories:location'

              During  the execution of completion functions, the EXTENDED_GLOB
              option is in effect, so the characters `#',  `~'  and  `^'  have
              special meanings in the patterns.

       file-sort
              The  standard filename completion function uses this style with-
              out a tag to determine  in  which  order  the  names  should  be
              listed;  menu completion will cycle through them in the same or-
              der.  The possible values are: `size' to sort by the size of the
              file; `links' to sort by the number of links to the file; `modi-
              fication' (or `time' or `date') to sort by the last modification
              time;  `access' to sort by the last access time; and `inode' (or
              `change') to sort by the last inode change time.  If  the  style
              is set to any other value, or is unset, files will be sorted al-
              phabetically by name.  If the value  contains  the  string  `re-
              verse',  sorting  is  done  in the opposite order.  If the value
              contains the string `follow', timestamps are associated with the
              targets  of symbolic links; the default is to use the timestamps
              of the links themselves.

       file-split-chars
              A set of characters that will cause all file completions for the
              given  context to be split at the point where any of the charac-
              ters occurs.  A typical use is to set the style to :;  then  ev-
              erything  up to and including the last : in the string so far is
              ignored when completing files.  As this is  quite  heavy-handed,
              it is usually preferable to update completion functions for con-
              texts where this behaviour is useful.

       filter The ldap plugin of  email  address  completion  (see  _email_ad-
              dresses)  uses  this  style  to  specify the attributes to match
              against when filtering entries.  So for example, if the style is
              set  to  `sn', matching is done against surnames.  Standard LDAP
              filtering is used so normal completion matching is bypassed.  If
              this style is not set, the LDAP plugin is skipped.  You may also
              need to set the command style to specify how to connect to  your
              LDAP server.

       force-list
              This forces a list of completions to be shown at any point where
              listing is done, even in cases where the list would  usually  be
              suppressed.   For  example,  normally  the list is only shown if
              there are at least two different matches.  By setting this style
              to  `always',  the  list  will always be shown, even if there is
              only a single match that  will  immediately  be  accepted.   The
              style  may  also be set to a number.  In this case the list will
              be shown if there are at least that many matches, even  if  they
              would all insert the same string.

              This style is tested for the default tag as well as for each tag
              valid for the current completion.   Hence  the  listing  can  be
              forced only for certain types of match.

       format If  this is set for the descriptions tag, its value is used as a
              string to display above matches in completion  lists.   The  se-
              quence  `%d'  in  this  string will be replaced with a short de-
              scription of what these matches are.  This string may also  con-
              tain  the  output  attribute  sequences understood by compadd -X
              (see zshcompwid(1)).

              The style is tested with each tag valid for the current  comple-
              tion  before  it is tested for the descriptions tag.  Hence dif-
              ferent format strings can be  defined  for  different  types  of
              match.

              Note  also  that  some  completer  functions  define  additional
              `%'-sequences.  These are described for the completer  functions
              that make use of them.

              Some  completion  functions  display  messages  that may be cus-
              tomised by setting this style for the messages tag.   Here,  the
              `%d'  is  replaced  with a message given by the completion func-
              tion.

              Finally, the format string is looked up with the  warnings  tag,
              for use when no matches could be generated at all.  In this case
              the `%d' is replaced with the descriptions for the matches  that
              were  expected  separated  by  spaces.  The sequence `%D' is re-
              placed with the same descriptions separated by newlines.

              It is possible to use printf-style field width  specifiers  with
              `%d' and similar escape sequences.  This is handled by the zfor-
              mat builtin command  from  the  zsh/zutil  module,  see  zshmod-
              ules(1).

       gain-privileges
              If set to true, this style enables the use of commands like sudo
              or doas to gain extra privileges when retrieving information for
              completion.  This  is  only done when a command such as sudo ap-
              pears on the command-line. To force the use of, e.g. sudo or  to
              override  any prefix that might be added due to gain-privileges,
              the command style can be used with a value that  begins  with  a
              hyphen.

       glob   This  is  used by the _expand completer.  If it is set to `true'
              (the default), globbing will be attempted on the words resulting
              from  a previous substitution (see the substitute style) or else
              the original string from the line.

       global If this is set to `true' (the default), the  _expand_alias  com-
              pleter and bindable command will try to expand global aliases.

       group-name
              The  completion  system  can  group  different types of matches,
              which appear in separate lists.  This style can be used to  give
              the  names  of groups for particular tags.  For example, in com-
              mand position the completion system generates names  of  builtin
              and external commands, names of aliases, shell functions and pa-
              rameters and reserved words as possible  completions.   To  have
              the external commands and shell functions listed separately:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:commands' \
                            group-name commands
                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:functions' \
                            group-name functions

              As  a consequence, any match with the same tag will be displayed
              in the same group.

              If the name given is the empty string the name of  the  tag  for
              the  matches will be used as the name of the group.  So, to have
              all different types of matches  displayed  separately,  one  can
              just set:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' group-name ''

              All  matches for which no group name is defined will be put in a
              group named -default-.

              To display the group name in the output, see  the  format  style
              (q.v.)  under the descriptions tag.

       group-order
              This  style is additional to the group-name style to specify the
              order for display of the groups defined by that  style  (compare
              tag-order,  which  determines  which completions appear at all).
              The groups named are shown in the given order; any other  groups
              are shown in the order defined by the completion function.

              For  example, to have names of builtin commands, shell functions
              and external commands appear in that order  when  completing  in
              command position:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:*' group-order \
                            builtins functions commands

       groups A list of names of UNIX groups.  If this is not set, group names
              are taken from the YP database or the file `/etc/group'.

       hidden If this is set to `true', matches for the given context will not
              be listed, although any description for the matches set with the
              format style will be shown.  If it is set to `all', not even the
              description will be displayed.

              Note that the matches will still be completed; they are just not
              shown in the list.  To avoid having matches considered as possi-
              ble  completions  at all, the tag-order style can be modified as
              described below.

       hosts  A list of names of hosts that should be completed.  If  this  is
              not set, hostnames are taken from the file `/etc/hosts'.

       hosts-ports
              This style is used by commands that need or accept hostnames and
              network ports.  The strings in the value should be of  the  form
              `host:port'.   Valid  ports  are  determined  by the presence of
              hostnames; multiple ports for the same host may appear.

       ignore-line
              This is tested for each tag valid for  the  current  completion.
              If  it  is  set to `true', none of the words that are already on
              the line will be considered as possible completions.  If  it  is
              set  to `current', the word the cursor is on will not be consid-
              ered as a possible completion.   The  value  `current-shown'  is
              similar but only applies if the list of completions is currently
              shown on the screen.  Finally, if the style is set  to  `other',
              all  words  on  the  line except for the current one will be ex-
              cluded from the possible completions.

              The values `current' and `current-shown' are a bit like the  op-
              posite  of  the  accept-exact  style:  only strings with missing
              characters will be completed.

              Note that you almost certainly don't want to set this to  `true'
              or  `other' for a general context such as `:completion:*'.  This
              is because it would disallow completion of, for example, options
              multiple  times  even if the command in question accepts the op-
              tion more than once.

       ignore-parents
              The style is tested without a tag  by  the  function  completing
              pathnames  in  order to determine whether to ignore the names of
              directories already mentioned in the current word, or  the  name
              of the current working directory.  The value must include one or
              both of the following strings:

              parent The name of any directory whose path is already contained
                     in  the  word  on the line is ignored.  For example, when
                     completing after foo/../, the directory foo will  not  be
                     considered a valid completion.

              pwd    The  name  of  the  current working directory will not be
                     completed; hence, for example, completion after ../  will
                     not use the name of the current directory.

              In addition, the value may include one or both of:

              ..     Ignore  the  specified  directories only when the word on
                     the line contains the substring `../'.

              directory
                     Ignore the specified directories only when names  of  di-
                     rectories  are  completed,  not  when completing names of
                     files.

              Excluded values act in a similar fashion to values  of  the  ig-
              nored-patterns  style,  so they can be restored to consideration
              by the _ignored completer.

       ignored-patterns
              A list of patterns; any trial completion  matching  one  of  the
              patterns will be excluded from consideration.  The _ignored com-
              pleter can appear in the list of completers to restore  the  ig-
              nored matches.  This is a more configurable version of the shell
              parameter $fignore.

              Note that the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set during  the  execution
              of completion functions, so the characters `#', `~' and `^' have
              special meanings in the patterns.

       insert This style is used  by  the  _all_matches  completer  to  decide
              whether  to  insert  the list of all matches unconditionally in-
              stead of adding the list as another match.

       insert-ids
              When completing process IDs, for example  as  arguments  to  the
              kill and wait builtins the name of a command may be converted to
              the appropriate process ID.  A problem arises when  the  process
              name  typed  is not unique.  By default (or if this style is set
              explicitly to `menu') the name will be converted immediately  to
              a  set  of  possible IDs, and menu completion will be started to
              cycle through them.

              If the value of the style is `single', the shell will wait until
              the user has typed enough to make the command unique before con-
              verting the name to an ID; attempts at completion will be unsuc-
              cessful  until  that  point.   If the value is any other string,
              menu completion will be started when the  string  typed  by  the
              user is longer than the common prefix to the corresponding IDs.

       insert-sections
              This  style  is used with tags of the form `manuals.X' when com-
              pleting names of manual pages. If set and the X in the tag  name
              matches the section number of the page being completed, the sec-
              tion number is inserted along with the page name.  For  example,
              given

                     zstyle ':completion:*:manuals.*' insert-sections true

              man ssh_<TAB> may be completed to man 5 ssh_config.

              The  value  may  also  be  set to one of `prepend', or `suffix'.
              `prepend' behaves the same as `true' as in  the  above  example,
              while `suffix' would complete man ssh_<TAB> as man ssh_config.5.

              This is especially useful in conjunction with separate-sections,
              as it ensures that the page requested of man corresponds to  the
              one  displayed in the completion listing when there are multiple
              pages with the same name (e.g., printf(1) and printf(3)).

              The default for this style is `false'.

       insert-tab
              If this is set to `true', the completion system  will  insert  a
              TAB  character  (assuming that was used to start completion) in-
              stead of performing completion when there is no non-blank  char-
              acter  to the left of the cursor.  If it is set to `false', com-
              pletion will be done even there.

              The value may also contain the substrings  `pending'  or  `pend-
              ing=val'.   In  this  case, the typed character will be inserted
              instead of starting completion when there is  unprocessed  input
              pending.   If  a  val  is  given, completion will not be done if
              there are at least that many characters  of  unprocessed  input.
              This  is  often  useful when pasting characters into a terminal.
              Note however, that it relies on the $PENDING  special  parameter
              from  the zsh/zle module being set properly which is not guaran-
              teed on all platforms.

              The default value of this style is `true' except for  completion
              within vared builtin command where it is `false'.

       insert-unambiguous
              This  is  used by the _match and _approximate completers.  These
              completers are often used with menu completion  since  the  word
              typed may bear little resemblance to the final completion.  How-
              ever, if this style is `true', the  completer  will  start  menu
              completion  only  if it could find no unambiguous initial string
              at least as long as the original string typed by the user.

              In the case of the _approximate completer, the  completer  field
              in  the context will already have been set to one of correct-num
              or approximate-num, where num is the number of errors that  were
              accepted.

              In  the  case of the _match completer, the style may also be set
              to the string `pattern'.  Then the pattern on the line  is  left
              unchanged if it does not match unambiguously.

       keep-prefix
              This  style  is used by the _expand completer.  If it is `true',
              the completer will try to keep a prefix containing  a  tilde  or
              parameter  expansion.   Hence,  for  example,  the string `~/f*'
              would be expanded to `~/foo' instead  of  `/home/user/foo'.   If
              the  style  is  set  to `changed' (the default), the prefix will
              only be left unchanged if there were other changes  between  the
              expanded words and the original word from the command line.  Any
              other value forces the prefix to be expanded unconditionally.

              The behaviour of _expand when this style is `true' is  to  cause
              _expand  to  give  up  when a single expansion with the restored
              prefix is the same as the original;  hence  any  remaining  com-
              pleters may be called.

       known-hosts-files
              This  style  should  contain  a list of files to search for host
              names and (if the use-ip style is set) IP addresses in a  format
              compatible  with  ssh  known_hosts files.  If it is not set, the
              files /etc/ssh/ssh_known_hosts and ~/.ssh/known_hosts are used.

       last-prompt
              This is a more flexible form of the  ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT  option.
              If  it  is  `true', the completion system will try to return the
              cursor to the previous command line after displaying  a  comple-
              tion list.  It is tested for all tags valid for the current com-
              pletion, then the default tag.  The cursor will be moved back to
              the  previous  line  if  this  style  is `true' for all types of
              match.  Note that unlike the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option  this  is
              independent of the numeric argument.

       list   This  style  is used by the _history_complete_word bindable com-
              mand.  If it is set to `true' it has no effect.  If it is set to
              `false'  matches will not be listed.  This overrides the setting
              of the options  controlling  listing  behaviour,  in  particular
              AUTO_LIST.   The  context  always  starts with `:completion:his-
              tory-words'.

       list-colors
              If the zsh/complist module is loaded, this style can be used  to
              set  color  specifications.   This mechanism replaces the use of
              the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters described in the  sec-
              tion  `The zsh/complist Module' in zshmodules(1), but the syntax
              is the same.

              If this style is set for the default tag,  the  strings  in  the
              value  are  taken  as  specifications that are to be used every-
              where.  If it is set for other tags, the specifications are used
              only  for matches of the type described by the tag.  For this to
              work best, the group-name style must be set to an empty string.

              In addition to setting styles for specific tags, it is also pos-
              sible  to use group names specified explicitly by the group-name
              tag together with the `(group)' syntax allowed by the ZLS_COLORS
              and ZLS_COLOURS parameters and simply using the default tag.

              It  is  possible  to use any color specifications already set up
              for the GNU version of the ls command:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:default' list-colors \
                            ${(s.:.)LS_COLORS}

              The default colors are the same as for the GNU  ls  command  and
              can  be  obtained  by setting the style to an empty string (i.e.
              '').

       list-dirs-first
              This is used by file completion and corresponds to a  particular
              setting  of the file-patterns style.  If set, the default direc-
              tories to be completed are listed  separately  from  and  before
              completion for other files.

       list-grouped
              If  this  style  is  `true' (the default), the completion system
              will try to make certain completion  listings  more  compact  by
              grouping  matches.   For example, options for commands that have
              the same description (shown when the verbose  style  is  set  to
              `true')  will appear as a single entry.  However, menu selection
              can be used to cycle through all the matches.

       list-packed
              This is tested for each tag valid in the current context as well
              as  the  default tag.  If it is set to `true', the corresponding
              matches appear in listings as if  the  LIST_PACKED  option  were
              set.  If it is set to `false', they are listed normally.

       list-prompt
              If  this style is set for the default tag, completion lists that
              don't fit on the screen can be scrolled (see the description  of
              the  zsh/complist  module  in zshmodules(1)).  The value, if not
              the empty string, will be displayed after  every  screenful  and
              the  shell  will  prompt for a key press; if the style is set to
              the empty string, a default prompt will be used.

              The value may contain the escape sequences: `%l' or `%L',  which
              will  be  replaced  by the number of the last line displayed and
              the total number of lines; `%m' or `%M', the number of the  last
              match  shown and the total number of matches; and `%p' and `%P',
              `Top' when at the beginning of the list, `Bottom'  when  at  the
              end  and  the position shown as a percentage of the total length
              otherwise.  In each case the form with the uppercase letter will
              be  replaced  by  a  string of fixed width, padded to the  right
              with spaces, while the lowercase form  will  be  replaced  by  a
              variable  width  string.  As in other prompt strings, the escape
              sequences `%S', `%s', `%B', `%b', `%U', `%u'  for  entering  and
              leaving  the  display  modes  standout,  bold and underline, and
              `%F', `%f', `%K', `%k' for changing  the  foreground  background
              colour, are also available, as is the form `%{...%}' for enclos-
              ing escape sequences which display with zero (or, with a numeric
              argument, some other) width.

              After deleting this prompt the variable LISTPROMPT should be un-
              set for the removal to take effect.

       list-rows-first
              This style is tested in the same way as  the  list-packed  style
              and  determines whether matches are to be listed in a rows-first
              fashion as if the LIST_ROWS_FIRST option were set.

       list-separator
              The value of this style is used in completion listing  to  sepa-
              rate  the  string  to  complete from a description when possible
              (e.g. when completing options).  It defaults to  `--'  (two  hy-
              phens).

       list-suffixes
              This style is used by the function that completes filenames.  If
              it is `true', and completion is attempted on a string containing
              multiple partially typed pathname components, all ambiguous com-
              ponents will be shown.  Otherwise, completion stops at the first
              ambiguous component.

       local  This  is for use with functions that complete URLs for which the
              corresponding files are available directly from the file system.
              Its  value should consist of three strings: a hostname, the path
              to the default web pages for the server, and the directory  name
              used by a user placing web pages within their home area.

              For example:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' local toast \
                         /var/http/public/toast public_html

              Completion  after  `http://toast/stuff/'  will look for files in
              the directory  /var/http/public/toast/stuff,   while  completion
              after  `http://toast/~yousir/' will look for files in the direc-
              tory ~yousir/public_html.

       mail-directory
              If set, zsh will assume that mailbox files can be found  in  the
              directory specified.  It defaults to `~/Mail'.

       match-original
              This  is  used  by  the _match completer.  If it is set to only,
              _match will try to generate matches without inserting a  `*'  at
              the  cursor  position.   If set to any other non-empty value, it
              will first try to generate matches without inserting the `*' and
              if  that  yields  no matches, it will try again with the `*' in-
              serted.  If it is unset or set to  the  empty  string,  matching
              will only be performed with the `*' inserted.

       matcher
              This  style  is tested separately for each tag valid in the cur-
              rent context.  Its value is placed before any  match  specifica-
              tions  given  by the matcher-list style so can override them via
              the use of an x: specification.  The value should be in the form
              described  in  the section `Completion Matching Control' in zsh-
              compwid(1).  For examples of this, see the  description  of  the
              tag-order style.

              For  notes comparing the use of this and the matcher-list style,
              see under the description of the tag-order style.

       matcher-list
              This style can be set to a list of match specifications that are
              to  be applied everywhere. Match specifications are described in
              the section `Completion Matching Control' in zshcompwid(1).  The
              completion  system will try them one after another for each com-
              pleter selected.  For example, to try  first  simple  completion
              and, if that generates no matches, case-insensitive completion:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

              By  default  each  specification replaces the previous one; how-
              ever, if a specification is prefixed with +, it is added to  the
              existing list.  Hence it is possible to create increasingly gen-
              eral specifications without repetition:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list \
                            '' '+m:{a-z}={A-Z}' '+m:{A-Z}={a-z}'

              It is possible to create match specifications valid for particu-
              lar  completers  by  using the third field of the context.  This
              applies  only   to   completers   that   override   the   global
              matcher-list, which as of this writing includes only _prefix and
              _ignored.  For example, to  use  the  completers  _complete  and
              _prefix  but  allow  case-insensitive completion only with _com-
              plete:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _prefix
                     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*:*:*' matcher-list \
                            '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

              User-defined names, as explained for the  completer  style,  are
              available.   This  makes  it  possible to try the same completer
              more than once with different match  specifications  each  time.
              For example, to try normal completion without a match specifica-
              tion, then normal  completion  with  case-insensitive  matching,
              then correction, and finally partial-word completion:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
                         _complete _correct _complete:foo
                     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*:*:*' matcher-list \
                         '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'
                     zstyle ':completion:*:foo:*:*:*' matcher-list \
                         'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z} r:|[-_./]=* r:|=*'

              If  the  style is unset in any context no match specification is
              applied.  Note also that some completers such  as  _correct  and
              _approximate  do not use the match specifications at all, though
              these completers will only ever  be  called  once  even  if  the
              matcher-list contains more than one element.

              Where  multiple  specifications are useful, note that the entire
              completion is done for each element of matcher-list,  which  can
              quickly  reduce  the  shell's  performance.   As a rough rule of
              thumb, one to three strings will  give  acceptable  performance.
              On  the other hand, putting multiple space-separated values into
              the same string does not have an appreciable impact  on  perfor-
              mance.

              If  there  is  no current matcher or it is empty, and the option
              NO_CASE_GLOB is in effect, the matching for files  is  performed
              case-insensitively  in  any case.  However, any matcher must ex-
              plicitly specify case-insensitive matching if that is required.

              For notes comparing the use of this and the matcher  style,  see
              under the description of the tag-order style.

       max-errors
              This  is  used  by the _approximate and _correct completer func-
              tions to determine the maximum number of errors to  allow.   The
              completer will try to generate completions by first allowing one
              error, then two errors, and so  on,  until  either  a  match  or
              matches were found or the maximum number of errors given by this
              style has been reached.

              If the value for this style contains the string  `numeric',  the
              completer function will take any numeric argument as the maximum
              number of errors allowed. For example, with

                     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 2 numeric

              two errors are allowed if no numeric argument is given, but with
              a  numeric argument of six (as in `ESC-6 TAB'), up to six errors
              are accepted.  Hence with a value of `0 numeric', no  correcting
              completion will be attempted unless a numeric argument is given.

              If  the  value  contains the string `not-numeric', the completer
              will not try to generate corrected completions when given a  nu-
              meric  argument,  so  in  this  case  the number given should be
              greater than zero.  For example, `2 not-numeric' specifies  that
              correcting completion with two errors will usually be performed,
              but if a numeric argument is given, correcting  completion  will
              not be performed.

              The default value for this style is `2 numeric'.

       max-matches-width
              This  style is used to determine the trade off between the width
              of the display used for matches and the width used for their de-
              scriptions when the verbose style is in effect.  The value gives
              the number of display columns to reserve for the  matches.   The
              default is half the width of the screen.

              This  has the most impact when several matches have the same de-
              scription and so will be grouped together.  Increasing the style
              will  allow  more  matches to be grouped together; decreasing it
              will allow more of the description to be visible.

       menu   If this is `true' in the context of any of the tags defined  for
              the  current completion menu completion will be used.  The value
              for a specific tag will take precedence over that for  the  `de-
              fault' tag.

              If  none  of the values found in this way is `true' but at least
              one is set to `auto', the shell behaves as if the AUTO_MENU  op-
              tion is set.

              If  one of the values is explicitly set to `false', menu comple-
              tion will be explicitly turned off, overriding the MENU_COMPLETE
              option and other settings.

              In the form `yes=num', where `yes' may be any of the `true' val-
              ues (`yes', `true', `on'  and  `1'),  menu  completion  will  be
              turned  on  if  there  are  at  least  num matches.  In the form
              `yes=long', menu completion will be turned on if the  list  does
              not  fit  on the screen.  This does not activate menu completion
              if the widget normally only lists completions, but menu  comple-
              tion   can   be   activated   in   that   case  with  the  value
              `yes=long-list' (Typically,  the  value  `select=long-list'  de-
              scribed  later  is  more  useful  as  it  provides  control over
              scrolling.)

              Similarly, with any of the `false' values (as in `no=10'),  menu
              completion will not be used if there are num or more matches.

              The value of this widget also controls menu selection, as imple-
              mented by the zsh/complist module.  The following values may ap-
              pear either alongside or instead of the values above.

              If  the  value contains the string `select', menu selection will
              be started unconditionally.

              In the form `select=num', menu selection will only be started if
              there are at least num matches.  If the values for more than one
              tag provide a number, the smallest number is taken.

              Menu selection can be turned off explicitly by defining a  value
              containing the string`no-select'.

              It  is also possible to start menu selection only if the list of
              matches does not fit on the  screen  by  using  the  value  `se-
              lect=long'.   To start menu selection even if the current widget
              only performs listing, use the value `select=long-list'.

              To turn on menu completion or menu selection when  there  are  a
              certain number of matches or the list of matches does not fit on
              the screen, both of `yes=' and `select='  may  be  given  twice,
              once with a number and once with `long' or `long-list'.

              Finally,  it  is  possible to activate two special modes of menu
              selection.  The word `interactive' in the value causes  interac-
              tive  mode  to  be  entered  immediately  when menu selection is
              started; see the description of the zsh/complist module in  zsh-
              modules(1) for a description of interactive mode.  Including the
              string `search' does the same for incremental search  mode.   To
              select   backward   incremental   search,   include  the  string
              `search-backward'.

       muttrc If set, gives the location of the mutt configuration  file.   It
              defaults to `~/.muttrc'.

       numbers
              This is used with the jobs tag.  If it is `true', the shell will
              complete job numbers instead of the shortest unambiguous  prefix
              of  the job command text.  If the value is a number, job numbers
              will only be used if that many words from the  job  descriptions
              are  required to resolve ambiguities.  For example, if the value
              is `1', strings will only be used if  all  jobs  differ  in  the
              first word on their command lines.

       old-list
              This  is  used  by the _oldlist completer.  If it is set to `al-
              ways', then standard widgets which perform listing  will  retain
              the  current  list of matches, however they were generated; this
              can be turned off explicitly with the value `never', giving  the
              behaviour  without  the _oldlist completer.  If the style is un-
              set, or any other value, then the existing list  of  completions
              is  displayed if it is not already; otherwise, the standard com-
              pletion list is generated; this  is  the  default  behaviour  of
              _oldlist.   However, if there is an old list and this style con-
              tains the name of the  completer  function  that  generated  the
              list, then the old list will be used even if it was generated by
              a widget which does not do listing.

              For example, suppose you type ^Xc to use the _correct_word  wid-
              get,  which  generates  a list of corrections for the word under
              the cursor.  Usually, typing ^D would generate a  standard  list
              of  completions for the word on the command line, and show that.
              With _oldlist, it will instead show the list of corrections  al-
              ready generated.

              As  another  example consider the _match completer: with the in-
              sert-unambiguous style set to `true' it inserts  only  a  common
              prefix  string, if there is any.  However, this may remove parts
              of the original pattern, so that further completion  could  pro-
              duce  more  matches  than  on  the  first attempt.  By using the
              _oldlist completer and setting this style to _match, the list of
              matches generated on the first attempt will be used again.

       old-matches
              This  is  used by the _all_matches completer to decide if an old
              list of matches should be used if one exists.  This is  selected
              by  one  of  the  `true' values or by the string `only'.  If the
              value is `only', _all_matches will only  use  an  old  list  and
              won't  have  any  effect  on the list of matches currently being
              generated.

              If this style  is  set  it  is  generally  unwise  to  call  the
              _all_matches completer unconditionally.  One possible use is for
              either this style or the completer style to be defined with  the
              -e option to zstyle to make the style conditional.

       old-menu
              This  is  used  by the _oldlist completer.  It controls how menu
              completion behaves when a completion has already  been  inserted
              and  the  user types a standard completion key such as TAB.  The
              default behaviour of _oldlist is  that  menu  completion  always
              continues  with the existing list of completions.  If this style
              is set to `false', however, a new completion is started  if  the
              old  list  was generated by a different completion command; this
              is the behaviour without the _oldlist completer.

              For example, suppose you type ^Xc to generate a list of  correc-
              tions,  and menu completion is started in one of the usual ways.
              Usually, or with this style set to `false', typing TAB  at  this
              point would start trying to complete the line as it now appears.
              With _oldlist, it instead continues to cycle through the list of
              corrections.

       original
              This  is used by the _approximate and _correct completers to de-
              cide if the original string should be added as a  possible  com-
              pletion.   Normally, this is done only if there are at least two
              possible corrections, but if this style is set to `true', it  is
              always  added.   Note  that  the style will be examined with the
              completer field in the context name set to  correct-num  or  ap-
              proximate-num,  where  num is the number of errors that were ac-
              cepted.

       packageset
              This style is used  when  completing  arguments  of  the  Debian
              `dpkg' program.  It contains an override for the default package
              set for a given context.  For example,

                     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:dpkg:option--status-1:*' \
                                    packageset avail

              causes available packages, rather than only installed  packages,
              to be completed for `dpkg --status'.

       path   The function that completes color names uses this style with the
              colors tag.  The value should be the pathname of a file contain-
              ing  color  names  in the format of an X11 rgb.txt file.  If the
              style is not set but this file is found in one of various  stan-
              dard locations it will be used as the default.

       path-completion
              This  is used by filename completion.  By default, filename com-
              pletion examines all components of a path to see  if  there  are
              completions  of that component.  For example, /u/b/z can be com-
              pleted  to  /usr/bin/zsh.   Explicitly  setting  this  style  to
              `false'  inhibits this behaviour for path components up to the /
              before the cursor; this  overrides  the  setting  of  accept-ex-
              act-dirs.

              Even with the style set to `false', it is still possible to com-
              plete multiple paths by setting the option COMPLETE_IN_WORD  and
              moving  the cursor back to the first component in the path to be
              completed.  For example, /u/b/z can be completed to /usr/bin/zsh
              if the cursor is after the /u.

       pine-directory
              If  set,  specifies the directory containing PINE mailbox files.
              There is no default, since recursively searching this  directory
              is inconvenient for anyone who doesn't use PINE.

       ports  A  list  of  Internet service names (network ports) to complete.
              If this is not set,  service  names  are  taken  from  the  file
              `/etc/services'.

       prefix-hidden
              This  is  used for certain completions which share a common pre-
              fix, for example command options beginning with dashes.   If  it
              is `true', the prefix will not be shown in the list of matches.

              The default value for this style is `false'.

       prefix-needed
              This  style  is  also relevant for matches with a common prefix.
              If it is set to `true' this common prefix must be typed  by  the
              user to generate the matches.

              The  style  is  applicable  to the options, signals, jobs, func-
              tions, and parameters completion tags.

              For command options, this means that the initial  `-',  `+',  or
              `--'  must  be typed explicitly before option names will be com-
              pleted.

              For signals, an initial `-' is required before signal names will
              be completed.

              For  jobs,  an  initial `%' is required before job names will be
              completed.

              For function and parameter names, an initial `_' or `.'  is  re-
              quired  before  function  or parameter names starting with those
              characters will be completed.

              The default value for this style is `false' for function and pa-
              rameter completions, and  `true' otherwise.

       preserve-prefix
              This style is used when completing path names.  Its value should
              be a pattern matching an initial prefix of the word to  complete
              that  should be left unchanged under all circumstances.  For ex-
              ample, on some Unices an initial `//' (double slash) has a  spe-
              cial  meaning;  setting  this style to the string `//' will pre-
              serve it.  As another example, setting this style to `?:/' under
              Cygwin would allow completion after `a:/...' and so on.

       range  This  is  used  by  the _history completer and the _history_com-
              plete_word bindable command to decide which words should be com-
              pleted.

              If it is a single number, only the last N words from the history
              will be completed.

              If it is a range of the form `max:slice', the last  slice  words
              will  be  completed;  then  if that yields no matches, the slice
              words before those will be tried and so on.  This process  stops
              either when at least one match has been found, or max words have
              been tried.

              The default is to complete all words from the history at once.

       recursive-files
              If this style is set, its value is an array of  patterns  to  be
              tested  against  `$PWD/':  note the trailing slash, which allows
              directories in the pattern to be delimited unambiguously by  in-
              cluding  slashes  on both sides.  If an ordinary file completion
              fails and the word on the command line does not yet have  a  di-
              rectory  part to its name, the style is retrieved using the same
              tag as for the completion  just  attempted,  then  the  elements
              tested  against  $PWD/  in turn.  If one matches, then the shell
              reattempts completion by prepending the word on the command line
              with  each directory in the expansion of **/*(/) in turn.  Typi-
              cally the elements of the style will be set to restrict the num-
              ber  of directories beneath the current one to a manageable num-
              ber, for example `*/.git/*'.

              For example,

                     zstyle ':completion:*' recursive-files '*/zsh/*'

              If the current directory is /home/pws/zsh/Src, then  zle_tr<TAB>
              can be completed to Zle/zle_tricky.c.

       regular
              This  style  is used by the _expand_alias completer and bindable
              command.  If set to `true' (the default), regular  aliases  will
              be  expanded  but  only  in  command  position.  If it is set to
              `false', regular aliases will never be expanded.   If it is  set
              to  `always',  regular  aliases  will be expanded even if not in
              command position.

       rehash If this is set when completing external commands,  the  internal
              list (hash) of commands will be updated for each search by issu-
              ing the rehash command.  There is a speed penalty for this which
              is  only  likely  to  be noticeable when directories in the path
              have slow file access.

       remote-access
              If set to `false', certain commands will be prevented from  mak-
              ing  Internet  connections to retrieve remote information.  This
              includes the completion for the CVS command.

              It is not always possible to know if connections are in fact  to
              a remote site, so some may be prevented unnecessarily.

       remove-all-dups
              The  _history_complete_word  bindable  command  and the _history
              completer use this to decide if all duplicate matches should  be
              removed, rather than just consecutive duplicates.

       select-prompt
              If  this is set for the default tag, its value will be displayed
              during menu selection (see the menu style above) when  the  com-
              pletion  list  does  not fit on the screen as a whole.  The same
              escapes as for the list-prompt style are understood, except that
              the  numbers  refer  to the match or line the mark is on.  A de-
              fault prompt is used when the value is the empty string.

       select-scroll
              This style is tested for the default tag and  determines  how  a
              completion  list  is  scrolled  during a menu selection (see the
              menu style above) when the completion list does not fit  on  the
              screen  as  a  whole.   If  the value is `0' (zero), the list is
              scrolled by half-screenfuls; if it is a  positive  integer,  the
              list  is scrolled by the given number of lines; if it is a nega-
              tive number, the list is scrolled by a screenful minus the abso-
              lute  value  of  the  given  number of lines.  The default is to
              scroll by single lines.

       separate-sections
              This style is used with the manuals tag when completing names of
              manual  pages.   If it is `true', entries for different sections
              are added separately using tag names of  the  form  `manuals.X',
              where  X  is  the  section number.  When the group-name style is
              also in effect, pages from different sections will appear  sepa-
              rately.   This style is also used similarly with the words style
              when completing words for the dict command. It allows words from
              different  dictionary databases to be added separately. See also
              insert-sections.

              The default for this style is `false'.

       show-ambiguity
              If the zsh/complist module is loaded, this style can be used  to
              highlight the first ambiguous character in completion lists. The
              value is either a color indication such as  those  supported  by
              the  list-colors  style or, with a value of `true', a default of
              underlining is selected. The highlighting is only applied if the
              completion display strings correspond to the actual matches.

       show-completer
              Tested  whenever a new completer is tried.  If it is `true', the
              completion system outputs a progress message in the listing area
              showing  what  completer  is  being  tried.  The message will be
              overwritten by any output when completions are found and is  re-
              moved after completion is finished.

       single-ignored
              This  is  used  by the _ignored completer when there is only one
              match.  If its value is `show', the single match  will  be  dis-
              played  but not inserted.  If the value is `menu', then the sin-
              gle match and the original string are both added as matches  and
              menu  completion  is started, making it easy to select either of
              them.

       sort   This allows the standard ordering of matches to be overridden.

              If its value is `true' or `false', sorting is  enabled  or  dis-
              abled.   Additionally the values associated with the `-o' option
              to compadd can also be listed: match, nosort, numeric,  reverse.
              If  it is not set for the context, the standard behaviour of the
              calling widget is used.

              The style is tested first against the full context including the
              tag,  and  if  that fails to produce a value against the context
              without the tag.

              In many cases where a calling widget explicitly selects  a  par-
              ticular  ordering  in  lieu of the default, a value of `true' is
              not honoured.  An example of where this is not the case  is  for
              command history where the default of sorting matches chronologi-
              cally may be overridden by setting the style to `true'.

              In the _expand completer, if it is set to `true', the expansions
              generated  will  always be sorted.  If it is set to `menu', then
              the expansions are only sorted when they are offered  as  single
              strings  but  not  in  the string containing all possible expan-
              sions.

       special-dirs
              Normally, the completion code will  not  produce  the  directory
              names  `.'  and  `..' as possible completions.  If this style is
              set to `true', it will add both `.' and `..' as possible comple-
              tions; if it is set to `..', only `..' will be added.

              The following example sets special-dirs to `..' when the current
              prefix is empty, is a single `.', or consists only of a path be-
              ginning with `../'.  Otherwise the value is `false'.

                     zstyle -e ':completion:*' special-dirs \
                        '[[ $PREFIX = (../)#(|.|..) ]] && reply=(..)'

       squeeze-slashes
              If  set  to  `true', sequences of slashes in filename paths (for
              example in `foo//bar') will be treated as a single slash.   This
              is  the  usual behaviour of UNIX paths.  However, by default the
              file completion function behaves as if there were a `*'  between
              the slashes.

       stop   If  set  to  `true', the _history_complete_word bindable command
              will stop once when reaching the beginning or end  of  the  his-
              tory.   Invoking _history_complete_word will then wrap around to
              the opposite end of the  history.   If  this  style  is  set  to
              `false'  (the default), _history_complete_word will loop immedi-
              ately as in a menu completion.

       strip-comments
              If set to `true', this style causes non-essential  comment  text
              to  be  removed  from  completion matches.  Currently it is only
              used when completing e-mail addresses where it removes any  dis-
              play  name  from  the  addresses,  cutting  them  down  to plain
              user@host form.

       subst-globs-only
              This is used by the _expand completer.  If it is set to  `true',
              the  expansion  will  only be used if it resulted from globbing;
              hence, if expansions resulted from the  use  of  the  substitute
              style  described  below,  but  these were not further changed by
              globbing, the expansions will be rejected.

              The default for this style is `false'.

       substitute
              This boolean style controls whether the _expand  completer  will
              first  try  to  expand  all substitutions in the string (such as
              `$(...)' and `${...}').

              The default is `true'.

       suffix This is used by the _expand completer if the word starts with  a
              tilde  or  contains  a  parameter  expansion.   If  it is set to
              `true', the word will only be expanded if it doesn't have a suf-
              fix,  i.e.  if it is something like `~foo' or `$foo' rather than
              `~foo/' or `$foo/bar', unless that suffix itself contains  char-
              acters  eligible  for  expansion.  The default for this style is
              `true'.

       tag-order
              This provides a mechanism for sorting how the tags available  in
              a particular context will be used.

              The  values  for  the style are sets of space-separated lists of
              tags.  The tags in each value will be tried at the same time; if
              no  match  is found, the next value is used.  (See the file-pat-
              terns style for an exception to this behavior.)

              For example:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:-command-:*:*' tag-order \
                         'commands functions'

              specifies that completion in command position first  offers  ex-
              ternal  commands  and  shell  functions.  Remaining tags will be
              tried if no completions are found.

              In addition to tag names, each string in the value may take  one
              of the following forms:

              -      If  any  value  consists  of only a hyphen, then only the
                     tags specified in the other values are  generated.   Nor-
                     mally  all tags not explicitly selected are tried last if
                     the specified tags fail to generate  any  matches.   This
                     means that a single value consisting only of a single hy-
                     phen turns off completion.

              ! tags...
                     A string starting  with  an  exclamation  mark  specifies
                     names of tags that are not to be used.  The effect is the
                     same as if all other possible tags for  the  context  had
                     been listed.

              tag:label ...
                     Here, tag is one of the standard tags and label is an ar-
                     bitrary name.  Matches are generated as  normal  but  the
                     name  label  is used in contexts instead of tag.  This is
                     not useful in words starting with !.

                     If the label starts with a hyphen, the tag  is  prepended
                     to  the label to form the name used for lookup.  This can
                     be used to make the completion system try a  certain  tag
                     more  than  once,  supplying different style settings for
                     each attempt; see below for an example.

              tag:label:description
                     As before, but description will replace the `%d'  in  the
                     value of the format style instead of the default descrip-
                     tion supplied by the completion function.  Spaces in  the
                     description  must be quoted with a backslash.  A `%d' ap-
                     pearing in description is replaced with  the  description
                     given by the completion function.

              In  any  of  the forms above the tag may be a pattern or several
              patterns in the form `{pat1,pat2...}'.  In this case all  match-
              ing  tags  will  be  used except for any given explicitly in the
              same string.

              One use of these features is to try one tag more than once, set-
              ting  other styles differently on each attempt, but still to use
              all the other tags without having to repeat them all.  For exam-
              ple,  to  make  completion of function names in command position
              ignore all the completion functions starting with an  underscore
              the first time completion is tried:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:*' tag-order \
                         'functions:-non-comp *' functions
                     zstyle ':completion:*:functions-non-comp' \
                         ignored-patterns '_*'

              On the first attempt, all tags will be offered but the functions
              tag will be replaced by  functions-non-comp.   The  ignored-pat-
              terns  style  is  set for this tag to exclude functions starting
              with an underscore.  If there are no matches, the  second  value
              of  the  tag-order style is used which completes functions using
              the default tag, this time  presumably  including  all  function
              names.

              The matches for one tag can be split into different groups.  For
              example:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' tag-order \
                         'options:-long:long\ options
                          options:-short:short\ options
                          options:-single-letter:single\ letter\ options'
                     zstyle ':completion:*:options-long' \
                          ignored-patterns '[-+](|-|[^-]*)'
                     zstyle ':completion:*:options-short' \
                          ignored-patterns '--*' '[-+]?'
                     zstyle ':completion:*:options-single-letter' \
                          ignored-patterns '???*'

              With the group-names style set, options beginning with `--', op-
              tions beginning with a single `-' or `+' but containing multiple
              characters, and single-letter options will be displayed in sepa-
              rate groups with different descriptions.

              Another  use of patterns is to try multiple match specifications
              one after another.  The matcher-list style offers something sim-
              ilar,  but  it is tested very early in the completion system and
              hence can't be set for single commands  nor  for  more  specific
              contexts.   Here  is  how  to  try normal completion without any
              match specification and, if that generates no matches, try again
              with  case-insensitive matching, restricting the effect to argu-
              ments of the command foo:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:foo:*:*' tag-order '*' '*:-case'
                     zstyle ':completion:*-case' matcher 'm:{a-z}={A-Z}'

              First, all the tags offered when completing after foo are  tried
              using  the  normal  tag name.  If that generates no matches, the
              second value of tag-order is used, which tries  all  tags  again
              except  that  this  time each has -case appended to its name for
              lookup of styles.  Hence this time the  value  for  the  matcher
              style  from  the second call to zstyle in the example is used to
              make completion case-insensitive.

              It is possible to use the -e option of the zstyle  builtin  com-
              mand  to specify conditions for the use of particular tags.  For
              example:

                     zstyle -e '*:-command-:*' tag-order '
                         if [[ -n $PREFIX$SUFFIX ]]; then
                           reply=( )
                         else
                           reply=( - )
                         fi'

              Completion in command position will be  attempted  only  if  the
              string typed so far is not empty.  This is tested using the PRE-
              FIX special parameter; see zshcompwid for a description  of  pa-
              rameters  which  are special inside completion widgets.  Setting
              reply to an empty array provides the default behaviour of trying
              all  tags  at once; setting it to an array containing only a hy-
              phen disables the use of all tags and hence of all completions.

              If no tag-order style  has  been  defined  for  a  context,  the
              strings  `(|*-)argument-*  (|*-)option-*  values'  and `options'
              plus all tags offered by the completion function will be used to
              provide  a  sensible  default  behavior  that  causes  arguments
              (whether normal command arguments or arguments of options) to be
              completed before option names for most commands.

       urls   This  is used together with the urls tag by functions completing
              URLs.

              If the value consists of more than one string, or  if  the  only
              string  does  not name a file or directory, the strings are used
              as the URLs to complete.

              If the value contains only one string which is  the  name  of  a
              normal  file  the  URLs are taken from that file (where the URLs
              may be separated by white space or newlines).

              Finally, if the only string in the value names a directory,  the
              directory  hierarchy  rooted at this directory gives the comple-
              tions.  The top  level  directory  should  be  the  file  access
              method,  such  as  `http', `ftp', `bookmark' and so on.  In many
              cases the next level of directories will be a filename.  The di-
              rectory hierarchy can descend as deep as necessary.

              For example,

                     zstyle ':completion:*' urls ~/.urls
                     mkdir -p ~/.urls/ftp/ftp.zsh.org/pub

              allows   completion   of   all   the   components   of  the  URL
              ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub after suitable commands such as `netscape'
              or  `lynx'.   Note,  however,  that access methods and files are
              completed separately, so if the hosts style is set hosts can  be
              completed without reference to the urls style.

              See the description in the function _urls itself for more infor-
              mation (e.g. `more $^fpath/_urls(N)').

       use-cache
              If this is set, the completion caching layer  is  activated  for
              any  completions  which  use  it  (via  the  _store_cache,  _re-
              trieve_cache, and _cache_invalid functions).  The directory con-
              taining  the  cache  files  can  be  changed with the cache-path
              style.

       use-compctl
              If this style is set to a string not equal to false, 0, no,  and
              off, the completion system may use any completion specifications
              defined with the compctl builtin command.  If the style  is  un-
              set, this is done only if the zsh/compctl module is loaded.  The
              string may also contain the substring `first' to use completions
              defined  with  `compctl  -T', and the substring `default' to use
              the completion defined with `compctl -D'.

              Note that this is only intended to smooth  the  transition  from
              compctl  to  the  new completion system and may disappear in the
              future.

              Note also that the definitions from compctl will only be used if
              there  is  no  specific  completion  function for the command in
              question.  For example, if there is a function _foo to  complete
              arguments  to the command foo, compctl will never be invoked for
              foo.  However, the compctl version will be  tried  if  foo  only
              uses default completion.

       use-ip By default, the function _hosts that completes host names strips
              IP addresses from entries read from host databases such  as  NIS
              and  ssh  files.   If this style is `true', the corresponding IP
              addresses can be completed as well.  This style is  not  use  in
              any  context  where the hosts style is set; note also it must be
              set before the cache of host names is generated  (typically  the
              first completion attempt).

       users  This  may  be set to a list of usernames to be completed.  If it
              is not set all usernames will be completed.  Note that if it  is
              set  only  that list of users will be completed; this is because
              on some systems querying all users can take a prohibitive amount
              of time.

       users-hosts
              The  values  of  this style should be of the form `user@host' or
              `user:host'. It is used for commands that need  pairs  of  user-
              and hostnames.  These commands will complete usernames from this
              style (only), and will restrict subsequent  hostname  completion
              to  hosts  paired  with  that  user  in one of the values of the
              style.

              It is possible to group values for sets of commands which  allow
              a remote login, such as rlogin and ssh, by using the my-accounts
              tag.  Similarly, values for sets of commands which usually refer
              to the accounts of other people, such as talk and finger, can be
              grouped by using the other-accounts tag.  More  ambivalent  com-
              mands may use the accounts tag.

       users-hosts-ports
              Like  users-hosts but used for commands like telnet and contain-
              ing strings of the form `user@host:port'.

       verbose
              If set, as it is by default, the completion listing is more ver-
              bose.  In particular many commands show descriptions for options
              if this style is `true'.

       word   This is used by the _list completer, which prevents  the  inser-
              tion  of  completions until a second completion attempt when the
              line has not changed.  The normal way of finding out if the line
              has  changed  is  to compare its entire contents between the two
              occasions.  If this style is `true', the comparison  is  instead
              performed only on the current word.  Hence if completion is per-
              formed on another word with the same contents,  completion  will
              not be delayed.

CONTROL FUNCTIONS
       The initialization script compinit redefines all the widgets which per-
       form completion to call the supplied  widget  function  _main_complete.
       This function acts as a wrapper calling the so-called `completer' func-
       tions that generate matches.  If _main_complete is  called  with  argu-
       ments, these are taken as the names of completer functions to be called
       in the order given.  If no arguments are given, the set of functions to
       try is taken from the completer style.  For example, to use normal com-
       pletion and correction if that doesn't generate any matches:

              zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct

       after calling compinit. The default value for this style is  `_complete
       _ignored',  i.e. normally only ordinary completion is tried, first with
       the effect of the ignored-patterns style  and  then  without  it.   The
       _main_complete  function  uses the return status of the completer func-
       tions to decide if other completers should be called.   If  the  return
       status  is  zero,  no other completers are tried and the _main_complete
       function returns.

       If the first argument to _main_complete is a single hyphen,  the  argu-
       ments  will  not  be taken as names of completers.  Instead, the second
       argument gives a name to use in the completer field of the context  and
       the other arguments give a command name and arguments to call to gener-
       ate the matches.

       The following completer functions are contained  in  the  distribution,
       although  users may write their own.  Note that in contexts the leading
       underscore is stripped, for example basic completion  is  performed  in
       the context `:completion::complete:...'.

       _all_matches
              This  completer  can  be  used to add a string consisting of all
              other matches.  As it influences later completers it must appear
              as  the first completer in the list.  The list of all matches is
              affected by the avoid-completer and old-matches styles described
              above.

              It may be useful to use the _generic function described below to
              bind _all_matches to its own keystroke, for example:

                     zle -C all-matches complete-word _generic
                     bindkey '^Xa' all-matches
                     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' old-matches only
                     zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer _all_matches

              Note that this does not generate completions by  itself:   first
              use  any  of  the  standard ways of generating a list of comple-
              tions, then use ^Xa to show all matches.  It is possible instead
              to  add  a  standard  completer to the list and request that the
              list of all matches should be directly inserted:

                     zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer \
                            _all_matches _complete
                     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' insert true

              In this case the old-matches style should not be set.

       _approximate
              This is similar to the basic _complete completer but allows  the
              completions  to  undergo corrections.  The maximum number of er-
              rors can be specified by the max-errors style; see the  descrip-
              tion  of  approximate  matching in zshexpn(1) for how errors are
              counted.  Normally this completer will only be tried  after  the
              normal _complete completer:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _approximate

              This  will give correcting completion if and only if normal com-
              pletion yields no possible completions.  When corrected  comple-
              tions  are found, the completer will normally start menu comple-
              tion allowing you to cycle through these strings.

              This completer uses the tags corrections and original when  gen-
              erating  the  possible corrections and the original string.  The
              format style for the former may contain the additional sequences
              `%e' and `%o' which will be replaced by the number of errors ac-
              cepted to generate the corrections and the original string,  re-
              spectively.

              The  completer  progressively increases the number of errors al-
              lowed up to the limit by the max-errors style, hence if  a  com-
              pletion  is found with one error, no completions with two errors
              will be shown, and so on.  It modifies the completer name in the
              context  to  indicate  the  number of errors being tried: on the
              first try the completer field contains `approximate-1',  on  the
              second try `approximate-2', and so on.

              When _approximate is called from another function, the number of
              errors to accept may be passed with the -a option.  The argument
              is  in  the  same  format  as  the  max-errors style, all in one
              string.

              Note that this completer (and the _correct  completer  mentioned
              below)  can  be quite expensive to call, especially when a large
              number of errors are allowed.  One way to avoid this is  to  set
              up  the  completer  style  using the -e option to zstyle so that
              some completers are only used when  completion  is  attempted  a
              second time on the same string, e.g.:

                     zstyle -e ':completion:*' completer '
                       if [[ $_last_try != "$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR" ]]; then
                         _last_try="$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR"
                         reply=(_complete _match _prefix)
                       else
                         reply=(_ignored _correct _approximate)
                       fi'

              This uses the HISTNO parameter and the BUFFER and CURSOR special
              parameters that are available inside zle and completion  widgets
              to  find  out  if the command line hasn't changed since the last
              time completion was tried.  Only then are the _ignored, _correct
              and _approximate completers called.

       _canonical_paths  [ -A var ] [ -N ] [ -MJV12nfX ] tag descr [ paths ...
       ]
              This completion function completes all paths given  to  it,  and
              also  tries to offer completions which point to the same file as
              one of the paths given (relative path when an absolute  path  is
              given,  and  vice versa; when ..'s are present in the word to be
              completed; and some paths got from symlinks).

              -A, if specified, takes the paths from the array variable speci-
              fied.  Paths  can also be specified on the command line as shown
              above.  -N, if  specified,  prevents  canonicalizing  the  paths
              given before using them for completion, in case they are already
              so. The options -M, -J, -V, -1, -2, -n, -F,  -X  are  passed  to
              compadd.

              See _description for a description of tag and descr.

       _cmdambivalent
              Completes the remaining positional arguments as an external com-
              mand.  The external command and its arguments are  completed  as
              separate  arguments  (in  a  manner  appropriate  for completing
              /usr/bin/env) if there are two or more remaining positional  ar-
              guments  on the command line, and as a quoted command string (in
              the manner of system(...)) otherwise.  See also  _cmdstring  and
              _precommand.

              This function takes no arguments.

       _cmdstring
              Completes  an external command as a single argument, as for sys-
              tem(...).

       _complete
              This completer generates all  possible  completions  in  a  con-
              text-sensitive  manner, i.e. using the settings defined with the
              compdef function explained above and the current settings of all
              special parameters.  This gives the normal completion behaviour.

              To  complete  arguments  of commands, _complete uses the utility
              function _normal, which is in turn responsible for  finding  the
              particular function; it is described below.  Various contexts of
              the form -context- are handled specifically. These are all  men-
              tioned above as possible arguments to the #compdef tag.

              Before  trying  to find a function for a specific context, _com-
              plete checks if the  parameter  `compcontext'  is  set.  Setting
              `compcontext'  allows  the  usual  completion  dispatching to be
              overridden which is useful in places such  as  a  function  that
              uses vared for input. If it is set to an array, the elements are
              taken to be the possible matches which will be  completed  using
              the tag `values' and the description `value'. If it is set to an
              associative array, the keys are used as the possible completions
              and  the  values (if non-empty) are used as descriptions for the
              matches.  If `compcontext' is set to a string containing colons,
              it  should  be of the form `tag:descr:action'.  In this case the
              tag and descr give the tag and description to use and the action
              indicates  what should be completed in one of the forms accepted
              by the _arguments utility function described below.

              Finally, if `compcontext' is set to a string without colons, the
              value  is  taken as the name of the context to use and the func-
              tion defined for that context will be called.  For this purpose,
              there  is  a special context named -command-line- that completes
              whole command lines (commands and their arguments).  This is not
              used  by the completion system itself but is nonetheless handled
              when explicitly called.

       _correct
              Generate corrections, but not completions, for the current word;
              this is similar to _approximate but will not allow any number of
              extra characters at the cursor as that completer does.  The  ef-
              fect is similar to spell-checking.  It is based on _approximate,
              but the completer field in the context name is correct.

              For example, with:

                     zstyle ':completion:::::' completer \
                            _complete _correct _approximate
                     zstyle ':completion:*:correct:::' max-errors 2 not-numeric
                     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 3 numeric

              correction will accept up to two errors.  If a numeric  argument
              is  given, correction will not be performed, but correcting com-
              pletion will be, and will accept as many errors as given by  the
              numeric  argument.  Without a numeric argument, first correction
              and then correcting completion will be tried, with the first one
              accepting two errors and the second one accepting three errors.

              When  _correct  is called as a function, the number of errors to
              accept may be given following the -a option.  The argument is in
              the same form a values to the accept style, all in one string.

              This  completer function is intended to be used without the _ap-
              proximate completer or, as in the example, just before it.   Us-
              ing  it  after  the _approximate completer is useless since _ap-
              proximate will at least generate the corrected strings generated
              by the _correct completer -- and probably more.

       _expand
              This  completer function does not really perform completion, but
              instead checks if the word on the command line is  eligible  for
              expansion  and,  if  it is, gives detailed control over how this
              expansion is done.  For this to happen,  the  completion  system
              needs  to  be invoked with complete-word, not expand-or-complete
              (the default binding for TAB), as otherwise the string  will  be
              expanded by the shell's internal mechanism before the completion
              system is started.  Note also this completer  should  be  called
              before the _complete completer function.

              The  tags used when generating expansions are all-expansions for
              the string containing all possible expansions,  expansions  when
              adding  the  possible  expansions as single matches and original
              when adding the original string from the  line.   The  order  in
              which  these strings are generated, if at all, can be controlled
              by the group-order and tag-order styles, as usual.

              The format string for all-expansions and for expansions may con-
              tain  the  sequence  `%o' which will be replaced by the original
              string from the line.

              The kind of expansion to be tried is controlled by  the  substi-
              tute, glob and subst-globs-only styles.

              It is also possible to call _expand as a function, in which case
              the different modes may be selected with options: -s for substi-
              tute, -g for glob and -o for subst-globs-only.

       _expand_alias
              If  the word the cursor is on is an alias, it is expanded and no
              other completers are called.  The types of aliases which are  to
              be  expanded  can  be controlled with the styles regular, global
              and disabled.

              This function is also a bindable command, see the section `Bind-
              able Commands' below.

       _extensions
              If  the  cursor follows the string `*.', filename extensions are
              completed. The extensions are taken from files in current direc-
              tory  or  a  directory specified at the beginning of the current
              word. For exact matches, completion  continues  to  allow  other
              completers  such  as _expand to expand the pattern. The standard
              add-space and prefix-hidden styles are observed.

       _external_pwds
              Completes current directories of other zsh  processes  belonging
              to the current user.

              This  is intended to be used via _generic, bound to a custom key
              combination. Note that pattern matching is enabled  so  matching
              is performed similar to how it works with the _match completer.

       _history
              Complete  words  from  the  shell's command  history.  This com-
              pleter can be controlled by the remove-all-dups, and sort styles
              as for the _history_complete_word bindable command, see the sec-
              tion `Bindable Commands' below and the section `Completion  Sys-
              tem Configuration' above.

       _ignored
              The  ignored-patterns  style  can  be  set to a list of patterns
              which are compared against possible completions;  matching  ones
              are  removed.   With  this  completer those matches can be rein-
              stated, as if no ignored-patterns style were set.  The completer
              actually generates its own list of matches; which completers are
              invoked is determined in the same way as for  the  _prefix  com-
              pleter.  The single-ignored style is also available as described
              above.

       _list  This completer allows the insertion of matches to be delayed un-
              til  completion  is  attempted a second time without the word on
              the line being changed.  On the first attempt, only the list  of
              matches  will  be shown.  It is affected by the styles condition
              and word, see  the  section  `Completion  System  Configuration'
              above.

       _match This  completer  is intended to be used after the _complete com-
              pleter.  It behaves similarly but the string on the command line
              may be a pattern to match against trial completions.  This gives
              the effect of the GLOB_COMPLETE option.

              Normally completion will be performed by taking the pattern from
              the  line,  inserting a `*' at the cursor position and comparing
              the resulting pattern with the possible  completions  generated.
              This  can  be  modified  with the match-original style described
              above.

              The generated matches will be offered in a menu  completion  un-
              less  the insert-unambiguous style is set to `true'; see the de-
              scription above for other options for this style.

              Note that matcher specifications defined globally or used by the
              completion  functions (the styles matcher-list and matcher) will
              not be used.

       _menu  This completer was written as simple example  function  to  show
              how  menu  completion  can be enabled in shell code. However, it
              has the notable effect of disabling menu selection which can  be
              useful  with  _generic  based  widgets. It should be used as the
              first completer in the list.  Note that this is  independent  of
              the  setting  of the MENU_COMPLETE option and does not work with
              the other menu completion widgets such as reverse-menu-complete,
              or accept-and-menu-complete.

       _oldlist
              This  completer controls how the standard completion widgets be-
              have when there is an existing list  of  completions  which  may
              have  been  generated  by  a  special  completion  (i.e. a sepa-
              rately-bound completion command).  It allows the  ordinary  com-
              pletion  keys  to  continue  to use the list of completions thus
              generated, instead of producing a new list of  ordinary  contex-
              tual  completions.   It  should appear in the list of completers
              before any of the widgets which generate matches.  It  uses  two
              styles:  old-list and old-menu, see the section `Completion Sys-
              tem Configuration' above.

       _precommand
              Complete an external command in word-separated arguments, as for
              exec and /usr/bin/env.

       _prefix
              This  completer  can  be  used to try completion with the suffix
              (everything after the cursor) ignored.  In other words, the suf-
              fix  will  not be considered to be part of the word to complete.
              The effect is similar to the expand-or-complete-prefix command.

              The completer style is used to decide which other completers are
              to  be  called to generate matches.  If this style is unset, the
              list of completers set for the current context is  used  --  ex-
              cept,  of course, the _prefix completer itself.  Furthermore, if
              this completer appears more than once in the list of  completers
              only  those  completers not already tried by the last invocation
              of _prefix will be called.

              For example, consider this global completer style:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
                         _complete _prefix _correct _prefix:foo

              Here, the _prefix completer tries normal completion but ignoring
              the  suffix.   If that doesn't generate any matches, and neither
              does the call to the _correct completer after it,  _prefix  will
              be called a second time and, now only trying correction with the
              suffix ignored.  On the second invocation the completer part  of
              the context appears as `foo'.

              To use _prefix as the last resort and try only normal completion
              when it is invoked:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete ... _prefix
                     zstyle ':completion::prefix:*' completer _complete

              The add-space style is also respected.  If it is set  to  `true'
              then  _prefix  will insert a space between the matches generated
              (if any) and the suffix.

              Note that this completer is only useful if the  COMPLETE_IN_WORD
              option is set; otherwise, the cursor will be moved to the end of
              the current word before the completion code is called and  hence
              there will be no suffix.

       _user_expand
              This  completer  behaves  similarly to the _expand completer but
              instead  performs  expansions  defined  by  users.   The  styles
              add-space  and sort styles specific to the _expand completer are
              usable with _user_expand in addition  to  other  styles  handled
              more generally by the completion system.  The tag all-expansions
              is also available.

              The expansion depends on the array style user-expand  being  de-
              fined  for  the  current  context; remember that the context for
              completers is less specific than that for contextual  completion
              as  the  full  context has not yet been determined.  Elements of
              the array may have one of the following forms:

              $hash

                     hash is the name of an associative array.  Note  this  is
                     not  a  full  parameter  expression, merely a $, suitably
                     quoted to prevent immediate expansion,  followed  by  the
                     name  of  an  associative  array.  If the trial expansion
                     word matches a key in hash, the  resulting  expansion  is
                     the corresponding value.
              _func

                     _func is the name of a shell function whose name must be-
                     gin with _ but is not otherwise special to the completion
                     system.  The function is called with the trial word as an
                     argument.  If the word is to be  expanded,  the  function
                     should  set the array reply to a list of expansions.  Op-
                     tionally, it can set REPLY to a word that will be used as
                     a description for the set of expansions.  The return sta-
                     tus of the function is irrelevant.
BINDABLE COMMANDS
       In addition to the context-dependent completions  provided,  which  are
       expected to work in an intuitively obvious way, there are a few widgets
       implementing special behaviour which can be bound separately  to  keys.
       The following is a list of these and their default bindings.

       _bash_completions
              This  function  is  used by two widgets, _bash_complete-word and
              _bash_list-choices.  It exists  to  provide  compatibility  with
              completion  bindings in bash.  The last character of the binding
              determines what is completed: `!', command names; `$',  environ-
              ment  variables;  `@',  host  names;  `/',  file names; `~' user
              names.  In bash, the binding preceded by `\e' gives  completion,
              and  preceded  by `^X' lists options.  As some of these bindings
              clash with standard zsh bindings, only `\e~' and `^X~' are bound
              by  default.   To add the rest, the following should be added to
              .zshrc after compinit has been run:

                     for key in '!' '$' '@' '/' '~'; do
                       bindkey "\e$key" _bash_complete-word
                       bindkey "^X$key" _bash_list-choices
                     done

              This includes the bindings for `~' in  case  they  were  already
              bound  to  something else; the completion code does not override
              user bindings.

       _correct_filename (^XC)
              Correct the filename path at the cursor position.  Allows up  to
              six  errors in the name.  Can also be called with an argument to
              correct a filename path, independently of zle; the correction is
              printed on standard output.

       _correct_word (^Xc)
              Performs correction of the current argument using the usual con-
              textual completions as possible choices. This stores the  string
              `correct-word'  in  the  function  field of the context name and
              then calls the _correct completer.

       _expand_alias (^Xa)
              This function can be used as a completer and as a bindable  com-
              mand.   It  expands the word the cursor is on if it is an alias.
              The types of alias expanded can be controlled  with  the  styles
              regular, global and disabled.

              When  used as a bindable command there is one additional feature
              that can be selected by setting the complete  style  to  `true'.
              In  this  case,  if  the  word is not the name of an alias, _ex-
              pand_alias tries to complete the word to a full alias name with-
              out  expanding it.  It leaves the cursor directly after the com-
              pleted word so that invoking _expand_alias once more will expand
              the now-complete alias name.

       _expand_word (^Xe)
              Performs expansion on the current word:  equivalent to the stan-
              dard expand-word command, but using the _expand completer.   Be-
              fore  calling  it,  the  function field of the context is set to
              `expand-word'.

       _generic
              This function is not defined as a widget and not  bound  by  de-
              fault.  However, it can be used to define a widget and will then
              store the name of the widget in the function field of  the  con-
              text and call the completion system.  This allows custom comple-
              tion widgets with their own set of style settings to be  defined
              easily.   For  example,  to define a widget that performs normal
              completion and starts menu selection:

                     zle -C foo complete-word _generic
                     bindkey '...' foo
                     zstyle ':completion:foo:*' menu yes select=1

              Note in particular that the completer style may be set  for  the
              context in order to change the set of functions used to generate
              possible matches.  If _generic is called with  arguments,  those
              are  passed  through to _main_complete as the list of completers
              in place of those defined by the completer style.

       _history_complete_word (\e/)
              Complete words from the shell's command history. This  uses  the
              list, remove-all-dups, sort, and stop styles.

       _most_recent_file (^Xm)
              Complete  the  name  of the most recently modified file matching
              the pattern on the command line (which may be blank).  If  given
              a  numeric  argument  N, complete the Nth most recently modified
              file.  Note the completion, if any, is always unique.

       _next_tags (^Xn)
              This command alters the set of matches used to that for the next
              tag,  or  set of tags, either as given by the tag-order style or
              as set by default; these matches would otherwise not  be  avail-
              able.   Successive  invocations of the command cycle through all
              possible sets of tags.

       _read_comp (^X^R)
              Prompt the user for a string, and use that to perform completion
              on  the  current  word.   There  are  two  possibilities for the
              string.  First, it can be a set of words beginning `_', for  ex-
              ample `_files -/', in which case the function with any arguments
              will be called to generate the completions.   Unambiguous  parts
              of  the  function  name  will be completed automatically (normal
              completion is not available at this  point)  until  a  space  is
              typed.

              Second, any other string will be passed as a set of arguments to
              compadd and should hence be an expression specifying what should
              be completed.

              A  very  restricted  set  of  editing commands is available when
              reading the string:  `DEL' and `^H' delete the  last  character;
              `^U'  deletes  the  line,  and `^C' and `^G' abort the function,
              while `RET' accepts the completion.  Note  the  string  is  used
              verbatim  as  a command line, so arguments must be quoted in ac-
              cordance with standard shell rules.

              Once a string has been read, the next call  to  _read_comp  will
              use  the existing string instead of reading a new one.  To force
              a new string to be read, call _read_comp with  a  numeric  argu-
              ment.

       _complete_debug (^X?)
              This widget performs ordinary completion, but captures in a tem-
              porary file a trace of the shell commands executed by  the  com-
              pletion  system.   Each completion attempt gets its own file.  A
              command to view each of these files is pushed  onto  the  editor
              buffer stack.

       _complete_help (^Xh)
              This  widget  displays  information about the context names, the
              tags, and the completion functions used when completing  at  the
              current  cursor position. If given a numeric argument other than
              1 (as in `ESC-2 ^Xh'), then the styles used and the contexts for
              which they are used will be shown, too.

              Note that the information about styles may be incomplete; it de-
              pends on the information available from the completion functions
              called, which in turn is determined by the user's own styles and
              other settings.

       _complete_help_generic
              Unlike other commands listed here, this must  be  created  as  a
              normal ZLE widget rather than a completion widget (i.e. with zle
              -N).  It is used for generating help with a widget bound to  the
              _generic widget that is described above.

              If  this widget is created using the name of the function, as it
              is by default, then when executed it will read a  key  sequence.
              This  is expected to be bound to a call to a completion function
              that uses the _generic widget.  That widget  will  be  executed,
              and  information  provided  in  the  same  format that the _com-
              plete_help widget displays for contextual completion.

              If the widget's name contains debug, for example if it  is  cre-
              ated as `zle -N _complete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic',
              it will read and execute the keystring for a generic  widget  as
              before, but then generate debugging information as done by _com-
              plete_debug for contextual completion.

              If the widget's  name  contains  noread,  it  will  not  read  a
              keystring  but  instead  arrange  that the next use of a generic
              widget run in the same shell will have the effect  as  described
              above.

              The    widget    works    by   setting   the   shell   parameter
              ZSH_TRACE_GENERIC_WIDGET which is read by  _generic.   Unsetting
              the parameter cancels any pending effect of the noread form.

              For example, after executing the following:

                     zle -N _complete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic
                     bindkey '^x:' _complete_debug_generic

              typing `C-x :' followed by the key sequence for a generic widget
              will cause trace output for that widget to be saved to a file.

       _complete_tag (^Xt)
              This widget completes symbol tags created by the etags or  ctags
              programmes (note there is no connection with the completion sys-
              tem's tags) stored in a file TAGS, in the format used by  etags,
              or  tags,  in the format created by ctags.  It will look back up
              the path hierarchy for the first occurrence of either  file;  if
              both  exist,  the  file  TAGS is preferred.  You can specify the
              full path to a TAGS or tags file by setting the parameter $TAGS-
              FILE  or  $tagsfile  respectively.  The corresponding completion
              tags used are etags and vtags, after emacs and vi respectively.

UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       Descriptions follow for utility functions that may be useful when writ-
       ing  completion  functions.   If functions are installed in subdirecto-
       ries, most of these reside in the Base subdirectory.  Like the  example
       functions  for commands in the distribution, the utility functions gen-
       erating matches all follow the convention of returning status  zero  if
       they  generated  completions  and  non-zero  if no matching completions
       could be added.

       _absolute_command_paths
              This function completes external commands as absolute paths (un-
              like  _command_names  -e  which  completes their basenames).  It
              takes no arguments.

       _all_labels [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ command arg ... ]
              This is a convenient interface to the _next_label  function  be-
              low,  implementing  the  loop  shown in the _next_label example.
              The command  and  its  arguments  are  called  to  generate  the
              matches.  The options stored in the parameter name will automat-
              ically be inserted into the args passed to  the  command.   Nor-
              mally,  they  are  put directly after the command, but if one of
              the args is a single hyphen, they are inserted  directly  before
              that.   If  the  hyphen is the last argument, it will be removed
              from the argument list before the command is called.   This  al-
              lows  _all_labels  to  be  used  in  almost  all cases where the
              matches can be generated by a single call to the compadd builtin
              command or by a call to one of the utility functions.

              For example:

                     local expl
                     ...
                     if _requested foo; then
                       ...
                       _all_labels foo expl '...' compadd ... - $matches
                     fi

              Will complete the strings from the matches parameter, using com-
              padd with additional options which  will  take  precedence  over
              those generated by _all_labels.

       _alternative [ -O name ] [ -C name ] spec ...
              This  function is useful in simple cases where multiple tags are
              available.  Essentially it implements a loop like  the  one  de-
              scribed for the _tags function below.

              The  tags to use and the action to perform if a tag is requested
              are described using the specs which are of  the  form:  `tag:de-
              scr:action'.  The tags are offered using _tags and if the tag is
              requested, the action is executed with the given description de-
              scr.   The actions are those accepted by the _arguments function
              (described below), with the following exceptions:
              •      The `->state' and `=...' forms are not supported.

              •      The `((a\:bar b\:baz))' form does not need the  colon  to
                     be  escaped,  since  the  specs  have  no colon-separated
                     fields after the action.

              For example, the action may be a simple function call:

                     _alternative \
                         'users:user:_users' \
                         'hosts:host:_hosts'

              offers usernames and hostnames as possible matches, generated by
              the _users and _hosts functions respectively.

              Like  _arguments,  this function uses _all_labels to execute the
              actions, which will loop over all sets of  tags.   Special  han-
              dling  is only required if there is an additional valid tag, for
              example inside a function called from _alternative.

              The option `-O name' is used in the same way as  by  the  _argu-
              ments  function.  In other words, the elements of the name array
              will be passed to compadd when executing an action.

              Like _tags this function supports the -C option to give  a  dif-
              ferent name for the argument context field.

       _arguments [ -nswWCRS ] [ -A pat ] [ -O name ] [ -M matchspec ]
                  [ : ] spec ...
       _arguments [ opt ... ] -- [ -l ] [ -i pats ] [ -s pair ]
                  [ helpspec ...]
              This  function  can be used to give a complete specification for
              completion for a command whose arguments  follow  standard  UNIX
              option and argument conventions.

              Options Overview

              Options  to _arguments itself must be in separate words, i.e. -s
              -w, not -sw.  The options are followed by  specs  that  describe
              options and arguments of the analyzed command.  To avoid ambigu-
              ity, all options to _arguments itself may be separated from  the
              spec forms by a single colon.

              The  `--' form is used to intuit spec forms from the help output
              of the command being analyzed, and is described in detail below.
              The opts for the `--' form are otherwise the same options as the
              first form.  Note that `-s' following `--' has a distinct  mean-
              ing from `-s' preceding `--', and both may appear.

              The option switches -s, -S, -A, -w, and -W affect how _arguments
              parses the analyzed command line's options.  These switches  are
              useful for commands with standard argument parsing.

              The options of _arguments have the following meanings:

              -n     With  this  option, _arguments sets the parameter NORMARG
                     to the position of  the  first  normal  argument  in  the
                     $words  array, i.e. the position after the end of the op-
                     tions.  If that argument has not been reached, NORMARG is
                     set  to  -1.  The caller should declare `integer NORMARG'
                     if the -n option is passed; otherwise  the  parameter  is
                     not used.

              -s     Enable option stacking for single-letter options, whereby
                     multiple single-letter options may  be  combined  into  a
                     single  word.  For example, the two options `-x' and `-y'
                     may be combined into a single word  `-xy'.   By  default,
                     every  word corresponds to a single option name (`-xy' is
                     a single option named `xy').

                     Options beginning with a single hyphen or plus  sign  are
                     eligible  for  stacking; words beginning with two hyphens
                     are not.

                     Note that -s after -- has a different meaning,  which  is
                     documented  in  the segment entitled `Deriving spec forms
                     from the help output'.

              -w     In combination with -s, allow option stacking even if one
                     or  more  of the options take arguments.  For example, if
                     -x takes an argument, with no -s, `-xy' is considered  as
                     a  single  (unhandled)  option; with -s, -xy is an option
                     with the argument `y'; with both -s and -w,  -xy  is  the
                     option  -x and the option -y with arguments to -x (and to
                     -y, if it takes arguments) still to  come  in  subsequent
                     words.

              -W     This  option takes -w a stage further:  it is possible to
                     complete single-letter options  even  after  an  argument
                     that occurs in the same word.  However, it depends on the
                     action performed whether options will really be completed
                     at  this point.  For more control, use a utility function
                     like _guard as part of the action.

              -C     Modify the curcontext parameter for an action of the form
                     `->state'.  This is discussed in detail below.

              -R     Return  status 300 instead of zero when a $state is to be
                     handled, in the `->string' syntax.

              -S     Do not complete options after a  `--'  appearing  on  the
                     line,  and ignore the `--'.  For example, with -S, in the
                     line

                            foobar -x -- -y

                     the `-x' is considered an option, the `-y' is  considered
                     an argument, and the `--' is considered to be neither.

              -A pat Do  not complete options after the first non-option argu-
                     ment on the line.  pat is a pattern matching all  strings
                     which  are not to be taken as arguments.  For example, to
                     make _arguments stop completing options after  the  first
                     normal argument, but ignoring all strings starting with a
                     hyphen even if they are not described by one of the  opt-
                     specs, the form is `-A "-*"'.

              -O name
                     Pass the elements of the array name as arguments to func-
                     tions called to execute actions.  This  is  discussed  in
                     detail below.

              -M matchspec
                     Use  the match specification matchspec for completing op-
                     tion names and values.  The default matchspec allows par-
                     tial  word completion after `_' and `-', such as complet-
                     ing `-f-b' to `-foo-bar'.  The default matchspec is:
                     r:|[_-]=* r:|=*

              -0     When populating values of the `opt_args' associative  ar-
                     ray,  don't  backslash-escape  colons and backslashes and
                     use NUL rather than colon for  joining  multiple  values.
                     This  option is described in more detail below, under the
                     heading specs: actions.

              specs: overview

              Each of the following forms is a spec describing individual sets
              of options or arguments on the command line being analyzed.

              n:message:action
              n::message:action
                     This  describes  the  n'th  normal argument.  The message
                     will be printed above the matches generated and  the  ac-
                     tion  indicates  what  can  be completed in this position
                     (see below).  If there are two colons before the  message
                     the  argument  is optional.  If the message contains only
                     white space, nothing will be printed  above  the  matches
                     unless the action adds an explanation string itself.

              :message:action
              ::message:action
                     Similar, but describes the next argument, whatever number
                     that happens to be.  If all arguments  are  specified  in
                     this  form  in the correct order the numbers are unneces-
                     sary.

              *:message:action
              *::message:action
              *:::message:action
                     This describes how arguments  (usually  non-option  argu-
                     ments,  those  not  beginning with - or +) are to be com-
                     pleted when neither of the first two forms was  provided.
                     Any number of arguments can be completed in this fashion.

                     With two colons before the message, the words special ar-
                     ray and the CURRENT special parameter are modified to re-
                     fer  only to the normal arguments when the action is exe-
                     cuted or evaluated.  With three colons before the message
                     they  are  modified to refer only to the normal arguments
                     covered by this description.

              optspec
              optspec:...
                     This describes an option.  The colon  indicates  handling
                     for  one  or  more  arguments to the option; if it is not
                     present, the option is assumed to take no arguments.

                     The following forms are available for  the  initial  opt-
                     spec, whether or not the option has arguments.

                     *optspec
                            Here  optspec is one of the remaining forms below.
                            This indicates the following optspec  may  be  re-
                            peated.   Otherwise if the corresponding option is
                            already present on the command line to the left of
                            the cursor it will not be offered again.

                     -optname
                     +optname
                            In  the  simplest form the optspec is just the op-
                            tion name beginning with a minus or a  plus  sign,
                            such as `-foo'.  The first argument for the option
                            (if any) must follow as a separate  word  directly
                            after the option.

                            Either  of `-+optname' and `+-optname' can be used
                            to specify that -optname  and  +optname  are  both
                            valid.

                            In all the remaining forms, the leading `-' may be
                            replaced by or paired with `+' in this way.

                     -optname-
                            The first argument of the  option  must  come  di-
                            rectly  after  the  option  name in the same word.
                            For example, `-foo-:...' specifies that  the  com-
                            pleted   option   and   argument  will  look  like
                            `-fooarg'.

                     -optname+
                            The first argument may  appear  immediately  after
                            optname in the same word, or may appear as a sepa-
                            rate  word  after  the   option.    For   example,
                            `-foo+:...'  specifies  that  the completed option
                            and argument will look like  either  `-fooarg'  or
                            `-foo arg'.

                     -optname=
                            The  argument  may  appear as the next word, or in
                            same word as the option name provided that  it  is
                            separated  from  it by an equals sign, for example
                            `-foo=arg' or `-foo arg'.

                     -optname=-
                            The argument to the option must  appear  after  an
                            equals sign in the same word, and may not be given
                            in the next argument.

                     optspec[explanation]
                            An explanation string may be appended  to  any  of
                            the  preceding forms of optspec by enclosing it in
                            brackets, as in `-q[query operation]'.

                            The verbose style is used to  decide  whether  the
                            explanation  strings are displayed with the option
                            in a completion listing.

                            If no bracketed explanation string  is  given  but
                            the auto-description style is set and only one ar-
                            gument is described for this optspec, the value of
                            the style is displayed, with any appearance of the
                            sequence `%d' in it replaced by the message of the
                            first optarg that follows the optspec; see below.

                     It  is  possible for options with a literal `+' or `=' to
                     appear, but that character must be  quoted,  for  example
                     `-\+'.

                     Each  optarg  following  an  optspec must take one of the
                     following forms:

                     :message:action
                     ::message:action
                            An argument to the option; message and action  are
                            treated  as  for ordinary arguments.  In the first
                            form, the argument is mandatory, and in the second
                            form it is optional.

                            This  group may be repeated for options which take
                            multiple arguments.  In other words, :message1:ac-
                            tion1:message2:action2  specifies  that the option
                            takes two arguments.

                     :*pattern:message:action
                     :*pattern::message:action
                     :*pattern:::message:action
                            This describes multiple arguments.  Only the  last
                            optarg for an option taking multiple arguments may
                            be given in this form.  If the  pattern  is  empty
                            (i.e.  :*:),  all  the remaining words on the line
                            are to be completed as described  by  the  action;
                            otherwise,  all  the  words  up to and including a
                            word matching the pattern are to be completed  us-
                            ing the action.

                            Multiple  colons  are  treated  as for the `*:...'
                            forms for ordinary arguments:  when the message is
                            preceded  by  two  colons, the words special array
                            and the CURRENT  special  parameter  are  modified
                            during  the  execution or evaluation of the action
                            to refer only to the words after the option.  When
                            preceded by three colons, they are modified to re-
                            fer only to the words covered by this description.

              Any literal colon in an optname, message, or action must be pre-
              ceded by a backslash, `\:'.

              Each of the forms above may be preceded by a list in parentheses
              of option names and argument numbers.  If the given option is on
              the  command line, the options and arguments indicated in paren-
              theses  will  not  be  offered.   For  example,  `(-two   -three
              1)-one:...'  completes the option `-one'; if this appears on the
              command line, the options -two and -three and the first ordinary
              argument will not be completed after it.  `(-foo):...' specifies
              an ordinary argument completion; -foo will not be  completed  if
              that argument is already present.

              Other  items may appear in the list of excluded options to indi-
              cate various other items that should not  be  applied  when  the
              current specification is matched: a single star (*) for the rest
              arguments (i.e. a specification of the form  `*:...');  a  colon
              (:) for all normal (non-option-) arguments; and a hyphen (-) for
              all options.  For example, if `(*)' appears before an option and
              the  option  appears  on the command line, the list of remaining
              arguments (those shown in the above table beginning  with  `*:')
              will not be completed.

              To aid in reuse of specifications, it is possible to precede any
              of the forms above with `!'; then the form  will  no  longer  be
              completed,  although  if  the  option or argument appears on the
              command line they will be skipped as normal.  The main  use  for
              this is when the arguments are given by an array, and _arguments
              is called repeatedly for more specific contexts:  on  the  first
              call  `_arguments  $global_options'  is  used, and on subsequent
              calls `_arguments !$^global_options'.

              specs: actions

              In each of the forms above the action determines how completions
              should  be generated.  Except for the `->string' form below, the
              action will be executed by calling the _all_labels  function  to
              process  all  tag labels.  No special handling of tags is needed
              unless a function call introduces a new one.

              The functions called to execute actions will be called with  the
              elements  of  the  array  named by the `-O name' option as argu-
              ments.  This can be used, for example, to pass the same  set  of
              options for the compadd builtin to all actions.

              The forms for action are as follows.

               (single unquoted space)
                     This  is  useful  where an argument is required but it is
                     not possible or desirable to  generate  matches  for  it.
                     The  message will be displayed but no completions listed.
                     Note that even in this case the colon at the end  of  the
                     message  is needed; it may only be omitted when neither a
                     message nor an action is given.

              (item1 item2 ...)
                     One of a list of possible matches, for example:

                            :foo:(foo bar baz)

              ((item1\:desc1 ...))
                     Similar to the above, but with descriptions for each pos-
                     sible  match.   Note the backslash before the colon.  For
                     example,

                            :foo:((a\:bar b\:baz))

                     The matches will be listed together with  their  descrip-
                     tions if the description style is set with the values tag
                     in the context.

              ->string
                     In this form, _arguments processes the arguments and  op-
                     tions  and  then  returns control to the calling function
                     with parameters set to indicate the state of  processing;
                     the  calling function then makes its own arrangements for
                     generating completions.  For example, functions that  im-
                     plement a state machine can use this type of action.

                     Where _arguments encounters action in the `->string' for-
                     mat, it will strip all leading  and  trailing  whitespace
                     from  string  and  set  the array state to the set of all
                     strings for which an action is to be performed.  The ele-
                     ments  of  the  array state_descr are assigned the corre-
                     sponding message field from each optarg  containing  such
                     an action.

                     By default and in common with all other well behaved com-
                     pletion functions, _arguments returns status zero  if  it
                     was  able to add matches and non-zero otherwise. However,
                     if the -R option is given, _arguments will instead return
                     a status of 300 to indicate that $state is to be handled.

                     In  addition  to $state and $state_descr, _arguments also
                     sets  the  global  parameters   `context',   `line'   and
                     `opt_args'  as  described  below,  and does not reset any
                     changes made to the special parameters such as PREFIX and
                     words.  This gives the calling function the choice of re-
                     setting these parameters or propagating changes in them.

                     A function calling _arguments with at  least  one  action
                     containing  a `->string' must therefore declare appropri-
                     ate local parameters:

                            local context state state_descr line
                            typeset -A opt_args

                     to prevent _arguments from altering the  global  environ-
                     ment.

              {eval-string}
                     A string in braces is evaluated as shell code to generate
                     matches.  If the eval-string itself does not  begin  with
                     an opening parenthesis or brace it is split into separate
                     words before execution.

              = action
                     If the action starts with `= ' (an equals  sign  followed
                     by  a  space), _arguments will insert the contents of the
                     argument field of the current context as  the  new  first
                     element  in  the  words  special  array and increment the
                     value of the CURRENT special parameter.  This has the ef-
                     fect  of  inserting a dummy word onto the completion com-
                     mand line while not changing the point at  which  comple-
                     tion is taking place.

                     This  is  most useful with one of the specifiers that re-
                     strict the words on the command line on which the  action
                     is  to  operate  (the  two- and three-colon forms above).
                     One particular use is when an action itself causes _argu-
                     ments  on a restricted range; it is necessary to use this
                     trick to insert an  appropriate  command  name  into  the
                     range  for  the  second  call to _arguments to be able to
                     parse the line.

               word...
              word...
                     This covers all forms other than those above.  If the ac-
                     tion  starts  with  a  space, the remaining list of words
                     will be invoked unchanged.

                     Otherwise it will be  invoked  with  some  extra  strings
                     placed  after the first word; these are to be passed down
                     as options to the compadd builtin.  They ensure that  the
                     state specified by _arguments, in particular the descrip-
                     tions of options and arguments, is  correctly  passed  to
                     the  completion  command.  These additional arguments are
                     taken from the array parameter `expl'; this will  be  set
                     up  before executing the action and hence may be referred
                     to inside it, typically  in  an  expansion  of  the  form
                     `$expl[@]' which preserves empty elements of the array.

              During  the  performance  of the action the array `line' will be
              set to the normal arguments from  the  command  line,  i.e.  the
              words from the command line after the command name excluding all
              options and their arguments.  Options are stored in the associa-
              tive  array `opt_args' with option names as keys and their argu-
              ments as the values.  By default, all colons and backslashes  in
              the  value  are  escaped  with backslashes, and if an option has
              multiple arguments (for example, when using an  optspec  of  the
              form `*optspec'), they are joined with (unescaped) colons.  How-
              ever, if the -0 option was passed, no backslash escaping is per-
              formed,  and multiple values are joined with NUL bytes.  For ex-
              ample, after `zsh -o foo:foo -o bar:bar -o <TAB>', the  contents
              of `opt_args' would be

                     typeset -A opt_args=( [-o]='foo\:foo:bar\:bar:' )

              by default, and

                     typeset -A opt_args=( [-o]=$'foo:foo\x00bar:bar\x00' )

              if _arguments had been called with the -0 option.

              The  parameter  `context'  is  set when returning to the calling
              function to perform an action of the form `->string'.  It is set
              to an array of elements corresponding to the elements of $state.
              Each element is a suitable name for the argument  field  of  the
              context: either a string of the form `option-opt-n' for the n'th
              argument of the option -opt, or a  string  of  the  form  `argu-
              ment-n'  for  the  n'th argument.  For `rest' arguments, that is
              those in the list at the end not handled by position, n  is  the
              string `rest'.  For example, when completing the argument of the
              -o option, the name is `option-o-1', while for the second normal
              (non-option-) argument it is `argument-2'.

              Furthermore,  during  the  evaluation  of the action the context
              name in the curcontext parameter is altered to append  the  same
              string that is stored in the context parameter.

              The  option -C tells _arguments to modify the curcontext parame-
              ter for an action of the form `->state'.  This is  the  standard
              parameter  used  to  keep track of the current context.  Here it
              (and not the context array) should be made local to the  calling
              function  to avoid passing back the modified value and should be
              initialised to the current value at the start of the function:

                     local curcontext="$curcontext"

              This is useful where it is not possible for multiple  states  to
              be valid together.

              Grouping Options

              Options  can  be grouped to simplify exclusion lists. A group is
              introduced with `+' followed by a name for the group in the sub-
              sequent  word.  Whole groups can then be referenced in an exclu-
              sion list or a group name can be used  to  disambiguate  between
              two forms of the same option. For example:

                     _arguments \
                         '(group2--x)-a' \
                       + group1 \
                         -m \
                         '(group2)-n' \
                       + group2 \
                         -x -y

              If  the  name  of a group is specified in the form `(name)' then
              only one value from that group will ever be completed; more for-
              mally,  all  specifications  are mutually exclusive to all other
              specifications in that group. This is useful  for  defining  op-
              tions that are aliases for each other. For example:

                     _arguments \
                         -a -b \
                       + '(operation)' \
                         {-c,--compress}'[compress]' \
                         {-d,--decompress}'[decompress]' \
                         {-l,--list}'[list]'

              If  an  option  in  a  group  appears on the command line, it is
              stored in the associative array `opt_args'  with  'group-option'
              as a key.  In the example above, a key `operation--c' is used if
              the option `-c' is present on the command line.

              Specifying Multiple Sets of Arguments

              It is possible to specify multiple sets of options and arguments
              with  the  sets  separated  by single hyphens. This differs from
              groups in that sets are considered to be mutually  exclusive  of
              each other.

              Specifications  before the first set and from any group are com-
              mon to all sets. For example:

                     _arguments \
                         -a \
                       - set1 \
                         -c \
                       - set2 \
                         -d \
                         ':arg:(x2 y2)'

              This defines two sets.  When the command line contains  the  op-
              tion  `-c', the `-d' option and the argument will not be consid-
              ered possible completions.  When it contains `-d'  or  an  argu-
              ment,  the  option  `-c' will not be considered.  However, after
              `-a' both sets will still be considered valid.

              As for groups, the name of a set may appear in exclusion  lists,
              either alone or preceding a normal option or argument specifica-
              tion.

              The completion code has to parse the command line separately for
              each set. This can be slow so sets should only be used when nec-
              essary.  A useful alternative is often an  option  specification
              with  rest-arguments  (as in `-foo:*:...'); here the option -foo
              swallows up all remaining arguments as described by  the  optarg
              definitions.

              Deriving spec forms from the help output

              The  option `--' allows _arguments to work out the names of long
              options that support the `--help' option which  is  standard  in
              many GNU commands.  The command word is called with the argument
              `--help' and the output examined for option names.  Clearly,  it
              can  be dangerous to pass this to commands which may not support
              this option as the behaviour of the command is unspecified.

              In addition to options, `_arguments --' will try to  deduce  the
              types   of   arguments  available  for  options  when  the  form
              `--opt=val' is valid.  It is also possible to provide  hints  by
              examining  the  help  text of the command and adding helpspec of
              the form `pattern:message:action'; note  that  other  _arguments
              spec  forms  are  not  used.  The pattern is matched against the
              help text for an option, and if it matches the message  and  ac-
              tion  are  used  as  for other argument specifiers.  The special
              case of `*:' means both message and action are empty, which  has
              the  effect of causing options having no description in the help
              output to be ordered in listings ahead of options  that  have  a
              description.

              For example:

                     _arguments -- '*\*:toggle:(yes no)' \
                                   '*=FILE*:file:_files' \
                                   '*=DIR*:directory:_files -/' \
                                   '*=PATH*:directory:_files -/'

              Here,  `yes'  and  `no' will be completed as the argument of op-
              tions whose description ends in a star; file names will be  com-
              pleted for options that contain the substring `=FILE' in the de-
              scription; and directories will be completed for  options  whose
              description  contains  `=DIR' or `=PATH'.  The last three are in
              fact the default and so need not be given  explicitly,  although
              it is possible to override the use of these patterns.  A typical
              help text which uses this feature is:

                       -C, --directory=DIR          change to directory DIR

              so that the above specifications will cause  directories  to  be
              completed after `--directory', though not after `-C'.

              Note also that _arguments tries to find out automatically if the
              argument for an option is optional.  This can be  specified  ex-
              plicitly by doubling the colon before the message.

              If the pattern ends in `(-)', this will be removed from the pat-
              tern and the action will be used only directly  after  the  `=',
              not  in the next word.  This is the behaviour of a normal speci-
              fication defined with the form `=-'.

              By default, the command (with the option `--help') is run  after
              resetting  all  the  locale  categories (except for LC_CTYPE) to
              `C'.  If the localized help output is known to work, the  option
              `-l' can be specified after the `_arguments --' so that the com-
              mand is run in the current locale.

              The `_arguments --' can be followed by the option `-i  patterns'
              to give patterns for options which are not to be completed.  The
              patterns can be given as the name of an array parameter or as  a
              literal list in parentheses.  For example,

                     _arguments -- -i \
                         "(--(en|dis)able-FEATURE*)"

              will  cause  completion to ignore the options `--enable-FEATURE'
              and `--disable-FEATURE' (this example is useful with GNU config-
              ure).

              The  `_arguments --' form can also be followed by the option `-s
              pair' to describe option aliases.  The pair consists of  a  list
              of alternating patterns and corresponding replacements, enclosed
              in parens and quoted so that it forms a single argument word  in
              the _arguments call.

              For example, some configure-script help output describes options
              only as `--enable-foo', but the script also accepts the  negated
              form `--disable-foo'.  To allow completion of the second form:

                     _arguments -- -s "((#s)--enable- --disable-)"

              Miscellaneous notes

              Finally,  note  that _arguments generally expects to be the pri-
              mary function handling any completion for which it is used.   It
              may  have side effects which change the treatment of any matches
              added by other functions called after it.  To combine _arguments
              with  other  functions,  those functions should be called either
              before _arguments, as an action within a spec,  or  in  handlers
              for `->state' actions.

              Here is a more general example of the use of _arguments:

                     _arguments '-l+:left border:' \
                                '-format:paper size:(letter A4)' \
                                '*-copy:output file:_files::resolution:(300 600)' \
                                ':postscript file:_files -g \*.\(ps\|eps\)' \
                                '*:page number:'

              This describes three options: `-l', `-format', and `-copy'.  The
              first takes one argument described as `left border' for which no
              completion will be offered because of the empty action.  Its ar-
              gument may come directly after the `-l' or it may  be  given  as
              the next word on the line.

              The  `-format'  option  takes one argument in the next word, de-
              scribed as `paper size' for which only the strings `letter'  and
              `A4' will be completed.

              The `-copy' option may appear more than once on the command line
              and takes two arguments.  The first is  mandatory  and  will  be
              completed as a filename.  The second is optional (because of the
              second colon before the description `resolution')  and  will  be
              completed from the strings `300' and `600'.

              The  last two descriptions say what should be completed as argu-
              ments.  The first describes the first argument as a  `postscript
              file' and makes files ending in `ps' or `eps' be completed.  The
              last description gives all other arguments the description `page
              number' but does not offer completions.

       _cache_invalid cache_identifier
              This  function returns status zero if the completions cache cor-
              responding to the given cache identifier needs  rebuilding.   It
              determines  this  by  looking  up the cache-policy style for the
              current context.  This should provide a function name  which  is
              run  with  the  full path to the relevant cache file as the only
              argument.

              Example:

                     _example_caching_policy () {
                         # rebuild if cache is more than a week old
                         local -a oldp
                         oldp=( "$1"(Nm+7) )
                         (( $#oldp ))
                     }

       _call_function return name [ arg ... ]
              If a function name exists, it is called with the arguments args.
              The  return  argument gives the name of a parameter in which the
              return status from the function name should be stored; if return
              is empty or a single hyphen it is ignored.

              The  return status of _call_function itself is zero if the func-
              tion name exists and was called and non-zero otherwise.

       _call_program [ -l ] [ -p ] tag string ...
              This function provides a mechanism for the user to override  the
              use  of an external command.  It looks up the command style with
              the supplied tag.  If the style is set, its value is used as the
              command to execute.  The strings from the call to _call_program,
              or from the style if set, are concatenated with  spaces  between
              them  and  the resulting string is evaluated.  The return status
              is the return status of the command called.

              By default, the command is run in an environment where  all  the
              locale  categories  (except  for  LC_CTYPE)  are reset to `C' by
              calling the utility function _comp_locale (see  below).  If  the
              option  `-l'  is  given, the command is run with the current lo-
              cale.

              If the option `-p' is supplied it  indicates  that  the  command
              output  is  influenced by the permissions it is run with. If the
              gain-privileges style is set to true,  _call_program  will  make
              use of commands such as sudo, if present on the command-line, to
              match the permissions to whatever the final command is likely to
              run  under.  When  looking  up  the  gain-privileges and command
              styles, the command component of the  zstyle  context  will  end
              with a slash (`/') followed by the command that would be used to
              gain privileges.

       _combination [ -s pattern ] tag style spec ... field opts ...
              This function is used to complete combinations of  values,   for
              example  pairs  of  hostnames and usernames.  The style argument
              gives the style which defines the pairs; it is looked  up  in  a
              context with the tag specified.

              The style name consists of field names separated by hyphens, for
              example `users-hosts-ports'.  For each field for a value is  al-
              ready  known,  a spec of the form `field=pattern' is given.  For
              example, if the command line so far specifies a user `pws',  the
              argument `users=pws' should appear.

              The  next  argument  with no equals sign is taken as the name of
              the field for which completions should be generated  (presumably
              not one of the fields for which the value is known).

              The matches generated will be taken from the value of the style.
              These should contain the possible values for the combinations in
              the  appropriate  order  (users,  hosts,  ports  in  the example
              above).  The values for the different fields  are  separated  by
              colons.   This can be altered with the option -s to _combination
              which specifies a pattern.  Typically this is a character class,
              as for example `-s "[:@]"' in the case of the users-hosts style.
              Each `field=pattern'  specification  restricts  the  completions
              which apply to elements of the style with appropriately matching
              fields.

              If no style with the given name is defined for the given tag, or
              if  none  of  the strings in style's value match, but a function
              name of the required field preceded by an underscore is defined,
              that function will be called to generate the matches.  For exam-
              ple, if there is no `users-hosts-ports' or no matching  hostname
              when  a  host  is required, the function `_hosts' will automati-
              cally be called.

              If the same name is used for more than one field,  in  both  the
              `field=pattern'  and  the  argument  that  gives the name of the
              field to be completed, the number of the  field  (starting  with
              one)  may  be  given after the fieldname, separated from it by a
              colon.

              All arguments after the required field name are passed  to  com-
              padd  when  generating  matches  from the style value, or to the
              functions for the fields if they are called.

       _command_names [ -e | - ]
              This function completes words that are valid  at  command  posi-
              tion:  names  of  aliases, builtins, hashed commands, functions,
              and so on.  With the -e flag,  only  hashed  commands  are  com-
              pleted.  The - flag is ignored.

       _comp_locale
              This  function  resets  all  the  locale  categories  other than
              LC_CTYPE to `C' so that the output from external commands can be
              easily  analyzed  by the completion system. LC_CTYPE retains the
              current value (taking LC_ALL and LANG  into  account),  ensuring
              that  non-ASCII characters in file names are still handled prop-
              erly.

              This function should normally be run only in a subshell, because
              the  new  locale  is  exported to the environment. Typical usage
              would be `$(_comp_locale; command ...)'.

       _completers [ -p ]
              This function completes names of completers.

              -p     Include the leading underscore (`_') in the matches.

       _default
              This function corresponds to the -default- special context which
              is applied where no completion is defined.  It is useful to call
              it under certain error conditions such as  completion  after  an
              unrecognised  subcommand.   This applies the concept of graceful
              degradation to the completion system, allowing it to fallback on
              basic completion of commonly useful things like filenames.

       _describe [-12JVx] [ -oO | -t tag ] descr name1 [ name2 ] [ opt ... ]
                 [ -- name1 [ name2 ] [ opt ... ] ... ]
              This  function associates completions with descriptions.  Multi-
              ple groups separated by -- can  be  supplied,  potentially  with
              different completion options opts.

              The  descr  is taken as a string to display above the matches if
              the format style for the descriptions tag is set.  This is  fol-
              lowed  by one or two names of arrays followed by options to pass
              to compadd.  The array name1 contains the  possible  completions
              with  their  descriptions  in the form `completion:description'.
              Any literal colons in completion must be  quoted  with  a  back-
              slash.   If  a name2 is given, it should have the same number of
              elements as name1; in this case the corresponding  elements  are
              added  as possible completions instead of the completion strings
              from name1.  The completion list will  retain  the  descriptions
              from name1.  Finally, a set of completion options can appear.

              If  the  option  `-o'  appears  before  the  first argument, the
              matches added will be treated as names of command options  (N.B.
              not  shell  options),  typically following a `-', `--' or `+' on
              the command line.  In this case _describe uses  the  prefix-hid-
              den, prefix-needed and verbose styles to find out if the strings
              should be added as completions and if the descriptions should be
              shown.   Without the `-o' option, only the verbose style is used
              to decide how descriptions are shown.  If `-O' is  used  instead
              of  `-o',  command  options are completed as above but _describe
              will not handle the prefix-needed style.

              With the -t option a tag can be specified.  The default is `val-
              ues' or, if the -o option is given, `options'.

              The options -1, -2, -J, -V, -x are passed to _next_label.

              If selected by the list-grouped style, strings with the same de-
              scription will appear together in the list.

              _describe uses the _all_labels function to generate the matches,
              so it does not need to appear inside a loop over tag labels.

       _description [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ spec ... ]
              This function is not to be confused with the previous one; it is
              used as a helper function for creating options to  compadd.   It
              is  buried  inside many of the higher level completion functions
              and so often does not need to be called directly.

              The styles listed below are tested in the current context  using
              the  given  tag.  The resulting options for compadd are put into
              the array named name (this is  traditionally  `expl',  but  this
              convention  is  not  enforced).   The description for the corre-
              sponding set of matches is passed to the function in descr.

              The styles tested are: format, hidden, matcher, ignore-line, ig-
              nored-patterns,  group-name and sort.  The format style is first
              tested for the given tag and then for the descriptions tag if no
              value was found, while the remainder are only tested for the tag
              given as the first argument.  The  function  also  calls  _setup
              which tests some more styles.

              The  string  returned by the format style (if any) will be modi-
              fied so that the sequence `%d' is replaced by the descr given as
              the  third argument without any leading or trailing white space.
              If, after removing the white  space,  the  descr  is  the  empty
              string,  the  format  style will not be used and the options put
              into the name array will not contain an explanation string to be
              displayed above the matches.

              If  _description  is  called with more than three arguments, the
              additional specs should be of the form `char:str'.  These supply
              escape sequence replacements for the format style: every appear-
              ance of `%char' will be replaced by string.   If  no  additional
              specs  are given but the description in descr conforms to a com-
              mon form then further escape sequences are set for  elements  of
              that  description.  These elements correspond to a default value
              (`%o'), the units (`%m') range of acceptable values  (`%r')  and
              the  remaining initial part of the description (`%h').  The form
              the description takes consists of specifying the units and range
              in parentheses and the default value in square brackets, for ex-
              ample:

                     _description times expl 'timeout (seconds) (0-60) [20]'

              It is possible  to  use  zformat  conditional  expressions  when
              styling  these elements. So, for example, to add `default:' as a
              tag but only when there is a default value to show,  the  format
              style might include `%(o.default: %o.)'.

              If  the  -x  option  is given, the description will be passed to
              compadd using the -x option instead of  the  default  -X.   This
              means  that  the description will be displayed even if there are
              no corresponding matches.

              The options placed  in  the  array  name  take  account  of  the
              group-name  style,  so  matches  are  placed in a separate group
              where necessary.  The group normally has its elements sorted (by
              passing  the  option  -J  to compadd), but if an option starting
              with `-V', `-J', `-1', or `-2' is passed to  _description,  that
              option  will be included in the array.  Hence it is possible for
              the completion group to be unsorted by giving the  option  `-V',
              `-1V', or `-2V'.

              In most cases, the function will be used like this:

                     local expl
                     _description files expl file
                     compadd "$expl[@]" - "$files[@]"

              Note  the use of the parameter expl, the hyphen, and the list of
              matches.  Almost all calls to compadd within the completion sys-
              tem  use  a  similar  format;  this  ensures that user-specified
              styles are correctly passed down to the builtins which implement
              the internals of completion.

       _dir_list [ -s sep ] [ -S ]
              Complete a list of directory names separated by colons (the same
              format as $PATH).

              -s sep Use sep as separator between items.  sep  defaults  to  a
                     colon (`:').

              -S     Add  sep instead of slash (`/') as an autoremoveable suf-
                     fix.

       _dispatch context string ...
              This sets the current context to context and looks  for  comple-
              tion  functions  to  handle  this context by hunting through the
              list of command names or special contexts  (as  described  above
              for compdef) given as strings.  The first completion function to
              be defined for one of the contexts in the list is used to gener-
              ate  matches.   Typically, the last string is -default- to cause
              the function for default completion to be used as a fallback.

              The function sets the parameter $service  to  the  string  being
              tried,  and  sets  the context/command field (the fourth) of the
              $curcontext parameter to the context given as  the  first  argu-
              ment.

       _email_addresses [ -c ] [ -n plugin ]
              Complete email addresses.  Addresses are provided by plugins.

              -c     Complete  bare  localhost@domain.tld addresses, without a
                     name part or a  comment.   Without  this  option,  RFC822
                     `Firstname Lastname <address>' strings are completed.

              -n plugin
                     Complete aliases from plugin.

              The following plugins are available by default: _email-ldap (see
              the filter style), _email-local  (completes  user@hostname  Unix
              addresses),  _email-mail  (completes  aliases  from  ~/.mailrc),
              _email-mush, _email-mutt, and _email-pine.

              Addresses from the _email-foo plugin are  added  under  the  tag
              `email-foo'.

              Writing plugins

              Plugins  are  written  as separate functions with names starting
              with `_email-'.  They are invoked with the -c option and compadd
              options.   They should either do their own completion or set the
              $reply array to a list of `alias:address'  elements  and  return
              300.  New plugins will be picked up and run automatically.

       _files The function _files is a wrapper around _path_files. It supports
              all of the same functionality, with  some  enhancements  --  no-
              tably,  it  respects  the  list-dirs-first  style, and it allows
              users to override the behaviour of the -g and  -/  options  with
              the  file-patterns  style.  _files should therefore be preferred
              over _path_files in most cases.

              This function  accepts  the  full  set  of  options  allowed  by
              _path_files, described below.

       _gnu_generic
              This function is a simple wrapper around the _arguments function
              described above.  It can be used to determine automatically  the
              long  options  understood  by  commands that produce a list when
              passed the option `--help'.  It is intended  to  be  used  as  a
              top-level completion function in its own right.  For example, to
              enable option completion for the commands foo and bar, use

                     compdef _gnu_generic foo bar

              after the call to compinit.

              The completion system as supplied is conservative in its use  of
              this  function, since it is important to be sure the command un-
              derstands the option `--help'.

       _guard [ options ] pattern descr
              This function displays descr if pattern matches the string to be
              completed.   It  is  intended  to  be used in the action for the
              specifications passed to _arguments and similar functions.

              The return status is zero if the message was displayed  and  the
              word to complete is not empty, and non-zero otherwise.

              The  pattern may be preceded by any of the options understood by
              compadd that are passed down from _description, namely  -M,  -J,
              -V,  -1,  -2,  -n,  -F and -X.  All of these options will be ig-
              nored.  This fits in conveniently with the argument-passing con-
              ventions of actions for _arguments.

              As  an  example,  consider  a  command taking the options -n and
              -none, where -n must be followed by a numeric value in the  same
              word.  By using:

                     _arguments '-n-: :_guard "[0-9]#" "numeric value"' '-none'

              _arguments  can  be  made  to  both display the message `numeric
              value' and complete options after `-n<TAB>'.  If the `-n' is al-
              ready  followed  by  one  or  more digits (the pattern passed to
              _guard) only the message will be displayed; if the `-n' is  fol-
              lowed by another character, only options are completed.

       _message [ -r12 ] [ -VJ group ] descr
       _message -e [ tag ] descr
              The  descr  is used in the same way as the third argument to the
              _description function, except that the resulting string will al-
              ways  be  shown  whether or not matches were generated.  This is
              useful for displaying a help message in places where no  comple-
              tions can be generated.

              The  format  style  is  examined with the messages tag to find a
              message; the usual tag, descriptions, is used only if the  style
              is not set with the former.

              If  the -r option is given, no style is used; the descr is taken
              literally as the string to display.  This is  most  useful  when
              the descr comes from a pre-processed argument list which already
              contains an expanded description.  Note that  this  option  does
              not disable the `%'-sequence parsing done by compadd.

              The  -12VJ options and the group are passed to compadd and hence
              determine the group the message string is added to.

              The second -e form gives a description for completions with  the
              tag  tag  to be shown even if there are no matches for that tag.
              This form is called by _arguments in the event that there is  no
              action  for an option specification.  The tag can be omitted and
              if so the tag is taken from the parameter $curtag; this is main-
              tained by the completion system and so is usually correct.  Note
              that if there are no  matches  at  the  time  this  function  is
              called, compstate[insert] is cleared, so additional matches gen-
              erated later are not inserted on the command line.

       _multi_parts [ -i ] sep array
              The argument sep is a separator character.  The array may be ei-
              ther  the  name  of an array parameter or a literal array in the
              form `(foo bar)', a parenthesised list  of  words  separated  by
              whitespace.   The  possible completions are the strings from the
              array.  However, each chunk delimited by sep will  be  completed
              separately.  For example, the _tar function uses `_multi_parts /
              patharray' to complete partial file paths from the  given  array
              of complete file paths.

              The  -i option causes _multi_parts to insert a unique match even
              if that requires multiple separators to be  inserted.   This  is
              not  usually  the expected behaviour with filenames, but certain
              other types of completion, for example those with a fixed set of
              possibilities, may be more suited to this form.

              Like  other  utility  functions, this function accepts the `-V',
              `-J', `-1', `-2', `-n', `-f',  `-X',  `-M',  `-P',  `-S',  `-r',
              `-R', and `-q' options and passes them to the compadd builtin.

       _next_label [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ option ... ]
              This  function  is used to implement the loop over different tag
              labels for a particular tag as described above for the tag-order
              style.   On each call it checks to see if there are any more tag
              labels; if there is it returns status zero, otherwise  non-zero.
              As  this  function requires a current tag to be set, it must al-
              ways follow a call to _tags or _requested.

              The -x12VJ options and the first three arguments are  passed  to
              the  _description  function.   Where appropriate the tag will be
              replaced by a tag label in this call.  Any description given  in
              the  tag-order  style  is  preferred  to  the  descr  passed  to
              _next_label.

              The options given after the descr are set in the parameter given
              by name, and hence are to be passed to compadd or whatever func-
              tion is called to add the matches.

              Here is a typical use of this function for  the  tag  foo.   The
              call to _requested determines if tag foo is required at all; the
              loop over _next_label handles any labels defined for the tag  in
              the tag-order style.

                     local expl ret=1
                     ...
                     if _requested foo; then
                       ...
                       while _next_label foo expl '...'; do
                         compadd "$expl[@]" ... && ret=0
                       done
                       ...
                     fi
                     return ret

       _normal [ -P | -p precommand ]
              This  is  the standard function called to handle completion out-
              side any special -context-.  It is called both to  complete  the
              command  word and also the arguments for a command.  In the sec-
              ond case, _normal looks for a special completion for  that  com-
              mand,  and  if there is none it uses the completion for the -de-
              fault- context.

              A second use is to reexamine the command line specified  by  the
              $words  array  and  the $CURRENT parameter after those have been
              modified.  For example, the  function  _precommand,  which  com-
              pletes  after  precommand  specifiers such as nohup, removes the
              first word from the words array, decrements the CURRENT  parame-
              ter,  then calls `_normal -p $service'.  The effect is that `no-
              hup cmd ...' is treated in the same way as `cmd ...'.

              -P     Reset the list of precommands. This option should be used
                     if  completing  a command line which allows internal com-
                     mands (e.g. builtins and functions) regardless  of  prior
                     precommands (e.g. `zsh -c').

              -p precommand
                     Append precommand to the list of precommands. This option
                     should be used in nearly all cases in which -P is not ap-
                     plicable.

              If  the command name matches one of the patterns given by one of
              the options -p or -P to compdef,  the  corresponding  completion
              function  is called and then the parameter _compskip is checked.
              If it is set completion is terminated at that point even  if  no
              matches  have  been  found.   This  is the same effect as in the
              -first- context.

       _numbers [ option ... ] [ description ] [ suffix ... ]
              This can be used where a number is followed by a suffix to indi-
              cate the units.  The unit suffixes are completed and can also be
              included in the description used when completion is invoked  for
              the preceding number.

              In addition to common compadd options, _numbers accepts the fol-
              lowing options:

              -t tag Specify a tag to use instead of the default of numbers.

              -u units
                     Indicate the default units for the number, e.g. bytes.

              -l min Specify the lowest possible value for the number.

              -m max Specify the highest possible value for the number.

              -d default
                     Specify the default value.

              -N     Allow negative numbers.  This is implied if the range in-
                     cludes a negative.

              -f     Allow decimal numbers.

              Where  a  particular  suffix  represents the default units for a
              number, it should be prefixed with a colon.  Additionally,  suf-
              fixes  can be followed by a colon and a description.  So for ex-
              ample, the following allows the age of something  to  be  speci-
              fied, either in seconds or with an optional suffix with a longer
              unit of time:

                     _numbers -u seconds age :s:seconds m:minutes h:hours d:days

              It is typically helpful for units to be presented  in  order  of
              magnitude  when  completed.   To  facilitate  this, the order in
              which they are given is preserved.

              When the format style is looked up with the descriptions tag  or
              the  tag specified with -t, the list of suffixes is available as
              a `%x' escape sequence. This is in addition  to  the  usual  se-
              quences  documented  under  the format style. The form this list
              takes can also be configured. To this end, the format  style  is
              first looked up with the tag unit-suffixes. The retrieved format
              is applied to each suffix in turn and the results are then  con-
              catenated to form the completed list. For the unit-suffixes for-
              mat, `%x' expands to the individual suffix and `%X' to  its  de-
              scription.  %d'  indicates a default suffix and can be used in a
              condition. The index and reverse index are set in `%i' and  `%r'
              respectively  and  are  useful  for  text included only with the
              first and last suffixes in the list. So for example, the follow-
              ing joins the suffixes together as a comma-separated list:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:unit-suffixes' format '%x%(r::,)'

       _options
              This  can  be  used  to complete the names of shell options.  It
              provides a matcher specification that ignores  a  leading  `no',
              ignores underscores and allows upper-case letters to match their
              lower-case  counterparts   (for   example,   `glob',   `noglob',
              `NO_GLOB'  are  all completed).  Any arguments are propagated to
              the compadd builtin.

       _options_set and _options_unset
              These functions complete only set or  unset  options,  with  the
              same matching specification used in the _options function.

              Note  that  you  need to uncomment a few lines in the _main_com-
              plete function for these functions to work properly.  The  lines
              in  question are used to store the option settings in effect be-
              fore the completion widget locally sets the  options  it  needs.
              Hence  these  functions are not generally used by the completion
              system.

       _parameters
              This is used to complete the names of shell parameters.

              The option `-g pattern'  limits  the  completion  to  parameters
              whose type matches the pattern.  The type of a parameter is that
              shown by `print ${(t)param}', hence judicious use of `*' in pat-
              tern is probably necessary.

              All other arguments are passed to the compadd builtin.

       _path_files
              This  function  is used throughout the completion system to com-
              plete filenames.  It allows completion of  partial  paths.   For
              example,  the  string `/u/i/s/sig' may be completed to `/usr/in-
              clude/sys/signal.h'.

              The options accepted by both _path_files and _files are:

              -f     Complete all filenames.  This is the default.

              -/     Specifies that only directories should be completed.

              -g pattern
                     Specifies that only files matching the pattern should  be
                     completed.

              -W paths
                     Specifies  path  prefixes that are to be prepended to the
                     string from the command line to  generate  the  filenames
                     but  that should not be inserted as completions nor shown
                     in completion listings.  Here, paths may be the  name  of
                     an  array  parameter, a literal list of paths enclosed in
                     parentheses or an absolute pathname.

              -F ignored-files
                     This behaves as for the corresponding option to the  com-
                     padd  builtin.   It gives direct control over which file-
                     names should be ignored.  If the option is  not  present,
                     the ignored-patterns style is used.

              Both  _path_files  and  _files also accept the following options
              which are passed to compadd: `-J', `-V', `-1', `-2', `-n', `-X',
              `-M', `-P', `-S', `-q', `-r', and `-R'.

              Finally,  the  _path_files function  uses the styles expand, am-
              biguous, special-dirs,  list-suffixes  and  file-sort  described
              above.

       _pick_variant [ -b builtin-label ] [ -c command ] [ -r name ]
                     label=pattern ... label [ arg ... ]
              This  function is used to resolve situations where a single com-
              mand name requires more than one type of  handling,  either  be-
              cause  it  has  more than one variant or because there is a name
              clash between two different commands.

              The command to run is taken from the first element of the  array
              words  unless this is overridden by the option -c.  This command
              is run and its output is compared with  a  series  of  patterns.
              Arguments  to  be  passed to the command can be specified at the
              end after all the other arguments.  The patterns to try in order
              are given by the arguments label=pattern; if the output of `com-
              mand arg ...' contains pattern, then label is  selected  as  the
              label  for  the command variant.  If none of the patterns match,
              the final command label is selected and status 1 is returned.

              If the `-b builtin-label' is given, the command is tested to see
              if  it  is  provided as a shell builtin, possibly autoloaded; if
              so, the label builtin-label is selected as  the  label  for  the
              variant.

              If the `-r name' is given, the label picked is stored in the pa-
              rameter named name.

              The results are also cached in the _cmd_variant associative  ar-
              ray indexed by the name of the command run.

       _regex_arguments name spec ...
              This function generates a completion function name which matches
              the specifications specs, a set of regular  expressions  as  de-
              scribed  below.   After  running  _regex_arguments, the function
              name should be called as a normal completion function.  The pat-
              tern  to  be matched is given by the contents of the words array
              up to the current cursor  position  joined  together  with  null
              characters; no quotation is applied.

              The  arguments  are grouped as sets of alternatives separated by
              `|', which are tried one after  the  other  until  one  matches.
              Each  alternative consists of a one or more specifications which
              are tried  left  to  right,  with  each  pattern  matched  being
              stripped  in  turn from the command line being tested, until all
              of the group succeeds or until one fails; in  the  latter  case,
              the  next  alternative is tried.  This structure can be repeated
              to arbitrary depth by using parentheses; matching proceeds  from
              inside to outside.

              A  special  procedure is applied if no test succeeds but the re-
              maining command line string contains no null character (implying
              the  remaining  word  is the one for which completions are to be
              generated).  The completion target is restricted to the  remain-
              ing word and any actions for the corresponding patterns are exe-
              cuted.  In this case, nothing is stripped from the command  line
              string.   The  order  of evaluation of the actions can be deter-
              mined by the tag-order style; the various formats  supported  by
              _alternative  can be used in action.  The descr is used for set-
              ting up the array parameter expl.

              Specification arguments take one of following  forms,  in  which
              metacharacters such as `(', `)', `#' and `|' should be quoted.

              /pattern/ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
                     This is a single primitive component.  The function tests
                     whether  the  combined  pattern   `(#b)((#B)pattern)look-
                     ahead*'  matches the command line string.  If so, `guard'
                     is evaluated and its return status is examined to  deter-
                     mine  if the test has succeeded.  The pattern string `[]'
                     is guaranteed never  to  match.   The  lookahead  is  not
                     stripped from the command line before the next pattern is
                     examined.

                     The argument starting with : is used in the  same  manner
                     as an argument to _alternative.

                     A  component is used as follows: pattern is tested to see
                     if the component already exists on the command line.   If
                     it  does,  any  following  specifications are examined to
                     find something to complete.  If a  component  is  reached
                     but  no  such pattern exists yet on the command line, the
                     string containing the action is used to generate  matches
                     to insert at that point.

              /pattern/+ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
                     This  is  similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the left part of
                     the command line string (i.e. the part already matched by
                     previous patterns) is also considered part of the comple-
                     tion target.

              /pattern/- [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
                     This is similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the actions of the
                     current  and previously matched patterns are ignored even
                     if the following `pattern' matches the empty string.

              ( spec )
                     Parentheses may be used to groups specs; note each paren-
                     thesis is a single argument to _regex_arguments.

              spec # This allows any number of repetitions of spec.

              spec spec
                     The  two  specs  are to be matched one after the other as
                     described above.

              spec | spec
                     Either of the two specs can be matched.

              The function _regex_words can be used as a  helper  function  to
              generate  matches  for  a set of alternative words possibly with
              their own arguments as a command line argument.

              Examples:

                     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
                         /$'[^\0]#\0'/ :'compadd aaa'

              This generates a function _tst that completes aaa  as  its  only
              argument.   The  tag  and  description  for the action have been
              omitted for brevity (this works but is not recommended in normal
              use).   The  first  component matches the command word, which is
              arbitrary; the second matches  any argument.  As the argument is
              also  arbitrary, any following component would not depend on aaa
              being present.

                     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
                         /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa'

              This is a more typical use; it is  similar,  but  any  following
              patterns  would only match if aaa was present as the first argu-
              ment.

                     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \( \
                         /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \
                         /$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#

              In this example, an indefinite number of command  arguments  may
              be completed.  Odd arguments are completed as aaa and even argu-
              ments as bbb.  Completion fails unless the set of  aaa  and  bbb
              arguments before the current one is matched correctly.

                     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
                         \( /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \| \
                         /$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#

              This  is similar, but either aaa or bbb may be completed for any
              argument.  In this case _regex_words could be used to generate a
              suitable expression for the arguments.

       _regex_words tag description spec ...
              This  function  can  be  used  to  generate  arguments  for  the
              _regex_arguments command which may  be  inserted  at  any  point
              where  a set of rules is expected.  The tag and description give
              a standard tag and description pertaining to  the  current  con-
              text.   Each spec contains two or three arguments separated by a
              colon: note that there is no leading colon in this case.

              Each spec gives one of a set of words that may be  completed  at
              this point, together with arguments.  It is thus roughly equiva-
              lent to the _arguments function when used in normal  (non-regex)
              completion.

              The  part  of  the spec before the first colon is the word to be
              completed.  This may contain a *; the entire  word,  before  and
              after  the * is completed, but only the text before the * is re-
              quired for the context to be matched, so that further  arguments
              may be completed after the abbreviated form.

              The second part of spec is a description for the word being com-
              pleted.

              The optional third part of the spec describes how words  follow-
              ing  the one being completed are themselves to be completed.  It
              will be evaluated in order to avoid problems with quoting.  This
              means  that  typically  it contains a reference to an array con-
              taining previously generated regex arguments.

              The option -t term specifies a terminator for the  word  instead
              of the usual space.  This is handled as an auto-removable suffix
              in the manner of the option -s sep to _values.

              The result of the processing by _regex_words is  placed  in  the
              array reply, which should be made local to the calling function.
              If the set of words and arguments may be matched repeatedly, a #
              should be appended to the generated array at that point.

              For example:

                     local -a reply
                     _regex_words mydb-commands 'mydb commands' \
                       'add:add an entry to mydb:$mydb_add_cmds' \
                       'show:show entries in mydb'
                     _regex_arguments _mydb "$reply[@]"
                     _mydb "$@"

              This  shows a completion function for a command mydb which takes
              two command arguments, add and show.  show takes  no  arguments,
              while the arguments for add have already been prepared in an ar-
              ray  mydb_add_cmds,  quite  possibly  by  a  previous  call   to
              _regex_words.

       _requested [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag [ name descr [ command [ arg ... ] ]
              This  function  is called to decide whether a tag already regis-
              tered by a call to _tags (see below) has been requested  by  the
              user  and  hence  completion should be performed for it.  It re-
              turns status zero if the tag is requested  and  non-zero  other-
              wise.   The  function  is  typically used as part of a loop over
              different tags as follows:

                     _tags foo bar baz
                     while _tags; do
                       if _requested foo; then
                         ... # perform completion for foo
                       fi
                       ... # test the tags bar and baz in the same way
                       ... # exit loop if matches were generated
                     done

              Note that the test for whether matches  were  generated  is  not
              performed  until the end of the _tags loop.  This is so that the
              user can set the tag-order style to specify a set of tags to  be
              completed at the same time.

              If  name  and descr are given, _requested calls the _description
              function with these arguments together with the  options  passed
              to _requested.

              If command is given, the _all_labels function will be called im-
              mediately with the same arguments.  In simple cases  this  makes
              it  possible to perform the test for the tag and the matching in
              one go.  For example:

                     local expl ret=1
                     _tags foo bar baz
                     while _tags; do
                       _requested foo expl 'description' \
                           compadd foobar foobaz && ret=0
                       ...
                       (( ret )) || break
                     done

              If the command is not compadd, it must nevertheless be  prepared
              to handle the same options.

       _retrieve_cache cache_identifier
              This  function  retrieves  completion  information from the file
              given by cache_identifier, stored in a  directory  specified  by
              the  cache-path  style which defaults to ~/.zcompcache.  The re-
              turn status is zero if retrieval was successful.  It  will  only
              attempt retrieval if the use-cache style is set, so you can call
              this function without worrying about whether the user wanted  to
              use the caching layer.

              See _store_cache below for more details.

       _sep_parts
              This function is passed alternating arrays and separators as ar-
              guments.  The arrays specify completions for parts of strings to
              be  separated by the separators.  The arrays may be the names of
              array parameters or a quoted list of words in parentheses.   For
              example,  with the array `hosts=(ftp news)' the call `_sep_parts
              '(foo bar)' @ hosts' will complete the string  `f' to `foo'  and
              the string `b@n' to `bar@news'.

              This  function  accepts  the  compadd  options `-V', `-J', `-1',
              `-2', `-n', `-X', `-M', `-P', `-S', `-r',  `-R',  and  `-q'  and
              passes them on to the compadd builtin used to add the matches.

       _sequence [ -s sep ] [ -n max ] [ -d ] function [ - ] ...
              This  function  is  a  wrapper to other functions for completing
              items in a separated list. The same function is used to complete
              each  item  in  the list. The separator is specified with the -s
              option. If -s is omitted it will use `,'. Duplicate  values  are
              not matched unless -d is specified. If there is a fixed or maxi-
              mum number of items in the list, this can be specified with  the
              -n option.

              Common compadd options are passed on to the function. It is pos-
              sible to use compadd directly with _sequence, though _values may
              be more appropriate in this situation.

       _setup tag [ group ]
              This function sets up the special parameters used by the comple-
              tion system appropriately for the tag given as the  first  argu-
              ment.     It   uses   the   styles   list-colors,   list-packed,
              list-rows-first, last-prompt, accept-exact, menu and force-list.

              The optional group supplies the name of the group in  which  the
              matches  will be placed.  If it is not given, the tag is used as
              the group name.

              This function is  called  automatically  from  _description  and
              hence is not normally called explicitly.

       _store_cache cache_identifier param ...
              This function, together with _retrieve_cache and _cache_invalid,
              implements a caching layer which can be used in  any  completion
              function.   Data obtained by costly operations are stored in pa-
              rameters; this function then dumps the values of  those  parame-
              ters  to  a  file.   The data can then be retrieved quickly from
              that file via _retrieve_cache, even in  different  instances  of
              the shell.

              The cache_identifier specifies the file which the data should be
              dumped to.  The file is stored in a directory specified  by  the
              cache-path style which defaults to ~/.zcompcache.  The remaining
              params arguments are the parameters to dump to the file.

              The return status is zero if storage was successful.  The  func-
              tion will only attempt storage if the use-cache style is set, so
              you can call this function without worrying  about  whether  the
              user wanted to use the caching layer.

              The  completion  function may avoid calling _retrieve_cache when
              it already has the  completion  data  available  as  parameters.
              However,  in  that  case  it should call _cache_invalid to check
              whether the data in the parameters and in the  cache  are  still
              valid.

              See  the  _perl_modules completion function for a simple example
              of the usage of the caching layer.

       _tags [ [ -C name ] tag ... ]
              If called with arguments, these are taken to  be  the  names  of
              tags  valid  for completions in the current context.  These tags
              are stored internally and sorted by using the tag-order style.

              Next, _tags is called repeatedly without arguments from the same
              completion  function.  This successively selects the first, sec-
              ond, etc. set of tags requested by the user.  The return  status
              is  zero  if  at least one of the tags is requested and non-zero
              otherwise.  To test if a particular tag is to be tried, the _re-
              quested function should be called (see above).

              If  `-C  name' is given, name is temporarily stored in the argu-
              ment field (the fifth) of the context in the curcontext  parame-
              ter  during  the  call  to _tags; the field is restored on exit.
              This allows _tags to use a more specific context without  having
              to change and reset the curcontext parameter (which has the same
              effect).

       _tilde_files
              Like _files, but resolve leading tildes according to  the  rules
              of  filename expansion, so the suggested completions don't start
              with a `~' even if the filename on the command-line does.

       _values [ -O name ] [ -s sep ] [ -S sep ] [ -wC ] desc spec ...
              This is used to complete arbitrary keywords (values)  and  their
              arguments, or lists of such combinations.

              If  the  first argument is the option `-O name', it will be used
              in the same way as by the _arguments function.  In other  words,
              the  elements  of  the name array will be passed to compadd when
              executing an action.

              If the first argument (or the first argument after `-O name') is
              `-s',  the next argument is used as the character that separates
              multiple values.  This character is  automatically  added  after
              each  value in an auto-removable fashion (see below); all values
              completed by `_values -s' appear in the same word on the command
              line, unlike completion using _arguments.  If this option is not
              present, only a single value will be completed per word.

              Normally, _values will only use the current  word  to  determine
              which  values  are already present on the command line and hence
              are not to be completed again.  If the -w option is given, other
              arguments are examined as well.

              The  first  non-option  argument,  desc,  is used as a string to
              print as a description before listing the values.

              All other arguments describe the possible values and their argu-
              ments  in the same format used for the description of options by
              the _arguments function (see above).  The only  differences  are
              that  no minus or plus sign is required at the beginning, values
              can have only one argument, and the forms  of  action  beginning
              with an equal sign are not supported.

              The  character  separating  a value from its argument can be set
              using the option -S (like -s, followed by the character  to  use
              as  the  separator in the next argument).  By default the equals
              sign will be used as the separator between values and arguments.

              Example:

                     _values -s , 'description' \
                             '*foo[bar]' \
                             '(two)*one[number]:first count:' \
                             'two[another number]::second count:(1 2 3)'

              This describes three possible values: `foo', `one',  and  `two'.
              The  first  is described as `bar', takes no argument and may ap-
              pear more than once.  The second is described as  `number',  may
              appear  more  than  once,  and  takes one mandatory argument de-
              scribed as `first count'; no action is specified, so it will not
              be  completed.   The  `(two)'  at the beginning says that if the
              value `one' is on the line, the value `two' will  no  longer  be
              considered  a  possible  completion.   Finally,  the  last value
              (`two') is described as `another number' and takes  an  optional
              argument  described  as `second count' for which the completions
              (to appear after an `=') are `1', `2',  and  `3'.   The  _values
              function  will  complete lists of these values separated by com-
              mas.

              Like _arguments, this function temporarily adds another  context
              name  component to the arguments element (the fifth) of the cur-
              rent context while executing the action.  Here this name is just
              the name of the value for which the argument is completed.

              The  style verbose is used to decide if the descriptions for the
              values (but not those for the arguments) should be printed.

              The associative array val_args is  used  to  report  values  and
              their  arguments;  this works similarly to the opt_args associa-
              tive array used by _arguments.  Hence the function calling _val-
              ues  should  declare  the  local  parameters state, state_descr,
              line, context and val_args:

                     local context state state_descr line
                     typeset -A val_args

              when using an action of the form `->string'.  With this function
              the context parameter will be set to the name of the value whose
              argument is to be completed.  Note that for _values,  the  state
              and  state_descr  are scalars rather than arrays.  Only a single
              matching state is returned.

              Note also that _values normally adds the character used  as  the
              separator between values as an auto-removable suffix (similar to
              a `/' after a directory).  However, this is not possible  for  a
              `->string'  action as the matches for the argument are generated
              by the calling function.  To get the usual behaviour, the  call-
              ing  function can add the separator x as a suffix by passing the
              options `-qS x' either directly or indirectly to compadd.

              The option -C is treated in the same way as it is by _arguments.
              In  that  case the parameter curcontext should be made local in-
              stead of context (as described above).

       _wanted [ -x ] [ -C name ]  [ -12VJ ] tag name descr command [ arg ...]
              In many contexts, completion can only  generate  one  particular
              set of matches, usually corresponding to a single tag.  However,
              it is still  necessary  to  decide  whether  the  user  requires
              matches of this type.  This function is useful in such a case.

              The  arguments  to  _wanted are the same as those to _requested,
              i.e. arguments to be passed to _description.  However,  in  this
              case  the  command is not optional;  all the processing of tags,
              including the loop over both tags and tag labels and the genera-
              tion of matches, is carried out automatically by _wanted.

              Hence  to offer only one tag and immediately add the correspond-
              ing matches with the given description:

                     local expl
                     _wanted tag expl 'description' \
                         compadd -- match1 match2...

              See also the use of _wanted in the example function in the  sub-
              section `Dynamic named directories' in zshexpn(1).

              Note that, as for _requested, the command must be able to accept
              options to be passed down to compadd.

              Like _tags this function supports the -C option to give  a  dif-
              ferent  name  for the argument context field.  The -x option has
              the same meaning as for _description.

       _widgets [ -g pattern ]
              This function completes names of zle widgets  (see  the  section
              `Widgets'  in  zshzle(1)).   The pattern, if present, is matched
              against values of the $widgets special parameter, documented  in
              the section `The zsh/zleparameter Module' in zshmodules(1).

COMPLETION SYSTEM VARIABLES
       There  are  some  standard variables, initialised by the _main_complete
       function and then used from other functions.

       The standard variables are:

       _comp_caller_options
              The completion system uses setopt to set a  number  of  options.
              This allows functions to be written without concern for compati-
              bility with every possible combination of user options. However,
              sometimes  completion needs to know what the user's option pref-
              erences are. These are saved in the  _comp_caller_options  asso-
              ciative array. Option names, spelled in lowercase without under-
              scores, are mapped to one or  other  of  the  strings  `on'  and
              `off'.

       _comp_priv_prefix
              Completion functions such as _sudo can set the _comp_priv_prefix
              array to a command prefix that may then be used by _call_program
              to  match  the  privileges  when  calling  programs  to generate
              matches.

       Two more features are offered by the _main_complete function.  The  ar-
       rays compprefuncs and comppostfuncs may contain names of functions that
       are to be called immediately before or after completion has been tried.
       A  function will only be called once unless it explicitly reinserts it-
       self into the array.

COMPLETION DIRECTORIES
       In the source distribution, the files are contained in  various  subdi-
       rectories of the Completion directory.  They may have been installed in
       the same structure, or into one single function directory.  The follow-
       ing  is  a  description  of  the  files found in the original directory
       structure.  If you wish to alter an installed file, you  will  need  to
       copy  it to some directory which appears earlier in your fpath than the
       standard directory where it appears.

       Base   The core functions and special completion widgets  automatically
              bound  to  keys.   You will certainly need most of these, though
              will probably not need to alter them.  Many of these  are  docu-
              mented above.

       Zsh    Functions for completing arguments of shell builtin commands and
              utility functions for this.  Some of  these  are  also  used  by
              functions from the Unix directory.

       Unix   Functions  for  completing  arguments  of  external commands and
              suites of commands.  They may need modifying  for  your  system,
              although in many cases some attempt is made to decide which ver-
              sion of a command is present.  For example, completion  for  the
              mount  command  tries  to determine the system it is running on,
              while completion for many other utilities try to decide  whether
              the  GNU version of the command is in use, and hence whether the
              --help option is supported.

       X, AIX, BSD, ...
              Completion and utility function for commands available  only  on
              some  systems.   These  are not arranged hierarchically, so, for
              example, both the Linux and Debian directories, as well as the X
              directory, may be useful on your system.

ZSHCOMPCTL(1)               General Commands Manual              ZSHCOMPCTL(1)

NAME
       zshcompctl - zsh programmable completion

DESCRIPTION
       This  version  of zsh has two ways of performing completion of words on
       the command line.  New users of the shell may prefer to use  the  newer
       and more powerful system based on shell functions; this is described in
       zshcompsys(1), and the basic shell mechanisms which support it are  de-
       scribed  in  zshcompwid(1).  This manual entry describes the older com-
       pctl command.

       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ command ... ]
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ]
               [ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]
       compctl -M match-specs ...
       compctl -L [ -CDTM ] [ command ... ]
       compctl + command ...

       Control the editor's completion behavior according to the supplied  set
       of options.  Various editing commands, notably expand-or-complete-word,
       usually bound to tab, will attempt to complete  a  word  typed  by  the
       user, while others, notably delete-char-or-list, usually bound to ^D in
       EMACS editing mode, list the possibilities; compctl controls what those
       possibilities  are.  They may for example be filenames (the most common
       case, and  hence  the  default),  shell  variables,  or  words  from  a
       user-specified list.

COMMAND FLAGS
       Completion of the arguments of a command may be different for each com-
       mand or may use the default.  The behavior when completing the  command
       word  itself may also be separately specified.  These correspond to the
       following flags and arguments, all of which (except for -L) may be com-
       bined with any combination of the options described subsequently in the
       section `Option Flags':

       command ...
              controls completion for the named commands, which must be listed
              last on the command line.  If completion is attempted for a com-
              mand with a pathname containing slashes and no completion  defi-
              nition  is  found,  the search is retried with the last pathname
              component. If the command starts with a =, completion  is  tried
              with the pathname of the command.

              Any  of the command strings may be patterns of the form normally
              used for filename generation.  These should be quoted to protect
              them  from  immediate  expansion; for example the command string
              'foo*' arranges for completion of the words of any  command  be-
              ginning  with  foo.   When  completion is attempted, all pattern
              completions are tried in the reverse order of  their  definition
              until one matches.  By default, completion then proceeds as nor-
              mal, i.e. the shell will try to generate more  matches  for  the
              specific  command on the command line; this can be overridden by
              including -tn in the flags for the pattern completion.

              Note that aliases are expanded before the command name is deter-
              mined  unless  the COMPLETE_ALIASES option is set.  Commands may
              not be combined with the -C, -D or -T flags.

       -C     controls completion when the command word itself is  being  com-
              pleted.  If no compctl -C command has been issued,  the names of
              any executable command (whether in the path or specific  to  the
              shell, such as aliases or functions) are completed.

       -D     controls  default  completion behavior for the arguments of com-
              mands not assigned any special behavior.  If no compctl -D  com-
              mand has been issued, filenames are completed.

       -T     supplies completion flags to be used before any other processing
              is done, even before processing for compctls  defined  for  spe-
              cific  commands.   This  is especially useful when combined with
              extended completion (the -x flag, see the section `Extended Com-
              pletion'  below).  Using this flag you can define default behav-
              ior which will apply to all commands without exception,  or  you
              can  alter the standard behavior for all commands.  For example,
              if your access to the user database is too slow and/or  it  con-
              tains  too  many users (so that completion after `~' is too slow
              to be usable), you can use

                     compctl -T -x 's[~] C[0,[^/]#]' -k friends -S/ -tn

              to complete the strings in the array friends after a  `~'.   The
              C[...]  argument  is necessary so that this form of ~-completion
              is not tried after the directory name is finished.

       -L     lists the existing completion behavior in a manner suitable  for
              putting  into  a  start-up  script; the existing behavior is not
              changed.  Any combination of the above forms,  or  the  -M  flag
              (which must follow the -L flag), may be specified, otherwise all
              defined completions are listed.  Any other  flags  supplied  are
              ignored.

       no argument
              If  no  argument is given, compctl lists all defined completions
              in an abbreviated form;  with a list of options, all completions
              with  those  flags  set  (not  counting extended completion) are
              listed.

       If the + flag is alone and followed immediately by  the  command  list,
       the  completion  behavior  for all the commands in the list is reset to
       the default.  In other words, completion will subsequently use the  op-
       tions specified by the -D flag.

       The  form  with -M as the first and only option defines global matching
       specifications (see zshcompwid). The match specifications given will be
       used  for  every  completion attempt (only when using compctl, not with
       the new completion system) and are tried in the order in which they are
       defined until one generates at least one match. E.g.:

              compctl -M '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

       This  will first try completion without any global match specifications
       (the empty string) and, if that generates no matches, will try case in-
       sensitive completion.

OPTION FLAGS
       [ -fcFBdeaRGovNAIOPZEnbjrzu/12 ]
       [ -k array ] [ -g globstring ] [ -s subststring ]
       [ -K function ]
       [ -Q ] [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
       [ -W file-prefix ] [ -H num pattern ]
       [ -q ] [ -X explanation ] [ -Y explanation ]
       [ -y func-or-var ] [ -l cmd ] [ -h cmd ] [ -U ]
       [ -t continue ] [ -J name ] [ -V name ]
       [ -M match-spec ]

       The remaining options specify the type of command arguments to look for
       during completion.  Any combination of these flags  may  be  specified;
       the  result is a sorted list of all the possibilities.  The options are
       as follows.

   Simple Flags
       These produce completion lists made up by the shell itself:

       -f     Filenames and file system paths.

       -/     Just file system paths.

       -c     Command names, including aliases, shell functions, builtins  and
              reserved words.

       -F     Function names.

       -B     Names of builtin commands.

       -m     Names of external commands.

       -w     Reserved words.

       -a     Alias names.

       -R     Names of regular (non-global) aliases.

       -G     Names of global aliases.

       -d     This can be combined with -F, -B, -w, -a, -R and -G to get names
              of disabled functions, builtins, reserved words or aliases.

       -e     This option (to show enabled commands) is in effect by  default,
              but may be combined with -d; -de in combination with -F, -B, -w,
              -a, -R and -G will complete names of  functions,  builtins,  re-
              served words or aliases whether or not they are disabled.

       -o     Names of shell options (see zshoptions(1)).

       -v     Names of any variable defined in the shell.

       -N     Names of scalar (non-array) parameters.

       -A     Array names.

       -I     Names of integer variables.

       -O     Names of read-only variables.

       -p     Names of parameters used by the shell (including special parame-
              ters).

       -Z     Names of shell special parameters.

       -E     Names of environment variables.

       -n     Named directories.

       -b     Key binding names.

       -j     Job names:  the first word of the  job  leader's  command  line.
              This is useful with the kill builtin.

       -r     Names of running jobs.

       -z     Names of suspended jobs.

       -u     User names.

   Flags with Arguments
       These have user supplied arguments to determine how the list of comple-
       tions is to be made up:

       -k array
              Names taken from the elements of $array (note that the `$'  does
              not  appear  on  the command line).  Alternatively, the argument
              array itself may be a set of space- or comma-separated values in
              parentheses,  in which any delimiter may be escaped with a back-
              slash; in this case the argument should be quoted.  For example,

                     compctl -k "(cputime filesize datasize stacksize
                                 coredumpsize resident descriptors)" limit

       -g globstring
              The globstring is expanded using filename globbing; it should be
              quoted  to  protect  it  from immediate expansion. The resulting
              filenames are taken as the possible completions.  Use `*(/)' in-
              stead of `*/' for directories.  The fignore special parameter is
              not applied to the resulting files.  More than one  pattern  may
              be  given separated by blanks. (Note that brace expansion is not
              part of globbing.  Use the syntax `(either|or)' to match  alter-
              natives.)

       -s subststring
              The subststring is split into words and these words are than ex-
              panded using all shell expansion  mechanisms  (see  zshexpn(1)).
              The resulting words are taken as possible completions.  The fig-
              nore special parameter is not applied to  the  resulting  files.
              Note that -g is faster for filenames.

       -K function
              Call the given function to get the completions.  Unless the name
              starts with an underscore, the function is passed two arguments:
              the  prefix and the suffix of the word on which completion is to
              be attempted, in other words those characters before the  cursor
              position, and those from the cursor position onwards.  The whole
              command line can be accessed with the -c and  -l  flags  of  the
              read  builtin.  The function should set the variable reply to an
              array containing the completions (one completion  per  element);
              note  that reply should not be made local to the function.  From
              such a function the command line can be accessed with the -c and
              -l flags to the read builtin.  For example,

                     function whoson { reply=(`users`); }
                     compctl -K whoson talk

              completes only logged-on users after `talk'.  Note that `whoson'
              must return an array, so `reply=`users`' would be incorrect.

       -H num pattern
              The possible completions are taken from  the  last  num  history
              lines.   Only  words matching pattern are taken.  If num is zero
              or negative the whole history is searched and if pattern is  the
              empty  string  all words are taken (as with `*').  A typical use
              is

                     compctl -D -f + -H 0 ''

              which forces completion to look back in the history list  for  a
              word if no filename matches.

   Control Flags
       These do not directly specify types of name to be completed, but manip-
       ulate the options that do:

       -Q     This instructs the shell not to quote any metacharacters in  the
              possible  completions.  Normally the results of a completion are
              inserted into the command line with any metacharacters quoted so
              that  they are interpreted as normal characters.  This is appro-
              priate for filenames and ordinary strings.  However, for special
              effects,  such  as inserting a backquoted expression from a com-
              pletion array (-k) so that the expression will not be  evaluated
              until the complete line is executed, this option must be used.

       -P prefix
              The  prefix  is  inserted  just before the completed string; any
              initial part already typed will be completed and the whole  pre-
              fix ignored for completion purposes.  For example,

                     compctl -j -P "%" kill

              inserts  a  `%'  after  the  kill command and then completes job
              names.

       -S suffix
              When a completion is found the suffix is inserted after the com-
              pleted string.  In the case of menu completion the suffix is in-
              serted immediately, but it is still possible  to  cycle  through
              the list of completions by repeatedly hitting the same key.

       -W file-prefix
              With  directory  file-prefix:   for command, file, directory and
              globbing completion (options -c, -f, -/, -g), the file prefix is
              implicitly added in front of the completion.  For example,

                     compctl -/ -W ~/Mail maildirs

              completes  any subdirectories to any depth beneath the directory
              ~/Mail, although that prefix does  not  appear  on  the  command
              line.   The  file-prefix may also be of the form accepted by the
              -k flag, i.e. the name of an array or a literal list  in  paren-
              thesis.  In  this  case  all the directories in the list will be
              searched for possible completions.

       -q     If used with a suffix as specified by the -S option, this causes
              the  suffix to be removed if the next character typed is a blank
              or does not insert anything or if the suffix  consists  of  only
              one  character  and the next character typed is the same charac-
              ter; this the same rule used for the  AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH  option.
              The  option  is  most  useful for list separators (comma, colon,
              etc.).

       -l cmd This option restricts the range of command line words  that  are
              considered  to  be  arguments.   If combined with one of the ex-
              tended completion patterns `p[...]', `r[...]', or `R[...]'  (see
              the section `Extended Completion' below) the range is restricted
              to the range of arguments specified in the brackets.  Completion
              is then performed as if these had been given as arguments to the
              cmd supplied with the option. If the cmd  string  is  empty  the
              first  word  in  the range is instead taken as the command name,
              and command name completion performed on the first word  in  the
              range.  For example,

                     compctl -x 'r[-exec,;]' -l '' -- find

              completes  arguments  between  `-exec' and the following `;' (or
              the end of the command line if there is no such  string)  as  if
              they were a separate command line.

       -h cmd Normally  zsh completes quoted strings as a whole. With this op-
              tion, completion can be done separately on  different  parts  of
              such  strings. It works like the -l option but makes the comple-
              tion code work on the parts of the current word that  are  sepa-
              rated by spaces. These parts are completed as if they were argu-
              ments to the given cmd. If cmd is the empty  string,  the  first
              part is completed as a command name, as with -l.

       -U     Use  the whole list of possible completions, whether or not they
              actually match the word on the command line.  The word typed  so
              far will be deleted.  This is most useful with a function (given
              by the -K option) which can examine the word  components  passed
              to  it  (or  via the read builtin's -c and -l flags) and use its
              own criteria to decide what matches.  If there is no completion,
              the original word is retained.  Since the produced possible com-
              pletions seldom have interesting common prefixes  and  suffixes,
              menu  completion  is started immediately if AUTO_MENU is set and
              this flag is used.

       -y func-or-var
              The list provided by func-or-var is  displayed  instead  of  the
              list  of  completions whenever a listing is required; the actual
              completions to be inserted are not affected.  It can be provided
              in  two ways. Firstly, if func-or-var begins with a $ it defines
              a variable, or if it begins with a left  parenthesis  a  literal
              array, which contains the list.  A variable may have been set by
              a call to a function using the -K option.  Otherwise it contains
              the  name  of  a  function  which will be executed to create the
              list.  The function will be  passed  as  an  argument  list  all
              matching  completions,  including prefixes and suffixes expanded
              in full, and should set the array reply to the result.  In  both
              cases,  the display list will only be retrieved after a complete
              list of matches has been created.

              Note that the returned list does not have to correspond, even in
              length,  to  the original set of matches, and may be passed as a
              scalar instead of an array.  No special formatting of characters
              is performed on the output in this case; in particular, newlines
              are printed literally and if they appear output  in  columns  is
              suppressed.

       -X explanation
              Print  explanation  when trying completion on the current set of
              options. A `%n' in this string is  replaced  by  the  number  of
              matches that were added for this explanation string.  The expla-
              nation only appears if completion was tried  and  there  was  no
              unique  match,  or when listing completions. Explanation strings
              will be listed together with the matches of the group  specified
              together  with the -X option (using the -J or -V option). If the
              same explanation string is given to  multiple  -X  options,  the
              string  appears  only  once  (for  each group) and the number of
              matches shown for the `%n' is the total number  of  all  matches
              for each of these uses. In any case, the explanation string will
              only be shown if there was at least one match added for the  ex-
              planation string.

              The  sequences  %B,  %b,  %S,  %s, %U, and %u specify output at-
              tributes (bold, standout, and underline), %F, %f, %K, %k specify
              foreground  and  background  colours, and %{...%} can be used to
              include literal escape sequences as in prompts.

       -Y explanation
              Identical to -X, except that the explanation first undergoes ex-
              pansion  following the usual rules for strings in double quotes.
              The expansion will be carried out after any functions are called
              for the -K or -y options, allowing them to set variables.

       -t continue
              The  continue-string  contains  a character that specifies which
              set of completion flags should be used next.  It is useful:

              (i) With -T, or when trying a list of pattern completions,  when
              compctl  would  usually  continue with ordinary processing after
              finding matches; this can be suppressed with `-tn'.

              (ii) With a list of alternatives separated by  +,  when  compctl
              would  normally  stop  when  one  of  the alternatives generates
              matches.  It can be forced to consider the next set  of  comple-
              tions by adding `-t+' to the flags of the alternative before the
              `+'.

              (iii) In an extended completion list (see below),  when  compctl
              would  normally  continue  until  a set of conditions succeeded,
              then use only the immediately following flags.  With `-t-', com-
              pctl  will  continue  trying extended completions after the next
              `-'; with `-tx' it will  attempt  completion  with  the  default
              flags, in other words those before the `-x'.

       -J name
              This  gives  the  name of the group the matches should be placed
              in. Groups are listed and sorted separately; likewise, menu com-
              pletion  will  offer  the  matches in the groups in the order in
              which the groups were defined. If no group  name  is  explicitly
              given,  the  matches  are  stored  in a group named default. The
              first time a group name is encountered, a group with  that  name
              is  created. After that all matches with the same group name are
              stored in that group.

              This can be useful with non-exclusive  alternative  completions.
              For example, in

                     compctl -f -J files -t+ + -v -J variables foo

              both  files  and  variables are possible completions, as the -t+
              forces both sets of alternatives before and after the  +  to  be
              considered  at  once.   Because  of the -J options, however, all
              files are listed before all variables.

       -V name
              Like -J, but matches within the group  will  not  be  sorted  in
              listings  nor in menu completion. These unsorted groups are in a
              different name space from the sorted ones, so groups defined  as
              -J files and -V files are distinct.

       -1     If given together with the -V option, makes only consecutive du-
              plicates in the group be removed.  Note  that  groups  with  and
              without this flag are in different name spaces.

       -2     If given together with the -J or -V option, makes all duplicates
              be kept. Again, groups with and without this flag are in differ-
              ent name spaces.

       -M match-spec
              This  defines  additional  matching  control specifications that
              should be used only when testing words for  the  list  of  flags
              this flag appears in. The format of the match-spec string is de-
              scribed in zshcompwid.

ALTERNATIVE COMPLETION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options + options [ + ... ] [ + ] command ...

       The form with `+' specifies alternative options.  Completion  is  tried
       with the options before the first `+'. If this produces no matches com-
       pletion is tried with the flags after the `+' and so on. If  there  are
       no  flags  after the last `+' and a match has not been found up to that
       point, default completion is tried.  If the list of flags contains a -t
       with  a + character, the next list of flags is used even if the current
       list produced matches.

       Additional options are available that restrict completion to some  part
       of the command line; this is referred to as `extended completion'.

EXTENDED COMPLETION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options -x pattern options - ... --
               [ command ... ]
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ]
               [ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]

       The  form  with  `-x'  specifies  extended  completion for the commands
       given; as shown, it may be combined with alternative  completion  using
       `+'.  Each pattern is examined in turn; when a match is found, the cor-
       responding options, as described in the section `Option  Flags'  above,
       are  used to generate possible completions.  If no pattern matches, the
       options given before the -x are used.

       Note that each pattern should be supplied  as  a  single  argument  and
       should be quoted to prevent expansion of metacharacters by the shell.

       A  pattern  is built of sub-patterns separated by commas; it matches if
       at least one of these sub-patterns matches  (they  are  `or'ed).  These
       sub-patterns  are  in  turn composed of other sub-patterns separated by
       white spaces which match if all of the  sub-patterns  match  (they  are
       `and'ed).  An element of the sub-patterns is of the form `c[...][...]',
       where the pairs of brackets may be repeated as often as necessary,  and
       matches  if  any  of the sets of brackets match (an `or').  The example
       below makes this clearer.

       The elements may be any of the following:

       s[string]...
              Matches if the current word on the command line starts with  one
              of the strings given in brackets.  The string is not removed and
              is not part of the completion.

       S[string]...
              Like s[string] except that the string is part of the completion.

       p[from,to]...
              Matches if the number of the current word is between one of  the
              from  and  to pairs inclusive. The comma and to are optional; to
              defaults to the same value as from.  The numbers  may  be  nega-
              tive: -n refers to the n'th last word on the line.

       c[offset,string]...
              Matches if the string matches the word offset by offset from the
              current word position.  Usually offset will be negative.

       C[offset,pattern]...
              Like c but using pattern matching instead.

       w[index,string]...
              Matches if the word in position index is  equal  to  the  corre-
              sponding  string.   Note  that  the word count is made after any
              alias expansion.

       W[index,pattern]...
              Like w but using pattern matching instead.

       n[index,string]...
              Matches if the current word contains string.  Anything up to and
              including the indexth occurrence of this string will not be con-
              sidered part of the completion, but the rest will.  index may be
              negative  to  count from the end: in most cases, index will be 1
              or -1.  For example,

                     compctl -s '`users`' -x 'n[1,@]' -k hosts -- talk

              will usually complete usernames, but if you insert  an  @  after
              the  name,  names from the array hosts (assumed to contain host-
              names, though you must make the array  yourself)  will  be  com-
              pleted.  Other commands such as rcp can be handled similarly.

       N[index,string]...
              Like  n  except  that  the  string  will be taken as a character
              class.  Anything up to and including the indexth  occurrence  of
              any  of  the characters in string will not be considered part of
              the completion.

       m[min,max]...
              Matches if the total number of words lies between  min  and  max
              inclusive.

       r[str1,str2]...
              Matches  if  the  cursor  is  after a word with prefix str1.  If
              there is also a word with prefix str2 on the command line  after
              the  one matched by str1 it matches only if the cursor is before
              this word. If the comma and str2 are omitted, it matches if  the
              cursor is after a word with prefix str1.

       R[str1,str2]...
              Like r but using pattern matching instead.

       q[str]...
              Matches  the  word currently being completed is in single quotes
              and the str begins with the letter `s', or if completion is done
              in  double quotes and str starts with the letter `d', or if com-
              pletion is done in backticks and str starts with a `b'.

EXAMPLE
              compctl -u -x 's[+] c[-1,-f],s[-f+]' \
                -g '~/Mail/*(:t)' - 's[-f],c[-1,-f]' -f -- mail

       This is to be interpreted as follows:

       If the current command is mail, then

              if ((the current word begins with + and the previous word is -f)
              or (the current word begins with -f+)), then complete the
              non-directory part (the `:t' glob modifier) of files in the directory
              ~/Mail; else

              if the current word begins with -f or the previous word was -f, then
              complete any file; else

              complete user names.

ZSHMODULES(1)               General Commands Manual              ZSHMODULES(1)

NAME
       zshmodules - zsh loadable modules

DESCRIPTION
       Some optional parts of zsh are in modules, separate from  the  core  of
       the  shell.   Each  of  these  modules may be linked in to the shell at
       build time, or can be dynamically linked while the shell is running  if
       the  installation supports this feature.  Modules are linked at runtime
       with the zmodload command, see zshbuiltins(1).

       The modules that are bundled with the zsh distribution are:

       zsh/attr
              Builtins for manipulating extended attributes (xattr).

       zsh/cap
              Builtins for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability  (privi-
              lege) sets.

       zsh/clone
              A builtin that can clone a running shell onto another terminal.

       zsh/compctl
              The compctl builtin for controlling completion.

       zsh/complete
              The basic completion code.

       zsh/complist
              Completion listing extensions.

       zsh/computil
              A  module  with  utility  builtins needed for the shell function
              based completion system.

       zsh/curses
              curses windowing commands

       zsh/datetime
              Some date/time commands and parameters.

       zsh/db/gdbm
              Builtins for managing associative array parameters tied to  GDBM
              databases.

       zsh/deltochar
              A ZLE function duplicating EMACS' zap-to-char.

       zsh/example
              An example of how to write a module.

       zsh/files
              Some basic file manipulation commands as builtins.

       zsh/langinfo
              Interface to locale information.

       zsh/mapfile
              Access to external files via a special associative array.

       zsh/mathfunc
              Standard  scientific  functions  for use in mathematical evalua-
              tions.

       zsh/nearcolor
              Map colours to the nearest colour in the available palette.

       zsh/newuser
              Arrange for files for new users to be installed.

       zsh/parameter
              Access to internal hash tables via special associative arrays.

       zsh/pcre
              Interface to the PCRE library.

       zsh/param/private
              Builtins for managing private-scoped parameters in function con-
              text.

       zsh/regex
              Interface to the POSIX regex library.

       zsh/sched
              A  builtin  that  provides a timed execution facility within the
              shell.

       zsh/net/socket
              Manipulation of Unix domain sockets

       zsh/stat
              A builtin command interface to the stat system call.

       zsh/system
              A builtin interface to various low-level system features.

       zsh/net/tcp
              Manipulation of TCP sockets

       zsh/termcap
              Interface to the termcap database.

       zsh/terminfo
              Interface to the terminfo database.

       zsh/watch
              Reporting of login and logout events.

       zsh/zftp
              A builtin FTP client.

       zsh/zle
              The Zsh Line Editor, including the bindkey and vared builtins.

       zsh/zleparameter
              Access to internals of the Zsh Line Editor via parameters.

       zsh/zprof
              A module allowing profiling for shell functions.

       zsh/zpty
              A builtin for starting a command in a pseudo-terminal.

       zsh/zselect
              Block and return when file descriptors are ready.

       zsh/zutil
              Some utility builtins, e.g. the one for supporting configuration
              via styles.

THE ZSH/ATTR MODULE
       The  zsh/attr module is used for manipulating extended attributes.  The
       -h option causes all commands to operate on symbolic links  instead  of
       their targets.  The builtins in this module are:

       zgetattr [ -h ] filename attribute [ parameter ]
              Get  the  extended  attribute attribute from the specified file-
              name. If the optional argument parameter is given, the attribute
              is set on that parameter instead of being printed to stdout.

       zsetattr [ -h ] filename attribute value
              Set  the  extended attribute attribute on the specified filename
              to value.

       zdelattr [ -h ] filename attribute
              Remove the extended attribute attribute from the specified file-
              name.

       zlistattr [ -h ] filename [ parameter ]
              List  the  extended  attributes  currently  set on the specified
              filename. If the optional argument parameter is given, the  list
              of  attributes is set on that parameter instead of being printed
              to stdout.

       zgetattr and zlistattr allocate memory dynamically.  If  the  attribute
       or  list of attributes grows between the allocation and the call to get
       them, they return 2.  On all other errors, 1 is returned.  This  allows
       the calling function to check for this case and retry.

THE ZSH/CAP MODULE
       The zsh/cap module is used for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capabil-
       ity sets.  If the operating system does not support this interface, the
       builtins  defined by this module will do nothing.  The builtins in this
       module are:

       cap [ capabilities ]
              Change the shell's process capability sets to the specified  ca-
              pabilities, otherwise display the shell's current capabilities.

       getcap filename ...
              This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.
              It displays the capability sets on each specified filename.

       setcap capabilities filename ...
              This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.
              It  sets  the  capability sets on each specified filename to the
              specified capabilities.

THE ZSH/CLONE MODULE
       The zsh/clone module makes available one builtin command:

       clone tty
              Creates a forked instance of the current shell, attached to  the
              specified  tty.  In the new shell, the PID, PPID and TTY special
              parameters are changed appropriately.  $! is set to zero in  the
              new shell, and to the new shell's PID in the original shell.

              The  return status of the builtin is zero in both shells if suc-
              cessful, and non-zero on error.

              The target of clone should be an unused terminal, such as an un-
              used virtual console or a virtual terminal created by

                     xterm -e sh -c 'trap : INT QUIT TSTP; tty;
                             while :; do sleep 100000000; done'

              Some  words  of  explanation are warranted about this long xterm
              command line: when doing clone on a pseudo-terminal, some  other
              session ("session" meant as a unix session group, or SID) is al-
              ready owning the terminal. Hence the cloned zsh  cannot  acquire
              the pseudo-terminal as a controlling tty. That means two things:

              •      the    job    control    signals    will    go   to   the
                     sh-started-by-xterm process group (that's why we  disable
                     INT  QUIT  and  TSTP  with trap; otherwise the while loop
                     could get suspended or killed)

              •      the cloned shell will have job control disabled, and  the
                     job  control  keys  (control-C,  control-\ and control-Z)
                     will not work.

              This does not apply when cloning to an unused vc.

              Cloning to a used (and unprepared) terminal will result  in  two
              processes  reading  simultaneously  from the same terminal, with
              input bytes going randomly to either process.

              clone is mostly useful  as  a  shell  built-in  replacement  for
              openvt.

THE ZSH/COMPCTL MODULE
       The  zsh/compctl  module makes available two builtin commands. compctl,
       is the old, deprecated way to control completions for ZLE.  See zshcom-
       pctl(1).   The  other builtin command, compcall can be used in user-de-
       fined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).

THE ZSH/COMPLETE MODULE
       The zsh/complete module makes available several builtin commands  which
       can be used in user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).

THE ZSH/COMPLIST MODULE
       The zsh/complist module offers three extensions to completion listings:
       the ability to highlight matches in such a list, the ability to  scroll
       through long lists and a different style of menu completion.

   Colored completion listings
       Whenever one of the parameters ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS is set and the
       zsh/complist module is loaded or  linked  into  the  shell,  completion
       lists will be colored.  Note, however, that complist will not automati-
       cally be loaded if it is not linked in:  on systems with dynamic  load-
       ing, `zmodload zsh/complist' is required.

       The  parameters  ZLS_COLORS  and  ZLS_COLOURS  describe how matches are
       highlighted.  To turn on highlighting an empty value suffices, in which
       case  all  the  default values given below will be used.  The format of
       the value of these parameters is the same as used by the GNU version of
       the  ls  command:  a colon-separated list of specifications of the form
       `name=value'.  The name may be one of the following  strings,  most  of
       which specify file types for which the value will be used.  The strings
       and their default values are:

       no 0   for normal text (i.e. when displaying  something  other  than  a
              matched file)

       fi 0   for regular files

       di 32  for directories

       ln 36  for  symbolic links.  If this has the special value target, sym-
              bolic links are dereferenced and the target file used to  deter-
              mine the display format.

       pi 31  for named pipes (FIFOs)

       so 33  for sockets

       bd 44;37
              for block devices

       cd 44;37
              for character devices

       or none
              for  a symlink to nonexistent file (default is the value defined
              for ln)

       mi none
              for a non-existent file (default is the value defined  for  fi);
              this code is currently not used

       su 37;41
              for files with setuid bit set

       sg 30;43
              for files with setgid bit set

       tw 30;42
              for world writable directories with sticky bit set

       ow 34;43
              for world writable directories without sticky bit set

       sa none
              for  files  with an associated suffix alias; this is only tested
              after specific suffixes, as described below

       st 37;44
              for directories with sticky bit set but not world writable

       ex 35  for executable files

       lc \e[ for the left code (see below)

       rc m   for the right code

       tc 0   for the character indicating the file type  printed after  file-
              names if the LIST_TYPES option is set

       sp 0   for the spaces printed after matches to align the next column

       ec none
              for the end code

       Apart  from  these strings, the name may also be an asterisk (`*') fol-
       lowed by any string. The value given for such a string will be used for
       all  files  whose  name  ends with the string.  The name may also be an
       equals sign (`=') followed by a pattern; the EXTENDED_GLOB option  will
       be  turned  on for evaluation of the pattern.  The value given for this
       pattern will be used for all matches (not just filenames) whose display
       string  are  matched by the pattern.  Definitions for the form with the
       leading equal sign take precedence over the  values  defined  for  file
       types, which in turn take precedence over the form with the leading as-
       terisk (file extensions).

       The leading-equals form also allows different parts  of  the  displayed
       strings  to  be  colored differently.  For this, the pattern has to use
       the `(#b)' globbing flag and pairs of parentheses surrounding the parts
       of  the  strings  that are to be colored differently.  In this case the
       value may consist of more than one color code separated by equal signs.
       The first code will be used for all parts for which no explicit code is
       specified and the following codes will be used for the parts matched by
       the  sub-patterns  in  parentheses.   For  example,  the  specification
       `=(#b)(?)*(?)=0=3=7' will be used for all matches which  are  at  least
       two  characters long and will use the code `3' for the first character,
       `7' for the last character and `0' for the rest.

       All three forms of name may be preceded by a  pattern  in  parentheses.
       If  this  is  given,  the value will be used only for matches in groups
       whose names are matched by the pattern given in the  parentheses.   For
       example,  `(g*)m*=43'  highlights  all  matches  beginning  with `m' in
       groups whose names  begin with `g' using the color code `43'.  In  case
       of the `lc', `rc', and `ec' codes, the group pattern is ignored.

       Note also that all patterns are tried in the order in which they appear
       in the parameter value until the first one matches which is then  used.
       Patterns  may  be  matched  against completions, descriptions (possibly
       with spaces appended for padding), or lines consisting of a  completion
       followed by a description.  For consistent coloring it may be necessary
       to use more than one pattern or a pattern with backreferences.

       When printing a match, the code prints the value of lc, the  value  for
       the  file-type or the last matching specification with a `*', the value
       of rc, the string to display for the match itself, and then  the  value
       of  ec  if that is defined or the values of lc, no, and rc if ec is not
       defined.

       The default values are ISO 6429 (ANSI) compliant and  can  be  used  on
       vt100 compatible terminals such as xterms.  On monochrome terminals the
       default values will have no visible effect.  The colors  function  from
       the  contribution  can be used to get associative arrays containing the
       codes for ANSI terminals (see the section `Other Functions' in  zshcon-
       trib(1)).    For   example,   after   loading  colors,  one  could  use
       `$color[red]'  to  get  the  code  for   foreground   color   red   and
       `$color[bg-green]' for the code for background color green.

       If  the completion system invoked by compinit is used, these parameters
       should not be set directly because the  system  controls  them  itself.
       Instead, the list-colors style should be used (see the section `Comple-
       tion System Configuration' in zshcompsys(1)).

   Scrolling in completion listings
       To enable scrolling through a completion list, the LISTPROMPT parameter
       must  be set.  Its value will be used as the prompt; if it is the empty
       string, a default prompt will be used.  The value may  contain  escapes
       of  the  form  `%x'.   It  supports the escapes `%B', `%b', `%S', `%s',
       `%U', `%u', `%F', `%f', `%K', `%k' and `%{...%}'  used  also  in  shell
       prompts  as well as three pairs of additional sequences: a `%l' or `%L'
       is replaced by the number of the last line shown and the  total  number
       of  lines  in  the form `number/total'; a `%m' or `%M' is replaced with
       the number of the last match shown and the total number of matches; and
       `%p'  or  `%P'  is replaced with `Top', `Bottom' or the position of the
       first line shown in percent of the total number of lines, respectively.
       In  each  of these cases the form with the uppercase letter will be re-
       placed with a string of fixed width, padded to the right  with  spaces,
       while the lowercase form will not be padded.

       If the parameter LISTPROMPT is set, the completion code will not ask if
       the list should be shown.  Instead it immediately starts displaying the
       list,  stopping  after  the  first screenful, showing the prompt at the
       bottom, waiting for a  keypress  after  temporarily  switching  to  the
       listscroll  keymap.   Some  of the zle functions have a special meaning
       while scrolling lists:

       send-break
              stops listing discarding the key pressed

       accept-line, down-history, down-line-or-history
       down-line-or-search, vi-down-line-or-history
              scrolls forward one line

       complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
       expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-complete-or-expand
              scrolls forward one screenful

       accept-search
              stop listing but take no other action

       Every other character stops listing and immediately processes  the  key
       as  usual.   Any key that is not bound in the listscroll keymap or that
       is bound to undefined-key is looked up  in  the  keymap  currently  se-
       lected.

       As for the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters, LISTPROMPT should not
       be set directly when using the shell function based completion  system.
       Instead, the list-prompt style should be used.

   Menu selection
       The  zsh/complist  module also offers an alternative style of selecting
       matches from a list, called menu selection, which can be  used  if  the
       shell is set up to return to the last prompt after showing a completion
       list (see the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option in zshoptions(1)).

       Menu selection can be invoked directly by the  widget  menu-select  de-
       fined  by this module.  This is a standard ZLE widget that can be bound
       to a key in the usual way as described in zshzle(1).

       Alternatively, the parameter MENUSELECT can be set to an integer, which
       gives  the  minimum  number of matches that must be present before menu
       selection is automatically turned on.  This second method requires that
       menu  completion  be  started,  either  directly  from a widget such as
       menu-complete, or due to one of the options MENU_COMPLETE or  AUTO_MENU
       being  set.  If MENUSELECT is set, but is 0, 1 or empty, menu selection
       will always be started during an ambiguous menu completion.

       When using the completion system based on shell functions, the  MENUSE-
       LECT  parameter should not be used (like the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS
       parameters described above).  Instead, the menu style  should  be  used
       with the select=... keyword.

       After  menu  selection is started, the matches will be listed. If there
       are more matches than fit on the screen, only the  first  screenful  is
       shown.   The  matches  to  insert into the command line can be selected
       from this list.  In the list one match is highlighted using  the  value
       for ma from the ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS parameter.  The default value
       for this is `7' which forces the selected match to be highlighted using
       standout  mode  on  a vt100-compatible terminal.  If neither ZLS_COLORS
       nor ZLS_COLOURS is set, the same terminal control sequence as  for  the
       `%S' escape in prompts is used.

       If  there  are  more  matches  than fit on the screen and the parameter
       MENUPROMPT is set, its value will be shown below the matches.  It  sup-
       ports  the  same  escape sequences as LISTPROMPT, but the number of the
       match or line shown will be that of the one where the mark  is  placed.
       If its value is the empty string, a default prompt will be used.

       The  MENUSCROLL  parameter  can  be  used  to  specify  how the list is
       scrolled.  If the parameter is unset, this is done line by line, if  it
       is  set to `0' (zero), the list will scroll half the number of lines of
       the screen.  If the value is positive, it gives the number of lines  to
       scroll  and  if it is negative, the list will be scrolled the number of
       lines of the screen minus the (absolute) value.

       As for the ZLS_COLORS, ZLS_COLOURS and LISTPROMPT  parameters,  neither
       MENUPROMPT  nor  MENUSCROLL should be set directly when using the shell
       function based completion system.  Instead, the select-prompt  and  se-
       lect-scroll styles should be used.

       The completion code sometimes decides not to show all of the matches in
       the list.  These hidden matches are either matches for which  the  com-
       pletion  function  which  added them explicitly requested that they not
       appear in the list (using the -n option of the compadd builtin command)
       or  they  are matches which duplicate a string already in the list (be-
       cause they differ only in things like prefixes or suffixes that are not
       displayed).   In  the list used for menu selection, however, even these
       matches are shown so that it is possible to select them.  To  highlight
       such  matches  the  hi  and  du  capabilities  in  the  ZLS_COLORS  and
       ZLS_COLOURS parameters are supported for hidden matches  of  the  first
       and second kind, respectively.

       Selecting matches is done by moving the mark around using the zle move-
       ment functions.  When not all matches can be shown on the screen at the
       same  time,  the  list will scroll up and down when crossing the top or
       bottom line.  The following zle functions have special  meaning  during
       menu  selection.   Note that the following always perform the same task
       within the menu selection map and cannot be replaced  by  user  defined
       widgets, nor can the set of functions be extended:

       accept-line, accept-search
              accept  the  current  match and leave menu selection (but do not
              cause the command line to be accepted)

       send-break
              leaves menu selection and restores the previous contents of  the
              command line

       redisplay, clear-screen
              execute their normal function without leaving menu selection

       accept-and-hold, accept-and-menu-complete
              accept  the  currently inserted match and continue selection al-
              lowing to select the next match to insert into the line

       accept-and-infer-next-history
              accepts the current match and then tries  completion  with  menu
              selection again;  in the case of files this allows one to select
              a directory and immediately attempt to complete files in it;  if
              there are no matches, a message is shown and one can use undo to
              go back to completion on the previous  level,  every  other  key
              leaves  menu  selection (including the other zle functions which
              are otherwise special during menu selection)

       undo   removes matches inserted during the menu selection by one of the
              three functions before

       down-history, down-line-or-history
       vi-down-line-or-history,  down-line-or-search
              moves the mark one line down

       up-history, up-line-or-history
       vi-up-line-or-history, up-line-or-search
              moves the mark one line up

       forward-char, vi-forward-char
              moves the mark one column right

       backward-char, vi-backward-char
              moves the mark one column left

       forward-word, vi-forward-word
       vi-forward-word-end, emacs-forward-word
              moves the mark one screenful down

       backward-word, vi-backward-word, emacs-backward-word
              moves the mark one screenful up

       vi-forward-blank-word, vi-forward-blank-word-end
              moves the mark to the first line of the next group of matches

       vi-backward-blank-word
              moves the mark to the last line of the previous group of matches

       beginning-of-history
              moves the mark to the first line

       end-of-history
              moves the mark to the last line

       beginning-of-buffer-or-history, beginning-of-line
       beginning-of-line-hist, vi-beginning-of-line
              moves the mark to the leftmost column

       end-of-buffer-or-history, end-of-line
       end-of-line-hist, vi-end-of-line
              moves the mark to the rightmost column

       complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
       expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-expand-or-complete
              moves the mark to the next match

       reverse-menu-complete
              moves the mark to the previous match

       vi-insert
              this toggles between normal and interactive mode; in interactive
              mode the keys bound to self-insert and self-insert-unmeta insert
              into  the  command  line  as  in normal editing mode but without
              leaving menu selection; after each character completion is tried
              again  and the list changes to contain only the new matches; the
              completion widgets make the longest unambiguous  string  be  in-
              serted  in the command line and undo and backward-delete-char go
              back to the previous set of matches

       history-incremental-search-forward
       history-incremental-search-backward
              this starts incremental searches in the list of completions dis-
              played;  in  this  mode,  accept-line  only  leaves  incremental
              search, going back to the normal menu selection mode

       All movement functions wrap around at the edges; any other zle function
       not  listed  leaves  menu  selection and executes that function.  It is
       possible to make widgets in the above list do the  same  by  using  the
       form  of the widget with a `.' in front.  For example, the widget `.ac-
       cept-line' has the effect of leaving menu selection and  accepting  the
       entire command line.

       During  this  selection the widget uses the keymap menuselect.  Any key
       that is not defined in this keymap or that is bound to undefined-key is
       looked  up  in  the  keymap currently selected.  This is used to ensure
       that the most important keys used during selection (namely  the  cursor
       keys,  return,  and  TAB) have sensible defaults.  However, keys in the
       menuselect keymap can be modified directly using  the  bindkey  builtin
       command  (see zshmodules(1)). For example, to make the return key leave
       menu selection without accepting the match currently selected one could
       call

              bindkey -M menuselect '^M' send-break

       after loading the zsh/complist module.

THE ZSH/COMPUTIL MODULE
       The  zsh/computil module adds several builtin commands that are used by
       some of the completion functions in  the  completion  system  based  on
       shell  functions  (see  zshcompsys(1)  ).   Except  for compquote these
       builtin commands are very specialised and  thus  not  very  interesting
       when  writing your own completion functions.  In summary, these builtin
       commands are:

       comparguments
              This is used by the _arguments function to do the  argument  and
              command  line parsing.  Like compdescribe it has an option -i to
              do the parsing and initialize some internal  state  and  various
              options to access the state information to decide what should be
              completed.

       compdescribe
              This is used by the _describe function to build the displays for
              the  matches and to get the strings to add as matches with their
              options.  On the first call one of the options -i or  -I  should
              be  supplied  as the first argument.  In the first case, display
              strings without the descriptions will be generated, in the  sec-
              ond case, the string used to separate the matches from their de-
              scriptions must be given as the second argument and the descrip-
              tions  (if any) will be shown.  All other arguments are like the
              definition arguments to _describe itself.

              Once compdescribe has been called with either the -i or  the  -I
              option,  it  can be repeatedly called with the -g option and the
              names of four parameters  as  its  arguments.   This  will  step
              through  the  different  sets  of matches and store the value of
              compstate[list] in the first scalar, the options for compadd  in
              the  second  array,  the  matches  in  the  third array, and the
              strings to be displayed in the completion listing in the  fourth
              array.  The arrays may then be directly given to compadd to reg-
              ister the matches with the completion code.

       compfiles
              Used by the _path_files function to optimize  complex  recursive
              filename generation (globbing).  It does three things.  With the
              -p and -P options it builds the glob patterns to use,  including
              the  paths  already  handled and trying to optimize the patterns
              with respect to the prefix and suffix  from  the  line  and  the
              match  specification currently used.  The -i option does the di-
              rectory tests for the ignore-parents style  and  the  -r  option
              tests  if  a  component for some of the matches are equal to the
              string on the line and removes all  other  matches  if  that  is
              true.

       compgroups
              Used  by  the  _tags  function to implement the internals of the
              group-order style.  This only takes its arguments  as  names  of
              completion  groups and creates the groups for it (all six types:
              sorted and unsorted, both without removing duplicates, with  re-
              moving all duplicates and with removing consecutive duplicates).

       compquote [ -p ] names ...
              There  may be reasons to write completion functions that have to
              add the matches using the -Q option to compadd and perform quot-
              ing  themselves.  Instead of interpreting the first character of
              the all_quotes key of the compstate special association and  us-
              ing  the  q  flag  for  parameter  expansions,  one can use this
              builtin command.  The arguments are the names of scalar or array
              parameters  and  the  values  of  these parameters are quoted as
              needed for the innermost quoting level.  If  the  -p  option  is
              given,  quoting  is  done  as if there is some prefix before the
              values of the parameters, so that a leading equal sign will  not
              be quoted.

              The  return status is non-zero in case of an error and zero oth-
              erwise.

       comptags
       comptry
              These implement the internals of the tags mechanism.

       compvalues
              Like comparguments, but for the _values function.

THE ZSH/CURSES MODULE
       The zsh/curses module makes available one builtin command  and  various
       parameters.

   Builtin
       zcurses init
       zcurses end
       zcurses addwin targetwin nlines ncols begin_y begin_x [ parentwin ]
       zcurses delwin targetwin
       zcurses refresh [ targetwin ... ]
       zcurses touch targetwin ...
       zcurses move targetwin new_y new_x
       zcurses clear targetwin [ redraw | eol | bot ]
       zcurses position targetwin array
       zcurses char targetwin character
       zcurses string targetwin string
       zcurses border targetwin border
       zcurses attr targetwin [ [+|-]attribute | fg_col/bg_col ] [...]
       zcurses bg targetwin [ [+|-]attribute | fg_col/bg_col | @char ] [...]
       zcurses scroll targetwin [ on | off | [+|-]lines ]
       zcurses input targetwin [ param [ kparam [ mparam ] ] ]
       zcurses mouse [ delay num | [+|-]motion ]
       zcurses timeout targetwin intval
       zcurses querychar targetwin [ param ]
       zcurses resize height width [ endwin | nosave | endwin_nosave ]
              Manipulate  curses  windows.  All uses of this command should be
              bracketed by `zcurses init' to initialise  use  of  curses,  and
              `zcurses  end'  to  end it; omitting `zcurses end' can cause the
              terminal to be in an unwanted state.

              The subcommand addwin creates a window  with  nlines  lines  and
              ncols  columns.  Its upper left corner will be placed at row be-
              gin_y and column begin_x of the screen.  targetwin is  a  string
              and  refers  to  the  name of a window that is not currently as-
              signed.  Note in particular the curses convention that  vertical
              values appear before horizontal values.

              If addwin is given an existing window as the final argument, the
              new window is created as a subwindow of parentwin.  This differs
              from  an  ordinary  new  window in that the memory of the window
              contents is shared with the parent's memory.  Subwindows must be
              deleted  before their parent.  Note that the coordinates of sub-
              windows are relative to the screen,  not  the  parent,  as  with
              other windows.

              Use  the  subcommand  delwin to delete a window created with ad-
              dwin.  Note that end does not  implicitly  delete  windows,  and
              that delwin does not erase the screen image of the window.

              The  window  corresponding  to the full visible screen is called
              stdscr; it always exists after  `zcurses  init'  and  cannot  be
              delete with delwin.

              The  subcommand  refresh  will refresh window targetwin; this is
              necessary to make any pending changes (such  as  characters  you
              have  prepared for output with char) visible on the screen.  re-
              fresh without an argument causes the screen to  be  cleared  and
              redrawn.   If  multiple windows are given, the screen is updated
              once at the end.

              The subcommand touch marks the  targetwins  listed  as  changed.
              This is necessary before refreshing windows if a window that was
              in front of another window (which may be stdscr) is deleted.

              The subcommand move moves the cursor position  in  targetwin  to
              new  coordinates  new_y  and  new_x.   Note  that the subcommand
              string (but not the subcommand char) advances the  cursor  posi-
              tion over the characters added.

              The subcommand clear erases the contents of targetwin.  One (and
              no more than one) of three options may be specified.   With  the
              option  redraw,  in  addition the next refresh of targetwin will
              cause the screen to be cleared and repainted.  With  the  option
              eol,  targetwin is only cleared to the end of the current cursor
              line.  With the option bot, targetwin is cleared to the  end  of
              the  window, i.e everything to the right and below the cursor is
              cleared.

              The subcommand position writes various positions associated with
              targetwin into the array named array.  These are, in order:
              -      The y and x coordinates of the cursor relative to the top
                     left of targetwin
              -      The y and x coordinates of the top left of  targetwin  on
                     the screen
              -      The size of targetwin in y and x dimensions.

              Outputting  characters  and  strings  are  achieved  by char and
              string respectively.

              To draw a border around window targetwin, use border.  Note that
              the  border  is  not  subsequently  handled specially:  in other
              words, the border is simply a set of characters  output  at  the
              edge of the window.  Hence it can be overwritten, can scroll off
              the window, etc.

              The subcommand attr will set  targetwin's  attributes  or  fore-
              ground/background  color  pair for any successive character out-
              put.  Each attribute given on the line may be prepended by  a  +
              to  set  or a - to unset that attribute; + is assumed if absent.
              The attributes supported are blink, bold, dim,  reverse,  stand-
              out, and underline.

              Each  fg_col/bg_col attribute (to be read as `fg_col on bg_col')
              sets the foreground and background color for  character  output.
              The  color  default is sometimes available (in particular if the
              library is ncurses), specifying  the  foreground  or  background
              color  with  which  the  terminal  started.   The color pair de-
              fault/default is always available. To use more than the 8  named
              colors  (red,  green,  etc.)  construct  the fg_col/bg_col pairs
              where fg_col and bg_col are decimal integers, e.g 128/200.   The
              maximum color value is 254 if the terminal supports 256 colors.

              bg overrides the color and other attributes of all characters in
              the window.  Its usual use is to set the  background  initially,
              but  it  will  overwrite the attributes of any characters at the
              time when it is called.  In addition to  the  arguments  allowed
              with  attr,  an argument @char specifies a character to be shown
              in otherwise blank areas of the window.  Owing to limitations of
              curses  this cannot be a multibyte character (use of ASCII char-
              acters only is recommended).  As the specified set of attributes
              override  the existing background, turning attributes off in the
              arguments is not useful, though this does not cause an error.

              The subcommand scroll can be used with on or off to  enabled  or
              disable  scrolling  of  a window when the cursor would otherwise
              move below the window due to typing or output.  It can  also  be
              used with a positive or negative integer to scroll the window up
              or down the given number of lines without changing  the  current
              cursor position (which therefore appears to move in the opposite
              direction relative to the  window).   In  the  second  case,  if
              scrolling is off it is temporarily turned on to allow the window
              to be scrolled.

              The subcommand input reads a single character  from  the  window
              without  echoing it back.  If param is supplied the character is
              assigned to the parameter param, else it is assigned to the  pa-
              rameter REPLY.

              If  both param and kparam are supplied, the key is read in `key-
              pad' mode.  In this mode special keys such as function keys  and
              arrow  keys  return the name of the key in the parameter kparam.
              The key  names  are  the  macros  defined  in  the  curses.h  or
              ncurses.h  with the prefix `KEY_' removed; see also the descrip-
              tion of the parameter zcurses_keycodes below.  Other keys  cause
              a  value  to  be set in param as before.  On a successful return
              only one of param or kparam contains  a  non-empty  string;  the
              other is set to an empty string.

              If  mparam  is also supplied, input attempts to handle mouse in-
              put.  This is only available with  the  ncurses  library;  mouse
              handling  can  be  detected  by  checking for the exit status of
              `zcurses mouse' with no arguments.  If a mouse button is clicked
              (or  double-  or  triple-clicked,  or pressed or released with a
              configurable delay from being clicked) then kparam is set to the
              string  MOUSE,  and  mparam is set to an array consisting of the
              following elements:
              -      An identifier to discriminate  different  input  devices;
                     this is only rarely useful.
              -      The x, y and z coordinates of the mouse click relative to
                     the full screen, as three elements in  that  order  (i.e.
                     the  y coordinate is, unusually, after the x coordinate).
                     The z coordinate is only available for a few unusual  in-
                     put devices and is otherwise set to zero.
              -      Any events that occurred as separate items; usually there
                     will be just one.  An  event  consists  of  PRESSED,  RE-
                     LEASED,  CLICKED,  DOUBLE_CLICKED  or TRIPLE_CLICKED fol-
                     lowed immediately (in the same element) by the number  of
                     the button.
              -      If the shift key was pressed, the string SHIFT.
              -      If the control key was pressed, the string CTRL.
              -      If the alt key was pressed, the string ALT.

              Not  all mouse events may be passed through to the terminal win-
              dow; most terminal emulators  handle  some  mouse  events  them-
              selves.   Note  that the ncurses manual implies that using input
              both with and without mouse handling may cause the mouse  cursor
              to appear and disappear.

              The  subcommand  mouse  can  be used to configure the use of the
              mouse.  There is no window argument; mouse options  are  global.
              `zcurses mouse' with no arguments returns status 0 if mouse han-
              dling is possible, else status 1.  Otherwise, the possible argu-
              ments  (which  may  be combined on the same command line) are as
              follows.  delay num sets the maximum delay in  milliseconds  be-
              tween  press and release events to be considered as a click; the
              value 0 disables click resolution, and the default is one  sixth
              of  a second.  motion proceeded by an optional `+' (the default)
              or - turns on or off reporting of mouse motion  in  addition  to
              clicks,  presses  and releases, which are always reported.  How-
              ever, it appears reports for mouse motion are not currently  im-
              plemented.

              The  subcommand timeout specifies a timeout value for input from
              targetwin.  If intval is negative, `zcurses input' waits indefi-
              nitely  for  a  character  to be typed; this is the default.  If
              intval is zero, `zcurses input' returns immediately; if there is
              typeahead  it is returned, else no input is done and status 1 is
              returned.  If intval is positive, `zcurses input'  waits  intval
              milliseconds  for  input and if there is none at the end of that
              period returns status 1.

              The subcommand querychar queries the character  at  the  current
              cursor  position.   The  return  values  are stored in the array
              named param if supplied, else in the  array  reply.   The  first
              value  is  the  character (which may be a multibyte character if
              the system supports them); the second is the color pair  in  the
              usual  fg_col/bg_col  notation,  or 0 if color is not supported.
              Any attributes other than color that apply to the character,  as
              set with the subcommand attr, appear as additional elements.

              The  subcommand  resize  resizes stdscr and all windows to given
              dimensions (windows that stick out from the new  dimensions  are
              resized  down).  The  underlying  curses  extension (resize_term
              call) can be unavailable. To verify,  zeroes  can  be  used  for
              height  and  width.  If  the  result of the subcommand is 0, re-
              size_term is available (2 otherwise). Tests show  that  resizing
              can  be normally accomplished by calling zcurses end and zcurses
              refresh. The resize subcommand is provided for versatility. Mul-
              tiple  system  configurations  have been checked and zcurses end
              and zcurses refresh are still needed for correct terminal  state
              after  resize.  To invoke them with resize, use endwin argument.
              Using nosave argument will cause new terminal state  to  not  be
              saved internally by zcurses. This is also provided for versatil-
              ity and should normally be not needed.

   Parameters
       ZCURSES_COLORS
              Readonly integer.  The maximum number  of  colors  the  terminal
              supports.   This  value is initialised by the curses library and
              is not available until the first time zcurses init is run.

       ZCURSES_COLOR_PAIRS
              Readonly  integer.   The   maximum   number   of   color   pairs
              fg_col/bg_col  that  may  be defined in `zcurses attr' commands;
              note this limit applies to all color pairs that have  been  used
              whether  or  not  they are currently active.  This value is ini-
              tialised by the curses library and is not  available  until  the
              first time zcurses init is run.

       zcurses_attrs
              Readonly  array.  The attributes supported by zsh/curses; avail-
              able as soon as the module is loaded.

       zcurses_colors
              Readonly array.  The colors supported by  zsh/curses;  available
              as soon as the module is loaded.

       zcurses_keycodes
              Readonly  array.   The values that may be returned in the second
              parameter supplied to `zcurses input' in the order in which they
              are  defined  internally  by  curses.  Not all function keys are
              listed, only F0; curses reserves space for F0 up to F63.

       zcurses_windows
              Readonly array.  The current list of windows, i.e.  all  windows
              that  have  been  created  with `zcurses addwin' and not removed
              with `zcurses delwin'.

THE ZSH/DATETIME MODULE
       The zsh/datetime module makes available one builtin command:

       strftime [ -s scalar | -n ] format [ epochtime [ nanoseconds ] ]
       strftime -r [ -q ] [ -s scalar | -n ] format timestring
              Output the date in the format specified.  With no epochtime, the
              current  system  date/time is used; optionally, epochtime may be
              used to specify the number  of  seconds  since  the  epoch,  and
              nanoseconds  may  additionally  be used to specify the number of
              nanoseconds past the second (otherwise that number is assumed to
              be  0).   See  strftime(3)  for details.  The zsh extensions de-
              scribed in the section EXPANSION OF  PROMPT  SEQUENCES  in  zsh-
              misc(1) are also available.

              -n     Suppress printing a newline after the formatted string.

              -q     Run  quietly; suppress printing of all error messages de-
                     scribed below.  Errors for invalid epochtime  values  are
                     always printed.

              -r     With the option -r (reverse), use format to parse the in-
                     put string timestring and output the  number  of  seconds
                     since  the epoch at which the time occurred.  The parsing
                     is implemented by the system function strptime; see strp-
                     time(3).   This  means that zsh format extensions are not
                     available, but for reverse lookup they are not required.

                     In most implementations of strftime any timezone  in  the
                     timestring  is ignored and the local timezone declared by
                     the TZ environment variable is used; other parameters are
                     set to zero if not present.

                     If  timestring  does not match format the command returns
                     status 1 and prints  an  error  message.   If  timestring
                     matches  format but not all characters in timestring were
                     used, the conversion succeeds but also  prints  an  error
                     message.

                     If  either  of the system functions strptime or mktime is
                     not available, status 2 is returned and an error  message
                     is printed.

              -s scalar
                     Assign the date string (or epoch time in seconds if -r is
                     given) to scalar instead of printing it.

              Note that depending on the system's declared integral time type,
              strftime  may  produce incorrect results for epoch times greater
              than 2147483647 which corresponds to 2038-01-19 03:14:07 +0000.

       The zsh/datetime module makes available  several  parameters;  all  are
       readonly:

       EPOCHREALTIME
              A  floating point value representing the number of seconds since
              the epoch.  The notional  accuracy  is  to  nanoseconds  if  the
              clock_gettime  call  is available and to microseconds otherwise,
              but in practice the range of double precision floating point and
              shell scheduling latencies may be significant effects.

       EPOCHSECONDS
              An  integer  value  representing the number of seconds since the
              epoch.

       epochtime
              An array value containing the number of seconds since the  epoch
              in  the  first  element  and the remainder of the time since the
              epoch in nanoseconds in the second element.  To ensure  the  two
              elements  are consistent the array should be copied or otherwise
              referenced as a single substitution before the values are  used.
              The following idiom may be used:

                     for secs nsecs in $epochtime; do
                       ...
                     done

THE ZSH/DB/GDBM MODULE
       The zsh/db/gdbm module is used to create "tied" associative arrays that
       interface to database files.  If the GDBM interface is  not  available,
       the  builtins defined by this module will report an error.  This module
       is also intended as a prototype for creating additional database inter-
       faces, so the ztie builtin may move to a more generic module in the fu-
       ture.

       The builtins in this module are:

       ztie -d db/gdbm -f filename [ -r ] arrayname
              Open the GDBM database identified by filename and,  if  success-
              ful,  create the associative array arrayname linked to the file.
              To create a local tied array, the parameter must  first  be  de-
              clared,  so  commands similar to the following would be executed
              inside a function scope:

                     local -A sampledb
                     ztie -d db/gdbm -f sample.gdbm sampledb

              The -r option opens the database file for reading only, creating
              a  parameter  with the readonly attribute.  Without this option,
              using `ztie' on a file for which the user does  not  have  write
              permission  is  an  error.   If writable, the database is opened
              synchronously so fields changed  in  arrayname  are  immediately
              written to filename.

              Changes  to  the file modes filename after it has been opened do
              not alter the state of arrayname,  but  `typeset  -r  arrayname'
              works as expected.

       zuntie [ -u ] arrayname ...
              Close  the GDBM database associated with each arrayname and then
              unset the parameter.  The -u option forces an unset  of  parame-
              ters made readonly with `ztie -r'.

              This  happens automatically if the parameter is explicitly unset
              or its local scope (function) ends.  Note that a readonly param-
              eter  may  not  be  explicitly unset, so the only way to unset a
              global parameter created with `ztie -r' is to use `zuntie -u'.

       zgdbmpath parametername
              Put path to database file assigned to parametername  into  REPLY
              scalar.

       zgdbm_tied
              Array holding names of all tied parameters.

       The  fields of an associative array tied to GDBM are neither cached nor
       otherwise stored in memory, they are read from or written to the  data-
       base  on  each  reference.  Thus, for example, the values in a readonly
       array may be changed by a second writer of the same database file.

THE ZSH/DELTOCHAR MODULE
       The zsh/deltochar module makes available two ZLE functions:

       delete-to-char
              Read a character from the keyboard, and delete from  the  cursor
              position  up to and including the next (or, with repeat count n,
              the nth) instance of that  character.   Negative  repeat  counts
              mean delete backwards.

       zap-to-char
              This  behaves  like delete-to-char, except that the final occur-
              rence of the character itself is not deleted.

THE ZSH/EXAMPLE MODULE
       The zsh/example module makes available one builtin command:

       example [ -flags ] [ args ... ]
              Displays the flags and arguments it is invoked with.

       The purpose of the module is to serve as an example of how to  write  a
       module.

THE ZSH/FILES MODULE
       The  zsh/files module makes available some common commands for file ma-
       nipulation as builtins; these commands are probably not needed for many
       normal  situations  but  can be useful in emergency recovery situations
       with constrained resources.  The commands do not implement all features
       now required by relevant standards committees.

       For  all commands, a variant beginning zf_ is also available and loaded
       automatically.  Using the features capability of zmodload will let  you
       load  only  those names you want.  Note that it's possible to load only
       the builtins with zsh-specific names using the following command:

              zmodload -m -F zsh/files b:zf_\*

       The commands loaded by default are:

       chgrp [ -hRs ] group filename ...
              Changes group of files specified.  This is equivalent  to  chown
              with a user-spec argument of `:group'.

       chmod [ -Rs ] mode filename ...
              Changes mode of files specified.

              The specified mode must be in octal.

              The  -R option causes chmod to recursively descend into directo-
              ries, changing the mode of all  files  in  the  directory  after
              changing the mode of the directory itself.

              The -s option is a zsh extension to chmod functionality.  It en-
              ables paranoid behaviour, intended to  avoid  security  problems
              involving  a chmod being tricked into affecting files other than
              the ones intended.  It will refuse to follow symbolic links,  so
              that  (for example) ``chmod 600 /tmp/foo/passwd'' can't acciden-
              tally chmod /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens  to  be  a  link  to
              /etc.  It will also check where it is after leaving directories,
              so that a recursive chmod of a deep directory tree can't end  up
              recursively chmoding /usr as a result of directories being moved
              up the tree.

       chown [ -hRs ] user-spec filename ...
              Changes ownership and group of files specified.

              The user-spec can be in four forms:

              user   change owner to user; do not change group
              user:: change owner to user; do not change group
              user:  change owner to user;  change  group  to  user's  primary
                     group
              user:group
                     change owner to user; change group to group
              :group do not change owner; change group to group

              In each case, the `:' may instead be a `.'.  The rule is that if
              there is a `:' then the separator is `:', otherwise if there  is
              a  `.'  then the separator is `.', otherwise there is no separa-
              tor.

              Each of user and group may be either a username (or group  name,
              as appropriate) or a decimal user ID (group ID).  Interpretation
              as a name takes precedence, if there is an all-numeric  username
              (or group name).

              If  the target is a symbolic link, the -h option causes chown to
              set the ownership of the link instead of its target.

              The -R option causes chown to recursively descend into  directo-
              ries, changing the ownership of all files in the directory after
              changing the ownership of the directory itself.

              The -s option is a zsh extension to chown functionality.  It en-
              ables  paranoid  behaviour,  intended to avoid security problems
              involving a chown being tricked into affecting files other  than
              the  ones intended.  It will refuse to follow symbolic links, so
              that (for example) ``chown luser /tmp/foo/passwd''  can't  acci-
              dentally  chown  /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to be a link to
              /etc.  It will also check where it is after leaving directories,
              so  that a recursive chown of a deep directory tree can't end up
              recursively chowning /usr as a result of directories being moved
              up the tree.

       ln [ -dfhins ] filename dest
       ln [ -dfhins ] filename ... dir
              Creates  hard (or, with -s, symbolic) links.  In the first form,
              the specified destination is created, as a link to the specified
              filename.  In the second form, each of the filenames is taken in
              turn, and linked to a pathname in the specified  directory  that
              has the same last pathname component.

              Normally,  ln  will not attempt to create hard links to directo-
              ries.  This check can be overridden using the -d option.   Typi-
              cally  only the super-user can actually succeed in creating hard
              links to directories.  This does not apply to symbolic links  in
              any case.

              By  default, existing files cannot be replaced by links.  The -i
              option causes the user to be queried  about  replacing  existing
              files.   The  -f  option  causes  existing  files to be silently
              deleted, without querying.  -f takes precedence.

              The -h and -n options are identical and both exist for  compati-
              bility;  either  one  indicates  that if the target is a symlink
              then it should not be dereferenced.  Typically this is  used  in
              combination with -sf so that if an existing link points to a di-
              rectory then it will be removed, instead of followed.   If  this
              option  is used with multiple filenames and the target is a sym-
              bolic link pointing to a directory then the result is an error.

       mkdir [ -p ] [ -m mode ] dir ...
              Creates directories.  With the -p  option,  non-existing  parent
              directories are first created if necessary, and there will be no
              complaint if the directory already exists.  The -m option can be
              used  to  specify  (in  octal) a set of file permissions for the
              created directories, otherwise mode 777 modified by the  current
              umask (see umask(2)) is used.

       mv [ -fi ] filename dest
       mv [ -fi ] filename ... dir
              Moves files.  In the first form, the specified filename is moved
              to the specified destination.  In the second form, each  of  the
              filenames is taken in turn, and moved to a pathname in the spec-
              ified directory that has the same last pathname component.

              By default, the user will be queried before replacing  any  file
              that  the  user  cannot  write  to,  but  writable files will be
              silently removed.  The -i option causes the user to  be  queried
              about  replacing  any  existing files.  The -f option causes any
              existing files to be silently  deleted,  without  querying.   -f
              takes precedence.

              Note  that this mv will not move files across devices.  Histori-
              cal versions of mv, when actual  renaming  is  impossible,  fall
              back  on  copying  and  removing files; if this behaviour is de-
              sired, use cp and rm manually.  This may change in a future ver-
              sion.

       rm [ -dfiRrs ] filename ...
              Removes files and directories specified.

              Normally,  rm will not remove directories (except with the -R or
              -r options).  The -d option causes rm to try  removing  directo-
              ries  with  unlink  (see  unlink(2)),  the  same method used for
              files.  Typically only the super-user can  actually  succeed  in
              unlinking  directories in this way.  -d takes precedence over -R
              and -r.

              By default, the user will be queried before  removing  any  file
              that  the  user  cannot  write  to,  but  writable files will be
              silently removed.  The -i option causes the user to  be  queried
              about  removing  any  files.   The  -f option causes files to be
              silently deleted, without querying, and suppresses all error in-
              dications.  -f takes precedence.

              The  -R  and -r options cause rm to recursively descend into di-
              rectories, deleting all files in the directory  before  removing
              the directory with the rmdir system call (see rmdir(2)).

              The  -s  option  is a zsh extension to rm functionality.  It en-
              ables paranoid behaviour,  intended  to  avoid  common  security
              problems  involving  a  root-run  rm being tricked into removing
              files other than the ones intended.  It will  refuse  to  follow
              symbolic  links,  so  that  (for example) ``rm /tmp/foo/passwd''
              can't accidentally remove /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to  be
              a  link  to  /etc.  It will also check where it is after leaving
              directories, so that a recursive removal  of  a  deep  directory
              tree  can't  end up recursively removing /usr as a result of di-
              rectories being moved up the tree.

       rmdir dir ...
              Removes empty directories specified.

       sync   Calls the system call of the  same  name  (see  sync(2)),  which
              flushes  dirty  buffers to disk.  It might return before the I/O
              has actually been completed.

THE ZSH/LANGINFO MODULE
       The zsh/langinfo module makes available one parameter:

       langinfo
              An associative array that maps langinfo elements to  their  val-
              ues.

              Your implementation may support a number of the following keys:

              CODESET, D_T_FMT, D_FMT, T_FMT, RADIXCHAR, THOUSEP, YESEXPR, NO-
              EXPR,   CRNCYSTR,   ABDAY_{1..7},   DAY_{1..7},   ABMON_{1..12},
              MON_{1..12},   T_FMT_AMPM,   AM_STR,   PM_STR,  ERA,  ERA_D_FMT,
              ERA_D_T_FMT, ERA_T_FMT, ALT_DIGITS

THE ZSH/MAPFILE MODULE
       The zsh/mapfile module provides one special associative array parameter
       of the same name.

       mapfile
              This associative array takes as keys the names of files; the re-
              sulting value is the content of the file.  The value is  treated
              identically  to  any  other  text  coming from a parameter.  The
              value may also be assigned to, in which case the file  in  ques-
              tion  is  written  (whether or not it originally existed); or an
              element may be unset, which will delete the  file  in  question.
              For  example, `vared 'mapfile[myfile]'' works as expected, edit-
              ing the file `myfile'.

              When the array is accessed as a whole, the keys are the names of
              files  in  the  current  directory, and the values are empty (to
              save a huge overhead in memory).   Thus  ${(k)mapfile}  has  the
              same  effect  as  the  glob operator *(D), since files beginning
              with a dot are not special.  Care must be taken with expressions
              such  as  rm  ${(k)mapfile}, which will delete every file in the
              current directory without the usual `rm *' test.

              The parameter mapfile may be made read-only; in that case, files
              referenced may not be written or deleted.

              A  file  may  conveniently be read into an array as one line per
              element with the form `array=("${(f@)mapfile[filename]}")'.  The
              double  quotes  and the `@' are necessary to prevent empty lines
              from being removed.  Note that if the file ends with a  newline,
              the  shell  will split on the final newline, generating an addi-
              tional empty  field;  this  can  be  suppressed  by  using  `ar-
              ray=("${(f@)${mapfile[filename]%$'\n'}}")'.

   Limitations
       Although  reading  and  writing  of the file in question is efficiently
       handled, zsh's internal memory management may be  arbitrarily  baroque;
       however,  mapfile is usually very much more efficient than anything in-
       volving a loop.  Note in particular that the whole contents of the file
       will  always reside physically in memory when accessed (possibly multi-
       ple times, due to standard parameter substitution operations).  In par-
       ticular,  this  means handling of sufficiently long files (greater than
       the machine's swap space, or than the range of the pointer  type)  will
       be incorrect.

       No  errors  are printed or flagged for non-existent, unreadable, or un-
       writable files, as the parameter mechanism is too low in the shell exe-
       cution hierarchy to make this convenient.

       It  is  unfortunate that the mechanism for loading modules does not yet
       allow the user to specify the name of the shell parameter to  be  given
       the special behaviour.

THE ZSH/MATHFUNC MODULE
       The  zsh/mathfunc  module  provides standard mathematical functions for
       use when evaluating mathematical formulae.  The syntax agrees with nor-
       mal C and FORTRAN conventions, for example,

              (( f = sin(0.3) ))

       assigns the sine of 0.3 to the parameter f.

       Most  functions  take  floating  point  arguments and return a floating
       point value.  However, any necessary conversions  from  or  to  integer
       type  will  be  performed  automatically by the shell.  Apart from atan
       with a second argument and the abs, int and float functions, all  func-
       tions  behave as noted in the manual page for the corresponding C func-
       tion, except that any arguments out of range for the function in  ques-
       tion will be detected by the shell and an error reported.

       The  following  functions  take a single floating point argument: acos,
       acosh, asin, asinh, atan, atanh, cbrt, ceil, cos, cosh, erf, erfc, exp,
       expm1,  fabs,  floor,  gamma,  j0, j1, lgamma, log, log10, log1p, log2,
       logb, sin, sinh, sqrt, tan, tanh, y0, y1.  The atan  function  can  op-
       tionally  take  a  second argument, in which case it behaves like the C
       function atan2.  The ilogb function takes a single floating point argu-
       ment, but returns an integer.

       The  function signgam takes no arguments, and returns an integer, which
       is the C variable of the same name, as  described  in  gamma(3).   Note
       that  it  is therefore only useful immediately after a call to gamma or
       lgamma.  Note also that `signgam()' and `signgam' are distinct  expres-
       sions.

       The  functions  min, max, and sum are defined not in this module but in
       the zmathfunc autoloadable function, described in the  section  `Mathe-
       matical Functions' in zshcontrib(1).

       The  following  functions  take two floating point arguments: copysign,
       fmod, hypot, nextafter.

       The following take an integer first argument and a floating point  sec-
       ond argument: jn, yn.

       The  following take a floating point first argument and an integer sec-
       ond argument: ldexp, scalb.

       The function abs does not convert the type of its single  argument;  it
       returns  the absolute value of either a floating point number or an in-
       teger.  The functions float and int  convert  their  arguments  into  a
       floating point or integer value (by truncation) respectively.

       Note  that  the C pow function is available in ordinary math evaluation
       as the `**' operator and is not provided here.

       The function rand48 is available if your system's mathematical  library
       has the function erand48(3).  It returns a pseudo-random floating point
       number between 0 and 1.  It takes a single string optional argument.

       If the argument is not present, the random number seed  is  initialised
       by  three calls to the rand(3) function --- this produces the same ran-
       dom numbers as the next three values of $RANDOM.

       If the argument is present, it gives the name  of  a  scalar  parameter
       where  the  current  random  number  seed will be stored.  On the first
       call, the value must contain at least twelve  hexadecimal  digits  (the
       remainder of the string is ignored), or the seed will be initialised in
       the same manner as for a call to rand48 with no  argument.   Subsequent
       calls  to  rand48(param)  will  then maintain the seed in the parameter
       param as a string of twelve hexadecimal digits, with no base signifier.
       The random number sequences for different parameters are completely in-
       dependent, and are also independent from that used by calls  to  rand48
       with no argument.

       For example, consider

              print $(( rand48(seed) ))
              print $(( rand48() ))
              print $(( rand48(seed) ))

       Assuming  $seed  does  not  exist,  it will be initialised by the first
       call.  In the second call, the default seed is initialised; note,  how-
       ever,  that  because of the properties of rand() there is a correlation
       between the seeds used for the two initialisations, so for more  secure
       uses,  you  should  generate your own 12-byte seed.  The third call re-
       turns to the same sequence of random numbers used in  the  first  call,
       unaffected by the intervening rand48().

THE ZSH/NEARCOLOR MODULE
       The  zsh/nearcolor  module  replaces  colours specified as hex triplets
       with the nearest colour in the 88  or  256  colour  palettes  that  are
       widely  used by terminal emulators.  By default, 24-bit true colour es-
       cape codes are generated when colours are specified using hex triplets.
       These  are  not supported by all terminals.  The purpose of this module
       is to make it easier to define colour preferences in a  form  that  can
       work across a range of terminal emulators.

       Aside  from  the  default colour, the ANSI standard for terminal escape
       codes provides for eight colours. The bright attribute brings  this  to
       sixteen. These basic colours are commonly used in terminal applications
       due to being widely supported. Expanded 88 and 256 colour palettes  are
       also  common and, while the first sixteen colours vary somewhat between
       terminals and configurations, these add a generally consistent and pre-
       dictable set of colours.

       In  order  to use the zsh/nearcolor module, it only needs to be loaded.
       Thereafter, whenever a colour is specified using a hex triplet, it will
       be  compared against each of the available colours and the closest will
       be selected. The first  sixteen  colours  are  never  matched  in  this
       process due to being unpredictable.

       It  isn't  possible  to  reliably detect support for true colour in the
       terminal emulator. It is therefore recommended to be selective in load-
       ing  the  zsh/nearcolor  module.  For example, the following checks the
       COLORTERM environment variable:

              [[ $COLORTERM = *(24bit|truecolor)* ]] || zmodload zsh/nearcolor

       Note that some terminals accept the true color  escape  codes  but  map
       them  internally  to  a more limited palette in a similar manner to the
       zsh/nearcolor module.

THE ZSH/NEWUSER MODULE
       The zsh/newuser module is loaded at boot if it is  available,  the  RCS
       option is set, and the PRIVILEGED option is not set (all three are true
       by default).  This takes place immediately after commands in the global
       zshenv  file  (typically  /etc/zsh/zshenv), if any, have been executed.
       If the module is not available it is silently ignored by the shell; the
       module  may safely be removed from $MODULE_PATH by the administrator if
       it is not required.

       On loading, the module tests if any  of  the  start-up  files  .zshenv,
       .zprofile,  .zshrc or .zlogin exist in the directory given by the envi-
       ronment variable ZDOTDIR, or the user's home directory if that  is  not
       set.   The test is not performed and the module halts processing if the
       shell was in an emulation mode (i.e. had been  invoked  as  some  other
       shell than zsh).

       If none of the start-up files were found, the module then looks for the
       file newuser first in a sitewide directory, usually the  parent  direc-
       tory of the site-functions directory, and if that is not found the mod-
       ule searches in a version-specific directory, usually the parent of the
       functions  directory containing version-specific functions.  (These di-
       rectories  can  be  configured  when  zsh  is  built  using  the  --en-
       able-site-scriptdir=dir  and --enable-scriptdir=dir flags to configure,
       respectively;   the   defaults   are    prefix/share/zsh    and    pre-
       fix/share/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION where the default prefix is /usr/local.)

       If  the file newuser is found, it is then sourced in the same manner as
       a start-up file.  The file is  expected  to  contain  code  to  install
       start-up  files for the user, however any valid shell code will be exe-
       cuted.

       The zsh/newuser module is then unconditionally unloaded.

       Note that it is possible to achieve exactly  the  same  effect  as  the
       zsh/newuser  module  by adding code to /etc/zsh/zshenv.  The module ex-
       ists simply to allow the shell to make arrangements for new users with-
       out  the need for intervention by package maintainers and system admin-
       istrators.

       The  script  supplied  with  the  module  invokes  the  shell  function
       zsh-newuser-install.   This may be invoked directly by the user even if
       the zsh/newuser module is disabled.  Note, however, that if the  module
       is  not installed the function will not be installed either.  The func-
       tion is documented in the section  `User  Configuration  Functions'  in
       zshcontrib(1).

THE ZSH/PARAMETER MODULE
       The  zsh/parameter module gives access to some of the internal hash ta-
       bles used by the shell by defining some special parameters.

       options
              The keys for this associative array are the names of the options
              that  can  be  set  and  unset  using  the  setopt  and unsetopt
              builtins. The value of each key is either the string on  if  the
              option  is currently set, or the string off if the option is un-
              set.  Setting a key to one of these strings is like  setting  or
              unsetting  the option, respectively. Unsetting a key in this ar-
              ray is like setting it to the value off.

       commands
              This array gives access to the command hash table. The keys  are
              the  names of external commands, the values are the pathnames of
              the files that would be executed when the command would  be  in-
              voked.  Setting  a key in this array defines a new entry in this
              table in the same way as with the hash builtin. Unsetting a  key
              as  in  `unset  "commands[foo]"' removes the entry for the given
              key from the command hash table.

       functions
              This associative array maps names of enabled functions to  their
              definitions.  Setting  a  key  in it is like defining a function
              with the name given by the key and the body given by the  value.
              Unsetting a key removes the definition for the function named by
              the key.

       dis_functions
              Like functions but for disabled functions.

       functions_source
              This readonly associative array maps names of enabled  functions
              to the name of the file containing the source of the function.

              For  an  autoloaded  function  that  has already been loaded, or
              marked for autoload with an absolute path, or that has  had  its
              path  resolved  with  `functions -r', this is the file found for
              autoloading, resolved to an absolute path.

              For a function defined within the body of a  script  or  sourced
              file,  this is the name of that file.  In this case, this is the
              exact path originally used to that file, which may be a relative
              path.

              For  any other function, including any defined at an interactive
              prompt or an autoload function whose path has not yet  been  re-
              solved,  this is the empty string.  However, the hash element is
              reported as defined just so long as  the  function  is  present:
              the keys to this hash are the same as those to $functions.

       dis_functions_source
              Like functions_source but for disabled functions.

       builtins
              This  associative array gives information about the builtin com-
              mands currently enabled. The keys are the names of  the  builtin
              commands  and the values are either `undefined' for builtin com-
              mands that will automatically be loaded from a module if invoked
              or `defined' for builtin commands that are already loaded.

       dis_builtins
              Like builtins but for disabled builtin commands.

       reswords
              This array contains the enabled reserved words.

       dis_reswords
              Like reswords but for disabled reserved words.

       patchars
              This array contains the enabled pattern characters.

       dis_patchars
              Like patchars but for disabled pattern characters.

       aliases
              This  maps the names of the regular aliases currently enabled to
              their expansions.

       dis_aliases
              Like aliases but for disabled regular aliases.

       galiases
              Like aliases, but for global aliases.

       dis_galiases
              Like galiases but for disabled global aliases.

       saliases
              Like raliases, but for suffix aliases.

       dis_saliases
              Like saliases but for disabled suffix aliases.

       parameters
              The keys in this associative array are the names of the  parame-
              ters  currently  defined.  The values are strings describing the
              type of the parameter, in the same format used by the t  parame-
              ter  flag,  see  zshexpn(1) .  Setting or unsetting keys in this
              array is not possible.

       modules
              An associative array giving information about modules. The  keys
              are  the  names  of  the  modules  loaded,  registered to be au-
              toloaded, or aliased. The value says which state the named  mod-
              ule  is  in and is one of the strings `loaded', `autoloaded', or
              `alias:name', where name is the name the module is aliased to.

              Setting or unsetting keys in this array is not possible.

       dirstack
              A normal array holding the elements of the directory stack. Note
              that  the  output  of the dirs builtin command includes one more
              directory, the current working directory.

       history
              This associative array maps history event numbers  to  the  full
              history  lines.   Although it is presented as an associative ar-
              ray, the array of all values (${history[@]}) is guaranteed to be
              returned in order from most recent to oldest history event, that
              is, by decreasing history event number.

       historywords
              A special array containing the  words  stored  in  the  history.
              These also appear in most to least recent order.

       jobdirs
              This  associative array maps job numbers to the directories from
              which the job was started (which may not be the  current  direc-
              tory of the job).

              The  keys  of  the associative arrays are usually valid job num-
              bers, and  these  are  the  values  output  with,  for  example,
              ${(k)jobdirs}.   Non-numeric  job  references  may  be used when
              looking up a value; for example, ${jobdirs[%+]}  refers  to  the
              current job.

              See  the  jobs  builtin for how job information is provided in a
              subshell.

       jobtexts
              This associative array maps job numbers to the texts of the com-
              mand lines that were used to start the jobs.

              Handling  of  the  keys of the associative array is as described
              for jobdirs above.

              See the jobs builtin for how job information is  provided  in  a
              subshell.

       jobstates
              This associative array gives information about the states of the
              jobs currently known. The keys are the job numbers and the  val-
              ues  are  strings of the form `job-state:mark:pid=state...'. The
              job-state gives the state the whole job is currently in, one  of
              `running',  `suspended', or `done'. The mark is `+' for the cur-
              rent job, `-' for the previous job and empty otherwise. This  is
              followed  by  one `:pid=state' for every process in the job. The
              pids are, of course, the process IDs and the state describes the
              state of that process.

              Handling  of  the  keys of the associative array is as described
              for jobdirs above.

              See the jobs builtin for how job information is  provided  in  a
              subshell.

       nameddirs
              This  associative  array  maps the names of named directories to
              the pathnames they stand for.

       userdirs
              This associative array maps user names to the pathnames of their
              home directories.

       usergroups
              This  associative array maps names of system groups of which the
              current user is a member to the corresponding group identifiers.
              The  contents  are  the same as the groups output by the id com-
              mand.

       funcfiletrace
              This array contains the absolute line numbers and  corresponding
              file  names  for  the  point where the current function, sourced
              file, or (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval command was  called.   The
              array  is  of  the same length as funcsourcetrace and functrace,
              but differs from funcsourcetrace in that the line and  file  are
              the point of call, not the point of definition, and differs from
              functrace in that all values are absolute line numbers in files,
              rather than relative to the start of a function, if any.

       funcsourcetrace
              This  array  contains  the  file  names  and line numbers of the
              points where the functions, sourced files, and  (if  EVAL_LINENO
              is  set)  eval  commands  currently being executed were defined.
              The line number is the line where the `function name'  or  `name
              ()'  started.   In  the case of an autoloaded function  the line
              number is reported as zero.  The format of each element is file-
              name:lineno.

              For functions autoloaded from a file in native zsh format, where
              only the body of the function occurs in the file, or  for  files
              that have been executed by the source or `.' builtins, the trace
              information is shown as filename:0, since the entire file is the
              definition.   The  source  file  name is resolved to an absolute
              path when the function is loaded or the path to it otherwise re-
              solved.

              Most  users  will  be interested in the information in the func-
              filetrace array instead.

       funcstack
              This array contains the names of the functions,  sourced  files,
              and  (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval commands. currently being exe-
              cuted. The first element is the name of the function  using  the
              parameter.

              The  standard shell array zsh_eval_context can be used to deter-
              mine the type of shell construct being executed at  each  depth:
              note,  however, that is in the opposite order, with the most re-
              cent item last, and it is more detailed, for  example  including
              an entry for toplevel, the main shell code being executed either
              interactively or from a script, which is not present  in  $func-
              stack.

       functrace
              This  array  contains  the names and line numbers of the callers
              corresponding to the functions currently  being  executed.   The
              format  of  each element is name:lineno.  Callers are also shown
              for sourced files; the caller is the point where the  source  or
              `.' command was executed.

THE ZSH/PCRE MODULE
       The zsh/pcre module makes some commands available as builtins:

       pcre_compile [ -aimxs ] PCRE
              Compiles a perl-compatible regular expression.

              Option -a will force the pattern to be anchored.  Option -i will
              compile a case-insensitive pattern.  Option -m  will  compile  a
              multi-line  pattern; that is, ^ and $ will match newlines within
              the pattern.   Option  -x  will  compile  an  extended  pattern,
              wherein  whitespace and # comments are ignored.  Option -s makes
              the dot metacharacter match all characters, including those that
              indicate newline.

       pcre_study
              Studies  the previously-compiled PCRE which may result in faster
              matching.

       pcre_match [ -v var ] [ -a arr ] [ -n offset ] [ -b ] string
              Returns successfully if string matches  the  previously-compiled
              PCRE.

              Upon  successful  match,  if  the expression captures substrings
              within parentheses, pcre_match will set the array match to those
              substrings, unless the -a option is given, in which case it will
              set the array arr.  Similarly, the variable MATCH will be set to
              the  entire  matched portion of the string, unless the -v option
              is given, in which case the variable var will be set.  No  vari-
              ables  are altered if there is no successful match.  A -n option
              starts searching for a match from the byte  offset  position  in
              string.   If  the -b option is given, the variable ZPCRE_OP will
              be set to an offset pair string, representing  the  byte  offset
              positions  of the entire matched portion within the string.  For
              example, a ZPCRE_OP set to "32 45" indicates  that  the  matched
              portion  began  on  byte  offset 32 and ended on byte offset 44.
              Here, byte offset position 45 is the position directly after the
              matched portion.  Keep in mind that the byte position isn't nec-
              essarily the same as the character position when  UTF-8  charac-
              ters  are involved.  Consequently, the byte offset positions are
              only to be relied on in the context of using them for subsequent
              searches  on  string, using an offset position as an argument to
              the -n option.  This is mostly used to implement the  "find  all
              non-overlapping matches" functionality.

              A simple example of "find all non-overlapping matches":

                     string="The following zip codes: 78884 90210 99513"
                     pcre_compile -m "\d{5}"
                     accum=()
                     pcre_match -b -- $string
                     while [[ $? -eq 0 ]] do
                         b=($=ZPCRE_OP)
                         accum+=$MATCH
                         pcre_match -b -n $b[2] -- $string
                     done
                     print -l $accum

       The zsh/pcre module makes available the following test condition:

       expr -pcre-match pcre
              Matches a string against a perl-compatible regular expression.

              For example,

                     [[ "$text" -pcre-match ^d+$ ]] &&
                     print text variable contains only "d's".

              If the REMATCH_PCRE option is set, the =~ operator is equivalent
              to -pcre-match, and the NO_CASE_MATCH option may be used.   Note
              that  NO_CASE_MATCH never applies to the pcre_match builtin, in-
              stead use the -i switch of pcre_compile.

THE ZSH/PARAM/PRIVATE MODULE
       The zsh/param/private module is used to create parameters  whose  scope
       is  limited  to  the  current function body, and not to other functions
       called by the current function.

       This module provides a single autoloaded builtin:

       private [ {+|-}AHUahlmrtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZi [ n ] ] [ name[=value] ... ]
              The private builtin accepts all the same options  and  arguments
              as  local (zshbuiltins(1)) except for the `-T' option.  Tied pa-
              rameters may not be made private.

              The `-p' option is presently a no-op because the state  of  pri-
              vate  parameters cannot reliably be reloaded.  This also applies
              to printing private parameters with `typeset -p'.

              If used at the top level (outside  a  function  scope),  private
              creates  a  normal  parameter  in  the same manner as declare or
              typeset.  A warning about this is printed if  WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL
              is  set  (zshoptions(1)).  Used inside a function scope, private
              creates a local parameter similar to one  declared  with  local,
              except having special properties noted below.

              Special  parameters  which  expose  or manipulate internal shell
              state, such as ARGC,  argv,  COLUMNS,  LINES,  UID,  EUID,  IFS,
              PROMPT, RANDOM, SECONDS, etc., cannot be made private unless the
              `-h' option is used to hide the special meaning of  the  parame-
              ter.  This may change in the future.

       As  with other typeset equivalents, private is both a builtin and a re-
       served word, so arrays may be assigned  with  parenthesized  word  list
       name=(value...)  syntax.   However,  the reserved word `private' is not
       available until zsh/param/private is loaded, so care must be taken with
       order  of execution and parsing for function definitions which use pri-
       vate.  To compensate for this, the module also adds the option `-P'  to
       the `local' builtin to declare private parameters.

       For  example,  this construction fails if zsh/param/private has not yet
       been loaded when `bad_declaration' is defined:
              bad_declaration() {
                zmodload zsh/param/private
                private array=( one two three )
              }

       This construction works because local is already  a  keyword,  and  the
       module is loaded before the statement is executed:
              good_declaration() {
                zmodload zsh/param/private
                local -P array=( one two three )
              }

       The following is usable in scripts but may have trouble with autoload:
              zmodload zsh/param/private
              iffy_declaration() {
                private array=( one two three )
              }

       The  private builtin may always be used with scalar assignments and for
       declarations without assignments.

       Parameters declared with private have the following properties:

       •      Within the function body where it is declared, the parameter be-
              haves  as a local, except as noted above for tied or special pa-
              rameters.

       •      The type of a parameter declared private cannot  be  changed  in
              the scope where it was declared, even if the parameter is unset.
              Thus an array cannot be assigned to a private scalar, etc.

       •      Within any other function called by the declaring function,  the
              private  parameter  does  NOT  hide other parameters of the same
              name, so for example a global parameter of the same name is vis-
              ible  and  may  be  assigned  or  unset.  This includes calls to
              anonymous functions, although that may also change  in  the  fu-
              ture.   However, the private name may not be created outside the
              local scope when it was not previously declared.

       •      An exported private remains in the environment of  inner  scopes
              but appears unset for the current shell in those scopes.  Gener-
              ally, exporting private parameters should be avoided.

       Note that this differs from the static scope defined by  compiled  lan-
       guages derived from C, in that the a new call to the same function cre-
       ates a new scope, i.e., the parameter is still associated with the call
       stack  rather  than  with the function definition.  It differs from ksh
       `typeset -S' because the syntax used to  define  the  function  has  no
       bearing on whether the parameter scope is respected.

THE ZSH/REGEX MODULE
       The zsh/regex module makes available the following test condition:

       expr -regex-match regex
              Matches  a  string  against a POSIX extended regular expression.
              On successful match, matched portion of the string will normally
              be  placed  in  the  MATCH variable.  If there are any capturing
              parentheses within the regex, then the match array variable will
              contain  those.   If the match is not successful, then the vari-
              ables will not be altered.

              For example,

                     [[ alphabetical -regex-match ^a([^a]+)a([^a]+)a ]] &&
                     print -l $MATCH X $match

              If the option REMATCH_PCRE is not set, then the =~ operator will
              automatically  load  this  module  as needed and will invoke the
              -regex-match operator.

              If BASH_REMATCH is set, then the array BASH_REMATCH will be  set
              instead of MATCH and match.

              Note  that the zsh/regex module logic relies on the host system.
              The same expr and regex pair could produce different results  on
              different  platforms  if  a  regex  with  non-standard syntax is
              given.

              For example, no syntax for matching a word boundary  is  defined
              in  the POSIX extended regular expression standard. GNU libc and
              BSD libc both  provide  such  syntaxes  as  extensions  (\b  and
              [[:<:]]/[[:>:]]  respectively), but neither of these syntaxes is
              supported by both of these implementations.

              Refer to the regcomp(3) and re_format(7) manual  pages  on  your
              system for locally-supported syntax.

THE ZSH/SCHED MODULE
       The zsh/sched module makes available one builtin command and one param-
       eter.

       sched [-o] [+]hh:mm[:ss] command ...
       sched [-o] [+]seconds command ...
       sched [ -item ]
              Make an entry in the scheduled list of commands to execute.  The
              time  may  be specified in either absolute or relative time, and
              either as hours, minutes and (optionally) seconds separated by a
              colon,  or  seconds  alone.  An absolute number of seconds indi-
              cates the time since the epoch (1970/01/01 00:00); this is  use-
              ful in combination with the features in the zsh/datetime module,
              see the zsh/datetime module entry in zshmodules(1).

              With no arguments, prints the list of  scheduled  commands.   If
              the  scheduled command has the -o flag set, this is shown at the
              start of the command.

              With the argument `-item', removes the given item from the list.
              The  numbering of the list is continuous and entries are in time
              order, so the numbering can change when  entries  are  added  or
              deleted.

              Commands  are  executed  either  immediately before a prompt, or
              while the shell's line editor is waiting for input.  In the lat-
              ter case it is useful to be able to produce output that does not
              interfere with the line being edited.  Providing the  option  -o
              causes  the shell to clear the command line before the event and
              redraw it afterwards.  This should be used  with  any  scheduled
              event  that  produces  visible output to the terminal; it is not
              needed, for example, with output that updates a terminal  emula-
              tor's title bar.

              To  effect  changes to the editor buffer when an event executes,
              use the `zle' command with no arguments to test whether the edi-
              tor is active, and if it is, then use `zle widget' to access the
              editor via the named widget.

              The sched builtin is not made  available  by  default  when  the
              shell  starts in a mode emulating another shell.  It can be made
              available with the command `zmodload -F zsh/sched b:sched'.

       zsh_scheduled_events
              A readonly array corresponding to the events  scheduled  by  the
              sched  builtin.  The indices of the array correspond to the num-
              bers shown when sched is run with no  arguments  (provided  that
              the  KSH_ARRAYS option is not set).  The value of the array con-
              sists of the scheduled time in seconds since the epoch (see  the
              section  `The zsh/datetime Module' for facilities for using this
              number), followed by a colon, followed by any options (which may
              be empty but will be preceded by a `-' otherwise), followed by a
              colon, followed by the command to be executed.

              The sched builtin should be used for  manipulating  the  events.
              Note  that this will have an immediate effect on the contents of
              the array, so that indices may become invalid.

THE ZSH/NET/SOCKET MODULE
       The zsh/net/socket module makes available one builtin command:

       zsocket [ -altv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]
              zsocket is implemented as a builtin to allow full use  of  shell
              command line editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.

   Outbound Connections
       zsocket [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
              Open a new Unix domain connection to filename.  The shell param-
              eter REPLY will be set to the file  descriptor  associated  with
              that  connection.   Currently,  only stream connections are sup-
              ported.

              If -d is specified, its argument will be  taken  as  the  target
              file descriptor for the connection.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

              File  descriptors can be closed with normal shell syntax when no
              longer needed, for example:

                     exec {REPLY}>&-

   Inbound Connections
       zsocket -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
              zsocket -l will open a socket listening on filename.  The  shell
              parameter  REPLY  will  be set to the file descriptor associated
              with that listener.  The file descriptor remains  open  in  sub-
              shells and forked external executables.

              If  -d  is  specified,  its argument will be taken as the target
              file descriptor for the connection.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

       zsocket -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd
              zsocket -a will accept an incoming connection to the socket  as-
              sociated  with  listenfd.  The shell parameter REPLY will be set
              to the file descriptor associated with the  inbound  connection.
              The  file descriptor remains open in subshells and forked exter-
              nal executables.

              If -d is specified, its argument will be  taken  as  the  target
              file descriptor for the connection.

              If  -t  is specified, zsocket will return if no incoming connec-
              tion is pending.  Otherwise it will wait for one.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

THE ZSH/STAT MODULE
       The zsh/stat module makes available one builtin command under two  pos-
       sible names:

       zstat [ -gnNolLtTrs ] [ -f fd ] [ -H hash ] [ -A array ] [ -F fmt ]
             [ +element ] [ file ... ]
       stat ...
              The  command  acts  as  a front end to the stat system call (see
              stat(2)).  The same command is provided with two names;  as  the
              name stat is often used by an external command it is recommended
              that only the zstat form of the command is used.   This  can  be
              arranged  by  loading  the  module with the command `zmodload -F
              zsh/stat b:zstat'.

              If the stat call fails, the  appropriate  system  error  message
              printed  and  status  1  is returned.  The fields of struct stat
              give information about the files provided as  arguments  to  the
              command.   In addition to those available from the stat call, an
              extra element `link' is provided.  These elements are:

              device The number of the device on which the file resides.

              inode  The unique number of the file  on  this  device  (`inode'
                     number).

              mode   The mode of the file; that is, the file's type and access
                     permissions.  With the -s option, this will  be  returned
                     as a string corresponding to the first column in the dis-
                     play of the ls -l command.

              nlink  The number of hard links to the file.

              uid    The user ID of the owner of the file.  With  the  -s  op-
                     tion, this is displayed as a user name.

              gid    The  group  ID  of the file.  With the -s option, this is
                     displayed as a group name.

              rdev   The raw device number.  This is only useful  for  special
                     devices.

              size   The size of the file in bytes.

              atime
              mtime
              ctime  The  last  access, modification and inode change times of
                     the file, respectively, as the number  of  seconds  since
                     midnight  GMT  on 1st January, 1970.  With the -s option,
                     these are printed as strings for the local time zone; the
                     format can be altered with the -F option, and with the -g
                     option the times are in GMT.

              blksize
                     The number of bytes in one allocation block on the device
                     on which the file resides.

              block  The number of disk blocks used by the file.

              link   If  the  file  is  a link and the -L option is in effect,
                     this contains the name of the file linked  to,  otherwise
                     it  is  empty.   Note  that  if  this element is selected
                     (``zstat +link'') then the  -L  option  is  automatically
                     used.

              A  particular element may be selected by including its name pre-
              ceded by a `+' in the option list; only one element is  allowed.
              The  element may be shortened to any unique set of leading char-
              acters.  Otherwise, all elements will be shown for all files.

              Options:

              -A array
                     Instead of displaying the results on standard output, as-
                     sign  them to an array, one struct stat element per array
                     element for each file in order.  In this case neither the
                     name  of the element nor the name of the files appears in
                     array unless the -t or -n  options  were  given,  respec-
                     tively.   If  -t  is given, the element name appears as a
                     prefix to the appropriate array element; if -n is  given,
                     the file name appears as a separate array element preced-
                     ing all the others.  Other  formatting  options  are  re-
                     spected.

              -H hash
                     Similar  to  -A,  but  instead assign the values to hash.
                     The keys are the elements listed above.  If the -n option
                     is  provided then the name of the file is included in the
                     hash with key name.

              -f fd  Use the file on  file  descriptor  fd  instead  of  named
                     files; no list of file names is allowed in this case.

              -F fmt Supplies a strftime (see strftime(3)) string for the for-
                     matting of the time elements.  The format string supports
                     all of the zsh extensions described in the section EXPAN-
                     SION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).   In  particular,
                     -F  %s.%N  can be used to show timestamps with nanosecond
                     precision if supported by the system.  The -s  option  is
                     implied.

              -g     Show  the time elements in the GMT time zone.  The -s op-
                     tion is implied.

              -l     List the names of the type elements (to  standard  output
                     or an array as appropriate) and return immediately; argu-
                     ments, and options other than -A, are ignored.

              -L     Perform an lstat (see lstat(2)) rather than a stat system
                     call.   In  this case, if the file is a link, information
                     about the link itself rather than the target file is  re-
                     turned.  This option is required to make the link element
                     useful.  It's important to note that this  is  the  exact
                     opposite from ls(1), etc.

              -n     Always  show  the names of files.  Usually these are only
                     shown when output is to standard output and there is more
                     than one file in the list.

              -N     Never show the names of files.

              -o     If a raw file mode is printed, show it in octal, which is
                     more useful for human consumption  than  the  default  of
                     decimal.   A  leading  zero will be printed in this case.
                     Note that this does not affect whether a raw or formatted
                     file  mode is shown, which is controlled by the -r and -s
                     options, nor whether a mode is shown at all.

              -r     Print raw data (the default format) alongside string data
                     (the  -s  format); the string data appears in parentheses
                     after the raw data.

              -s     Print mode, uid, gid  and  the  three  time  elements  as
                     strings  instead  of numbers.  In each case the format is
                     like that of ls -l.

              -t     Always show the type names for  the  elements  of  struct
                     stat.   Usually  these  are  only shown when output is to
                     standard output and no individual element  has  been  se-
                     lected.

              -T     Never show the type names of the struct stat elements.

THE ZSH/SYSTEM MODULE
       The  zsh/system module makes available various builtin commands and pa-
       rameters.

   Builtins
       syserror [ -e errvar ] [ -p prefix ] [ errno | errname ]
              This command prints out the error message associated with errno,
              a system error number, followed by a newline to standard error.

              Instead of the error number, a name errname, for example ENOENT,
              may be used.  The set of names is the same as  the  contents  of
              the array errnos, see below.

              If the string prefix is given, it is printed in front of the er-
              ror message, with no intervening space.

              If errvar is supplied, the entire message, without a newline, is
              assigned to the parameter names errvar and nothing is output.

              A  return  status  of  0  indicates the message was successfully
              printed (although it may not be useful if the error  number  was
              out  of  the  system's range), a return status of 1 indicates an
              error in the parameters, and a return status of 2 indicates  the
              error name was not recognised (no message is printed for this).

       sysopen [ -arw ] [ -m permissions ] [ -o options ]
               -u fd file
              This  command  opens  a  file.  The -r, -w and -a flags indicate
              whether the file should be opened for reading, writing  and  ap-
              pending,  respectively. The -m option allows the initial permis-
              sions to use when creating a file to be specified in octal form.
              The  file  descriptor  is  specified with -u. Either an explicit
              file descriptor in the range 0 to 9 can be specified or a  vari-
              able  name can be given to which the file descriptor number will
              be assigned.

              The -o option allows various system specific options to be spec-
              ified as a comma-separated list. The following is a list of pos-
              sible options. Note that, depending on the system, some may  not
              be available.
              cloexec
                     mark  file  to be closed when other programs are executed
                     (else the file descriptor remains open in  subshells  and
                     forked external executables)

              create
              creat  create file if it does not exist

              excl   create file, error if it already exists

              noatime
                     suppress updating of the file atime

              nofollow
                     fail if file is a symbolic link

              nonblock
                     the file is opened in nonblocking mode

              sync   request  that  writes wait until data has been physically
                     written

              truncate
              trunc  truncate file to size 0

              To close the file, use one of the following:

                     exec {fd}<&-
                     exec {fd}>&-

       sysread [ -c countvar ] [ -i infd ] [ -o outfd ]
               [ -s bufsize ] [ -t timeout ] [ param ]
              Perform a single system read from file descriptor infd, or  zero
              if that is not given.  The result of the read is stored in param
              or REPLY if that is not given.  If countvar is given, the number
              of bytes read is assigned to the parameter named by countvar.

              The  maximum  number of bytes read is bufsize or 8192 if that is
              not given, however the command returns as soon as any number  of
              bytes was successfully read.

              If  timeout  is  given, it specifies a timeout in seconds, which
              may be zero to poll the file descriptor.  This is handled by the
              poll  system call if available, otherwise the select system call
              if available.

              If outfd is given, an attempt is made to  write  all  the  bytes
              just  read to the file descriptor outfd.  If this fails, because
              of a system error other than EINTR or because of an internal zsh
              error  during  an  interrupt, the bytes read but not written are
              stored in the parameter named by param if supplied  (no  default
              is  used  in  this  case),  and the number of bytes read but not
              written is stored in the parameter named by countvar if that  is
              supplied.  If it was successful, countvar contains the full num-
              ber of bytes transferred, as usual, and param is not set.

              The error EINTR (interrupted system call) is handled  internally
              so  that  shell  interrupts  are transparent to the caller.  Any
              other error causes a return.

              The possible return statuses are
              0      At least one byte of data was successfully read  and,  if
                     appropriate, written.

              1      There  was  an  error  in  the parameters to the command.
                     This is the only error for which a message is printed  to
                     standard error.

              2      There  was  an error on the read, or on polling the input
                     file descriptor for a timeout.  The parameter ERRNO gives
                     the error.

              3      Data were successfully read, but there was an error writ-
                     ing them to outfd.  The parameter ERRNO gives the error.

              4      The attempt to read timed out.  Note this  does  not  set
                     ERRNO as this is not a system error.

              5      No system error occurred, but zero bytes were read.  This
                     usually indicates end of file.  The  parameters  are  set
                     according  to  the  usual rules; no write to outfd is at-
                     tempted.

       sysseek [ -u fd ] [ -w start|end|current ] offset
              The current file position at which future reads and writes  will
              take  place is adjusted to the specified byte offset. The offset
              is evaluated as a math expression. The -u option allows the file
              descriptor  to  be specified. By default the offset is specified
              relative to the start or the file but, with the -w option, it is
              possible  to  specify  that the offset should be relative to the
              current position or the end of the file.

       syswrite [ -c countvar ] [ -o outfd ] data
              The data (a single string of bytes) are written to the file  de-
              scriptor  outfd, or 1 if that is not given, using the write sys-
              tem call.  Multiple write operations may be used  if  the  first
              does not write all the data.

              If  countvar  is  given, the number of byte written is stored in
              the parameter named by countvar; this may not be the full length
              of data if an error occurred.

              The  error EINTR (interrupted system call) is handled internally
              by retrying; otherwise an error causes the  command  to  return.
              For  example, if the file descriptor is set to non-blocking out-
              put, an error EAGAIN (on some systems, EWOULDBLOCK)  may  result
              in the command returning early.

              The  return  status  may be 0 for success, 1 for an error in the
              parameters to the command, or 2 for an error on  the  write;  no
              error message is printed in the last case, but the parameter ER-
              RNO will reflect the error that occurred.

       zsystem flock [ -t timeout ] [ -i interval ] [ -f var ] [-er] file
       zsystem flock -u fd_expr
              The builtin zsystem's subcommand flock  performs  advisory  file
              locking  (via the fcntl(2) system call) over the entire contents
              of the given file.  This form of locking requires the  processes
              accessing the file to cooperate; its most obvious use is between
              two instances of the shell itself.

              In the first form the named file, which must already  exist,  is
              locked  by  opening a file descriptor to the file and applying a
              lock to the file descriptor.  The lock terminates when the shell
              process  that created the lock exits; it is therefore often con-
              venient to create file locks within subshells, since the lock is
              automatically  released  when the subshell exits.  Note that use
              of the print builtin with the -u option will, as a side  effect,
              release  the  lock, as will redirection to the file in the shell
              holding the lock.  To work around  this  use  a  subshell,  e.g.
              `(print  message)  >>  file'.   Status 0 is returned if the lock
              succeeds, else status 1.

              In the second form the file descriptor given by  the  arithmetic
              expression  fd_expr  is  closed, releasing a lock.  The file de-
              scriptor can be queried by using the `-f var'  form  during  the
              lock; on a successful lock, the shell variable var is set to the
              file descriptor used for locking.  The lock will be released  if
              the  file  descriptor  is closed by any other means, for example
              using `exec {var}>&-'; however, the form described here performs
              a safety check that the file descriptor is in use for file lock-
              ing.

              By default the shell waits indefinitely for the lock to succeed.
              The  option  -t timeout specifies a timeout for the lock in sec-
              onds; fractional seconds are allowed.  During this  period,  the
              shell  will  attempt  to lock the file every interval seconds if
              the -i interval option is given, otherwise once a second.  (This
              interval is shortened before the last attempt if needed, so that
              the shell waits only until the timeout and not longer.)  If  the
              attempt times out, status 2 is returned.

              (Note:  timeout  is  limited to 2^30-1 seconds (about 34 years),
              and interval to 0.999 * LONG_MAX  microseconds  (only  about  35
              minutes on 32-bit systems).)

              If  the  option -e is given, the file descriptor for the lock is
              preserved when the shell uses exec to start a new process;  oth-
              erwise it is closed at that point and the lock released.

              If  the option -r is given, the lock is only for reading, other-
              wise it is for reading and  writing.   The  file  descriptor  is
              opened accordingly.

       zsystem supports subcommand
              The  builtin zsystem's subcommand supports tests whether a given
              subcommand is supported.  It returns status 0 if so, else status
              1.   It  operates silently unless there was a syntax error (i.e.
              the wrong number of arguments), in which case status 255 is  re-
              turned.  Status 1 can indicate one of two things:  subcommand is
              known but not supported by the current operating system, or sub-
              command  is not known (possibly because this is an older version
              of the shell before it was implemented).

   Math Functions
       systell(fd)
              The systell math function returns the current file position  for
              the file descriptor passed as an argument.

   Parameters
       errnos A  readonly  array of the names of errors defined on the system.
              These are typically macros defined in C by including the  system
              header  file  errno.h.  The index of each name (assuming the op-
              tion KSH_ARRAYS is unset) corresponds to the error number.   Er-
              ror  numbers  num before the last known error which have no name
              are given the name Enum in the array.

              Note that aliases for errors are not handled; only the canonical
              name is used.

       sysparams
              A readonly associative array.  The keys are:

              pid    Returns  the  process  ID of the current process, even in
                     subshells.  Compare $$, which returns the process  ID  of
                     the main shell process.

              ppid   Returns  the current process ID of the parent of the cur-
                     rent process, even in subshells.   Compare  $PPID,  which
                     returns  the process ID of the initial parent of the main
                     shell process.

              procsubstpid
                     Returns the process ID of the last  process  started  for
                     process  substitution,  i.e. the <(...) and >(...) expan-
                     sions.

THE ZSH/NET/TCP MODULE
       The zsh/net/tcp module makes available one builtin command:

       ztcp [ -acflLtv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]
              ztcp is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell com-
              mand line editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.

              If  ztcp  is run with no options, it will output the contents of
              its session table.

              If it is run with only the option -L, it will  output  the  con-
              tents  of  the  session table in a format suitable for automatic
              parsing.  The option is ignored if given with a command to  open
              or  close a session.  The output consists of a set of lines, one
              per session, each containing the following elements separated by
              spaces:

              File descriptor
                     The  file descriptor in use for the connection.  For nor-
                     mal inbound (I) and outbound (O) connections this may  be
                     read and written by the usual shell mechanisms.  However,
                     it should only be close with `ztcp -c'.

              Connection type
                     A letter indicating how the session was created:

                     Z      A session created with the zftp command.

                     L      A connection opened for listening with `ztcp -l'.

                     I      An inbound connection accepted with `ztcp -a'.

                     O      An outbound connection  created  with  `ztcp  host
                            ...'.

              The local host
                     This  is usually set to an all-zero IP address as the ad-
                     dress of the localhost is irrelevant.

              The local port
                     This is likely to be zero unless the  connection  is  for
                     listening.

              The remote host
                     This  is  the fully qualified domain name of the peer, if
                     available, else an IP address.  It is an all-zero IP  ad-
                     dress for a session opened for listening.

              The remote port
                     This is zero for a connection opened for listening.

   Outbound Connections
       ztcp [ -v ] [ -d fd ] host [ port ]
              Open  a  new TCP connection to host.  If the port is omitted, it
              will default to port 23.  The connection will be  added  to  the
              session  table  and the shell parameter REPLY will be set to the
              file descriptor associated with that connection.

              If -d is specified, its argument will be  taken  as  the  target
              file descriptor for the connection.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Inbound Connections
       ztcp -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] port
              ztcp  -l  will  open a socket listening on TCP port.  The socket
              will be added to the session table and the shell parameter REPLY
              will  be  set  to  the file descriptor associated with that lis-
              tener.

              If -d is specified, its argument will be  taken  as  the  target
              file descriptor for the connection.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

       ztcp -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd
              ztcp  -a  will accept an incoming connection to the port associ-
              ated with listenfd.  The connection will be added to the session
              table  and the shell parameter REPLY will be set to the file de-
              scriptor associated with the inbound connection.

              If -d is specified, its argument will be  taken  as  the  target
              file descriptor for the connection.

              If  -t  is specified, ztcp will return if no incoming connection
              is pending.  Otherwise it will wait for one.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Closing Connections
       ztcp -cf [ -v ] [ fd ]
       ztcp -c [ -v ] [ fd ]
              ztcp -c will close the socket associated with  fd.   The  socket
              will be removed from the session table.  If fd is not specified,
              ztcp will close everything in the session table.

              Normally, sockets registered by zftp (see zshmodules(1) ) cannot
              be closed this way.  In order to force such a socket closed, use
              -f.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Example
       Here is how to create a TCP connection between two  instances  of  zsh.
       We  need  to  pick  an unassigned port; here we use the randomly chosen
       5123.

       On host1,
              zmodload zsh/net/tcp
              ztcp -l 5123
              listenfd=$REPLY
              ztcp -a $listenfd
              fd=$REPLY
       The second from last command blocks until there is an incoming  connec-
       tion.

       Now  create  a connection from host2 (which may, of course, be the same
       machine):
              zmodload zsh/net/tcp
              ztcp host1 5123
              fd=$REPLY

       Now on each host, $fd contains a file descriptor  for  talking  to  the
       other.  For example, on host1:
              print This is a message >&$fd
       and on host2:
              read -r line <&$fd; print -r - $line
       prints `This is a message'.

       To tidy up, on host1:
              ztcp -c $listenfd
              ztcp -c $fd
       and on host2
              ztcp -c $fd

THE ZSH/TERMCAP MODULE
       The zsh/termcap module makes available one builtin command:

       echotc cap [ arg ... ]
              Output  the  termcap  value corresponding to the capability cap,
              with optional arguments.

       The zsh/termcap module makes available one parameter:

       termcap
              An associative array that maps termcap capability codes to their
              values.

THE ZSH/TERMINFO MODULE
       The zsh/terminfo module makes available one builtin command:

       echoti cap [ arg ]
              Output  the  terminfo value corresponding to the capability cap,
              instantiated with arg if applicable.

       The zsh/terminfo module makes available one parameter:

       terminfo
              An associative array that  maps  terminfo  capability  names  to
              their values.

THE ZSH/WATCH MODULE
       The  zsh/watch  module can be used to report when specific users log in
       or out. This is controlled via the following parameters.

       LOGCHECK
              The interval in seconds between checks for login/logout activity
              using the watch parameter.

       watch <S> <Z> (WATCH <S>)
              An  array  (colon-separated  list) of login/logout events to re-
              port.

              If it contains the single  word  `all',  then  all  login/logout
              events  are  reported.   If it contains the single word `notme',
              then all events are reported as with `all' except $USERNAME.

              An entry in this list may consist of a username, an `@' followed
              by  a  remote hostname, and a `%' followed by a line (tty).  Any
              of these may be a pattern (be sure to quote this during the  as-
              signment  to  watch so that it does not immediately perform file
              generation); the setting of  the  EXTENDED_GLOB  option  is  re-
              spected.   Any  or  all of these components may be present in an
              entry; if a login/logout event matches all of them,  it  is  re-
              ported.

              For example, with the EXTENDED_GLOB option set, the following:

                     watch=('^(pws|barts)')

              causes  reports for activity associated with any user other than
              pws or barts.

       WATCHFMT
              The format of login/logout reports if  the  watch  parameter  is
              set.  Default is `%n has %a %l from %m'.  Recognizes the follow-
              ing escape sequences:

              %n     The name of the user that logged in/out.

              %a     The observed action, i.e. "logged on" or "logged off".

              %l     The line (tty) the user is logged in on.

              %M     The full hostname of the remote host.

              %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.  If only the IP address
                     is  available  or  the utmp field contains the name of an
                     X-windows display, the whole name is printed.

                     NOTE: The `%m' and `%M' escapes will work only  if  there
                     is a host name field in the utmp on your machine.  Other-
                     wise they are treated as ordinary strings.

              %F{color} (%f)
                     Start (stop) using a different foreground color.

              %K{color} (%k)
                     Start (stop) using a different background color.

              %S (%s)
                     Start (stop) standout mode.

              %U (%u)
                     Start (stop) underline mode.

              %B (%b)
                     Start (stop) boldface mode.

              %t
              %@     The time, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

              %T     The time, in 24-hour format.

              %w     The date in `day-dd' format.

              %W     The date in `mm/dd/yy' format.

              %D     The date in `yy-mm-dd' format.

              %D{string}
                     The date formatted as string using the strftime function,
                     with  zsh  extensions as described by EXPANSION OF PROMPT
                     SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

              %(x:true-text:false-text)
                     Specifies a ternary expression.  The character  following
                     the  x  is arbitrary; the same character is used to sepa-
                     rate the text for the "true" result  from  that  for  the
                     "false"  result.  Both the separator and the right paren-
                     thesis may be escaped with a backslash.  Ternary  expres-
                     sions may be nested.

                     The  test  character x may be any one of `l', `n', `m' or
                     `M', which indicate a `true' result if the  corresponding
                     escape sequence would return a non-empty value; or it may
                     be `a', which indicates a `true' result  if  the  watched
                     user  has  logged  in,  or  `false' if he has logged out.
                     Other characters evaluate to neither true nor false;  the
                     entire expression is omitted in this case.

                     If  the result is `true', then the true-text is formatted
                     according  to  the  rules  above  and  printed,  and  the
                     false-text  is  skipped.   If  `false',  the true-text is
                     skipped and the false-text is formatted and printed.  Ei-
                     ther or both of the branches may be empty, but both sepa-
                     rators must be present in any case.

       Furthermore, the zsh/watch module makes available one builtin command:

       log    List all users currently logged in who are affected by the  cur-
              rent setting of the watch parameter.

THE ZSH/ZFTP MODULE
       The zsh/zftp module makes available one builtin command:

       zftp subcommand [ args ]
              The  zsh/zftp  module  is a client for FTP (file transfer proto-
              col).  It is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell
              command line editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.  Of-
              ten, users will access it via shell functions providing  a  more
              powerful  interface; a set is provided with the zsh distribution
              and is described in zshzftpsys(1).  However, the zftp command is
              entirely usable in its own right.

              All  commands  consist  of the command name zftp followed by the
              name of a subcommand.  These are listed below.  The return  sta-
              tus  of  each  subcommand  is supposed to reflect the success or
              failure of the remote operation.  See a description of the vari-
              able ZFTP_VERBOSE for more information on how responses from the
              server may be printed.

   Subcommands
       open host[:port] [ user [ password [ account ] ] ]
              Open a new FTP session to host, which  may  be  the  name  of  a
              TCP/IP  connected host or an IP number in the standard dot nota-
              tion.  If the argument is in the form host:port, open a  connec-
              tion to TCP port port instead of the standard FTP port 21.  This
              may be the name of a TCP service or a number:  see the  descrip-
              tion of ZFTP_PORT below for more information.

              If  IPv6  addresses in colon format are used, the host should be
              surrounded by quoted square brackets to distinguish it from  the
              port, for example '[fe80::203:baff:fe02:8b56]'.  For consistency
              this is allowed with all forms of host.

              Remaining arguments are passed to the  login  subcommand.   Note
              that if no arguments beyond host are supplied, open will not au-
              tomatically call login.  If no arguments at  all  are  supplied,
              open will use the parameters set by the params subcommand.

              After   a   successful  open,  the  shell  variables  ZFTP_HOST,
              ZFTP_PORT, ZFTP_IP and ZFTP_SYSTEM  are  available;  see  `Vari-
              ables' below.

       login [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
       user [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
              Login  the  user name with parameters password and account.  Any
              of the parameters can be omitted, and will be read from standard
              input if needed (name is always needed).  If standard input is a
              terminal, a prompt for each one will be printed on standard  er-
              ror  and  password will not be echoed.  If any of the parameters
              are not used, a warning message is printed.

              After  a  successful  login,  the  shell  variables   ZFTP_USER,
              ZFTP_ACCOUNT and ZFTP_PWD are available; see `Variables' below.

              This  command may be re-issued when a user is already logged in,
              and the server will first be reinitialized for a new user.

       params [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
       params -
              Store the given parameters for a later open command with no  ar-
              guments.   Only  those  given on the command line will be remem-
              bered.  If no arguments are given, the parameters currently  set
              are  printed,  although  the  password  will appear as a line of
              stars; the return status is one if no parameters were set,  zero
              otherwise.

              Any  of the parameters may be specified as a `?', which may need
              to be quoted to protect it from shell expansion.  In this  case,
              the  appropriate  parameter  will be read from stdin as with the
              login subcommand, including special handling  of  password.   If
              the  `?' is followed by a string, that is used as the prompt for
              reading the parameter instead of the default message (any neces-
              sary punctuation and whitespace should be included at the end of
              the prompt).  The first letter of the parameter  (only)  may  be
              quoted  with  a `\'; hence an argument "\\$word" guarantees that
              the string from the shell parameter $word will be treated liter-
              ally, whether or not it begins with a `?'.

              If  instead  a  single `-' is given, the existing parameters, if
              any, are deleted.  In that case, calling open with no  arguments
              will cause an error.

              The  list of parameters is not deleted after a close, however it
              will be deleted if the zsh/zftp module is unloaded.

              For example,

                     zftp params ftp.elsewhere.xx juser '?Password for juser: '

              will store the host ftp.elsewhere.xx and the user juser and then
              prompt  the  user  for the corresponding password with the given
              prompt.

       test   Test the connection; if the server  has  reported  that  it  has
              closed the connection (maybe due to a timeout), return status 2;
              if no connection was open anyway, return status 1;  else  return
              status  0.   The  test subcommand is silent, apart from messages
              printed by the $ZFTP_VERBOSE mechanism, or error messages if the
              connection closes.  There is no network overhead for this test.

              The  test is only supported on systems with either the select(2)
              or poll(2) system calls; otherwise the message `not supported on
              this system' is printed instead.

              The test subcommand will automatically be called at the start of
              any other subcommand for the current session when  a  connection
              is open.

       cd directory
              Change the remote directory to directory.  Also alters the shell
              variable ZFTP_PWD.

       cdup   Change the remote directory to the one higher in  the  directory
              tree.  Note that cd .. will also work correctly on non-UNIX sys-
              tems.

       dir [ arg ... ]
              Give a (verbose) listing of the remote directory.  The args  are
              passed directly to the server. The command's behaviour is imple-
              mentation dependent, but a UNIX server will typically  interpret
              args as arguments to the ls command and with no arguments return
              the result of `ls -l'. The directory is listed to standard  out-
              put.

       ls [ arg ... ]
              Give  a  (short)  listing of the remote directory.  With no arg,
              produces a raw list of the files in the directory, one per line.
              Otherwise,  up to vagaries of the server implementation, behaves
              similar to dir.

       type [ type ]
              Change the type for the transfer to type, or print  the  current
              type if type is absent.  The allowed values are `A' (ASCII), `I'
              (Image, i.e. binary), or `B' (a synonym for `I').

              The FTP default for a transfer is ASCII.  However, if zftp finds
              that  the remote host is a UNIX machine with 8-bit byes, it will
              automatically switch to using binary  for  file  transfers  upon
              open.  This can subsequently be overridden.

              The  transfer type is only passed to the remote host when a data
              connection is established;  this  command  involves  no  network
              overhead.

       ascii  The same as type A.

       binary The same as type I.

       mode [ S | B ]
              Set  the  mode  type to stream (S) or block (B).  Stream mode is
              the default; block mode is not widely supported.

       remote file ...
       local [ file ... ]
              Print the size and last modification time of the remote or local
              files.   If there is more than one item on the list, the name of
              the file is printed first.  The first number is the  file  size,
              the second is the last modification time of the file in the for-
              mat CCYYMMDDhhmmSS consisting of year, month, date,  hour,  min-
              utes  and  seconds in GMT.  Note that this format, including the
              length, is guaranteed, so that time strings can be directly com-
              pared  via  the [[ builtin's < and > operators, even if they are
              too long to be represented as integers.

              Not all servers support the commands for retrieving this  infor-
              mation.  In that case, the remote command will print nothing and
              return status 2, compared with status 1 for a file not found.

              The local command (but not remote) may be  used  with  no  argu-
              ments,  in  which case the information comes from examining file
              descriptor zero.  This is the same file as seen by a put command
              with no further redirection.

       get file ...
              Retrieve all files from the server, concatenating them and send-
              ing them to standard output.

       put file ...
              For each file, read a file from standard input and send that  to
              the remote host with the given name.

       append file ...
              As  put, but if the remote file already exists, data is appended
              to it instead of overwriting it.

       getat file point
       putat file point
       appendat file point
              Versions of get, put and append which will start the transfer at
              the  given point in the remote file.  This is useful for append-
              ing to an incomplete local file.  However, note that this  abil-
              ity  is  not  universally supported by servers (and is not quite
              the behaviour specified by the standard).

       delete file ...
              Delete the list of files on the server.

       mkdir directory
              Create a new directory directory on the server.

       rmdir directory
              Delete the directory directory  on the server.

       rename old-name new-name
              Rename file old-name to new-name on the server.

       site arg ...
              Send a host-specific command to the server.  You  will  probably
              only need this if instructed by the server to use it.

       quote arg ...
              Send  the raw FTP command sequence to the server.  You should be
              familiar with the FTP command set as defined  in  RFC959  before
              doing  this.   Useful  commands may include STAT and HELP.  Note
              also the mechanism for returning messages as described  for  the
              variable  ZFTP_VERBOSE  below,  in  particular that all messages
              from the control connection are sent to standard error.

       close
       quit   Close the current data connection.  This unsets the shell param-
              eters  ZFTP_HOST,  ZFTP_PORT,  ZFTP_IP,  ZFTP_SYSTEM, ZFTP_USER,
              ZFTP_ACCOUNT, ZFTP_PWD, ZFTP_TYPE and ZFTP_MODE.

       session [ sessname ]
              Allows multiple FTP sessions to be used at once.   The  name  of
              the  session  is  an arbitrary string of characters; the default
              session is called `default'.  If this command is called  without
              an  argument, it will list all the current sessions; with an ar-
              gument, it will either switch to  the  existing  session  called
              sessname, or create a new session of that name.

              Each  session remembers the status of the connection, the set of
              connection-specific shell parameters (the same set as are  unset
              when a connection closes, as given in the description of close),
              and any user parameters specified with  the  params  subcommand.
              Changing  to  a previous session restores those values; changing
              to a new session initialises them in the same way as if zftp had
              just  been  loaded.  The name of the current session is given by
              the parameter ZFTP_SESSION.

       rmsession [ sessname ]
              Delete a session; if a name is not given, the current session is
              deleted.  If the current session is deleted, the earliest exist-
              ing session becomes the new current session, otherwise the  cur-
              rent  session  is  not changed.  If the session being deleted is
              the only one, a new session called `default' is created and  be-
              comes  the current session; note that this is a new session even
              if the session being deleted is also  called  `default'.  It  is
              recommended  that  sessions not be deleted while background com-
              mands which use zftp are still active.

   Parameters
       The following shell parameters are used by  zftp.   Currently  none  of
       them are special.

       ZFTP_TMOUT
              Integer.  The time in seconds to wait for a network operation to
              complete before returning an error.  If this is not set when the
              module  is  loaded,  it  will  be given the default value 60.  A
              value of zero turns off timeouts.  If a timeout  occurs  on  the
              control  connection  it  will  be closed.  Use a larger value if
              this occurs too frequently.

       ZFTP_IP
              Readonly.  The IP address of the current connection in dot nota-
              tion.

       ZFTP_HOST
              Readonly.   The  hostname  of the current remote server.  If the
              host was opened as an IP number,  ZFTP_HOST  contains  that  in-
              stead;  this saves the overhead for a name lookup, as IP numbers
              are most commonly used when a nameserver is unavailable.

       ZFTP_PORT
              Readonly.  The number of the remote TCP port to which  the  con-
              nection  is open (even if the port was originally specified as a
              named service).  Usually this is the standard FTP port, 21.

              In the unlikely event that your system does not have the  appro-
              priate conversion functions, this appears in network byte order.
              If your system is little-endian, the port then consists  of  two
              swapped  bytes  and  the standard port will be reported as 5376.
              In that case, numeric ports passed to zftp open will  also  need
              to be in this format.

       ZFTP_SYSTEM
              Readonly.   The system type string returned by the server in re-
              sponse to an FTP SYST request.  The most interesting case  is  a
              string beginning "UNIX Type: L8", which ensures maximum compati-
              bility with a local UNIX host.

       ZFTP_TYPE
              Readonly.  The type to be used for data transfers ,  either  `A'
              or `I'.   Use the type subcommand to change this.

       ZFTP_USER
              Readonly.  The username currently logged in, if any.

       ZFTP_ACCOUNT
              Readonly.   The  account name of the current user, if any.  Most
              servers do not require an account name.

       ZFTP_PWD
              Readonly.  The current directory on the server.

       ZFTP_CODE
              Readonly.  The three digit code of the last FTP reply  from  the
              server as a string.  This can still be read after the connection
              is closed, and is not changed when the current session changes.

       ZFTP_REPLY
              Readonly.  The last line of the last reply sent by  the  server.
              This  can  still  be read after the connection is closed, and is
              not changed when the current session changes.

       ZFTP_SESSION
              Readonly.  The name of the current FTP session; see the descrip-
              tion of the session subcommand.

       ZFTP_PREFS
              A  string  of  preferences for altering aspects of zftp's behav-
              iour.  Each preference is a single character.  The following are
              defined:

              P      Passive:  attempt to make the remote server initiate data
                     transfers.  This is slightly more efficient than sendport
                     mode.   If  the letter S occurs later in the string, zftp
                     will use sendport mode if passive mode is not available.

              S      Sendport:  initiate transfers by the  FTP  PORT  command.
                     If  this  occurs before any P in the string, passive mode
                     will never be attempted.

              D      Dumb:  use only the bare minimum of FTP  commands.   This
                     prevents  the variables ZFTP_SYSTEM and ZFTP_PWD from be-
                     ing set, and will mean all connections default  to  ASCII
                     type.   It  may prevent ZFTP_SIZE from being set during a
                     transfer if the server does  not  send  it  anyway  (many
                     servers do).

              If  ZFTP_PREFS is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set to
              a default of `PS', i.e. use passive mode if available, otherwise
              fall back to sendport mode.

       ZFTP_VERBOSE
              A  string  of digits between 0 and 5 inclusive, specifying which
              responses from the server should be printed.  All  responses  go
              to  standard  error.  If any of the numbers 1 to 5 appear in the
              string, raw responses from the server with reply codes beginning
              with  that  digit  will be printed to standard error.  The first
              digit of the three digit reply code is defined by RFC959 to cor-
              respond to:

              1.     A positive preliminary reply.

              2.     A positive completion reply.

              3.     A positive intermediate reply.

              4.     A transient negative completion reply.

              5.     A permanent negative completion reply.

              It should be noted that, for unknown reasons, the reply `Service
              not available', which forces termination  of  a  connection,  is
              classified as 421, i.e. `transient negative', an interesting in-
              terpretation of the word `transient'.

              The code 0 is special:  it indicates that all but the last  line
              of  multiline  replies  read  from the server will be printed to
              standard error in a processed format.   By  convention,  servers
              use this mechanism for sending information for the user to read.
              The appropriate reply code, if it  matches  the  same  response,
              takes priority.

              If  ZFTP_VERBOSE  is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set
              to the default value 450, i.e., messages destined for  the  user
              and  all  errors  will  be  printed.  A null string is valid and
              specifies that no messages should be printed.

   Functions
       zftp_chpwd
              If this function is set by the user, it is called every time the
              directory changes on the server, including when a user is logged
              in, or when a connection is closed.  In the last case, $ZFTP_PWD
              will be unset; otherwise it will reflect the new directory.

       zftp_progress
              If  this function is set by the user, it will be called during a
              get, put or append operation each time sufficient data has  been
              received from the host.  During a get, the data is sent to stan-
              dard output, so it is vital that this function should  write  to
              standard error or directly to the terminal, not to standard out-
              put.

              When it is called with a transfer in progress, the following ad-
              ditional shell parameters are set:

              ZFTP_FILE
                     The name of the remote file being transferred from or to.

              ZFTP_TRANSFER
                     A G for a get operation and a P for a put operation.

              ZFTP_SIZE
                     The  total  size  of the complete file being transferred:
                     the same as the first value provided by  the  remote  and
                     local  subcommands  for a particular file.  If the server
                     cannot supply this value for  a  remote  file  being  re-
                     trieved, it will not be set.  If input is from a pipe the
                     value may be incorrect and correspond simply  to  a  full
                     pipe buffer.

              ZFTP_COUNT
                     The  amount  of data so far transferred; a number between
                     zero and $ZFTP_SIZE, if that is set.  This number is  al-
                     ways available.

              The  function  is initially called with ZFTP_TRANSFER set appro-
              priately and ZFTP_COUNT set to zero.  After the transfer is fin-
              ished,   the   function  will  be  called  one  more  time  with
              ZFTP_TRANSFER set to GF or PF, in case it wishes to tidy up.  It
              is   otherwise  never  called  twice  with  the  same  value  of
              ZFTP_COUNT.

              Sometimes the progress meter may cause disruption.  It is up  to
              the user to decide whether the function should be defined and to
              use unfunction when necessary.

   Problems
       A connection may not be opened in the left hand side of a pipe as  this
       occurs  in  a  subshell  and the file information is not updated in the
       main shell.  In the case of type or mode changes or closing the connec-
       tion  in  a subshell, the information is returned but variables are not
       updated until the next call to zftp.  Other status changes in subshells
       will not be reflected by changes to the variables (but should be other-
       wise harmless).

       Deleting sessions while a zftp command is active in the background  can
       have  unexpected  effects,  even  if  it does not use the session being
       deleted.  This is because all shell subprocesses share  information  on
       the state of all connections, and deleting a session changes the order-
       ing of that information.

       On some operating systems, the control connection is not valid after  a
       fork(),  so  that  operations  in subshells, on the left hand side of a
       pipeline, or in the background are not possible,  as  they  should  be.
       This is presumably a bug in the operating system.

THE ZSH/ZLE MODULE
       The zsh/zle module contains the Zsh Line Editor.  See zshzle(1).

THE ZSH/ZLEPARAMETER MODULE
       The  zsh/zleparameter module defines two special parameters that can be
       used to access internal information of the Zsh Line  Editor  (see  zsh-
       zle(1)).

       keymaps
              This array contains the names of the keymaps currently defined.

       widgets
              This  associative  array contains one entry per widget. The name
              of the widget is the key and the value gives  information  about
              the widget. It is either
                the string `builtin' for builtin widgets,
                a string of the form `user:name' for user-defined widgets,
                  where  name  is  the name of the shell function implementing
              the widget,
                a string of the form `completion:type:name'
                  for completion widgets,
                or a null value if the widget is not yet  fully  defined.   In
              the penultimate case, type is the name of the builtin widget the
              completion widget imitates in its behavior and name is the  name
              of the shell function implementing the completion widget.

THE ZSH/ZPROF MODULE
       When  loaded, the zsh/zprof causes shell functions to be profiled.  The
       profiling results can be obtained with the zprof builtin  command  made
       available  by this module.  There is no way to turn profiling off other
       than unloading the module.

       zprof [ -c ]
              Without the -c option, zprof lists profiling results to standard
              output.   The  format  is  comparable  to  that of commands like
              gprof.

              At the top there is a summary listing all  functions  that  were
              called  at least once.  This summary is sorted in decreasing or-
              der of the amount of time spent in each.  The lines contain  the
              number of the function in order, which is used in other parts of
              the list in suffixes of the form `[num]',  then  the  number  of
              calls  made  to  the  function.  The next three columns list the
              time in milliseconds spent in the function and its  descendants,
              the  average  time in milliseconds spent in the function and its
              descendants per call and the percentage of  time  spent  in  all
              shell  functions used in this function and its descendants.  The
              following three columns give the same information, but  counting
              only  the  time  spent in the function itself.  The final column
              shows the name of the function.

              After the summary, detailed  information  about  every  function
              that  was  invoked  is listed, sorted in decreasing order of the
              amount of time spent in each function and its descendants.  Each
              of these entries consists of descriptions for the functions that
              called the function described,  the  function  itself,  and  the
              functions  that  were  called  from it.  The description for the
              function itself has the same format as in the summary (and shows
              the same information).  The other lines don't show the number of
              the function at the beginning and have their function named  in-
              dented  to  make  it  easier to distinguish the line showing the
              function described in the section from the surrounding lines.

              The information shown in this case is almost the same as in  the
              summary,  but only refers to the call hierarchy being displayed.
              For example, for a calling function the column showing the total
              running  time lists the time spent in the described function and
              its descendants only for the times when it was called from  that
              particular  calling  function.  Likewise, for a called function,
              this columns lists the total time spent in the  called  function
              and  its  descendants only for the times when it was called from
              the function described.

              Also in this case, the column showing the number of calls  to  a
              function also shows a slash and then the total number of invoca-
              tions made to the called function.

              As long as the zsh/zprof module is  loaded,  profiling  will  be
              done  and multiple invocations of the zprof builtin command will
              show the times and numbers of calls since the module was loaded.
              With the -c option, the zprof builtin command will reset its in-
              ternal counters and will not show the listing.

THE ZSH/ZPTY MODULE
       The zsh/zpty module offers one builtin:

       zpty [ -e ] [ -b ] name [ arg ... ]
              The arguments following name are concatenated  with  spaces  be-
              tween,  then  executed  as  a  command, as if passed to the eval
              builtin.  The command runs under a newly assigned  pseudo-termi-
              nal; this is useful for running commands non-interactively which
              expect an interactive environment.  The name is not part of  the
              command,  but is used to refer to this command in later calls to
              zpty.

              With the -e option, the pseudo-terminal is set up so that  input
              characters are echoed.

              With the -b option, input to and output from the pseudo-terminal
              are made non-blocking.

              The shell parameter REPLY is set to the file descriptor assigned
              to the master side of the pseudo-terminal.  This allows the ter-
              minal to be monitored with ZLE  descriptor  handlers  (see  zsh-
              zle(1))  or  manipulated  with  sysread  and  syswrite  (see THE
              ZSH/SYSTEM MODULE in zshmodules(1)).  Warning:  Use  of  sysread
              and  syswrite is not recommended; use zpty -r and zpty -w unless
              you know exactly what you are doing.

       zpty -d [ name ... ]
              The second form, with the -d option, is used to delete  commands
              previously  started,  by supplying a list of their names.  If no
              name is given, all commands are  deleted.   Deleting  a  command
              causes the HUP signal to be sent to the corresponding process.

       zpty -w [ -n ] name [ string ... ]
              The  -w option can be used to send the to command name the given
              strings as input (separated by spaces).  If the -n option is not
              given, a newline is added at the end.

              If  no  string  is provided, the standard input is copied to the
              pseudo-terminal; this may stop before copying the full input  if
              the  pseudo-terminal is non-blocking.  The exact input is always
              copied: the -n option is not applied.

              Note that the command under the pseudo-terminal sees this  input
              as  if  it were typed, so beware when sending special tty driver
              characters such as word-erase, line-kill, and end-of-file.

       zpty -r [ -mt ] name [ param [ pattern ] ]
              The -r option can be used to read  the  output  of  the  command
              name.   With  only a name argument, the output read is copied to
              the standard output.  Unless the pseudo-terminal  is  non-block-
              ing, copying continues until the command under the pseudo-termi-
              nal exits; when non-blocking, only as much output as is  immedi-
              ately  available  is  copied.   The return status is zero if any
              output is copied.

              When also given a param argument, at most one line is  read  and
              stored  in the parameter named param.  Less than a full line may
              be read if the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking.  The return sta-
              tus is zero if at least one character is stored in param.

              If  a  pattern  is given as well, output is read until the whole
              string read matches the pattern, even in the non-blocking  case.
              The  return  status  is zero if the string read matches the pat-
              tern, or if the command has exited but at  least  one  character
              could  still  be  read.  If the option -m is present, the return
              status is zero only if the pattern matches.  As of this writing,
              a maximum of one megabyte of output can be consumed this way; if
              a full megabyte is read without matching the pattern, the return
              status is non-zero.

              In  all cases, the return status is non-zero if nothing could be
              read, and is 2 if this is because the command has finished.

              If the -r option is combined with  the  -t  option,  zpty  tests
              whether output is available before trying to read.  If no output
              is available, zpty immediately returns the status 1.  When  used
              with  a  pattern,  the  behaviour on a failed poll is similar to
              when the command has exited:  the return value  is  zero  if  at
              least  one  character  could  still  be read even if the pattern
              failed to match.

       zpty -t name
              The -t option without the -r option can be used to test  whether
              the  command name is still running.  It returns a zero status if
              the command is running and a non-zero value otherwise.

       zpty [ -L ]
              The last form, without any arguments, is used to list  the  com-
              mands  currently  defined.   If  the -L option is given, this is
              done in the form of calls to the zpty builtin.

THE ZSH/ZSELECT MODULE
       The zsh/zselect module makes available one builtin command:

       zselect [ -rwe ] [ -t timeout ] [ -a array ] [ -A assoc ] [ fd ... ]
              The zselect builtin is a front-end to the `select' system  call,
              which  blocks  until  a  file descriptor is ready for reading or
              writing, or has an error condition, with  an  optional  timeout.
              If  this  is not available on your system, the command prints an
              error message and returns status 2 (normal errors return  status
              1).   For  more information, see your system's documentation for
              select(3).  Note there is no connection with the  shell  builtin
              of the same name.

              Arguments and options may be intermingled in any order.  Non-op-
              tion arguments are file descriptors, which must be decimal inte-
              gers.   By  default, file descriptors are to be tested for read-
              ing, i.e. zselect will return when data is available to be  read
              from  the file descriptor, or more precisely, when a read opera-
              tion from the file descriptor will not block.  After  a  -r,  -w
              and -e, the given file descriptors are to be tested for reading,
              writing, or error conditions.  These options  and  an  arbitrary
              list of file descriptors may be given in any order.

              (The presence of an `error condition' is not well defined in the
              documentation for many  implementations  of  the  select  system
              call.   According to recent versions of the POSIX specification,
              it is really an exception condition, of which the only  standard
              example  is out-of-band data received on a socket.  So zsh users
              are unlikely to find the -e option useful.)

              The option `-t timeout' specifies a timeout in hundredths  of  a
              second.   This  may  be zero, in which case the file descriptors
              will simply be polled and zselect will return  immediately.   It
              is  possible  to  call  zselect  with  no file descriptors and a
              non-zero timeout for use  as  a  finer-grained  replacement  for
              `sleep';  note,  however,  the  return  status is always 1 for a
              timeout.

              The option `-a array' indicates that array should be set to  in-
              dicate the file descriptor(s) which are ready.  If the option is
              not given, the array reply will be used for this  purpose.   The
              array  will  contain  a string similar to the arguments for zse-
              lect.  For example,

                     zselect -t 0 -r 0 -w 1

              might return immediately with status 0 and $reply containing `-r
              0 -w 1' to show that both file descriptors are ready for the re-
              quested operations.

              The option `-A assoc' indicates that the associative array assoc
              should  be  set  to  indicate  the  file descriptor(s) which are
              ready.  This option overrides the option -a, nor will  reply  be
              modified.   The  keys of assoc are the file descriptors, and the
              corresponding values are any of the characters `rwe' to indicate
              the condition.

              The  command returns status 0 if some file descriptors are ready
              for reading.  If the operation timed out, or a timeout of 0  was
              given and no file descriptors were ready, or there was an error,
              it returns status 1 and the array will not be set (nor  modified
              in  any way).  If there was an error in the select operation the
              appropriate error message is printed.

THE ZSH/ZUTIL MODULE
       The zsh/zutil module only adds some builtins:

       zstyle [ -L [ metapattern [ style ] ] ]
       zstyle [ -e | - | -- ] pattern style string ...
       zstyle -d [ pattern [ style ... ] ]
       zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
       zstyle -{a|b|s} context style name [ sep ]
       zstyle -{T|t} context style [ string ... ]
       zstyle -m context style pattern
              This builtin command  is  used  to  define  and  lookup  styles.
              Styles  are  pairs of names and values, where the values consist
              of any number of strings.  They are stored  together  with  pat-
              terns  and  lookup  is done by giving a string, called the `con-
              text', which is matched against the  patterns.   The  definition
              stored  for  the  most specific pattern that matches will be re-
              turned.

              A pattern is considered to be more specific than another  if  it
              contains  more components (substrings separated by colons) or if
              the patterns for the components are more specific, where  simple
              strings  are  considered  to  be more specific than patterns and
              complex patterns are considered to be  more  specific  than  the
              pattern `*'.  A `*' in the pattern will match zero or more char-
              acters in the context; colons are not treated specially in  this
              regard.  If two patterns are equally specific, the tie is broken
              in favour of the pattern that was defined first.

              Example

              For example, a fictional `weather' plugin  might  state  in  its
              documentation that it looks up the preferred-precipitation style
              under the `:weather:continent:day-of-the-week:phase-of-the-moon'
              context.  According to this, you might set the following in your
              zshrc:

                     zstyle ':weather:europe:*' preferred-precipitation rain
                     zstyle ':weather:*:Sunday:*' preferred-precipitation snow

              Then the plugin would run under the hood a command such as

                     zstyle -s ":weather:${continent}:${day_of_week}:${moon_phase}" preferred-precipitation REPLY

              in order to retrieve your preference into  the  scalar  variable
              $REPLY.   On Sundays $REPLY would be set to `snow'; in Europe it
              would be set to `rain'; and on Sundays in Europe it would be set
              to  `snow'  again,  because the patterns `:weather:europe:*' and
              `:weather:*:Sunday:*' both match the context argument to  zstyle
              -s,  are  equally specific, and the latter is more specific (be-
              cause it has more colon-separated components).

              Usage

              The forms that operate on patterns are the following.

              zstyle [ -L [ metapattern [ style ] ] ]
                     Without arguments, lists style definitions.   Styles  are
                     shown  in  alphabetic order and patterns are shown in the
                     order zstyle will test them.

                     If the -L option is given, listing is done in the form of
                     calls  to  zstyle.  The optional first argument, metapat-
                     tern, is a pattern which  will  be  matched  against  the
                     string  supplied  as  pattern when the style was defined.
                     Note: this  means,  for  example,  `zstyle  -L  ":comple-
                     tion:*"' will match any supplied pattern beginning `:com-
                     pletion:',  not  just  ":completion:*":   use   ':comple-
                     tion:\*'  to  match  that.   The optional second argument
                     limits the output to a specific style  (not  a  pattern).
                     -L is not compatible with any other options.

              zstyle [ - | -- | -e ] pattern style string ...
                     Defines  the given style for the pattern with the strings
                     as the value.  If the -e option  is  given,  the  strings
                     will  be  concatenated  (separated by spaces) and the re-
                     sulting string will be evaluated (in the same way  as  it
                     is  done  by  the eval builtin command) when the style is
                     looked up.  In this case the parameter  `reply'  must  be
                     assigned  to  set  the strings returned after the evalua-
                     tion.  Before evaluating the value, reply is  unset,  and
                     if  it  is still unset after the evaluation, the style is
                     treated as if it were not set.

              zstyle -d [ pattern [ style ... ] ]
                     Delete style definitions. Without arguments  all  defini-
                     tions  are  deleted,  with  a pattern all definitions for
                     that pattern are deleted and if  any  styles  are  given,
                     then only those styles are deleted for the pattern.

              zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
                     Retrieve a style definition. The name is used as the name
                     of an array in which the results are stored. Without  any
                     further  arguments,  all  patterns  defined are returned.
                     With a pattern the styles defined for  that  pattern  are
                     returned  and  with both a pattern and a style, the value
                     strings of that combination is returned.

              The other forms can be used to look up  or  test  styles  for  a
              given context.

              zstyle -s context style name [ sep ]
                     The  parameter  name is set to the value of the style in-
                     terpreted as a string.  If  the  value  contains  several
                     strings  they  are  concatenated with spaces (or with the
                     sep string if that is given) between them.

                     Return 0 if the style is set, 1 otherwise.

              zstyle -b context style name
                     The value is stored in name as a  boolean,  i.e.  as  the
                     string  `yes'  if  the value has only one string and that
                     string is equal to one of `yes', `true', `on', or `1'. If
                     the  value  is  any  other  string  or  has more than one
                     string, the parameter is set to `no'.

                     Return 0 if name is set to `yes', 1 otherwise.

              zstyle -a context style name
                     The value is stored in name as an array. If name  is  de-
                     clared  as  an associative array,  the first, third, etc.
                     strings are used as the keys and the  other  strings  are
                     used as the values.

                     Return 0 if the style is set, 1 otherwise.

              zstyle -t context style [ string ... ]
              zstyle -T context style [ string ... ]
                     Test  the  value  of a style, i.e. the -t option only re-
                     turns a status (sets $?).  Without any string the  return
                     status  is  zero if the style is defined for at least one
                     matching pattern, has only one string in its  value,  and
                     that  is  equal  to one of `true', `yes', `on' or `1'. If
                     any strings are given the status is zero if and  only  if
                     at  least  one of the strings is equal to at least one of
                     the strings in the value. If the  style  is  defined  but
                     doesn't  match,  the  return status is 1. If the style is
                     not defined, the status is 2.

                     The -T option tests the values of the style like -t,  but
                     it  returns  status  zero (rather than 2) if the style is
                     not defined for any matching pattern.

              zstyle -m context style pattern
                     Match a value. Returns status zero if the pattern matches
                     at least one of the strings in the value.

       zformat -f param format spec ...
       zformat -F param format spec ...
       zformat -a array sep spec ...
              This  builtin  provides different forms of formatting. The first
              form is selected with the -f option. In  this  case  the  format
              string  will  be modified by replacing sequences starting with a
              percent sign in it with  strings  from  the  specs.   Each  spec
              should  be  of the form `char:string' which will cause every ap-
              pearance of the sequence `%char' in format to be replaced by the
              string.   The `%' sequence may also contain optional minimum and
              maximum field width  specifications  between  the  `%'  and  the
              `char'  in the form `%min.maxc', i.e. the minimum field width is
              given first and if the maximum field width is used, it has to be
              preceded  by  a dot.  Specifying a minimum field width makes the
              result be padded with spaces to  the  right  if  the  string  is
              shorter  than  the  requested width.  Padding to the left can be
              achieved by giving a negative minimum field width.  If a maximum
              field  width  is  specified,  the string will be truncated after
              that many characters.  After all `%'  sequences  for  the  given
              specs have been processed, the resulting string is stored in the
              parameter param.

              The %-escapes also understand ternary expressions  in  the  form
              used  by  prompts.  The % is followed by a `(' and then an ordi-
              nary format specifier character as described above.   There  may
              be a set of digits either before or after the `('; these specify
              a test number, which defaults to  zero.   Negative  numbers  are
              also allowed.  An arbitrary delimiter character follows the for-
              mat specifier, which is followed by a piece of `true' text,  the
              delimiter  character again, a piece of `false' text, and a clos-
              ing parenthesis.  The complete expression (without  the  digits)
              thus  looks like `%(X.text1.text2)', except that the `.' charac-
              ter is arbitrary.  The value given for the format  specifier  in
              the  char:string  expressions is evaluated as a mathematical ex-
              pression, and compared with the test number.  If  they  are  the
              same,  text1 is output, else text2 is output.  A parenthesis may
              be escaped in text2 as %).  Either of text1 or text2 may contain
              nested %-escapes.

              For example:

                     zformat -f REPLY "The answer is '%3(c.yes.no)'." c:3

              outputs  "The answer is 'yes'." to REPLY since the value for the
              format specifier c is 3, agreeing with the digit argument to the
              ternary expression.

              With  -F  instead  of -f, ternary expressions choose between the
              `true' or `false' text on the basis of whether the format speci-
              fier  is present and non-empty.  A test number indicates a mini-
              mum width for the value given in the format specifier.  Negative
              numbers  reverse  this, so the test is for whether the value ex-
              ceeds a maximum width.

              The form, using the -a option, can be used for aligning strings.
              Here,  the  specs  are of the form `left:right' where `left' and
              `right' are arbitrary strings.  These strings  are  modified  by
              replacing  the  colons  by  the  sep string and padding the left
              strings with spaces to the right so that the sep strings in  the
              result  (and hence the right strings after them) are all aligned
              if the strings are printed below each other.  All strings  with-
              out  a  colon  are  left unchanged and all strings with an empty
              right string have the trailing colon removed.  In both cases the
              lengths  of  the strings are not used to determine how the other
              strings are to be aligned.  A colon in the left  string  can  be
              escaped  with  a backslash.  The resulting strings are stored in
              the array.

       zregexparse
              This implements some internals of the _regex_arguments function.

       zparseopts [ -D -E -F -K -M ] [ -a array ] [ -A assoc ] [ - ] spec ...
              This builtin simplifies the parsing of options in positional pa-
              rameters,  i.e. the set of arguments given by $*.  Each spec de-
              scribes one option and must be of the form `opt[=array]'.  If an
              option described by opt is found in the positional parameters it
              is copied into the array specified with the -a  option;  if  the
              optional  `=array'  is given, it is instead copied into that ar-
              ray, which should be declared as a normal array and never as  an
              associative array.

              Note  that  it  is an error to give any spec without an `=array'
              unless one of the -a or -A options is used.

              Unless the -E option is given, parsing stops at the first string
              that isn't described by one of the specs.  Even with -E, parsing
              always stops at a positional parameter equal to `-' or `--'. See
              also -F.

              The  opt  description  must be one of the following.  Any of the
              special characters can appear in the option name provided it  is
              preceded by a backslash.

              name
              name+  The  name  is  the name of the option without the leading
                     `-'.  To specify a GNU-style  long  option,  one  of  the
                     usual two leading `-' must be included in name; for exam-
                     ple, a `--file'  option  is  represented  by  a  name  of
                     `-file'.

                     If  a  `+'  appears after name, the option is appended to
                     array each time it is found in the positional parameters;
                     without the `+' only the last occurrence of the option is
                     preserved.

                     If one of these forms is used, the option takes no  argu-
                     ment,  so  parsing stops if the next positional parameter
                     does not also begin with `-' (unless  the  -E  option  is
                     used).

              name:
              name:-
              name:: If one or two colons are given, the option takes an argu-
                     ment; with one colon, the argument is mandatory and  with
                     two  colons  it is optional.  The argument is appended to
                     the array after the option itself.

                     An optional argument is put into the same  array  element
                     as the option name (note that this makes empty strings as
                     arguments indistinguishable).  A  mandatory  argument  is
                     added as a separate element unless the `:-' form is used,
                     in which case the argument is put into the same element.

                     A `+' as described above may appear between the name  and
                     the first colon.

              In  all  cases,  option-arguments must appear either immediately
              following the option in the same positional parameter or in  the
              next  one.  Even an optional argument may appear in the next pa-
              rameter, unless it begins with a `-'.  There is no special  han-
              dling  of `=' as with GNU-style argument parsers; given the spec
              `-foo:', the  positional  parameter  `--foo=bar'  is  parsed  as
              `--foo' with an argument of `=bar'.

              When  the  names  of two options that take no arguments overlap,
              the longest one wins, so that parsing for the specs `-foo  -foo-
              bar' (for example) is unambiguous. However, due to the aforemen-
              tioned handling of option-arguments, ambiguities may arise  when
              at  least  one  overlapping spec takes an argument, as in `-foo:
              -foobar'. In that case, the last matching spec wins.

              The options of zparseopts itself cannot be stacked because,  for
              example,  the  stack `-DEK' is indistinguishable from a spec for
              the GNU-style long option `--DEK'.  The  options  of  zparseopts
              itself are:

              -a array
                     As described above, this names the default array in which
                     to store the recognised options.

              -A assoc
                     If this is given, the options and their values  are  also
                     put  into  an  associative array with the option names as
                     keys and the arguments (if any) as the values.

              -D     If this option is given, all options  found  are  removed
                     from  the  positional  parameters of the calling shell or
                     shell function, up to but not including any not described
                     by  the  specs.   If  the  first such parameter is `-' or
                     `--', it is removed as well.  This is  similar  to  using
                     the shift builtin.

              -E     This  changes  the parsing rules to not stop at the first
                     string that isn't described by one of the specs.  It  can
                     be used to test for or (if used together with -D) extract
                     options and their arguments, ignoring all  other  options
                     and  arguments  that may be in the positional parameters.
                     As indicated above, parsing still stops at the first  `-'
                     or  `--'  not  described by a spec, but it is not removed
                     when used with -D.

              -F     If this option is given, zparseopts immediately stops  at
                     the  first  option-like parameter not described by one of
                     the specs, prints an error message, and returns status 1.
                     Removal  (-D)  and extraction (-E) are not performed, and
                     option arrays are not updated.  This provides basic vali-
                     dation for the given options.

                     Note  that the appearance in the positional parameters of
                     an option without its  required  argument  always  aborts
                     parsing  and  returns an error as described above regard-
                     less of whether this option is used.

              -K     With this option, the arrays specified with the -a option
                     and  with the `=array' forms are kept unchanged when none
                     of the specs for them is used.  Otherwise the entire  ar-
                     ray  is replaced when any of the specs is used.  Individ-
                     ual elements of associative arrays specified with the  -A
                     option  are  preserved  by -K.  This allows assignment of
                     default values to arrays before calling zparseopts.

              -M     This changes the assignment  rules  to  implement  a  map
                     among  equivalent  option  names.   If  any spec uses the
                     `=array' form, the string array  is  interpreted  as  the
                     name  of  another  spec, which is used to choose where to
                     store the values.  If no other spec is found, the  values
                     are  stored as usual.  This changes only the way the val-
                     ues are stored, not the way $* is parsed, so results  may
                     be  unpredictable if the `name+' specifier is used incon-
                     sistently.

              For example,

                     set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
                     zparseopts a=foo b:=bar c+:=bar

              will have the effect of

                     foo=(-a)
                     bar=(-b x -c y -c z)

              The arguments from `baz' on will not be used.

              As an example for the -E option, consider:

                     set -- -a x -b y -c z arg1 arg2
                     zparseopts -E -D b:=bar

              will have the effect of

                     bar=(-b y)
                     set -- -a x -c z arg1 arg2

              I.e., the option -b and its arguments are taken from  the  posi-
              tional parameters and put into the array bar.

              The -M option can be used like this:

                     set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
                     zparseopts -A bar -M a=foo b+: c:=b

              to have the effect of

                     foo=(-a)
                     bar=(-a '' -b xyz)

ZSHCALSYS(1)                General Commands Manual               ZSHCALSYS(1)

NAME
       zshcalsys - zsh calendar system

DESCRIPTION
       The shell is supplied with a series of functions to replace and enhance
       the traditional Unix calendar programme, which warns the user of  immi-
       nent or future events, details of which are stored in a text file (typ-
       ically calendar in the user's home directory).   The  version  provided
       here includes a mechanism for alerting the user when an event is due.

       In  addition  functions  age, before and after are provided that can be
       used in a glob qualifier; they allow files  to  be  selected  based  on
       their modification times.

       The  format of the calendar file and the dates used there in and in the
       age function are described first, then the functions that can be called
       to examine and modify the calendar file.

       The  functions here depend on the availability of the zsh/datetime mod-
       ule which is usually installed with the shell.   The  library  function
       strptime()  must  be  available; it is present on most recent operating
       systems.

FILE AND DATE FORMATS
   Calendar File Format
       The calendar file is by default ~/calendar.  This can be configured  by
       the  calendar-file style, see the section STYLES below.  The basic for-
       mat consists of a series of separate lines, with no  indentation,  each
       including  a  date  and time specification followed by a description of
       the event.

       Various enhancements to this format are supported, based on the  syntax
       of Emacs calendar mode.  An indented line indicates a continuation line
       that continues the description of the event  from  the  preceding  line
       (note the date may not be continued in this way).  An initial ampersand
       (&) is ignored for compatibility.

       An indented line on which the first non-whitespace character  is  #  is
       not  displayed with the calendar entry, but is still scanned for infor-
       mation.  This can be used to hide information useful  to  the  calendar
       system  but not to the user, such as the unique identifier used by cal-
       endar_add.

       The Emacs extension that a date with no description may refer to a num-
       ber of succeeding events at different times is not supported.

       Unless the done-file style has been altered, any events which have been
       processed are appended to the file with the same name as  the  calendar
       file with the suffix .done, hence ~/calendar.done by default.

       An example is shown below.

   Date Format
       The  format of the date and time is designed to allow flexibility with-
       out admitting ambiguity.  (The words `date' and `time' are both used in
       the documentation below; except where specifically noted this implies a
       string that may include both a date and a  time  specification.)   Note
       that  there  is no localization support; month and day names must be in
       English and separator characters are fixed.  Matching is case  insensi-
       tive,  and  only  the first three letters of the names are significant,
       although as a special case a form  beginning  "month"  does  not  match
       "Monday".   Furthermore,  time zones are not handled; all times are as-
       sumed to be local.

       It is recommended that, rather than exploring the  intricacies  of  the
       system,  users  find a date format that is natural to them and stick to
       it.  This will avoid unexpected effects.  Various key facts  should  be
       noted.

       •      In  particular,  note  the  confusion between month/day/year and
              day/month/year when the month is numeric; these  formats  should
              be avoided if at all possible.  Many alternatives are available.

       •      The  year  must  be  given  in full to avoid confusion, and only
              years from 1900 to 2099 inclusive are matched.

       The following give some obvious examples; users finding here  a  format
       they  like  and  not subject to vagaries of style may skip the full de-
       scription.  As dates and times are matched separately (even though  the
       time  may  be  embedded in the date), any date format may be mixed with
       any format for the time of day provide the separators are clear (white-
       space, colons, commas).

              2007/04/03 13:13
              2007/04/03:13:13
              2007/04/03 1:13 pm
              3rd April 2007, 13:13
              April 3rd 2007 1:13 p.m.
              Apr 3, 2007 13:13
              Tue Apr 03 13:13:00 2007
              13:13 2007/apr/3

       More detailed rules follow.

       Times  are  parsed and extracted before dates.  They must use colons to
       separate hours and minutes, though a dot is allowed before  seconds  if
       they are present.  This limits time formats to the following:

       •      HH:MM[:SS[.FFFFF]] [am|pm|a.m.|p.m.]

       •      HH:MM.SS[.FFFFF] [am|pm|a.m.|p.m.]

       Here,  square brackets indicate optional elements, possibly with alter-
       natives.  Fractions of a second are recognised but ignored.  For  abso-
       lute times (the normal format require by the calendar file and the age,
       before and after functions) a date is mandatory but a time  of  day  is
       not;  the  time returned is at the start of the date.  One variation is
       allowed: if a.m. or p.m. or one of their variants is present,  an  hour
       without a minute is allowed, e.g. 3 p.m..

       Time  zones  are not handled, though if one is matched following a time
       specification it will be removed to allow  a  surrounding  date  to  be
       parsed.  This only happens if the format of the timezone is not too un-
       usual.  The following are examples of forms that are understood:

              +0100
              GMT
              GMT-7
              CET+1CDT

       Any part of the timezone that is not numeric must  have  exactly  three
       capital letters in the name.

       Dates  suffer from the ambiguity between DD/MM/YYYY and MM/DD/YYYY.  It
       is recommended this form is avoided with purely numeric dates, but  use
       of ordinals, eg. 3rd/04/2007, will resolve the ambiguity as the ordinal
       is always parsed as the day of the month.  Years must  be  four  digits
       (and  the  first  two  must  be  19 or 20); 03/04/08 is not recognised.
       Other numbers may have leading zeroes, but they are not required.   The
       following are handled:

       •      YYYY/MM/DDYYYY-MM-DDYYYY/MNM/DDYYYY-MNM-DDDD[th|st|rd] MNM[,] [ YYYY ]

       •      MNM DD[th|st|rd][,] [ YYYY ]

       •      DD[th|st|rd]/MM[,] YYYYDD[th|st|rd]/MM/YYYYMM/DD[th|st|rd][,] YYYYMM/DD[th|st|rd]/YYYY

       Here,  MNM is at least the first three letters of a month name, matched
       case-insensitively.  The remainder of the month name may appear but its
       contents  are  irrelevant,  so  janissary,  febrile,  martial, apricot,
       maybe, junta, etc. are happily handled.

       Where the year is shown as  optional,  the  current  year  is  assumed.
       There  are  only  two  such cases, the form Jun 20 or 14 September (the
       only two commonly occurring forms, apart from a "the" in some forms  of
       English,  which  isn't currently supported).  Such dates will of course
       become ambiguous in the future, so should ideally be avoided.

       Times may follow dates with a colon, e.g. 1965/07/12:09:45; this is  in
       order  to  provide a format with no whitespace.  A comma and whitespace
       are allowed, e.g. 1965/07/12, 09:45.  Currently the order of these sep-
       arators  is  not  checked,  so  illogical formats such as 1965/07/12, :
       ,09:45 will also be matched.  For simplicity such  variations  are  not
       shown in the list above.  Otherwise, a time is only recognised as being
       associated with a date if there is only whitespace in  between,  or  if
       the time was embedded in the date.

       Days  of the week are not normally scanned, but will be ignored if they
       occur at the start of the date  pattern  only.   However,  in  contexts
       where it is useful to specify dates relative to today, days of the week
       with no other date specification may be given.  The day is  assumed  to
       be  either  today or within the past week.  Likewise, the words yester-
       day, today and tomorrow are handled.  All matches are case-insensitive.
       Hence  if today is Monday, then Sunday is equivalent to yesterday, Mon-
       day is equivalent to today, but Tuesday gives  a  date  six  days  ago.
       This  is  not generally useful within the calendar file.  Dates in this
       format may be combined with a time specification; for example Tomorrow,
       8 p.m..

       For example, the standard date format:

              Fri Aug 18 17:00:48 BST 2006

       is  handled  by  matching  HH:MM:SS  and  removing it together with the
       matched (but unused) time zone.  This leaves the following:

              Fri Aug 18 2006

       Fri is ignored and the rest is matched according to the standard rules.

   Relative Time Format
       In certain places relative times are handled.  Here, a date is not  al-
       lowed;  instead a combination of various supported periods are allowed,
       together with an optional time.  The periods must be in order from most
       to least significant.

       In some cases, a more accurate calculation is possible when there is an
       anchor date:  offsets of months or years pick the correct  day,  rather
       than  being  rounded,  and it is possible to pick a particular day in a
       month as `(1st Friday)', etc., as described in more detail below.

       Anchors are available in the following cases.  If one or two times  are
       passed  to the function calendar, the start time acts an anchor for the
       end time when the end time is relative (even if the start time  is  im-
       plicit).   When examining calendar files, the scheduled event being ex-
       amined anchors the warning time when it is given explicitly by means of
       the  WARN  keyword;  likewise, the scheduled event anchors a repetition
       period when given by the RPT keyword, so that  specifications  such  as
       RPT 2 months, 3rd Thursday are handled properly.  Finally, the -R argu-
       ment to calendar_scandate directly provides an anchor for relative cal-
       culations.

       The periods handled, with possible abbreviations are:

       Years  years,  yrs, ys, year, yr, y, yearly.  A year is 365.25 days un-
              less there is an anchor.

       Months months, mons, mnths, mths, month, mon, mnth, mth, monthly.  Note
              that  m, ms, mn, mns are ambiguous and are not handled.  A month
              is a period of 30 days rather than a calendar month unless there
              is an anchor.

       Weeks  weeks, wks, ws, week, wk, w, weekly

       Days   days, dys, ds, day, dy, d, daily

       Hours  hours, hrs, hs, hour, hr, h, hourly

       Minutes
              minutes, mins, minute, min, but not m, ms, mn or mns

       Seconds
              seconds, secs, ss, second, sec, s

       Spaces  between  the  numbers  are  optional,  but are required between
       items, although a comma may be used (with or without spaces).

       The forms yearly to hourly allow the number to be omitted;  it  is  as-
       sumed  to  be 1.  For example, 1 d and daily are equivalent.  Note that
       using those forms with plurals is confusing; 2 yearly is the same as  2
       years, not twice yearly, so it is recommended they only be used without
       numbers.

       When an anchor time is present, there is an extension to handle regular
       events  in the form of the nth someday of the month.  Such a specifica-
       tion must occur immediately after any year and month specification, but
       before  any  time  of day, and must be in the form n(th|st|rd) day, for
       example 1st Tuesday or 3rd  Monday.   As  in  other  places,  days  are
       matched  case  insensitively,  must  be  in English, and only the first
       three letters are significant except that a form beginning `month' does
       not match `Monday'.  No attempt is made to sanitize the resulting date;
       attempts to squeeze too many occurrences into a month will push the day
       into  the next month (but in the obvious fashion, retaining the correct
       day of the week).

       Here are some examples:

              30 years 3 months 4 days 3:42:41
              14 days 5 hours
              Monthly, 3rd Thursday
              4d,10hr

   Example
       Here is an example calendar file.  It uses a consistent date format, as
       recommended above.

              Feb 1, 2006 14:30 Pointless bureaucratic meeting
              Mar 27, 2006 11:00 Mutual recrimination and finger pointing
                Bring water pistol and waterproofs
              Mar 31, 2006 14:00 Very serious managerial pontification
                # UID 12C7878A9A50
              Apr 10, 2006 13:30 Even more pointless blame assignment exercise WARN 30 mins
              May 18, 2006 16:00 Regular moaning session RPT monthly, 3rd Thursday

       The  second  entry has a continuation line.  The third entry has a con-
       tinuation line that will not be shown when the entry is displayed,  but
       the  unique  identifier  will be used by the calendar_add function when
       updating the event.  The fourth entry will produce a warning 30 minutes
       before  the  event (to allow you to equip yourself appropriately).  The
       fifth entry repeats after a month on the 3rd Thursday,  i.e.  June  15,
       2006, at the same time.

USER FUNCTIONS
       This  section  describes  functions  that are designed to be called di-
       rectly by the user.  The first part describes those  functions  associ-
       ated  with  the  user's  calendar; the second part describes the use in
       glob qualifiers.

   Calendar system functions
       calendar [ -abdDsv ] [ -C calfile ] [ -n num ] [ -S showprog ]
                [ [ start ] end ]
       calendar -r [ -abdDrsv ] [ -C calfile ] [ -n num ] [ -S showprog ]
                [ start ]
              Show events in the calendar.

              With no arguments, show events from the start of today until the
              end of the next working day after today.  In other words, if to-
              day is Friday, Saturday, or Sunday, show up to the  end  of  the
              following Monday, otherwise show today and tomorrow.

              If  end  is given, show events from the start of today up to the
              time and date given, which is in the  format  described  in  the
              previous  section.   Note that if this is a date the time is as-
              sumed to be midnight at the start of the date,  so  that  effec-
              tively this shows all events before the given date.

              end may start with a +, in which case the remainder of the spec-
              ification is a relative time format as described in the previous
              section indicating the range of time from the start time that is
              to be included.

              If start is also given, show events starting from that time  and
              date.  The word now can be used to indicate the current time.

              To  implement  an alert when events are due, include calendar -s
              in your ~/.zshrc file.

              Options:

              -a     Show all items in the calendar, regardless of  the  start
                     and end.

              -b     Brief:   don't  display continuation lines (i.e. indented
                     lines following the line with the  date/time),  just  the
                     first line.

              -B lines
                     Brief:  display at most the first lines lines of the cal-
                     endar entry.  `-B 1' is equivalent to `-b'.

              -C calfile
                     Explicitly specify a calendar file instead of  the  value
                     of the calendar-file style or the default ~/calendar.

              -d     Move  any  events that have passed from the calendar file
                     to the "done" file, as given by the  done-file  style  or
                     the  default  which  is  the calendar file with .done ap-
                     pended.  This option is implied by the -s option.

              -D     Turns off the option -d, even if the -s  option  is  also
                     present.

              -n num, -num
                     Show  at  least  num  events,  if present in the calendar
                     file, regardless of the start and end.

              -r     Show all the remaining options in the calendar,  ignoring
                     the given end time.  The start time is respected; any ar-
                     gument given is treated as a start time.

              -s     Use the shell's sched command to schedule a  timed  event
                     that  will warn the user when an event is due.  Note that
                     the sched command only runs if the shell is at an  inter-
                     active  prompt;  a  foreground  task blocks the scheduled
                     task from running until it is finished.

                     The timed event usually runs the programme  calendar_show
                     to  show  the  event, as described in the section UTILITY
                     FUNCTIONS below.

                     By default, a warning of the event is shown five  minutes
                     before  it  is due.  The warning period can be configured
                     by the style warn-time or for a single calendar entry  by
                     including  WARN  reltime  in the first line of the entry,
                     where reltime is one of the usual relative time formats.

                     A repeated event may be indicated by including  RPT  rel-
                     date in the first line of the entry.  After the scheduled
                     event has been displayed it will be re-entered  into  the
                     calendar file at a time reldate after the existing event.
                     Note that this is currently the only use made of the  re-
                     peat  count,  so  that  it  is  not possible to query the
                     schedule for a recurrence of an event in the calendar un-
                     til the previous event has passed.

                     If  RPT is used, it is also possible to specify that cer-
                     tain recurrences of an  event  are  rescheduled  or  can-
                     celled.   This  is done with the OCCURRENCE keyword, fol-
                     lowed by whitespace and the date and time of  the  occur-
                     rence in the regular sequence, followed by whitespace and
                     either the date and time of the rescheduled event or  the
                     exact  string  CANCELLED.  In this case the date and time
                     must be in exactly the "date with local time" format used
                     by    the    text/calendar    MIME   type   (RFC   2445),
                     <YYYY><MM><DD>T<hh><mm><ss> (note  the  presence  of  the
                     literal character T).  The first word (the regular recur-
                     rence) may be something other than a proper date/time  to
                     indicate  that  the event is additional to the normal se-
                     quence; a convention that retains the formatting  appear-
                     ance is XXXXXXXXTXXXXXX.

                     Furthermore,  it is useful to record the next regular re-
                     currence (as  then  the  displayed  date  may  be  for  a
                     rescheduled  event  so cannot be used for calculating the
                     regular sequence).  This is specified by RECURRENCE and a
                     time  or date in the same format.  calendar_add adds such
                     an indication when it encounters a recurring  event  that
                     does not include one, based on the headline date/time.

                     If  calendar_add  is  used  to update occurrences the UID
                     keyword described there should be present in both the ex-
                     isting  entry  and the added occurrence in order to iden-
                     tify recurring event sequences.

                     For example,

                            Thu May 6, 2010 11:00 Informal chat RPT 1 week
                              # RECURRENCE 20100506T110000
                              # OCCURRENCE 20100513T110000 20100513T120000
                              # OCCURRENCE 20100520T110000 CANCELLED

                     The event that occurs  at  11:00  on  13th  May  2010  is
                     rescheduled  an hour later.  The event that occurs a week
                     later is cancelled.  The occurrences are given on a  con-
                     tinuation  line  starting  with a # character so will not
                     usually be displayed as part of the event.  As elsewhere,
                     no  account  of time zones is taken with the times. After
                     the next event occurs the headline date/time will be `Thu
                     May  13,  2010 12:00' while the RECURRENCE date/time will
                     be  `20100513T110000'  (note  that  cancelled  and  moved
                     events  are not taken account of in the RECURRENCE, which
                     records what the next regular recurrence is, but they are
                     accounted for in the headline date/time).

                     It  is  safe to run calendar -s to reschedule an existing
                     event (if the calendar file has  changed,  for  example),
                     and also to have it running in multiples instances of the
                     shell since the calendar file is locked when in use.

                     By default, expired events are moved to the "done"  file;
                     see the -d option.  Use -D to prevent this.

              -S showprog
                     Explicitly  specify  a  programme  to be used for showing
                     events instead of the value of the show-prog style or the
                     default calendar_show.

              -v     Verbose:   show more information about stages of process-
                     ing.  This is useful for confirming that the function has
                     successfully parsed the dates in the calendar file.

       calendar_add [ -BL ] event ...
              Adds a single event to the calendar in the appropriate location.
              The event can contain multiple lines, as described in  the  sec-
              tion  `Calendar File Format' above.  Using this function ensures
              that the calendar file is sorted in date  and  time  order.   It
              also makes special arrangements for locking the file while it is
              altered.  The old calendar is left in a  file  with  the  suffix
              .old.

              The  option  -B indicates that backing up the calendar file will
              be handled by the caller and should not be performed  by  calen-
              dar_add.   The  option  -L  indicates that calendar_add does not
              need to lock the calendar file as it is already  locked.   These
              options will not usually be needed by users.

              If the style reformat-date is true, the date and time of the new
              entry will be rewritten into the standard date format:  see  the
              descriptions of this style and the style date-format.

              The  function can use a unique identifier stored with each event
              to ensure that updates to existing events are treated correctly.
              The  entry  should contain the word UID, followed by whitespace,
              followed by a word consisting entirely of hexadecimal digits  of
              arbitrary  length (all digits are significant, including leading
              zeroes).  As the UID is not directly useful to the user,  it  is
              convenient  to hide it on an indented continuation line starting
              with a #, for example:

                     Aug 31, 2007 09:30  Celebrate the end of the holidays
                       # UID 045B78A0

              The second line will not be shown by the calendar function.

              It is possible to specify the RPT keyword followed by  CANCELLED
              instead  of  a  relative time.  This causes any matched event or
              series of events to be cancelled (the original  event  does  not
              have  to be marked as recurring in order to be cancelled by this
              method).  A UID is required in order to match an existing  event
              in the calendar.

              calendar_add  will attempt to manage recurrences and occurrences
              of repeating events as described for event scheduling by  calen-
              dar  -s  above.   To  reschedule or cancel a single event calen-
              dar_add should be called with an entry that includes the correct
              UID  but  does  not  include the RPT keyword as this is taken to
              mean the entry applies to a series of repeating events and hence
              replaces  all  existing  information.   Each rescheduled or can-
              celled occurrence must have an OCCURRENCE keyword in  the  entry
              passed  to  calendar_add  which will be merged into the calendar
              file.  Any existing reference to the occurrence is replaced.  An
              occurrence  that  does  not  refer  to a valid existing event is
              added as a one-off occurrence to the same calendar entry.

       calendar_edit
              This calls the user's editor to  edit  the  calendar  file.   If
              there  are  arguments,  they are taken as the editor to use (the
              file name is appended to the commands); otherwise, the editor is
              given by the variable VISUAL, if set, else the variable EDITOR.

              If  the  calendar  scheduler was running, then after editing the
              file calendar -s is called to update it.

              This function locks out the calendar  system  during  the  edit.
              Hence  it  should  be used to edit the calendar file if there is
              any possibility of a calendar event occurring  meanwhile.   Note
              this  can  lead to another shell with calendar functions enabled
              hanging waiting for a lock, so it is necessary to quit the  edi-
              tor as soon as possible.

       calendar_parse calendar-entry
              This  is the internal function that analyses the parts of a cal-
              endar entry, which is passed as the only argument.  The function
              returns status 1 if the argument could not be parsed as a calen-
              dar entry and status 2 if the wrong  number  of  arguments  were
              passed; it also sets the parameter reply to an empty associative
              array.  Otherwise, it returns status 0 and sets elements of  the
              associative array reply as follows:

              time   The  time  as  a  string  of  digits in the same units as
                     $EPOCHSECONDS
              schedtime
                     The regularly scheduled time.  This may differ  from  the
                     actual  event  time time if this is a recurring event and
                     the next occurrence  has  been  rescheduled.   Then  time
                     gives the actual time and schedtime the time of the regu-
                     lar recurrence before modification.
              text1  The text from the line not including the date and time of
                     the  event,  but  including  any WARN or RPT keywords and
                     values.
              warntime
                     Any warning time given by the WARN keyword as a string of
                     digits  containing  the time at which to warn in the same
                     units as $EPOCHSECONDS.  (Note this is an absolute  time,
                     not the relative time passed down.)  Not set no WARN key-
                     word and value were matched.
              warnstr
                     The raw string matched after the WARN keyword,  else  un-
                     set.
              rpttime
                     Any  recurrence time given by the RPT keyword as a string
                     of digits containing the time of the  recurrence  in  the
                     same  units  as $EPOCHSECONDS.  (Note this is an absolute
                     time.)  Not set if no RPT keyword and value were matched.
              schedrpttime
                     The next regularly scheduled occurrence  of  a  recurring
                     event before modification.  This may differ from rpttime,
                     which is the actual time of the event that may have  been
                     rescheduled from the regular time.
              rptstr The raw string matched after the RPT keyword, else unset.
              text2  The  text from the line after removal of the date and any
                     keywords and values.

       calendar_showdate [ -r ] [ -f fmt ] date-spec ...
              The given date-spec is interpreted and  the  corresponding  date
              and time printed.  If the initial date-spec begins with a + or -
              it is treated as relative to the current time; date-specs  after
              the  first are treated as relative to the date calculated so far
              and a leading + is optional in that case.  This  allows  one  to
              use  the  system  as  a  date  calculator.   For example, calen-
              dar_showdate '+1 month, 1st Friday' shows the date of the  first
              Friday of next month.

              With  the option -r nothing is printed but the value of the date
              and time in seconds since the epoch is stored in  the  parameter
              REPLY.

              With  the option -f fmt the given date/time conversion format is
              passed to strftime; see notes on the date-format style below.

              In order to avoid ambiguity with negative relative date specifi-
              cations,  options  must occur in separate words; in other words,
              -r and -f should not be combined in the same word.

       calendar_sort
              Sorts the calendar file into date and  time  order.     The  old
              calendar is left in a file with the suffix .old.

   Glob qualifiers
       age    The  function  age can be autoloaded and use separately from the
              calendar system, although it uses the function calendar_scandate
              for date formatting.  It requires the zsh/stat builtin, but uses
              only the builtin zstat.

              age selects files having a given modification time for use as  a
              glob  qualifier.  The format of the date is the same as that un-
              derstood by the calendar system, described in the  section  FILE
              AND DATE FORMATS above.

              The  function  can  take one or two arguments, which can be sup-
              plied either directly as command or arguments, or separately  as
              shell parameters.

                     print *(e:age 2006/10/04 2006/10/09:)

              The  example  above matches all files modified between the start
              of those dates.  The second argument may alternatively be a rel-
              ative time introduced by a +:

                     print *(e:age 2006/10/04 +5d:)

              The example above is equivalent to the previous example.

              In  addition  to  the special use of days of the week, today and
              yesterday, times with no date may be specified; these  apply  to
              today.  Obviously such uses become problematic around midnight.

                     print *(e-age 12:00 13:30-)

              The  example  above shows files modified between 12:00 and 13:00
              today.

                     print *(e:age 2006/10/04:)

              The example above matches all files modified on that  date.   If
              the  second  argument  is  omitted  it is taken to be exactly 24
              hours after the first argument (even if the first argument  con-
              tains a time).

                     print *(e-age 2006/10/04:10:15 2006/10/04:10:45-)

              The  example  above supplies times.  Note that whitespace within
              the time and date specification must be quoted to ensure age re-
              ceives  the  correct  arguments, hence the use of the additional
              colon to separate the date and time.

                     AGEREF=2006/10/04:10:15
                     AGEREF2=2006/10/04:10:45
                     print *(+age)

              This shows the same example before using another form  of  argu-
              ment  passing.  The dates and times in the parameters AGEREF and
              AGEREF2 stay in effect until unset, but will  be  overridden  if
              any  argument is passed as an explicit argument to age.  Any ex-
              plicit argument causes both parameters to be ignored.

              Instead of an explicit date and time, it's possible to  use  the
              modification  time of a file as the date and time for either ar-
              gument by introducing the file name with a colon:

                     print *(e-age :file1-)

              matches all files created on the same  day  (24  hours  starting
              from midnight) as file1.

                     print *(e-age :file1 :file2-)

              matches  all  files  modified no earlier than file1 and no later
              than file2; precision here is to the nearest second.

       after
       before The functions after and before are simpler versions of age  that
              take  just one argument.  The argument is parsed similarly to an
              argument of age; if it is not given the variable AGEREF is  con-
              sulted.   As  the names of the functions suggest, a file matches
              if its modification time is after or before the  time  and  date
              specified.  If a time only is given the date is today.

              The two following examples are therefore equivalent:
                     print *(e-after 12:00-)
                     print *(e-after today:12:00-)

STYLES
       The zsh style mechanism using the zstyle command is describe in zshmod-
       ules(1).  This is the same mechanism used in the completion system.

       The styles below are all examined in the  context  :datetime:function:,
       for example :datetime:calendar:.

       calendar-file
              The location of the main calendar.  The default is ~/calendar.

       date-format
              A  strftime  format string (see strftime(3)) with the zsh exten-
              sions providing various numbers with no leading zero or space if
              the  number  is  a  single digit as described for the %D{string}
              prompt format in the section EXPANSION OF  PROMPT  SEQUENCES  in
              zshmisc(1).

              This  is  used for outputting dates in calendar, both to support
              the -v option and when adding recurring events back to the  cal-
              endar file, and in calendar_showdate as the final output format.

              If  the  style is not set, the default used is similar the stan-
              dard system format as output by the date command (also known  as
              `ctime format'): `%a %b %d %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'.

       done-file
              The  location  of the file to which events which have passed are
              appended.  The default is the calendar file  location  with  the
              suffix  .done.  The style may be set to an empty string in which
              case a "done" file will not be maintained.

       reformat-date
              Boolean, used by calendar_add.  If it is true, the date and time
              of  new entries added to the calendar will be reformatted to the
              format given by the style date-format or its default.  Only  the
              date and time of the event itself is reformatted; any subsidiary
              dates and times such as those associated with repeat and warning
              times are left alone.

       show-prog
              The  programme  run  by calendar for showing events.  It will be
              passed the start time and stop time of the events  requested  in
              seconds  since  the epoch followed by the event text.  Note that
              calendar -s uses a start time and stop time equal to one another
              to indicate alerts for specific events.

              The default is the function calendar_show.

       warn-time
              The  time  before an event at which a warning will be displayed,
              if the first line of the event does not include the  text  EVENT
              reltime.  The default is 5 minutes.

UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       calendar_lockfiles
              Attempt  to  lock  the  files given in the argument.  To prevent
              problems with network file locking this is done  in  an  ad  hoc
              fashion by attempting to create a symbolic link to the file with
              the name file.lockfile.  No other  system  level  functions  are
              used  for locking, i.e. the file can be accessed and modified by
              any utility that does not use this  mechanism.   In  particular,
              the  user is not prevented from editing the calendar file at the
              same time unless calendar_edit is used.

              Three attempts are made to lock the file before giving  up.   If
              the  module  zsh/zselect is available, the times of the attempts
              are jittered so that multiple instances of the calling  function
              are unlikely to retry at the same time.

              The  files  locked  are  appended  to the array lockfiles, which
              should be local to the caller.

              If all files were successfully locked, status zero is  returned,
              else status one.

              This  function  may  be used as a general file locking function,
              although this will only work if only this mechanism is  used  to
              lock files.

       calendar_read
              This  is  a backend used by various other functions to parse the
              calendar file, which is passed as the only argument.  The  array
              calendar_entries  is  set  to the list of events in the file; no
              pruning is done except that  ampersands  are  removed  from  the
              start of the line.  Each entry may contain multiple lines.

       calendar_scandate
              This  is a generic function to parse dates and times that may be
              used separately from the calendar system.   The  argument  is  a
              date  or time specification as described in the section FILE AND
              DATE FORMATS above.  The parameter REPLY is set to the number of
              seconds  since the epoch corresponding to that date or time.  By
              default, the date and time may occur anywhere within  the  given
              argument.

              Returns  status  zero  if  the  date  and time were successfully
              parsed, else one.

              Options:
              -a     The date and time are anchored to the start of the  argu-
                     ment;  they  will  not  be  matched if there is preceding
                     text.

              -A     The date and time are anchored to both the start and  end
                     of  the  argument; they will not be matched if the is any
                     other text in the argument.

              -d     Enable additional debugging output.

              -m     Minus.  When -R anchor_time is also  given  the  relative
                     time is calculated backwards from anchor_time.

              -r     The argument passed is to be parsed as a relative time.

              -R anchor_time
                     The  argument  passed is to be parsed as a relative time.
                     The time is relative to anchor_time, a  time  in  seconds
                     since  the  epoch, and the returned value is the absolute
                     time corresponding to advancing anchor_time by the  rela-
                     tive  time  given.   This  allows lengths of months to be
                     correctly taken into account.  If the final day does  not
                     exist in the given month, the last day of the final month
                     is given.  For example, if the anchor time is during 31st
                     January  2007 and the relative time is 1 month, the final
                     time is the same time of day during 28th February 2007.

              -s     In addition to setting REPLY, set REPLY2 to the remainder
                     of  the  argument  after  the  date  and  time  have been
                     stripped.  This is empty if the option -A was given.

              -t     Allow a time with no date specification.  The date is as-
                     sumed  to  be today.  The behaviour is unspecified if the
                     iron tongue of midnight is tolling twelve.

       calendar_show
              The function used by default to display events.   It  accepts  a
              start  time  and end time for events, both in epoch seconds, and
              an event description.

              The event is always printed to standard output.  If the  command
              line  editor is active (which will usually be the case) the com-
              mand line will be redisplayed after the output.

              If the parameter DISPLAY is set and the start and end times  are
              the  same  (indicating a scheduled event), the function uses the
              command xmessage to display a window with the event details.

BUGS
       As the system is based entirely on shell functions (with a little  sup-
       port  from  the zsh/datetime module) the mechanisms used are not as ro-
       bust as those provided by a dedicated calendar  utility.   Consequently
       the user should not rely on the shell for vital alerts.

       There is no calendar_delete function.

       There  is  no localization support for dates and times, nor any support
       for the use of time zones.

       Relative periods of months and years do not take into account the vari-
       able number of days.

       The  calendar_show  function is currently hardwired to use xmessage for
       displaying alerts on X Window System displays.  This should be  config-
       urable and ideally integrate better with the desktop.

       calendar_lockfiles  hangs the shell while waiting for a lock on a file.
       If called from a scheduled task, it should instead reschedule the event
       that caused it.

ZSHTCPSYS(1)                General Commands Manual               ZSHTCPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshtcpsys - zsh tcp system

DESCRIPTION
       A  module  zsh/net/tcp  is  provided to provide network I/O over TCP/IP
       from within the shell; see its description in zshmodules(1).  This man-
       ual page describes a function suite based on the module.  If the module
       is installed, the functions are usually installed at the same time,  in
       which  case they will be available for autoloading in the default func-
       tion search path.  In addition to the zsh/net/tcp module, the  zsh/zse-
       lect  module  is  used  to  implement timeouts on read operations.  For
       troubleshooting tips, consult the corresponding  advice  for  the  zftp
       functions described in zshzftpsys(1).

       There  are  functions  corresponding  to the basic I/O operations open,
       close, read and send, named  tcp_open  etc.,  as  well  as  a  function
       tcp_expect  for pattern match analysis of data read as input.  The sys-
       tem makes it easy to receive data from and send data to multiple  named
       sessions  at once.  In addition, it can be linked with the shell's line
       editor in such a way that input data is automatically shown at the ter-
       minal.   Other  facilities  available  including logging, filtering and
       configurable output prompts.

       To use the system where it is available, it should be  enough  to  `au-
       toload  -U  tcp_open'  and  run tcp_open as documented below to start a
       session.  The tcp_open function will autoload the remaining functions.

TCP USER FUNCTIONS
   Basic I/O
       tcp_open [ -qz ] host port [ sess ]
       tcp_open [ -qz ] [ -s sess | -l sess[,...] ] ...
       tcp_open [ -qz ] [ -a fd | -f fd ] [ sess ]
              Open a new session.  In the first and simplest form, open a  TCP
              connection to host host at port port; numeric and symbolic forms
              are understood for both.

              If sess is given, this becomes the name of the session which can
              be used to refer to multiple different TCP connections.  If sess
              is not given, the function will  invent  a  numeric  name  value
              (note  this  is not the same as the file descriptor to which the
              session is attached).  It is recommended that session names  not
              include  `funny'  characters,  where  funny  characters  are not
              well-defined but certainly do not include alphanumerics  or  un-
              derscores, and certainly do include whitespace.

              In  the second case, one or more sessions to be opened are given
              by name.  A  single  session  name  is  given  after  -s  and  a
              comma-separated  list  after -l; both options may be repeated as
              many times as necessary.  A failure to open any  session  causes
              tcp_open  to  abort.   The  host and port are read from the file
              .ztcp_sessions in the same directory as the user's zsh initiali-
              sation  files,  i.e. usually the home directory, but $ZDOTDIR if
              that is set.  The file consists of lines each giving  a  session
              name  and  the  corresponding host and port, in that order (note
              the session name comes first, not  last),  separated  by  white-
              space.

              The  third form allows passive and fake TCP connections.  If the
              option -a is used, its argument is a file  descriptor  open  for
              listening for connections.  No function front-end is provided to
              open such a file descriptor, but a call to `ztcp -l  port'  will
              create one with the file descriptor stored in the parameter $RE-
              PLY.  The listening port can be closed with  `ztcp  -c  fd'.   A
              call  to  `tcp_open -a fd' will block until a remote TCP connec-
              tion is made to port on the local machine.   At  this  point,  a
              session  is  created  in  the usual way and is largely indistin-
              guishable from an active connection  created  with  one  of  the
              first two forms.

              If  the  option  -f  is  used, its argument is a file descriptor
              which is used directly as if it were a TCP  session.   How  well
              the remainder of the TCP function system copes with this depends
              on what actually underlies this file descriptor.  A regular file
              is  likely  to be unusable; a FIFO (pipe) of some sort will work
              better, but note that it is not a good idea  for  two  different
              sessions to attempt to read from the same FIFO at once.

              If  the option -q is given with any of the three forms, tcp_open
              will not print informational messages, although it will  in  any
              case exit with an appropriate status.

              If  the line editor (zle) is in use, which is typically the case
              if the shell is interactive, tcp_open installs a handler  inside
              zle  which will check for new data at the same time as it checks
              for keyboard input.  This is convenient as the shell consumes no
              CPU  time  while waiting; the test is performed by the operating
              system.  Giving the option -z to any of the  forms  of  tcp_open
              prevents  the handler from being installed, so data must be read
              explicitly.  Note, however, this is not necessary for  executing
              complete  sets of send and read commands from a function, as zle
              is not active at this point.  Generally speaking, the handler is
              only  active  when  the  shell is waiting for input at a command
              prompt or in the vared builtin.  The option has no effect if zle
              is not active; `[[ -o zle]]' will test for this.

              The  first  session to be opened becomes the current session and
              subsequent calls to tcp_open do not change it.  The current ses-
              sion  is  stored  in the parameter $TCP_SESS; see below for more
              detail about the parameters used by the system.

              The function tcp_on_open, if defined, is called when  a  session
              is opened.  See the description below.

       tcp_close [ -qn ] [ -a | -l sess[,...] | sess ... ]
              Close  the  named  sessions,  or  the current session if none is
              given, or all open sessions if -a is given.  The options -l  and
              -s  are both handled for consistency with tcp_open, although the
              latter is redundant.

              If the session being closed is the current one, $TCP_SESS is un-
              set,  leaving  no  current session, even if there are other ses-
              sions still open.

              If the session was opened with tcp_open -f, the file  descriptor
              is  closed  so  long as it is in the range 0 to 9 accessible di-
              rectly from the command line.  If the option -n is given, no at-
              tempt  will be made to close file descriptors in this case.  The
              -n option is not used for genuine ztcp  session;  the  file  de-
              scriptors are always closed with the session.

              If  the  option  -q  is given, no informational messages will be
              printed.

       tcp_read [ -bdq ] [ -t TO ] [ -T TO ]
                [ -a | -u fd[,...] | -l sess[,...] | -s sess ... ]
              Perform a read operation on the current session, or on a list of
              sessions  if  any  are given with -u, -l or -s, or all open ses-
              sions if the option -a is given.  Any of the -u, -l  or  -s  op-
              tions  may  be repeated or mixed together.  The -u option speci-
              fies a file descriptor directly (only those managed by this sys-
              tem are useful), the other two specify sessions as described for
              tcp_open above.

              The function checks for new data available on all  the  sessions
              listed.   Unless the -b option is given, it will not block wait-
              ing for new data.  Any one line of data from any of  the  avail-
              able  sessions  will be read, stored in the parameter $TCP_LINE,
              and displayed to standard output unless $TCP_SILENT  contains  a
              non-empty  string.   When  printed to standard output the string
              $TCP_PROMPT will be shown at the start of the line; the  default
              form  for this includes the name of the session being read.  See
              below for more information on these parameters.  In  this  mode,
              tcp_read  can  be  called  repeatedly  until it returns status 2
              which indicates all pending input from  all  specified  sessions
              has been handled.

              With the option -b, equivalent to an infinite timeout, the func-
              tion will block until a line is available to read  from  one  of
              the  specified  sessions.   However,  only  a single line is re-
              turned.

              The option  -d  indicates  that  all  pending  input  should  be
              drained.   In  this  case tcp_read may process multiple lines in
              the manner given above; only the last is  stored  in  $TCP_LINE,
              but the complete set is stored in the array $tcp_lines.  This is
              cleared at the start of each call to tcp_read.

              The options -t and -T specify a timeout in seconds, which may be
              a  floating  point  number  for increased accuracy.  With -t the
              timeout is applied before each line read.  With -T, the  timeout
              applies  to  the  overall operation, possibly including multiple
              read operations if the option -d is present;  without  this  op-
              tion, there is no distinction between -t and -T.

              The  function  does not print informational messages, but if the
              option -q is given, no error message is printed for a  non-exis-
              tent session.

              A  return  status  of  2 indicates a timeout or no data to read.
              Any other non-zero return status indicates some error condition.

              See tcp_log for how to control where data is sent by tcp_read.

       tcp_send [ -cnq ] [ -s sess | -l sess[,...] ] data ...
       tcp_send [ -cnq ] -a data ...
              Send the supplied data strings to all the specified sessions  in
              turn.  The underlying operation differs little from a `print -r'
              to the session's file descriptor, although it attempts  to  pre-
              vent  the  shell  from dying owing to a SIGPIPE caused by an at-
              tempt to write to a defunct session.

              The option -c causes tcp_send to  behave  like  cat.   It  reads
              lines  from  standard input until end of input and sends them in
              turn to the specified session(s) exactly as if they  were  given
              as data arguments to individual tcp_send commands.

              The  option  -n  prevents tcp_send from putting a newline at the
              end of the data strings.

              The remaining options all behave as for tcp_read.

              The data arguments are not further processed once they have been
              passed to tcp_send; they are simply passed down to print -r.

              If  the  parameter $TCP_OUTPUT is a non-empty string and logging
              is enabled then the data sent to each session will be echoed  to
              the  log  file(s)  with  $TCP_OUTPUT in front where appropriate,
              much in the manner of $TCP_PROMPT.

   Session Management
       tcp_alias [ -q ] alias=sess ...
       tcp_alias [ -q ] [ alias ... ]
       tcp_alias -d [ -q ] alias ...
              This function is not particularly well tested.

              The first form creates an alias for a session  name;  alias  can
              then  be  used  to  refer to the existing session sess.  As many
              aliases may be listed as required.

              The second form lists any aliases specified, or all  aliases  if
              none.

              The  third  form deletes all the aliases listed.  The underlying
              sessions are not affected.

              The option -q suppresses an inconsistently chosen subset of  er-
              ror messages.

       tcp_log [ -asc ] [ -n | -N ] [ logfile ]
              With an argument logfile, all future input from tcp_read will be
              logged to the named file.  Unless -a  (append)  is  given,  this
              file  will  first  be truncated or created empty.  With no argu-
              ments, show the current status of logging.

              With the option -s, per-session logging is enabled.  Input  from
              tcp_read  is output to the file logfile.sess.  As the session is
              automatically discriminated by the filename,  the  contents  are
              raw   (no  $TCP_PROMPT).   The  option   -a  applies  as  above.
              Per-session logging and logging of all data in one file are  not
              mutually exclusive.

              The  option -c closes all logging, both complete and per-session
              logs.

              The options -n and -N respectively turn off or restore output of
              data  read  by  tcp_read to standard output; hence `tcp_log -cn'
              turns off all output by tcp_read.

              The function is purely a convenient front end to setting the pa-
              rameters  $TCP_LOG,  $TCP_LOG_SESS,  $TCP_SILENT,  which are de-
              scribed below.

       tcp_rename old new
              Rename session old to session new.  The  old  name  becomes  in-
              valid.

       tcp_sess [ sess [ command [ arg ... ] ] ]
              With  no  arguments,  list  all the open sessions and associated
              file descriptors.  The current session is marked  with  a  star.
              For   use   in   functions,  direct  access  to  the  parameters
              $tcp_by_name, $tcp_by_fd and $TCP_SESS is probably  more  conve-
              nient; see below.

              With  a sess argument, set the current session to sess.  This is
              equivalent to changing $TCP_SESS directly.

              With additional arguments, temporarily set the  current  session
              while  executing  `command arg ...'.  command is re-evaluated so
              as to expand aliases etc., but the  remaining  args  are  passed
              through as that appear to tcp_sess.  The original session is re-
              stored when tcp_sess exits.

   Advanced I/O
       tcp_command send-option ... send-argument ...
              This is a convenient front-end to tcp_send.  All  arguments  are
              passed  to  tcp_send, then the function pauses waiting for data.
              While data is arriving at least every $TCP_TIMEOUT (default 0.3)
              seconds,  data  is handled and printed out according to the cur-
              rent settings.  Status 0 is always returned.

              This is generally only useful for interactive  use,  to  prevent
              the display becoming fragmented by output returned from the con-
              nection.  Within a programme or function it is generally  better
              to handle reading data by a more explicit method.

       tcp_expect [ -q ] [ -p var | -P var ] [ -t TO | -T TO ]
                  [ -a | -s sess | -l sess[,...] ] pattern ...
              Wait  for  input  matching any of the given patterns from any of
              the specified sessions.  Input is ignored until  an  input  line
              matches  one of the given patterns; at this point status zero is
              returned, the matching line is stored in $TCP_LINE, and the full
              set of lines read during the call to tcp_expect is stored in the
              array $tcp_expect_lines.

              Sessions are specified in the same way as tcp_read: the  default
              is  to use the current session, otherwise the sessions specified
              by -a, -s, or -l are used.

              Each pattern is a standard zsh extended-globbing  pattern;  note
              that  it  needs  to be quoted to avoid it being expanded immedi-
              ately by filename generation.  It must match the full  line,  so
              to  match  a substring there must be a `*' at the start and end.
              The line matched  against  includes  the  $TCP_PROMPT  added  by
              tcp_read.   It is possible to include the globbing flags `#b' or
              `#m' in the patterns to make backreferences available in the pa-
              rameters $MATCH, $match, etc., as described in the base zsh doc-
              umentation on pattern matching.

              Unlike tcp_read, the default behaviour of tcp_expect is to block
              indefinitely  until  the  required  input is found.  This can be
              modified by specifying a timeout with -t or -T;  these  function
              as  in  tcp_read,  specifying a per-read or overall timeout, re-
              spectively, in seconds, as an integer or floating-point  number.
              As tcp_read, the function returns status 2 if a timeout occurs.

              The  function  returns  as soon as any one of the patterns given
              match.  If the caller  needs  to  know  which  of  the  patterns
              matched,  the  option -p var can be used; on return, $var is set
              to the number of the pattern using ordinary zsh  indexing,  i.e.
              the  first  is 1, and so on.  Note the absence of a `$' in front
              of var.  To avoid clashes, the parameter cannot begin with `_ex-
              pect'.   The  index  -1  is  used if there is a timeout and 0 if
              there is no match.

              The option -P var works similarly to -p, but instead of  numeri-
              cal  indexes the regular arguments must begin with a prefix fol-
              lowed by a colon: that prefix is then used as a tag to which var
              is  set  when  the argument matches.  The tag timeout is used if
              there is a timeout and the empty string if there  is  no  match.
              Note  it is acceptable for different arguments to start with the
              same prefix if the matches do not need to be distinguished.

              The option -q is passed directly down to tcp_read.

              As all input is done via tcp_read, all  the  usual  rules  about
              output of lines read apply.  One exception is that the parameter
              $tcp_lines will  only  reflect  the  line  actually  matched  by
              tcp_expect; use $tcp_expect_lines for the full set of lines read
              during the function call.

       tcp_proxy
              This is a simple-minded function to accept a TCP connection  and
              execute  a  command  with I/O redirected to the connection.  Ex-
              treme caution should be taken as there is no security whatsoever
              and this can leave your computer open to the world.  Ideally, it
              should only be used behind a firewall.

              The first argument is a TCP port on which the function will lis-
              ten.

              The remaining arguments give a command and its arguments to exe-
              cute with standard input, standard  output  and  standard  error
              redirected  to  the file descriptor on which the TCP session has
              been accepted.  If no command is given, a new  zsh  is  started.
              This  gives  everyone  on your network direct access to your ac-
              count, which in many cases will be a bad thing.

              The command is run in the background, so tcp_proxy can then  ac-
              cept  new  connections.   It continues to accept new connections
              until interrupted.

       tcp_spam [ -ertv ] [ -a | -s sess | -l sess[,...] ] cmd [ arg ... ]
              Execute `cmd [ arg ... ]' for each session in turn.   Note  this
              executes the command and arguments; it does not send the command
              line as data unless the -t (transmit) option is given.

              The sessions may be selected explicitly with the standard -a, -s
              or  -l  options,  or  may  be chosen implicitly.  If none of the
              three options is given  the  rules  are:  first,  if  the  array
              $tcp_spam_list  is  set,  this is taken as the list of sessions,
              otherwise all sessions are taken.  Second, any sessions given in
              the  array  $tcp_no_spam_list  are removed from the list of ses-
              sions.

              Normally, any sessions added by the `-a' flag or when  all  ses-
              sions  are  chosen  implicitly  are spammed in alphabetic order;
              sessions given by the $tcp_spam_list array  or  on  the  command
              line  are  spammed in the order given.  The -r flag reverses the
              order however it was arrived it.

              The -v flag specifies that a $TCP_PROMPT will be  output  before
              each session.  This is output after any modification to TCP_SESS
              by the user-defined tcp_on_spam function described below.   (Ob-
              viously that function is able to generate its own output.)

              If the option -e is present, the line given as `cmd [ arg ... ]'
              is executed using eval, otherwise it  is  executed  without  any
              further processing.

       tcp_talk
              This  is  a  fairly  simple-minded attempt to force input to the
              line editor to go straight to the default TCP_SESS.

              An escape string, $TCP_TALK_ESCAPE, default `:', is used to  al-
              low  access  to  normal shell operation.  If it is on its own at
              the start of the line, or followed only by whitespace, the  line
              editor  returns  to normal operation.  Otherwise, the string and
              any following whitespace are skipped and the  remainder  of  the
              line executed as shell input without any change of the line edi-
              tor's operating mode.

              The current implementation is somewhat deficient in terms of use
              of the command history.  For this reason, many users will prefer
              to use some form of alternative approach for sending data easily
              to  the  current  session.  One simple approach is to alias some
              special character (such as `%') to `tcp_command --'.

       tcp_wait
              The sole argument is an integer or floating point  number  which
              gives  the seconds to delay.  The shell will do nothing for that
              period except wait for input on  all  TCP  sessions  by  calling
              tcp_read  -a.   This  is similar to the interactive behaviour at
              the command prompt when zle handlers are installed.

   `One-shot' file transfer
       tcp_point port
       tcp_shoot host port
              This pair of functions provide a simple way to transfer  a  file
              between  two  hosts  within the shell.  Note, however, that bulk
              data transfer is currently done using cat.  tcp_point reads  any
              data arriving at port and sends it to standard output; tcp_shoot
              connects to port on host and sends its standard input.  Any  un-
              used port may be used; the standard mechanism for picking a port
              is to think of a random four-digit number above 1024  until  one
              works.

              To  transfer  a  file  from  host  woodcock to host springes, on
              springes:

                     tcp_point 8091 >output_file

              and on woodcock:

                     tcp_shoot springes 8091 <input_file

              As these two functions do not require tcp_open to set up  a  TCP
              connection first, they may need to be autoloaded separately.

TCP USER-DEFINED FUNCTIONS
       Certain  functions, if defined by the user, will be called by the func-
       tion system in certain contexts.  This facility depends on  the  module
       zsh/parameter,  which is usually available in interactive shells as the
       completion system depends on it.  None of the  functions  need  be  de-
       fined; they simply provide convenient hooks when necessary.

       Typically,  these are called after the requested action has been taken,
       so that the various parameters will reflect the new state.

       tcp_on_alias alias fd
              When an alias is defined, this function will be called with  two
              arguments: the name of the alias, and the file descriptor of the
              corresponding session.

       tcp_on_awol sess fd
              If the function tcp_fd_handler is handling input from  the  line
              editor  and  detects that the file descriptor is no longer reus-
              able, by default it removes it from the list of file descriptors
              handled  by  this  method and prints a message.  If the function
              tcp_on_awol is defined it  is  called  immediately  before  this
              point.   It may return status 100, which indicates that the nor-
              mal handling should still be performed; any other return  status
              indicates  that  no  further  action  should  be  taken  and the
              tcp_fd_handler should return immediately with the given  status.
              Typically  the  action  of tcp_on_awol will be to close the ses-
              sion.

              The variable TCP_INVALIDATE_ZLE will be a non-empty string if it
              is  necessary  to  invalidate the line editor display using `zle
              -I' before printing output from the function.

              (`AWOL' is military jargon for `absent without  leave'  or  some
              variation.   It  has  no pre-existing technical meaning known to
              the author.)

       tcp_on_close sess fd
              This is called with the name of a session being closed  and  the
              file  descriptor  which corresponded to that session.  Both will
              be invalid by the time the function is called.

       tcp_on_open sess fd
              This is called after a new session has  been  defined  with  the
              session  name and file descriptor as arguments.  If it returns a
              non-zero status, opening the session is assumed to fail and  the
              session  is closed again; however, tcp_open will continue to at-
              tempt to open any remaining sessions given on the command line.

       tcp_on_rename oldsess fd newsess
              This is called after a session has been renamed with  the  three
              arguments old session name, file descriptor, new session name.

       tcp_on_spam sess command ...
              This is called once for each session spammed, just before a com-
              mand is executed for a session by tcp_spam.  The  arguments  are
              the  session  name  followed by the command list to be executed.
              If tcp_spam was called with the option  -t,  the  first  command
              will be tcp_send.

              This  function  is  called after $TCP_SESS is set to reflect the
              session to be spammed, but before any use of it is made.   Hence
              it is possible to alter the value of $TCP_SESS within this func-
              tion.  For example, the session arguments to tcp_spam could  in-
              clude  extra  information  to  be  stripped off and processed in
              tcp_on_spam.

              If the function sets the parameter $REPLY to `done', the command
              line  is not executed; in addition, no prompt is printed for the
              -v option to tcp_spam.

       tcp_on_unalias alias fd
              This is called with the name of an alias and  the  corresponding
              session's file descriptor after an alias has been deleted.

TCP UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       The  following  functions  are used by the TCP function system but will
       rarely if ever need to be called directly.

       tcp_fd_handler
              This is the function installed by tcp_open  for  handling  input
              from  within the line editor, if that is required.  It is in the
              format documented for the builtin `zle -F' in zshzle(1) .

              While active, the function sets the parameter TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE
              to 1.  This allows shell code called internally (for example, by
              setting tcp_on_read) to tell if is being called when  the  shell
              is otherwise idle at the editor prompt.

       tcp_output [ -q ] -P prompt -F fd -S sess
              This  function  is  used for both logging and handling output to
              standard output, from within tcp_read  and  (if  $TCP_OUTPUT  is
              set) tcp_send.

              The  prompt  to use is specified by -P; the default is the empty
              string.  It can contain:
              %c     Expands to 1 if the session is the current session,  oth-
                     erwise   0.    Used  with  ternary  expressions  such  as
                     `%(c.-.+)' to output `+' for the current session and  `-'
                     otherwise.

              %f     Replaced by the session's file descriptor.

              %s     Replaced by the session name.

              %%     Replaced by a single `%'.

              The  option  -q suppresses output to standard output, but not to
              any log files which are configured.

              The -S and -F options are used to pass in the session  name  and
              file descriptor for possible replacement in the prompt.

TCP USER PARAMETERS
       Parameters  follow  the  usual  convention  that  uppercase is used for
       scalars and integers, while lowercase is used for normal  and  associa-
       tive  array.  It is always safe for user code to read these parameters.
       Some parameters may also be set; these are  noted  explicitly.   Others
       are  included  in this group as they are set by the function system for
       the user's benefit, i.e. setting them is typically not  useful  but  is
       benign.

       It  is  often  also useful to make settable parameters local to a func-
       tion.  For example, `local TCP_SILENT=1' specifies that data read  dur-
       ing  the  function call will not be printed to standard output, regard-
       less  of  the  setting  outside   the   function.    Likewise,   `local
       TCP_SESS=sess'  sets a session for the duration of a function, and `lo-
       cal TCP_PROMPT=' specifies that no prompt is used for input during  the
       function.

       tcp_expect_lines
              Array.   The  set  of lines read during the last call to tcp_ex-
              pect, including the last ($TCP_LINE).

       tcp_filter
              Array. May be set directly.  A set of extended globbing patterns
              which,  if  matched in tcp_output, will cause the line not to be
              printed to standard output.  The patterns should be  defined  as
              described  for  the  arguments to tcp_expect.  Output of line to
              log files is not affected.

       TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE
              Scalar.  Set to 1 within tcp_fd_handler to indicate to functions
              called  recursively  that they have been called during an editor
              session.  Otherwise unset.

       TCP_LINE
              The last line read by tcp_read, and hence also tcp_expect.

       TCP_LINE_FD
              The   file   descriptor   from   which   $TCP_LINE   was   read.
              ${tcp_by_fd[$TCP_LINE_FD]}  will  give the corresponding session
              name.

       tcp_lines
              Array. The set of lines read during the last call  to  tcp_read,
              including the last ($TCP_LINE).

       TCP_LOG
              May  be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log.
              The name of a file to which output from  all  sessions  will  be
              sent.   The output is proceeded by the usual $TCP_PROMPT.  If it
              is not an absolute path name, it will follow the user's  current
              directory.

       TCP_LOG_SESS
              May  be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log.
              The prefix for a set of files to which output from each  session
              separately    will    be    sent;    the    full   filename   is
              ${TCP_LOG_SESS}.sess.  Output to each file is raw; no prompt  is
              added.   If  it is not an absolute path name, it will follow the
              user's current directory.

       tcp_no_spam_list
              Array.  May be set directly.  See tcp_spam for how this is used.

       TCP_OUTPUT
              May be set directly.  If a non-empty string, any data sent to  a
              session  by  tcp_send  will be logged.  This parameter gives the
              prompt to be used in a file specified by $TCP_LOG but not  in  a
              file  generated  from  $TCP_LOG_SESS.  The prompt string has the
              same format as TCP_PROMPT and the same rules for its use apply.

       TCP_PROMPT
              May be set directly.  Used  as  the  prefix  for  data  read  by
              tcp_read  which is printed to standard output or to the log file
              given by $TCP_LOG, if any.  Any `%s', `%f' or `%%' occurring  in
              the string will be replaced by the name of the session, the ses-
              sion's underlying file descriptor,  or  a  single  `%',  respec-
              tively.   The  expression `%c' expands to 1 if the session being
              read is the current session, else 0;  this  is  most  useful  in
              ternary  expressions such as `%(c.-.+)' which outputs `+' if the
              session is the current one, else `-'.

              If the prompt starts with %P, this is stripped and the  complete
              result  of  the previous stage is passed through standard prompt
              %-style formatting before being output.

       TCP_READ_DEBUG
              May be set directly.  If this has non-zero length, tcp_read will
              give some limited diagnostics about data being read.

       TCP_SECONDS_START
              This value is created and initialised to zero by tcp_open.

              The  functions  tcp_read  and tcp_expect use the shell's SECONDS
              parameter for their own timing purposes.  If that  parameter  is
              not  of floating point type on entry to one of the functions, it
              will create a local parameter SECONDS which  is  floating  point
              and set the parameter TCP_SECONDS_START to the previous value of
              $SECONDS.  If the parameter is already  floating  point,  it  is
              used without a local copy being created and TCP_SECONDS_START is
              not set.  As the global value is zero, the shell elapsed time is
              guaranteed to be the sum of $SECONDS and $TCP_SECONDS_START.

              This  can  be  avoided by setting SECONDS globally to a floating
              point value using `typeset -F SECONDS'; then the  TCP  functions
              will  never make a local copy and never set TCP_SECONDS_START to
              a non-zero value.

       TCP_SESS
              May be set directly.  The current session; must refer to one  of
              the sessions established by tcp_open.

       TCP_SILENT
              May  be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log.
              If of non-zero length, data read by tcp_read will not be written
              to standard output, though may still be written to a log file.

       tcp_spam_list
              Array.   May  be set directly.  See the description of the func-
              tion tcp_spam for how this is used.

       TCP_TALK_ESCAPE
              May be set  directly.   See  the  description  of  the  function
              tcp_talk for how this is used.

       TCP_TIMEOUT
              May  be  set directly.  Currently this is only used by the func-
              tion tcp_command, see above.

TCP USER-DEFINED PARAMETERS
       The following parameters are not set by the function system, but have a
       special effect if set by the user.

       tcp_on_read
              This should be an associative array; if it is not, the behaviour
              is undefined.  Each key is the name of a shell function or other
              command,  and  the corresponding value is a shell pattern (using
              EXTENDED_GLOB).  Every line read from a TCP session directly  or
              indirectly  using tcp_read (which includes lines read by tcp_ex-
              pect) is compared against the pattern.  If the line matches, the
              command  given in the key is called with two arguments: the name
              of the session from which the line was read, and  the  line  it-
              self.

              If  any function called to handle a line returns a non-zero sta-
              tus, the line is not output.  Thus a  tcp_on_read  handler  con-
              taining  only the instruction `return 1' can be used to suppress
              output of particular lines  (see,  however,  tcp_filter  above).
              However,  the  line  is  still stored in TCP_LINE and tcp_lines;
              this occurs after all tcp_on_read processing.

TCP UTILITY PARAMETERS
       These parameters are controlled by the function  system;  they  may  be
       read directly, but should not usually be set by user code.

       tcp_aliases
              Associative  array.   The  keys are the names of sessions estab-
              lished with tcp_open; each value is a  space-separated  list  of
              aliases which refer to that session.

       tcp_by_fd
              Associative  array.  The keys are session file descriptors; each
              value is the name of that session.

       tcp_by_name
              Associative array.  The keys are the  names  of  sessions;  each
              value is the file descriptor associated with that session.

TCP EXAMPLES
       Here is a trivial example using a remote calculator.

       To  create a calculator server on port 7337 (see the dc manual page for
       quite how infuriating the underlying command is):

              tcp_proxy 7337 dc

       To connect to this from the same host with a session also named `dc':

              tcp_open localhost 7337 dc

       To send a command to the remote session and wait a short while for out-
       put (assuming dc is the current session):

              tcp_command 2 4 + p

       To close the session:

              tcp_close

       The  tcp_proxy  needs  to  be killed to be stopped.  Note this will not
       usually kill any connections which have already been accepted, and also
       that the port is not immediately available for reuse.

       The  following  chunk  of  code  puts  a list of sessions into an xterm
       header, with the current session followed by a star.

              print -n "\033]2;TCP:" ${(k)tcp_by_name:/$TCP_SESS/$TCP_SESS\*} "\a"

TCP BUGS
       The function tcp_read uses the shell's normal read  builtin.   As  this
       reads a complete line at once, data arriving without a terminating new-
       line can cause the function to block indefinitely.

       Though the function suite works well for interactive use and  for  data
       arriving  in  small amounts, the performance when large amounts of data
       are being exchanged is likely to be extremely poor.

ZSHZFTPSYS(1)               General Commands Manual              ZSHZFTPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshzftpsys - zftp function front-end

DESCRIPTION
       This describes the set of shell functions supplied with the source dis-
       tribution  as an interface to the zftp builtin command, allowing you to
       perform FTP operations from the shell command line or within  functions
       or scripts.  The interface is similar to a traditional FTP client (e.g.
       the ftp command itself, see ftp(1)), but as it is entirely done  within
       the  shell  all the familiar completion, editing and globbing features,
       and so on, are present, and macros are particularly simple to write  as
       they are just ordinary shell functions.

       The  prerequisite  is  that  the  zftp command, as described in zshmod-
       ules(1) , must be available in the version of  zsh  installed  at  your
       site.   If the shell is configured to load new commands at run time, it
       probably is: typing `zmodload zsh/zftp' will make sure  (if  that  runs
       silently, it has worked).  If this is not the case, it is possible zftp
       was linked into the shell anyway: to test this, type `which  zftp'  and
       if  zftp  is  available  you will get the message `zftp: shell built-in
       command'.

       Commands given directly with zftp builtin may be  interspersed  between
       the  functions  in  this suite; in a few cases, using zftp directly may
       cause some of the status information stored in shell parameters to  be-
       come  invalid.   Note  in  particular  the description of the variables
       $ZFTP_TMOUT, $ZFTP_PREFS and $ZFTP_VERBOSE for zftp.

INSTALLATION
       You should make sure all the functions from the  Functions/Zftp  direc-
       tory  of the source distribution are available; they all begin with the
       two letters `zf'.  They may already have been installed on your system;
       otherwise,  you  will  need  to find them and copy them.  The directory
       should appear as one of the elements of the $fpath array  (this  should
       already  be the case if they were installed), and at least the function
       zfinit should be autoloaded; it will autoload the  rest.   Finally,  to
       initialize  the use of the system you need to call the zfinit function.
       The following code in your .zshrc will arrange  for  this;  assume  the
       functions are stored in the directory ~/myfns:

              fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
              autoload -U zfinit
              zfinit

       Note  that zfinit assumes you are using the zmodload method to load the
       zftp command.  If it is already built into the shell, change zfinit  to
       zfinit  -n.  It is helpful (though not essential) if the call to zfinit
       appears after any code to initialize the new  completion  system,  else
       unnecessary compctl commands will be given.

FUNCTIONS
       The sequence of operations in performing a file transfer is essentially
       the same as that in a standard FTP client.  Note that, due to  a  quirk
       of the shell's getopts builtin, for those functions that handle options
       you must use `--' rather than `-' to ensure the remaining arguments are
       treated literally (a single `-' is treated as an argument).

   Opening a connection
       zfparams [ host [ user [ password ... ] ] ]
              Set  or  show  the  parameters for a future zfopen with no argu-
              ments.  If no arguments are given, the  current  parameters  are
              displayed  (the  password will be shown as a line of asterisks).
              If a host is given, and either the user or password is not, they
              will  be  prompted for; also, any parameter given as `?' will be
              prompted for, and if the `?' is followed by a string, that  will
              be  used  as  the prompt.  As zfopen calls zfparams to store the
              parameters, this usually need not be called directly.

              A single argument `-' will delete the stored  parameters.   This
              will  also cause the memory of the last directory (and so on) on
              the other host to be deleted.

       zfopen [ -1 ] [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
              If host is present, open a connection to that host  under  user-
              name  user  with  password  password (and, on the rare occasions
              when it is necessary, account account).  If a necessary  parame-
              ter is missing or given as `?' it will be prompted for.  If host
              is not present, use a previously stored set of parameters.

              If the command was successful, and the  terminal  is  compatible
              with  xterm  or  is  sun-cmd, a summary will appear in the title
              bar, giving the local host:directory and the remote  host:direc-
              tory;  this is handled by the function zftp_chpwd, described be-
              low.

              Normally, the host, user and password  are  internally  recorded
              for  later  re-opening, either by a zfopen with no arguments, or
              automatically (see below).  With the option `-1', no information
              is  stored.  Also, if an open command with arguments failed, the
              parameters will not be retained  (and  any  previous  parameters
              will  also  be  deleted).   A zfopen on its own, or a zfopen -1,
              never alters the stored parameters.

              Both zfopen and zfanon (but not zfparams) understand URLs of the
              form  ftp://host/path... as meaning to connect to the host, then
              change directory to path (which  must  be  a  directory,  not  a
              file).   The `ftp://' can be omitted; the trailing `/' is enough
              to trigger recognition of the path.  Note  prefixes  other  than
              `ftp:'  are  not  recognized,  and that all characters after the
              first slash beyond host are significant in path.

       zfanon [ -1 ] host
              Open a connection host for anonymous FTP.  The username used  is
              `anonymous'.   The  password  (which  will be reported the first
              time) is generated as user@host; this  is  then  stored  in  the
              shell parameter $EMAIL_ADDR which can alternatively be set manu-
              ally to a suitable string.

   Directory management
       zfcd [ dir ]
       zfcd -
       zfcd old new
              Change the current directory on the remote server:  this is  im-
              plemented to have many of the features of the shell builtin cd.

              In the first form with dir present, change to the directory dir.
              The command `zfcd ..' is treated specially, so is guaranteed  to
              work  on  non-UNIX  servers  (note this is handled internally by
              zftp).  If dir is omitted, has the effect of `zfcd ~'.

              The second form changes to the directory previously current.

              The third form attempts to change the current directory  by  re-
              placing  the  first occurrence of the string old with the string
              new in the current directory.

              Note that in this command, and indeed anywhere a remote filename
              is  expected,  the string which on the local host corresponds to
              `~' is converted back to a `~' before being passed to the remote
              machine.   This  is  convenient  because of the way expansion is
              performed on the command line before  zfcd  receives  a  string.
              For  example,  suppose  the  command is `zfcd ~/foo'.  The shell
              will   expand   this   to   a   full   path   such   as    `zfcd
              /home/user2/pws/foo'.   At  this stage, zfcd recognises the ini-
              tial path as corresponding to `~' and will send the directory to
              the  remote  host  as ~/foo, so that the `~' will be expanded by
              the server to the correct remote host  directory.   Other  named
              directories of the form `~name' are not treated in this fashion.

       zfhere Change  directory  on the remote server to the one corresponding
              to the current local directory, with special handling of `~'  as
              in  zfcd.   For  example,  if  the  current  local  directory is
              ~/foo/bar, then zfhere performs the effect of `zfcd ~/foo/bar'.

       zfdir [ -rfd ] [ - ] [ dir-options ] [ dir ]
              Produce a long directory listing.  The arguments dir-options and
              dir are passed directly to the server and their effect is imple-
              mentation dependent, but specifying a particular  remote  direc-
              tory  dir  is  usually possible.  The output is passed through a
              pager given by the environment variable  $PAGER,  or  `more'  if
              that is not set.

              The directory is usually cached for re-use.  In fact, two caches
              are maintained.  One is for use when there is no dir-options  or
              dir,  i.e. a full listing of the current remote directory; it is
              flushed when the current remote directory changes.  The other is
              kept  for repeated use of zfdir with the same arguments; for ex-
              ample, repeated use of `zfdir /pub/gnu' will  only  require  the
              directory  to  be  retrieved  on the first call.  Alternatively,
              this cache can be re-viewed with the -r option.  As relative di-
              rectories will confuse zfdir, the -f option can be used to force
              the cache to be flushed before the directory is listed.  The op-
              tion  -d  will  delete  both  caches without showing a directory
              listing; it will also delete the cache of file names in the cur-
              rent remote directory, if any.

       zfls [ ls-options ] [ dir ]
              List  files  on the remote server.  With no arguments, this will
              produce a simple list of file names for the current  remote  di-
              rectory.   Any  arguments are passed directly to the server.  No
              pager and no caching is used.

   Status commands
       zftype [ type ]
              With no arguments, show the type of data to be transferred, usu-
              ally  ASCII  or  binary.  With an argument, change the type: the
              types `A' or `ASCII' for ASCII data and `B' or `BINARY', `I'  or
              `IMAGE' for binary data are understood case-insensitively.

       zfstat [ -v ]
              Show  the  status  of the current or last connection, as well as
              the status of some of zftp's status variables.  With the -v  op-
              tion,  a more verbose listing is produced by querying the server
              for its version of events, too.

   Retrieving files
       The commands for retrieving files all take at  least  two  options.  -G
       suppresses remote filename expansion which would otherwise be performed
       (see below for a more detailed description of that).   -t  attempts  to
       set the modification time of the local file to that of the remote file:
       see the description of the function zfrtime below for more information.

       zfget [ -Gtc ] file1 ...
              Retrieve all the listed files file1 ... one at a time  from  the
              remote  server.   If  a  file  contains  a `/', the full name is
              passed to the remote server, but the file is stored locally  un-
              der  the name given by the part after the final `/'.  The option
              -c (cat) forces all files to be sent as a single stream to stan-
              dard output; in this case the -t option has no effect.

       zfuget [ -Gvst ] file1 ...
              As  zfget,  but only retrieve files where the version on the re-
              mote server is newer (has a later modification time),  or  where
              the  local file does not exist.  If the remote file is older but
              the files have different sizes, or if the sizes are the same but
              the  remote  file  is  newer,  the user will usually be queried.
              With the option -s, the command runs silently  and  will  always
              retrieve the file in either of those two cases.  With the option
              -v, the command prints more information about the files while it
              is working out whether or not to transfer them.

       zfcget [ -Gt ] file1 ...
              As  zfget,  but if any of the local files exists, and is shorter
              than the corresponding remote file, the command assumes that  it
              is  the result of a partially completed transfer and attempts to
              transfer the rest of the file.  This is useful on a poor connec-
              tion which keeps failing.

              Note  that  this  requires a commonly implemented, but non-stan-
              dard, version of the FTP protocol, so is not guaranteed to  work
              on all servers.

       zfgcp [ -Gt ] remote-file local-file
       zfgcp [ -Gt ] rfile1 ... ldir
              This  retrieves  files from the remote server with arguments be-
              having similarly to the cp command.

              In the first form, copy remote-file from the server to the local
              file local-file.

              In  the  second  form, copy all the remote files rfile1 ... into
              the local directory ldir retaining the same basenames.  This as-
              sumes UNIX directory semantics.

   Sending files
       zfput [ -r ] file1 ...
              Send  all  the  file1 ... given separately to the remote server.
              If a filename contains a `/', the full filename is used  locally
              to  find  the file, but only the basename is used for the remote
              file name.

              With the option -r, if any of the files are directories they are
              sent  recursively with all their subdirectories, including files
              beginning with `.'.  This requires that the remote  machine  un-
              derstand  UNIX  file semantics, since `/' is used as a directory
              separator.

       zfuput [ -vs ] file1 ...
              As zfput, but only send files which are newer than their  remote
              equivalents, or if the remote file does not exist.  The logic is
              the same as for zfuget, but reversed between  local  and  remote
              files.

       zfcput file1 ...
              As  zfput,  but if any remote file already exists and is shorter
              than the local equivalent, assume it is the result of an  incom-
              plete  transfer  and  send the rest of the file to append to the
              existing part.  As the FTP append command is part of  the  stan-
              dard set, this is in principle more likely to work than zfcget.

       zfpcp local-file remote-file
       zfpcp lfile1 ... rdir
              This  sends  files  to the remote server with arguments behaving
              similarly to the cp command.

              With two  arguments,  copy  local-file  to  the  server  as  re-
              mote-file.

              With  more  than  two arguments, copy all the local files lfile1
              ... into the existing remote directory rdir retaining  the  same
              basenames.  This assumes UNIX directory semantics.

              A  problem  arises if you attempt to use zfpcp lfile1 rdir, i.e.
              the second form of copying but with two arguments, as  the  com-
              mand  has  no simple way of knowing if rdir corresponds to a di-
              rectory or a filename.  It attempts to resolve this  in  various
              ways.   First,  if the rdir argument is `.' or `..' or ends in a
              slash, it is assumed to be a directory.  Secondly, if the opera-
              tion  of  copying to a remote file in the first form failed, and
              the remote server sends back the expected failure code 553 and a
              reply  including  the  string  `Is a directory', then zfpcp will
              retry using the second form.

   Closing the connection
       zfclose
              Close the connection.

   Session management
       zfsession [ -lvod ] [ sessname ]
              Allows you to manage multiple FTP sessions at once.  By default,
              connections  take place in a session called `default'; by giving
              the command `zfsession sessname' you can change to a new or  ex-
              isting  session with a name of your choice.  The new session re-
              members its own connection, as well as associated shell  parame-
              ters,  and also the host/user parameters set by zfparams.  Hence
              you can have different sessions set up to connect  to  different
              hosts, each remembering the appropriate host, user and password.

              With no arguments, zfsession prints the name of the current ses-
              sion; with the option -l it lists all sessions  which  currently
              exist,  and  with  the option -v it gives a verbose list showing
              the host and directory for each session, where the current  ses-
              sion is marked with an asterisk.  With -o, it will switch to the
              most recent previous session.

              With -d, the given session (or else the current one) is removed;
              everything to do with it is completely forgotten.  If it was the
              only session, a new session called `default' is created and made
              current.   It  is safest not to delete sessions while background
              commands using zftp are active.

       zftransfer sess1:file1 sess2:file2
              Transfer files between two sessions; no local copy is made.  The
              file is read from the session sess1 as file1 and written to ses-
              sion sess2 as file file2; file1 and file2 may be relative to the
              current  directories  of the session.  Either sess1 or sess2 may
              be omitted (though the colon should be retained if  there  is  a
              possibility  of a colon appearing in the file name) and defaults
              to the current session; file2 may be omitted or may end  with  a
              slash,  in  which case the basename of file1 will be added.  The
              sessions sess1 and sess2 must be distinct.

              The operation is performed using pipes, so it is  required  that
              the  connections  still be valid in a subshell, which is not the
              case under versions of some operating systems, presumably due to
              a system bug.

   Bookmarks
       The two functions zfmark and zfgoto allow you to `bookmark' the present
       location (host, user and directory) of the current FTP  connection  for
       later use.  The file to be used for storing and retrieving bookmarks is
       given by the parameter $ZFTP_BMFILE; if not set when  one  of  the  two
       functions  is  called, it will be set to the file .zfbkmarks in the di-
       rectory where your zsh startup files live (usually ~).

       zfmark [ bookmark ]
              If given an argument, mark the current host, user and  directory
              under the name bookmark for later use by zfgoto.  If there is no
              connection open, use the values for the last connection  immedi-
              ately  before  it  was closed; it is an error if there was none.
              Any existing bookmark under the same name will be  silently  re-
              placed.

              If  not  given  an argument, list the existing bookmarks and the
              points to which they refer in the form user@host:directory; this
              is  the  format  in  which  they are stored, and the file may be
              edited directly.

       zfgoto [ -n ] bookmark
              Return to the location given by bookmark, as previously  set  by
              zfmark.  If the location has user `ftp' or `anonymous', open the
              connection with zfanon, so that no password is required.  If the
              user and host parameters match those stored for the current ses-
              sion, if any, those will be used, and again no password  is  re-
              quired.  Otherwise a password will be prompted for.

              With  the  option  -n,  the  bookmark  is taken to be a nickname
              stored by the ncftp program in its bookmark file, which  is  as-
              sumed  to be ~/.ncftp/bookmarks.  The function works identically
              in other ways.  Note that there is no mechanism  for  adding  or
              modifying ncftp bookmarks from the zftp functions.

   Other functions
       Mostly,  these  functions  will  not  be  called  directly  (apart from
       zfinit), but are described here for completeness.  You may wish to  al-
       ter zftp_chpwd and zftp_progress, in particular.

       zfinit [ -n ]
              As described above, this is used to initialize the zftp function
              system.  The -n option should be used if the zftp command is al-
              ready built into the shell.

       zfautocheck [ -dn ]
              This  function is called to implement automatic reopening behav-
              iour, as described in more detail below.  The options  must  ap-
              pear  in the first argument; -n prevents the command from chang-
              ing to the old directory, while -d prevents it from setting  the
              variable  do_close,  which it otherwise does as a flag for auto-
              matically closing the connection after a transfer.  The host and
              directory  for  the  last  session  are  stored  in the variable
              $zflastsession, but the internal  host/user/password  parameters
              must also be correctly set.

       zfcd_match prefix suffix
              This performs matching for completion of remote directory names.
              If the remote server is UNIX, it will attempt  to  persuade  the
              server  to list the remote directory with subdirectories marked,
              which usually works but is not guaranteed.  On  other  hosts  it
              simply calls zfget_match and hence completes all files, not just
              directories.  On some systems, directories  may  not  even  look
              like filenames.

       zfget_match prefix suffix
              This  performs  matching for completion of remote filenames.  It
              caches files for the current directory (only) in the  shell  pa-
              rameter  $zftp_fcache.  It is in the form to be called by the -K
              option of compctl, but  also  works  when  called  from  a  wid-
              get-style  completion function with prefix and suffix set appro-
              priately.

       zfrglob varname
              Perform remote globbing, as  describes  in  more  detail  below.
              varname  is  the name of a variable containing the pattern to be
              expanded; if there were any matches, the same variable  will  be
              set to the expanded set of filenames on return.

       zfrtime lfile rfile [ time ]
              Set  the  local file lfile to have the same modification time as
              the remote file rfile, or the explicit time time in  FTP  format
              CCYYMMDDhhmmSS  for  the  GMT  timezone.   This uses the shell's
              zsh/datetime module to perform the conversion from GMT to  local
              time.

       zftp_chpwd
              This  function  is  called every time a connection is opened, or
              closed, or the remote directory changes.   This  version  alters
              the  title bar of an xterm-compatible or sun-cmd terminal emula-
              tor to reflect the local and remote hostnames and current direc-
              tories.   It  works  best when combined with the function chpwd.
              In particular, a function of the form

                     chpwd() {
                       if [[ -n $ZFTP_USER ]]; then
                         zftp_chpwd
                       else
                         # usual chpwd e.g put host:directory in title bar
                       fi
                     }

              fits in well.

       zftp_progress
              This function shows the status of the  transfer.   It  will  not
              write  anything  unless  the output is going to a terminal; how-
              ever, if you transfer files in the background, you  should  turn
              off  progress  reports  by hand using `zstyle ':zftp:*' progress
              none'.  Note also that if you alter it, any output  must  be  to
              standard error, as standard output may be a file being received.
              The form of the progress meter, or whether it is  used  at  all,
              can be configured without altering the function, as described in
              the next section.

       zffcache
              This is used to implement caching of files in the current direc-
              tory for each session separately.  It is used by zfget_match and
              zfrglob.

MISCELLANEOUS FEATURES
   Configuration
       Various styles are available using the standard shell style  mechanism,
       described  in  zshmodules(1).  Briefly,  the  command `zstyle ':zftp:*'
       style value ...'.  defines the style to have value value; more than one
       value  may be given, although that is not useful in the cases described
       here.  These values will then be used throughout the zftp function sys-
       tem.   For more precise control, the first argument, which gives a pat-
       tern that matches contexts in which the style applies, can be  modified
       to  include  a  particular  function, as for example `:zftp:zfget': the
       style will then have the given value only in the  zfget  function,  and
       will override styles set under `:zftp:*'.  Note that only the top level
       function name, as called by the user, is used; calling of  lower  level
       functions is transparent to the user.  Hence modifications to the title
       bar in zftp_chpwd use the contexts :zftp:zfopen, :zftp:zfcd, etc.,  de-
       pending where it was called from.  The following styles are understood:

       progress
              Controls the way that zftp_progress reports on the progress of a
              transfer.  If empty, unset, or `none',  no  progress  report  is
              made; if `bar' a growing bar of inverse video is shown; if `per-
              cent' (or any other string, though this may change  in  future),
              the  percentage of the file transferred is shown.  The bar meter
              requires that the width of the terminal  be  available  via  the
              $COLUMNS parameter (normally this is set automatically).  If the
              size of the file being transferred is  not  available,  bar  and
              percent  meters will simply show the number of bytes transferred
              so far.

              When zfinit is run, if this style is not defined for the context
              :zftp:*, it will be set to `bar'.

       update Specifies  the  minimum  time  interval  between  updates of the
              progress meter in seconds.  No update is made  unless  new  data
              has  been  received, so the actual time interval is limited only
              by $ZFTP_TIMEOUT.

              As described for progress, zfinit will force this to default  to
              1.

       remote-glob
              If  set  to `1', `yes' or `true', filename generation (globbing)
              is performed on the remote machine instead of by zsh itself; see
              below.

       titlebar
              If  set  to `1', `yes' or `true', zftp_chpwd will put the remote
              host and remote directory into the titlebar of  terminal  emula-
              tors such as xterm or sun-cmd that allow this.

              As  described for progress, zfinit will force this to default to
              1.

       chpwd  If set to `1' `yes' or `true', zftp_chpwd will call the function
              chpwd when a connection is closed.  This is useful if the remote
              host details were put into the terminal title bar by  zftp_chpwd
              and your usual chpwd also modifies the title bar.

              When  zfinit  is run, it will determine whether chpwd exists and
              if so it will set the default value for the style to 1  if  none
              exists already.

       Note  that  there  is also an associative array zfconfig which contains
       values used by the function system.  This should  not  be  modified  or
       overwritten.

   Remote globbing
       The  commands  for retrieving files usually perform filename generation
       (globbing) on their arguments; this can be turned off  by  passing  the
       option  -G to each of the commands.  Normally this operates by retriev-
       ing a complete list of files for the directory in question, then match-
       ing these locally against the pattern supplied.  This has the advantage
       that the full range of zsh patterns (respecting the setting of the  op-
       tion  EXTENDED_GLOB) can be used.  However, it means that the directory
       part of a filename will not be expanded and must be given exactly.   If
       the remote server does not support the UNIX directory semantics, direc-
       tory handling is problematic and it is recommended that  globbing  only
       be used within the current directory.  The list of files in the current
       directory, if retrieved, will be cached, so that  subsequent  globs  in
       the same directory without an intervening zfcd are much faster.

       If  the  remote-glob style (see above) is set, globbing is instead per-
       formed on the remote host: the server is asked for a list  of  matching
       files.   This  is  highly  dependent  on how the server is implemented,
       though typically UNIX servers will provide support for basic glob  pat-
       terns.   This  may in some cases be faster, as it avoids retrieving the
       entire list of directory contents.

   Automatic and temporary reopening
       As described for the zfopen command, a subsequent zfopen with no param-
       eters  will  reopen the connection to the last host (this includes con-
       nections made with the zfanon command).  Opened in  this  fashion,  the
       connection  starts in the default remote directory and will remain open
       until explicitly closed.

       Automatic re-opening is also available.  If a connection  is  not  cur-
       rently  open  and  a  command requiring a connection is given, the last
       connection is implicitly reopened.  In this case  the  directory  which
       was  current  when  the connection was closed again becomes the current
       directory (unless, of course, the command given changes it).  Automatic
       reopening  will  also take place if the connection was close by the re-
       mote server for whatever reason (e.g. a timeout).  It is not  available
       if the -1 option to zfopen or zfanon was used.

       Furthermore,  if  the command issued is a file transfer, the connection
       will be closed after  the  transfer  is  finished,  hence  providing  a
       one-shot mode for transfers.  This does not apply to directory changing
       or listing commands; for example a zfdir may reopen  a  connection  but
       will  leave  it open.  Also, automatic closure will only ever happen in
       the same command as automatic opening, i.e a zfdir directly followed by
       a zfget will never close the connection automatically.

       Information  about the previous connection is given by the zfstat func-
       tion.  So, for example, if that reports:

              Session:        default
              Not connected.
              Last session:   ftp.bar.com:/pub/textfiles

       then the command zfget file.txt will attempt to reopen a connection  to
       ftp.bar.com, retrieve the file /pub/textfiles/file.txt, and immediately
       close the connection again.  On the other hand, zfcd ..  will open  the
       connection in the directory /pub and leave it open.

       Note  that  all  the above is local to each session; if you return to a
       previous session, the connection for that session is the one which will
       be reopened.

   Completion
       Completion  of  local and remote files, directories, sessions and book-
       marks is supported.  The older,  compctl-style  completion  is  defined
       when zfinit is called; support for the new widget-based completion sys-
       tem is provided in  the  function  Completion/Zsh/Command/_zftp,  which
       should  be  installed with the other functions of the completion system
       and hence should automatically be available.

ZSHCONTRIB(1)               General Commands Manual              ZSHCONTRIB(1)

NAME
       zshcontrib - user contributions to zsh

DESCRIPTION
       The Zsh source distribution includes a number of items  contributed  by
       the  user community.  These are not inherently a part of the shell, and
       some may not be available in every zsh installation.  The most signifi-
       cant of these are documented here.  For documentation on other contrib-
       uted items such as shell functions, look for comments in  the  function
       source files.

UTILITIES
   Accessing On-Line Help
       The key sequence ESC h is normally bound by ZLE to execute the run-help
       widget (see zshzle(1)).  This invokes the  run-help  command  with  the
       command  word from the current input line as its argument.  By default,
       run-help is an alias for the man command, so this often fails when  the
       command  word  is  a  shell builtin or a user-defined function.  By re-
       defining the run-help alias, one can improve the on-line help  provided
       by the shell.

       The helpfiles utility, found in the Util directory of the distribution,
       is a Perl program that can be used to process the zsh manual to produce
       a  separate  help  file for each shell builtin and for many other shell
       features as well.  The autoloadable run-help function, found  in  Func-
       tions/Misc,  searches  for  these  helpfiles and performs several other
       tests to produce the most complete help possible for the command.

       Help files are installed by default to a subdirectory of /usr/share/zsh
       or /usr/local/share/zsh.

       To create your own help files with helpfiles, choose or create a direc-
       tory where the individual command help files will reside.  For example,
       you  might  choose ~/zsh_help.  If you unpacked the zsh distribution in
       your home directory, you would use the commands:

              mkdir ~/zsh_help
              perl ~/zsh-5.9/Util/helpfiles ~/zsh_help

       The HELPDIR parameter tells run-help where to look for the help  files.
       When unset, it uses the default installation path.  To use your own set
       of help files, set this to the appropriate path in one of your  startup
       files:

              HELPDIR=~/zsh_help

       To  use the run-help function, you need to add lines something like the
       following to your .zshrc or equivalent startup file:

              unalias run-help
              autoload run-help

       Note that in order for `autoload run-help' to work, the  run-help  file
       must  be  in one of the directories named in your fpath array (see zsh-
       param(1)).  This should already be the case if you have a standard  zsh
       installation;  if  it is not, copy Functions/Misc/run-help to an appro-
       priate directory.

   Recompiling Functions
       If you frequently edit your zsh functions, or periodically update  your
       zsh  installation  to  track the latest developments, you may find that
       function digests compiled with the zcompile builtin are frequently  out
       of date with respect to the function source files.  This is not usually
       a problem, because zsh always looks for the newest file when loading  a
       function,  but  it may cause slower shell startup and function loading.
       Also, if a digest file is explicitly used as an element of  fpath,  zsh
       won't check whether any of its source files has changed.

       The  zrecompile  autoloadable function, found in Functions/Misc, can be
       used to keep function digests up to date.

       zrecompile [ -qt ] [ name ... ]
       zrecompile [ -qt ] -p arg ... [ -- arg ... ]
              This tries to find *.zwc files and automatically re-compile them
              if at least one of the original files is newer than the compiled
              file.  This works only if the names stored in the compiled files
              are  full  paths  or are relative to the directory that contains
              the .zwc file.

              In the first form, each name is the name of a compiled file or a
              directory  containing *.zwc files that should be checked.  If no
              arguments are given, the directories and *.zwc  files  in  fpath
              are used.

              When -t is given, no compilation is performed, but a return sta-
              tus of zero (true) is set if there are files  that  need  to  be
              re-compiled  and non-zero (false) otherwise.  The -q option qui-
              ets the chatty output that describes what zrecompile is doing.

              Without the -t option, the return status is zero  if  all  files
              that  needed  re-compilation  could  be compiled and non-zero if
              compilation for at least one of the files failed.

              If the -p option is given, the args are interpreted  as  one  or
              more sets of arguments for zcompile, separated by `--'.  For ex-
              ample:

                     zrecompile -p \
                                -R ~/.zshrc -- \
                                -M ~/.zcompdump -- \
                                ~/zsh/comp.zwc ~/zsh/Completion/*/_*

              This compiles ~/.zshrc into ~/.zshrc.zwc if that  doesn't  exist
              or  if  it  is  older  than  ~/.zshrc. The compiled file will be
              marked for reading instead of mapping.  The  same  is  done  for
              ~/.zcompdump  and  ~/.zcompdump.zwc,  but  this compiled file is
              marked  for  mapping.  The  last  line   re-creates   the   file
              ~/zsh/comp.zwc if any of the files matching the given pattern is
              newer than it.

              Without the -p option, zrecompile does not create  function  di-
              gests  that  do not already exist, nor does it add new functions
              to the digest.

       The following shell loop is an example of a method for  creating  func-
       tion  digests  for  all functions in your fpath, assuming that you have
       write permission to the directories:

              for ((i=1; i <= $#fpath; ++i)); do
                dir=$fpath[i]
                zwc=${dir:t}.zwc
                if [[ $dir == (.|..) || $dir == (.|..)/* ]]; then
                  continue
                fi
                files=($dir/*(N-.))
                if [[ -w $dir:h && -n $files ]]; then
                  files=(${${(M)files%/*/*}#/})
                  if ( cd $dir:h &&
                       zrecompile -p -U -z $zwc $files ); then
                    fpath[i]=$fpath[i].zwc
                  fi
                fi
              done

       The -U and -z options are appropriate for functions in the default  zsh
       installation fpath; you may need to use different options for your per-
       sonal function directories.

       Once the digests have been created and your fpath modified to refer  to
       them,  you can keep them up to date by running zrecompile with no argu-
       ments.

   Keyboard Definition
       The large number of possible combinations of  keyboards,  workstations,
       terminals, emulators, and window systems makes it impossible for zsh to
       have built-in key bindings for  every  situation.   The  zkbd  utility,
       found  in  Functions/Misc, can help you quickly create key bindings for
       your configuration.

       Run zkbd either as an autoloaded function, or as a shell script:

              zsh -f ~/zsh-5.9/Functions/Misc/zkbd

       When you run zkbd, it first asks you to enter your  terminal  type;  if
       the  default it offers is correct, just press return.  It then asks you
       to press a number of different keys  to  determine  characteristics  of
       your  keyboard and terminal; zkbd warns you if it finds anything out of
       the ordinary, such as a Delete key that sends neither ^H nor ^?.

       The keystrokes read by zkbd are recorded as a definition for  an  asso-
       ciative  array  named  key, written to a file in the subdirectory .zkbd
       within either your HOME or ZDOTDIR directory.  The name of the file  is
       composed  from  the  TERM,  VENDOR and OSTYPE parameters, joined by hy-
       phens.

       You may read this file into your .zshrc or another  startup  file  with
       the `source' or `.' commands, then reference the key parameter in bind-
       key commands, like this:

              source ${ZDOTDIR:-$HOME}/.zkbd/$TERM-$VENDOR-$OSTYPE
              [[ -n ${key[Left]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Left]}" backward-char
              [[ -n ${key[Right]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Right]}" forward-char
              # etc.

       Note that in order for `autoload zkbd' to work, the zkdb file  must  be
       in  one of the directories named in your fpath array (see zshparam(1)).
       This should already be the case if you have a  standard  zsh  installa-
       tion;  if  it is not, copy Functions/Misc/zkbd to an appropriate direc-
       tory.

   Dumping Shell State
       Occasionally you may encounter what appears to be a bug in  the  shell,
       particularly  if  you  are using a beta version of zsh or a development
       release.  Usually it is sufficient to send a description of the problem
       to  one of the zsh mailing lists (see zsh(1)), but sometimes one of the
       zsh developers will need to recreate your environment in order to track
       the problem down.

       The script named reporter, found in the Util directory of the distribu-
       tion, is provided for this purpose.  (It is also possible  to  autoload
       reporter,  but  reporter  is  not installed in fpath by default.)  This
       script outputs a detailed dump of the shell state, in the form  of  an-
       other script that can be read with `zsh -f' to recreate that state.

       To  use  reporter, read the script into your shell with the `.' command
       and redirect the output into a file:

              . ~/zsh-5.9/Util/reporter > zsh.report

       You should check the zsh.report file for any sensitive information such
       as  passwords  and delete them by hand before sending the script to the
       developers.  Also, as the output can be voluminous, it's best  to  wait
       for the developers to ask for this information before sending it.

       You  can  also  use  reporter to dump only a subset of the shell state.
       This is sometimes useful for creating startup files for the first time.
       Most  of  the output from reporter is far more detailed than usually is
       necessary for a startup file, but the  aliases,  options,  and  zstyles
       states  may  be  useful  because they include only changes from the de-
       faults.  The bindings state may be useful if you have  created  any  of
       your own keymaps, because reporter arranges to dump the keymap creation
       commands as well as the bindings for every keymap.

       As is usual with automated tools, if you create a startup file with re-
       porter,  you  should  edit  the results to remove unnecessary commands.
       Note that if you're using the new completion  system,  you  should  not
       dump  the  functions state to your startup files with reporter; use the
       compdump function instead (see zshcompsys(1)).

       reporter [ state ... ]
              Print to standard output the indicated  subset  of  the  current
              shell state.  The state arguments may be one or more of:

              all    Output everything listed below.
              aliases
                     Output alias definitions.
              bindings
                     Output ZLE key maps and bindings.
              completion
                     Output  old-style  compctl  commands.   New completion is
                     covered by functions and zstyles.
              functions
                     Output autoloads and function definitions.
              limits Output limit commands.
              options
                     Output setopt commands.
              styles Same as zstyles.
              variables
                     Output shell parameter assignments, plus export  commands
                     for any environment variables.
              zstyles
                     Output zstyle commands.

              If the state is omitted, all is assumed.

       With the exception of `all', every state can be abbreviated by any pre-
       fix, even a single letter; thus a is the same as aliases, z is the same
       as zstyles, etc.

   Manipulating Hook Functions
       add-zsh-hook [ -L | -dD ] [ -Uzk ] hook function
              Several  functions are special to the shell, as described in the
              section SPECIAL FUNCTIONS, see zshmisc(1), in that they are  au-
              tomatically  called  at  specific points during shell execution.
              Each has an associated array consisting of names of functions to
              be  called  at  the  same point; these are so-called `hook func-
              tions'.  The shell function add-zsh-hook provides a  simple  way
              of adding or removing functions from the array.

              hook  is one of chpwd, periodic, precmd, preexec, zshaddhistory,
              zshexit, or zsh_directory_name, the special functions  in  ques-
              tion.  Note that zsh_directory_name is called in a different way
              from the other functions, but may  still  be  manipulated  as  a
              hook.

              function  is  name of an ordinary shell function.  If no options
              are given this will be added to the array of functions to be ex-
              ecuted in the given context.  Functions are invoked in the order
              they were added.

              If the option -L is given, the current values for the  hook  ar-
              rays are listed with typeset.

              If  the option -d is given, the function is removed from the ar-
              ray of functions to be executed.

              If the option -D is given, the function is treated as a  pattern
              and  any  matching names of functions are removed from the array
              of functions to be executed.

              The options -U, -z and -k are passed as  arguments  to  autoload
              for  function.   For functions contributed with zsh, the options
              -Uz are appropriate.

       add-zle-hook-widget [ -L | -dD ] [ -Uzk ] hook widgetname
              Several widget names are special to  the  line  editor,  as  de-
              scribed  in  the section Special Widgets, see zshzle(1), in that
              they are automatically called at specific points during editing.
              Unlike  function  hooks,  these do not use a predefined array of
              other names to call  at  the  same  point;  the  shell  function
              add-zle-hook-widget  maintains  a similar array and arranges for
              the special widget to invoke those additional widgets.

              hook is one of  isearch-exit,  isearch-update,  line-pre-redraw,
              line-init, line-finish, history-line-set, or keymap-select, cor-
              responding to each of the special widgets zle-isearch-exit, etc.
              The special widget names are also accepted as the hook argument.

              widgetname is the name of a ZLE widget.  If no options are given
              this is added to the array of widgets to be invoked in the given
              hook context.  Widgets are invoked in the order they were added,
              with
                     zle widgetname -Nw -f "nolast" -- "$@"

              Note that this means that the `WIDGET' special parameter  tracks
              the  widgetname  when the widget function is called, rather than
              tracking the name of the corresponding special hook widget.

              If the option -d is given, the widgetname is  removed  from  the
              array of widgets to be executed.

              If  the  option -D is given, the widgetname is treated as a pat-
              tern and any matching names of widgets are removed from the  ar-
              ray.

              If widgetname does not name an existing widget when added to the
              array, it is assumed that a shell function also named widgetname
              is meant to provide the implementation of the widget.  This name
              is therefore marked for autoloading, and the options -U, -z  and
              -k  are  passed  as  arguments to autoload as with add-zsh-hook.
              The widget is also created with `zle -N widgetname' to cause the
              corresponding  function  to be loaded the first time the hook is
              called.

              The arrays of widgetname are currently maintained in zstyle con-
              texts, one for each hook context, with a style of `widgets'.  If
              the -L option is given,  this  set  of  styles  is  listed  with
              `zstyle  -L'.   This  implementation may change, and the special
              widgets  that  refer  to  the  styles  are   created   only   if
              add-zle-hook-widget  is called to add at least one widget, so if
              this function is used for any hooks, then all  hooks  should  be
              managed only via this function.

REMEMBERING RECENT DIRECTORIES
       The function cdr allows you to change the working directory to a previ-
       ous working directory from a list maintained automatically.  It is sim-
       ilar  in  concept  to the directory stack controlled by the pushd, popd
       and dirs builtins, but is more configurable, and as it stores  all  en-
       tries  in  files  it is maintained across sessions and (by default) be-
       tween terminal emulators in the current session.  Duplicates are  auto-
       matically removed, so that the list reflects the single most recent use
       of each directory.

       Note that the pushd directory stack is not actually modified or used by
       cdr  unless you configure it to do so as described in the configuration
       section below.

   Installation
       The system works by means of a hook function that is called every  time
       the  directory  changes.   To install the system, autoload the required
       functions and use the add-zsh-hook function described above:

              autoload -Uz chpwd_recent_dirs cdr add-zsh-hook
              add-zsh-hook chpwd chpwd_recent_dirs

       Now every time you change directly interactively, no matter which  com-
       mand  you  use, the directory to which you change will be remembered in
       most-recent-first order.

   Use
       All direct user interaction is via the cdr function.

       The argument to cdr is a number N corresponding to  the  Nth  most  re-
       cently changed-to directory.  1 is the immediately preceding directory;
       the current directory is remembered but is not offered  as  a  destina-
       tion.  Note that if you have multiple windows open 1 may refer to a di-
       rectory changed to in another window; you  can  avoid  this  by  having
       per-terminal  files  for  storing  directory  as  described for the re-
       cent-dirs-file style below.

       If you set the recent-dirs-default style described below cdr  will  be-
       have  the  same as cd if given a non-numeric argument, or more than one
       argument.  The recent directory list is updated just the  same  however
       you change directory.

       If  the  argument is omitted, 1 is assumed.  This is similar to pushd's
       behaviour of swapping the two most recent directories on the stack.

       Completion for the argument to cdr is available if  compinit  has  been
       run; menu selection is recommended, using:

              zstyle ':completion:*:*:cdr:*:*' menu selection

       to  allow  you  to  cycle through recent directories; the order is pre-
       served, so the first choice is the most  recent  directory  before  the
       current  one.   The verbose style is also recommended to ensure the di-
       rectory is shown; this style is on by default so no action is  required
       unless you have changed it.

   Options
       The behaviour of cdr may be modified by the following options.

       -l     lists  the numbers and the corresponding directories in abbrevi-
              ated form (i.e. with ~ substitution reapplied),  one  per  line.
              The directories here are not quoted (this would only be an issue
              if a directory name contained a newline).  This is used  by  the
              completion system.

       -r     sets  the  variable  reply  to  the  current set of directories.
              Nothing is printed and the directory is not changed.

       -e     allows you to edit the list of directories, one per  line.   The
              list can be edited to any extent you like; no sanity checking is
              performed.  Completion is available.  No  quoting  is  necessary
              (except for newlines, where I have in any case no sympathy); di-
              rectories are in unabbreviated  form  and  contain  an  absolute
              path, i.e. they start with /.  Usually the first entry should be
              left as the current directory.

       -p 'pattern'
              Prunes any items in the directory list that match the given  ex-
              tended glob pattern; the pattern needs to be quoted from immedi-
              ate expansion on the  command  line.   The  pattern  is  matched
              against each completely expanded file name in the list; the full
              string must match, so wildcards at the end  (e.g.  '*removeme*')
              are needed to remove entries with a given substring.

              If output is to a terminal, then the function will print the new
              list after pruning and prompt  for  confirmation  by  the  user.
              This output and confirmation step can be skipped by using -P in-
              stead of -p.

   Configuration
       Configuration is by means of the styles mechanism that should be famil-
       iar  from completion; if not, see the description of the zstyle command
       in see zshmodules(1).  The context for setting styles should  be  ':ch-
       pwd:*'  in  case  the meaning of the context is extended in future, for
       example:

              zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-max 0

       sets the value of the recent-dirs-max style  to  0.   In  practice  the
       style name is specific enough that a context of '*' should be fine.

       An  exception  is  recent-dirs-insert, which is used exclusively by the
       completion system and  so  has  the  usual  completion  system  context
       (':completion:*'  if nothing more specific is needed), though again '*'
       should be fine in practice.

       recent-dirs-default
              If true, and the command is expecting a recent directory  index,
              and  either  there  is more than one argument or the argument is
              not an integer, then fall through to "cd".  This allows the lazy
              to  use  only  one  command  for directory changing.  Completion
              recognises this, too; see recent-dirs-insert for how to  control
              completion when this option is in use.

       recent-dirs-file
              The file where the list of directories is saved.  The default is
              ${ZDOTDIR:-$HOME}/.chpwd-recent-dirs, i.e. this is in your  home
              directory  unless  you  have  set  the variable ZDOTDIR to point
              somewhere else.  Directory names  are  saved  in  $'...'  quoted
              form,  so  each line in the file can be supplied directly to the
              shell as an argument.

              The value of this style may be an  array.   In  this  case,  the
              first  file  in the list will always be used for saving directo-
              ries while any other files are left untouched.  When reading the
              recent  directory list, if there are fewer than the maximum num-
              ber of entries in the first file, the contents of later files in
              the array will be appended with duplicates removed from the list
              shown.  The contents of the two files are not  sorted  together,
              i.e.  all  the  entries  in the first file are shown first.  The
              special value + can appear in the list to indicate  the  default
              file should be read at that point.  This allows effects like the
              following:

                     zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file \
                     ~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-${TTY##*/} +

              Recent directories are read from a file  numbered  according  to
              the  terminal.   If  there  are insufficient entries the list is
              supplemented from the default file.

              It is possible to use zstyle -e to make  the  directory  config-
              urable at run time:

                     zstyle -e ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file pick-recent-dirs-file
                     pick-recent-dirs-file() {
                       if [[ $PWD = ~/text/writing(|/*) ]]; then
                         reply=(~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-writing)
                       else
                         reply=(+)
                       fi
                     }

              In this example, if the current directory is ~/text/writing or a
              directory under it, then use a special file  for  saving  recent
              directories, else use the default.

       recent-dirs-insert
              Used  by  completion.  If recent-dirs-default is true, then set-
              ting this to true causes the actual directory, rather  than  its
              index, to be inserted on the command line; this has the same ef-
              fect as using the corresponding index,  but  makes  the  history
              clearer and the line easier to edit.  With this setting, if part
              of an argument was already typed,  normal  directory  completion
              rather than recent directory completion is done; this is because
              recent directory completion is expected to be  done  by  cycling
              through entries menu fashion.

              If  the  value of the style is always, then only recent directo-
              ries will be completed; in that case, use the  cd  command  when
              you want to complete other directories.

              If  the  value  is  fallback,  recent  directories will be tried
              first, then normal directory completion is performed  if  recent
              directory completion failed to find a match.

              Finally,  if the value is both then both sets of completions are
              presented; the usual tag mechanism can be  used  to  distinguish
              results,  with  recent  directories tagged as recent-dirs.  Note
              that the recent directories inserted are abbreviated with direc-
              tory names where appropriate.

       recent-dirs-max
              The  maximum number of directories to save to the file.  If this
              is zero or negative there is no maximum.   The  default  is  20.
              Note  this  includes the current directory, which isn't offered,
              so the highest number of directories you will be offered is  one
              less than the maximum.

       recent-dirs-prune
              This  style  is an array determining what directories should (or
              should not) be added to the recent list.  Elements of the  array
              can include:

              parent Prune  parents  (more accurately, ancestors) from the re-
                     cent list.  If present, changing  directly  down  by  any
                     number  of directories causes the current directory to be
                     overwritten.   For  example,  changing   from   ~pws   to
                     ~pws/some/other/dir causes ~pws not to be left on the re-
                     cent  directory  stack.   This  only  applies  to  direct
                     changes to descendant directories; earlier directories on
                     the list are not  pruned.   For  example,  changing  from
                     ~pws/yet/another  to  ~pws/some/other/dir  does not cause
                     ~pws to be pruned.

              pattern:pattern
                     Gives a zsh pattern for directories that  should  not  be
                     added  to  the  recent list (if not already there).  This
                     element can be repeated to add different  patterns.   For
                     example,  'pattern:/tmp(|/*)'  stops  /tmp or its descen-
                     dants from being added.  The EXTENDED_GLOB option is  al-
                     ways turned on for these patterns.

       recent-dirs-pushd
              If  set  to true, cdr will use pushd instead of cd to change the
              directory, so the directory is saved on the directory stack.  As
              the  directory  stack  is  completely  separate from the list of
              files saved by the mechanism used in this file there is no obvi-
              ous reason to do this.

   Use with dynamic directory naming
       It  is possible to refer to recent directories using the dynamic direc-
       tory name syntax by using the supplied function  zsh_directory_name_cdr
       a hook:

              autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook
              add-zsh-hook -Uz zsh_directory_name zsh_directory_name_cdr

       When  this  is done, ~[1] will refer to the most recent directory other
       than $PWD, and so on.  Completion after ~[...  also works.

   Details of directory handling
       This section is for the curious or confused; most users will  not  need
       to know this information.

       Recent  directories  are saved to a file immediately and hence are pre-
       served across sessions.  Note currently no file locking is applied: the
       list  is  updated  immediately on interactive commands and nowhere else
       (unlike history), and it is assumed you are only going to change direc-
       tory  in  one window at once.  This is not safe on shared accounts, but
       in any case the system has limited utility when someone else is  chang-
       ing to a different set of directories behind your back.

       To make this a little safer, only directory changes instituted from the
       command line, either directly  or  indirectly  through  shell  function
       calls  (but  not  through subshells, evals, traps, completion functions
       and the like) are saved.  Shell functions should use cd -q or pushd  -q
       to avoid side effects if the change to the directory is to be invisible
       at the command line.   See  the  contents  of  the  function  chpwd_re-
       cent_dirs for more details.

ABBREVIATED DYNAMIC REFERENCES TO DIRECTORIES
       The  dynamic directory naming system is described in the subsection Dy-
       namic named directories of  the  section  Filename  Expansion  in  zsh-
       expn(1).   In  this,  a  reference  to ~[...] is expanded by a function
       found by the hooks mechanism.

       The contributed function zsh_directory_name_generic provides  a  system
       allowing the user to refer to directories with only a limited amount of
       new code.  It supports all three of the standard interfaces for  direc-
       tory  naming:  converting from a name to a directory, converting in the
       reverse direction to find a short name, and completion of names.

       The main feature of this function is a path-like syntax, combining  ab-
       breviations  at  multiple  levels  separated  by  ":".   As an example,
       ~[g:p:s] might specify:
       g      The top level directory for your git area.  This first component
              has to match, or the function will return indicating another di-
              rectory name hook function should be tried.

       p      The name of a project within your git area.

       s      The source area within that project.  This allows  you  to  col-
              lapse  references  to  long  hierarchies to a very compact form,
              particularly if the hierarchies are similar across different ar-
              eas of the disk.

       Name  components may be completed: if a description is shown at the top
       of the list of completions, it includes the path to which previous com-
       ponents  expand,  while  the  description  for an individual completion
       shows the path segment it would add.  No  additional  configuration  is
       needed for this as the completion system is aware of the dynamic direc-
       tory name mechanism.

   Usage
       To use the function, first define a wrapper function for your  specific
       case.   We'll assume it's to be autoloaded.  This can have any name but
       we'll refer to it as zdn_mywrapper.  This wrapper function will  define
       various  variables  and then call this function with the same arguments
       that the wrapper function gets.  This configuration is described below.

       Then arrange for the wrapper to be run as a zsh_directory_name hook:

              autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook zsh_directory_name_generic zdn_mywrapper
              add-zsh-hook -U zsh_directory_name zdn_mywrapper

   Configuration
       The wrapper function should define a local associative  array  zdn_top.
       Alternatively,  this  can be set with a style called mapping.  The con-
       text for the style is :zdn:wrapper-name where wrapper-name is the func-
       tion calling zsh_directory_name_generic; for example:

              zstyle :zdn:zdn_mywrapper: mapping zdn_mywrapper_top

       The keys in this associative array correspond to the first component of
       the name.  The values are matching directories.  They may have  an  op-
       tional  suffix with a slash followed by a colon and the name of a vari-
       able in the same format to give the next component.  (The slash  before
       the  colon  is  to disambiguate the case where a colon is needed in the
       path for a drive.  There is otherwise no syntax for escaping  this,  so
       path  components  whose names start with a colon are not supported.)  A
       special component :default: specifies a variable in the form /:var (the
       path  section is ignored and so is usually empty) that will be used for
       the next component if no variable is given for the path.  Variables re-
       ferred  to  within  zdn_top have the same format as zdn_top itself, but
       contain relative paths.

       For example,

              local -A zdn_top=(
                g   ~/git
                ga  ~/alternate/git
                gs  /scratch/$USER/git/:second2
                :default: /:second1
              )

       This specifies the behaviour of a directory referred to as ~[g:...]  or
       ~[ga:...]  or  ~[gs:...].   Later path components are optional; in that
       case  ~[g]  expands   to   ~/git,   and   so   on.    gs   expands   to
       /scratch/$USER/git  and uses the associative array second2 to match the
       second component; g and ga use the associative array second1  to  match
       the second component.

       When  expanding  a name to a directory, if the first component is not g
       or ga or gs, it is not an error; the function simply returns 1 so  that
       a later hook function can be tried.  However, matching the first compo-
       nent commits the function, so if a later component does not  match,  an
       error  is printed (though this still does not stop later hooks from be-
       ing executed).

       For components after the first, a relative path is expected,  but  note
       that multiple levels may still appear.  Here is an example of second1:

              local -A second1=(
                p   myproject
                s   somproject
                os  otherproject/subproject/:third
              )

       The path as found from zdn_top is extended with the matching directory,
       so ~[g:p] becomes ~/git/myproject.  The slash between is added automat-
       ically  (it's not possible to have a later component modify the name of
       a directory already matched).  Only os specifies a variable for a third
       component,  and  there's  no  :default:, so it's an error to use a name
       like ~[g:p:x] or ~[ga:s:y] because there's nowhere to look up the x  or
       y.

       The  associative  arrays  need  to be visible within this function; the
       generic function therefore uses internal variable names beginning _zdn_
       in  order  to  avoid clashes.  Note that the variable reply needs to be
       passed back to the shell, so should not be local in the  calling  func-
       tion.

       The  function  does not test whether directories assembled by component
       actually exist; this allows the system to work across automounted  file
       systems.   The  error from the command trying to use a non-existent di-
       rectory should be sufficient to indicate the problem.

   Complete example
       Here is a full fictitious but usable autoloadable definition of the ex-
       ample  function  defined  by  the  code above.  So ~[gs:p:s] expands to
       /scratch/$USER/git/myscratchproject/top/srcdir  (with  $USER  also  ex-
       panded).

              local -A zdn_top=(
                g   ~/git
                ga  ~/alternate/git
                gs  /scratch/$USER/git/:second2
                :default: /:second1
              )

              local -A second1=(
                p   myproject
                s   somproject
                os  otherproject/subproject/:third
              )

              local -A second2=(
                p   myscratchproject
                s   somescratchproject
              )

              local -A third=(
                s   top/srcdir
                d   top/documentation
              )

              # autoload not needed if you did this at initialisation...
              autoload -Uz zsh_directory_name_generic
              zsh_directory_name_generic "$@

       It  is  also possible to use global associative arrays, suitably named,
       and set the style for the context of your wrapper function to refer  to
       this.  Then your set up code would contain the following:

              typeset -A zdn_mywrapper_top=(...)
              # ... and so on for other associative arrays ...
              zstyle ':zdn:zdn_mywrapper:' mapping zdn_mywrapper_top
              autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook zsh_directory_name_generic zdn_mywrapper
              add-zsh-hook -U zsh_directory_name zdn_mywrapper

       and the function zdn_mywrapper would contain only the following:

              zsh_directory_name_generic "$@"

GATHERING INFORMATION FROM VERSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
       In  a  lot  of  cases, it is nice to automatically retrieve information
       from version control systems (VCSs), such as subversion, CVS or git, to
       be  able  to  provide it to the user; possibly in the user's prompt. So
       that you can instantly tell which branch you are currently on, for  ex-
       ample.

       In order to do that, you may use the vcs_info function.

       The following VCSs are supported, showing the abbreviated name by which
       they are referred to within the system:
       Bazaar (bzr)
              https://bazaar.canonical.com/
       Codeville (cdv)
              http://freecode.com/projects/codeville/
       Concurrent Versioning System (cvs)
              https://www.nongnu.org/cvs/
       Darcs (darcs)
              http://darcs.net/
       Fossil (fossil)
              https://fossil-scm.org/
       Git (git)
              https://git-scm.com/
       GNU arch (tla)
              https://www.gnu.org/software/gnu-arch/
       Mercurial (hg)
              https://www.mercurial-scm.org/
       Monotone (mtn)
              https://monotone.ca/
       Perforce (p4)
              https://www.perforce.com/
       Subversion (svn)
              https://subversion.apache.org/
       SVK (svk)
              https://svk.bestpractical.com/

       There  is  also  support  for  the  patch   management   system   quilt
       (https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt).  See  Quilt Support below
       for details.

       To load vcs_info:

              autoload -Uz vcs_info

       It can be used in any existing prompt, because it does not require  any
       specific $psvar entries to be available.

   Quickstart
       To  get this feature working quickly (including colors), you can do the
       following (assuming, you loaded vcs_info properly - see above):

              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' actionformats \
                  '%F{5}(%f%s%F{5})%F{3}-%F{5}[%F{2}%b%F{3}|%F{1}%a%F{5}]%f '
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' formats       \
                  '%F{5}(%f%s%F{5})%F{3}-%F{5}[%F{2}%b%F{5}]%f '
              zstyle ':vcs_info:(sv[nk]|bzr):*' branchformat '%b%F{1}:%F{3}%r'
              precmd () { vcs_info }
              PS1='%F{5}[%F{2}%n%F{5}] %F{3}%3~ ${vcs_info_msg_0_}%f%# '

       Obviously, the last two lines are there for demonstration. You need  to
       call  vcs_info  from your precmd function. Once that is done you need a
       single quoted '${vcs_info_msg_0_}' in your prompt.

       To be able to use '${vcs_info_msg_0_}' directly  in  your  prompt  like
       this, you will need to have the PROMPT_SUBST option enabled.

       Now call the vcs_info_printsys utility from the command line:

              % vcs_info_printsys
              ## list of supported version control backends:
              ## disabled systems are prefixed by a hash sign (#)
              bzr
              cdv
              cvs
              darcs
              fossil
              git
              hg
              mtn
              p4
              svk
              svn
              tla
              ## flavours (cannot be used in the enable or disable styles; they
              ## are enabled and disabled with their master [git-svn -> git])
              ## they *can* be used in contexts: ':vcs_info:git-svn:*'.
              git-p4
              git-svn
              hg-git
              hg-hgsubversion
              hg-hgsvn

       You  may not want all of these because there is no point in running the
       code to detect systems you do not use.  So there is a  way  to  disable
       some backends altogether:

              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr cdv darcs mtn svk tla

       You may also pick a few from that list and enable only those:

              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable git cvs svn

       If  you  rerun  vcs_info_printsys after one of these commands, you will
       see the backends listed in the disable style (or backends  not  in  the
       enable  style  -  if  you used that) marked as disabled by a hash sign.
       That means the detection of these systems  is  skipped  completely.  No
       wasted time there.

   Configuration
       The vcs_info feature can be configured via zstyle.

       First, the context in which we are working:
              :vcs_info:vcs-string:user-context:repo-root-name

       vcs-string
              is  one  of:  git, git-svn, git-p4, hg, hg-git, hg-hgsubversion,
              hg-hgsvn, darcs, bzr, cdv, mtn, svn, cvs, svk, tla, p4  or  fos-
              sil.  This is followed by `.quilt-quilt-mode' in Quilt mode (see
              Quilt Support for details) and by `+hook-name' while  hooks  are
              active (see Hooks in vcs_info for details).

              Currently, hooks in quilt mode don't add the `.quilt-quilt-mode'
              information.  This may change in the future.

       user-context
              is a freely configurable string, assignable by the user  as  the
              first argument to vcs_info (see its description below).

       repo-root-name
              is  the name of a repository in which you want a style to match.
              So, if you want a setting specific to  /usr/src/zsh,  with  that
              being  a CVS checkout, you can set repo-root-name to zsh to make
              it so.

       There are three special values  for  vcs-string:  The  first  is  named
       -init-,  that  is  in  effect as long as there was no decision what VCS
       backend to use. The second is -preinit-; it is used before vcs_info  is
       run,  when initializing the data exporting variables. The third special
       value is formats and is used by the vcs_info_lastmsg for looking up its
       styles.

       The  initial  value  of repo-root-name is -all- and it is replaced with
       the actual name, as soon as it is known. Only use this part of the con-
       text for defining the formats, actionformats or branchformat styles, as
       it is guaranteed that repo-root-name is  set  up  correctly  for  these
       only. For all other styles, just use '*' instead.

       There are two pre-defined values for user-context:
       default
              the one used if none is specified
       command
              used by vcs_info_lastmsg to lookup its styles

       You  can of course use ':vcs_info:*' to match all VCSs in all user-con-
       texts at once.

       This is a description of all styles that are looked up.

       formats
              A list of formats, used when actionformats is not used (which is
              most of the time).

       actionformats
              A list of formats, used if there is a special action going on in
              your current repository; like an interactive rebase or  a  merge
              conflict.

       branchformat
              Some backends replace %b in the formats and actionformats styles
              above, not only by a branch name but also by a revision  number.
              This style lets you modify how that string should look.

       nvcsformats
              These  "formats" are set when we didn't detect a version control
              system for the current directory or vcs_info was disabled.  This
              is  useful if you want vcs_info to completely take over the gen-
              eration  of  your  prompt.   You   would   do   something   like
              PS1='${vcs_info_msg_0_}' to accomplish that.

       hgrevformat
              hg  uses  both  a hash and a revision number to reference a spe-
              cific changeset in a repository. With this style you can  format
              the  revision  string  (see  branchformat)  to include either or
              both. It's only useful when get-revision is true. Note, the full
              40-character revision id is not available (except when using the
              use-simple option) because  executing  hg  more  than  once  per
              prompt is too slow; you may customize this behavior using hooks.

       max-exports
              Defines the maximum number of vcs_info_msg_*_ variables vcs_info
              will set.

       enable A list of backends you want to use. Checked in the  -init-  con-
              text.  If  this  list contains an item called NONE no backend is
              used at all and vcs_info will do nothing. If this list  contains
              ALL,  vcs_info will use all known backends. Only with ALL in en-
              able will the disable style have any effect. ALL  and  NONE  are
              case insensitive.

       disable
              A  list of VCSs you don't want vcs_info to test for repositories
              (checked in the -init- context, too). Only used if  enable  con-
              tains ALL.

       disable-patterns
              A  list  of patterns that are checked against $PWD. If a pattern
              matches, vcs_info will be disabled. This style is checked in the
              :vcs_info:-init-:*:-all- context.

              Say,  ~/.zsh  is a directory under version control, in which you
              do not want vcs_info to be active, do:
                     zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable-patterns "${(b)HOME}/.zsh(|/*)"

       use-quilt
              If enabled, the quilt support code is active  in  `addon'  mode.
              See Quilt Support for details.

       quilt-standalone
              If  enabled,  `standalone' mode detection is attempted if no VCS
              is active in a given directory. See Quilt Support for details.

       quilt-patch-dir
              Overwrite the value of the $QUILT_PATCHES environment  variable.
              See Quilt Support for details.

       quiltcommand
              When  quilt itself is called in quilt support, the value of this
              style is used as the command name.

       check-for-changes
              If enabled, this style causes the %c and %u  format  escapes  to
              show  when  the  working  directory has uncommitted changes. The
              strings displayed by these escapes can  be  controlled  via  the
              stagedstr  and  unstagedstr  styles. The only backends that cur-
              rently support this option are git, hg, and bzr (the latter  two
              only support unstaged).

              For  this style to be evaluated with the hg backend, the get-re-
              vision style needs to be set and the use-simple style  needs  to
              be unset. The latter is the default; the former is not.

              With  the  bzr  backend,  lightweight  checkouts only honor this
              style if the use-server style is set.

              Note, the actions taken if this style is enabled are potentially
              expensive (read: they may be slow, depending on how big the cur-
              rent repository is).  Therefore, it is disabled by default.

       check-for-staged-changes
              This style is like check-for-changes, but it  never  checks  the
              worktree  files,  only  the metadata in the .${vcs} dir.  There-
              fore, this style initializes only the %c escape (with stagedstr)
              but   not   the   %u   escape.    This   style  is  faster  than
              check-for-changes.

              In the git backend, this style checks for changes in the  index.
              Other backends do not currently implement this style.

              This style is disabled by default.

       stagedstr
              This  string  will  be used in the %c escape if there are staged
              changes in the repository.

       unstagedstr
              This string will be used in the %u escape if there are  unstaged
              changes in the repository.

       command
              This  style  causes  vcs_info  to use the supplied string as the
              command to use as the VCS's binary. Note, that setting  this  in
              ':vcs_info:*' is not a good idea.

              If  the value of this style is empty (which is the default), the
              used binary name is the name of the backend in use (e.g. svn  is
              used in an svn repository).

              The  repo-root-name  part  in  the context is always the default
              -all- when this style is looked up.

              For example, this style can be used to use binaries from non-de-
              fault  installation  directories.  Assume,  git  is installed in
              /usr/bin but your sysadmin installed a newer version in /usr/lo-
              cal/bin.  Instead of changing the order of your $PATH parameter,
              you can do this:
                     zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*:-all-' command /usr/local/bin/git

       use-server
              This is used by the Perforce backend (p4) to decide if it should
              contact  the  Perforce server to find out if a directory is man-
              aged by Perforce.  This is the only reliable way of doing  this,
              but runs the risk of a delay if the server name cannot be found.
              If the server (more specifically, the host:port pair  describing
              the  server) cannot be contacted, its name is put into the asso-
              ciative array  vcs_info_p4_dead_servers  and  is  not  contacted
              again during the session until it is removed by hand.  If you do
              not set this style, the p4 backend is only usable  if  you  have
              set  the  environment  variable P4CONFIG to a file name and have
              corresponding files in the root  directories  of  each  Perforce
              client.   See  comments  in  the function VCS_INFO_detect_p4 for
              more detail.

              The Bazaar backend (bzr) uses  this  to  permit  contacting  the
              server  about  lightweight  checkouts, see the check-for-changes
              style.

       use-simple
              If there are two different ways of  gathering  information,  you
              can  select  the  simpler one by setting this style to true; the
              default is to use the not-that-simple code, which is potentially
              a  lot  slower but might be more accurate in all possible cases.
              This style is used by the bzr, hg, and git backends. In the case
              of  hg  it will invoke the external hexdump program to parse the
              binary dirstate cache file; this method will not return the  lo-
              cal revision number.

       get-revision
              If  set  to true, vcs_info goes the extra mile to figure out the
              revision of a repository's work tree (currently for the git  and
              hg  backends,  where  this kind of information is not always vi-
              tal). For git, the hash value of the currently checked out  com-
              mit  is available via the %i expansion. With hg, the local revi-
              sion number and the corresponding global hash are available  via
              %i.

       get-mq If  set  to true, the hg backend will look for a Mercurial Queue
              (mq) patch directory. Information will be available via the `%m'
              replacement.

       get-bookmarks
              If set to true, the hg backend will try to get a list of current
              bookmarks. They will be available via the `%m' replacement.

              The default is to generate a comma-separated list of  all  book-
              mark names that refer to the currently checked out revision.  If
              a bookmark is active, its  name  is  suffixed  an  asterisk  and
              placed first in the list.

       use-prompt-escapes
              Determines  if we assume that the assembled string from vcs_info
              includes prompt escapes. (Used by vcs_info_lastmsg.)

       debug  Enable debugging output to track  possible  problems.  Currently
              this style is only used by vcs_info's hooks system.

       hooks  A  list  style  that  defines  hook-function names. See Hooks in
              vcs_info below for details.

       patch-format
       nopatch-format
              This pair of styles format the patch information used by the  %m
              expando  in  formats  and actionformats for the git and hg back-
              ends.  The value is subject to  certain  %-expansions  described
              below.  The expanded value is made available in the global back-
              end_misc  array   as   ${backend_misc[patches]}   (also   if   a
              set-patch-format hook is used).

       get-unapplied
              This  boolean style controls whether a backend should attempt to
              gather a list of unapplied patches (for example  with  Mercurial
              Queue patches).

              Used by the quilt, hg, and git backends.

       The default values for these styles in all contexts are:

       formats
              " (%s)-[%b]%u%c-"
       actionformats
              " (%s)-[%b|%a]%u%c-"
       branchformat
              "%b:%r" (for bzr, svn, svk and hg)
       nvcsformats
              ""
       hgrevformat
              "%r:%h"
       max-exports
              2
       enable ALL
       disable
              (empty list)
       disable-patterns
              (empty list)
       check-for-changes
              false
       check-for-staged-changes
              false
       stagedstr
              (string: "S")
       unstagedstr
              (string: "U")
       command
              (empty string)
       use-server
              false
       use-simple
              false
       get-revision
              false
       get-mq true
       get-bookmarks
              false
       use-prompt-escapes
              true
       debug  false
       hooks  (empty list)
       use-quilt
              false
       quilt-standalone
              false
       quilt-patch-dir
              empty - use $QUILT_PATCHES
       quiltcommand
              quilt
       patch-format
              backend dependent
       nopatch-format
              backend dependent
       get-unapplied
              false

       In  normal  formats  and  actionformats  the following replacements are
       done:

       %s     The VCS in use (git, hg, svn, etc.).
       %b     Information about the current branch.
       %a     An identifier that describes the action. Only makes sense in ac-
              tionformats.
       %i     The  current revision number or identifier. For hg the hgrevfor-
              mat style may be used to customize the output.
       %c     The string from the stagedstr style if there are staged  changes
              in the repository.
       %u     The  string  from  the  unstagedstr  style if there are unstaged
              changes in the repository.
       %R     The base directory of the repository.
       %r     The repository name. If %R is /foo/bar/repoXY, %r is repoXY.
       %S     A subdirectory within a  repository.  If  $PWD  is  /foo/bar/re-
              poXY/beer/tasty, %S is beer/tasty.
       %m     A  "misc" replacement. It is at the discretion of the backend to
              decide what this replacement expands to.

              The hg and git backends use this expando to display patch infor-
              mation.   hg  sources  patch information from the mq extensions;
              git from in-progress rebase and cherry-pick operations and  from
              the stgit extension.  The patch-format and nopatch-format styles
              control the generated string.  The former is used when at  least
              one  patch from the patch queue has been applied, and the latter
              otherwise.

              The hg backend displays bookmark information in this expando (in
              addition  to  mq information).  See the get-mq and get-bookmarks
              styles.  Both of these styles may be enabled at the  same  time.
              If  both are enabled, both resulting strings will be shown sepa-
              rated by a semicolon (that cannot currently be customized).

              The quilt `standalone' backend sets this  expando  to  the  same
              value as the %Q expando.

       %Q     Quilt series information.  When quilt is used (either in `addon'
              mode or as a `standalone' backend), this expando is set  to  the
              quilt  series'  patch-format  string.  The set-patch-format hook
              and nopatch-format style are honoured.

              See Quilt Support below for details.

       In branchformat these replacements are done:

       %b     The branch name. For hg, the branch name  can  include  a  topic
              name.
       %r     The current revision number or the hgrevformat style for hg.

       In hgrevformat these replacements are done:

       %r     The current local revision number.
       %h     The current global revision identifier.

       In patch-format and nopatch-format these replacements are done:

       %p     The name of the top-most applied patch; may be overridden by the
              applied-string hook.
       %u     The number of unapplied patches; may be overridden by the  unap-
              plied-string hook.
       %n     The number of applied patches.
       %c     The number of unapplied patches.
       %a     The number of all patches (%a = %n + %c).
       %g     The names of active mq guards (hg backend).
       %G     The number of active mq guards (hg backend).

       Not  all VCS backends have to support all replacements. For nvcsformats
       no replacements are performed at all, it is just a string.

   Oddities
       If you want to use the %b (bold off) prompt expansion in formats, which
       expands  %b  itself, use %%b. That will cause the vcs_info expansion to
       replace %%b with %b, so that zsh's prompt expansion mechanism can  han-
       dle  it. Similarly, to hand down %b from branchformat, use %%%%b. Sorry
       for this inconvenience, but it cannot be easily avoided. Luckily we  do
       not  clash  with  a  lot of prompt expansions and this only needs to be
       done for those.

       When  one  of   the   gen-applied-string,   gen-unapplied-string,   and
       set-patch-format     hooks     is    defined,    applying    %-escaping
       (`foo=${foo//'%'/%%}') to the interpolated values for use in the prompt
       is  the  responsibility of those hooks (jointly); when neither of those
       hooks is defined, vcs_info handles escaping by itself.  We regret  this
       coupling, but it was required for backwards compatibility.

   Quilt Support
       Quilt  is  not  a  version control system, therefore this is not imple-
       mented as a backend. It can help keeping track of a series of  patches.
       People use it to keep a set of changes they want to use on top of soft-
       ware packages (which is  tightly  integrated  into  the  package  build
       process - the Debian project does this for a large number of packages).
       Quilt can also help individual  developers  keep  track  of  their  own
       patches on top of real version control systems.

       The  vcs_info  integration tries to support both ways of using quilt by
       having two slightly different modes  of  operation:  `addon'  mode  and
       `standalone' mode).

       Quilt  integration  is  off by default; to enable it, set the use-quilt
       style, and add %Q to your formats or actionformats style:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' use-quilt true

       Styles   looked   up   from   the   Quilt    support    code    include
       `.quilt-quilt-mode'  in  the  vcs-string  part  of  the  context, where
       quilt-mode    is    either    addon    or     standalone.      Example:
       :vcs_info:git.quilt-addon:default:repo-root-name.

       For `addon' mode to become active vcs_info must have already detected a
       real version control system controlling the directory. If that  is  the
       case,  a  directory  that holds quilt's patches needs to be found. That
       directory is configurable via the `QUILT_PATCHES' environment variable.
       If  that  variable  exists  its  value  is  used,  otherwise  the value
       `patches' is assumed. The value from $QUILT_PATCHES can be  overwritten
       using  the `quilt-patch-dir' style. (Note: you can use vcs_info to keep
       the value of $QUILT_PATCHES correct all the  time  via  the  post-quilt
       hook).

       When the directory in question is found, quilt is assumed to be active.
       To gather more information,  vcs_info  looks  for  a  directory  called
       `.pc';  Quilt  uses  that directory to track its current state. If this
       directory does not exist we know that quilt has not  done  anything  to
       the working directory (read: no patches have been applied yet).

       If  patches  are  applied,  vcs_info will try to find out which. If you
       want to know which patches of a series are not yet applied, you need to
       activate the get-unapplied style in the appropriate context.

       vcs_info  allows for very detailed control over how the gathered infor-
       mation is presented (see the Configuration and Hooks in  vcs_info  sec-
       tions),  all  of which are documented below. Note there are a number of
       other patch tracking systems that work on top of a certain version con-
       trol  system  (like stgit for git, or mq for hg); the configuration for
       systems like that are generally configured the same way  as  the  quilt
       support.

       If the quilt support is working in `addon' mode, the produced string is
       available as a simple format replacement (%Q to be precise), which  can
       be used in formats and actionformats; see below for details).

       If,  on  the  other  hand,  the support code is working in `standalone'
       mode, vcs_info will pretend as if quilt were an actual version  control
       system.  That  means  that the version control system identifier (which
       otherwise would be something like  `svn'  or  `cvs')  will  be  set  to
       `-quilt-'.  This  has implications on the used style context where this
       identifier is the second element. vcs_info will have filled in a proper
       value  for  the "repository's" root directory and the string containing
       the information about quilt's state will be available as the `misc' re-
       placement (and %Q for compatibility with `addon' mode).

       What  is  left to discuss is how `standalone' mode is detected. The de-
       tection itself is a series of searches for directories.  You  can  have
       this detection enabled all the time in every directory that is not oth-
       erwise under version control. If you know there is only a  limited  set
       of  trees  where  you  would like vcs_info to try and look for Quilt in
       `standalone' mode to minimise the amount of searching on every call  to
       vcs_info, there are a number of ways to do that:

       Essentially,  `standalone'  mode  detection  is  controlled  by a style
       called `quilt-standalone'. It is a string style and its value can  have
       different  effects.  The simplest values are: `always' to run detection
       every time vcs_info is run, and `never' to turn the detection  off  en-
       tirely.

       If  the  value of quilt-standalone is something else, it is interpreted
       differently. If the value is the name of a scalar variable the value of
       that  variable  is  checked  and  that  value  is used in the same `al-
       ways'/`never' way as described above.

       If the value of quilt-standalone is an array, the elements of that  ar-
       ray  are  used as directory names under which you want the detection to
       be active.

       If quilt-standalone is an associative array, the keys are taken as  di-
       rectory names under which you want the detection to be active, but only
       if the corresponding value is the string `true'.

       Last, but not least, if the value of quilt-standalone is the name of  a
       function, the function is called without arguments and the return value
       decides whether detection should be active. A `0' return value is true;
       a non-zero return value is interpreted as false.

       Note,  if  there  is  both  a  function  and  a variable by the name of
       quilt-standalone, the function will take precedence.

   Function Descriptions (Public API)
       vcs_info [user-context]
              The main function, that runs all backends and assembles all data
              into  ${vcs_info_msg_*_}.  This is the function you want to call
              from precmd if you want to  include  up-to-date  information  in
              your prompt (see Variable Description below).  If an argument is
              given, that string will  be  used  instead  of  default  in  the
              user-context field of the style context.

       vcs_info_hookadd
              Statically  registers a number of functions to a given hook. The
              hook needs to be given as the first argument; what follows is  a
              list  of hook-function names to register to the hook. The `+vi-'
              prefix needs to be left out here. See Hooks  in  vcs_info  below
              for details.

       vcs_info_hookdel
              Remove  hook-functions  from  a given hook. The hook needs to be
              given as the first non-option argument; what follows is  a  list
              of  hook-function names to un-register from the hook. If `-a' is
              used as the first argument, all occurrences of the functions are
              unregistered.  Otherwise only the last occurrence is removed (if
              a function was registered to a hook more than once). The  `+vi-'
              prefix  needs  to be left out here.  See Hooks in vcs_info below
              for details.

       vcs_info_lastmsg
              Outputs the current values of  ${vcs_info_msg_*_}.   Takes  into
              account   the   value   of   the   use-prompt-escapes  style  in
              ':vcs_info:formats:command:-all-'. It also only  prints  max-ex-
              ports values.

       vcs_info_printsys [user-context]
              Prints  a  list of all supported version control systems. Useful
              to find out possible contexts (and which of them are enabled) or
              values for the disable style.

       vcs_info_setsys
              Initializes vcs_info's internal list of available backends. With
              this function, you can add support for new VCSs without restart-
              ing the shell.

       All functions named VCS_INFO_* are for internal use only.

   Variable Description
       ${vcs_info_msg_N_} (Note the trailing underscore)
              Where  N  is  an integer, e.g., vcs_info_msg_0_. These variables
              are the storage for the informational message the last  vcs_info
              call has assembled. These are strongly connected to the formats,
              actionformats and  nvcsformats  styles  described  above.  Those
              styles  are  lists.  The first member of that list gets expanded
              into ${vcs_info_msg_0_}, the second into ${vcs_info_msg_1_}  and
              the  Nth  into  ${vcs_info_msg_N-1_}. (See the max-exports style
              above.)

       All variables named VCS_INFO_* are for internal use only.

   Hooks in vcs_info
       Hooks are places in vcs_info where you can run your own code. That code
       can  communicate  with the code that called it and through that, change
       the system's behaviour.

       For configuration, hooks change the style context:
              :vcs_info:vcs-string+hook-name:user-context:repo-root-name

       To register functions to a hook, you need to list  them  in  the  hooks
       style in the appropriate context.

       Example:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*+foo:*' hooks bar baz

       This  registers  functions to the hook `foo' for all backends. In order
       to  avoid  namespace  problems,  all  registered  function  names   are
       prepended  by  a  `+vi-',  so the actual functions called for the `foo'
       hook are `+vi-bar' and `+vi-baz'.

       If you would like to register a function to a hook  regardless  of  the
       current context, you may use the vcs_info_hookadd function. To remove a
       function that was added like that, the vcs_info_hookdel function can be
       used.

       If  something  seems weird, you can enable the `debug' boolean style in
       the proper context and the hook-calling code will print what  it  tried
       to execute and whether the function in question existed.

       When  you  register more than one function to a hook, all functions are
       executed one after another until one function returns non-zero or until
       all  functions  have  been called. Context-sensitive hook functions are
       executed  before  statically  registered  ones  (the  ones   added   by
       vcs_info_hookadd).

       You   may  pass  data  between  functions  via  an  associative  array,
       user_data.  For example:
              +vi-git-myfirsthook(){
                  user_data[myval]=$myval
              }
              +vi-git-mysecondhook(){
                  # do something with ${user_data[myval]}
              }

       There are a number of variables that are special in hook contexts:

       ret    The return value that  the  hooks  system  will  return  to  the
              caller.  The  default is an integer `zero'. If and how a changed
              ret value changes the execution of the  caller  depends  on  the
              specific hook. See the hook documentation below for details.

       hook_com
              An  associated  array which is used for bidirectional communica-
              tion from the caller to hook functions. The used keys depend  on
              the specific hook.

       context
              The  active  context  of the hook. Functions that wish to change
              this variable should make it local scope first.

       vcs    The current VCS after it was detected. The same values as in the
              enable/disable  style  are  used.  Available in all hooks except
              start-up.

       Finally, the full list of currently available hooks:

       start-up
              Called after starting vcs_info but before the VCS in this direc-
              tory is determined. It can be used to deactivate vcs_info tempo-
              rarily if necessary. When ret is set to 1, vcs_info  aborts  and
              does  nothing;  when set to 2, vcs_info sets up everything as if
              no version control were active and exits.

       pre-get-data
              Same as start-up but after the VCS was detected.

       gen-hg-bookmark-string
              Called in the Mercurial backend when a bookmark string is gener-
              ated; the get-revision and get-bookmarks styles must be true.

              This  hook  gets  the  names  of  the  Mercurial  bookmarks that
              vcs_info collected from `hg'.

              If a bookmark is active, the key ${hook_com[hg-active-bookmark]}
              is set to its name.  The key is otherwise unset.

              When  setting ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[hg-book-
              mark-string]} will be used in the %m escape in formats  and  ac-
              tionformats and will be available in the global backend_misc ar-
              ray as ${backend_misc[bookmarks]}.

       gen-applied-string
              Called in the git (with stgit or during rebase or merge), and hg
              (with  mq) backends and in quilt support when the applied-string
              is generated; the use-quilt zstyle must be true for  quilt  (the
              mq and stgit backends are active by default).

              The arguments to this hook describe applied patches in the oppo-
              site order, which means that the first argument is the  top-most
              patch and so forth.

              When  the  patches' log messages can be extracted, those are em-
              bedded within each argument after a space, so each  argument  is
              of  the  form  `patch-name first line of the log message', where
              patch-name contains no whitespace. The mq backend  passes  argu-
              ments  of  the form `patch name', with possible embedded spaces,
              but without extracting the patch's log message.

              When setting ret  to  non-zero,  the  string  in  ${hook_com[ap-
              plied-string]}  will  be available as %p in the patch-format and
              nopatch-format  styles.   This  hook   is,   in   concert   with
              set-patch-format,  responsible for %-escaping that value for use
              in the prompt.  (See the Oddities section.)

              The   quilt   backend   passes   to   this   hook   the   inputs
              ${hook_com[quilt-patches-dir]}  and,  if it has been determined,
              ${hook_com[quilt-pc-dir]}.

       gen-unapplied-string
              Called in the git (with stgit or during rebase),  and  hg  (with
              mq)  backend  and  in quilt support when the unapplied-string is
              generated; the get-unapplied style must be true.

              This hook gets the names of all unapplied patches which vcs_info
              in  order,  which  means  that  the  first argument is the patch
              next-in-line to be applied and so forth.

              The format of each argument is as for gen-applied-string, above.

              When setting ret to non-zero,  the  string  in  ${hook_com[unap-
              plied-string]}  will  be available as %u in the patch-format and
              nopatch-format  styles.   This  hook   is,   in   concert   with
              set-patch-format,  responsible for %-escaping that value for use
              in the prompt.  (See the Oddities section.)

              The   quilt   backend   passes   to   this   hook   the   inputs
              ${hook_com[quilt-patches-dir]}  and,  if it has been determined,
              ${hook_com[quilt-pc-dir]}.

       gen-mqguards-string
              Called in the hg backend when guards-string  is  generated;  the
              get-mq style must be true (default).

              This hook gets the names of any active mq guards.

              When    setting    ret    to    non-zero,    the    string    in
              ${hook_com[guards-string]} will be used in the %g escape in  the
              patch-format and nopatch-format styles.

       no-vcs This  hooks  is  called  when  no version control system was de-
              tected.

              The `hook_com' parameter is not used.

       post-backend
              Called as soon as the backend has finished  collecting  informa-
              tion.

              The `hook_com' keys available are as for the set-message hook.

       post-quilt
              Called  after  the quilt support is done. The following informa-
              tion is passed as arguments to the hook:  1.  the  quilt-support
              mode  (`addon'  or `standalone'); 2. the directory that contains
              the patch series; 3. the directory that holds quilt's status in-
              formation  (the  `.pc' directory) or the string "-nopc-" if that
              directory wasn't found.

              The `hook_com' parameter is not used.

       set-branch-format
              Called before `branchformat' is set. The only  argument  to  the
              hook is the format that is configured at this point.

              The  `hook_com'  keys  considered  are  `branch' and `revision'.
              They are set to the values figured out so far  by  vcs_info  and
              any  change will be used directly when the actual replacement is
              done.

              If ret is set to non-zero, the string  in  ${hook_com[branch-re-
              place]}  will  be  used unchanged as the `%b' replacement in the
              variables set by vcs_info.

       set-hgrev-format
              Called before a `hgrevformat' is set. The only argument  to  the
              hook is the format that is configured at this point.

              The  `hook_com' keys considered are `hash' and `localrev'.  They
              are set to the values figured out so far  by  vcs_info  and  any
              change  will  be  used  directly  when the actual replacement is
              done.

              If ret is set to  non-zero,  the  string  in  ${hook_com[rev-re-
              place]}  will  be  used unchanged as the `%i' replacement in the
              variables set by vcs_info.

       pre-addon-quilt
              This hook is used when vcs_info's quilt functionality is  active
              in  "addon"  mode  (quilt  used on top of a real version control
              system). It is activated right before any quilt specific  action
              is taken.

              Setting  the  `ret'  variable  in  this hook to a non-zero value
              avoids any quilt specific actions from being run at all.

       set-patch-format
              This hook is used to control some of the possible expansions  in
              patch-format  and nopatch-format styles with patch queue systems
              such as quilt, mqueue and the like.

              This hook is used in the git, hg and quilt backends.

              The hook allows the control of the %p (${hook_com[applied]}) and
              %u  (${hook_com[unapplied]})  expansion in all backends that use
              the   hook.    With    the    mercurial    backend,    the    %g
              (${hook_com[guards]})  expansion  is controllable in addition to
              that.

              If ret is set to non-zero, the  string  in  ${hook_com[patch-re-
              place]}  will  be  used  unchanged instead of an expanded format
              from patch-format or nopatch-format.

              This hook is, in concert with the gen-applied-string or  gen-un-
              applied-string  hooks if they are defined, responsible for %-es-
              caping the final patch-format value for use in the prompt.  (See
              the Oddities section.)

              The   quilt   backend   passes   to   this   hook   the   inputs
              ${hook_com[quilt-patches-dir]} and, if it has  been  determined,
              ${hook_com[quilt-pc-dir]}.

       set-message
              Called  each time before a `vcs_info_msg_N_' message is set.  It
              takes two arguments; the first being  the  `N'  in  the  message
              variable name, the second is the currently configured formats or
              actionformats.

              There are a number of `hook_com' keys, that are used here:  `ac-
              tion',  `branch',  `base', `base-name', `subdir', `staged', `un-
              staged', `revision', `misc', `vcs' and  one  `miscN'  entry  for
              each  backend-specific data field (N starting at zero). They are
              set to the values figured out so far by vcs_info and any  change
              will be used directly when the actual replacement is done.

              Since  this hook is triggered multiple times (once for each con-
              figured formats or actionformats), each of the  `hook_com'  keys
              mentioned  above  (except  for the miscN entries) has an `_orig'
              counterpart, so even if you changed a value to your  liking  you
              can  still  get the original value in the next run. Changing the
              `_orig' values is probably not a good idea.

              If ret is set to non-zero, the  string  in  ${hook_com[message]}
              will be used unchanged as the message by vcs_info.

       If  all  of  this  sounds rather confusing, take a look at the Examples
       section below and also in the Misc/vcs_info-examples file  in  the  Zsh
       source.  They contain some explanatory code.

   Examples
       Don't use vcs_info at all (even though it's in your prompt):
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable NONE

       Disable the backends for bzr and svk:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr svk

       Disable everything but bzr and svk:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable bzr svk

       Provide a special formats for git:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' formats       ' GIT, BABY! [%b]'
              zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' actionformats ' GIT ACTION! [%b|%a]'

       All  %x  expansion  in  all  sorts  of formats (formats, actionformats,
       branchformat, you name it) are done using the  `zformat'  builtin  from
       the  `zsh/zutil' module. That means you can do everything with these %x
       items what zformat supports. In particular, if you want something  that
       is  really  long  to  have  a  fixed  width, like a hash in a mercurial
       branchformat, you can do this: %12.12i. That'll shrink the 40 character
       hash  to  its  12 leading characters. The form is actually `%min.maxx'.
       More is possible.  See the section `The zsh/zutil  Module'  in  zshmod-
       ules(1) for details.

       Use the quicker bzr backend
              zstyle ':vcs_info:bzr:*' use-simple true

       If    you    do    use   use-simple,   please   report   if   it   does
       `the-right-thing[tm]'.

       Display the revision number in yellow for bzr and svn:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:(svn|bzr):*' \
                     branchformat '%b%%F{yellow}:%r'

       The doubled percent sign is explained in the Oddities section.

       Alternatively, one can use the raw colour codes directly:

              zstyle ':vcs_info:(svn|bzr):*' \
                     branchformat '%b%{'${fg[yellow]}'%}:%r'

       Normally when a variable is interpolated  into  a  format  string,  the
       variable needs to be %-escaped. In this example we skipped that because
       we assume the value of ${fg[yellow]} doesn't contain any % signs.

       Make sure you enclose the color codes in %{...%} if you want to use the
       string provided by vcs_info in prompts.

       Here  is  how  to  print  the  VCS  information  as a command (not in a
       prompt):
              vcsi() { vcs_info interactive; vcs_info_lastmsg }

       This way,  you  can  even  define  different  formats  for  output  via
       vcs_info_lastmsg in the ':vcs_info:*:interactive:*' namespace.

       Now  as promised, some code that uses hooks: say, you'd like to replace
       the string `svn' by `subversion' in vcs_info's %s formats replacement.

       First, we will tell vcs_info to call a  function  when  populating  the
       message variables with the gathered information:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion

       Nothing happens. Which is reasonable, since we didn't define the actual
       function yet. To see what the hooks subsystem is trying to  do,  enable
       the `debug' style:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug true

       That  should give you an idea what is going on. Specifically, the func-
       tion that we are looking for is `+vi-svn2subversion'. Note, the  `+vi-'
       prefix.  So,  everything  is in order, just as documented. When you are
       done checking out the debugging output, disable it again:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug false

       Now, let's define the function:
              function +vi-svn2subversion() {
                  [[ ${hook_com[vcs_orig]} == svn ]] && hook_com[vcs]=subversion
              }

       Simple enough. And it could have even been simpler, if only we had reg-
       istered our function in a less generic context. If we do it only in the
       `svn' backend's context, we don't need to test which the active backend
       is:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:svn+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion
              function +vi-svn2subversion() {
                  hook_com[vcs]=subversion
              }

       And finally a little more elaborate example, that uses a hook to create
       a customised bookmark string for the hg backend.

       Again, we start off by registering a function:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:hg+gen-hg-bookmark-string:*' hooks hgbookmarks

       And then we define the `+vi-hgbookmarks' function:
              function +vi-hgbookmarks() {
                  # The default is to connect all bookmark names by
                  # commas. This mixes things up a little.
                  # Imagine, there's one type of bookmarks that is
                  # special to you. Say, because it's *your* work.
                  # Those bookmarks look always like this: "sh/*"
                  # (because your initials are sh, for example).
                  # This makes the bookmarks string use only those
                  # bookmarks. If there's more than one, it
                  # concatenates them using commas.
                  # The bookmarks returned by `hg' are available in
                  # the function's positional parameters.
                  local s="${(Mj:,:)@:#sh/*}"
                  # Now, the communication with the code that calls
                  # the hook functions is done via the hook_com[]
                  # hash. The key at which the `gen-hg-bookmark-string'
                  # hook looks is `hg-bookmark-string'. So:
                  hook_com[hg-bookmark-string]=$s
                  # And to signal that we want to use the string we
                  # just generated, set the special variable `ret' to
                  # something other than the default zero:
                  ret=1
                  return 0
              }

       Some longer examples and code snippets which might be useful are avail-
       able  in the examples file located at Misc/vcs_info-examples in the Zsh
       source directory.

       This concludes our guided tour through zsh's vcs_info.

PROMPT THEMES
   Installation
       You should make sure all the functions from the  Functions/Prompts  di-
       rectory  of  the source distribution are available; they all begin with
       the string `prompt_' except for the special function `promptinit'.  You
       also   need  the  `colors'  and  `add-zsh-hook'  functions  from  Func-
       tions/Misc.  All these functions may already be installed on your  sys-
       tem;  if  not, you will need to find them and copy them.  The directory
       should appear as one of the elements of the fpath  array  (this  should
       already  be the case if they were installed), and at least the function
       promptinit should be autoloaded; it will autoload the  rest.   Finally,
       to  initialize  the  use  of the system you need to call the promptinit
       function.  The following code in your .zshrc will arrange for this; as-
       sume the functions are stored in the directory ~/myfns:

              fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
              autoload -U promptinit
              promptinit

   Theme Selection
       Use  the  prompt  command to select your preferred theme.  This command
       may be added to your .zshrc following the call to promptinit  in  order
       to start zsh with a theme already selected.

       prompt [ -c | -l ]
       prompt [ -p | -h ] [ theme ... ]
       prompt [ -s ] theme [ arg ... ]
              Set  or  examine  the prompt theme.  With no options and a theme
              argument, the theme with that name is set as the current  theme.
              The  available themes are determined at run time; use the -l op-
              tion to see a list.  The special theme `random' selects at  ran-
              dom one of the available themes and sets your prompt to that.

              In  some  cases  the  theme may be modified by one or more argu-
              ments, which should be given after the theme name.  See the help
              for each theme for descriptions of these arguments.

              Options are:

              -c     Show  the currently selected theme and its parameters, if
                     any.
              -l     List all available prompt themes.
              -p     Preview the theme named by theme, or  all  themes  if  no
                     theme is given.
              -h     Show help for the theme named by theme, or for the prompt
                     function if no theme is given.
              -s     Set theme as the current theme and save state.

       prompt_theme_setup
              Each available theme has a setup function which is called by the
              prompt function to install that theme.  This function may define
              other functions as necessary to maintain the  prompt,  including
              functions  used  to  preview  the prompt or provide help for its
              use.  You should not normally call a theme's setup function  di-
              rectly.

   Utility Themes
       prompt off
              The  theme `off' sets all the prompt variables to minimal values
              with no special effects.

       prompt default
              The theme `default' sets all prompt variables to the same  state
              as  if  an  interactive  zsh  was started with no initialization
              files.

       prompt restore
              The special theme `restore' erases all theme settings  and  sets
              prompt  variables  to  their  state  before  the  first time the
              `prompt' function was run, provided each theme has properly  de-
              fined its cleanup (see below).

              Note  that  you  can undo `prompt off' and `prompt default' with
              `prompt restore', but a second restore does not undo the first.

   Writing Themes
       The first step for adding your own theme is to choose a  name  for  it,
       and  create  a  file  `prompt_name_setup' in a directory in your fpath,
       such as ~/myfns in the example above.  The file should at minimum  con-
       tain  assignments  for  the  prompt variables that your theme wishes to
       modify.  By convention, themes use PS1, PS2, RPS1,  etc.,  rather  than
       the longer PROMPT and RPROMPT.

       The  file  is autoloaded as a function in the current shell context, so
       it may contain any necessary commands to customize your theme,  includ-
       ing  defining additional functions.  To make some complex tasks easier,
       your setup function may also do any of the following:

       Assign prompt_opts
              The array prompt_opts may be assigned any of "bang", "cr", "per-
              cent",  "sp",  and/or  "subst" as values.  The corresponding se-
              topts (promptbang, etc.) are turned on, all other prompt-related
              options are turned off.  The prompt_opts array preserves setopts
              even beyond the scope of localoptions, should your function need
              that.

       Modify hooks
              Use  of add-zsh-hook and add-zle-hook-widget is recommended (see
              the Manipulating Hook Functions section above).  All hooks  that
              follow  the  naming  pattern prompt_theme_hook are automatically
              removed when the prompt theme changes or is disabled.

       Declare cleanup
              If your function makes any other changes that should  be  undone
              when the theme is disabled, your setup function may call

                     prompt_cleanup command

              where  command should be suitably quoted.  If your theme is ever
              disabled or replaced by another, command is executed with  eval.
              You may declare more than one such cleanup hook.

       Define preview
              Define  or  autoload a function prompt_name_preview to display a
              simulated version of your prompt.  A simple default previewer is
              defined  by  promptinit for themes that do not define their own.
              This preview function is called by `prompt -p'.

       Provide help
              Define or autoload a function prompt_name_help to display  docu-
              mentation  or  help  text for your theme.  This help function is
              called by `prompt -h'.

ZLE FUNCTIONS
   Widgets
       These functions all implement user-defined ZLE widgets (see  zshzle(1))
       which  can  be bound to keystrokes in interactive shells.  To use them,
       your .zshrc should contain lines of the form

              autoload function
              zle -N function

       followed by an appropriate bindkey command to  associate  the  function
       with a key sequence.  Suggested bindings are described below.

       bash-style word functions
              If  you  are  looking for functions to implement moving over and
              editing words in the manner of  bash,  where  only  alphanumeric
              characters are considered word characters, you can use the func-
              tions described in the next section.  The  following  is  suffi-
              cient:

                     autoload -U select-word-style
                     select-word-style bash

       forward-word-match, backward-word-match
       kill-word-match, backward-kill-word-match
       transpose-words-match, capitalize-word-match
       up-case-word-match, down-case-word-match
       delete-whole-word-match, select-word-match
       select-word-style, match-word-context, match-words-by-style
              The  first eight `-match' functions are drop-in replacements for
              the builtin widgets without the suffix.  By default they  behave
              in  a  similar way.  However, by the use of styles and the func-
              tion select-word-style, the way words are  matched  can  be  al-
              tered. select-word-match is intended to be used as a text object
              in vi mode but with custom word styles. For comparison, the wid-
              gets described in zshzle(1) under Text Objects use fixed defini-
              tions of words, compatible with the vim editor.

              The simplest way of configuring the  functions  is  to  use  se-
              lect-word-style, which can either be called as a normal function
              with the appropriate argument, or invoked as a user-defined wid-
              get  that  will prompt for the first character of the word style
              to be used.  The first time  it  is  invoked,  the  first  eight
              -match  functions  will  automatically  replace the builtin ver-
              sions, so they do not need to be loaded explicitly.

              The word styles available are as follows.  Only the first  char-
              acter is examined.

              bash   Word characters are alphanumeric characters only.

              normal As  in  normal  shell operation:  word characters are al-
                     phanumeric characters plus any characters present in  the
                     string given by the parameter $WORDCHARS.

              shell  Words  are complete shell command arguments, possibly in-
                     cluding complete quoted strings, or any tokens special to
                     the shell.

              whitespace
                     Words are any set of characters delimited by whitespace.

              default
                     Restore the default settings; this is usually the same as
                     `normal'.

              All but `default' can be input as an upper case character, which
              has  the  same  effect  but with subword matching turned on.  In
              this case, words with upper case  characters  are  treated  spe-
              cially:  each separate run of upper case characters, or an upper
              case character followed by any number of  other  characters,  is
              considered a word.  The style subword-range can supply an alter-
              native character range to the default `[:upper:]'; the value  of
              the  style is treated as the contents of a `[...]' pattern (note
              that the outer brackets should not be supplied, only those  sur-
              rounding named ranges).

              More  control  can  be obtained using the zstyle command, as de-
              scribed in zshmodules(1).  Each style is looked up in  the  con-
              text  :zle:widget  where  widget is the name of the user-defined
              widget, not the name of the function implementing it, so in  the
              case of the definitions supplied by select-word-style the appro-
              priate contexts are :zle:forward-word, and so on.  The  function
              select-word-style  itself  always defines styles for the context
              `:zle:*' which can be overridden by more specific (longer)  pat-
              terns as well as explicit contexts.

              The  style word-style specifies the rules to use.  This may have
              the following values.

              normal Use the standard  shell  rules,  i.e.  alphanumerics  and
                     $WORDCHARS, unless overridden by the styles word-chars or
                     word-class.

              specified
                     Similar to normal, but only the specified characters, and
                     not also alphanumerics, are considered word characters.

              unspecified
                     The  negation  of  specified.   The  given characters are
                     those which will not be considered part of a word.

              shell  Words are obtained by using the syntactic rules for  gen-
                     erating  shell  command  arguments.  In addition, special
                     tokens which are never command arguments such as `()' are
                     also treated as words.

              whitespace
                     Words are whitespace-delimited strings of characters.

              The  first  three of those rules usually use $WORDCHARS, but the
              value  in  the  parameter  can  be  overridden  by   the   style
              word-chars,  which  works in exactly the same way as $WORDCHARS.
              In addition, the style word-class uses character class syntax to
              group  characters  and  takes precedence over word-chars if both
              are set.  The word-class style does not include the  surrounding
              brackets of the character class; for example, `-:[:alnum:]' is a
              valid word-class to include all alphanumerics plus  the  charac-
              ters  `-'  and  `:'.   Be  careful including `]', `^' and `-' as
              these are special inside character classes.

              word-style may also have `-subword' appended  to  its  value  to
              turn on subword matching, as described above.

              The  style  skip-chars  is mostly useful for transpose-words and
              similar functions.  If set,  it  gives  a  count  of  characters
              starting  at  the  cursor  position which will not be considered
              part of the word and are treated as space,  regardless  of  what
              they actually are.  For example, if

                     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words' skip-chars 1

              has  been set, and transpose-words-match is called with the cur-
              sor on the X of fooXbar, where X can be any character, then  the
              resulting expression is barXfoo.

              Finer  grained  control  can  be  obtained  by setting the style
              word-context to an array of pairs of entries.  Each pair of  en-
              tries  consists  of a pattern and a subcontext.  The shell argu-
              ment the cursor is on is matched against each  pattern  in  turn
              until  one  matches;  if  it  does, the context is extended by a
              colon and the corresponding subcontext.  Note that the  test  is
              made against the original word on the line, with no stripping of
              quotes.  Special handling is done  between  words:  the  current
              context  is  examined  and if it contains the string between the
              word is set to a single space; else if it is contains the string
              back,  the  word  before the cursor is considered, else the word
              after cursor is considered. Some examples are given below.

              The style skip-whitespace-first  is  only  used  with  the  for-
              ward-word widget.  If it is set to true, then forward-word skips
              any non-word-characters, followed  by  any  non-word-characters:
              this  is  similar to the behaviour of other word-orientated wid-
              gets, and also that used by other editors,  however  it  differs
              from  the  standard zsh behaviour.  When using select-word-style
              the widget is set in the context :zle:*  to  true  if  the  word
              style is bash and false otherwise.  It may be overridden by set-
              ting it in the more specific context :zle:forward-word*.

              It is possible to create  widgets  with  specific  behaviour  by
              defining  a  new  widget  implemented by the appropriate generic
              function, then setting a style for the context of  the  specific
              widget.   For  example,  the  following  defines  a widget back-
              ward-kill-space-word using backward-kill-word-match, the generic
              widget  implementing  backward-kill-word  behaviour, and ensures
              that the new widget always implements space-delimited behaviour.

                     zle -N backward-kill-space-word backward-kill-word-match
                     zstyle :zle:backward-kill-space-word word-style space

              The widget backward-kill-space-word can now be bound to a key.

              Here are some further examples of use of  the  styles,  actually
              taken from the simplified interface in select-word-style:

                     zstyle ':zle:*' word-style standard
                     zstyle ':zle:*' word-chars ''

              Implements  bash-style  word handling for all widgets, i.e. only
              alphanumerics are word characters; equivalent to setting the pa-
              rameter WORDCHARS empty for the given context.

                     style ':zle:*kill*' word-style space

              Uses  space-delimited  words for widgets with the word `kill' in
              the name.  Neither of the styles word-chars  nor  word-class  is
              used in this case.

              Here  are  some examples of use of the word-context style to ex-
              tend the context.

                     zstyle ':zle:*' word-context \
                            "*/*" filename "[[:space:]]" whitespace
                     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:whitespace' word-style shell
                     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-style normal
                     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-chars ''

              This provides two different ways of  using  transpose-words  de-
              pending  on whether the cursor is on whitespace between words or
              on a filename, here any word containing  a  /.   On  whitespace,
              complete  arguments  as  defined by standard shell rules will be
              transposed.  In a filename, only alphanumerics  will  be  trans-
              posed.   Elsewhere,  words  will be transposed using the default
              style for :zle:transpose-words.

              The word matching and all the handling of zstyle settings is ac-
              tually  implemented  by the function match-words-by-style.  This
              can be used to create new  user-defined  widgets.   The  calling
              function  should set the local parameter curcontext to :zle:wid-
              get,  create  the  local  parameter   matched_words   and   call
              match-words-by-style    with    no    arguments.    On   return,
              matched_words will be set to an array with the elements: (1) the
              start  of  the  line  (2)  the  word  before  the cursor (3) any
              non-word characters between that word and  the  cursor  (4)  any
              non-word  character  at  the  cursor position plus any remaining
              non-word characters before the next word, including all  charac-
              ters  specified by the skip-chars style, (5) the word at or fol-
              lowing the cursor (6) any  non-word  characters  following  that
              word  (7) the remainder of the line.  Any of the elements may be
              an empty string; the calling function should test  for  this  to
              decide whether it can perform its function.

              If  the  variable  matched_words  is  defined  by  the caller to
              match-words-by-style  as  an   associative   array   (local   -A
              matched_words),  then the seven values given above should be re-
              trieved from it as  elements  named  start,  word-before-cursor,
              ws-before-cursor,   ws-after-cursor,  word-after-cursor,  ws-af-
              ter-word, and end.  In addition the element is-word-start  is  1
              if  the cursor is on the start of a word or subword, or on white
              space before it (the cases can be distinguished by  testing  the
              ws-after-cursor  element)  and 0 otherwise.  This form is recom-
              mended for future compatibility.

              It   is   possible   to   pass   options   with   arguments   to
              match-words-by-style to override the use of styles.  The options
              are:
              -w     word-style
              -s     skip-chars
              -c     word-class
              -C     word-chars
              -r     subword-range

              For example, match-words-by-style -w shell -c 0 may be  used  to
              extract the command argument around the cursor.

              The   word-context   style   is   implemented  by  the  function
              match-word-context.  This should not usually need to  be  called
              directly.

       bracketed-paste-magic
              The  bracketed-paste  widget (see the subsection `Miscellaneous'
              in zshzle(1)) inserts pasted text literally into the editor buf-
              fer  rather than interpret it as keystrokes.  This disables some
              common usages where the self-insert widget is replaced in  order
              to accomplish some extra processing.  An example is the contrib-
              uted url-quote-magic widget described below.

              The bracketed-paste-magic widget  is  meant  to  replace  brack-
              eted-paste  with a wrapper that re-enables these self-insert ac-
              tions, and other actions as selected by zstyles.  Therefore this
              widget is installed with

                     autoload -Uz bracketed-paste-magic
                     zle -N bracketed-paste bracketed-paste-magic

              Other    than    enabling   some   widget   processing,   brack-
              eted-paste-magic attempts to replicate bracketed-paste as faith-
              fully as possible.

              The following zstyles may be set to control processing of pasted
              text.    All   are   looked   up   in   the   context   `:brack-
              eted-paste-magic'.

              active-widgets
                     A  list  of patterns matching widget names that should be
                     activated during the paste.  All other key sequences  are
                     processed as self-insert-unmeta.  The default is `self-*'
                     so any user-defined widgets named with  that  prefix  are
                     active along with the builtin self-insert.

                     If  this  style is not set (explicitly deleted) or set to
                     an empty value, no widgets are active and the pasted text
                     is  inserted  literally.   If  the  value includes `unde-
                     fined-key', any unknown sequences are discarded from  the
                     pasted text.

              inactive-keys
                     The  inverse  of  active-widgets, a list of key sequences
                     that always use self-insert-unmeta even when bound to  an
                     active  widget.   Note that this is a list of literal key
                     sequences, not patterns.

              paste-init
                     A list of function names, called in widget  context  (but
                     not as widgets).  The functions are called in order until
                     one of them returns a  non-zero  status.   The  parameter
                     `PASTED'  contains  the initial state of the pasted text.
                     All other ZLE parameters such as `BUFFER' have their nor-
                     mal  values  and side-effects, and full history is avail-
                     able, so for example paste-init functions may move  words
                     from  BUFFER  into  PASTED to make those words visible to
                     the active-widgets.

                     A non-zero return from a  paste-init  function  does  not
                     prevent the paste itself from proceeding.

                     Loading    bracketed-paste-magic   defines   backward-ex-
                     tend-paste, a helper function for use in paste-init.

                            zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic paste-init \
                                   backward-extend-paste

                     When a paste would insert into the middle of  a  word  or
                     append  text  to a word already on the line, backward-ex-
                     tend-paste moves the prefix from LBUFFER into  PASTED  so
                     that  the  active-widgets see the full word so far.  This
                     may be useful with url-quote-magic.

              paste-finish
                     Another list of function names called in order until  one
                     returns  non-zero.   These functions are called after the
                     pasted text has been processed by the active-widgets, but
                     before it is inserted into `BUFFER'.  ZLE parameters have
                     their normal values and side-effects.

                     A non-zero return from a paste-finish function  does  not
                     prevent the paste itself from proceeding.

                     Loading bracketed-paste-magic also defines quote-paste, a
                     helper function for use in paste-finish.

                            zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic paste-finish \
                                   quote-paste
                            zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic:finish quote-style \
                                   qqq

                     When the pasted text  is  inserted  into  BUFFER,  it  is
                     quoted  per  the quote-style value.  To forcibly turn off
                     the built-in numeric prefix quoting  of  bracketed-paste,
                     use:

                            zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic:finish quote-style \
                                   none

              Important:  During active-widgets processing of the paste (after
              paste-init and before paste-finish),  BUFFER  starts  empty  and
              history  is  restricted,  so  cursor motions, etc., may not pass
              outside of the pasted content.  Text assigned to BUFFER  by  the
              active widgets is copied back into PASTED before paste-finish.

       copy-earlier-word
              This  widget  works  like  a combination of insert-last-word and
              copy-prev-shell-word.  Repeated invocations of  the  widget  re-
              trieve  earlier  words on the relevant history line.  With a nu-
              meric argument N, insert the Nth word from the history  line;  N
              may be negative to count from the end of the line.

              If insert-last-word has been used to retrieve the last word on a
              previous history line, repeated invocations  will  replace  that
              word with earlier words from the same line.

              Otherwise, the widget applies to words on the line currently be-
              ing edited.  The widget style can be set to the name of  another
              widget  that  should  be  called to retrieve words.  This widget
              must accept the same three arguments as insert-last-word.

       cycle-completion-positions
              After inserting an unambiguous string into the command line, the
              new  function  based  completion  system may know about multiple
              places in this string where characters  are  missing  or  differ
              from  at  least one of the possible matches.  It will then place
              the cursor on the position it considers to be the most interest-
              ing one, i.e. the one where one can disambiguate between as many
              matches as possible with as little typing as possible.

              This widget allows the cursor to be easily moved  to  the  other
              interesting  spots.   It  can be invoked repeatedly to cycle be-
              tween all positions reported by the completion system.

       delete-whole-word-match
              This is another function which works like the  -match  functions
              described  immediately  above,  i.e.  using styles to decide the
              word boundaries.  However, it is not a replacement for  any  ex-
              isting function.

              The  basic  behaviour  is  to delete the word around the cursor.
              There is no numeric argument  handling;  only  the  single  word
              around  the  cursor  is  considered.  If the widget contains the
              string kill, the removed text will be placed  in  the  cutbuffer
              for   future   yanking.    This  can  be  obtained  by  defining
              kill-whole-word-match as follows:

                     zle -N kill-whole-word-match delete-whole-word-match

              and then binding the widget kill-whole-word-match.

       up-line-or-beginning-search, down-line-or-beginning-search
              These   widgets   are   similar   to   the   builtin   functions
              up-line-or-search  and  down-line-or-search:   if in a multiline
              buffer they move up or down within the  buffer,  otherwise  they
              search  for  a  history  line  matching the start of the current
              line.  In this case, however,  they  search  for  a  line  which
              matches  the  current line up to the current cursor position, in
              the manner of  history-beginning-search-backward  and  -forward,
              rather than the first word on the line.

       edit-command-line
              Edit the command line using your visual editor, as in ksh.

                     bindkey -M vicmd v edit-command-line

              The  editor  to  be  used can also be specified using the editor
              style in the context of the widget. It is specified as an  array
              of command and arguments:

                     zstyle :zle:edit-command-line editor gvim -f

       expand-absolute-path
              Expand  the  file name under the cursor to an absolute path, re-
              solving symbolic links.  Where possible, the initial  path  seg-
              ment  is  turned into a named directory or reference to a user's
              home directory.

       history-search-end
              This   function   implements    the    widgets    history-begin-
              ning-search-backward-end    and    history-beginning-search-for-
              ward-end.  These commands work by first calling the  correspond-
              ing builtin widget (see `History Control' in zshzle(1)) and then
              moving the cursor to the end of the line.  The  original  cursor
              position  is  remembered and restored before calling the builtin
              widget a second time, so that the same  search  is  repeated  to
              look farther through the history.

              Although  you autoload only one function, the commands to use it
              are slightly different because it implements two widgets.

                     zle -N history-beginning-search-backward-end \
                            history-search-end
                     zle -N history-beginning-search-forward-end \
                            history-search-end
                     bindkey '\e^P' history-beginning-search-backward-end
                     bindkey '\e^N' history-beginning-search-forward-end

       history-beginning-search-menu
              This function implements yet another form of history  searching.
              The text before the cursor is used to select lines from the his-
              tory, as for history-beginning-search-backward except  that  all
              matches  are  shown  in a numbered menu.  Typing the appropriate
              digits inserts the full history line.  Note that leading  zeroes
              must  be  typed (they are only shown when necessary for removing
              ambiguity).  The entire history is searched; there  is  no  dis-
              tinction between forwards and backwards.

              With a numeric argument, the search is not anchored to the start
              of the line; the string typed by the use may appear anywhere  in
              the line in the history.

              If  the  widget  name contains `-end' the cursor is moved to the
              end of the line inserted.  If the widget name contains  `-space'
              any  space  in  the  text typed is treated as a wildcard and can
              match anything (hence a leading space is equivalent to giving  a
              numeric argument).  Both forms can be combined, for example:

                     zle -N history-beginning-search-menu-space-end \
                            history-beginning-search-menu

       history-pattern-search
              The  function  history-pattern-search  implements  widgets which
              prompt for a pattern with which to search the history  backwards
              or  forwards.   The  pattern is in the usual zsh format, however
              the first character may be ^ to anchor the search to  the  start
              of  the  line,  and  the  last  character may be $ to anchor the
              search to the end of the line.  If the search was  not  anchored
              to  the  end of the line the cursor is positioned just after the
              pattern found.

              The commands to create bindable widgets are similar to those  in
              the example immediately above:

                     autoload -U history-pattern-search
                     zle -N history-pattern-search-backward history-pattern-search
                     zle -N history-pattern-search-forward history-pattern-search

       incarg Typing  the keystrokes for this widget with the cursor placed on
              or to the left of an integer causes that integer  to  be  incre-
              mented  by  one.   With a numeric argument, the number is incre-
              mented by the amount of the argument (decremented if the numeric
              argument is negative).  The shell parameter incarg may be set to
              change the default increment to something other than one.

                     bindkey '^X+' incarg

       incremental-complete-word
              This allows incremental completion of a  word.   After  starting
              this  command,  a  list of completion choices can be shown after
              every character you type, which you can delete with ^H  or  DEL.
              Pressing return accepts the completion so far and returns you to
              normal editing (that is, the command line is not immediately ex-
              ecuted).   You  can hit TAB to do normal completion, ^G to abort
              back to the state when you started, and ^D to list the matches.

              This works only with the new function based completion system.

                     bindkey '^Xi' incremental-complete-word

       insert-composed-char
              This function allows you to compose characters that don't appear
              on  the keyboard to be inserted into the command line.  The com-
              mand is followed by two keys corresponding to  ASCII  characters
              (there is no prompt).  For accented characters, the two keys are
              a base character followed by a code for the  accent,  while  for
              other special characters the two characters together form a mne-
              monic for the character to be inserted.  The two-character codes
              are  a  subset  of  those  given  by  RFC  1345 (see for example
              http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc1345.html).

              The function may optionally be followed by up to two  characters
              which  replace  one or both of the characters read from the key-
              board; if both characters are supplied, no input is  read.   For
              example,  insert-composed-char a: can be used within a widget to
              insert an a with umlaut into the command line.  This has the ad-
              vantages  over use of a literal character that it is more porta-
              ble.

              For best results zsh should have been  built  with  support  for
              multibyte  characters (configured with --enable-multibyte); how-
              ever, the function works for the  limited  range  of  characters
              available in single-byte character sets such as ISO-8859-1.

              The character is converted into the local representation and in-
              serted into the command line at the cursor position.  (The  con-
              version  is done within the shell, using whatever facilities the
              C library provides.)  With a numeric argument, the character and
              its code are previewed in the status line

              The  function may be run outside zle in which case it prints the
              character (together with a newline) to standard  output.   Input
              is still read from keystrokes.

              See insert-unicode-char for an alternative way of inserting Uni-
              code characters using their hexadecimal character number.

              The set of accented characters is reasonably complete up to Uni-
              code  character  U+0180,  the set of special characters less so.
              However, it is very sporadic from that point.  Adding new  char-
              acters is easy, however; see the function define-composed-chars.
              Please send any additions to zsh-workers@zsh.org.

              The codes for the second character when used to accent the first
              are  as  follows.   Note that not every character can take every
              accent.
              !      Grave.
              '      Acute.
              >      Circumflex.
              ?      Tilde.  (This is not ~ as RFC 1345 does not  assume  that
                     character is present on the keyboard.)
              -      Macron.  (A horizontal bar over the base character.)
              (      Breve.  (A shallow dish shape over the base character.)
              .      Dot above the base character, or in the case of i no dot,
                     or in the case of L and l a centered dot.
              :      Diaeresis (Umlaut).
              c      Cedilla.
              _      Underline, however  there  are  currently  no  underlined
                     characters.
              /      Stroke through the base character.
              "      Double acute (only supported on a few letters).
              ;      Ogonek.   (A  little  forward  facing  hook at the bottom
                     right of the character.)
              <      Caron.  (A little v over the letter.)
              0      Circle over the base character.
              2      Hook over the base character.
              9      Horn over the base character.

              The most common characters from the Arabic, Cyrillic, Greek  and
              Hebrew  alphabets are available; consult RFC 1345 for the appro-
              priate sequences.  In addition, a set of two letter codes not in
              RFC  1345  are  available for the double-width characters corre-
              sponding to ASCII characters from !  to ~ (0x21 to 0x7e) by pre-
              ceding  the  character with ^, for example ^A for a double-width
              A.

              The following other two-character sequences are understood.

              ASCII characters
                     These are already present on most keyboards:
              <(     Left square bracket
              //     Backslash (solidus)
              )>     Right square bracket
              (!     Left brace (curly bracket)
              !!     Vertical bar (pipe symbol)
              !)     Right brace (curly bracket)
              '?     Tilde

              Special letters
                     Characters found in various variants of the Latin  alpha-
                     bet:
              ss     Eszett (scharfes S)
              D-, d- Eth
              TH, th Thorn
              kk     Kra
              'n     'n
              NG, ng Ng
              OI, oi Oi
              yr     yr
              ED     ezh

              Currency symbols
              Ct     Cent
              Pd     Pound sterling (also lira and others)
              Cu     Currency
              Ye     Yen
              Eu     Euro (N.B. not in RFC 1345)

              Punctuation characters
                     References to "right" quotes indicate the shape (like a 9
                     rather than 6) rather than their grammatical  use.   (For
                     example,  a "right" low double quote is used to open quo-
                     tations in German.)
              !I     Inverted exclamation mark
              BB     Broken vertical bar
              SE     Section
              Co     Copyright
              -a     Spanish feminine ordinal indicator
              <<     Left guillemet
              --     Soft hyphen
              Rg     Registered trade mark
              PI     Pilcrow (paragraph)
              -o     Spanish masculine ordinal indicator
              >>     Right guillemet
              ?I     Inverted question mark
              -1     Hyphen
              -N     En dash
              -M     Em dash
              -3     Horizontal bar
              :3     Vertical ellipsis
              .3     Horizontal midline ellipsis
              !2     Double vertical line
              =2     Double low line
              '6     Left single quote
              '9     Right single quote
              .9     "Right" low quote
              9'     Reversed "right" quote
              "6     Left double quote
              "9     Right double quote
              :9     "Right" low double quote
              9"     Reversed "right" double quote
              /-     Dagger
              /=     Double dagger

              Mathematical symbols
              DG     Degree
              -2, +-, -+
                     - sign, +/- sign, -/+ sign
              2S     Superscript 2
              3S     Superscript 3
              1S     Superscript 1
              My     Micro
              .M     Middle dot
              14     Quarter
              12     Half
              34     Three quarters
              *X     Multiplication
              -:     Division
              %0     Per mille
              FA, TE, /0
                     For all, there exists, empty set
              dP, DE, NB
                     Partial derivative, delta (increment), del (nabla)
              (-, -) Element of, contains
              *P, +Z Product, sum
              *-, Ob, Sb
                     Asterisk, ring, bullet
              RT, 0(, 00
                     Root sign, proportional to, infinity

              Other symbols
              cS, cH, cD, cC
                     Card suits: spades, hearts, diamonds, clubs
              Md, M8, M2, Mb, Mx, MX
                     Musical notation: crotchet (quarter note), quaver (eighth
                     note),  semiquavers (sixteenth notes), flag sign, natural
                     sign, sharp sign
              Fm, Ml Female, male

              Accents on their own
              '>     Circumflex (same as caret, ^)
              '!     Grave (same as backtick, `)
              ',     Cedilla
              ':     Diaeresis (Umlaut)
              'm     Macron
              ''     Acute

       insert-files
              This function allows you type a file pattern, and  see  the  re-
              sults  of  the expansion at each step.  When you hit return, all
              expansions are inserted into the command line.

                     bindkey '^Xf' insert-files

       insert-unicode-char
              When first executed, the user inputs a set of  hexadecimal  dig-
              its.   This  is  terminated  with  another  call  to insert-uni-
              code-char.  The digits are then turned  into  the  corresponding
              Unicode  character.  For example, if the widget is bound to ^XU,
              the character sequence `^XU 4 c ^XU' inserts L (Unicode U+004c).

              See insert-composed-char for a way of inserting characters using
              a two-character mnemonic.

       narrow-to-region [ -p pre ] [ -P post ]
                        [  -S statepm | -R statepm | [ -l lbufvar ] [ -r rbuf-
       var ] ]
                        [ -n ] [ start end ]
       narrow-to-region-invisible
              Narrow the editable portion of the buffer to the region  between
              the  cursor and the mark, which may be in either order.  The re-
              gion may not be empty.

              narrow-to-region may be used as a widget or called as a function
              from a user-defined widget; by default, the text outside the ed-
              itable area remains visible.  A recursive-edit is performed  and
              the  original widening status is then restored.  Various options
              and arguments are available when it is called as a function.

              The options -p pretext and -P posttext may be  used  to  replace
              the  text  before  and after the display for the duration of the
              function; either or both may be an empty string.

              If the option -n is also given, pretext or posttext will only be
              inserted  if  there  is  text before or after the region respec-
              tively which will be made invisible.

              Two numeric arguments may be given which will be used instead of
              the cursor and mark positions.

              The  option  -S statepm is used to narrow according to the other
              options while saving the original state in  the  parameter  with
              name statepm, while the option -R statepm is used to restore the
              state from the parameter; note in both cases the name of the pa-
              rameter  is required.  In the second case, other options and ar-
              guments are irrelevant.  When this method  is  used,  no  recur-
              sive-edit  is  performed;  the  calling  widget should call this
              function with the option -S, perform its own editing on the com-
              mand  line or pass control to the user via `zle recursive-edit',
              then call this  function  with  the  option  -R.   The  argument
              statepm  must  be a suitable name for an ordinary parameter, ex-
              cept that parameters beginning with the  prefix  _ntr_  are  re-
              served for use within narrow-to-region.  Typically the parameter
              will be local to the calling function.

              The options -l lbufvar and -r rbufvar may be used to specify pa-
              rameters where the widget will store the resulting text from the
              operation.  The parameter lbufvar will contain LBUFFER and rbuf-
              var  will  contain RBUFFER.  Neither of these two options may be
              used with -S or -R.

              narrow-to-region-invisible is a simple widget which  calls  nar-
              row-to-region  with arguments which replace any text outside the
              region with `...'.  It does not take any arguments.

              The display is restored (and the widget returns)  upon  any  zle
              command  which  would  usually  cause the line to be accepted or
              aborted.  Hence an additional such command is required to accept
              or abort the current line.

              The  return  status  of both widgets is zero if the line was ac-
              cepted, else non-zero.

              Here is a trivial example of a widget using this feature.
                     local state
                     narrow-to-region -p $'Editing restricted region\n' \
                       -P '' -S state
                     zle recursive-edit
                     narrow-to-region -R state

       predict-on
              This set of functions implements predictive typing using history
              search.   After  predict-on, typing characters causes the editor
              to look backward in the history for  the  first  line  beginning
              with what you have typed so far.  After predict-off, editing re-
              turns to normal for the line found.  In fact,  you  often  don't
              even  need to use predict-off, because if the line doesn't match
              something in the history, adding a key performs standard comple-
              tion,  and  then  inserts  itself  if no completions were found.
              However, editing in the middle of a line is  liable  to  confuse
              prediction; see the toggle style below.

              With  the  function based completion system (which is needed for
              this), you should be able to type TAB at almost any point to ad-
              vance  the cursor to the next ``interesting'' character position
              (usually the end of the current word, but sometimes somewhere in
              the  middle  of  the word).  And of course as soon as the entire
              line is what you want, you can accept with return, without need-
              ing to move the cursor to the end first.

              The first time predict-on is used, it creates several additional
              widget functions:

              delete-backward-and-predict
                     Replaces the backward-delete-char  widget.   You  do  not
                     need to bind this yourself.
              insert-and-predict
                     Implements predictive typing by replacing the self-insert
                     widget.  You do not need to bind this yourself.
              predict-off
                     Turns off predictive typing.

              Although you autoload only the predict-on function, it is neces-
              sary to create a keybinding for predict-off as well.

                     zle -N predict-on
                     zle -N predict-off
                     bindkey '^X^Z' predict-on
                     bindkey '^Z' predict-off

       read-from-minibuffer
              This is most useful when called as a function from inside a wid-
              get, but will work correctly as a widget in its own  right.   It
              prompts  for a value below the current command line; a value may
              be input using all of  the  standard  zle  operations  (and  not
              merely the restricted set available when executing, for example,
              execute-named-cmd).  The value is then returned to  the  calling
              function in the parameter $REPLY and the editing buffer restored
              to its previous state.  If the read was aborted  by  a  keyboard
              break  (typically  ^G), the function returns status 1 and $REPLY
              is not set.

              If one argument is supplied to the function it  is  taken  as  a
              prompt,  otherwise `? ' is used.  If two arguments are supplied,
              they are the prompt and the initial value of $LBUFFER, and if  a
              third  argument  is  given  it is the initial value of $RBUFFER.
              This provides a default value  and  starting  cursor  placement.
              Upon return the entire buffer is the value of $REPLY.

              One  option is available: `-k num' specifies that num characters
              are to be read instead of a whole line.  The line editor is  not
              invoked  recursively  in this case, so depending on the terminal
              settings the input may not be visible, and only the  input  keys
              are  placed  in $REPLY, not the entire buffer.  Note that unlike
              the read builtin num must be given; there is no default.

              The name is a slight  misnomer,  as  in  fact  the  shell's  own
              minibuffer is not used.  Hence it is still possible to call exe-
              cuted-named-cmd and similar functions while reading a value.

       replace-argument, replace-argument-edit
              The function replace-argument can be used to replace  a  command
              line  argument  in  the  current command line or, if the current
              command line is empty, in the last command  line  executed  (the
              new  command  line is not executed).  Arguments are as delimited
              by standard shell syntax,

              If a numeric argument is given, that specifies the  argument  to
              be replaced.  0 means the command name, as in history expansion.
              A negative numeric argument counts backward from the last word.

              If no numeric argument is given, the  current  argument  is  re-
              placed;  this  is the last argument if the previous history line
              is being used.

              The function prompts for a replacement argument.

              If the widget contains the string edit, for example  is  defined
              as

                     zle -N replace-argument-edit replace-argument

              then the function presents the current value of the argument for
              editing, otherwise the editing buffer  for  the  replacement  is
              initially empty.

       replace-string, replace-pattern
       replace-string-again, replace-pattern-again
              The  function  replace-string  implements three widgets.  If de-
              fined under the same name as the function, it  prompts  for  two
              strings;  the first (source) string will be replaced by the sec-
              ond everywhere it occurs in the line editing buffer.

              If the widget name contains the word `pattern', for  example  by
              defining  the  widget  using the command `zle -N replace-pattern
              replace-string', then the matching is performed using  zsh  pat-
              terns.   All  zsh  extended globbing patterns can be used in the
              source string; note that unlike filename generation the  pattern
              does  not  need  to match an entire word, nor do glob qualifiers
              have any effect.  In addition, the replacement string  can  con-
              tain  parameter or command substitutions.  Furthermore, a `&' in
              the replacement string will be replaced with the matched  source
              string,  and a backquoted digit `\N' will be replaced by the Nth
              parenthesised expression matched.  The form `\{N}' may  be  used
              to protect the digit from following digits.

              If  the  widget instead contains the word `regex' (or `regexp'),
              then the matching is performed using  regular  expressions,  re-
              specting  the  setting  of the option RE_MATCH_PCRE (see the de-
              scription of the function regexp-replace  below).   The  special
              replacement  facilities described above for pattern matching are
              available.

              By default the previous source or replacement string will not be
              offered  for editing.  However, this feature can be activated by
              setting the style edit-previous in the context :zle:widget  (for
              example,  :zle:replace-string) to true.  In addition, a positive
              numeric argument forces the previous values  to  be  offered,  a
              negative or zero argument forces them not to be.

              The function replace-string-again can be used to repeat the pre-
              vious  replacement;  no  prompting  is  done.    As   with   re-
              place-string,  if the name of the widget contains the word `pat-
              tern' or `regex', pattern or regular expression matching is per-
              formed, else a literal string replacement.  Note that the previ-
              ous source and replacement text are the  same  whether  pattern,
              regular expression or string matching is used.

              In addition, replace-string shows the previous replacement above
              the prompt, so long as there was one during the current session;
              if the source string is empty, that replacement will be repeated
              without the widget prompting for a replacement string.

              For example, starting from the line:

                     print This line contains fan and fond

              and invoking replace-pattern with the source string `f(?)n'  and
              the replacement string `c\1r' produces the not very useful line:

                     print This line contains car and cord

              The  range of the replacement string can be limited by using the
              narrow-to-region-invisible widget.  One limitation of  the  cur-
              rent  version is that undo will cycle through changes to the re-
              placement and source strings before undoing the replacement  it-
              self.

       send-invisible
              This is similar to read-from-minibuffer in that it may be called
              as a function from a widget or as a widget of its own,  and  in-
              teractively  reads  input from the keyboard.  However, the input
              being typed is concealed and a  string  of  asterisks  (`*')  is
              shown  instead.   The value is saved in the parameter $INVISIBLE
              to which a reference is inserted into the editing buffer at  the
              restored cursor position.  If the read was aborted by a keyboard
              break (typically ^G) or another  escape  from  editing  such  as
              push-line, $INVISIBLE is set to empty and the original buffer is
              restored unchanged.

              If one argument is supplied to the function it  is  taken  as  a
              prompt, otherwise `Non-echoed text: ' is used (as in emacs).  If
              a second and third argument are supplied they are used to  begin
              and  end  the  reference to $INVISIBLE that is inserted into the
              buffer.  The default is to open with  ${,  then  INVISIBLE,  and
              close with }, but many other effects are possible.

       smart-insert-last-word
              This function may replace the insert-last-word widget, like so:

                     zle -N insert-last-word smart-insert-last-word

              With  a  numeric argument, or when passed command line arguments
              in a call from another widget, it behaves like insert-last-word,
              except  that words in comments are ignored when INTERACTIVE_COM-
              MENTS is set.

              Otherwise, the rightmost ``interesting'' word from the  previous
              command  is found and inserted.  The default definition of ``in-
              teresting'' is that the word contains at  least  one  alphabetic
              character, slash, or backslash.  This definition may be overrid-
              den by use of the match style.  The context used to look up  the
              style  is  the  widget  name,  so  usually  the  context is :in-
              sert-last-word.  However, you can bind this function to  differ-
              ent widgets to use different patterns:

                     zle -N insert-last-assignment smart-insert-last-word
                     zstyle :insert-last-assignment match '[[:alpha:]][][[:alnum:]]#=*'
                     bindkey '\e=' insert-last-assignment

              If  no  interesting word is found and the auto-previous style is
              set to a true value, the search  continues  upward  through  the
              history.   When  auto-previous  is unset or false (the default),
              the widget must be invoked repeatedly in order to search earlier
              history lines.

       transpose-lines
              Only useful with a multi-line editing buffer; the lines here are
              lines within the current on-screen buffer,  not  history  lines.
              The effect is similar to the function of the same name in Emacs.

              Transpose  the  current line with the previous line and move the
              cursor to the start of the next line.  Repeating this (which can
              be done by providing a positive numeric argument) has the effect
              of moving the line above the cursor down by a number of lines.

              With a negative numeric argument, requires two lines  above  the
              cursor.   These two lines are transposed and the cursor moved to
              the start of the previous line.  Using a numeric  argument  less
              than -1 has the effect of moving the line above the cursor up by
              minus that number of lines.

       url-quote-magic
              This widget replaces the built-in self-insert to make it  easier
              to  type URLs as command line arguments.  As you type, the input
              character is analyzed and, if it may need quoting,  the  current
              word  is checked for a URI scheme.  If one is found and the cur-
              rent word is not already in quotes, a backslash is inserted  be-
              fore the input character.

              Styles to control quoting behavior:

              url-metas
                     This    style    is    looked    up    in   the   context
                     `:url-quote-magic:scheme' (where scheme is  that  of  the
                     current  URL, e.g. "ftp").  The value is a string listing
                     the characters to be treated as  globbing  metacharacters
                     when  appearing  in a URL using that scheme.  The default
                     is to quote all zsh extended globbing characters, exclud-
                     ing  '<' and '>' but including braces (as in brace expan-
                     sion).  See also url-seps.

              url-seps
                     Like url-metas, but lists characters that should be  con-
                     sidered  command separators, redirections, history refer-
                     ences, etc.  The default is to quote the standard set  of
                     shell  separators,  excluding those that overlap with the
                     extended globbing characters, but including '<'  and  '>'
                     and the first character of $histchars.

              url-globbers
                     This    style    is    looked    up    in   the   context
                     `:url-quote-magic'.  The values form a  list  of  command
                     names  that  are expected to do their own globbing on the
                     URL string.  This implies that they are  aliased  to  use
                     the  `noglob'  modifier.  When the first word on the line
                     matches one of the values and the URL refers to  a  local
                     file (see url-local-schema), only the url-seps characters
                     are quoted; the url-metas are left alone,  allowing  them
                     to affect command-line parsing, completion, etc.  The de-
                     fault values  are  a  literal  `noglob'  plus  (when  the
                     zsh/parameter  module  is available) any commands aliased
                     to  the  helper  function  `urlglobber'  or   its   alias
                     `globurl'.

              url-local-schema
                     This  style is always looked up in the context `:urlglob-
                     ber', even though it is used by both url-quote-magic  and
                     urlglobber.   The  values  form a list of URI schema that
                     should be treated as referring to local  files  by  their
                     real  local  path  names,  as  opposed to files which are
                     specified relative to a web-server-defined document root.
                     The defaults are "ftp" and "file".

              url-other-schema
                     Like  url-local-schema,  but  lists  all other URI schema
                     upon which urlglobber and url-quote-magic should act.  If
                     the  URI  on  the command line does not have a scheme ap-
                     pearing either in this list or in url-local-schema, it is
                     not  magically  quoted.   The  default values are "http",
                     "https", and "ftp".  When a scheme appears both here  and
                     in  url-local-schema,  it is quoted differently depending
                     on whether the command name appears in url-globbers.

              Loading url-quote-magic also defines a helper function `urlglob-
              ber'  and  aliases `globurl' to `noglob urlglobber'.  This func-
              tion takes a local URL apart, attempts to pattern-match the  lo-
              cal file portion of the URL path, and then puts the results back
              into URL format again.

       vi-pipe
              This function reads a movement command  from  the  keyboard  and
              then  prompts  for  an  external command. The part of the buffer
              covered by the movement is piped to  the  external  command  and
              then  replaced  by the command's output. If the movement command
              is bound to vi-pipe, the current line is used.

              The function serves as an example for reading a vi movement com-
              mand from within a user-defined widget.

       which-command
              This  function  is  a drop-in replacement for the builtin widget
              which-command.  It has enhanced behaviour, in that it  correctly
              detects  whether or not the command word needs to be expanded as
              an alias; if so, it continues tracing the command word from  the
              expanded  alias  until  it reaches the command that will be exe-
              cuted.

              The style whence is available in the context :zle:$WIDGET;  this
              may be set to an array to give the command and options that will
              be used to investigate the command word found.  The  default  is
              whence -c.

       zcalc-auto-insert
              This  function  is  useful  together with the zcalc function de-
              scribed in the section `Mathematical Functions'.  It  should  be
              bound  to a key representing a binary operator such as `+', `-',
              `*' or `/'.  When running in zcalc, if the  key  occurs  at  the
              start  of the line or immediately following an open parenthesis,
              the text "ans " is inserted before the representation of the key
              itself.   This  allows  easy use of the answer from the previous
              calculation in the current line.  The text to be inserted before
              the  symbol  typed  can  be  modified  by  setting  the variable
              ZCALC_AUTO_INSERT_PREFIX.

              Hence, for example, typing `+12' followed by return adds  12  to
              the previous result.

              If  zcalc  is in RPN mode (-r option) the effect of this binding
              is automatically suppressed as operators alone  on  a  line  are
              meaningful.

              When not in zcalc, the key simply inserts the symbol itself.

   Utility Functions
       These  functions  are  useful  in constructing widgets.  They should be
       loaded with  `autoload  -U  function'  and  called  as  indicated  from
       user-defined widgets.

       split-shell-arguments
              This  function splits the line currently being edited into shell
              arguments and whitespace.  The result is stored in the array re-
              ply.   The  array  contains  all the parts of the line in order,
              starting with any whitespace before the first argument, and fin-
              ishing  with  any whitespace after the last argument.  Hence (so
              long as the option KSH_ARRAYS is not set) whitespace is given by
              odd  indices  in  the array and arguments by even indices.  Note
              that no stripping of quotes is done; joining  together  all  the
              elements of reply in order is guaranteed to produce the original
              line.

              The parameter REPLY is set to the index of  the  word  in  reply
              which  contains  the character after the cursor, where the first
              element has index 1.  The parameter REPLY2 is set to  the  index
              of  the character under the cursor in that word, where the first
              character has index 1.

              Hence reply, REPLY and REPLY2 should all be made  local  to  the
              enclosing function.

              See  the  function modify-current-argument, described below, for
              an example of how to call this function.

       modify-current-argument [ expr-using-$ARG | func ]
              This function provides a simple method of allowing  user-defined
              widgets to modify the command line argument under the cursor (or
              immediately to the left of the cursor if the cursor  is  between
              arguments).

              The  argument can be an expression which when evaluated operates
              on the shell parameter ARG, which will have been set to the com-
              mand  line  argument under the cursor.  The expression should be
              suitably quoted to prevent it being evaluated too early.

              Alternatively, if the argument does not contain the string  ARG,
              it  is assumed to be a shell function, to which the current com-
              mand line argument is passed as the only argument.  The function
              should  set  the variable REPLY to the new value for the command
              line argument.  If the function returns non-zero status, so does
              the calling function.

              For example, a user-defined widget containing the following code
              converts the characters in the argument under  the  cursor  into
              all upper case:

                     modify-current-argument '${(U)ARG}'

              The  following strips any quoting from the current word (whether
              backslashes or one of the styles of  quotes),  and  replaces  it
              with single quoting throughout:

                     modify-current-argument '${(qq)${(Q)ARG}}'

              The  following  performs directory expansion on the command line
              argument and replaces it by the absolute path:

                     expand-dir() {
                       REPLY=${~1}
                       REPLY=${REPLY:a}
                     }
                     modify-current-argument expand-dir

              In practice the function expand-dir would probably  not  be  de-
              fined within the widget where modify-current-argument is called.

   Styles
       The  behavior  of several of the above widgets can be controlled by the
       use of the zstyle mechanism.  In particular, widgets that interact with
       the  completion system pass along their context to any completions that
       they invoke.

       break-keys
              This style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget.  Its
              value  should  be  a pattern, and all keys matching this pattern
              will cause the widget to stop incremental completion without the
              key  having any further effect. Like all styles used directly by
              incremental-complete-word, this style is  looked  up  using  the
              context `:incremental'.

       completer
              The incremental-complete-word and insert-and-predict widgets set
              up their top-level context name before calling completion.  This
              allows  one  to define different sets of completer functions for
              normal completion and for these widgets.  For  example,  to  use
              completion,  approximation and correction for normal completion,
              completion and correction for incremental  completion  and  only
              completion for prediction one could use:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
                             _complete _correct _approximate
                     zstyle ':completion:incremental:*' completer \
                             _complete _correct
                     zstyle ':completion:predict:*' completer \
                             _complete

              It is a good idea to restrict the completers used in prediction,
              because they may be automatically  invoked  as  you  type.   The
              _list and _menu completers should never be used with prediction.
              The _approximate, _correct, _expand, and _match  completers  may
              be  used,  but be aware that they may change characters anywhere
              in the word behind the cursor, so you need  to  watch  carefully
              that the result is what you intended.

       cursor The  insert-and-predict  widget  uses this style, in the context
              `:predict', to decide where to place the cursor after completion
              has been tried.  Values are:

              complete
                     The cursor is left where it was when completion finished,
                     but only if it is after a character equal to the one just
                     inserted  by the user.  If it is after another character,
                     this value is the same as `key'.

              key    The cursor is left after the nth occurrence of the  char-
                     acter  just inserted, where n is the number of times that
                     character appeared in the word before completion was  at-
                     tempted.   In  short,  this has the effect of leaving the
                     cursor after the character just typed even if the comple-
                     tion  code  found out that no other characters need to be
                     inserted at that position.

              Any other value for this style unconditionally leaves the cursor
              at the position where the completion code left it.

       list   When using the incremental-complete-word widget, this style says
              if the matches should be listed on every key press (if they  fit
              on  the  screen).  Use the context prefix `:completion:incremen-
              tal'.

              The insert-and-predict widget uses this style to decide  if  the
              completion  should  be  shown even if there is only one possible
              completion.  This is done if the value  of  this  style  is  the
              string  always.   In  this  case  the context is `:predict' (not
              `:completion:predict').

       match  This style is used by smart-insert-last-word to provide  a  pat-
              tern (using full EXTENDED_GLOB syntax) that matches an interest-
              ing word.  The context is  the  name  of  the  widget  to  which
              smart-insert-last-word is bound (see above).  The default behav-
              ior of smart-insert-last-word is equivalent to:

                     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:]/\\]*'

              However, you might want to include words that contain spaces:

                     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:][:space:]/\\]*'

              Or include numbers as long as the word is at least  two  charac-
              ters long:

                     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*([[:digit:]]?|[[:alpha:]/\\])*'

              The above example causes redirections like "2>" to be included.

       prompt The  incremental-complete-word  widget  shows  the value of this
              style in the status line  during  incremental  completion.   The
              string  value may contain any of the following substrings in the
              manner of the PS1 and other prompt parameters:

              %c     Replaced by the name of the completer function that  gen-
                     erated the matches (without the leading underscore).

              %l     When the list style is set, replaced by `...' if the list
                     of matches is too long to fit on the screen and  with  an
                     empty  string otherwise.  If the list style is `false' or
                     not set, `%l' is always removed.

              %n     Replaced by the number of matches generated.

              %s     Replaced by `-no match-',  `-no  prefix-',  or  an  empty
                     string if there is no completion matching the word on the
                     line, if the matches have no common prefix different from
                     the  word  on the line, or if there is such a common pre-
                     fix, respectively.

              %u     Replaced by the unambiguous part of all matches, if there
                     is any, and if it is different from the word on the line.

              Like `break-keys', this uses the `:incremental' context.

       stop-keys
              This style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget.  Its
              value is treated similarly to the one for the  break-keys  style
              (and  uses  the same context: `:incremental').  However, in this
              case all keys matching the pattern given as its value will  stop
              incremental  completion  and will then execute their usual func-
              tion.

       toggle This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related widgets
              in the context `:predict'.  If set to one of the standard `true'
              values, predictive typing is automatically toggled off in situa-
              tions  where it is unlikely to be useful, such as when editing a
              multi-line buffer or after moving into the middle of a line  and
              then  deleting  a character.  The default is to leave prediction
              turned on until an explicit call to predict-off.

       verbose
              This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related widgets
              in the context `:predict'.  If set to one of the standard `true'
              values, these widgets display a message below  the  prompt  when
              the  predictive state is toggled.  This is most useful in combi-
              nation with the toggle style.   The  default  does  not  display
              these messages.

       widget This style is similar to the command style: For widget functions
              that use zle to call other widgets, this style can sometimes  be
              used  to  override  the widget which is called.  The context for
              this style is the name of the calling widget (not  the  name  of
              the  calling function, because one function may be bound to mul-
              tiple widget names).

                     zstyle :copy-earlier-word widget smart-insert-last-word

              Check the documentation for the calling widget  or  function  to
              determine whether the widget style is used.

EXCEPTION HANDLING
       Two  functions are provided to enable zsh to provide exception handling
       in a form that should be familiar from other languages.

       throw exception
              The function throw throws the named exception.  The name  is  an
              arbitrary  string  and is only used by the throw and catch func-
              tions.  An exception is for the most part treated the same as  a
              shell error, i.e. an unhandled exception will cause the shell to
              abort all processing in a function or script and  to  return  to
              the top level in an interactive shell.

       catch exception-pattern
              The  function  catch  returns  status  zero  if an exception was
              thrown and the pattern exception-pattern matches its name.  Oth-
              erwise  it  returns  status  1.  exception-pattern is a standard
              shell  pattern,  respecting  the  current  setting  of  the  EX-
              TENDED_GLOB  option.   An alias catch is also defined to prevent
              the argument to the function from matching  filenames,  so  pat-
              terns  may  be  used  unquoted.  Note that as exceptions are not
              fundamentally different from other shell errors it  is  possible
              to  catch shell errors by using an empty string as the exception
              name.  The shell variable CAUGHT is set by catch to the name  of
              the exception caught.  It is possible to rethrow an exception by
              calling the throw function again  once  an  exception  has  been
              caught.

       The  functions  are  designed  to be used together with the always con-
       struct described in zshmisc(1).  This is important as  only  this  con-
       struct provides the required support for exceptions.  A typical example
       is as follows.

              {
                # "try" block
                # ... nested code here calls "throw MyExcept"
              } always {
                # "always" block
                if catch MyExcept; then
                  print "Caught exception MyExcept"
                elif catch ''; then
                  print "Caught a shell error.  Propagating..."
                  throw ''
                fi
                # Other exceptions are not handled but may be caught further
                # up the call stack.
              }

       If all exceptions should  be  caught,  the  following  idiom  might  be
       preferable.

              {
                # ... nested code here throws an exception
              } always {
                if catch *; then
                  case $CAUGHT in
                    (MyExcept)
                    print "Caught my own exception"
                    ;;
                    (*)
                    print "Caught some other exception"
                    ;;
                  esac
                fi
              }

       In common with exception handling in other languages, the exception may
       be thrown by code deeply nested inside the `try' block.  However,  note
       that  it  must  be  thrown  inside the current shell, not in a subshell
       forked for a pipeline, parenthesised current-shell construct,  or  some
       form of command or process substitution.

       The  system  internally uses the shell variable EXCEPTION to record the
       name of the exception between throwing and catching.  One  drawback  of
       this scheme is that if the exception is not handled the variable EXCEP-
       TION remains set and may be incorrectly recognised as the  name  of  an
       exception if a shell error subsequently occurs.  Adding unset EXCEPTION
       at the start of the outermost layer of any  code  that  uses  exception
       handling will eliminate this problem.

MIME FUNCTIONS
       Three  functions  are available to provide handling of files recognised
       by extension, for example to dispatch a file text.ps when executed as a
       command to an appropriate viewer.

       zsh-mime-setup [ -fv ] [ -l [ suffix ... ] ]
       zsh-mime-handler [ -l ] command argument ...
              These   two   functions   use   the   files   ~/.mime.types  and
              /etc/mime.types, which associate types and extensions,  as  well
              as  ~/.mailcap and /etc/mailcap files, which associate types and
              the programs that handle them.  These are provided on many  sys-
              tems with the Multimedia Internet Mail Extensions.

              To  enable the system, the function zsh-mime-setup should be au-
              toloaded and run.  This  allows  files  with  extensions  to  be
              treated  as  executable; such files be completed by the function
              completion system.  The  function  zsh-mime-handler  should  not
              need to be called by the user.

              The  system  works by setting up suffix aliases with `alias -s'.
              Suffix aliases already installed by the user will not  be  over-
              written.

              For  suffixes  defined  in  lower case, upper case variants will
              also automatically be handled (e.g. PDF is automatically handled
              if handling for the suffix pdf is defined), but not vice versa.

              Repeated  calls  to  zsh-mime-setup do not override the existing
              mapping between suffixes and executable files unless the  option
              -f  is given.  Note, however, that this does not override exist-
              ing suffix aliases assigned to handlers other than zsh-mime-han-
              dler.

              Calling  zsh-mime-setup  with  the  option -l lists the existing
              mappings without altering them.  Suffixes  to  list  (which  may
              contain  pattern characters that should be quoted from immediate
              interpretation on the command line) may be given  as  additional
              arguments, otherwise all suffixes are listed.

              Calling  zsh-mime-setup with the option -v causes verbose output
              to be shown during the setup operation.

              The system respects the mailcap flags  needsterminal  and  copi-
              ousoutput;  see  mailcap(4)  or  mailcap(5) (the man page's name
              varies across platforms).

              The functions use the following styles, which are  defined  with
              the  zstyle builtin command (see zshmodules(1)).  They should be
              defined before zsh-mime-setup is run.   The  contexts  used  all
              start with :mime:, with additional components in some cases.  It
              is recommended that a trailing * (suitably quoted)  be  appended
              to  style  patterns  in  case  the system is extended in future.
              Some examples are given below.

              For files that have multiple suffixes, e.g. .pdf.gz,  where  the
              context  includes  the suffix it will be looked up starting with
              the longest possible suffix until  a  match  for  the  style  is
              found.   For  example,  if .pdf.gz produces a match for the han-
              dler, that will be used; otherwise the handler for .gz  will  be
              used.   Note  that,  owing to the way suffix aliases work, it is
              always required that there be a handler for the shortest  possi-
              ble  suffix,  so  in this example .pdf.gz can only be handled if
              .gz is also handled (though not necessarily in  the  same  way).
              Alternatively, if no handling for .gz on its own is needed, sim-
              ply adding the command

                     alias -s gz=zsh-mime-handler

              to the initialisation code is sufficient; .gz will not  be  han-
              dled on its own, but may be in combination with other suffixes.

              current-shell
                     If  this  boolean  style is true, the mailcap handler for
                     the context in question is run using the eval builtin in-
                     stead  of by starting a new sh process.  This is more ef-
                     ficient, but may not work in the occasional  cases  where
                     the mailcap handler uses strict POSIX syntax.

              disown If  this  boolean style is true, mailcap handlers started
                     in the background will be disowned, i.e. not  subject  to
                     job  control  within  the  parent  shell.   Such handlers
                     nearly always produce their  own  windows,  so  the  only
                     likely  harmful  side effect of setting the style is that
                     it becomes harder to kill jobs from within the shell.

              execute-as-is
                     This style gives a list of patterns to be matched against
                     files  passed  for  execution with a handler program.  If
                     the file matches the pattern, the entire command line  is
                     executed  in  its current form, with no handler.  This is
                     useful for files which might have suffixes  but  nonethe-
                     less  be  executable in their own right.  If the style is
                     not set, the pattern *(*) *(/) is used; hence  executable
                     files  are executed directly and not passed to a handler,
                     and the option AUTO_CD may be used to change to  directo-
                     ries that happen to have MIME suffixes.

              execute-never
                     This  style  is useful in combination with execute-as-is.
                     It is set to an array of patterns corresponding  to  full
                     paths  to  files  that  should  never  be treated as exe-
                     cutable, even if the file  passed  to  the  MIME  handler
                     matches  execute-as-is.   This is useful for file systems
                     that don't handle execute permission or that contain exe-
                     cutables  from another operating system.  For example, if
                     /mnt/windows is a Windows mount, then

                            zstyle ':mime:*' execute-never '/mnt/windows/*'

                     will ensure that any files found in that area will be ex-
                     ecuted  as  MIME  types  even if they are executable.  As
                     this example shows, the complete  file  name  is  matched
                     against  the  pattern,  regardless  of  how  the file was
                     passed to the handler.  The file is resolved  to  a  full
                     path  using  the  :P modifier described in the subsection
                     `Modifiers' in zshexpn(1); this means that symbolic links
                     are  resolved  where  possible,  so that links into other
                     file systems behave in the correct fashion.

              file-path
                     Used if the style find-file-in-path is true for the  same
                     context.   Set  to  an array of directories that are used
                     for searching for the file to be handled; the default  is
                     the  command  path  given  by the special parameter path.
                     The shell option PATH_DIRS is respected; if that is  set,
                     the appropriate path will be searched even if the name of
                     the file to be handled as it appears on the command  line
                     contains  a  `/'.  The full context is :mime:.suffix:, as
                     described for the style handler.

              find-file-in-path
                     If set, allows files whose names do not contain  absolute
                     paths  to be searched for in the command path or the path
                     specified by the file-path style.  If  the  file  is  not
                     found  in  the path, it is looked for locally (whether or
                     not the current directory is in the path); if it  is  not
                     found  locally,  the  handler  will abort unless the han-
                     dle-nonexistent style is set.  Files found  in  the  path
                     are tested as described for the style execute-as-is.  The
                     full context is  :mime:.suffix:,  as  described  for  the
                     style handler.

              flags  Defines flags to go with a handler; the context is as for
                     the handler style, and the format is as for the flags  in
                     mailcap.

              handle-nonexistent
                     By  default, arguments that don't correspond to files are
                     not passed to the MIME handler in  order  to  prevent  it
                     from  intercepting commands found in the path that happen
                     to have suffixes.  This style may be set to an  array  of
                     extended  glob patterns for arguments that will be passed
                     to the handler even if they don't exist.  If  it  is  not
                     explicitly  set  it defaults to [[:alpha:]]#:/* which al-
                     lows URLs to be passed to the MIME  handler  even  though
                     they  don't exist in that format in the file system.  The
                     full context is  :mime:.suffix:,  as  described  for  the
                     style handler.

              handler
                     Specifies  a handler for a suffix; the suffix is given by
                     the context as :mime:.suffix:, and the format of the han-
                     dler  is exactly that in mailcap.  Note in particular the
                     `.' and trailing colon to distinguish  this  use  of  the
                     context.   This  overrides  any  handler specified by the
                     mailcap files.  If the handler requires a  terminal,  the
                     flags style should be set to include the word needstermi-
                     nal, or if the output is to be displayed through a  pager
                     (but not if the handler is itself a pager), it should in-
                     clude copiousoutput.

              mailcap
                     A  list  of  files  in  the  format  of  ~/.mailcap   and
                     /etc/mailcap  to  be read during setup, replacing the de-
                     fault list which consists of those two files.   The  con-
                     text  is :mime:.  A + in the list will be replaced by the
                     default files.

              mailcap-priorities
                     This style is used to resolve  multiple  mailcap  entries
                     for  the  same MIME type.  It consists of an array of the
                     following elements,  in  descending  order  of  priority;
                     later  entries will be used if earlier entries are unable
                     to resolve the entries being compared.  If  none  of  the
                     tests resolve the entries, the first entry encountered is
                     retained.

                     files  The order of files (entries in the mailcap  style)
                            read.   Earlier  files  are preferred.  (Note this
                            does not resolve entries in the same file.)

                     priority
                            The priority flag from  the  mailcap  entry.   The
                            priority  is  an  integer from 0 to 9 with the de-
                            fault value being 5.

                     flags  The test given by the mailcap-prio-flags option is
                            used to resolve entries.

                     place  Later  entries  are  preferred; as the entries are
                            strictly ordered, this test always succeeds.

                     Note that as this style is handled during initialisation,
                     the  context  is always :mime:, with no discrimination by
                     suffix.

              mailcap-prio-flags
                     This style is used when the keyword flags is  encountered
                     in  the list of tests specified by the mailcap-priorities
                     style.  It should be set to a list of patterns,  each  of
                     which  is tested against the flags specified in the mail-
                     cap entry (in other words, the sets of assignments  found
                     with some entries in the mailcap file).  Earlier patterns
                     in the list are preferred to later ones, and matched pat-
                     terns are preferred to unmatched ones.

              mime-types
                     A  list  of  files  in  the  format  of ~/.mime.types and
                     /etc/mime.types to be read during  setup,  replacing  the
                     default list which consists of those two files.  The con-
                     text is :mime:.  A + in the list will be replaced by  the
                     default files.

              never-background
                     If  this  boolean style is set, the handler for the given
                     context is always run in  the  foreground,  even  if  the
                     flags  provided  in the mailcap entry suggest it need not
                     be (for example, it doesn't require a terminal).

              pager  If set, will be used instead of $PAGER or more to  handle
                     suffixes  where  the copiousoutput flag is set.  The con-
                     text is as for handler, i.e. :mime:.suffix: for  handling
                     a file with the given suffix.

              Examples:

                     zstyle ':mime:*' mailcap ~/.mailcap /usr/local/etc/mailcap
                     zstyle ':mime:.txt:' handler less %s
                     zstyle ':mime:.txt:' flags needsterminal

              When  zsh-mime-setup is subsequently run, it will look for mail-
              cap entries in the two files given.  Files of suffix  .txt  will
              be  handled  by running `less file.txt'.  The flag needsterminal
              is set to show that this program must run attached to  a  termi-
              nal.

              As there are several steps to dispatching a command, the follow-
              ing should be checked if attempting to execute a file by  exten-
              sion .ext does not have the expected effect.

              The  command  `alias  -s ext' should show `ps=zsh-mime-handler'.
              If it shows something else, another suffix alias was already in-
              stalled  and  was not overwritten.  If it shows nothing, no han-
              dler was installed:  this is most likely because no handler  was
              found in the .mime.types and mailcap combination for .ext files.
              In  that  case,  appropriate  handling  should   be   added   to
              ~/.mime.types and mailcap.

              If  the extension is handled by zsh-mime-handler but the file is
              not opened correctly, either the handler defined for the type is
              incorrect,  or  the flags associated with it are in appropriate.
              Running zsh-mime-setup -l will show the handler  and,  if  there
              are any, the flags.  A %s in the handler is replaced by the file
              (suitably quoted if necessary).  Check that the handler  program
              listed  lists  and can be run in the way shown.  Also check that
              the flags needsterminal or copiousoutput are set if the  handler
              needs to be run under a terminal; the second flag is used if the
              output should be sent to a pager.   An  example  of  a  suitable
              mailcap entry for such a program is:

                     text/html; /usr/bin/lynx '%s'; needsterminal

              Running  `zsh-mime-handler  -l  command line' prints the command
              line that would be executed, simplified to remove the effect  of
              any  flags,  and  quoted so that the output can be run as a com-
              plete zsh command line.  This is used by the  completion  system
              to   decide   how   to   complete   after   a  file  handled  by
              zsh-mime-setup.

       pick-web-browser
              This function is separate from the two MIME functions  described
              above and can be assigned directly to a suffix:

                     autoload -U pick-web-browser
                     alias -s html=pick-web-browser

              It  is  provided  as  an intelligent front end to dispatch a web
              browser.  It may be run as either a function or a shell  script.
              The status 255 is returned if no browser could be started.

              Various   styles  are  available  to  customize  the  choice  of
              browsers:

              browser-style
                     The value of the style is an array giving preferences  in
                     decreasing  order  for  the  type of browser to use.  The
                     values of elements may be

                     running
                            Use a GUI browser that is already running when  an
                            X  Window  display  is  available.   The  browsers
                            listed in the x-browsers style are tried in  order
                            until  one  is  found;  if it is, the file will be
                            displayed in that browser, so the user may need to
                            check  whether  it  has  appeared.   If no running
                            browser is found, one is  not  started.   Browsers
                            other  than  Firefox,  Opera and Konqueror are as-
                            sumed to understand the Mozilla syntax for opening
                            a URL remotely.

                     x      Start  a  new GUI browser when an X Window display
                            is available.  Search for the availability of  one
                            of the browsers listed in the x-browsers style and
                            start the first one that is found.   No  check  is
                            made for an already running browser.

                     tty    Start  a  terminal-based  browser.  Search for the
                            availability of one of the browsers listed in  the
                            tty-browsers style and start the first one that is
                            found.

                     If the style is not set the  default  running  x  tty  is
                     used.

              x-browsers
                     An array in decreasing order of preference of browsers to
                     use when running under the X Window  System.   The  array
                     consists  of  the  command  name under which to start the
                     browser.  They are looked up in the context :mime: (which
                     may  be  extended  in  future, so appending `*' is recom-
                     mended).  For example,

                            zstyle ':mime:*' x-browsers opera konqueror firefox

                     specifies that pick-web-browser should first look  for  a
                     running  instance of Opera, Konqueror or Firefox, in that
                     order, and if it fails to  find  any  should  attempt  to
                     start  Opera.   The  default  is firefox mozilla netscape
                     opera konqueror.

              tty-browsers
                     An array similar to  x-browsers,  except  that  it  gives
                     browsers  to  use  when no X Window display is available.
                     The default is elinks links lynx.

              command
                     If it is set this style is used to pick the command  used
                     to   open   a   page  for  a  browser.   The  context  is
                     :mime:browser:new:$browser: to start  a  new  browser  or
                     :mime:browser:running:$browser:   to  open  a  URL  in  a
                     browser already running on the current X  display,  where
                     $browser  is  the  value  matched  in  the  x-browsers or
                     tty-browsers  style.   The  escape  sequence  %b  in  the
                     style's  value  will be replaced by the browser, while %u
                     will be replaced by the URL.  If the style  is  not  set,
                     the  default for all new instances is equivalent to %b %u
                     and the defaults for using running browsers  are  equiva-
                     lent  to  the  values kfmclient openURL %u for Konqueror,
                     firefox -new-tab %u for Firefox, opera  -newpage  %u  for
                     Opera, and %b -remote "openUrl(%u)" for all others.

MATHEMATICAL FUNCTIONS
       zcalc [ -erf ] [ expression ... ]
              A reasonably powerful calculator based on zsh's arithmetic eval-
              uation facility.  The syntax is similar to that of  formulae  in
              most  programming languages; see the section `Arithmetic Evalua-
              tion' in zshmisc(1) for details.

              Non-programmers should note that, as in many  other  programming
              languages,  expressions  involving  only  integers (whether con-
              stants without a `.', variables  containing  such  constants  as
              strings,  or  variables  declared to be integers) are by default
              evaluated using integer arithmetic, which is not how an ordinary
              desk  calculator  operates.   To force floating point operation,
              pass the option -f; see further notes below.

              If the file ~/.zcalcrc exists it  will  be  sourced  inside  the
              function  once  it  is  set  up and about to process the command
              line.  This can be used, for example, to set shell options; emu-
              late -L zsh and setopt extendedglob are in effect at this point.
              Any failure to source the file if it exists is treated as fatal.
              As  with  other  initialisation files, the directory $ZDOTDIR is
              used instead of $HOME if it is set.

              The mathematical library zsh/mathfunc will be loaded  if  it  is
              available;  see the section `The zsh/mathfunc Module' in zshmod-
              ules(1).  The mathematical functions correspond to the raw  sys-
              tem  libraries,  so  trigonometric functions are evaluated using
              radians, and so on.

              Each line typed is evaluated as an expression.  The prompt shows
              a  number, which corresponds to a positional parameter where the
              result of that calculation is stored.  For example,  the  result
              of the calculation on the line preceded by `4> ' is available as
              $4.  The last value calculated is available as ans.   Full  com-
              mand  line  editing,  including the history of previous calcula-
              tions,  is  available;  the  history  is  saved  in   the   file
              ~/.zcalc_history.   To  exit, enter a blank line or type `:q' on
              its own (`q' is allowed for historical compatibility).

              A line ending with a single backslash is  treated  in  the  same
              fashion  as it is in command line editing:  the backslash is re-
              moved, the function prompts for more input (the prompt  is  pre-
              ceded  by  `...'  to  indicate this), and the lines are combined
              into one to get the final result.  In addition, if the input  so
              far  contains more open than close parentheses zcalc will prompt
              for more input.

              If arguments are given to zcalc on start up, they  are  used  to
              prime  the first few positional parameters.  A visual indication
              of this is given when the calculator starts.

              The constants PI (3.14159...) and E (2.71828...)  are  provided.
              Parameter  assignment  is possible, but note that all parameters
              will be put into the global namespace unless the :local  special
              command  is  used.   The  function creates local variables whose
              names start with _, so users should avoid doing so.   The  vari-
              ables  ans  (the  last answer) and stack (the stack in RPN mode)
              may be referred to directly; stack is an array but  elements  of
              it  are  numeric.   Various other special variables are used lo-
              cally with their  standard  meaning,  for  example  compcontext,
              match, mbegin, mend, psvar.

              The  output  base  can  be  initialised  by  passing  the option
              `-#base', for example `zcalc -#16'  (the  `#'  may  have  to  be
              quoted, depending on the globbing options set).

              If  the option `-e' is set, the function runs non-interactively:
              the arguments are treated as expressions to be evaluated  as  if
              entered interactively line by line.

              If  the  option `-f' is set, all numbers are treated as floating
              point, hence for example the expression `3/4' evaluates to  0.75
              rather than 0.  Options must appear in separate words.

              If the option `-r' is set, RPN (Reverse Polish Notation) mode is
              entered.  This has various additional properties:
              Stack  Evaluated values are maintained in a stack; this is  con-
                     tained in an array named stack with the most recent value
                     in ${stack[1]}.

              Operators and functions
                     If the line entered matches an operator (+, -, *, /,  **,
                     ^, | or &) or a function supplied by the zsh/mathfunc li-
                     brary, the bottom element or elements of  the  stack  are
                     popped  to  use as the argument or arguments.  The higher
                     elements of stack (least recent) are used as earlier  ar-
                     guments.  The result is then pushed into ${stack[1]}.

              Expressions
                     Other  expressions  are  evaluated normally, printed, and
                     added to the stack as numeric values.  The syntax  within
                     expressions  on  a single line is normal shell arithmetic
                     (not RPN).

              Stack listing
                     If an integer follows the option -r with no  space,  then
                     on  every  evaluation  that  many  elements of the stack,
                     where available, are printed instead of just the most re-
                     cent   result.   Hence,  for  example,  zcalc  -r4  shows
                     $stack[4] to $stack[1] each time results are printed.

              Duplication: =
                     The pseudo-operator = causes the most recent  element  of
                     the stack to be duplicated onto the stack.

              pop    The pseudo-function pop causes the most recent element of
                     the stack to be popped.  A `>' on its own  has  the  same
                     effect.

              >ident The  expression  >  followed  (with  no space) by a shell
                     identifier causes the most recent element of the stack to
                     be  popped  and  assigned to the variable with that name.
                     The variable is local to the zcalc function.

              <ident The expression < followed (with  no  space)  by  a  shell
                     identifier  causes  the  value  of the variable with that
                     name to be pushed onto the stack.  ident may be an  inte-
                     ger,  in  which case the previous result with that number
                     (as shown before the > in the standard zcalc  prompt)  is
                     put on the stack.

              Exchange: xy
                     The  pseudo-function  xy  causes the most recent two ele-
                     ments of the stack to be exchanged.  `<>'  has  the  same
                     effect.

              The  prompt is configurable via the parameter ZCALCPROMPT, which
              undergoes standard prompt expansion.  The index of  the  current
              entry is stored locally in the first element of the array psvar,
              which can be referred to in ZCALCPROMPT as `%1v'.   The  default
              prompt is `%1v> '.

              The  variable ZCALC_ACTIVE is set within the function and can be
              tested by nested functions; it has the value rpn if RPN mode  is
              active, else 1.

              A  few special commands are available; these are introduced by a
              colon.  For backward compatibility, the colon may be omitted for
              certain  commands.  Completion is available if compinit has been
              run.

              The output precision may be specified within  zcalc  by  special
              commands familiar from many calculators.
              :norm  The  default output format.  It corresponds to the printf
                     %g specification.  Typically this shows six decimal  dig-
                     its.

              :sci digits
                     Scientific  notation, corresponding to the printf %g out-
                     put format with the precision given by digits.  This pro-
                     duces  either fixed point or exponential notation depend-
                     ing on the value output.

              :fix digits
                     Fixed point notation, corresponding to the printf %f out-
                     put format with the precision given by digits.

              :eng digits
                     Exponential notation, corresponding to the printf %E out-
                     put format with the precision given by digits.

              :raw   Raw output:  this is the default form of the output  from
                     a math evaluation.  This may show more precision than the
                     number actually possesses.

              Other special commands:
              :!line...
                     Execute line... as a normal  shell  command  line.   Note
                     that  it is executed in the context of the function, i.e.
                     with local variables.  Space is optional after :!.

              :local arg ...
                     Declare variables local to the function.  Other variables
                     may be used, too, but they will be taken from or put into
                     the global scope.

              :function name [ body ]
                     Define a mathematical function or (with no  body)  delete
                     it.   :function may be abbreviated to :func or simply :f.
                     The name may contain the same characters as a shell func-
                     tion  name.   The function is defined using zmathfuncdef,
                     see below.

                     Note that zcalc takes care of all quoting.  Hence for ex-
                     ample:

                            :f cube $1 * $1 * $1

                     defines  a function to cube the sole argument.  Functions
                     so defined, or indeed any functions defined  directly  or
                     indirectly  using  functions -M, are available to execute
                     by typing only the name on the line  in  RPN  mode;  this
                     pops the appropriate number of arguments off the stack to
                     pass to the function, i.e. 1 in the case of  the  example
                     cube  function.  If there are optional arguments only the
                     mandatory arguments are supplied by this means.

              [#base]
                     This is not a special  command,  rather  part  of  normal
                     arithmetic  syntax;  however, when this form appears on a
                     line by itself the default output radix is set  to  base.
                     Use,  for  example, `[#16]' to display hexadecimal output
                     preceded by an indication of the base, or  `[##16]'  just
                     to display the raw number in the given base.  Bases them-
                     selves are always specified in  decimal.  `[#]'  restores
                     the  normal  output  format.  Note that setting an output
                     base suppresses floating point output; use `[#]'  to  re-
                     turn to normal operation.

              $var   Print out the value of var literally; does not affect the
                     calculation.  To use the value of var, omit  the  leading
                     `$'.

              See the comments in the function for a few extra tips.

       min(arg, ...)
       max(arg, ...)
       sum(arg, ...)
       zmathfunc
              The  function zmathfunc defines the three mathematical functions
              min, max, and sum.  The functions min and max take one  or  more
              arguments.   The function sum takes zero or more arguments.  Ar-
              guments can be of different types (ints and floats).

              Not to be confused with the zsh/mathfunc  module,  described  in
              the section `The zsh/mathfunc Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zmathfuncdef [ mathfunc [ body ] ]
              A convenient front end to functions -M.

              With  two  arguments, define a mathematical function named math-
              func which can be used in any  form  of  arithmetic  evaluation.
              body is a mathematical expression to implement the function.  It
              may contain references to position parameters $1,  $2,  ...   to
              refer  to  mandatory parameters and ${1:-defvalue} ...  to refer
              to optional parameters.  Note that the forms  must  be  strictly
              adhered  to  for the function to calculate the correct number of
              arguments.  The implementation is held in a shell function named
              zsh_math_func_mathfunc;  usually the user will not need to refer
              to the shell function directly.  Any existing  function  of  the
              same name is silently replaced.

              With  one argument, remove the mathematical function mathfunc as
              well as the shell function implementation.

              With no arguments, list all mathfunc functions in a  form  suit-
              able  for restoring the definition.  The functions have not nec-
              essarily been defined by zmathfuncdef.

USER CONFIGURATION FUNCTIONS
       The zsh/newuser module comes with a  function  to  aid  in  configuring
       shell options for new users.  If the module is installed, this function
       can also be run by hand.  It is available even if the module's  default
       behaviour,  namely running the function for a new user logging in with-
       out startup files, is inhibited.

       zsh-newuser-install [ -f ]
              The function presents the user with  various  options  for  cus-
              tomizing  their initialization scripts.  Currently only ~/.zshrc
              is handled.  $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc is used instead  if  the  parameter
              ZDOTDIR  is set; this provides a way for the user to configure a
              file without altering an existing .zshrc.

              By default the function exits immediately if it finds any of the
              files  .zshenv, .zprofile, .zshrc, or .zlogin in the appropriate
              directory.  The option -f is required  in  order  to  force  the
              function  to  continue.  Note this may happen even if .zshrc it-
              self does not exist.

              As currently configured, the function will exit  immediately  if
              the  user has root privileges; this behaviour cannot be overrid-
              den.

              Once activated, the  function's  behaviour  is  supposed  to  be
              self-explanatory.   Menus are present allowing the user to alter
              the value of options and parameters.  Suggestions  for  improve-
              ments are always welcome.

              When the script exits, the user is given the opportunity to save
              the new file or not; changes are  not  irreversible  until  this
              point.   However,  the  script is careful to restrict changes to
              the file only to a group marked by the lines `# Lines configured
              by  zsh-newuser-install'  and  `#  End  of  lines  configured by
              zsh-newuser-install'.  In addition, the old version of .zshrc is
              saved to a file with the suffix .zni appended.

              If  the  function edits an existing .zshrc, it is up to the user
              to ensure that the changes made will take effect.  For  example,
              if  control  usually  returns early from the existing .zshrc the
              lines will not be executed; or a later initialization  file  may
              override  options or parameters, and so on.  The function itself
              does not attempt to detect any such conflicts.

OTHER FUNCTIONS
       There are a large number of helpful functions in the Functions/Misc di-
       rectory  of  the zsh distribution.  Most are very simple and do not re-
       quire documentation here, but a few are worthy of special mention.

   Descriptions
       colors This function initializes  several  associative  arrays  to  map
              color names to (and from) the ANSI standard eight-color terminal
              codes.  These are used by the prompt theme system  (see  above).
              You seldom should need to run colors more than once.

              The  eight base colors are: black, red, green, yellow, blue, ma-
              genta, cyan, and white.  Each of these has codes for  foreground
              and  background.   In  addition  there  are  seven intensity at-
              tributes: bold, faint, standout, underline, blink, reverse,  and
              conceal.   Finally,  there  are  seven  codes used to negate at-
              tributes: none (reset all attributes to  the  defaults),  normal
              (neither  bold  nor faint), no-standout, no-underline, no-blink,
              no-reverse, and no-conceal.

              Some terminals do not support all combinations of colors and in-
              tensities.

              The associative arrays are:

              color
              colour Map all the color names to their integer codes, and inte-
                     ger codes to the color names.  The eight base  names  map
                     to  the foreground color codes, as do names prefixed with
                     `fg-', such as `fg-red'.  Names prefixed with `bg-', such
                     as `bg-blue', refer to the background codes.  The reverse
                     mapping from code to color yields  base  name  for  fore-
                     ground codes and the bg- form for backgrounds.

                     Although  it  is  a misnomer to call them `colors', these
                     arrays also map the other fourteen attributes from  names
                     to codes and codes to names.

              fg
              fg_bold
              fg_no_bold
                     Map  the  eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape
                     sequences that  set  the  corresponding  foreground  text
                     properties.   The  fg  sequences change the color without
                     changing the eight intensity attributes.

              bg
              bg_bold
              bg_no_bold
                     Map the eight basic color names to ANSI  terminal  escape
                     sequences  that  set the corresponding background proper-
                     ties.  The bg sequences change the color without changing
                     the eight intensity attributes.

              In  addition,  the  scalar parameters reset_color and bold_color
              are set to the ANSI terminal  escapes  that  turn  off  all  at-
              tributes and turn on bold intensity, respectively.

       fned [ -x num ] name
              Same  as  zed -f.  This function does not appear in the zsh dis-
              tribution, but can be created by linking zed to the name fned in
              some directory in your fpath.

       histed [ [ name ] size ]
              Same  as  zed -h.  This function does not appear in the zsh dis-
              tribution, but can be created by linking zed to the name  histed
              in some directory in your fpath.

       is-at-least needed [ present ]
              Perform  a  greater-than-or-equal-to  comparison  of two strings
              having the format of a zsh version number; that is, a string  of
              numbers  and text with segments separated by dots or dashes.  If
              the present string is not provided, $ZSH_VERSION is used.   Seg-
              ments  are  paired left-to-right in the two strings with leading
              non-number parts ignored.  If one string has fewer segments than
              the other, the missing segments are considered zero.

              This  is  useful in startup files to set options and other state
              that are not available in all versions of zsh.

                     is-at-least 3.1.6-15 && setopt NO_GLOBAL_RCS
                     is-at-least 3.1.0 && setopt HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
                     is-at-least 2.6-17 || print "You can't use is-at-least here."

       nslookup [ arg ... ]
              This wrapper function for  the  nslookup  command  requires  the
              zsh/zpty  module  (see  zshmodules(1)).  It behaves exactly like
              the standard  nslookup  except  that  it  provides  customizable
              prompts  (including  a  right-side  prompt)  and  completion  of
              nslookup commands, host  names,  etc.  (if  you  use  the  func-
              tion-based  completion  system).   Completion  styles may be set
              with the context prefix `:completion:nslookup'.

              See also the pager, prompt and rprompt styles below.

       regexp-replace var regexp replace
              Use regular expressions to perform a global search  and  replace
              operation  on  a  variable.   POSIX extended regular expressions
              (ERE) are used, unless the option RE_MATCH_PCRE has been set, in
              which  case  Perl-compatible  regular expressions are used (this
              requires the shell to be linked against the pcre library).

              var is the name of the variable  containing  the  string  to  be
              matched.   The  variable  will be modified directly by the func-
              tion.  The variables MATCH, MBEGIN, MEND,  match,  mbegin,  mend
              should  be  avoided  as these are used by the regular expression
              code.

              regexp is the regular expression to match against the string.

              replace is the replacement text.  This  can  contain  parameter,
              command  and  arithmetic expressions which will be replaced:  in
              particular, a reference to $MATCH will be replaced by  the  text
              matched by the pattern.

              The return status is 0 if at least one match was performed, else
              1.

              Note that if using POSIX EREs, the ^ or word boundary  operators
              (where available) may not work properly.

       run-help cmd
              This function is designed to be invoked by the run-help ZLE wid-
              get, in place of the  default  alias.   See  `Accessing  On-Line
              Help' above for setup instructions.

              In  the  discussion which follows, if cmd is a file system path,
              it is first reduced to its rightmost component (the file name).

              Help is first sought by looking for a file named cmd in the  di-
              rectory named by the HELPDIR parameter.  If no file is found, an
              assistant function, alias,  or  command  named  run-help-cmd  is
              sought.   If  found,  the assistant is executed with the rest of
              the current command line (everything after the command name cmd)
              as its arguments.  When neither file nor assistant is found, the
              external command `man cmd' is run.

              An example assistant for the "ssh" command:

                     run-help-ssh() {
                         emulate -LR zsh
                         local -a args
                         # Delete the "-l username" option
                         zparseopts -D -E -a args l:
                         # Delete other options, leaving: host command
                         args=(${@:#-*})
                         if [[ ${#args} -lt 2 ]]; then
                             man ssh
                         else
                             run-help $args[2]
                         fi
                     }

              Several of these assistants are provided in  the  Functions/Misc
              directory.   These  must  be autoloaded, or placed as executable
              scripts in your search path, in order to be found  and  used  by
              run-help.

              run-help-btrfs
              run-help-git
              run-help-ip
              run-help-openssl
              run-help-p4
              run-help-sudo
              run-help-svk
              run-help-svn
                     Assistant  functions for the btrfs, git, ip, openssl, p4,
                     sudo, svk, and svn, commands.

       tetris Zsh was once accused of not being as complete as Emacs,  because
              it  lacked  a  Tetris game.  This function was written to refute
              this vicious slander.

              This function must be used as a ZLE widget:

                     autoload -U tetris
                     zle -N tetris
                     bindkey keys tetris

              To start a game, execute the widget by typing the  keys.   What-
              ever  command  line you were editing disappears temporarily, and
              your keymap is also temporarily replaced by the  Tetris  control
              keys.   The  previous editor state is restored when you quit the
              game (by pressing `q') or when you lose.

              If you quit in the middle of a game, the next invocation of  the
              tetris widget will continue where you left off.  If you lost, it
              will start a new game.

       tetriscurses
              This is a port of the above to zcurses.  The input  handling  is
              improved a bit so that moving a block sideways doesn't automati-
              cally advance a timestep, and the  graphics  use  unicode  block
              graphics.

              This  version  does not save the game state between invocations,
              and is not invoked as a widget, but rather as:

                     autoload -U tetriscurses
                     tetriscurses

       zargs [ option ... -- ] [ input ... ] [ -- command [ arg ... ] ]
              This function has a similar purpose to GNU  xargs.   Instead  of
              reading  lines  of  arguments  from the standard input, it takes
              them from the command line.  This is useful because  zsh,  espe-
              cially with recursive glob operators, often can construct a com-
              mand line for a shell function that is longer than  can  be  ac-
              cepted by an external command.

              The  option list represents options of the zargs command itself,
              which are the same as those of xargs.  The  input  list  is  the
              collection  of  strings (often file names) that become the argu-
              ments of the command, analogous to the standard input of  xargs.
              Finally,  the  arg list consists of those arguments (usually op-
              tions) that are passed to the command each time  it  runs.   The
              arg  list precedes the elements from the input list in each run.
              If no command is provided, then no arg list may be provided, and
              in  that event the default command is `print' with arguments `-r
              --'.

              For example, to get a long ls listing of  all  non-hidden  plain
              files in the current directory or its subdirectories:

                     autoload -U zargs
                     zargs -- **/*(.) -- ls -ld --

              The first and third occurrences of `--' are used to mark the end
              of options for zargs and ls respectively to guard against  file-
              names  starting  with  `-', while the second is used to separate
              the list of files from the command to run (`ls -ld --').

              The first `--' would also be needed if there was  a  chance  the
              list might be empty as in:

                     zargs -r -- ./*.back(#qN) -- rm -f

              In  the event that the string `--' is or may be an input, the -e
              option may be used to change  the  end-of-inputs  marker.   Note
              that  this does not change the end-of-options marker.  For exam-
              ple, to use `..' as the marker:

                     zargs -e.. -- **/*(.) .. ls -ld --

              This is a good choice in that example because no plain file  can
              be  named  `..',  but the best end-marker depends on the circum-
              stances.

              The options -i, -I, -l, -L, and -n differ  slightly  from  their
              usage in xargs.  There are no input lines for zargs to count, so
              -l and -L count through the input list, and -n counts the number
              of  arguments passed to each execution of command, including any
              arg list.  Also, any time -i or -I is used, each input  is  pro-
              cessed separately as if by `-L 1'.

              For  details  of  the  other zargs options, see the xargs(1) man
              page (but note the difference  in  function  between  zargs  and
              xargs) or run zargs with the --help option.

       zed [ -f [ -x num ] ] name
       zed [ -h [ name ] size ]
       zed -b This function uses the ZLE editor to edit a file or function.

              Only  one  name argument is allowed.  If the -f option is given,
              the name is taken to be that of a function; if the  function  is
              marked  for  autoloading,  zed  searches for it in the fpath and
              loads it.  Note that functions edited  this  way  are  installed
              into  the  current  shell,  but not written back to the autoload
              file.  In this case the -x option specifies  that  leading  tabs
              indenting  the  function according to syntax should be converted
              into the given number of spaces; `-x 2' is consistent  with  the
              layout of functions distributed with the shell.

              Without  -f,  name  is  the path name of the file to edit, which
              need not exist; it is created on write, if necessary.  With  -h,
              the file is presumed to contain history events.

              When  no  file name is provided for -h the current shell history
              is edited in place.  The history is renumbered  when  zed  exits
              successfully.

              When  editing  history,  multi-line  events must have a trailing
              backslash on every line before the last.

              While editing, the function sets the main keymap to zed and  the
              vi  command  keymap to zed-vicmd.  These will be copied from the
              existing main and vicmd keymaps if they do not exist  the  first
              time  zed is run.  They can be used to provide special key bind-
              ings used only in zed.

              If it creates the keymap, zed rebinds the return key to insert a
              line  break and `^X^W' to accept the edit in the zed keymap, and
              binds `ZZ' to accept the edit in the zed-vicmd keymap.

              The bindings alone can be installed by running `zed  -b'.   This
              is  suitable for putting into a startup file.  Note that, if re-
              run, this will overwrite the existing zed and zed-vicmd keymaps.

              Completion is available, and styles may be set with the  context
              prefix `:completion:zed:'.

              A zle widget zed-set-file-name is available.  This can be called
              by name from within zed using `\ex zed-set-file-name' or can  be
              bound  to  a key in either of the zed or zed-vicmd keymaps after
              `zed -b' has been run.  When the widget is  called,  it  prompts
              for  a  new  name for the file being edited.  When zed exits the
              file will be written under that name and the original file  will
              be  left alone.  The widget has no effect when invoked from `zed
              -f'.   The  completion   context   is   changed   to   `:comple-
              tion:zed-set-file-name:'.  When editing the current history with
              `zed -h', the history is first updated  and  then  the  file  is
              written, but the global setting of HISTFILE is not altered.

              While zed-set-file-name is running, zed uses the keymap zed-nor-
              mal-keymap, which is linked from the main keymap  in  effect  at
              the time zed initialised its bindings.  (This is to make the re-
              turn key operate normally.)  The result  is  that  if  the  main
              keymap has been changed, the widget won't notice.  This is not a
              concern for most users.

       zcp [ -finqQvwW ] srcpat dest
       zln [ -finqQsvwW ] srcpat dest
              Same as zmv -C and zmv -L, respectively.  These functions do not
              appear  in  the  zsh distribution, but can be created by linking
              zmv to the names zcp and zln in some directory in your fpath.

       zkbd   See `Keyboard Definition' above.

       zmv [ -finqQsvwW ] [ -C | -L | -M | -{p|P} program ] [ -o optstring ]
           srcpat dest
              Move (usually, rename) files matching the pattern srcpat to cor-
              responding  files  having names of the form given by dest, where
              srcpat contains parentheses surrounding patterns which  will  be
              replaced in turn by $1, $2, ... in dest.  For example,

                     zmv '(*).lis' '$1.txt'

              renames    `foo.lis'   to   `foo.txt',   `my.old.stuff.lis'   to
              `my.old.stuff.txt', and so on.

              The pattern is always treated as an EXTENDED_GLOB pattern.   Any
              file whose name is not changed by the substitution is simply ig-
              nored.  Any error (a substitution resulted in an  empty  string,
              two  substitutions  gave the same result, the destination was an
              existing regular file and -f was not given)  causes  the  entire
              function to abort without doing anything.

              In  addition  to pattern replacement, the variable $f can be re-
              ferred to in the second (replacement) argument.  This  makes  it
              possible to use variable substitution to alter the argument; see
              examples below.

              Options:

              -f     Force overwriting of destination  files.   Not  currently
                     passed  down  to  the mv/cp/ln command due to vagaries of
                     implementations (but you can use -o-f to do that).
              -i     Interactive: show each line to be executed  and  ask  the
                     user  whether to execute it.  `Y' or `y' will execute it,
                     anything else will skip it.  Note that you just  need  to
                     type one character.
              -n     No execution: print what would happen, but don't do it.
              -q     Turn bare glob qualifiers off: now assumed by default, so
                     this has no effect.
              -Q     Force bare glob qualifiers on.  Don't turn this on unless
                     you are actually using glob qualifiers in a pattern.
              -s     Symbolic, passed down to ln; only works with -L.
              -v     Verbose: print each command as it's being executed.
              -w     Pick  out  wildcard  parts  of  the pattern, as described
                     above, and implicitly add parentheses  for  referring  to
                     them.
              -W     Just  like  -w, with the addition of turning wildcards in
                     the replacement pattern into sequential ${1} .. ${N} ref-
                     erences.
              -C
              -L
              -M     Force  cp, ln or mv, respectively, regardless of the name
                     of the function.
              -p program
                     Call program instead of cp, ln or mv.  Whatever it  does,
                     it  should  at least understand the form `program -- old-
                     name newname' where oldname  and  newname  are  filenames
                     generated  by  zmv.  program will be split into words, so
                     might be e.g. the name of an archive tool plus a copy  or
                     rename subcommand.
              -P program
                     As -p program, except that program does not accept a fol-
                     lowing -- to indicate the end of options.  In  this  case
                     filenames  must already be in a sane form for the program
                     in question.
              -o optstring
                     The optstring is split into words and passed down  verba-
                     tim  to  the  cp,  ln or mv command called to perform the
                     work.  It should probably begin with a `-'.

              Further examples:

                     zmv -v '(* *)' '${1// /_}'

              For any file in the current directory with at least one space in
              the  name,  replace every space by an underscore and display the
              commands executed.

                     zmv -v '* *' '${f// /_}'

              This does exactly the same by referring to the file name  stored
              in $f.

              For more complete examples and other implementation details, see
              the zmv source file, usually located in one of  the  directories
              named in your fpath, or in Functions/Misc/zmv in the zsh distri-
              bution.

       zrecompile
              See `Recompiling Functions' above.

       zstyle+ context style value [ + subcontext style value ... ]
              This makes defining styles a bit simpler by using a  single  `+'
              as  a  special token that allows you to append a context name to
              the previously used context name.  Like this:

                     zstyle+ ':foo:bar' style1 value1 \
                            +':baz'     style2 value2 \
                            +':frob'    style3 value3

              This defines style1 with value1  for  the  context  :foo:bar  as
              usual,  but  it  also defines style2 with value2 for the context
              :foo:bar:baz and style3 with value3 for :foo:bar:frob.  Any sub-
              context  may be the empty string to re-use the first context un-
              changed.

   Styles
       insert-tab
              The zed function sets this style in context  `:completion:zed:*'
              to  turn  off completion when TAB is typed at the beginning of a
              line.  You may override this by setting your own value for  this
              context and style.

       pager  The  nslookup  function  looks  up  this  style  in  the context
              `:nslookup' to determine the program used to display output that
              does not fit on a single screen.

       prompt
       rprompt
              The  nslookup  function  looks  up  this  style  in  the context
              `:nslookup' to set the prompt and the right-side prompt, respec-
              tively.   The  usual  expansions for the PS1 and RPS1 parameters
              may be used (see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)).

ZSHALL(1)                   General Commands Manual                  ZSHALL(1)

FILES
       $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv
       $ZDOTDIR/.zprofile
       $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc
       $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin
       $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout
       ${TMPPREFIX}*   (default is /tmp/zsh*)
       /etc/zsh/zshenv
       /etc/zsh/zprofile
       /etc/zsh/zshrc
       /etc/zsh/zlogin
       /etc/zsh/zlogout    (installation-specific - /etc is the default)

SEE ALSO
       sh(1), csh(1), tcsh(1), rc(1), bash(1), ksh(1)

       IEEE Standard for information Technology -  Portable  Operating  System
       Interface  (POSIX)  - Part 2: Shell and Utilities, IEEE Inc, 1993, ISBN
       1-55937-255-9.

zsh 5.9                          May 14, 2022                        ZSHALL(1)

Generated by dwww version 1.15 on Sun Jun 23 11:32:44 CEST 2024.